Blundell Practical English Grammar


Practical English Grammar
I must reacknowledge my debt to those whose help with the preparation of the first edition continues as a
contribution to the second: Jonathan Blundell, Anthony Cowie, Alan Duff, Christine Forster, Michael
Macfarlane, Nigel Middlemiss, Jonathan Price, Christina Ruse, Loreto Todd, Philip Tregidgo and
Catherine Walter.
There is not enough space to mention all the grammarians and other linguists on whose work I have
drawn, even if I had a complete record of my borrowings; but I must at least pay homage to the
monumental Comprehensive Grammar of the English Language, by Quirk, Greenbaum, Leech and
Svartvik (Longman 1985), whose authoritative account of the facts of English structure and usage
constitutes an essential source of information for anyone writing pedagogic grammar materials today.
It is with particular pleasure that I express my affectionate and deeply-felt gratitude to Stewart Melluish of
Oxford University Press. Without his deployment of the many qualities that distinguish editors from
authors, including heroic calm, unfailing courtesy and monumental patience, this book would still be far
from finished.
Finally, my thanks to Catherine, Mark and Helen for their support and tolerance during the writing of this
book, which has separated me from them for too many hours over too many years.
page x
The purpose of this book
English, like all languages, is full of problems for the foreign learner. Some of these points are easy to
explain - for instance, the formation of questions, the difference between since and for, the meaning of
after all. Other problems are more tricky, and cause difficulty even for advanced students and teachers.
How exactly is the present perfect tense used? When do we use past tenses to be polite? What are the
differences between at, on and wwith expressions of place? We can say a chair leg - why not * a girl leg7.
What are the real rules for the use of like and as? When can we use the expression do so? When is the
used with superlatives? Is unless the same as if not7. What are the differences between come and go,
between each and every, between big, large and great, between fairly, quite, rather and pretty7 Is it correct
to say There's three more bottles in the fridge7 How do you actually say 3x4= 121 And so on, and so on.
This book is a practical reference guide to questions of this kind. It deals with over 600 points which
regularly cause problems for foreign students of English. Most of the points treated are grammatical, but
there are also explanations of a certain number of common vocabulary problems.
Level
The book is intended for intermediate and advanced students, and for teachers of English. Being a
reference book, it contains information at various levels, ranging from relatively simple points to quite
advanced
problems.
Organisation
Problems are mostly explained in short separate entries; the book is more like a dictionary than a
grammar in form. This makes it possible to give a clear complete treatment of each point, and enables the
user to concentrate just on the question he or she needs information about. Entries are arranged
alphabetically by title and numbered in sequence; a comprehensive index shows where each point can be
found.
Approach and style
I have tried to make the presentation as practical as possible. Each entry contains an explanation of a
problem, examples of correct usage, and (when this is useful) examples of typical mistakes. More
complicated items are divided into separate entries: a general explanation first, followed by more complete
information for advanced students and teachers. Explanations are, as far as possible, in simple everyday
language. Where it has been necessary to use grammatical terminology, I have generally preferred to use
traditional terms that are well known and easy to understand. Some of these terms (e.g. future tense)
would be regarded as unsatisfactory by academic grammarians, but I am not writing for specialists. There
is a dictionary of the language terminology used in the book on pages xxi-xxix.
page ri


Introduction The kind of English described
The explanations deal mainly with standard modem British English, and the examples are as realistic as I
can make them. Stylistic differences (e.g. between formal and informal usage, or spoken and written
language) are mentioned where this is appropriate. A good deal of information is given about American
usage, but the book is not intended as a systematic guide to American English.
Correctness
If we say that a form is 'incorrect', we can mean two different things. We may be referring to a form like */
have seen her yesterday, which normally only occurs in the English of foreigners; or we may be talking
about a form like ain 't, which is used in speech by many British and American people, but -which does not
occur in the standard dialects and is not usually written. In this book, I am mainly concerned with the first
sort of 'incorrectness' (the differences between British or American English and 'foreign' English), but I
have mentioned a few examples of the second kind. Sometimes a form is used by some educated people,
but considered wrong by others (e.g. mem It was me that found your keys). When this is the case, I have
said so, but I have not usually tried to suggest who is right.
How to use the book
This is a reference book, not a systematic course in English grammar. It will be most useful to a student
who has made a mistake and wants to find out why it is wrong, or to a teacher who is looking for a clear
explanation of a difficult point of grammar or vocabulary. The best way to find a point is to look in the index
at the back: most problems are indexed under several different names, so it is not usually difficult to locate
quickly the entry you need. (For instance, if you want to know why we say I'm not used to driving on the
left instead of* I'm not used to drive on the left, you can find the number of the section where this is
explained by looking in the index under 'used', 'be used', 'to' or '-ing forms'.)
Other reference books
This book gives explanations of individual points of usage, but does not show how the separate points 'fit
together'. For a systematically organised account of the whole of English grammar, students should
consult a book such as A Student's Grammar of the English Language, by Greenbaum and Quirk
(Longman), the Longman English Grammar, by L.G. Alexander, or the Oxford Guide to English Grammar,
by John Eastwood. For a detailed treatment of English vocabulary, see the Ox ford Advanced Learner's
Dictionary of Current English, the Longman Dictionary of Contemporary English or the Collins Cobuild
English Language Dictionary.
-L
List of entries
1 abbreviated styles 42
2 abbreviations and acronyms 43
3 able 44
4 about and on 45
5 about to 46
6 above and over
7 accept and agree 47
8 according to 48
9 across, over and through 49
10 active verb forms 50
11 actual(ly) 51
12 adjectives: complementation 52
13 adjectives ending in -ed: 53 pronunciation 54
14 adjectives: order before nouns 55
15 adjectives: position 56
16 adjectives: position after as, how, 57 so, too 58
17 adjectives with and 59
18 adjectives without nouns 60
19 adverb particles 61
20 adverbs of manner and adjectives 62
21 adverbs or adjectives? confusing 63 cases 64
22 adverbs: position (general)
23 adverbs: position (details) 65
24 affect and effect 66
25 afraid 67
26 after (adverb)
27 after (conjunction) 68
28 after all 69
29 afternoon, evening and night
30 age 70
31 ago 71
32 alike 72
33 all (I): introduction 73
34 all (2): subject, object or
complement; all, everybody and 74 everything 75
35 all (3): all (of) with nouns and 76 pronouns 77
36 all (4): with verbs 78
37 all and every 79
38 all and whole 80
39 all right and alright 81
40 allow, permit and let 82
alone, lonely, lonesome and lone along
already and all ready also, as well and too also, as well, too and either in negative clauses
alternate(ly) and altemative(ly) although and though altogether and all together American and British
English and
and after try, wait, go etc another and other(s) any
any and every any and no: adverbs any more appear
arise and rise (a) round and about arouse and rouse articles (I): introduction articles (2): summary of the
rules articles (3): countable and uncountable nouns articles (4): the (details) articles (5): a/an (details)
articles (6): the difference between some/any and no article articles (7): talking in general articles (8):
special rules and exceptions
as... as...; as much/many as as and though: special word order as, because, since and for as, when and
while (simultaneous events)
as if and as though as long as as usual as well as ask
at/in and to at, on and in (place) at, on and in (time) at all


84 auxiliary verbs
85 (a)wake and (a)waken
86 back and again
87 bath and bathe
88 be: progressive forms
89 be with auxiliary do
90 be + infinitive
91 be and have
92 beat and win
93 because and because of
94 been meaning 'come' or 'gone'
95 before (adverb)
96 before (conjunction)
97 before (preposition) and in front of
98 begin and start
99 below and under
100 beside and besides
101 besides, except and apart from
102 bet
103 better
104 between and among
105 big, large and great
106 a bit
107 born and borne
108 borrow and lend
109 both (of) with nouns and pronouns
110 both with verbs
111 both... and
112 bring and take
113 bring up and educate
114 Britain, the United Kingdom, the British Isles and England
115 broad and wide
116 but = except
117 by (method, agent) and with (tools etc)
118 by: time
119 by and near
120 call
121 can and could (I): introduction
122 can and could (2): ability
123 can and could (3): possibility and probability
124 can and could (4): interpersonal uses (permission, requests etc)
1??i ran and could f51: with see, hear
List of entries
127 care: take due (of), care (about) and care for
128 change
129 changes
130 city and town
131 cleft sentences
132 close and shut
133 cloth and clothes
134 come and go
135 comparison (1) structures
136 comparison (2): comparative and superlative adjectives
137 comparison (3): comparative and superlative adverbs
138 comparison (4): using
comparatives and superlatives
139 comparison (5): much, far etc with comparatives and superlatives
140 complements
141 conditional
142 conjunctions (I): general points
143 conjunctions (2): problems
144 contractions
145 contrary
146 control
147 copular verbs
148 countable and uncountable nouns
149 country
150 dare
151 dates
152 dead and died
153 degree (I): modification of adjectives and adverbs
154 degree (2): modification of nouns
155 degree (3): modification of verbs
156 degree (4): modification of other words
157 determiners
158 different
159 discourse markers
160 disinterested
161 distancing
162 do (I): introduction
163 do (2): auxiliary verb
164 do (3): general-purpose verb; do and make
165 do (4): substitute verb
166 do so/it/that
167 doubt
list of entries
170 due to and owing to
171 during and for
172 during and in
173 each
174 each and every: the difference
175 each other and one another
176 east and eastern, north and northern etc
177 efficient and effective
178 either: determiner
179 either... or
180 elder and eldest
181 ellipsis (I): general
182 ellipsis (2): with and, but and or
183 ellipsis (3): at the beginning of a sentence
184 ellipsis (4): in noun phrases
185 ellipsis (5): after auxiliary verbs
186 ellipsis (6): infinitives
187 else
188 embedding and comprehension problems
189 emphasis
190 enable
191 end and finish (verbs)
192 enjoy
193 enough
194 especial(ly) and specially)
195 even
196 eventual(ly)
197 ever
198 ever so, ever such
199 every (one)
200 except (for)
201 exclamations: structures
202 expect, hope, wait and look forward
203 experiment and experience
204 explain
205 fairly, quite, rather and pretty:
adverbs of degree
206 far and a long way
^ farther and further
208 feel
209 female and feminine; mate and masculine
210 finally, at last, in the end and at the end
rf'1 1 0 . -
212 fit and suit
213 for: purpose and cause
214 for, in, from and since (time)
215 forget and leave "
216 formality and politeness
217 fronting
218 fun and funny
219 future (I): introduction
220 future (2): present progressive and be going to
221 future (3): shall/will (information and prediction)
222 future (4): shall and will (interpersonal uses)
223 future (5): simple present
224 future (6): future perfect
225 future (7): future progressive
226 future (8): future in the past
227 gender (references to males and females)
228 get
229 get and go (movement)
230 give with action-nouns
231 go/come for a...
232 go/come.. .ing
233 gone with be
234 had better
235 half
236 happen
237 hardly, scarcely and no sooner
238 have (I): introduction
239 have (2): auxiliary verb
240 have (3): actions
241 have (4): have (got) - possession, relationships and other states
242 have (5):+object + verb form
243 have (6): have (got) to
244 hear and listen (to)
245 hear, see etc + object + verb form
246 hear, see etc with that-clause
247 help
248 here and there
249 high and tall
250 holiday and holidays
251 home
252 hope
253 hopefully
254 how


List of entries
256 -icand-ical
257 idioms and collocations
258 if (I): introduction
259 if (2): ordinary tense-use
260 if (3): special tense-use
261 if (4): other points
262 if (5): other words with the same meaning
263 if (6): meaning 'although'
264 if I were you
265 if only
266 iU and sick
267 immediately, the moment etc (conjunctions)
268 imperatives
269 in and into, on and onto (prepositions)
270 in and to
271 in case and if
272 in front of, facing and opposite
273 in spite of
274 indeed
275 infinitives (I): introduction
276 infinitives (2): forms
277 infinitives (3): without to
278 infinitives (4): using perfect infinitives
279 infinitive clause as subject, object or complement of sentence
280 infinitive clause introduced by for + noun/pronoun
281 infinitive clauses of purpose
282 infinitive clauses: other uses
283 infinitive complements (I):
after verbs
284 infinitive complements (2):
after verb + object
285 infinitive complements (3):
after adjectives
286 infinitive complements (4):
after nouns and pronouns
287 infinitive complements (5): active and passive infinitive with similar meaning
288 infinitive complements (6): after who, what, how etc
289 information structure
290 -ing forms ('gerunds'and 'participles'): introduction
291 -ing forms used as modifiers
292 -ing forms used like nouns (I):
subject, object or complement
293 -ing forms used like nouns (2):
after verbs
294 -ing forms used like nouns (3):
after nouns and adjectives
295 -ing forms used like nouns (4):
after prepositions
296 -ing forms used like nouns (5):
-ing form or infinitive?
297 instead (of)
298 inversion (I): auxiliary verb before subject -'
299 inversion (2): whole verb before-subject
300 irregular verbs
301 it (I): preparatory subject
302 it (2): preparatory object
303 its and it's
304 it's time
305 just
306 know
307 last and the last
308 later and in
309 lay and lie
310 leam
311 least and fewest
312 left
313 less and fewer
314 lest
315 let introducing imperatives
316 let: structures
317 letters
318 life: countable or uncountable noun
319 like (verb)
320 like and as (similarity, function)
321 likely
322 (a) little and (a) few
323 long and (for) a long time
324 look
325 lose and loose
326 a lot, lots, plenty, a great deal, a large number, the majority
327 make
328 make: prepositions
list of entries
329 marry and divorce
330 may and might (1): introduction
331 may and might (2): possibility
332 may and might (3): permission
333 may and might (4): may in wishes and hopes
334 may and might (5):
may/might... but
335 may and might (6):
may/might as well
336 may and might (7): might (requests, suggestions and criticisms)
337 maybe and perhaps
338 meals
339 mean
340 means
341 measurements: marked and unmarked forms
342 mind
343 miss
344 modal auxiliary verbs:
introduction
345 modal auxiliary verbs: meanings
346 more
347 most
348 much and many
349 must (I): introduction
350 must (2): concluding that something is certain
351 must (3): necessity and obligation
352 must (4): must and have (got) to
353 names and tides
354 nationalities, countries and regions
355 near (to)
356 nearest and next
357 need
358 negative structures (I): basic rules
359 negative structures (2): transferred negation
360 negative structures (3): negative questions
361 negative structures (4): double negatives
362 negative structures (5): ambiguous sentences
363 neither (of): determiner
364 neither, nor and not... either
367 next and the next
368 no and none
369 no/none and not a/any
370 no doubt
371 no matter
372 no more, not any more, no longer, not any longer
373 no one and none
374 non-assertive words
375 not and no
376 not only
377 noun complementation
378 noun modifiers
379 nouns in groups (I): introduction and general rules
380 nouns in groups (2): classifying expressions
381 nouns in groups (3): the's structure and the of structure
382 nouns in groups (4): special cases
383 now (that)
384 nowadays
385 numbers
386 of course
387 often
388 older English verb forms
389 once (adverb)
390 once (conjunction)
391 one: substitute word
392 one, you and they: indefinite personal pronouns
393 one of...
394 only (focusing adverb)
395 open
396 opportunity and possibility
397 opposite: position 3S9 ought
399 out of
400 own
401 paragraphs
402 part
403 participles (-ing and -ed forms)
(I): introduction
404 participles (2): active and passive
405 participles (3): details
406 participles (4): clauses
407 passives (I): passive structures and verb forms


409 passives (3): choice of passive structures
410 passives (4): verbs with two objects
411 passives (5): infinitive and clause objects
412 passives (6): verbs with object + infinitive
413 -passives (7): object complements
414 passives (8): finished-result verbs
415 past time (I): talking about the past in English
416 past time (2): the simple past tense
417 past time (3): the past progressive tense
418 past time (4): the simple present perfect tense
419 past time (5): simple present
perfect and simple past (advanced points)
420 past time (6): the present perfect progressive tense
421 past time (7): the past perfect tenses
422 past verb form with present or future meaning
423 perfect verb forms
424 personal pronouns (I): general
425 personal pronouns (2): subject and object forms
426 piece- and group-words
427 place
428 play and game
429 please and thank you
430 point of view
431 politics and policy
432 possessive's: forms and grammar
433 possessives: my, mine etc
434 possessives with of (a friend of mine etc)
435 prefer
436 prepositions (I): introduction
437 prepositions (2): after particular words and expressions
438 prepositions (3): before particular words and expressions
439 prepositions (4): expressions without prepositions.
440 prepositions (5): at the ends of clauses
441 prepositions (6): before
List of entries
442 prepositions (7): -ing forms and infinitives
443 present tenses (I): introduction
444 present tenses (2): the simple present tense
445 present tenses (3): the present progressive tense
446 present tenses (4): stories,
commentaries and instructions
447 presently
448 price and prize
449 principal and principle
450 progressive verb forms (I): general
451 progressive verb forms (2):
non-progressive verbs
452 progressive verb forms (3) with always etc
453 punctuation (I): apostrophe
454 punctuation (2): colon
455 punctuation (3): comma
456 punctuation (4): dash
457 punctuation (5): full stop, question mark and exclamation mark
458 punctuation (6): quotation marks
459 punctuation (7): semi-colon
460 question words
461 questions (I): basic rules
462 questions (2): declarative questions
463 questions (3): reply questions
464 questions (4): rhetorical questions
465 questions (5): question tags (basic information)
466 questions (6): question tags (advanced points)
467 quite
468 rather (I): adverb of degree
469 rather (2): preference
470 reason
471 reflexive pronouns
472 reinforcement tags
473 relatives (I): relative clauses and pronouns (introduction)
474 relatives (2): identifying and non-identifying clauses
475 relatives (3): whose
476 relatives (4): what and other nominal relative pronouns
List of entries
479 repetition
480 reporting (I): introduction
481 reporting (2): basic rules for indirect speech
482 reporting (3): advanced points
483 requests
484 (the) rest
485 road and street
486 (the) same
487 say and tell
488 see
489 see, look (at) and watch
490 seem
491 sensible and sensitive
492 shade and shadow
493 short answers
494 should (1): the difference between should and would
495 should (2): obligation, deduction etc
496 should (3): should, ought and must
497 should (4): in subordinate clauses
498 should (5): should/would
499 since: tenses
500 singular and plural (1): regular plurals
501 singular and plural (2): irregular and special plurals
502 singular and plural (3):
pronunciation of regular plurals
503 singular and plural (4): singular nouns with plural verbs
504 singular and plural (5): plural
expressions with singular verbs 505 singular and plural (6): they with
singular reference 306 singular and plural (7): mixed
structures
507 singular and plural (8):
distributive plural
508 singular and plural (9): noun modifiers
509 singular and plural (10):
miscellaneous points
510 slang
511 small and little
512 smeU
°13 so (degree adverb, substitute word)
516 so am I, so do I etc
517 so and then
518 so much and so many
519 so that and in order that
520 'social' language
521 some
522 some and any
523 somebody, someone, anybody, anyone etc
524 some time, sometime and sometimes
525 soon, early and quickly
526 sort of, kind of and type of
527 sound
528 speak and talk
529 spelling (1): capital letters
530 spelling (2) :-ly
531 spelling (3): -ise and -ize
532 spelling (4): hyphens
533 spelling (5): finale
534 spelling (6) :y and i
535 spelling (7): doubling final consonants
536 speUing (8): ch and tch, k and ck
537 spelling (9): ie and ei
538 spelling and pronunciation
539 still, yet and already
540 stress, rhythm and intonation
541 subjunctive
542 substitution
543 such
544 such and so
545 suggest
546 suppose, supposing and what if
547 supposed to
548 surely
549 sympathetic
550 take
551 take (time)
552 taste
553 technique and technology
554 telephoning
555 telling the time
556 tense simplification in subordinate clauses
557 than, as and that
558 thankful and grateful
559 that-clauses
560 that: omission


List of entries
563 there is
564 think
565 this and that (demonstrative pronouns and determiners)
566 this/that and it in discourse
567 through (time)
568 time
569 tonight
570 too
571 too much and too many
572 travel, journey, trip and voyage
573 turning verbs into nouns
574 unless
575 until
576 up and down
577 used + infinitive
578 (be) used to
579 verb complementation: what can follow a verb?
580 verb + object + complement
581 verbs of movement
582 verbs with prepositions and particles
583 verbs with two objects
584 wait
585 want
586 -ward(s)
587 way
588 weak and strong forms
589 weU
590 when and if
591 where (to)
592 whether... or...
593 whether and if
594 which, what and who: question
words
595 who ever, what ever etc
596 whoever, whatever etc
597 whose (question word)
598 whose and who's
599 why and why not
600 will
601 wish
602 with
603 worth
604 would
Language terminology
The following words and expressions are used in this book to talk about grammar and other aspects of
language. For more information about their meaning, see the sections where they are discussed.
abstract noun (the opposite of a concrete noun) the name of something
which we experience as an idea, not by seeing, touching etc. doubt;
height; geography. active An active verb form is one like breaks, told, will help (not like is
broken, was told, will be helped, which are passive verb forms). The
subject of an active verb is usually the person or thing that does the
action, or is responsible for what happens. adjective a word like green, hungry, impossible, which is used
when we
describe people, things, events etc. Adjectives are used in connection with
nouns and pronouns, a green apple; she's hungry. adverb a word like tomorrow, once, badly, there, also,
which is used to say,
for example, when, where or how something happens. There are very
many kinds of adverbs with different functions; see sections 20-23. adverb particle a word like up, out, off,
used as part of a phrasal verb. clean
up, sold out, tell off.
adverbial a group of words that does the same job as an adverb. affirmative An affirmative sentence is
one that makes a statement - not a
negative sentence or a question. Compare I agree (affirmative); I don't
agree (negative). agent In a passive sentence, the agent is the expression that says who (or
what) an action is done by. This picture was probably painted by a child. article A, an and the are called
'articles'. A/an is called the 'indefinite article';
theis called the 'definite article'. assertive The words some, somebody etc are used most often in
affirmative
sentences. In other kinds of sentence, they are often replaced by any,
anybody etc. Some, somebody etc are called 'assertive forms'; any,
anybody etc are called 'non-assertive forms'. Other non-assertive forms
are yet, ever. attributive Adjectives placed before nouns are in 'attributive position'.
a green shirt; my noisy son. See also predicative. auxiliary verb a verb like be, have, do which is used with
another verb to
make tenses, passive forms etc. She was writing; Where haveyou put it?
See also modal auxiliary verb. bare infinitive the infinitive without to. Let me go. clause a part of a
sentence which contains a subject and a verb, usually
joined to the rest of the sentence by a conjunction. Mary said that she
was tired. The word clause is also sometimes used for structures
containing participles or infinitives (with no subject or conjunction).
Not knowing what to do, I telephoned Robin; I persuaded her to try a new
method. cleft sentence a sentence in which special emphasis is given to one part
(e.g. the subject or the object) by using a structure with itoi what.


Language terminology
collective noun a singular word used to refer to a group, family, team. comparative the form of an adjective
or adverb made with-er (older, faster),
also the structure more + adjective/adverb, used in the same way {more
useful; more politely). complement (1) a part of a sentence that gives more information about the
subject (after be, seem and some other verbs), or, in some structures,
about the object. You're the right person to help; She looks very kind;
The President appointed Bristow his confidential adviser. (2) structure or
words needed after a noun, adjective, verb or preposition, the intention to
invest; full of water; try phoning; down the street. compound A compound noun, verb, adjective,
preposition, etc is one that is
made of two or more parts, bits-driver; get on with; one-eyed; in spite of. concrete noun (the opposite of an
abstract noun) the name of something
which we can experience by seeing, touching etc. cloud; petrol; raspberry. conditional (1) a verb form
made by using the modal auxiliary would (also
should in the first person). I would run; she would sing; I should think.
(2) a clause or sentence containing (/'(or a word with a similar meaning),
and often containing a conditional verb form. If you try you'll understand;
I should be surprised if she knew; What wouldyou have done if the train
had been late? conjunction a word like and, but, although, because, when, if, which can be
used to join clauses together. I rang because I was worried about you. continuous the same as
progressive. contraction a short form in which a subject and an auxiliary verb, or a verb
and the word not, are joined together into one word. I'm; who'll; can't. co-ordinate clause one of two or
more clauses of equal 'value' that make up
a sentence. A co-ordinate clause does not function as a subject, object,
complement or adverbial in another clause. Shalllcome toyourplace or
would you like to come to mine ? It's cooler today and there's a bit of a
wind. See also subordinate clause. copular verb be, seem, feel and other verbs which link a subject to a
complement which describes it. My mother is in Jersey; He seems
unhappy; This feels soft. countable noun a noun like car, dog, idea, which can have a plural form, and
can be used with the indefinite article a/an. See also uncountable noun. dangling participle the same as
misrelated participle. declarative question a question which has the same grammatical form as a
statement. That's your girl-friend? definite article the. degree saying 'how much' something is true.
Adverbs of degree are, for
example, quite, rather, very, too. demonstrative this/these; that/those. determiner one of a group of words
that are normally used at the beginning
of noun phrases. Determiners include a/an, the, my, this, each, either,
several, more, both, all. direct object see object. direct speech speech reported 'directly', in the words
used by the original
speaker (more or less), without any changes of tense, pronouns etc.
She looked me straight in the eye and said, 'This is my money.' See also
indirect speech.
Language terminology
discourse marker a word or expression which shows the connection
between what is being said and the rest of the 'discourse' (e.g. what came
before or after, or the speaker's attitude to what he/she is saying), on the
other hand; frankly; as a matter of fact. duration the length of time something lasts. The preposition for can
be used
with an expression of time to indicate duration. ellipsis leaving out words when their meaning can be
understood from the
context. (It's a) Nice day, isn't it? It was better than I expected (it would be). emphasis giving special
importance to one part of a word or sentence (for
example by pronouncing it more loudly; by writing it in capital letters; by
using do in an affirmative clause; by using special word order). emphatic pronoun reflexive pronoun
(myself, yourself, himself etc} used to
emphasise a noun or pronoun. I'll tell him myself; I wouldn't sell this to
the King himself. See also reflexive pronouns. ending something added to the end of a word, e.g. -er, -ing,
-ed. first person see person. formal the style used when talking politely to strangers, on special occasions,
in some literary writing, in business letters, etc. For example, commence is
a more formal word than start. frequency Adverbs of frequency say how often something happens, often;
never; daily; occasionally. fronting moving a part of a clause to the beginning in order to give it special
emphasis. Jackllike, buthis wife I can't stand. future tense a verb form made with the auxiliary verb
shall/will. I shall
arrive; Will it matter? future perfect tense a verb form made with shall/will + have + past
participle. Iwill have finished by lunchtime. . future progressive a verb form made with shall/will + be +...
ing. I will be
needing the car this evening. gender the use of different grammatical forms to show the difference
between masculine, feminine and neuter, or between human and non-human. he, she, it; who, which.
genitive the form of a noun made with 's or s', used to show (for instance)
possession. Also called possessive, the earth's gravity; birds' nests. gradable Pretty, hard or cold are
gradable adjectives: things can be more or
less pretty, hard or cold. Adverbs of degree (like rather, very) can be used
with gradable words. Perfect or dead are not gradable words: we do not
usually say that something is more or less perfect, or very dead. grammar the rules that say how words
are combined, arranged and changed
to show different meanings. hanging participle the same as misrelated participle. hypothetical Conditional
verbs and structures are often used to talk about
hypothetical situations - that is to say, situations which may not happen,
or which are not real. What wouldyou do if you had three months free? identifying relative clause a relative
clause which identifies the noun it refers
to - that is to say, it tells us which person or thing is being talked about.
There's the woman who tried to steal your cat. (The relative clause who
tried to steal your car identifies the woman - it tells us which woman is
meant.) See also non-identifying relative clause. imperative the form of a verb used to give orders, make
suggestions, etc.


Language terminology
indefinite article a/an.
indirect object see object.
indirect speech a structure in which we report what somebody said by making it part of our own sentence
(so that the tenses, word order, and pronouns and other words may be different from those used by the
original speaker). Compare: He said, Tm tired' (the original speaker's words are reported in direct speech);
He said that he was tired (the original speaker's words are reported in indirect speech).
Infinitive the 'base' form of a verb (usually with to), used after another verb, after an adjective or noun, or
as the subject or object of a sentence. / want to go home; It's easy to sing; I've goto plan to start a
business; To err is human, to forgive divine.
Informal the style used in ordinary conversation, personal letters, etc, when there is no special reason to
speak politely or carefully. Get is used mostly in an informal style; start is a more informal word than
commence. -ing form the form of a verb ending in -ing. finding; keeping; running; firing.
initial at the beginning. Sometimes is an adverb that can go in initial position in a sentence. Sometimes I
wish I had never been born.
intensifying making stronger, more emphatic. Very and terribly are intensifying adverbs.
interrogative Interrogative words and structures are used for asking
questions. In an interrogative sentence, there is an auxiliary verb before the subject (e.g. Canyou swim?).
What, whomd whereare interrogative words.
intransitive An intransitive verb is one that cannot have an object or be used in the passive, smile; fall;
come; go.
inversion a structure in which a verb (or part of a verb) comes before its subject. Here comes John; Under
no circumstances are visitors allowed to feed the animals.
irregular not following the normal rules. An irregular verb has a past tense and/or past participle that does
not end in -ed (e.g. swam, taken); children is an irregular plural.
main clause, subordinate clause Some sentences consist of a main clause and one or more subordinate
clauses. A subordinate clause acts like a part of the main clause (e.g. like a subject, or an object, or an
adverbial). Where she is doesn't matter. (The subordinate clause Where she is is the subject of the main
clause.) Itoldyou that I didn't care. (The subordinate clause that Ididn't careis the direct object in the main
clause.) Wherever you go, you'll find Coca-cola. (The subordinate clause Wherever you go acts like an
adverb in the main clause; compare You'll find Coca-cola anywhere.] main verb the verb which is used as
the basis for the main clause in a sentence. In the sentence Running into the room, she started to cry,
started is the main verb.
manner an adverb of manner describes how something happens, well;
suddenly; fast. mid-position If an adverb is in mid-position in a sentence, it is between the
subject and the main verb. / definitely agree with you. misrelated participle a participle which does not
have a subject in the sentence. Looking out of the window, the mountains seemed very close. The
construction is usually avoided, because of the possibility of
Language terminology
modal auxiliary verb one of the verbs can, could, may, might, must, will,
shall, would, should, ought.
modify An adjective is said to 'modify' the noun it is used with: it adds to or changes its meaning. An
adverb can modify a verb (e.g. run fast), an adjective (e.g. completely ready) or other words or
expressions. In sports car, the first noun modifies the second. negative a negative sentence is one in
which the word not is used with the
verb. I don't know.
nominal relative clause a relative clause (usually introduced by what] which acts as the subject, object or
complement of a sentence. I gave him what he needed. non-assertive see assertive.
non-identifying relative clause a relative clause which does not identify the noun it refers to (because we
already know which person or thing is meant). There's Hannah Smith, who tried to steal my cat. (The
relative clause, who tried to steal my cat, does not identify the person - she is already identified by the
name Hannah Smith.) See also identifying relative clause.
noun a word like oil, memory, arm, which can be used with an article. Nouns are most often the names of
people or things. Personal names (e.g. George), and place-names (e.g. Birmingham) are called 'proper
nouns';
they are usually used without articles. noun phrase a group of words (e.g. article + adjective + noun) which
acts as a
subject, object or complement of a clause, the last bus. number the way in which differences between
singular and plural are shown grammatically. The differences between house and houses, mouse and
mice, this and these are differences of number.
object a noun or pronoun that normally comes after the verb, in an active clause. The direct object refers
to a person or thing affected by the action of the verb. In the sentence Take the dog for a walk, the dogis
the direct object. The indirect object usually refers to a person who receives the direct object. In the
sentence Ann gave me a watch, the indirect object is me, and the direct object is a watch. participle see
present participle and past participle. participle clause a clause-like structure which contains a participle,
not a finite verb form. Discouraged by his failure, he resigned from his job;
Having a couple of hours to spare, I went to see a film. passive a passive verb form is made with be +
past participle (e.g. is broken, was told, will be helped-not breaks, told, will help, which are active verb
forms). The subject of a passive verb is usually the person or thing that is affected by the action of the
verb. Compare: They sent Lucas to prison for five years (active); Lucas was sent to prison for five years
(passive). past participle a verb form like broken, gone, stopped, which can be used to form perfect tenses
and passives, or as an adjective. (The meaning is not necessarily past, in spite of the name.)
past perfect tense a verb form made with had + past participle. I had forgotten; The children had arrived;
she had been working; It had been raining. The first two examples are past perfect simple; the last two
(with had been + .. .ing) are past perfect progressive.
nact r/riwociM *A*/ " ,^-z- c^.- - J- ••' '


Language terminology
past simple tense see simple past tense. perfect a verb form made with the auxiliary have + past
participle. / have
forgotten; She had failed; having arrived; to have finished. perfect conditional should/would have + past
participle. IShould/would
have agreed; He would have known. perfect infinitive to have + past participle, to have arrived; to have
gone. person the way in which, in grammar, we show the difference between the
person speaking (first person), the person spoken to (second person), and
the people or things spoken about (third person). The differences
between am, are and isaie differences of person. personal pronouns the words I, me, you, he, him etc.
phrase two or more words that function together as a group, dead tired; the
silly old woman; would have been repaired; in the country. phrasal verb a verb that is made up of two
parts: a 'base' verb followed by an
adverb particle, fill up; run over; take in. plural grammatical form used to refer to more than one person,
thing etc.
we; buses; children; are; many; these. See also singular. possessive a form used to show possession and
similar ideas. John's; our,
mine. possessive pronoun Mine, yours, hers etc are usually called 'possessive
pronouns'. My, your, her etc are often called 'possessive adjectives'
(although in fact they are determiners, not adjectives). postmodifier a word which comes after the word
which it modifies, e.g.
invited in The people invited all came late. See also premodifier. predicative adjectives placed after a verb
like be, seem, look we in predicative
position. She looks happy; The house is enormous. See also attributive. premodifier a word that comes
before the noun it modifies, e.g. invited in
an invited audience. See also postmodifier. preparatory subject, preparatory object When the subject of a
sentence is an
infinitive or a clause, we usually put it towards the end of the sentence
and use the pronoun it as a preparatory subject (e.g. It is important to get
enough sleep}. There can also be used as a kind of preparatory subject
(usually in the structure there is); and it can be used as a preparatory
object in certain structures (e.g. He made it clear that he disagreed). preposition a word like on, off, of,
into, normally followed by a noun or
pronoun. prepositional verb a verb that has two parts: a 'base' verb and a preposition.
insist on; care for. present participle the verb-form ending in -ing. She was running; Opening
his newspaper, he started to read; I hate the noise of crying babies. (The
meaning is not necessarily present, in spite of the name.) present perfect tense a verb form made with
have/has + past participle.
I have forgotten; The children have arrived; I've been working all day,
It has been raining. The first two examples are present perfect simple;
the last two (with have been + ... ing) are present perfect progressive. present progressive tense a verb
form made with am/are/is +.. .ing.
I'm going; She is staying for two weeks. present simple tense see simple present tense. progressive A
verb form made with be +.. .ing (e.g. to be going; we were
wondering) is called progressive.
page xxvi
Language terminology
progressive infinitive a form like to be going; to be waiting.
pronoun a word like it, yourself, their, which is used instead of a more precise
noun or noun phrase (like the cat, Peter's self, the family's). The word
pronoun can also be used for a determiner when this 'includes' the
meaning of a following noun which has been left out. 'Which bottle would
you like?' -Til take both.' (Both stands for both bottles, and we can say that
it is used as a pronoun.) proper noun a noun (normally with no article) which is the name of a
particular person, place, organization, etc. Andrew; Brazil; Marks and
Spencer. quantifier a word or expression like many, few, little, several, plenty, a lot,
which is used in a noun phrase to show how many or how much we are
talking about. Most quantifiers are determiners. question tag an expression like isn 't it? or don 'tyou?
(consisting of auxiliary
verb + pronoun subject) put on to the end of a sentence. It's a nice day,
isn't it? reflexive pronouns myself, yourself, himself etc. I cut myself shaving this
morning. See also emphatic pronoun. regular following the normal rules. Hoped is a regular past tense;
cats is a
regular plural. See also irregular. reinforcement tag a tag which repeats (and so reinforces or strengthens)
the
meaning of the subject and verb. You're a real idiot, you are. relative clause a clause introduced by a
relative pronoun, like who or which.
I like people who like me. See also identifying relative clause;
non-identifying relative clause. relative pronoun one of the pronouns who, whom, whose, which and that
(and sometimes what, when, where and why). A relative pronoun is used
to repeat the meaning of a previous noun; at the same time, it connects a :
relative clause to the rest of the sentence (so it acts as a conjunction and a
pronoun at the same time). Is this the child that was causing all that
trouble? reply question a question (similar in structure to a question tag) used to
reply to a statement (for instance to express interest). 'I've been invited to
spend the weekend in London.'- 'Have you, dear?' second person see person. sentence a group of words
that expresses a statement, command, question
or exclamation. A sentence consists of one or more clauses, and usually
has at least one subject and verb. In writing, it begins with a capital letter
and ends with a full stop, question mark or exclamation mark. 's genitive a form like John's, the earth's,
our parents'. short answer an answer consisting of a subject and an auxiliary verb. 'Who's
ready for more?'-'I am.' simple past tense a past verb form made without an auxiliary verb.
I stopped; You heard; We saw. simple present tense a present verb form made without an auxiliary verb.
He goes there often; I know; I like chocolate. simple tense a tense that is not progressive. / went; she
wants; they have
arrived. singular a grammatical form used to talk about one person, thing, etc, or
about an 'uncountable' quantity or mass. me; bus; water; is; much;
this. See also plural.
nacre xxvil


s. ma-s. Ä…*JXW^y
slang a word, expression or special use of language found mainly in very
informal speech, especially in the usage of particular groups of people.
thick (= 'stupid'); lose one's cool (= 'get upset'). split infinitive structure in which an adverb comes between
to and the
infinitive verb form (sometimes considered 'incorrect'), to easily
understand. standard A standard form of a language, or a standard accent, is one that is
usually used by the most educated or influential people in a country, and
is therefore considered more widely acceptable or 'correct' than other
forms, and taught in schools. The standard language is the one normally
used for writing. I'm notis standard English; lain'tis non-standard, or
sub-standard. statement a sentence which gives information. I'm cold; Philip stayed out
all night. stress the way in which one or more parts of a word, phrase or sentence are
made to sound more important than the rest (by using a louder voice
and/or higher pitch). In the word particular, the main stress is on the -
second syllable /pa'tikjala/. In the sentence 'Where's the'new'secretary?
there are three stresses. strong form Certain words can be pronounced in two ways: slowly and
carefully ('strong form'), or with a quicker pronunciation with the vowel
/a/ or III ('weak form'), can (/keen/, /kan/); was(fwr>z/, /waz/);
he (/hi;/, /hi/). subject a noun or pronoun that comes before the verb in an ordinary
affirmative sentence. It often says (in an active sentence) who or what
does the action that the verb refers to. Helen broke another glass today;
Oil floats on water. subject-tag a tag which repeats or identifies the subject. She's an idiot,
that girl. subjunctive a verb form (not very common in British English) used in certain
structures. If I were you,...; It's important that he be informed
immediately. subordinate clause a clause which functions as part of another clause (e.g. as
subject, object or adverbial in the main clause of a sentence). / thought
thatyou understood; What I need is a drink; I'll follow you whereveryou
go. See also clause, main clause. sub-standard not in the standard language, and considered 'incorrect'.
I ain't ready; She don't agree; He already done it. superlative the form of an adjective or adverb made with
the suffix -est (e.g.
oldest, fastest); also the structure most+ adjective/adverb, used in the
same way (e.g. most intelligent, most politely). tag a short phrase (e.g. auxiliary verb + pronoun subject)
added on to the
end of a sentence. She doesn 't care, does she? See also question tag,
reinforcement tag, subject tag. tense a verb form which shows the time of an action or event, will go
(future); is sitting (present); saw (past). third person see person. transitive A transitive verb is one that can
have an object, eat (a meal); drive
(a car); give (a present). See also intransitive. -.

language terminology
uncountable noun a noun which has no plural form and cannot normally be
used with the article a/an. mud; rudeness; furniture. verb a word like ask, wake, play. be, can, which can
be used with a subject to
form the basis of a clause. Most verbs refer to actions or states. See also
auxiliary verb, modal auxiliary verb. verb phrase a verb that has several parts, would have been forgotten.
weak form see strong form.
page xxviii
page xxix


Phonetic alphabet
It is necessary to use a special alphabet to show the pronunciation of English words, because the ordinary
English alphabet does not have enough letters to represent all the sounds of the language. The following
list contains all the letters of the phonetic alphabet used in this book, with examples of the words in which
the sounds that they refer to are found.
Vowels and diphthongs (double vowels)

i;
i e as a:
D o:
u u:
A
3:
3
seat /si:t/, feel /fi:l/ sit /sit/, in /in/ set /set/, any /'eni:/ sat /saet/, match /maetf/ march /ma:t|7, after /'a;fta(r)/
pot /pot/, gone /gon/ port /port/, law /la:/ good /gud/, could /kud/ food /fu;d/, group /gru;p/ much /mAtf/, front
/frAnt/ turn /t3:n/, word /W3:d/ away /a'wei/, collect /ka'lekt/, until /an'tri/
Consonants
P b f v
e a t
d s z
I
3
pull /pul/, cup /kAp/ bull /bul/, rob /rob/ ferry /'feri;/, life /laif/ very /'veri:/, live /liv/ think /9ink/, bath /ba;9/
then /9en/, with /wio/ take /teik/, set /set/ day /dei/, red /red/ sing /sin/, rice /rais/ zoo /zu:/, days /deiz/ show
/Jau/, wish /wij7 pleasure /'ple3a(r)/, occasion /a'kei3n/
The sign 0 shows stress (see 540).
ei ai
31
au au
13
ea
take /teik/, wait /wert/ mine /main/, light /lart/ oil /oil/, boy /boi/ no /nau/, open /'aupan/ house /haus/, now
/nau/ hear /hia(r)/, deer /dia(r)/ air /ea(r)/, where /wea(r)/
ua tour /tua(r)/, endure /m'djua(r)/
tf cheap /tJi:p/, catch /kaetf/ d3 jail /d^eil/, bridge /bridg/ '' case /keis/, take /teik/ go /gau/, rug /rAg/ my
/mai/, come /kAm/ no /nau/, on /on/ sing /sin/, finger /'fir)ga(r)/ love /IAV/, hole /haul/ round /raund/, carry
/'kaeri:/ well /wel/ young /JAn/ house /haus/
k
9
m
n
r) 1 r w
page xxx
aDDreviateo sryies i
1 abbreviated styles
Some styles of writing and speech have their own special grammar rules, often because of the need to
save space or time.
1 advertisements and instructions
Small ads and instructions often leave out articles, subject or object pronouns, forms of be and
prepositions.
Cars wanted for cash. Contact Evans, 6 Latton Square.
(NOT Cars arc wanted for cash...) Single man looking for flat Oxford area. Phone 806127 weekends. Job
needed urgently. Will do anything legal. Call 312654. Pour mixture into large saucepan, heat until boiling,
then add three
pounds sugar and leave on low heat for 45 minutes. Can be assembled in ten minutes. Easy to clean.
Simple controls. Batteries
not included.
2 notes
'••" Informal notes, diary entries etc often follow similar rules. Gone to hairdresser. Back 12.30.
Book tickets phone Ann see Joe 11.00 meeting Sue lunch The same style may be used in postcards and
short informal letters. Dear Gran
Watching tennis on TV. A good book. Three meals a day. No washing-up. Clean sheets every day.
Everything done for me. Yes, you've guessed - in hospital!!
Only went to doctor for cold - landed up in hospital with pneumonia!! If you have time please tell the others
-would love some letters to cheer me up. Hope to see you. Love, Pam
3 commentaries
Commentaries on fast-moving events like football matches also have their
own grammar. Less important verbs are often left out.
Goal kick... And the score still Spurs 3, Arsenal 1... that's Pearce... Pearce to Coates... good ball... Sawyer
running wide... Billings takes it, through to Matthews, Matthews with a cross, oh, and Billings in beautifully,
a good chance there - and it's a goal!
4 titles, notices etc
Titles, labels, headings, notices and slogans usually consist of short phrases, not complete sentences.
Articles are often left out, especially in the names of buildings and institutions.
ROYAL HOTEL
SUPER CINEMA
INFORMATION OFFICE
BUS STOP
POLICE OUT!
MORE MONEY FOR NURSES! >
page 1


2
5 headlines
Newspaper headlines have their own special grammar and vocabulary. For details, see 366.
RECORD DRUGS HAUL AT AIRPORT: SIX HELD FOUR DIE IN M6 BLAZE
For other rules about leaving words out ('ellipsis'), see 181 -1-86.
2 abbreviations and acronyms
1 punctuation
We usually write abbreviations without full stops in modem British English. Full stops (US 'periods') are
normal in American English. Mr (US Mr.} = Mister (not usually written in full) Ltd (US Ltd.) = Limited
(company) kg (US kg.) = kilogram
initial-letter abbreviations
Some abbreviations are made from the first letters of several words. This often happens with the names of
organisations.
the BBC = the British Broadcasting Corporation
UNESCO = United Nations Educational, Scientific and Cultural Organisation
Some initial-letter abbreviations are pronounced letter by letter (e.g. the
BBC). Others are pronounced like words (e.g. UNESCO) - these are often called acronyms.
letter-by-letter abbreviations: pronunciation
These abbreviations are most often stressed on the last letter.
the BBC /oa bi: bi: 'si:/ the USA /oa ju; es 'ei/ If one of these abbreviations has an article (a/an or the), the
form and
pronunciation of the article depend on the pronunciation of the first letter of the abbreviation. Compare:
- an IRA attack
a US diplomat /9ju:.../ (NOT an US...)
- a BA degree
an MP /an em.../ (NOT aMP)
- the USA /9aju:.../ (NOT /-6v-)w-.. .1) theRSPCA IQv. n:r.../ (NOT /ooair.../)
acronyms: articles
Articles are usually dropped in acronyms (abbreviations that are pronounced like words).
UNESCO (NOT 4he UNESCO)
plurals
An apostrophe (') is sometimes used before the s in the plurals of abbreviations: MP's orMPs; CD's (=
'compact discs') or CDs.
page 2
3 able
We use able especially in the structure be able + infinitive. This often has the same meaning as can.
There is a negative form unable.
Some people are able to/can walk on their hands.
lam unable to /can't understand what she wants. Can is preferred in the sense of 'know how to', and in
expressions like can see, can hear etc (see 125).
Can you knit? (More natural than Are you able to knit?)
I can see a ship. (More natural than I am able to see a ship.) Be able is used in cases (e.g. future, present
perfect) where can/could is not grammatically possible.
One day scientists will be able to find a cure for cancer. (NOT ... will can find...)
What have you been able to find out? (NOT What have you could...?)
Imightbeable to helpyou. (NOT I might can...) Able is not usually followed by passive infinitives.
He can't be understood. (NOT He's not able to be understood.)
For the use of can for ability, see 122.
For other differences between could and was able, see 122.3.
For other uses of able, see a good dictionary.
4 about and on
Compare:
- a book for children about Africa and its peoples a textbook on African history
- a conversation about money
a lecture on economics
We use about to talk about ordinary, more general kinds of communication. On suggests that a book,
lecture, talk etc is serious or academic, suitable for specialists.
For some other uses of about, see 5, 60. For some other uses of on, see 80-81.
5 about to
About + infinitive means 'going to very soon'; 'just going to'.
Don't go out now - we're about to have lunch.
I was about to go to bed when the telephone rang. In informal American English, not about to can mean
'unwilling to'.
I'm not about to pay 100 dollars for that dress.
6 above and over
1 'higher than': above or over '^
Above and over can both mean 'higher than'. The water came up above/over our knees.
Can you see the helicopter above/over the palace? > page 3


2 'not directly over': above
We prefer above when one thing is not directly over another. We've got a little house above the lake.
3 'covering'; over
We prefer over when one thing covers and / or touches another.
There is cloud over the South of England.
He put on a coat over his pyjamas. We use over or across (see 9) when one thing crosses another.
The plane was flying over/across Denmark.
Electricity cables stretch over/across the fields.
4 measurements: above
Above is used in measurements of temperature and height, and in other
cases where we think of a vertical scale.
The temperature is three degrees above zero.
The summit of Everest is about 8000 metres above sea level.
She's well above average in intelligence.
5 ages, speeds, 'more than': over
We usually use over, not above, to talk about ages and speeds, and to mean 'more than'.
You have to be over 18 to see this film.
The police said she was driving at over 110 mph.
There were over 100,000 people at the festival.
6 see above/over
In a book or a paper, see above means 'look at something written before'; see over means 'look on the
next page*.
The difference between below and under is similar. See 99. For other meanings of over, see a good
dictionary.
7 accept and agree
Before an infinitive, we usually use agree, not accept.
I agreed to meet them here. (More normal than / accepted...)
8 according to
According to X means 'If what X says is true'. Note that after is not used in
this sense.
According to Harry, it's agood film. (NOT AftcrHarry...)
page 4
We do not usually give our own opinions with according to. Compare:
- According to Joan, the people across the road are moving.
(= If what Joan says is true,...) According to the timetable, the train gets in at 8.27.
- In my opinion, she's sick. (NOT According to me,...)
For other uses of according to, see a good dictionary.
9 across, over and through
1 on/to the other side of (line): across and over
Across and over can both be used to mean 'on or to the other side of a line, river, road, bridge etc'.
His village is just across/over the border.
See if you can jump across/over the stream.
2 high things: over preferred
We prefer over to say'on/to the other side of something high'. Why are you climbing over the wall? (NOT..
. across the wall?)
3 on flat areas; in water; across preferred
We usually prefer across to say' on / to the other side of a flat area or surface', or to talk about movement
in water.
He walked right across the desert. (NOT ... over the desert.)
Let's swim across the river. (NOT ... over the river.) But over is sometimes used in British English if there
is no idea of arriving at the other side.
We often walk over the fields in the evening.
4 the adverb over
Note that the adverb over has a wider meaning than the preposition over. You cannot say Let's swim over
the river to the church, but you can saylLt's swim over to the church.
5 across and through
The difference between across and through is like the difference between on and in. Through, unlike
across, is used for a movement in a three-dimensional space, with things on all sides. Compare:
- We walked across the ice. (We were on the ice.) I walked through the wood. (I was in the wood.)
- We drove across the desert. We drove through several towns.
For over and above, see 6. For other uses of these words, see a good dictionary.
page 5


10
active verb forms
This is a list of all the active affirmative forms of an ordinary English verb, with their names.
simple future I will/shall work, you will work, he/she/it will work, we will/shall work, they will work
future progressive / will/shall be working, you will be working etc simple future perfect / will/shall have
worked, you will have worked etc
future perfect progressive / will/shall have been working, you will have been
working etc .
simple present / work, you work, he! she/it works, we work, they work present progressive 1am working,
you are working etc
simple present perfect I have worked, you have worked, he/she/it has worked etc present perfect
progressive / have been working, you have been working etc simple past / worked, you worked, he/she/it
worked etc past progressive / was working, you were working etc simple past perfect 1/you/etc had
worked
past perfect progressive I/you/etc had been working, you had been working etc
infinitives (to) work, (to) be working, (to) have worked, (to) have been working -ing forms working, having
worked past participle worked
Progressive forms are called 'continuous' in some grammars. Shall is rare in American English (see
221.1).
For more information about the forms and their uses, see the entry for each one. For question forms, see
461. For negatives, see 358. For progressive forms, see 450.
For verbs that are not used in progressive forms, see 451. For perfect forms, see 423.
For 'conditional' forms, see 141 and 260-261. For irregular verbs, see 300. For auxiliary verbs, see 84.
For verb forms constructed with modal auxiliary verbs, see 344 and the entry for each modal auxiliary.
For passive verb forms, see 407.
11 actual(ly)
1 meaning and use
Actual means 'real'; actually means 'really' or 'in fact'. They can be used to correct mistakes or
misunderstandings.
The book says she died aged 47, but her actual age was 43.
'Hello, John. Nice to see you.' 'Actually, my name's Andy.'
They are also used to make things clearer or more precise, or to introduce unexpected information.
I've got a new job. Actually, they've made me sales manager. She was so angry that she actually tore up
the letter. British people often use actually to break bad news gently.
'How did you get on with my car?' 'Well, actually, I'm terribly sorry, I'm afraid I had a crash.'
page 6
Actually can suggest either that the hearer's expectations were wrong (see above examples), or that they
were correct (especially in British English). 'Didyou enjoy your holiday?' 'Very much, actually.'
2 'false friends'
Actual and actually are 'false friends' for people who speak some languages of European origin. They do
not mean the same as actuel(lement), aktuell, attual(ment)e etc. We express these ideas with present,
current, up to date-, at this moment, now, at present.
What's our current financial position?
(NOT ... our actual financial position?) In 1900 the population of London was higher than it is now. (NOT ...
than it actually is.)
For actually, in fact, as a matter offact and to tell the truth as discourse markers, see 159.
12 adjectives: complementation
Many adjectives can be followed by 'complements' - other words and expressions that 'complete' their
meaning. Not all adjectives are followed by the same kind of complement. Some can be followed by
preposition + noun I-ing.
I'm interested in cookery.
I'm interested in learning to cook. Some can be followed by infinitives.
You don't look happy to see me.
The soup is ready to eat. An infinitive may have its own subject, introduced by for (see 280). "
I'm anxious for her to get a good education.
(= I'm anxious that she should get...) Some adjectives can be followed by clauses.
I'm glad thatyou were able to come.
It's important that everybody should feel comfortable. And many adjectives can have more than one kind
of complement.
I'm pleased about her promotion.
I'm pleased to see you here.
I'm pleased that we seem to agree. We rarely put adjective + complement before a noun.
He's a difficult person to understand.
(NOT He's a difficult to understand person.)
For complementation in general, see 140. For more information about -ing forms after adjectives, see 294.
For infinitives after adjectives, see 285. For should in clauses after adjectives, see 497. For subjunctives in
clauses after adjectives, see 541.1.
; For the prepositions that are used after some common adjectives, see 437. For prepositions with clauses
after adjectives, see 441.
For structures with 'preparatory it' (e.g. It is important that we move fast. She made it dear that she
distrusted all of us), see 301-302.
page 7


" ." -cu. pruiiuiii-ia""" •*'
13 adjectives ending in -ed: pronunciation
A few adjectives ending in -ed have a special pronunciation: the last syllable is pronounced /id/ instead of
/d/ or /t/. They are:
aged /'eidyd/(.= very old) naked /'neikid/ beloved /bi'lAvid/ ragged /'raegid/ blessed /'blesid/ rugged /'rAgid/
crooked /'krukid/ sacred /'seiknd/ '•••-•-' "'-----" wicked /'wikid/
wretched /'retfid/ one/three/four-legged /'legid/
Note that agerf is pronounced /eidsd/ when it means 'years old' (as in He Aas a daughter aged ten), or
when it is a verb.
Other adjectives ending in -ed always have the normal pronunciation, with /id/ only after d or t.
tired /tarad/ hunchbacked /'hAntfbaekt/ undecided /Andi'saidfd/
cursed /'kaisid/ dogged /'dngid/ learned /'l3:nid/
14 adjectives: order before nouns
When several adjectives come before a noun (or when nouns are used to modify another noun), they
usually have to be put in a particular order. For instance, we say a fat old lady, not an old fat lady; a small
shiny black leather handbag, not a leather black shiny small handbag. Unfortunately, the rules for
adjective order are very complicated, and different grammars disagree about the details. Here are some of
the most important rules:
1 colour, origin, material and purpose
Adjectives (or modifying nouns) of colour, origin, material and purpose
usually go in that order.
colour
red a brown a
origin material purpose noun
Spanish leather riding boots German beer mug Venetian glass flower vase
2 other adjectives
Other adjectives usually go before words of colour, origin, material and
purpose. It is impossible to give exact rules, but adjectives of size, length and height often come first.
the round glass table (NOT the glass round table)
a big, modem brick house (NOT a modem, big brick house)
long, flexible steel poles a tall, ancient oak- tree
3 judgements and attitudes
Adjectives which express judgements or attitudes usually come before all
others. Examples are lovely, definite, pure, absolute, extreme, perfect, wonderful, silly.
a lovely, long, cool drink Who's that silly/at man over there?
page 8
" ^'•'WHIlW^SRy^^BT" swiJ^^fKXWfsa. yws.tx\^s.M. m.^
4 numbers
Numbers usually go before adjectives.
six large eggs the second big shock First, next and last most often go before one, two, three etc.
the first three days (more common than the three first days)
my last two jobs
5 commas
Before nouns, we generally use commas between adjectives (especially in longer sequences) which give
similar kinds of information, for example in physical descriptions.
a lovely, long, cool, refreshing drink
an expensive, ill-planned, wasteful project But commas can be dropped before short common adjectives.
a tallf,) dark(,) handsome cowboy
For and with adjectives, see 17. For commas with and, see 455.1.
15 adjectives: position
1 attributive and predicative position
Most adjectives can go in two main places in a sentence:
before a noun ('attributive position') The new secretary doesn't like me. He's going out with a rich
businesswoman.
after be, seem, look, become and other 'copular' verbs ('predicative position') That dress is new, isn't it?
She looks rich. I feel unhappy.
For adjectives with pronouns (e.g. Pooryou!), see 424.3. For details of the verbs that can be followed by
adjectives ('copular verbs'), see 147.
2 adjectives used only in attributive position
Some adjectives are used only (or mostly) in attributive position. After a verb, other words must be used.
Common examples of such adjectives are:
elder and eldest (mainly British English - see 180) Compare:
My elder sister is a pilot. She's three years older than me. live (meaning 'not dead') Compare:
a live fish It's still alive. old (referring to relationships that have lasted a long time)
an old friend (not the same as a friend who is old) little (see 511) Compare:
a nice little house The house is quite small. intensifying (emphasising) adjectives
He's a mere child. (BUT NOT That child is mere.)
It's sheer madness. (BUT NOT That madness is shcer^) ; >
page 9


l WJJCI^LIVCS. pUCTIllw*
) adjectives used only in predicative position
Some adjectives beginning with a-, and a few others, are used mainly in predicative position - after a verb.
Common examples: afloat, afraid, alight, alike, alive, alone, asleep, awake. Compare:
- The baby's asleep.
a sleeping baby (NOT an asleep baby)
- The ship's still afloat. a floating leaf
- He was afraid. a frightened man
The adjectives;'// and well are most common in predicative position. Before a noun, many people prefer
other words. Compare:
- He's very well. a healthy/fit man
- You look ill.
Nurses look after sick people.
For other uses of well, see 589.
For more information about ill and sick, see 266.
For very with afraid, see 25.3.
attributive adjectives after nouns
In older English (see 388), it was quite common to put attributive adjectives after nouns, especially in
poetry and songs. He came from his palace grand.
In modem English, this is only possible in a few cases. It happens in some fixed phrases.
Secretary General court martial (= military court) Poet Laureate Presidentelect Attorney General
Some adjectives can be used after nouns in a similar way to relative clauses. This is common with
adjectives ending in -ablel-ible.
Send all the tickets available. (=... tickets which are available.) It's the only solution possible.
Some adverbs can also be used like this. the woman upstairs the people outside
Before a noun, present refers to time; after a noun it means 'here/there', 'not absent*. Compare:
the present members (= those who are members now) the members present (.-= those who are/were at
the meeting)
Before a noun, proper means 'real', 'genuine' (especially GB). After a noun it
refers to the central or main part of something. Compare:
Snowdon's a proper mountain, not a hill.
After two days marching through the foothills, they found themselves at the base of the mountain proper.
For the position and meaning of opposite, see 397.
page 10
adjectives: position 15
5 something, everything etc
Adjectives come after something, everything, anything, nothing, somebody, anywhere and similar words.
Have you read anything interesting lately?
Let's go somewhere quiet.
6 expressions of measurement
Adjectives come after the measurement noun in most expressions of measurement.
two metres high
two miles long
ten years older
six feet deep
For word order with worth, see 603.
7 " attributive adjectives with complements
When an adjective has its own complement (e.g. skilled at design), the whole expression normally comes
after the noun in attributive position.
We are looking for people skilled at design.
(NOT ... skilled at design people.) A relative clause is often more natural.
We are looking for people who are skilled at design. In some cases an adjective can be put before a noun
and its complement after it. This happens with different, similar, the same; next, last, first, second etc;
comparatives and superlatives; and a few other adjectives like difficult and easy.
a different life from this one
the next house to the Royal Hotel (especially GB)
the second train from this platform
the best mother in the world
a difficult problem to solve
8 verb + object + adjective
Another possible position for adjectives is after the object, in the structure verb + object + adjective.
I'll get the car ready.
Do I make you happy?
Let's paint the kitchen yellow.
For information about noun modifiers (e.g. a leather jacket), see 378. For the order of adjectives and other
modifiers before nouns, see 14. For the use of and between adjectives, see 17. For commas between
adjectives, see 14.5.
page 11


J^-^^.CT,. pusiiion alter as, now, so, LUU *w
16 adjectives: position after as, how, so, too
Normally adjectives go after the article a/an. a beautiful voice
But after as, how, so, too and this/that meaning so, adjectives go before a/an. This structure is common in
a formal style.
as/how/so/too/this/that+ adjective + a/an +BOIM
I have as good a voice as you. How good a pianist is he? It was so warm a day that I could hardly work.
She is too polite a person to refuse. I couldn 't afford that big a car. The structure is not possible without
a/an. I like your country - it's so beautiful.
(NOT I like your so beautiful country.} Those girls are too kind to refuse. (NOT They are too ki
17
2
d girls to refuse.)
For structures with such and what+ adjective + noun, see 543.3, 544.1 and 201.2. For the structure with
adjective + as in expressions like tired as I was..., see 71.
adjectives with and
When two or more adjectives (or other modifiers) come together, we sometimes put and before the last
one and sometimes not. It depends partly on their position in the sentence.
after a verb
When adjectives come in predicative position (after be, seem and similar verbs - see 147), we usually put
and before the last one.
He was tall, dark and handsome.
You're like a winter's day: short, dark and dirty. In a very literary style, and is sometimes left out.
My soul is exotic, mysterious, incomprehensible.
before a noun
In attributive position (before a noun), and is less common.
a tall, dark, handsome cowboy
However, and is possible when the adjectives describe the same kind of thing (for example appearance or
character).
a cruel (and) vicious tyrant
a tall (and) elegant lady
And has to be used when two or more adjectives (or other modifiers) refer to different parts of something.
a yellow and black sports car
a concrete and glass factory
For more information about the use of and, see 51. For commas with adjectives, see 14.5.
page 12
auJd/uvca wiiiium nuuiis *o
18 adjectives without nouns
We cannot usually leave out a noun after an adjective.
Poor little boy! (NOT Poor little!)
The most important thing is to be happy.
(NOT The most important is to be happy.) But there are some exceptions.
1 well-known groups
The + adjective is used to talk about certain well-known groups of people, especially those in a particular
physical or social condition.
He's collecting money for the blind.
The unemployed are losing hope.
The meaning is usually general, but occasionally a more limited group is referred to.
After the accident, the injured were taken to hospital. The most common expressions of this kind are:
the blind the old
the dead the poor
the deaf the rich
the handicapped the unemployed
the jobless the young
the mentally ill
The above expressions are always plural: the dead means 'all dead people' or 'the dead people', but not
'the dead person'. Note that these expressions cannot be used with a possessive 's.
the problems of the poor OR poor people's problems
(NOT the poor's problems) Adjectives are not normally used in this way without the.
This government doesn't care about the poor. (NOT . ..about poor.) However, adjectives without the are
sometimes possible after quantifiers like many and more, in paired structures with and or or, and after
possessives.
There are more unemployed than ever before.
opportunities for both rich and poor
Give me your tired, your poor,...
2 adjectives of nationality
A few adjectives of nationality ending in -sh or -ch (see 354.3) are used after the without nouns. They
include Irish, Welsh, English, British, Spanish, Dutch, French.
The Irish are very proud of their sense of humour. These expressions are plural; singular equivalents are
for example an Irishwoman, a Welshman (NOT a Welsh).
Where nouns exist, these are preferred to expressions with the.. .ish'-we say the Danes or the Turks, not
the Danish or the Turkish. >
page 13


3
4
5
- -aavero paiui-ica *-
singular/plural examples
In a few formal fixed phrases, the + adjective can have a singular meaning.
These include the accused, the undersigned, the deceased, the former and the latter.
The accused was released on bail.
... Mr Gray and Mrs Cook; the latter is a well-known designer. Plural meanings are also possible (e.g. The
accused were released on bail).
abstract ideas
Adjectives are sometimes used after the to refer to general abstract ideas, especially in certain kinds of
philosophical writing. (Examples: the beautiful, the supernatural, the unreal.) These expressions are
singular. She's interested in the supernatural.
leaving out nouns
We often leave out a noun that has already been mentioned, or which does not need to be mentioned,
when thinking about a choice between two or more different kinds of thing.
'Have you got any bread?' 'Do you want white or brown?'
I'd like two three-hour video-cassettes and one four-how. Superlatives are often used in this way.
I'm the tallest in my family.
We bought the cheapest. Colour adjectives can sometimes have a plural -s in this situation.
Wash the reds and blues separately. (= red and blue clothes)
For other cases where nouns are left out after adjectives and determiners, see 184.
19 adverb particles
1 adverb particles and prepositions
Words like down, in, up are not always prepositions. Compare:
- / ran down the road. Please sit down.
- He's in his office. You can go in.
- Something's climbing up my leg. She's not up yet.
In the expressions down the road, in his office and up my leg, the words
down, in and up are prepositions: they have objects (.the road, his office and
my leg).
In sit down, go in and She's not up, the words down, in and up have no objects. They are adverbs, not
prepositions.
page 14
Small adverbs like these are usually called 'adverb(ial) particles'. They include above, about, across,
ahead, along, (a)round, aside, away, back, before, behind, below, by, down, forward, in, home, near, off,
on, out, over, past, through, under, up. Many words of this kind can be used as both adverb particles and
prepositions, but there are some exceptions: for example back, away (only adverb particles) ;from, during
(only prepositions).
2 phrasal verbs
Adverb particles often join together with verbs to make two-word verbs, sometimes with completely new
meanings (e.g. breakdown, put off, work out, give up). These are often called 'phrasal verbs'.
Note that, unlike most other adverbs, adverb particles can come just before the object of a verb (if the
object is a noun - see 582.3). Could you switch off the light?
For details of phrasal and prepositional verbs, see 582. For information about the position of adverbs, see
22-23.
3 adverb particles with foe
Adverb particles are often used, rather like adjectives, as complements of the verb be.
Why are all the lights on?
Hello! You're back!
The match will be over by 4.30.
For inverted word order in sentences beginning with an adverb particle (e.g. Out walked Sarah), see 299.
20 adverbs of manner and adjectives
1 adverbs of manner with verbs
Adverbs of manner say how something happens or is done.
Examples: quickly, happily, terribly, fast, badly, well.
These adverbs should not be confused with adjectives (happy, quick etc).
We use adverbs, not adjectives, to modify verbs.
(werb + adverb
We'll have to think quickly. (NOT ... to think quick.) She danced happily into the room. (NOT She danced
happy...)
She sang badly. (NOT She sang bad.)
fI
I don't remember him very well. (NOT ... very good.)
page 15


But note that adjective forms are sometimes used as adverbs in an informal style, especially in American
English (see21). She talks funny.
For the use of adjectives after copular verbs like look or seem, see 147.
2 other uses
These adverbs can also modify adjectives, past participles, other adverbs and adverbial phrases.
adverb + adjective It's terribly cold today. (NOT ... terrible cold.)
T v '
adverb + past participle
I This steak is very badly cooked. (NOT .. .bad cooked.)
,, , v
adi^id + adverb They're playing unusually fast. (NOT ... unusual fast.)
•••"is^?.' T '• -
• advlSlfji- adverbial phrase
He was madly in love with her. (NOT .. .-mad...)
For adjectives ending in -ty, see the next section.
For adverbs and adjectives with the same form, see the next section. For the adjective well, see 589.
For the position of adverbs of manner, see 23.6,23.10,23.14. For spelling rules, see 530.
21 adverbs or adjectives? confusing cases
1 adjectives ending in -ly
Some words ending in -ly are adjectives, and not normally adverbs.
Common examples: costly, cowardly, deadly, friendly, likely, lively, lonely, lovely, silly, ugly, unlikely.
She gave me a friendly smile. Her singing was lovely.
There are no adverbs friendly/'friendlily, lovely I lovelily etc. She smiled in a friendly way. (NOT She
smilcd-friendly.) He gave a silly laugh. (NOT He laughed silly.)
page 16
auverus or adjectives? coniusing cases zi
Daily, weekly, monthly, yearly, early and leisurely are both adjectives and adverbs.
It's a daily paper. It comes out daily.
an early train I got up early.
2 adjectives and adverbs with the same form;
adverbs with two forms
Some adjectives and adverbs have the same form: for example, a fast car goes fast; if you do hard work,
you work hard. In other cases, the adverb may have two forms (e.g. late and lately), one like the adjective
and the other with -ly. There is usually a difference of meaning or use. Some examples follow; for more
detailed information, check in a good dictionary.
clean The adverb clean means 'completely* before forget (informal) and some expressions of movement.
Sorry I didn 't turn up-I clean forgot.
The explosion blew the cooker clean through the wall.
dead The adverb dead is used in certain expressions to mean 'exactly', 'completely' or 'very'. Examples:
dead ahead, dead certain, dead drunk, dead right, dead slow (GB only),
dead straight, dead sure, dead tired
Note that deadly is an adjective, meaning 'fatal', 'causing death'. The adverb for this meaning is fatally.
Compare:
Cyanide is a deadly poison.
She was fatally injured in the crash.
direct Direct is often used as an adverb in British English, referring to journeys and timetables.
The plane goes direct from London to Houston without stopping.
easy Easy is used as an adverb in some informal expressions. Take it easy! (= Relax!) Easier said than
done. Go easy! (= Not too fast!) Easy come, easy go.
fair Fair is used as an adverb after a verb in some expressions.
to play fair to fight fair to hit something fair and square For the adverb of degree fairly, see 205.
fast Fast can mean both 'quick' and 'quickly' (a fast car goes fast). Fast means 'completely' in the
expression/as? asleep, and it means 'tight', 'impossible to remove' in expressions like holdfast, stick fast,
fast colours.
fine The adverb fine (= 'well') is used in some informal expressions.
That suits me fine. You're doing fine. The adverb finely is used to talk about small careful adjustments and
similar ideas.
a finely tuned engine finely chopped onions (= 'cut up very small') ^•
page 17


--- wiJcuuvesf contusing cases 'es
flat Flat can be used as an adverb in a musical sense (to sing flat means 'to sing on a note that is too
low'). In most other cases, the adverb is flatly.
free The adverb free (used after a verb) means 'without payment'; freely
means 'without limit or restriction'. Compare:
You can eat free in my restaurant whenever you like. You can speak freely -1 won't tell anyone what you
say.
hard The adverb hard has a similar meaning to the adjective.
Hit it hard. Don't work too hard. Hardly means 'almost not'.
I've hardly got any clean clothes left. For the use of hardly... when in clauses of time, see 237.
high High refers to height; highly expresses an extreme degree (it often means'very much'). Compare:
- He can jump really high. Throw it as high as you can.
- It's highly amusing.
lean highly recommend it.
just Just is an adverb with several meanings (see 305). There is also an
adjective just, meaning 'in accordance with justice or the law'; the adverb is
justly.
He was justly punished for his crimes.
late The adverb late has a similar meaning to the adjective late; lately means 'recently'. Compare:
I hate arriving late. I haven't been to the theatre much lately.
loud Loud is often used informally as an adverb after a verb. Don't talk so loud - you'll wake the whole
street.
low Low is an adjective and adverb (a low bridge, a low voice, bend low).
most Most is the superlative of. much, and is used to form superlative adjectives and adverbs (see 136).
Which part of the concert did you like most?
This is the most extraordinary day of my life. In a formal style, most can be used to mean 'very' (see 153).
You're a most unusual person. Mostly means 'mainly', 'most often' or 'in most cases'.
My friends are mostly non-smokers.
pretty The informal adverb of degree pretty is similar to rather (see 205, 468). Prettily means 'in a pretty
way'. Compare:
I'm getting pretty fed up. Isn't your little girl dressed prettily?
quick In an informal style, quick is often used instead of quickly, especially after verbs of movement.
I'll get back as quick as I can.
real In informal American English, real is often used instead of really before adjectives and adverbs.
That was real n ice. He cooks real well.
page 18
adverbs or adjectives? confusing cases 21
right .Rig/if with adverb phrases means 'just', 'exactly' or (GB only) "all the way'.
She arrived right after breakfast.
The snowball hit me right on the nose.
Turn the gas right down. (GB)
Right and rightly can both be used to mean 'correctly'. Right is only used after verbs, and is usually
informal. Compare:
/ rightly assumed that Henry was not coming.
You guessed right. It serves you right. (... rightly is not possible.)
sharp Sharp can be used as an adverb to mean 'punctually'.
Can you be there at six o'clock sharp?
It also has a musical sense (to sing sharp means 'to sing on a note that is too high'), and is used in the
expressions turn sharp left and turn sharp right (meaning 'with a big change of direction'). In other senses
the adverb is sharply.
She looked at him sharply. I thought you spoke to her rather sharply.
short Short is used as an adverb in the expressions stop short (= 'stop suddenly') and cut short (=
'interrupt'). Shortly means 'soon'; it can also describe an impatient way of speaking.
slow Slow is used as an adverb in road signs (e.g. SLOW-DANGEROUS BEND), and informally after go
and some other verbs (especially in . American English). Examples: go slow, drive slow.
sound Sound is used as an adverb in the expression sound asleep. In other cases, soundly is used (e.g.
She's sleeping soundly).
straight The adverb and the adjective are the same. A straight road goes straight from one place to
another.
sure Sure is often used to mean 'certainly' in an informal style, especially in American English.
'Can I borrow your tennis racket?' 'Sure.' Surely (not) usually expresses surprise (see 548 for details).
Surely you're not going out in that old coat?
tight After a verb, tight can be used instead of tightly, especially in an informal style. Typical expressions:
hold tight, packed tight (compare tightly packed).
well Well is an adverb corresponding to the adjective good (a good singer sings well). Well is also an
adjective meaning 'in good health' (the opposite of;'//). For details, see 589.
wide The normal adverb is wide; widely suggests distance or separation. Compare:
The door was wide open. She's travelled widely.
They have widely differing opinions. Note also the expression wide awake (the opposite offast asleep).
wrong Wrong can be used informally instead of wrongly after a verb. Compare:
/ wrongly believed that you wanted to help me. You guessed wrong.
page 19


si us; position (general;
3 comparatives and superlatives
Informal uses of adjective forms as adverbs are especially common with comparatives and superlatives.
Can you drive a bit slower?
Let's see who can do it quickest.
4 American English
In informal American English, many other adjective forms can also be used as adverbs of manner.
Drive friendly.
He looked at me real strange.
22 adverbs: position (general)
2
Different kinds of adverbs go in different positions in a clause. Here are some general rules; for more
details, see 23.
Note: in the following explanations, the word adverb is generally used both for one-word adverbs (e.g.
here, often) and for longer adverb phrases (e.g. in this house, once every six weeks).
verb and object
We do not usually put adverbs between a verb and its object. .. .adverb + verb + object
I often get headaches. (NOT I get often headaches.) .. .verb + object + adverb
She speaks English well. (NOT She speaks well English.) But an adverb particle (see 19,582) can go
between a verb and a noun object. Couldyou switch off the light?
initial, mid- and end position
There are three normal positions for adverbs:
initial position (at the beginning of a clause) Yesterday morning something very strange happened.
mid-position (with the verb)
(For exact position, see 23.10-13.)
My brother completely forgot my birthday. I have never understood her.
page 20
w1
adverbs: position (general) 22
end position (at the end of a clause)
What are you doing tomorrow?
Many adverbs can go in all three of these positions, and some others can go in both mid- and end
position. Longer adverb phrases cannot usually go in mid-position. Compare:
He quickly got dressed. He got dressed quickly. (Quickly can go in mid- or end position.)
He got dressed in a hurry. (NOT Ho in a hurry got dressed.)
(In a hurry cannot go in mid-position.) However, a few very common short adverb phrases like at once can
go in mid-position; and adverbs of degree like very, quite can be added to mid-position adverbs.
She at once realised her mistake.
I very much enjoy skiing.
We were quite often invited to parties at the weekends.
3 What goes where?
initial position
Connecting adverbs (which join a clause to what came before).
Time adverbs can also go here (see 23.8).
However, not everybody agreed, (connecting adverb) Tomorrow I've got a meeting in Cardiff, (time
adverb)
Some negative adverbial expressions (e.g. under no circumstances) can go in
initial position with 'inverted' word order (see 298.5).
Under no circumstances are children allowed in the bar.
mid-position
Focusing adverbs (which emphasise one part of the clause); adverbs of certainty and completeness;
adverbs of indefinite frequency; comment adverbs; some adverbs of manner (see 23.6).
She's done everything-she's even been a soldier, (focusing)
It will probably rain this evening, (certainty)
I've almost finished painting the house, (completeness)
My boss often travels to America, (indefinite frequency)
I stupidly forgot my keys. (comment)
She quickly got dressed, (manner)
end position
Adverbs of manner (how), place (where) and time (when) most often go in end position. (For details, see
23.7,23.8, 23.14.)
She brushed her hair slowly, (manner)
The children are playing upstairs, (place)
I phoned Alex this morning, (time)
page 21


'-"-'a. position lueiaiis;
23 adverbs: position (details)
(It is best to read section 22 before studying this.)
1 connecting adverbs
These adverbs join a clause to what came before. Examples: however, then, next, besides, anyway
Position: beginning of clause
Some of us want a new system; however, not everybody agrees. I worked until five o'clock. Then I went
home. Next, I want to say something about the future. Mid-position is often possible in a more formal style.
/ then went home.
2 indefinite frequency
These adverbs say how often something happens.
Examples: always, ever, usually, normally, often, frequently, sometimes, occasionally, rarely, seldom,
never.
Position: mid-position (after auxiliary verbs and amfare/is/was/were; before other verbs - see paragraph 10
for more details).
auxiliary verb + adverb
I have never seen a whale.
You can always come and stay with us if you want to.
Have you ever played American football?
am/are/is/was/were + adverb |
My boss is often bad- tempered. I'm seldom late for work.
adverb + other verb
We usually go to Scotland in August. It sometimes gets very windy here.
When there are two auxiliary verbs, these adverbs usually come after the first.
We have never been invited to one of their parties.
She must sometimes have wanted to run away. Usually, normally, often, frequently, sometimes and
occasionally can also go at the beginning or end of a clause. Always, ever, rarely, seldom and never
cannot normally go in these positions.
Sometimes I think I'd like to live somewhere else. • Usually I get up early.
BUT NOT -Always I get up early; Never I get up early. I go there occasionally.
I go there quite often. (B UT N o T I go there always.) However, always and never can begin imperative
clauses. Always look in the mirror before starting to drive. Never ask her about her marriage.
For adverbs of definite frequency (e.g. daily, weekly), see paragraph 8 below. For inversion after rarely,
seldom and never, see 298.5.
page 22
aaveros: position (.detailsJ 23
3 focusing adverbs
These adverbs 'point to' one part of a clause. Examples: also (see 45-46), just (see 305), even (see 195),
only (see 394), mainly, mostly, either (see 179), or, neither (see 364), nor (see 364). Position: mid-position
(see paragraph 10 for more details). They can also go in other places in a clause, directly before the
words they modify.
^auxiliary verb + adverb
He's been everywhere - he's even been to Antarctica. We're only going for two days.
fom/are/is/was/uiere + adverb
She's my teacher, but she's also my friend. The people at the meeting were mainly scientists.
Badverb + other verb
Your bicycle just needs some oil - that's all. She neither said thank-you nor looked, at me.
lidverb directly before word(s) modified
Ht.'.-i..
Only you could do a thing like that.
I feel really tired.
He always wears a coat, even in summer.
Too and 05 well are focusing adverbs that usually go in end position (see 45). Either goes in end position
after not (see 364).
4 adverbs of certainty
We use these adverbs to say how sure we are of something. Examples: certainly, definitely, clearly,
obviously, probably. Position: mid-position (see paragraph 10 for more details).
auxiliary verb + adverb
It will probably rain this evening. The train has obviously been delayed.
Vunlarelistwas/were + adverb
m^..
There is clearly something wrong. She is definitely older than him.
gadverb + other verb
He probably thinks you don't like him. I certainly feel better today.
Maybe and perhaps usually come at the beginning of a clause. Perhaps her train is late. Maybe I'm right
and maybe I'm wrong. >
paee 23


- --- "vcius; posilion (Wiaiia/ «•
adverbs of completeness
These adverbs say how completely something happens or is true. Examples: completely, practically,
almost, nearly, quite, rather, partly, sort of, kind of, more or less, hardly, scarcely. Position: mid-position
(see paragraph 10 for more details).
auxiliary verb + adverb
/ have completely forgotten your name. am/are/is/was/were + adverb
Sally can practically read.
It was almost dark. The house is partly ready. adverb + other verb I kind of hope she wins. It hardly
matters.
adverbs of manner; comment adverbs
Adverbs of manner say how something happens or is done.
Examples: angrily, happily, fast, slowly, suddenly, well, badly, nicely, noisily,
quietly, hard, softly.
Position: most often at the end of a clause, especially if the adverb is
important to the meaning of the verb and cannot be left out (see paragraph
14). Adverbs in -ly can go in mid-position if the adverb is not the main focus
of the message (for details of the exact position, see paragraph 10).
end position
He drove off angrily. You speak English well. She read the letter slowly.
mid-positioB She angrily tore up the letter. I slowly began to feel better again.
Mid-position is especially common with passive verbs.
Her books are always well written.
(BUT NOT She always well writes her books.) Comment adverbs (which give the speaker's opinion of an
action) most often go in mid-position.
I stupidly forgot my keys.
For more information about adverbs of manner, see 20-21.
adverbs of place
These adverbs say where something happens.
Examples: upstairs, around, here, to bed, in London, out of the window.
Position: at the end of a clause.
The children are playing upstairs. Come and sit here.
Don't throw orange peel out of the window.
She's sitting at the end of the garden.
Initial position is also possible, especially in literary writing and if the adverb is not the main focus of the
message.
At the end of the garden there was a very tall tree.
page 24
adverbs: position (details) 23
Adverbs of direction (movement) come before adverbs of position.
The children are running around upstairs. Here and there often begin clauses. Note the word order in
Here/There is, Here comes and There goes.
Here/There + verb + subJect
Here comes your bus. (NOT Here your bus comes.) There's Alice. There goes our train! Pronoun subjects
come directly after here and there.
Here it comes. (NOT Here comes it.) There she is. (NOT There is she.)
8 adverbs of time and definite frequency ^
These adverbs say when or how often something happens.
Examples: today, afterwards, in June, last year, finally, before, eventually,
already, soon, still, last, daily, weekly, every year.
Position: mostly in end position; initial position is also common if the adverb
is not the main focus of the message. Some can go in mid-position (see
below). Adverbs of indefinite frequency (often, ever etc) go in mid-position
(see paragraph 2).
I'm going to London today. I Today I'm going to London. She has a new hair style every week. I Every
week she has a new hair style. Finally, eventually, already, soon and last can also go in mid-position; still
and just only go in mid-position.
So you finally got here. When did you last see your father? I've already paid the bill. I still love you. We'll
soon be home. She's just gone out.
9 emphasising adverbs
These adverbs modify particular words or expressions in a clause, and go just
before them.
Examples: very, extremely, terribly, just, almost, really, right. I'll see you in the pub just before eight
o'clock. She walked right past me. We all thought she sang very well.
10 mid-position: detailed rules
Mid-position adverbs usually go after auxiliary verbs, after am/are/is/ was/were, and before other verbs.
She has never written to me. The discussion was mainly about money.
It certainly looks like rain. When there are two or more auxiliaries, the adverb usually goes after the first.
You have definitely been working too hard.
She would never have been promoted if she hadn't changed jobs. But other positions are possible,
especially when the first part of the verb phrase is a modal auxiliary (see 344), used to or have to.
They sometimes must be bored. (OR They must sometimes be bored.)
She could have easily been killed, (o R She could easily have been killed.)
We always used to go to the seaside in May. (o R We used always to go... OR We used to always go...) >
oaee 25


rovcros: position (detailsJ zy"
When adverbs of completeness or manner go in mid-position, they are normally put after all auxiliary
verbs.
/ will have completely finished by next June.
Do you think the repair hfis been properly done?
When I saw her, she was being well looked after.
This time next week I'll be happily working in my garden. When an auxiliary verb is used alone instead of a
complete verb phrase (see 185), a mid-position adverb comes before it.
'Areyou happy?' 'I certainly am.'
I don't trust politicians. I never have, and I never will.
mid-position adverbs with negative verbs
In negative sentences, adverbs generally come before not if they emphasise the negative; otherwise they
come after. Compare:
/ certainly do not agree.
I do not often have headaches.
Both positions are possible with some adverbs, often with a difference of meaning. Compare:
I don't really like her. (mild dislike)
/ really don't like her. (strong dislike)
When adverbs come before not, they may also come before the first auxiliary verb; they always come
before do.
I probably will not be there. (OR/ will probably not be there.}
He probably does not know. (NOT He does probably not know.) Only one position is possible before a
contracted negative.
I probably won't be there.
mid-position adverbs with emphatic verbs v
When we emphasise auxiliary verbs or am/are/is/was/were, we put most mid-position adverbs before
them instead of after. Compare:
- She has certainly made him angry. She certainly HAS made him angry!
- I'm really sorry. I really AM sorry.
- 'Polite people always say thank-you.' 'Yes, well, I always D 0 say thank-you.'
mid-position in American English
In American English (see 50), mid-position adverbs are often put before auxiliary verbs and
am/are/is/was/were, even when the verb is not emphasised. Compare:
He probably has arrived by now. (US normal, GB emphatic)
He has probably arrived by now. (GB normal) As an extreme example, here are four sentences in a
journalistic style taken from an American newspaper article on crime in Britain. The most normal British
equivalents are given in brackets.
- 'Britain long has been known as a land of law and order.' (GB Britain has long been known...) •
page 26
afraid 25
- '... but it probably will lead to a vote...' (GB ...but it will probably lead...'
- '... the Labor Party often has criticized police actions.' (GB... the Labour Party has often criticised...)
- '... he ultimately was responsible for the treatment...' (GB... he was ultimately responsible...)
14 end position: detailed rules
Some sentences are incomplete without adverb complements. For example, a sentence with put, go or
last may not make sense unless one says where something is put, where somebody goes or how long
something lasts. To say how well somebody does something, one is likely to need an adverb of manner.
These 'essential complements' usually go in end position, and before other adverbs.
Put the butter in the fridge at once. (NOT ... at once in the fridge.)
Let's go to bed early. (NOT ... early to bed.)
His speech lasted about three hours. You sang very well last night. Except for essential complements,
adverbs in end position usually come in the order manner, place, time.
/ worked hard yesterday.
She sang beautifully in the town hall last night.
24 affect and effect
Affect is a verb. It means 'cause a change in' or 'influence'.
The cold weather affected everybody's work. Effect is usually a noun meaning 'result' or 'change'. The
expression have an effect on is similar to affect. Compare:
The war seriously affected petrol prices.
The war had a serious effect on petrol prices. In a formal style, effect can also be used as a verb, meaning
'cany out', 'cause to happen'.
We did not effect much improvement in sales last year.
For more information about these words, see a good dictionary.
25 afraid
1 afraid and. fear
In an informal style, be afraid is more common than/ear.
Don't be afraid. (NOT Don't fear.} Are you afraid of the dark?
She's afraid that I might find out.
2 I'm afraid = Tm sorry*
I'm afraid (that) often means 'I'm sorry to tell you (that)'. It is used to introduce apologetic refusals and bad
news.
I'm afraid (that) I can't help you.
I'm afraid that there's been an accident. >
naee 27


"• • aw-ra^n ^g^. (adverDJ zo
J'w afraid so/not are used as 'short answers' (see 493). 'Can you lend me a pound?' Tm afraid not.' 'It's
going to rain.' 'Yes, I'm afraid so.'
3 not used before a noun
Afraid is one of the adjectives that are not usually used before a noun in 'attributive position' (see 15).
Compare:
John's afraid.
John's a frightened man. (NOT ... an afraid man.) We often use very much instead of very before afraid,
especially when I'm afraid means 'I'm sorry to tell you'.
I'm very much afraid he's out.
For information about -ing forms and infinitives after afraid, see 296.13.
26 after (adverb)
1 after in adverb phrases
After is often used in adverb phrases like shortly after, long after, a week after,
a few days after etc.
We had oysters for supper. Shortly after, I began to feel ill. They started the job on 17 June and finished a
week after.
2 after not used alone
After is not normally used alone as an adverb. Instead, we use other . . expressions like afterwards, then
or after that.
I'm going to do my exams, and afterwards I'm going to study medicine. (NOT ... and after, I'm going...)
for after (conjunction), see 27. For after and according to, see 8.
27 after (conjunction)
.clause + after + clause , after + clause, + clause,
'. &
1 use and position
The conjunction after joins one clause to another. After and its clause can come either after or before the
other clause.
- I went to America after I left school. After I left school, I went to America.
(In both cases the speaker left school first and then went to America. Note the comma in the second
structure.)
- He did military service after he went to university.
(He went to university first.) After he did military service, he went to university. (He did military service
first.)
page 28
anemoon, evening ana nigm z
2 present with future meaning
In a clause with after, we use a present tense if the meaning of the clause is future (see 556).
I'll telephone you after I arrive. (NOT ... after I will arrive.)
3 perfect tenses
In clauses with after, we often use present and past perfect tenses to show that one thing is completed
before another starts.
I'll telephone you after I've seen Jake.
After I had finished school, I went to America.
4 after...ing
In a formal style, we often use the structure afters -ing. After having + past participle is also possible,
especially when talking about the past.
After completing this form, give it to the secretary. (More natural than After having completed...)
He wrote his first book after returning/having returned from Mongolia.
for after (adverb), see 26.
28 after all
1 two meanings
After all can mean 'in spite of what was said before' or 'contrary to what was expected'. Position: usually at
the end of a clause.
I'm sorry. I can't come after all.
I expected to fail the exam, but I passed after all. Another meaning is 'we mustn't forget that...', introducing
an important argument or reason which may have been forgotten. Position: at the beginning or end of a
clause.
/ think we should let Sylvia go camping with her boyfriend. After all, she's a big girl now.
Of course you're tired. After all, you were up all night.
Let's finish the cake. Somebody's got to eat it, after all.
2 not used for 'finally'
After all does NOT mean 'finally', 'at last', 'in the end'.
After the theatre we had supper and went to a night club; then we finally went home. (NOT ... after all we
wont-home:)
29 afternoon, evening and night
1 afternoon and evening
In most people's speech, afternoon starts after lunch and changes to evening after work (or after normal
working hours). (
page 29


2
30
1
2
3
---- "(IP" age aw-
evening and night
Evening changes to night more or less at bedtime. But note that
Good evening usually has the sense of 'Hello' and Good night of 'Goodbye' -
Good night is not used to greet people.
A: Good evening. Terrible weather, isn't it?
B: Yes, dreadful.
A: Hasn't stopped raining for weeks. Well, I must be going. Goodnight. B: Goodnight.
age
use of be
We most often talk about people's ages with be + number.
He is thirty. (NOT Ho has thirty.) or be + number + years old (more formal... of age).
He is thirty years old/of age (NOT ... thirty years.) We ask How old are you?, not normally What is your
age?
be+... age
Note the structure be+... age (without a preposition).
When I was your age I was working. (NOT When I was at your ago...) The two boys are the same age.
She's the same age as me.
prepositions
In other structures, at is common before age.
He could read at the age of three. (NOT .. .in the age...]
31 ago
1 position
expression of time + ago
I met her six weeks ago. (NOT.. . ago six weeks.} a long time ago
tenses
An,expression with ago refers to a finished time, and is normally used with a
past tense, not a present perfect (see 418.7).
She phoned a few minutes ago. (NOT She has phoned...) 'Where's Mike?' 'He was working outside ten
minutes ago.'
However, a present perfect tense is used with since... ago (as with since +
any other time expression).
We've been living here since about eight years ago. I haven't bought any since a week ago.
page 30
antiJ: iimuuucLum ..*
3 the difference between ago and/or
Ago says how long before the present something happened; for (with a past tense) says how long it
lasted. Compare:
He died three years ago. (= three years before now)
(NOT He died for three years. OR .. .for three years ago.)
He was ill for three years before he died. (= His illness lasted three years.)
4 the difference between ago and before
counting back
Ago is used with a past tense and a time expression to 'count back' from the present; to say how long
before the present something happened. Before is used in the same way (with a past perfect tense) to
count back from a past moment (see also 95). Compare:
I met that woman in Scotland three years ago.
(NOT ... three years before/ before three years.) When we got talking, I found out that I had been at school
with her husband ten years before. (NOT .. .ten years ago.)
'at any time before now/then'
We can also use before, with a present or past perfect tense and no time expression, to mean 'at anytime
before now/then' (see 95.2).
'Have you been here before?"Yes, I was here a year ago.'
As soon as I saw her I knew that I had met her before.
For other uses of before, see 96-97.
32 alike M
Alike means 'like each other'. Compare:
The two boys are alike in looks, but not in personality.
He's like his brother. (NOT He's alike his brother.) Alike is mainly used in predicative position (see 15).
Compare:
His two daughters are very much alike.
He's got two very similar-looking daughters. (NOT ... alike daughters.)
For like, see 320.
33 all (I): introduction
1 three or more items
All refers to three or more items. Compare:
I'll take all three shirts, please. I'll take both shirts. (NOT ... all two shirts.) ^
page 31


- v viv^i, UUJCCT or compici""" •"
2 subject, object or complement
All can be the subject, object or complement of a sentence. All that matters is to be happy. I gave her all
she asked for. That's all.
For more detailed rules, see 34.
3 all with nouns and pronouns
All can modify a noun or pronoun. Two positions are possible:
with the noun or pronoun:
All (of) the people were singing. I haven't read, all of it.
Give my love to them all. with the verb:
The people were all singing.
For more detailed rules, see 35.
4 all with adjectives, adverbs etc
All can be used to emphasise some adjectives, adverbs, prepositions and
conjunctions.
You're all wet. I was all alone.
I looked all round, but I couldn't see anything.
Tell me all about your holiday. It's all because of you.
For more examples, see a good dictionary.
All, both and half follow similar grammar rules. For both, see 109-110; for half, see 235. For a/;W, see
116.1.
34 all (2): subject, object or complement; s:
all, everybody and everything
1 all and everybody
We do not normally use all to mean 'everybody'. Compare:
All the people stood up. Everybody stood up. (NOT All stood up.)
2 all and everything
All can mean 'everything', but usually only in the structure all + relative clause (all that...). Compare:
- All (that) I have is yours.
Everything is yours. (NOT All is yours.)
- She lost all she owned.
She lost everything. (NOT She lost all.) This structure often has a rather negative meaning, expressing
ideas like ^ 'nothing more* or 'the only thing(s)'.
This is all I've got.
All I want is a place to sit down.
All that happened was that he went to sleep. Note also That's all (= 'It's finished'; 'There's no mor6').
page 32
uu \*ff. w \v^f rvxifi ixuuiio cuiu piunuuns o«y
3 older English
In older English, all could be used alone to mean 'everybody' or 'everything' '.(e.g. Tell me all; All is lost;
All are dead). This only happens regularly in modern English in dramatic contexts like newspaper
headlines (e.g. SPY TELLS ALL).
35 all (3): all (of) with nouns and pronouns
1 all and all of
All (of) can modify nouns and pronouns.
Before a noun with a determiner (for example the, my, this), all and all o/are both possible. American
English usually has all of.
She's eaten all (of) the cake. All (of) my friends like riding. Before a noun with no determiner, we do not
normally use of.
All children can be difficult. (NOT All of children...)
For more about of in noun phrases, see 157.4.
2 all of+ personal pronoun
With personal pronouns, we use all of+ object form. All of us/you/them can be the subject or object of a
clause. All of us can come tomorrow. (NOT All we...) She's invited all of you. Mary sent all of them her
love.
3 pronoun + all
We can put all after pronouns used as objects.
She's invited you all.
Mary sent her love to them all.
I've made us all something to eat. This does not happen with complement pronouns or in short answers.
Is that all of them? (NOT 4s that them all?)
'Who did you invite?' 'All of them! (NOT "Them all.') All can follow a subject pronoun (e.g. They all went
home), but in this case it belongs grammatically with the verb (see 36) and may be separated from the
pronoun (e.g. They have all gone home).
For the American plural pronoun you all, see 424.2.
a.
4 types of noun
All is used mostly before uncountable and plural nouns.
all the water all my friends
However, all can be used before some singular countable nouns referring to things that can naturally be
divided into parts.
all that week all my family all the way With other singular countable nouns, it is more natural to use whole
(e.g. the whole story). For details, see 38.
For the difference between all and every, see 37. ^
page 33


5 negative verbs
It is not very common to use all + noun as the subject of a negative verb (e.g. All Americans don't like
hamburgers). We more often use not all + noun + affirmative verb.
Not all Americans like hamburgers. Note the difference between not all and no. Compare:
Not all birds can fly. No birds can play chess.
6 leaving out the
It is sometimes possible to drop the after all (e.g. all day, all three brothers). See 69.6 for details.
16 all (4): with verbs
When all refers to the subject of a clause, it can go with the verb, in 'mid-position' (like some adverbs - see
15).
auxiliary verb + all :
am/are/is/was/were + off',
We can all swim.
The guests have all arrived.
Those apples were all bad.
all + other verb
My family all work in education.
They all liked the soup.
Note that these meanings can also be expressed by using all (of) + noun/pronoun as the subject (see 35).
All of us can swim. All (of) the guests have arrived.
all and every
All and every can both be used to talk about people or things in general, or about all the members of a
group. There is little difference of meaning; every often suggests 'without exception*. The two words are
used in different Structures.
every with singular nouns; all with plurals
Every is used with a singular noun. To give the same meaning, all is used with a plural noun. Compare:
- every + singular
Every child needs love. (NOT All child needs love.) Every light was out.
- all+ plural
All children need love. All the lights were out.
page 34
2 all with determiners
We can use all, but not normally every, with certain determiners (articles, possessives or demonstratives).
Compare:
- all + determiner + plural
All the lights were out. I've written to all my friends.
- every + singular
Every light was out. (NOT The everylight...) I've written to every friend I have.
(NOT every my friend I my every friend.)
3 all with uncountables
We can use all, but not every, with uncountable nouns. I like all music. (NOT.. . every music.)
4 flH='every part of
We can use all with place names and some singular countable nouns to mean'every part of','the whole of'.
All London was talking about her affairs.
I've been round all the village looking for the cat. Note the difference between all day I week etc and every
day I week etc. _, -
She was here all day. (= from morning to night)
She was here every day. (Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday,...)
For the difference between all and whole, see 38.
For detailed rules for the use of all, see 33-36.
For the difference between every and each, see 174. ;i, ;
38 all and whole
1 pronunciation
all /y.l/ whole /haul/
2 word order
All (of) and whole can both be used with singular nouns to mean 'complete', 'every part of. The word order
is different.
determiner + whole + noun all (of) + determiner + noun
- Julie spentthe whole week athome. Julie spent all (of) the week at home.
- my whole life all (of) my life
3 indefinite reference
All is not generally used before indefinite articles.
She's eaten a whole loaf. (NOT ... all a loaf.) >
page 35


CUZ IlgllL 0.111-* l0"* "
4 uncountable nouns
With most uncountable nouns we prefer all (of).
I've drunk all (of) the milk. (NOT ... the whole-milk,)
5 the whole of
Instead of whole we can generally use the whole of.
Julie spent the whole of the summer at home.
the whole of my life
Before proper nouns (names) and pronouns we always use the whole of, not whole. All (of) is also
possible.
The whole of/All of Venice was under water. (NOT Whole Venice...)
I'vejustread the whole of/all ofWdr and Peace'.
I've read the whole of/all of it.
6 plural nouns
With plural nouns, all and whole have different meanings. AM is like every;
whole means 'complete', 'entire'. Compare:
All Indian tribes suffered from white settlement in America.
(= Every Indian tribe suffered...) Whole Indian tribes were killed off.
(= Complete tribes were killed off; nobody was left alive in these tribes.)
39 all right and alright
The standard spelling is all right. Alright is common, but many people consider it incorrect.
40 allow, permit and let
1 allow and permit
These words have similar meanings and uses. Permit is more formal. Both words can be followed by
object + infinitive.
We do not allow/permit people to smoke in the kitchen. When there is no personal object, an -ing form is
used.
We do not allow/permit smoking in the kitchen. .^,.' Passive structures are common; personal subjects and
gerund (-ing form) subjects are both possible.
People are not allowed/permitted to smoke in the kitchen.
Smoking is not allowed/permitted in the kitchen. The passive structure with it is only possible with permit.
It is not permitted to smoke in the kitchen.
(BUT NOT It is not allowed to smoke...} Allow, but not permit, can be used with adverb particles.
She wouldn 't allow me in.
Mary isn't allowed out at night.
page 36
almost ana nearly 41
2 let
Let is the least formal of these three words, and is followed by object + infinitive without to. Compare:
Please allow me to buy you a drink, (polite and formal)
Let me buy you a drink, (friendly and informal) Let is not usually used in the passive.
I wasn't allowed to pay for the drinks. (NOT I wasn't lot...) Let can be used with adverb particles; passives
are possible.
She wouldn't let me in.
I've been let down.
For more about let, see 315-316.
41 almost and nearly
1 meaning: progress, measurement and counting
Almost and nearly can both express ideas connected with progress, measurement or counting. Nearly is
less common in American English.
I've almost/nearly finished.
There were almost/nearly a thousand people there. Sometimes almost is a little 'nearer' than nearly.
Compare:
It's nearly ten o'clock. (= perhaps 9.45)
It's almost ten o'clock. (= perhaps 9.57) Very and pretty can be used with nearly but not almost.
I've very/pretty nearly finished. (NOT ... very almost...)
2 other ideas ?
Nearly mostly suggests progress towards a goal or closeness to a figure. We prefer almost for other ideas
like 'similar to, but not exactly the same', and to make statements less definite. Jake is almost like a father
to me. Our cat understands everything- he's almost human.
(NOT .. .-he's nearly human.) My aunt's got a strange accent. She almost sounds foreign.
(NOT ... She nearly sounds foreign.) I almost wish I'd stayed at home. (NOT I nearly wish...)
3 negative words
We do not usually use nearly before negative or non-assertive words: never, nobody, nothing, any etc.
Instead, we use almost, or we use hardly with ever, anybody, anything etc (see 374.2).
She's almost never I hardly ever at home. (NOT.. .nearly never...)
Almost nobody I hardly anybody was there.
He eats almost anything.
page 37


42 alone, lonely, lonesome and lone
Alone suggests that a person or thing is separate - there are no others around. Lonely (and informal US
lonesome) refers to unhappiness caused by being alone. Compare:
I like to be alone for short periods.
But after a few days I start getting lonely/lonesome. Alone can be emphasised by all.
After her husband died, she was all alone. Alone is not used before a noun (see 15.3). Lone and solitary
can be used instead; lone is rather literary.
The only green thing was a lone/solitary pine tree.
43 along
The preposition along is used with nouns like road, river, corridor, line:
words that refer to things with a long thin shape.
I saw her running along the road.
His office is along the corridor. To talk about periods or activities, we prefer through.
through the centuries (NOT along the centuries)
all through the journey (NOT all along the journey)
right through the meal
Note the special use of along as an adverb particle in expressions like Come along (= 'Come with me') or
walking along (= 'walking on one's way').
44 already and all ready
Already is an adverb of time, meaning 'by now', 'sooner than expected'. All ready simply means the same
as all + ready. Compare:
'When'sJane coming?' 'She's already arrived.'
'Are you all ready?' 'No, Pete isn 't.'
For more about already, see 539.
45 also, as well and too
1 position
Also, as well and too have similar meanings, but they do not go in the same position in clauses. Also
usually goes with the verb, in 'mid-position' (see 23.3); as well and too usually go at the end of a clause.As
well is less common in American English.
She not only sings; she also plays the piano. She not only sings; she plays the piano as well. She not only
sings; she plays the piano too.
page 38
aiso, as weu, TOO anil eiiner in negative clauses u
2 reference
These words can refer to different parts of a clause, depending on the meaning. Consider the sentence
We have meetings on Sundays as well. This can mean three different things:
a (Other people have meetings on Sundays, and) we have meetings on
Sundays as well. b (We do other things on Sundays, and) we have meetings on Sundays
as well. c (We have meetings another days, and) we have meetings on Sundays
as well.
When we speak, we show the exact meaning by stressing the word or expression that also/as well/too
refers to.
3 imperatives and short answers
As well and too are used in imperatives and 'short answers', but not
usually also.
Give me some bread as well, please. (More natural than Also give me...) 'She's nice.' 'Her sister is as
well.' (More natural than 'Her sister is also.') 'I've got a headache.' 'I have too.' (More natural than 'I also
have!}
In very informal speech, we often use Me too as a short answer. 'I'm going home.' 'Me too.'
More formal equivalents are So am For I am too, but not I also.
4 also referring to a whole clause
A/so can be used at the beginning of a clause to refer to the whole clause. It's a nice house, but it's very
small. Also, it needs a lot of repairs.
5 too in a formal style
In a formal or literary style, too can be placed directly after the subject. I, too, have experienced despair.
For also, as well, too and either in negative clauses, see 46. For also and even, see 195.3. For as well as,
see 77.
46 also, as well, too and either in negative clauses
1 negative + negative: either
After mentioning a negative idea or fact, we can add another negative point by using not... either. Also, as
well and too are not normally used with not in this way.
Peter isn't here today. John isn't here either.
(NOT John isn't here also.) I know you don't like me. I don't like you either.
(NOT I don't like you too.) >
page 39


aiiernate(ly) and altemativeUyJ vr
2 affirmative + negative: also/as well/too
After mentioning an affirmative (non-negative) fact or idea, we can add a related negative idea by using
not... also, not ...as well or not... too. He smokes too much, but at least he doesn't also drink too much.
That day, for the first time since her husband hftd died. a year before, she
was glad that she had not died as well. You can have an apple, but you can't have an orange too.
47 alternate (ly) and alternative (ly)
Alternate(ly) means 'every second', 'first one and then the other', 'in turns'.
We spend alternate weekends at our country cottage.
I'm alternately happy and depressed. Alternatively) is similar to 'different', 'instead', 'on the other hand'.
Janet's not free on the 27th. We'll have to find an alternative date for the meeting.
You could go by air, or alternatively you could drive there.
48 although and though
(al)though + clause, + clause Jclause, + (al)though + clause
SJclause + though ;
1 conjunctions
Both these words can be used as conjunctions, with the same meaning. In informal speech, though is
more common.
(Although the government refuses to admit it, its economic policy is in ruins.
(Although I don't agree with him, I think he's honest.
I'd quite like to go out, (al)though it is a bit late. We use even though to emphasise a contrast. [Even
although is not possible.)
Even though I didn 't understand a word, I kept smiling.
2 though used as an adverb
We can use though as an adverb, to mean 'however'. 'Nice day.' 'Yes. Bit cold, though.' The strongest
argument, though, is economic and not political.
For the difference between even and even though, see 195.4.
For even though and even so, see 195.4-5.
For as though, see 74.
For sentences like Cold though it was, I went out, see 71.
49 altogether and all together
Altogether means 'completely' or 'everything considered'. My new house isn't altogether finished.
Altogether, she decided, marriage was a bit of a mistake.
page 40
American ana nriusn cngnsn au
Altogether can also be used to give totals.
That's L4.38 altogether.
I'd like three dozen altogether. All together usually means 'everybody/everything together'.
Come on, everybody sing. All together now...
Put the plates all together in the sink.
They all went to the cinema together.
50 American and British English
These two varieties of English are very similar. There are a few differences of grammar and spelling, and
rather more differences of vocabulary and idiom. Modern British English is heavily influenced by American
English, so some of the contrasts are disappearing. Pronunciation is sometimes very different, but most
American and British speakers can understand each other without great difficulty.
1 grammar
Here are examples of the most important differences. Note that in many cases, two different forms are
possible in one variety of English, while only one of the forms is possible or normal in the other variety. For
more details, look up the sections in other parts of the book where these structures are discussed.
American English
He just went home. OR He's just gone home.
Do you have a problem? OR Have you got a problem?
I've never really gotten to know her.
I (can) see a car coming.
Her feet were sore because her shoes fit badly.
It's important that he be told.
'Will you buy it?' 'I may.' The committee meets tomorrow.
(on the phone) Hello, is this Susan? It looks like it's going to rain.
He looked at me real strange. (very informal) OR He looked at me really strangely.
British English
He's just gone home. (See 419.5, 305.2.)
Have you got a problem? (See 241.6.)
I've never really got to know her. (See 228.7.)
lean see a car coming. (See 125.1.)
Her feet were sore because her shoes fitted badly. (See 300.3.)
It's important that he should be told.
(See 541.)
... 7 may (do): (See 165.)
The committee meet/meets tomorrow.
(See 503.1.)
Hello, is that Susan? (See 565.5.)
It looks as if/ like it's going to rain.
(See 74.3.)
He looked at me really strangely.
(See 21.)
page 41


American English
One should get to know his neighbours, (formal)
He probably has arrived by now. OK He has probably arrived...
xnrrencan ana rsntisn cngiisn a"
British English
One should get to know one's neighbours, (formal) (See 392.6.)
He has probably arrived by now. (See 23.13.)
Besides get and fit, some other irregular verbs have different forms in British and American English. For
details, see 300.3.
For the Southern US second person plural pronoun you all, see 424.2.
vocabulary
There are very many differences. Sometimes the same word has different meanings (GB mad = 'crazy';
US mad = 'angry'). And very often, different words are used for the same idea (GB lorry = US truck). Here
are a few examples, with very brief information about the words and their meanings. (For a larger list with
more complete information, see The British/American Dictionary by Norman Moss, published by
Hutchinson.)
American English
airplane
anyplace, anywhere
apartment
area code
attorney, lawyer
busy
cab/taxi
call collect
can
candy
check/bill
coin-purse
cookie, cracker
corn
crib
crazy
cuffs
diaper
doctor's office
dumb, stupid
elevator
eraser
fall, autumn
faucet, tap
first floor, second floor etc
flashlight
flat (tire)
french fries
British English
aeroplane
anywhere
flat/apartment
dialling code (phone)
barrister, solicitor
engaged (phone)
taxi
reverse the charges (phone)
tin
sweets
bill (in a restaurant)
purse
biscuit
sweet corn, maize
cot
mad
turn-ups (on trousers)
nappy
doctor's surgery
stupid
lift
rubber, eraser
autumn
tap (indoors)
ground floor, first floor etc
torch
flat tyre, puncture
chips
page 42
American ana-DTinsn zaignsn au
American English
garbage, trash
garbage can, trashcan
gas(oline)
gear shift
highway, freeway
hood
intersection
mad
mail
mean
movie, film
one-way (ticket)
pants, trousers
pavement
pitcher
pocketbook, purse, handbag
(potato) chips
railroad
raise
rest room
round trip
schedule, timetable
sidewalk
sneakers
spigot, faucet
stand in line
stingy
store, shop
subway
truck
trunk
two weeks
vacation
windshield
zee
zipper
British English
rubbish
dustbin, rubbish bin
petrol
gear lever (on a car)
main road, motorway
bonnet (on a car)
crossroads
angry
post
nasty
film
single (ticket)
trousers
road surface
Jug
handbag
crisps
railway
rise (in salary)
public toilet
return (journey/ticket)
timetable
pavement
trainers (= sports shoes)
tap (outdoors)
queue
mean (opposite of'generous')
shop
underground
van, lorry
boot (of a car)
fortnight, two weeks
holiday(s)
windscreen (on a car)
zed (the name of the letter 'z')
zip
Expressions with prepositions and particles
American English
different from/than
check something (out)
do something over/again
live on X street
on a team
Monday through/to Friday
British English
different from/to (see 158) check something do something again live in X street in a team Monday to
Friday
page 43


-mi^oii aiiu oniisil E"S"°"
3
spelling
A number of words end in -or in American English and -our in British English (e.g. color/colour). Some
words end in -er in American English and -re in British English [e.g. center I centre). Many verbs which
end in-tee in American English (e.g. realize) can be spelt in British English with -ize or -ise (see 531).
Some of the commonest words with different forms are:
American English
aluminum analyze catalog(ue) center check color defense honor jewelry labor pajamas paralyze
practice, practise program realize theater tire
traveller whiskey
British English
aluminium analyse catalogue centre
cheque (.issued by a bank) colour defence honour jewellery labour pyjamas paralyse practise (verb)
programme realise/realize theatre
tyre (on a wheel) traveller (see 535) (Scotch) whisky; (Irish) whiskey
4 pronunciation
There are, of course, many different regional accents in both Britain and America. The most important
general differences between American and British speech are as follows:
a Certain vowels are nasal (pronounced through the nose and mouth at the
same time) in some varieties of American English, but not in most British accents.
b British English has one more vowel than American English. This is the rounded short o (/o/) used in
words like cot, dog, got, gone, off, stop, lost. In American English these words are pronounced either with
/a/, like the first vowel in father, or with I V.I, like the vowel in caught. (This vowel is also pronounced
rather differently in British and American English.)
c Some words written with a + consonant (e.g. fast, after) have different
pronunciations: with /a:/ in standard southern British English, and with 1x1 in American and some other
varieties of English.
d The vowel in home, go, open is pronounced /au/ in standard southern British English, and /ou/ in
American English. The two vowels sound very different.
page 44
In standard southern British English, r is only pronounced before a vowel sound. In most kinds of
American English, r is pronounced in all positions where it is written in a word, and it changes the quality
of a vowel that comes before it. So words like car, turn, offer sound very different in British and Amencan
speech.
In many varieties of American English, t and d both have a very light voiced pronunciation /d/ between
vowels - so writer and rider, for example, can sound the same. In British English they are quite different:
/'raita(r)/ and /'raida(r)/.
Some words which are pronounced with /u'.l in most varieties of American English have /ju:/ in British
English. These are words in which th, d, torn (and sometimes s or I) are followed by u or ew.
enthusiastic • US /m'Guizi'aestik/ GB /m'9ju:zi'aestik/
duty
tune
duty

US/'du:ti/

GB /'dju:ti/

tune

US/turn/

GB /tjurn/

new

US /nu:/

GB /nju:/

illuminate

US /i'lu:mmeit/

GB /i'lju:minert/

h Words ending in unstressed -He (e.g. fertile, reptile, missile, senile) are pronounced with /ail/ in British
English; some are pronounced with /!/ in American English.
fertile US /'fsirti/ (rhyming with turtle)
GB /'f3:tail/ (rhyming with her tile)
i Some long words ending in -ary, -ery or -ory are pronounced differently, with one more syllable in
American English. secretary US /'sekrateri/ GB /'sekratri/
j Borough and thorough are pronounced differently.
US /'DATOU, 'GArou/ GB /'DAra, 'GATB/
k Words borrowed from French are often stressed differently, especially if their pronunciation ends with a
vowel sound. The final vowel is usually stressed in American English but not in British English. pate US
/pae'tel/ GB /'paetel/ ballet US /bse'lei/ GB /'baelei/
51 and
1 use
When we join two or more grammatically similar expressions, we usually put and before the last.
bread and cheese
We drank, talked and danced.
I wrote the letters, Peter addressed them, George bought the stamps and
Alice posted them. And is sometimes left out in a very literary or poetic style, but this is unusual.
My dreams are full of darkness, despair, death.
For rules about the use of commas, see 455.1,5. >
page 45


2 fixed expressions ,
Some common expressions with and have a fixed order which cannot be changed. The shortest
expression often comes first.
bread and butter (NOT butter and bread]
hands and knees (NOT knees and hands)
young and pretty thunder and lightning
black and white cup and saucer
knife and fork
3 adjectives before a noun
We do not usually use and with adjectives (or other modifiers) before a noun (see 17.2).
Thanks for your nice long letter. (NOT ... nice and long letter.) a tall, dark, handsome cowboy cheap
wooden garden furniture
However, and is used in certain cases, for example when the modifiers refer
to different parts of the same thing.
red andyellow socks a metal and glass table
We also use and when we say that something belongs to two or more different classes.
It's a social and political problem. She's a musical and artistic genius.
And is common, too, when we are 'piling up' favourable or unfavourable descriptions.
You 're a good and generous person.
She's an intelligent and strong-minded woman.
It's an ill-planned, expensive and wasteful project.
4 nice and
In an informal style, the expression nice and is often used before another adjective or an adverb. It means
something like 'pleasantly' or 'suitably'.
It's nice and warm in front of the fire. (= pleasantly warm)
The work was nice and easy.
Now just put your gun down nice and slow.
5 meanings
When two clauses are joined by and, there are many possible relationships between them - for example
time, cause and effect, contrast, condition. Hay down and went straight to sleep, (time) She won the prize
and astonished them all. (cause and effect) She's a bank manager and I'm just a road-sweeper, (contrast)
Do that again and I'll hit you. (condition: = If you do that again...)
Note: and is usually pronounced /an(d)/, not /aend/ (see 588).
For ellipsis after and, in expressions like the bread and (the) butter, see 182.
For singular and plural verbs after subjects with and, see 504.5.
For and after try, wait, go, come etc, see 52.
For both... and, see 111.
page 46
52 and after try, wait, go etc
1 try/be sure/wait and...
We often use try and... instead of try/be sure to... This is informal.
Try and eat something - you'll feel better if you do.
I'll try and phone you tomorrow morning.
Be sure and ask Uncle Joe about his garden. We only use this structure with the simple base forms try/be
sure. It is not possible with tries, tried, trying or am/are/is/was/were sure. Compare:
Try and eat something.
I tried to eat something. (NOT I tried and ate something^ Note also the common expression Wait and see.
'What's for lunch? "Wait and see.'
2 come/go/etc and...
Come and..., go and..., run and..., hurry up and..., stay and... are often used informally with similar
meanings to infinitive structures.
Come and have a drink.
Stay and have dinner.
Hurry up and open the door. With these verbs, the structure is not only used with the base form.
He often comes and spends the evening with us.
She stayed and played with the children.
She thought of going and getting him.
3 American English
In informal American English, and is sometimes dropped after the base forms go and come.
Let's go see ifAnne's home.
Go jump in the river.
Come sit on my lap.
53 another and other(s)
1 spelling of another
Another is one word.
He's bought another car. (NOT.. .an other car.)
2 'additional, extra'
Another can mean 'an additional, extra'. It is used with singular countable nouns.
Could I have another piece of bread? Another can be used as a pronoun without a noun, or with one, if
the meaning is clear from what has come before.
Those cakes are wonderful. Could I have another (one) ? With uncountable and plural nouns, we normally
use more, not other.
Would you like some more meat? (NOT.. . other meat?)
Would you like some more peas? (NOT .. .other peas?) >
page 47


,.,__,-,-. . - m} " "^H ,, , «
However, we can use another before a plural noun in expressions with few or I a number.
fw staying for another few weeks. We need another three chairs.
For other cases where a(n) is followed by a plural, see 509.6.
3 'alternative'
(An)other can also mean '(an) alternative', 'besides this/these'.
I think we should paint it another colour.
Have you got any other cakes, or are these the only ones? Other people often means 'people besides
oneself.
Why don't you think more about other people?
4 other and others
When other is used with a noun it has no plural form.
Where are the other photos? (NOT ... the others photos?) But used alone, without a noun, it can have a
plural form.
I've got one lot of photos. Where are the others?
These are too small. Have you got any others? Normally, other(s) is only used alone if it refers to a noun
that has been
mentioned before. An exception is the common plural use of (the) others to mean (the) other people.
He never thinks of others. Jake's arrived -1 must tell the others. BUT NOT -On the telephone, one cannot
see the other OB He never listens to another.
5 not used to mean 'different'
Other is not used as an adjective to mean 'different'. I'd prefer a completely different colour.
(NOT ... a completely other colour.) It would print better on different paper. (NOT ... other paper:) You look
different with a beard. (NOT You look other...)
For one another, see 175.
I- any
I the meaning of any
Any is a determiner (see 157). It generally suggests an indefinite amount or number, and is used when it
is not important to say how much / many we are thinking of. Because of its 'open', non-specific meaning,
any is often used in
questions and negative clauses, and in other cases where there is an idea of doubt or negation.
Have you got any beer?
We didn 't have any trouble going through customs. You never give me any help.
The noise of the party stopped me getting any sleep. I suddenly realised I'd come out without any money.
page 48
Any is common after if.
If you find any blackberries, keep some for me. Sometimes any means ' if there is / are any' or 'whatever
there is / are'.
Any fog will clear by noon. (= If there is any fog, it will clear by noon.)
Perhaps you could correct any mistakes I've made. Any can be used to emphasise the idea of open
choice: 'it doesn't matter who/what/which'. For details, see paragraph 6 below.
You can borrow any book you like.
2 any and some
Any often contrasts with some, which is most common in affirmative clauses.
Compare:
I need some razor blades. Have you got any razor blades? Sorry, I haven't got any razor blades.
For details, see 522.
3 any, not any and no
Any alone does not have a negative meaning. It is only negative when used with not.
She's unhappy because she hasn't got any friends.
(NOT ... because she has got any friends.) No (see 369) means the same as not any, but is more
emphatic.
She's got no friends. Not any cannot begin a sentence; no is used instead.
JVo cigarette is harmless. (NOT Not any cigarette...)
No tourists came to the town that year.
For more details, see 369.
4 any and a/an
Any is very often used with uncountable and plural nouns. It can have the
same kind of meaning as the indefinite article a/an has with singular
countable nouns (see 66. la).
I haven't got a car, and I haven't got any money to buy one. Is there a tin-opener in the house? And are
there any plates?
With this meaning any is unusual with singular countable nouns. She hasn't got a job. (NOT She hasn't
got any job.) Do you know a good doctor? (NOT Do you know any good doctor?)
Note that the fixed expressions any idea and any difference are used as if the
nouns were uncountable (see 148.5). Have you got any idea what she wants? Is there any difference
between 'close' and 'shut'? 1
For the use ofany meaning 'it doesn't matter who/what/which' with singular countable nouns, see
paragraph 6 below. ^
page 49


any .14
any and no article
With an uncountable or plural noun, any usually suggests the idea of an indefinite amount or indefinite
number. When there is no idea of quantity or number, we generally use no article. For details, see 67.
Compare:
- Is there any water in that can? Is there water on the moon?
(The interest is in the existence of water, not its amount.)
- Dad hasn 't got any hair. (He has lost the amount he had.) Birds have feathers, not hair. (No idea of
amount.)
i any = 'it doesn't matter who/which/what'
Any can be used to emphasise the idea of free choice, with the meaning of'it doesn't matter
who/which/what'. With this meaning, any is common in affirmative clauses as well as questions and
negatives, and is often used with
singular countable nouns as well as uncountables and plurals. In speech, it is stressed.
Ask any doctor- they'll all tell you that alcohol is a poison.
She goes out with any boy who asks her.
'When shall I come? "Any time.'
Can I get a meal here at any time of the day?
I don't do just any work-I choose jobs that interest me.
Note that we use either (see 178), not any, to talk about a choice between two alternatives.
lean write with either hand. (NOT ... any hand.}
any and any of; any as a pronoun
Before a determiner (definite article, demonstrative or possessive word) or a pronoun, we use any of (see
157.4). Compare:
- / didn 't go to any lectures last term. (NOT.. . any of lectures...) / wasn't interested in any of the lectures.
(NOT ... any the lectures.)
- Do any books here belong to you? Do any of these books belong to you?
- I don't think any staff want to work tomorrow.
I don't think any of us want to work tomorrow. Note that when any of is followed by a plural subject, the
verb can be singular or plural. A singular verb is more common in a formal style.
If any of your friends is/are interested, let me know. A noun can be dropped after any, if the meaning is
clear.
'Did you get the oil?' 'No, there wasn't any left.'
Instead of not any, none (see 368) can be used. This is often more emphatic. There was none left.
at all
At all (see 82) is often used to emphasise the meaning of (not) any. I'll do any job at all - even road-
sweeping. Do you play any games at all? She doesn't speak any English at all. Is there any difference at
all between 'begin' and 'start'?
page 50

any and no: adverbs 56
9 compounds
Many of the rules given above also apply to the compounds anybody, anyone, anything and anywhere.
For more information about these, see 523.
For the use of any and no as adverbs, see 56.
For any... but, see 116.
For any and every, see 55. .'.
For some, see 521-522.
For any more/longer, see 372.
55 any and every
Any and every can both be used to talk in general about all the members of a class or group.
Any/Every child can learn to swim.
The meaning is not quite the same. Any looks at things one at a time: it means 'whichever one you
choose', 'this or that or the other'. Every looks at things together: its meaning is closer to 'all', 'this and that
and the other'. Compare:
'Which newspaper would you like?' 'It doesn't matter. Any one.'
(= 'one or another or another') (NOT ... Every one.) On the stand there were newspapers and magazines
of every kind. (= 'one and another and another') (NOT ... magazines of any kind.)
For more information about any, see 54. For every, see 199.
56 any and no: adverbs
any/no + comparative any/no different ^any/no good/use
1 any and no with comparatives
Any can modify comparatives. This can happen in questions and negative sentences, and after if (see
also 374.2).
Can you go any faster?
You don't look any older than your daughter. (= You don't look at all older...)
If I were any younger, I'd fall in love with you. No can also be used in this way (but not some).
I'm afraid the weather's no better than yesterday.
2 any/no different
We can also use any and no with different.
This school isn't any different from the last one. 'Is John any better?' 'No different. Still very ill.' >
page 51


3 any/no good; any/no use
Note the expressions any good/use and no good/use. Was the film any good? This watch is no use. It
keeps stopping.
57 any more
In British English, any more is usually written as two separate words. In American English, it is often
written as one word anymore when it refers to time (='any longer'). It usually comes in end position. She
doesn 't work in New York anymore.
(NOT She doesn't any more work in Now York.)
58 appear
1 copular verb:'seem'
Appear can be a copular verb (see 147), used to say how things look (like seem). It is used in similar ways
to seem: see 490 for details.
He appears (to be) very angry today. (NOT -He appears very angrily today.) It appears to be some kind of
bomb. • She appears to have enough money to live on. They do not appear to be at home. It appears that
we may be mistaken. There appears to be a problem with the oil pressure.
2 appear and seem: differences
Seem can be used to talk both about objective facts and about subjective impressions and feelings (see
490 for examples). Appear is mostly used to talk about objective facts. Compare:
The baby seems/appears (to be) hungry.
She doesn't want to go on studying. It seems a pity. (NOT It appears a pity.) Seem is often used with like.
This is not normal with appear.
It seemed like a good idea.
(More natural than It appeared like a good idea.) Seem can be used in a special structure with can't (see
490.4). This is not possible with appear.
I can't seem to make him understand.
(BUT NOT I can't appear to make him understand.) Appear is also rather more formal than seem.
3 'come into sight'
Appear can also mean 'come into sight' or 'arrive'. In this case it can be modified by an adverb.
She suddenly appeared in the doorway.
For appear with introductory there, see 563.5.
page 52
(ajrouna ana about 60
59 arise and rise
Arise means 'begin', 'appear', "come to one's notice'. It is used mostly with abstract nouns as subjects.
A discussion arose about the best way to pay.
I'm afraid a difficulty has arisen. Rise usually means 'get higher', 'come/go up'.
Prices keep rising.
What time does the sun rise?
My hopes are rising.
Note that we usually say that people get up in the morning. Rise is Only used with this meaning in a very
formal style.
Arise and rise are irregular verbs. (a)rise - (a)rose - (a)risen
For the difference between rise and raise, see 300.2.
For arouse and rouse, see 61.
60 (a) round and about
1 circular movement etc
In British English, we usually use round for movement or position in a circle or a curve.
She walked round the car and looked at the wheels.
We all sat round the table.
'Where do you live?' 'Just round the corner.'
2 touring; distribution
British people also use round to talk about going to all (or most) parts of a place, or giving things to
everybody in a group.
We walked round the old part of the town.
Can I look round?
Could you pass the cups round, please?
3 indefinite movement and position
We use around or about to refer to movements or positions that are not very clear or definite: 'here and
there', 'in lots of places', 'in different parts of, 'somewhere in'and similar ideas.-
The children were running around/about everywhere.
Stop standing around/about and do some work.
'Where'sJohn?' 'Somewhere around/about.'
I like doing odd jobs around/about the house. We also use these words to talk about time-wasting or silly
activity.
Stop fooling around/about. We're late. And around/about can mean 'approximately', 'not exactly'.
There were around/about fifty people there.
'What time shall I come?' 'Around/About eight.' ^
page 53


arouse aim ruuac wi
• American English
Note that in American English, about is mostly used to mean 'approximately', 'not exactly'; for the other
meanings discussed in paragraphs 1-3, Americans normally use around.
For more details and examples, see a good dictionary.
arouse and rouse
To rouse somebody is to wake them up, make them interested, make them excited etc.
It is extremely difficult to rouse my father in the mornings. (In an informal style,... to wake my father up...
would be much more natural.)
Professor Bognor's speech failed to rouse his audience. Arouse is often used with an abstract word as an
object: you can arouse somebody's interest, suspicions, sympathy etc.
When he kept saying he was working late at the office, it began to arouse
her suspicions. Arouse can be used in a sexual sense.
Most men are aroused by pictures of naked women. Arouse and rouse are both regular verbs.
For arise and rise, see 59. For (a)wake and (a)waken, see 85.
articles (I): introduction
How much do articles matter?
The correct use of the articles (a/an and the) is one of the most difficult points in English grammar.
Fortunately, most article mistakes do not matter too much. Even if we leave all the articles out of a
sentence, it is usually possible to understand it.
Please can you lend me pound of butter till end of week? However, it is better to use the articles correctly
if possible. Sections 63-69 give the most important rules and exceptions.
speakers of Western European languages
Most languages of Western European origin, and one or two others, have article systems very like
English. So a student does not need to know the whole contents of sections 63-69 if he/she already
speaks one of the following languages, for example, perfectly or very well: French, German, Dutch,
Danish, Swedish, Norwegian, Icelandic, Spanish, Italian, Portuguese, Greek, Romanian. However, some
of the rules in these sections will probably be useful. Note especially the following.
In English, when we are talking about people or things in general we do not usually use the with
uncountable or plural nouns. (See 68 for more details.)
Life is complicated. (NOT The life is complicated:)
My sister loves horses. (NOT.. . the horses.)
page 54
co \L-). auxiixixcuy m me n
3
63
i 1
2
3
In English, we normally put a/an with a noun that is used for classifying -saying what class, group or type
somebody or something belongs to, what job, role or position somebody or something fills, etc. (See 66. Ic
for more details.)
She's a dentist. (NOT She's dentist.)
I'm looking forward to being a grandmother. (NOT ... to being grandmother.}
I used my shoe as a hammer. (NOT.. . as hammer.)
speakers of other languages
If a student does not already have a very good knowledge of one of the languages listed in paragraph 2
(or a related language), he or she may have more difficulty with the correct use of articles. Most of the
important problems are dealt with in the following sections.
articles (2): summary of the rules
articles are determiners
The articles a/an and the belong to a group of words called 'determiners'. (Determiners also include
possessives like my, demonstratives like this and quantifiers like all. For more information, see 157.)
Articles normally come at the beginning of noun phrases, before adjectives.
For the word order in structures like How strange an idea, see 16.
For the word order in quite a... , see 154.2,5; for rather a..., see 154.2; for such a..., see 544.1; for whata...
, see 201.2.
What are articles used for?
A/an is called the 'indefinite article'. The is called the 'definite article'. Some/any is often used as the plural
of a/an. And if we use no article, this has a different meaning from all the others. So there are really four
articles.
Articles are used to show whether we are referring to things that are known both to the speaker/writer and
to the listener/reader ('definite'), or that are not known to them both ('indefinite').
Articles can also show whether we are talking about things in general or particular things.
the = 'we know which one(s)'
We say the doctor, the salt or the dogs (for example), when we expect the listener/reader to know which
doctor, salt or dogs we are talking about, hi other cases, we use a/an, some/any or no article. Compare:
- I've been to the doctor. (You know which one: my doctor.) A doctor must like people. (= any doctor at all)
- Could you pass me the salt?
(The listener knows that it is the salt on the table that is meant.) We need some more salt. (not particular'
known' salt) >
page 55


- Have you fed the dogs?
(The listener obviously knows which dogs are meant.) Do you like dogs? (= dogs in general)
For more details, see 65.
4 particular and general
We can use articles to show whether we are talking about particular things or things in general. Compare:
- There are some children in the garden. (= particular children) Children usually start walking at around
one year old. (= children in general)
- They're delivering the oil tomorrow. (= particular oil)
Oil has nearly doubled in price recently. (= oil in general) Note that with plural and uncountable nouns we
use no article, and not the, to talk about people or things in general.
Oil has nearly doubled in price. (NOT The oil...) -• ."• Children usually start walking... (NOT The children...)
But we can sometimes use the + singular countable noun to generalise. Who invented the telephone?
For more details, see 68. For more information about some and any, see 54,521 and 522.
1 articles (3): countable and uncountable nouns
Articles are used in different ways with countable and uncountable nouns. 1 the difference
Countable nouns are the names of separate objects, people, ideas etc which we can count.
a cat three cats
a secretary two secretaries
a plan two plans
Uncountable nouns are the names of materials, liquids and other things which we do not usually see as
separate objects.
water (NOT a water, -two waters)
wool (NOT a wool, two wools)
weather (NOT a weather, two weathers)
energy (NOT an energy, two energies)
use of articles
A singular countable noun normally has an article or other determiner (see 157) with it. We can say a cat,
the cat, my cat, this cat, any cat, either cat or every cat, but not just cat. (There are one or two exceptions
- see 69.) Plural
and uncountable nouns (e.g. cats, water) can be used with or without an article or other determiner.
page 56
amcies (4J:me (details.) es
3 a/an
Plural nouns cannot be used with a/an (because a/an has a similar meaning to 'one'), and uncountable
nouns are not generally used with a/an, though there are a certain number of exceptions (see paragraph
4).
4 exceptions: uncountable nouns treated as countable
Many normally uncountable nouns can be treated as countable to express the meaning 'a type of or 'a
portion of.
Have you got a shampoo for dry hair?
Three coffees, please. Many other normally uncountable nouns can have 'partly countable' uses:
they do not have plurals, but can be used with a/an. This can happen when the meaning is particular
rather than general.
We need a secretary with a knowledge of English.
You've been a great help.
I need a good sleep.
But some uncountable nouns (e.g. weather, progress) cannot normally be used in this way.
We're having terrible weather. (NOT ... a terrible weather.)
You 've made very good progress. (NOT .. .-a-wry good progress:) Note also:
She speaks very good English. (NOT ... a very good English.) Some nouns that are countable in other
languages are uncountable in English. Examples are information (NOT an information), advice (NOT -an
advice); see 148.3 for a more complete list.
For detailed information about countable and uncountable nouns, see 148.
65 articles (4): the (details)
1 the = 'you know which one (s)'
The usually means something like 'you know which one(s) I mean'. We use the before a noun when our
listener/reader knows (or can work out) which particular person(s), thing(s) etc we are talking about.
Compare:
Did you lock the car? (The listener knows very well which car is meant.) We hired a car to go to Scotland.
(The listener does not know which one.) The listener / reader may know which one (s) we mean because:
a we have mentioned it / them before
She's got two children: a boy and a girl. The boy's fourteen and
the girl's eight. 'So what did you do then7''Gave the money straight back to the
policeman.' (The speaker uses the because the listener has already heard about the money and the
policeman.)
b we say which one(s) we mean
Who's the girl over there with John?
Tell Pat the story about John and Susie.
What did you do with the camera I lent you? >
page 57


articles (4): the (deiausJ a
c it is clear from the situation which one (s) we mean
Could you close the door? (Only one door is open.) Ann's in the kitchen. Did you enjoy the party? What's
the time?
2 the = 'the only one(s) around'
The listener may know which one(s) we mean because there is no choice -we are talking about something
unique, like the sun, or something that is at least unique in our environment, like the Government, the
police.
I haven't seen the sun for days.
the moon the stars the planets the earth the world
the unions the railways
the Japanese (There is only one Japanese nation.) This use of the (to show that there is no choice) is
possible even when we are talking about somebody/something that the listener knows nothing about.
You don't know the Aldersons, do you? (The use of the makes it clear .that there is only one Alderson
family in the speaker's social environment.)
Have you never heard of the Thirty Years' War? (There was only one.)
3 physical environment
The is also used with a number of expressions referring to our physical environment - the world around us
and its climate - or to other common features of our lives. The use of the suggests that everybody is
familiar with '. what we are talking about. Examples are:
the town the mountains the fog the future the country the rain the weather the universe the sea the wind
the night the sunshine the seaside
Do you prefer the town or the country?
My wife likes the seaside, but I prefer the mountains.
I love listening to the wind.
Note that no article is used with nature, society or space when these have a 'general'meaning (see 68).
4 superlatives
We usually use the with superlatives (see 138.12) because there is normally only one best, biggest etc
individual or group (so it is clear which one(s) we are talking about). For the same reason, we usually use
the with first, next, last, same and only.
I'm the oldest in my family. Can I have the next pancake?
We went to the same school.
5 the meaning 'the well-known'
After a name, an identifying expression with the is often used to make it clear that the person referred to is
'the well-known one'.
She married Richard Burton, the actor.
I'd like you to meet Cathy Parker, the novelist.
page 58
aunties \3J~. a l an [.uciaiisJ
6
7
8
9
possessives and demonstratives
We do not use the with possessives or demonstratives. This is my uncle. (NOT ...the my uncle.} I like this
beer. (NOT ... the this beer.)
proper names
We do not usually use the with singular proper names (there are some exceptions -
-see 69.18-19).
66
Mary lives in Switzerland. (NOT The Mary lives in the Switzerland.}
But note the use of the (pronounced /'8i:/) with a person's name to mean 'the well-known'.
'My name's James Bond.' 'What, not the James Bond?'
things in general
We usually use no article, not the, to talk about things in general - the does not mean 'all'.
Boofcs are expensive. (NOT The books arc expensive.)
For details and exceptions, see 68.
pronunciation
The is pronounced /8i:/ before a vowel and /8a/ before a consonant. Compare:
the ice /8i: ais/ the snow /8a snau/
The choice between /8i:/ and /8a/ depends on pronunciation, not spelling. We pronounce /8i:/ before a
vowel sound, even if it is written as a consonant.
the hour /8i: aua/ the MP /8i: em pi:/ And we pronounce /8a/ before a consonant sound, even if it is written
as a .vowel.
the university /8a ju:ni'v3:sati/
the one-pound coin /8a 'WAR 'paund torn/ We sometimes pronounce a stressed /8i:/ before a hesitation,
or when we want to stress the following word, even if it begins with a consonant.
articles (5): a/an (details)
a/an
We can use a/an to talk about one particular person or thing, when the listener / reader does not know
which one is meant, or when it does not matter which one.
My brother's going out with a French girl.
(The listener does not know which particular French girl it is.)
She lives in a nice big house.
Could you lend me a pen?
We can also use a/an to talk about any one member of a class. A doctor must like people. (= any doctor)
A spider has eight legs.
page 59


articles (5): a/an (details) ee
c And we can use a/an after a copular verb or as to classify people and things -to say what class, group or
type they belong to. She's an architect. (NOT She's architect.) I'm looking forward to being a grandmother.
'What's that noise?' 'I think it's a helicopter.' He decided to become an engineer. He remained a bachelor
all his life. Don't use your plate as an ashtray. (NOT... as ashtray.)
2 a/an, some/any and no article
A/an is mainly used with singular countable nouns. (The original meaning of a/an was 'one'.) Before plural
and uncountable nouns, we normally express similar meanings (see paragraph 1) with some/any or no
article.
plural nouns
We met some nice French girls on holiday. (NOT.. .a nice French girls...)
Have you got any matches?
Doctors generally work long hours. (NOT A doctors...)
Both my parents are architects.
||mcountable nouns
I think there's some butter in the fridge.
Whisky is made from barley.
'What's that on your coat?' 'It looks like paint.'
For the difference between some/any and no article, see 67. For more information about some and any,
see 54 and 522-523. For structures like a happy three days, see 509.6.
3 adjectives
A/an cannot normally be used with an adjective alone (without a noun). Compare:
It's a good car.
It's good. (NOT It's a good.)
For a + adjective + one, see 391.
4 possessives
•A/an cannot be used together with a possessive. Instead, we can use the structure a... of mine/yours/etc
(see 434). He's a friend of mine. (NOT He's a my friend.)
5 when a/an cannot be dropped
Note that a/an is not normally left out in negative expressions, after
prepositions or after fractions.
'Lend me your pen.' 'I haven't got a pen.' (NOT 'I haven't gat pen.') You mustn't go out without a coat.
(NOT ... without coat.) three-quarters of a pound (NOT three quarters of pound)
For exceptions, see 69.2.
page 60

articles (6): the ditterence Between some/any ana no article B7
6 a and an
We do not normally pronounce the sound /a/ before a vowel. So before a vowel, the articled (/a/) changes
to an. Compare:
a rabbit a lemon an elephant an orange
The choice between a and an depends on pronunciation, not spelling. We use an before a vowel sound,
even if it is written as a consonant.
an hour /an 'aua/ an MP /an em 'pi:/ And we use a before a consonant sound, even if it is written as a
vowel.
a university /a ju:.../ a one-pound coin /a WAn.../ Some people say an, not a, before words beginning with
h if the first syllable is unstressed.
an hotel (a hotel is more common)
an historic occasion (.a historic... is more common)
(BUT NOT an housewife- the first syllable is stressed.) A is sometimes pronounced /ei/ before a
hesitation, when we want to emphasise the following word, or when we want to make a contrast with the.
It's a /ei/ reason - it's not the only reason.
167 articles (6): the difference between some/any and no article
1 use with uncountable and plural nouns
Uncountable and plural nouns can often be used either with some/any or with no article. There is not
always a great difference of meaning.
We need (some) cheese. I didn 't buy (any) eggs. Some is used especially in affirmative sentences; any is
more common in questions and negatives (see 54 and 522).
2 the difference
We use some/any when we are thinking about limited but rather indefinite vague numbers or quantities -
when we don't know, care or say exactly how much / many. We use no article when we are thinking about
unlimited numbers or quantities, or not thinking about numbers/quantities at all. Compare:
- We've planted some roses in the garden.
(A limited number; the speaker doesn't say how many.) I like roses. (No idea of number.)
- We got talking to some students. (A limited number.) Our next-door neighbours are students.
(The main idea is classification, not number.)
- Would you like some more beer?
(An indefinite amount - as much as the listener wants.) We need beer, sugar, eggs, butter, rice and toilet
paper. (The speaker is thinking just of the things that need to be bought, not of the amounts.)
- Is there any water in the fridge? (The speaker wants a limited amount.) Is there water on the moon?
(The interest is in the existence of water, not the amount.) >
page 61


ro ^ * ). tailing 111 j^iicicu
- This engine hardly uses any petrol. (The interest is in the amount.) This engine doesn 't use petrol.
(The interest is in the type of fuel, not the amount.)
We do not use some/any when it is clear exactly how much/many is meant. Compare:
- You've got some great books.
You've got pretty toes. (A definite number - ten. You've got some pretty toes would suggest that the
speaker is not making it clear how many-perhaps six or seven!)
For full details of the different uses of some and any, see 54 and 522-523.
68 articles (7): talking in general
1 (redoes not mean'all'
We do not use the with uncountable or plural nouns to talk about things in general - to talk about all books,
all people or all life, for example. The does not mean 'all'. Instead, we use no article. Compare:
- Move the books off that chair and sit down. (= particular books) Books are expensive. (NOT ^Fhe-books-
are expensive. The sentence is about books in general - all books.)
- I'm studying the life of Beethoven. (= one particular life)
Life is complicated. (NOT The life... The sentence is about the whole of life.)
- 'Where's the cheese?' 'I ate it.' I love cheese.
- Why has the light gone out?
Nothing can travel faster than light. Note that most (meaning 'the majority of) is used without the.
Most birds can fly. (NOT -The most...)
Mostofthe children got very tired. (NOT The most...)
2 generalisations with singular words
Sometimes we talk about things in general by using the with a singular countable noun.
Schools should pay less attention to examination success, and more attention to the child.
This is common with the names of scientific instruments and inventions, and musical instruments.
Life would be quieter without the telephone. The violin is more difficult than the piano.
We can also generalise by talking about one example of a class, using a/an (meaning 'any') with a
singular countable noun.
A baby deer can stand as soon as it's born. A child needs plenty of love. Note that we cannot use a/an in
this way when we are generalising about all of the members of a group together.
The tiger is in danger ofbecom ing extinct.
(NOT A tiger is-in-dangcr of becoming extinct. The sentence is about the whole tiecr familu nr\t ah.-.-.t
;^;.^J..-'- '
•J -J ----•• ••••0 •"""'t.
the whole tiger family, not about individuals.) Do you like horses? (NOT Do you like a horse?)
page 62
.ng ill general oo
3 difficult cases: 'general' + 'known'
We use no article to generalise with uncountable and plural words (see paragraph 1 above); but we use
the to show that the listener/reader knows which people or things we are talking about (see 65).
Sometimes both these meanings come together, and it is difficult to know whether or not to use the.
a the sea, the weather etc
The is used with a lot of general expressions that refer to our physical environment - the world around us
and its climate - or to other common features of our lives. The use of the seems to suggest shared
experience or knowledge: the listener/reader 'has been there too'.
Do you prefer the town or the country?
My wife likes the sea, but I prefer the mountains.
English people always talk about the weather.
I wish the trains were cleaner and more punctual.
He's always after the girls.
Note that we use no article with nature, society, space and other abstract nouns when these have a
general meaning.
I love nature. (NOT ... the nature.)
It isn't always easy to fit in with society. (NOT ...the society.)
We are just taking our first steps into space. (NOT .. .the space.)
b the Russians etc
We often use the to refer to well-known, well-defined groups of people (e.g. nationalities), even when we
are talking about these in general.
The Russians have a marvellous folksong tradition.
The Irish have their own language.
Should the police carry guns?
For more details of the grammar of nationality words, see 354. Note also the use of the + adjective (e.g.
the blind, the old) to talk about certain groups (see 18).
4 difficult cases: 'half-general'
Some expressions are 'half-general' - in the middle between general and particular. If we talk about
eighteenth-century history, sixties music or poverty in Britain, we are not talking about all history, music or
poverty, but these are still rather general ideas (compared with the history I did at school, the music we
heard last night or the poverty I grew up in). In these 'half-general' expressions, we usually use no article.
However, the is often used when the noun is followed by a limiting, defining phrase, especially one with of.
Compare:
- eighteenth-century music
the music of the eighteenth century
- African butterflies the butterflies of Africa
page 63


69 articles (8): special rules and exceptions
1 common expressions without articles
In some common fixed expressions to do with place, time and movement,
normally countable nouns are treated as uncountables, without articles. Examples are:
to school at school in school (US) from school
to/at/from university/college (GB) to/in/from college (US)
to/at/in/into/from church to/in/into/out of bed/prison
to/in/into/out of hospital (GB) to/at/from work
to/at sea to/in/from town at/from home leave home
leave/start/enter school/university/college
by day at night
by car/bus/bicycle/plane/train/tube/boat on foot
by radio/phone/letter/mail
With place nouns, similar expressions with articles may have different meanings. Compare:
- / met her at college, (when we were students)
I'll meet you at the college. (The college is just a meeting place.)
- fane's in hospital, (as a patient)
/ left my coat in the hospital when I was visiting fane.
- Who smokes in class? (=... in the classroom?)
Who smokes in the class? (= Who is a smoker...?) In American English, university and hospital are not
used without articles.
She was unhappy at the university.
2 double expressions
Articles are often dropped in double expressions, particularly with prepositions.
with knife and fork on land and sea day after day with hat and coat arm in arm husband and wife from top
to bottom inch by inch
But articles are not usually dropped when single nouns follow prepositions (for exceptions, see paragraph
1 above).
You can't get there without a car. (NOT.. .without car.) For cases like the bread and (the) butter, see 182.
3 's genitives
A noun that is used after an 's genitive (like John's, America's) has no article (just like a noun used after a
possessive). the coat that belongs to John = John's coat
(NOT John's the coat OR the John's coat) the economic problems of America = America's economic
problems
(NOT the America's economic problems) But the genitive noun itself may have an article. the wife of the
boss = the boss's wife
page 64
4 the... of a...
In classifying expressions of this kind, the first article is definite even if the meaning of the whole
expression is indefinite.
Lying by the side of the road we saw the wheel of a car. (NOT ... a wheel of a car.)
5 noun modifiers
When a noun modifies another noun, the first noun's article is dropped. guitar lessons = lessons in how to
play the guitar
(NOT the guitar lessons) a sunspot = a spot on the sun
6 both and all
We often leave out the after both.
Both (the) children are good at maths. And we often leave out the between all and a number.
All (the) three brothers were arrested.
We usually leave out the after all in all day, all night, all week, all year, all winter and all summer.
We've been waiting to hear from you all week.
I haven't seen her all day.
7 kind of etc
We usually leave out a/an after kind of, sort of, type of and similar expressions.
What kind of (a) person is she?
Haveyougota cheaper sort of radio?
They've developed a new variety of sheep.
For more information about kind of, sort of etc, see 159.16-17,526.
8 amount said number
The is dropped after the amount/number of.
I was surprised at the amount of money collected. The number of unemployed is rising steadily.
9 man and woman
Unlike other singular countable nouns, man and woman can be used in a general sense without articles.
Man and woman were created equal.
But in modern English we more often use a woman and a man, or men and women.
A woman without a man is like a fish without a bicycle, (old feminist joke)
Men and women have similar abilities and needs. Man is also commonly used to mean 'the human race',
though many people regard this usage as sexist and prefer to avoid it (see 227.6).
How did Man first discover fire? >
page 65


10 days, months and seasons
We use articles with the names of days of the week and months when we are talking about particular days
or months.
We met on a wet Monday in June.
She died on the Tuesday after the accident.
We're having a very wet April.
It was the January after we went to Greece.
. But articles are not used when the meaning is 'the day/month before or after this one'.
See you on Thursday. See you in April.
Where were you last Saturday? We're moving next September. To talk about the seasons in general, we
can say spring or the spring, summer or the summer, etc. There is little difference. The is always used in
in the fall (US).
Rome is lovely in (the) spring.
I like (the) winter best.
When we are talking about particular springs, summers etc, we are more likely to use the.
I worked very hard in the summer that year.
11 musical instruments
We often use the + singular when we talk about musical instruments in general, or about playing musical
instruments.
The violin is really difficult.
Who's that on the piano?
But the is often dropped when talking about jazz or pop, and sometimes when talking about classical
music.
This recording was made with Miles Davis on trumpet.
She studied oboe and saxophone at the Royal Academy of Music.
12 television, (the) radio, (the) cinema and (the) theatre
When we talk about television as a form of entertainment, we do not use articles.
It's not easy to write plays for television. Wouldyou rather go out or watch TV?
But articles are used when television means 'a television set'. Compare:
What's on TV?
Look out! The cat's on the TV! Articles are generally used with radio, cinema and theatre.
I always listen to the radio while I'm driving.
It was a great treat to go to the cinema or the theatre when I was a child. But the article can be dropped
when we talk about these institutions as art forms or professions.
Cinema is different from theatre in several ways. He's worked in radio all his life.
page 66
13 jobs and positions
We normally use a/an when we say what job somebody has (see 66.1c).
She's an architect. (NOT She's architect.) • The is not used in titles like Queen Elizabeth, President
Lincoln. Compare:
Queen Elizabeth had dinner with President Kennedy.
The Queen had dinner with the President. And the is not usually used in the complement of a sentence,
when we say that somebody has or gains a unique position (the only one in the organisation). Compare:
- They appointed him Head Librarian. ':' He's a librarian.
- He was elected President in 1879. I want to see the President.
14 exclamations
We use a/an with singular countable nouns in exclamations after What.
What a lovely dress! (NOT -What lovely dress!) Note that a/an cannot be used in exclamations with
uncountable nouns.
What nonsense! (NOT What a nonsense!)
What luck! (NOT What a luck!)
15 Illnesses
The names of illnesses are usually uncountable in standard British English (for more details, see 148.4).
The can be used informally before the names of some common illnesses such as the measles, the flu;
others have no article. American usage is different in some cases.
/ think I've got (the) measles.
Have you had appendicitis?
I'm getting toothache. (US... a toothache.) Exceptions: a cold, a headache (US also an earache, a
backache).
I've got a horrible cold.
Have you got a headache?
16 parts of the body etc
When talking about parts of someone's body, or about their possessions, we usually use possessives, not
the.
Katy broke her arm climbing. (NOT Katy broke the arm climbing.)
He stood in the doorway, his coat over his arm.
(NOT ... the coat over the arm.)
However, when talking about parts of the body we generally prefer the in prepositional phrases related to
the object of a clause (or the subject of a passive clause).
She hit him in the stomach.
Can'tyou look me in the eye?
He was shot in the leg. This can also happen in prepositional phrases after be + adjective.
He's broad across the shoulders. ^•
page 67


fvx/ICTA 1 U1C& CU1U CA^ayMV
17 measurements
Note the use of the in measuring expressions beginning with by.
Do you sell eggs by the kilo or by the dozen?
She drinks cough medicine by the litre.
He sits watching TV by the hour. Can I pay by the month? A/an is used to relate one measuring unit to
another.
sixty pence a kilo thirty miles anhour (OR ... miles per hour)
twice a week, on average a third of a pint
18 place names
We use the with these kinds of place names:
seas (.the Atlantic)
mountain groups (the Himalayas)
island groups (the West Indies)
rivers (the Rhine)
deserts (the Sahara) _
most hotels (the Grand Hotel)
most cinemas and theatres (the Odeon; the Playhouse)
most museums and art galleries (the British Museum; theFrick)
We usually use no article with:
continents, countries, states, counties, departments etc (Africa, Brazil,;
Texas, Berkshire, Westphalia)
towns (Oxford)
streets (New Street, Willow Road)
lakes (Lake Michigan)
Exceptions: places whose name is (or contains) a common noun like republic, state, union (e.g. the
People's Republic of China, the United Kingdom, the United States). Note also the Netherlands, and its
seat of government The Hague.
In British English, the is unusual in the tides of the principal public buildings and organisations of a town.
Oxford University (NOT the Oxford University)
Hull Station (NOT the Hull Station)
Salisbury Cathedral
Birmingham Airport
Bristol Zoo
Manchester City Council
Cheltenham Football Club In American English, the is more often used in such cases.
The San Diego Zoo The Detroit City Council
Names of single mountains vary. Most have no article.
Everest Kilimanjaro Snowdon Table Mountain But definite articles are usually translated in the English
versions of European mountain names, except those beginning LeMont.
The Meije (= La Meije) The Matterhorn (= DOS Matterhorn)
Mont Blanc (NOT the Mont Blanc)
page 68
as... as...-, as-niticnynianyas /w
19 newspapers and magazines
The names of newspapers usually have the.
The Times The Washington Post The names of magazines do not always have the.
New Scientist
20 abbreviated styles
70
We usually leave out articles in abbreviated styles (see 1). newspaper headlines MAN KILLED ON
MOUNTAIN Introduction Chapter 2 Section B
Mother and child SUPER CINEMA, RITZ HOTEL Open packet at other end Go through door A
Control to Car 27: can you hear me? Turn to page 26. (NOT .. .the page 26.) palm inner surface of hand...
take car to garage; pay phone bill;... J thinks company needs new office
headings
picture captions notices, posters etc instructions numbering and labelling
dictionary entries
lists
notes
For the use of articles with abbreviations (NATO, the USA), see 2.3-4.
For the use of the in double comparatives (the more, the better), see 138.4.
For a wifhfew and little, see 322.
For a with hundred, thousand etc, see 385.10.
For theblind etc, see 18.1.
For the Japanese etc, see 18.2.
For next and the next, see 367; for last and the last, see 307.
For the instead of enough, see 193.7.
For another two days, a good three weeks etc, see 509.6
as... as...; as much/many as
as + adieetfve/adverb + as + noun/ pronoun /clausitB ^WB^^aiiQfjE-CtWUil+as+nouQ/pronoun/cli "*
1 use
We use as... as... to say that two people or things are equal in some way. She's as tall as her brother. Is it
as good as you expected? She speaks French as well as the rest of us.
2 negative structures
After not, we can use so... as... instead of as... as... This structure is more common than less than in
informal English.
He's not as/so successful as his sister. >
page 69


• •. da ...; da inu^ii/ "•*'
3 as... 05 + adjective/adverb
Note the structure as... as + adjective/adverb. Please get here as soon us possible. I'll spend as much as
necessary.
You're as beautiful as ever.
4 pronouns after as
We can use object pronouns (me, him etc) after as, especially in an informal style.
She doesn't sing as well as me. In a formal style, we prefer subject + verb after as.
She doesn 't sing as well as I do.
Note that a subject form without a verb (e.g. as well as he) is unusual in this structure in modern English.
5 as much/many... as
We can use as much/many ...as... to talk about quantity.
/ haven't got as much money as I thought.
We need as many people as possible. As much/many can be used as pronouns, without following nouns.
/ ate as much as I could.
She didn't catch as many as she'd hoped. And as m uch... can be used as an adverb.
You ought to rest as much as possible.
6 half as ...as etc
Note the structure half as... as...; twice as... as...; three times as... as...;
etc.
You're not half as clever as you think you are.
I'm not going out with a man who's twice as old as me.
It took three times as long as I had expected.
(OR... three times longer than I had expected - see 138.7)
7 modification
Expressions with as... as... can be modified by (not) nearly, almost, just, nothing like (GB), every bit,
exactly, not quite. :
It's not nearly as cold as yesterday.
He's just as strong as ever.
You're nothing like as bad-tempered as you used to be.
She's every bit as beautiful as her sister.
I'm not quite as tired as I was last week.
8 infinitives
Where as... as is used with two infinitives, to is often dropped from the second.
It's as easy to do it right as (to) do it wrong.
\
page 70


9 tenses
In as... as-clauses (and other kinds ofos-clauses), a present tense is often used to refer to the future, and
a past tense is often used with a conditional meaning (see 556).
We'll get there as soon as you do/will.
If you married me, I'd give you as much freedom as you wanted.
10 ellipsis
The second part of the as... as or so... as structure can be left out when the meaning is clear from what
comes before.
The train takes 40 minutes. It'll take you twice as long by car.
I used to think he was clever. Now I'm not so sure. In cases like this, not so is much more common than
not as.
11 as replacing subject or object
As takes the place of the subject or object in a clause, rather like a relative
pronoun (see 473.5).
We've got food for as many people as want it. (NOT ... as they want it.) I gave him as much as he could
eat. (NOT ... as he could cat it.)
12 traditional expressions
We use the structure as... as... in a lot of traditional comparative expressions.
as cold as ice as black as night as hard as nails as good as new
The first as is sometimes dropped in these expressions, especially in American English. She's hard as
nails.
Note that as is usually pronounced /az/ (see 588).
For as long as, see 75.
For as well as, see 77.
For the word order in sentences like She's as good a dancer as her brother, see 16.
For other comparative structures, see 135-139.
71 as and though: special word order
'Adjective/adverb + as + clause^
As and though can be used in a special structure after an adjective or adverb. In this case they both mean
'although', and suggest an emphatic contrast. Cold as/though it was, we went out. (= Although it was very
cold,...) Tired as/though I was, I went on working. (= Although I was very tired,...) Bravely as/though they
fought, they had no chance of winning. Much as/though I respect your point of view, I can't agree. We
can't come and see you this weekend, much as we'd like to. Strange though it may seem, I don't like
watching cricket. >
page 71


I ^^^-^elLlot;, ollll^C' CUAVl H-*A •"•
Occasionally as can be used in this construction to mean 'because'.
. Tired as she was, I decided not to disturb her. In American English, as... as is normally used in this
structure. As cold as it was, we went out.
For the word order in structures like I did as good a job as I could, see 16.
72 as, because, since and for
All four of these words can be used to refer to the reason for something. They are not used in the same
way.
1 as and since
As and since are used when the reason is already known to the listener/reader,
or when it is not the most important part of the sentence. As- and smce-clauses
often come at the beginning of sentences.
As it's raining again, we'll have to stay at home. Since he had not paid his bill, his electricity was cut off.
As- and since-causes are relatively formal; in an informal style, the same
ideas are often expressed with so.
It's raining again, so we'll have to stay at home.
2 because
Because puts more emphasis on the reason, and most often introduces new information which is not
known to the listener/reader.
Because I was ill for six months, I lost my job. When the reason is the most important part of the sentence,
the because-clause usually comes at the end. It can also stand alone. Since and as cannot be used like
this.
Why am I leaving? I'm leaving because I'm fed up! (NOT .. .-fm leaving as/since I'm fed up!)
'Why are you laughing?' 'Because you look so funny.' A because-clause can be used at the end of a
sentence to say how one knows something.
You didn 't tell me the truth, because I found the money in your room. [=...1 know because I found...)
3 for
For introduces new information, but suggests that the reason is given as an afterthought. A/or-clause
could almost be in brackets. For-clauses never come at the beginning of sentences, and cannot stand
alone. For, used in this sense, is most common in a formal written style.
I decided to stop and have lunch -for I was feeling hungry.
page 72
as, when and while (simultaneous events) 73
73 as, when and while (simultaneous events)
To talk about actions or situations that take place at the same time, we can use as, when or while. There
are some differences.
1 'backgrounds': as, when or while
We can use all three words to introduce a longer 'background' action or situation, which is/was going on
when something else happens/happened. As / was walking down the street I saw Joe driving a Porsche.
The telephone always rings when you are having a bath. While they were playing cards, somebody broke
into the house. As-, when- and while-clauses can go at the beginning or end of sentences, but ox-clauses
usually introduce less important information, and most often go at the beginning.
A progressive tense is usually used for the longer 'background' action or situation (was walking; are
having, were playing). But as and while can be used with a simple tense, especially with a verb like sit, lie,
or grow which refers to a continuous action or state.
As I sat reading the paper, the door burst open.
2 simultaneous long actions: while; as
We usually use while to say that two longer actions or situations go/went on at the same time. We can use
progressive or simple tenses.
While you were reading the paper, I was working.
John cooked supper while I watched TV. As is used (with simple tenses) to talk about two situations which
develop or change together.
As I get older I get more optimistic. We prefer when to refer to ages and periods of life.
When I was a child we lived in London. (NOT As/While I was a child...)
His parents died when he was twelve. (NOT ... while he was twelve.)
3 simultaneous short actions: (just) as; (just) when
We usually use (just) as to say that two short actions or events happen/ happened at the same time. '1
As I opened my eyes I heard a strange voice.
Mary always arrives just as I start work. (Just) when is also possible.
I thought of it just when you opened your mouth.
4 reduced clauses with when and while
It is often possible to leave out subject + be after when (especially when it means 'whenever'), and after
while. ^ Don't forget to signal when turning right. " "(
(=... when you are turning right.) >
page 73


Climb when ready.
(=... when you are ready.)
While in Germany, he got to know a family of musicians. (= While he was...)
Note that as is usually pronounced /az/ (see 588).
For the use of present tenses to refer to the future with as, when, while and other conjunctions, see 556.
74 as if and as though
1 meaning
As if and as though mean the same. We use them to say what a situation seems like.
It looks as if/though it's going to rain.
I felt as if/though I was dying.
She was acting as if/though she was in charge.
2 tenses
We can use a past tense with a present meaning after as if/though. This shows that a comparison is
'unreal'. Compare:
- She looks as if she's rich.
(Perhaps she is rich.) He talks as if he was rich.
(But he is not.) . - You look as though you know each other.
' Why is she looking at me as though she knew me? I've never seen her befoi in my life.
However, we do not use a past perfect for a past unreal comparison. He talked as if he was rich, but he
wasn't. (NOT ... as ifhehadbecn rich...)
In a formal style, were can be used instead of was in an 'unreal' comparison. This is normal in American
English. He talks as if he were rich.
3 informal use of like
In an informal style, like is often used instead of as if/though, especially in American English. This is not
considered correct in a formal style. It seems like it's going to rain.
He sat there smiling like it was his birthday. For the difference between like and as, see 320.
75 as long as
1 tenses
After as long as, we use a present tense to express a future idea. I'll remember that day as long as I live.
(NOT ... as long as I will live.)
're
For other conjunctions which are used in this way, see 556.
page 74
as wen as TT
2 conditions
As/So long as is often used to state conditions.
You can take my car as/so long as you drive carefully. (=... on condition that you drive carefully.)
76 as usual
Note that in this expression we use the adjective usual, not the adverb usually.
The train's late, as usual. (NOT ... as usually.)
77 as well as
1 meaning
As well as has a similar meaning to 'not only... but also'. She's got a car as well as a motorbike.
(=... not only a motorbike, but also a car.) He's clever as well as good-looking.
(= He's not only good-looking, butalso clever.) She works in television as well as writing children's books.
Note the 'information structure': usually as well as introduces informatioh which is already known to the
listener/reader; the rest of the sentence gives new information.
They speak French in parts of Italy as well as France.
(NOT They speak French in France as well as parts of Italy:
Everybody knows that French is spoken in France, so this information is introduced by as well as.)
2 verbs after as well as
When we put a verb after as well as, we most often use the -ing form. Smoking is dangerous, as well as
makingyou smell bad.
(NOT ... as well as it makes you smell bad.) As well as breaking his leg, he hurt his arm.
(NOT ... as well as he broke his log,...) After an infinitive in the main clause, an infinitive without to is
possible.
I have to feed the animals as well as look after the children. Note the difference between:
She sings as well as playing the piano.
(= She not only plays, but also sings.) She sings as well as she plays the piano.
(= Her singing is as good as her playing.) >
page 75


3
subjects
It is possible to connect two subjects with as well as before a verb. If the first subject is singular, the verb
is also likely to be singular, especially if as well as... is separated by commas.
Alice, as well as Paula, was shocked by the news. (NOT Alice, as well as Paula, were shocked-...)
With longer singular subjects, a plural verb is more likely, especially ff commas are not used.
His appearance as well as his strange way of talking make me
suspicious.
However, this is not a common structure. It is more normal to put
as well as... after the main clause; with pronoun subjects, this almost always happens.
Alice was shocked by the news as well as Paula. He's ill as well as me.
(NOT-He
ell as I/me, is ill.)
For as well, also and too, see 45-46.
78 ask
ask and ask for
Ask for: ask somebody to give something Ask without/or: ash aaoiebody to teB something Compare:
- Don't ask me for money.
(NOT Don't ask me money.) Don't ask me my name. (NOT Don'task mefoi
Wfe)
Ask for the menu. Ask the price.
Ask is sometimes used without for when talking about asking for sums of money, especially in connection
with buying, selling and renting.
They're asking L500 a month rent.
'How much is the car?' 'I'm asking fifteen hundred.' Note also the expressions ask a lot of somebody, ask
too much of somebody, ask a favour of somebody and ask (for) permission.
2 direct and indirect objects
Ask can be followed by either a direct or an indirect object. Ask his name. Ask him.
When ask is followed by two objects, the indirect object (the person) normally comes first, without a
preposition.
I'll ask that man the time. (NOT I'll ask the time to that man.) Can laskyou a favour?
page 76
BT/ in ana 10 /
Astructure with direct object + of+ indirect object is also possible, especially in American English.
I want to ask a question of that man over there.
She's never asked a favour of anybody.
3 infinitive structures
We can use infinitive structures after ask (see 283-284). ask + infinitive
I asked to go home. (= I asked permission to go home.) flask + object + infinitive
I asked John to go home. (= I told John I would like him to go home.) Ijosfc + for + object + infinitive
I asked for the children to have extra milk. I asked for the parcel to be sent to my home address.
Note the difference between these two sentences:
I asked John to go home. (I wanted John to go home.) I asked John if I could go home. (I wanted to go
home myself.)
79 at/in and to
1 the difference
At and in are generally used for position (see 80); to is used for movement or direction. Compare:
- He works at the market. He gets to the market by bike.
- My father lives in Canada.
I go to Canada to see him whenever I can.
2 expressions of purpose
If we mention the purpose of a movement before we mention the destination, we usually use at/in before
the place. Compare:
- Let's go to Marcel's for coffee.
Let's go and have coffee at Marcel's.
(NOT Let's go and have coffee to Marcel's.)
- I went to Canada to see my father. I went to see my father in Canada.
(NOT I went to sec my father to Canada.)
3 targets
After some verbs, at is used to indicate the 'target' of a perception or nonverbal communication. Common
examples are look, smile, wave, frown, point.
Why are you looking at her like that?
Because she smiled at me. >
page 77


w, uii emu ui ipiaceJ aw
At is also used after some verbs referring to attacks or aggressive behaviour.
Common examples are shoot, laugh, throw and shout. It's a strange feeling to have somebody shoot at
you. If you can't laugh at yourself, who can you laugh at? Stop throwing stones at the cat, darling. You
don't need to shout at me.
Throw to and shout to are used when there is no idea of attack. Please do not throw food to the animals.
Could you shout to Phil and tell him it's breakfast time?
Arrive is generally followed by at or in; never by to.
We should arrive at Pat's in time for lunch. (NOT .. .arrive to Pat's...) When did you arrive in New Zealand?
(NOT ... to New Zealand?}
For in and into, see 269.
80 at, on and in (place)
1 at
At is used to talk about position at a point. It's very hot at the centre of the earth. Turn right at the next
comer.
Sometimes we use at with a larger place, if we just think of this as a point: a "stage on a journey or a
meeting place, for example. Compare:
- The plane stops for an hour at Frankfurt, (a point on a journey) She lives in Frankfurt, (somebody's
home)
- Let's meet at the club. (a meeting point)
It was warm and comfortable in the club. (a place to spend time) We very often use at before the name of
a building, when we are thinking not of the building itself but of the activity that happens there.
There's a good film at the cinema in Market Street.
Eat at the Steak House - best food in town.
Sorry I didn't phone last night-I was at the theatre.
At is particularly common with proper names used for buildings or organisations. Compare:
- 1firstmetyourfather at/in Harrods. I first met your father in a shop.
- She works at Legal and General Insurance.
She works in a big insurance company. At is used to say where people study. ' • He's at the London
School of Economics.
And at is used before the name of a city to refer to that city's university. Compare:
He's a student at Oxford. He lives in Cambridge.
At is also used before the names of group activities. at a party at a meeting at a concert at a lecture at the
match
page 78
at; on and in (place) 80
2 on
On is used to talk about position on a line (for example a road or a river).
His house is on the way from Aberdeen to Dundee.
Stratford is on the river Avon.
But in is used to talk about the position of things which actually form part of the line.
There's a misprint in line 6 on page 22.
Who's the good- looking boy in the sixth row? On is used for position on a surface.
Hurry up - supper's on the table!
That picture would look better on the other wall.
There's a big spider on the ceiling. On can mean 'attached to'.
Why do you wear that ring on your first finger?
There aren 't many apples on the tree this year. On is also used for position by a lake or sea.
Bowness is on Lake Windermere. Southend-on-Sea
3 in
In is used for position inside large areas, and in three-dimensional space (when something is surrounded
on all sides).
She grew up in Swaziland.
I don't think he's in his office.
He lived in the desert for three years.
Let's go for a walk in the woods.
I last saw her in the car park.
4 public transport
We use on (and off) to talk about travel using buses, planes arid trains, as
well as (motor) cycles and horses.
He's arrivingon the3.15 train. (NOT ... in/with the 3.15 train.)
We're booked on flight 604.
There's no room on the bus; let's get off again.
It took five days to cross the Atlantic on the Queen Elizabeth.
But we use in and out (of) to talk about private cars, planes and boats. Jump in and I'll drive you to the
station. He fell into the river when he was getting out of his canoe.
5 addresses
We generally use at to talk about addresses.
Are you still at the same address?
She lives at 73 Albert Street. We use in (US ore) if we just give the name of the street.
She lives in Albert Street. We use ore for the number of the floor.
She lives in aflat on the third floor. At can be used with a possessive to mean 'at somebody's house or
shop'.
'Where's Jane?' 'She's round at Pat's.'
You 're always at the hairdresser's. >
page 79


ai, on ana in ^imeJ 01
6 special expressions
Note these expressions:
in/at church at home/work
at school/college
,In sc/zoo//co//ege (American English)
in a picture in the sky in the rain in a tent in a hat
The map is on page 32. (BUT 1opened thebook atpage 32.)
in bed/(the) hospital/prison
on a farm working on the railway
Note that at is usually pronounced /at/,not /set/ (see588). For the difference between at/in and to, see 79.
For smile at etc, shoot at etc and arrive at, see 79.3. For other uses of at, on and in, see a good dictionary.
1 at, on and in (time)
at + clock time
in+ part of day
ore + particular day
at + weekend, public holiday
in + longer period
1 clock times: at
I usually get up at six o'clock. I'll meet you at 4.15. Phone me at lunch time.
At is usually left out before what time in an informal style (see paragraph 7). What time does your train
leave?
\ parts of the day: in
I work best in the morning. three o'clock in the afternoon We usually go out in the evening.
Note the difference between in the night (= during one particular night) and at night (= during any night).
Compare:
/ had to get up in the night.
I often work at night.
In an informal style, plurals without a preposition can be used to refer to repeated activity.
Would you rather work nights or days?
We use on if we say which morning / afternoon / etc we are talking about, or if we describe the
morning/afternoon/etc.
See you on Monday morning. We met on a cold afternoon in early spring.
page 80
at, on and in (time) 81
3 days: on
I'll ring you on Tuesday.
My birthday's on March 21st.
They're having a party on Christmas Day. In an informal style we sometimes leave out on. This is
especially common in American English.
I'm seeing her Sunday morning.
Note the use of plurals (Sundays, Mondays etc) when we talk about repeated actions.
We usually go and see Granny on Sundays.
4 public holidays and weekends: at
We use at to talk about the whole of the holidays at Christmas, New Year, Easter and Thanksgiving (US).
We're having the roof repaired at Easter. But we use on to talk about one day of the holiday.
Come and see us on Christmas Day.
What are you doing on Easter Monday? British people say at the weekend; Americans use on.
What did you do at the weekend? \
5 longer periods: in
It happened in the week after Christmas.
I was bom in March.
Our house was built in the 15th century.
Kent is beautiful in spring.
He died in 1616.
6 other uses of in
In can also be used to say how soon something will happen, and to say how long something takes to
happen.
Ask me again in three or four days.
I can run 200 metres in about 30 seconds. The expression in... 's time is used to say how soon something
will happen, not how long something takes. Compare:
I'll see you again in a month's time. It'll be ready inthree weeks' time.
He wrote the book in a month. (NOT ... in a month's time.) In American English, in can be used, like for, to
talk about periods up to the present (British English only/or).
I haven't seen her in years.
7 expressions with no preposition
At/on/in are not normally used in expressions of time before next, last, this, that (sometimes), one, any (in
an informal style), each, every, some, all.
See you next week. Come any time.
Are you free this morning? I'm at home every evening.
I didn 'tfeel very well that week. We stayed all day.
Let's meet one day. >
paee 81


ai (in of
These prepositions are not normally used, either, before yesterday, the day before yesterday, tomorrow or
the day after tomorrow.
What are you doing the day after tomorrow? And prepositions are usually dropped in questions beginning
What/Which + expression of time, and in answers which only contain an expression of time.
What day is the meeting?
Which week did you say you're on holiday?
What time are you leaving?' 'Eight o'clock.'
Note that at is usually pronounced /at/, not /aet/ (see 588). For the difference between in and during, see
172.
at all
at all with a negative
We often use at all to emphasise a negative idea.
/ didn 't understand anything at all. (= / didn't understand even a little.) She was hardly frightened at all.
questions etc ,
At all can also be used in questions, and with 'non-assertive' words like if, hardly, ever and any. '
Do you play poker at all? (=... even a little?)
He'll come before supper if he comes at all. I hardly know her at all.
You can come whenever you like - any time at all.
'Not at all'
The expression Not at all is used (especially in British English) as a rather formal answer to Thankyou -
see 520.19.
at first and first
We use at first to talk about the beginning of a situation, when we are making a contrast with what
happens / happened later. At first... is often followed by but.
At first they were very happy, but then things started going wrong. The work was hard at first, but I got
used to it. In other cases, we usually prefer first.
That's mine-Isaw it first! (NOT ... 1saw it atfirst.) We lived there when we were first married. {=... in the
early days of our
marriage.) (NOT .. .-when we wore at first married.) I first met her at a party in Oxford. (=... for the first
time...) First, I want to talk about the history of the problem; then I'll outline the
situation today; and then we'll discuss possible solutions.
(NOT At first, I want to talk...) Note that at last is not the opposite of at first - see 210.
foifirst(ly) as a discourse marker, see also 159.10. For information about other uses of first, see a good
dictionary.
page 82
"""T auxiliary verns ov
84 auxiliary verbs
1 the need for auxiliary verbs
In English sentences, a lot of important meanings are expressed by the form of the verb phrase - for
example questioning, negation, time, completion, continuation, repetition, willingness, possibility,
obligation. But English verbs do not have many different forms: the maximum (except for be) is five (e.g.
see, sees, seeing, saw, seen). So to express all these meanings, a number of 'auxiliary' (or 'helping')
verbs are added to other verbs. There are two groups.
2 be, do and have
Be is added to other verbs to make progressive and passive forms.
Is it raining?
She was imprisoned for three years.
Do is used to make questions, negatives and emphatic forms of non-auxiliary verbs.
Do you smoke?
It didn't matter.
Do come in. Have is used to make perfect forms.
What have you done?
I realised that I hadn 't turned the lights off. See the Index for details of entries on these forms and their
uses, and on non-auxiliary uses of foe, do and have.
3 modal auxiliary verbs
The verbs will, shall, would, should, can, could, may, might, must and ought are usually called'modal
auxiliary verbs'. They are used with other verbs to add various meanings, mostly to do with degrees of
certainty or obligation. For details, see 344-345 and the entries for each verb.
4 other verbs
Other verbs (e.g. seem) which are used in verb + verb structures are not usually called 'auxiliary verbs'.
One important difference is grammatical. In auxiliary verb structures, questions are made by simply
changing the order of the auxiliary verb and the subject, while in other verb + verb structures the auxiliary
do has to be added to the first verb. Negatives are also constructed differently. Compare:
- She ought to understand. Ought she to understand?
- She seems to understand. Does she seem to understand?
- He is swimming. He is not swimming
- He likes swimming.
He doesn't like swimming.
page 83


85 (a)wake and (a)waken
1 forms
The verbs awake and wake are irregular in British English, but can be regular in American English.
(a)wake - (a)woke - (a)woken GB/US (a)wake - (a)waked - (a)waked US (A)waken is regular.
(a) waken - (a)wakened - (a) wakened
2 use
Wake is the most common of these four verbs. It can mean 'stop sleeping'or 'make (somebody else) stop
sleeping'. It is often followed by up, especially when it means stop sleeping.
I woke up three times in the night.
Could you wake me (up) at half past six? Waken is a more literary alternative to wake (up).
The princess did not waken for a hundred years.
Then the prince wakened her with a kiss. Awake and awaken are also rather literary words. They can be
used to mean 'wake (up)', but are more often used figuratively, to talk not about waking from sleep, but
about the waking of emotions, understanding etc.
I slowly awoke to the danger that threatened me.
At first I paid little attention, but slowly my interest awoke.
The smell of her perfume awakened the gipsy's desire.
awake and asleep (adjectives)
Note that in informal British English the adjective awake is more common (in predicative position) than the
verb form waking; and asleep is more common than sleeping.
Is the baby awake yet? You were asleep at ten o 'clock.
f 01 arouse and rouse, see 61.
back and again
Back and again can be used with similar meanings, but there are some differences.
back with a verb
Back is an adverb particle (see 19). With a verb, we use back to suggest a return to an earlier situation, a
movement in the opposite direction to an
earlier movement, and similar ideas. Again is not normally used in this way with a verb.
Give me my watch back. (NOT Give me my watch again.] I'm taking this meat back to the shop.
(NOT I'm taking this meat to the shop again.)
3
page 84
2 ogawwithaverb
With a verb, again usually suggests repetition. Compare:
- That was lovely. Can you play it again? When I've recorded your voice I'll play it back.
- Eric was really bad-mannered. I'm never going to invite him again. She comes to our parties but she
never invites us back.
- I don't think he got your letter. You'd better write again. If I write to you, will you write back?
Note the difference between sell back (to the same person) and Sell again. The bike you sold me is too
small. Can I sell it back to you? If we buy this house and then have to move somewhere else, how easy
will it be to sell it again?
3 cases when back is not used
When the verb itself already expresses the idea of 'return to an earlier situation' or 'movement in the
opposite direction', back is not used, but, again can be used to emphasise the idea of 'return'. Stefan can
never return to his country (again).
(NOT Stefan can never return back...) Who opened the window? Could you close it (again), please? (NOT
... close it back...)
4 adverb particles etc
With adverb particles and prepositional phrases, we can use both back and again to suggest 'return to an
earlier situation' etc.
I stood up, and then I sat (back) down (again).
He tasted the apple and spat it (back) out (again).
Go (back) to sleep (again).
I'll be (back) in the office (again) on Monday.
5 ring/callback
Note that ring back (GB only) and call back can be used to mean both 'return
a phone call' and 'repeat a phone call'.
'She's not here just now.' 'Ask her to ring me back.' (= return my call) 'I haven't got time to talk now.' 'OK,
I'll ring back later.' (= ring again)
6 word order
Back, as an adverb particle, can usually go between a verb and its object,
unless this is a pronoun (see 582.3). Again cannot.
Take back your money-I don't want it. (OR Take your money back...) Count the money again, please.
(NOT Count again the money...)
For other uses of back and again, see a good dictionary.
page 85


bath and bathe
1 bath
Pronunciation: bath /ba:Q/
bathing /'ba:ein/ bathed /ba:9t/
The verb bath is used (in British English) to mean 'wash oneself in a bath (tub)'.
Children have to be made to bath regularly. The verb is rather formal, and is not used is American English;
in an informal
style, we usually say have a bath (British) or take a bath (British and American).
I'm feeling hot and sticky; I think I'll take a bath. Bath can also be used with an object (in British English).
It's your turn to bath the baby. (US... to bathe the baby.}
! bathe
Pronunciation: bathe /bero/
bathing /'bei8in/
bathed /beiQd/
Bathe (in British English) can mean 'swim for pleasure'. It is rather formal in this sense (and is not used
like this in American English); in an informal style, we usually say have a swim, go for a swim, go
swimming or just swim. , Let's go for a swim in the river.
In American English, bathe is commonly used to mean 'take a bath'. I always bathe before I go to bed.
Bathe can also be used (in both British and American English) with an
object, to talk about putting water on a part of the body that hurts (for instance sore eyes).
Your eyes are very red-you ought to bathe them. To lie in the sun is to sunbathe (NOT sunbath).
be: progressive forms
ySiflm being /you are being etc + adjecty6|^|((iyEn.
We can use this structure to talk about actions and behaviour, but not usually to talk about feelings.
Compare:
T- You'rebeing stupid. (= You're doing stupid things.)
I was being very careful. (= / was doing something carefully.) Who's being a silly baby, then?
- I'm happy just now. (NOT I'm being happy just now.) I was very depressed when you phoned. (NOT
4was4wmg very depressed...)
Note the difference between He's being sick (GB = He's vomiting) and He's sick (= He's ill).
For the use of am being etc in passive verb forms, see 407.2.
page 86
DB'+mnmnve su
89 be with auxiliary do
Normally, be is used without the auxiliary do.
I'm not often sick. (NOT/ don't often bo sick.) But do is used to make negative imperative sentences with
be (when we tell somebody not to do something).
Don't be silly! Don't be such a nuisance! And do be is used to begin emphatic imperatives.
Do be careful! Do be quiet, for God's sake! In an informal style, people sometimes use do with be in one
or two other structures which have a similar meaning to imperative sentences.
Why don't you be a good boy and sit down?
If you don't be quiet you'll go straight to bed.
For other auxiliary uses of do, see 163.
• ' \
90 be + infinitive
' lam to... you are to.
1 plans and arrangements
We use this structure in a formal style to talk about plans and arrangements, especially when they are
official.
The President is to visit Nigeria next month.
We are to get a 10 per cent wage rise in June.
I felt nervous because I was soon to leave home for the first time. A perfect infinitive can be used to show
that a planned event did not happen.
I was to have started work last week, but I changed my mind.
2 'fate'
Another use is to talk about things which are/were 'hidden in the future', fated to happen.
/ thought we were saying goodbye for ever. But we were to meet again, many years later, under very
strange circumstances.
3 pre-conditions
The structure is common in (f-clauses, when the main clause expresses a pre-condition - something that
must happen first if something else is to happen.
If we are to get there by lunchtime we had better hurry. He knew he would have to work hard if he was to
pass his exam.
4 orders
We also use the structure to give orders. Parents often use it when speaking to children.
You are to do your homework before you watch TV.
She can go to the party, but she's not to be back late. ^
page 87


-uc HIM nave CT*
5 be + passive infinitive . ." s ,JJI Be + passive infinitive is often used in notices and instructions.
am/are/is (not) to be* past participKk
This cover is not to be removed. Sometimes only the passive infinitive is used.
To be taken three times a day after meals, (on a medicine bottle) Some other common expressions with
be + passive infinitive:
There's nothing to be done.
She was nowhere to be found.
I looked out of the window, but there was nothing to be seen.
6 tenses
Note that this structure exists only in present and past tenses, not present perfect or future. We cannot
say that somebody has been to go somewhere,
or will be to go somewhere. Participle structures (being to go) are no^
possible either.
For other ways of talking about the future, see 219-226.
91 be and have
1 physical conditions etc
To talk about experiencing hunger, thirst, heat, cold and certain other common physical conditions we
normally use be (or feel) + adjective, not have + noun. Note the following expressions:
"'''' be hungry (NOT haw hunger) be thirsty bewarm
be hot be cold be sleepy be afraid Note also:
be right be wrong be lucky
2 age, height, weight, size and colour
Be is also used to talk about age, height, length, weight, size, shape and colour.
I'm nearly thirty. (NOT I have nearly thirty.) She is nearly my age. He is six feet tall. ' I wish I was ten kilos
lighter. The room is ten metres long. What size are your shoes? What colour are his eyes? She is the
same height as her father. Be heavy is not usually used in measuring expressions. It weighs 37 kilos.
(NOT It's 37 kilos heavy.)
For the use of have in expressions like have a bath, have a drink, have a walk, see 240.
page 88
oeen meaning cume-TOgone «
fS'
92 beat and win
You can win (in) a game, a race, a battle, an argument etc, and you can win a prize, money etc. You can
beat a person that you are playing / arguing / fighting etc against. Compare:
My girlfriend usually wins when we play poker.
My girlfriend beat me at poker the first time we played.
(NOT My girlfriend won me at poker...) Both verbs are irregular:
beat - beat - beaten
win - won - won
93 because and because of
1 the difference
Because is a conjunction. It is used at the beginning of a clause, before a subject and verb. Because of is
a two-word preposition, used before a noun or a pronoun. Compare:
- We were late because it rained. (NOT ... because of it rained.) We were late because of the rain. (NOT
... because the rain.)
- I'm happy because I met you. I'm happy because of you.
2 position of because-clsaises
Because and its clause can go after or before the main clause.
I finished early because I worked fast.
Because I worked fast, I finished early.
Because-clauses can stand alone as answers or after hesitations, but not ^ usually in other cases.
'Why are you crying?' 'Because John and I have had a row.'
I don't think I'll go to the party after all, actually... Because I'mfeelinga
bit tired. Note that after reason we usually use that or why, not because (see 470). :
For the differences between because, as, since and/or, see 72.
94 been meaning 'come' or 'gone'
Been is often used as a past participle of come and go.
Granny has been to see us twice since Christmas.
I haven't been to the theatre for ages.
Have you ever been to Northern Ireland? Note that been is only used for completed visits. Compare:
- The postman's already been. (He has come and gone away again.) Jane's come, so we can start work.
(She has come and is still here.)
- I've been to London three times this week. 'Where's Lucy7' 'She's gone to London.'
For be gone, see 233.
page 89


oetore laavero) 95
95 before (adverb)
1 'at any time before now/ then'
We can use before to mean 'at any time before now'. In British English, a present perfect tense is normally
used.
I think I've seen this film before. Haveyou ever been herebefore? Before can also mean 'at any time
before then - before the past moment that we are talking about'. In this case a past perfect tense is used.
She realised that she had seen him before.
2 counting back from a past time
We also use before after a time expression to 'count back' from a past moment - to say how much earlier
something else had happened. A past perfect tense is normally used.
When I went back to the town that I had left eight years before, everything
was different. (NOT .. .that I had left before eight years...) -To count back from the present, we use ago,
not before (see also 31).
f ]o'f't C/'^l/t/^? ^m* ••.//-" /-- '' •
I Ie ft school four years ago. (NOT .. .four years before I bcfo
3
before, be fore that and first
Before is not generally used to mean 'before that' or 'first'.
/ want to get married one day. But before that/first, I want to travel. (NOT ... But before, I want to travel)
For the difference between before and ever, see 197-198. For before as a conjunction and preposition,
see 96-97.
96 before (conjunction)
clause + &iigg|®?+ clause
• ^ ^before + cJMieNie, + clause''
1 position of before-dsaise
The conjunction before joins one clause to another. Before and its clause can come either after or before
the other clause, depending on what is to be stressed.
- I always feed the cat before I have breakfast. Before I have breakfast, I always feed the cat.
(The meaning is similar: the speaker feeds the cat and then has breakfast. Note the comma in the second
structure.)
- He did military service before he went to university.
(He did military service first.)
Before he did military service, he went to university. (He went to university first.)
2 present tense with future meaning
In a clause with before, we use a present tense if the meaning is future (see 556).
I'll telephoneyou before I come. (NOT ... before I will come.)
page 90
3 perfect tenses
In clauses with before, we often use present perfect and past perfect tenses to emphasise the idea of
completion.
You can't go home before I've signed the letters.
(= ... before the moment when I have completed the letters.) He went out before I had finished my
sentence.
(=... before the moment when I had completed my sentence.) (Note that in sentences like the last, a past
perfect tense can refer to a time later than the action of the main verb. This is unusual: see 421.)
4 before.. .ing
In a formal style, we often use the structure before.. .ing. Please put out all lights before leaving the office.
Before beginning the book, she spent five years on research.
For the use of before as an adverb, see 95. For the use of before as a preposition, see 97.
97 before (preposition) and in front of
before: time in front of: place
Compare:
I must move my car before nine o'clock.
It's parked in front of the post office. (NOT .. .before the post-effiee:)
Before is normally used to refer to time, but it can refer to place in a
few cases:
a to talk about the order in which people or things come in queues, lists,
written documents etc
Do you mind? I was before/in front of you!
Her name comes before mine in the alphabet.
We use 'a' before a consonant and 'an' before a vowel.
b to mean 'in the presence of (somebody important)'
I came up before the magistrates for dangerous driving last week.
c in the expressions right before one's eyes, before one's very eyes.
For the difference between in front ofandfacingi opposite, see 272. For the use of before as a conjunction,
see 96. For the use of before as an adverb, see 95. For by meaning 'at/on or before', see 118.
page 91

begin and start 98
98 begin and start
1 formality
There is usually little or no difference between begin and start.
I began/started teaching when I was 24.
IfSheila doesn 't come soon, let's begin/start without her. We generally prefer begin when we are using a
more formal style. Compare:
We will begin the meeting with a message from the President.
Oh no! It's starting to rain.
2 cases where begin is not possible .;
Start (but not begin) is used to mean:
a 'start a journey'
/ think we ought to start at six, while the roads are empty.
b 'start working' (for machines) The car won't start.
c 'make (machines) start'
How do you start the washing machine?
For infinitives and -ing forms after begin and start, see 296.10.
99 below and under
1 'lower than': below or under
The prepositions below and under can both mean 'lower than'. Look in the cupboard below/under the sink.
2 not directly under: below
We prefer below when one thing is not directly under another.
The climbers stopped 300m below the top of the mountain. . A moment later the sun had disappeared
below the horizon.
3 covered: under
We prefer under when something is covered or hidden by what is over it, and when things are touching.
/ think the cat's under the bed.
What are you wearing under your sweater?
The whole village is under water.
4 measurements: below
Below is used in measurements of temperature and height, and in other cases where we think of a vertical
scale.
The temperature is three degrees below zero.
Parts of Holland are below sea level.
The plane came down below the clouds.
She's well below average in intelligence. \
page 92
wvxuWf VJVL,WV. cum. a\Jai L II^JIZT
5 'less than': under
We usually use under, not below, to mean 'less than' or 'younger than'. There were under twenty people at
the lecture. You can't see this film if you're under 18.
6 underneath
Underneath is sometimes used as a preposition instead of under, but only for physical position. Compare:
There's a mouse under(neath) the piano.
He's still under 18. (NOT ... underneath 18.)
7 adverbs
Below can be used as an adverb. Under can be used as an adverb particle
(see 19) with some verbs, but in other cases we prefer underneath for
adverbial use.
We looked over the cliff at the waves crashing on the rocks below. A lot of businesses are going under
because of the economic crisis. I can't take my sweater off'-1 haven't got anything on underneath.
In a book or a paper, see below means 'look at something written later'.
The difference between above and over is similar to the difference between below and under. See 6 for
details.
100 beside and besides
Beside is a preposition meaning 'at the side of, "by', 'next to'.
Who's the big guy sitting beside Jane?
Besides can be used as a preposition with a similar meaning to as well as (see 77), to add new
information to what is already known. Besides literature, we have to study history and philosophy. Who
was at the party besides Jack and the Bensons? Besides can also be used as a discourse marker (see
159.11) meaning 'also', 'as well', 'in any case'. It is often used to add a stronger, more conclusive
argument to what has gone before. In this case, besides usually goes at the beginning of a clause.
/ don't like those shoes; besides, they're too expensive. It's too late to go out now. Besides, it's starting to
rain.
For the difference between besides, except and apart from, see 101.
101 besides, except and apart from
These expressions are sometimes confused. Besides usually adds: it is like saying with, or plus (+).
Besides the violin, he plays the piano and the flute.
(He plays three instruments.) Except subtracts: it is like saying without, or minus (-).
I like all musical instruments except the violin.
page 93


Apart from can be used in both senses.
Apart from the violin, he plays the piano and the flute.
(= Besides the violin...) I like all musical instruments apart from the violin.
(= .. .except the violin.)
After no, nobody, nothing and similar negative words, the three expressions can all have the same
meaning.
He has nothingbesides /except/apartfrom hissalary.
(= He only has his salary.)
For the use of besides as an adverbial discourse marker, see 159.11.
for beside, see 100.
For except and except for, see 200.
For nothing but, see 116.
102 bet
1 use
/ bet (you) can be used in an informal style to mean 'I think it's probable that'. That is usually dropped. I
bet (you) she's not at home.
(More natural than / bet (you) that she's not at home.)
2 tenses
After / bet (you), we often use a present tense to refer to the future. s I bet (you) they don't come this
evening, (on I bet (you) they won't come...) I bet (you) the Conservatives (will) lose.
3 two objects
When bet is used to talk about real bets, it can be followed by two objects: the person with whom the bet
is made, and the money or thing that is bet.
/ bet you L5 it doesn 't rain this week.
My father bet my mother dinner at the Ritz that she would marry him. He won, but she never bought him
the dinner.
103 better
1 'recovered'
When better means 'recovered from an illness', it can be used with completely or quite (unlike other
comparative adjectives). Don't start work again until you're quite better.
2 correcting mistakes
We do not normally use better to correct mistakes.
She's gone to Hungary - or rather, Poland. (NOT... or better, Poland.)
For the structure had better, see 234.
page 94

104
between and among
1 the difference
We say that somebody or something is between two or more clearly separate people or things. We use
among when somebody or something is in a group, a crowd or a mass of people or things which we do
not see separately. Compare:
- She was standing between Alice and Mary. She was standing among a crowd of children.
- Our house is between the woods, the river and the village.
His house is hidden among the trees. Between can be used to talk about intervals and time limits.
We need two metres between the windows.
I'll be at the office between nine and eleven.
2 things on two sides: between
We use between to say that there are things (or groups of things) on two sides. a little valley between high
mountains I saw something between the wheels of the car.
3 divide and share
Before a series of singular nouns we usually use divide between and share between. Before a plural noun,
we can say between or among. Compare:
He divided his money between his wife, his daughter and his sister.
I shared the food between/among all my friends.
4 difference between
We use between, not among, after difference.
What are the main differences between crows, rooks and jackdaws?
5 'one of'etc
Among can mean 'one of, 'some of or 'included in'. Among the first to arrive was the ambassador. He has
a number of criminals among his friends.
6 between each
Some people feel that expressions like between each window or between each birthday are incorrect.
They prefer between each... and the next. We need two metres between each window (and the next).
There seems to be less and less time between each birthday (and the next).
105 big, large and great
1 concrete nouns: big and large
Big and large are used mostly with concrete nouns- the names of things you can see, touch etc. Big is
most common in an informal style.
Get your big feet off my flowers.
I'm afraid my daughter has rather large feet.
It was a large house, situated near the river. ^ page 95


3
2 abstract nouns: great
Great is used mostly with abstract nouns - things you cannot see, touch etc. You are making a great
mistake.
Her work showed a great improvement last year. I have great respect for her ideas.
big with countable abstract nouns
Big can be used with countable abstract nouns in an informal style. Large is not normally used with
abstract nouns.
You 're making a big mistake. (NOT... a large mistake.) Bigis not used with uncountable abstract nouns
(except in a few fixed expressions like big business, big trouble).
His work shows great intelligence. (NOT ... big intelligence.)
uncountable concrete nouns
With uncountable concrete nouns, none of these three words is usual. You 've mt a. Int nflnaafiml tw r^ T
4
5
6
t4uggage!)
You've got a lot of luggage! (NOT ... big/large/gr other uses of great
We also use great to mean 'famous' or 'important'.
Doyou think Napoleon was really a great man? And in an informal style, great can mean 'wonderful'.
I've just got a great new job.
Great is used in some informal expressions to emphasise the idea ofsize. He's justa greatbig baby.
large and wide
Large is a 'false friend' for speakers of some languages. It does not mean 'wide'. The river is 100 metres
wide. (NOT ... 100 metres large.)
For tall and high, see 249. For broad and wide, see 115. For small and little, see 511.
106 a bit
1 use
A bit is often used as an adverb with the same meaning as a little, especially in informal British English.
She's a bit old to play with dolls, isn 't she? < > Can you drive a bit slower? Wait a bit.
Note that when a bit and a little are used with non-comparative adjectives, the meaning is usually negative
or critical. a bit tired a bit expensive a little (too) old (BUT NOT a bit kind, a little interesting)
page 96
2 abitofa
A bit of a can be used before some nouns in an informal style. The meaning is similar to rather a (see
468).
He's a bit of a fool, if you ask me. I've got a bit of a problem.
3 notabit
The informal expression not a bit means 'not at all'. ";. ,
I'm notabit tired.
'Doyou mind if I put some music on?' 'Notabit.' Note that notabit is not the same as the rather rare literary
expression not a little (= 'quite').
For a bit and other modifiers with comparative adjectives and adverbs, see 139.
For a little and little, see 322.
107 born and borne
1 be bom
To talk about coming into the world at birth, we usually use the passive verb to be bom.
Hundreds of children are born deaf every year. To give somebody's place or date of birth, we use the
simple past tense was/were born.
I was born in 1936. (NOT lam bom in 1936.)
My parents were bom in Scotland.
2 the verb bear
There is also a verb bear (bore, borne). This verb is most often used in the expression can'tbear (= 'hate',
'can't stand').
I can't bear her voice.
In a very formal style, bear can be used with other meanings, including 'carry'and'give birth to'.
They bore the king's body away on a stretcher.
She has borne six children in seven years. (More normal: She has had six children...)
For more details of the verb bear, see a good dictionary.
108 borrow and lend
E"' wrawsomethmgfnmisomsS'c^ nd somethingto somebody nd somebody something
Borrow is like take.
Can I borrow your bicycle? (NOT Can I lend your bicycle?) You borrow something^rom somebody.
I borrowed a pound from my brother.
(NOT I borrowed my brother a pound.) ^
page 97


Lend (US also loan) is like give. You lend something to somebody, or lend somebody something.
I lent my coat to Steve, and I never saw it again.
Lend me your comb for a minute, will you? (NOT Borrow me your...]
For lend in passive structures, see 410.
both (of) with nouns and pronouns
nouns with determiners: both (of)
Before a noun with a determiner (e.g. the, my, these), both and both o/are both possible. In American
English, both of is usual.
She's eaten both (of) the chops.
Both (of) my parents like riding.
Both (of) these oranges are bad. We often drop the or a possessive after both.
She's eaten both chops.
He lost both parents when he was a child.
personal pronouns: both of
With personal pronouns, we use both o/(foUowed by the object form of the pronoun). Both ofus/you/them
can be the subject or object of a clause.
Both of them can come tomorrow.
She's invited both of us.
Mary sends both of you her love. We can put both after pronouns used as objects.
She's invited us both.
Mary sends you both her love.
But this structure is not used with complement pronouns or in short answers.
'Who broke the window - Sarah or Alice?' 'It was both of them.' (NOT ... them both.)
'Who did you invite?' 'Both of them.' (NOT 'Them both.') When both is used after a subject pronoun (e.g.
They both wanted to many him) it goes in mid-position (see 22), and follows an auxiliary.
They have both been invited.
the not used before both
Note that we do not put the before both.
both (the) children (NOT -the-beth children)
negative structures
Instead ofboth... not, we normally use neither (see 363). Neither of them is here. (NOT Both of them are
not hero.)
For the use of both with verbs, see 110.
page 98
-'•-- * lynng cum taKC MWI
110 both with verbs
When both refers to the subject of a clause, it can go with the verb, in 'mid-position' (like all and some
adverbs - see 36, 22.3).
auxiliary verb + botfly are/were + both ^w
We can both swim. The children have both gone to bed. Those oranges were both bad.
both + other verb
My parents both work in education. They both liked the flowers. Note that these meanings can also be
expressed by using both (of) + noun/pronoun as the subject (see 109).
Both of us can swim. Both of the children have gone to bed.
111 both... and
],both + adjective + and + adjective ^SJoth + noun + and + noun
|:etc
People usually 'balance' this structure, so that the same kind of words or
expressions follow both and and.
She's both pretty and clever, (adjectives)
Ispoke to both the Director and her secretary, (nouns)
She both dances and sings, (verbs)
The following sentences, which are not 'balanced' in this way, are possible in
standard English. However, many people would feel that the style.was bad:
She both dances and she sings, (both + verb; and + clause)
She both plays the piano and the violin, (both + verb + noun; and + noun)
I both spoke to the Director and her secretary.
See also either... or (179), neither... nor (365) and not only... but also (376).
112 bring and take
1 speaker's/hearer's position
In British English, we use bring for movements to the place where the speaker or hearer is, but we use
take for movements to other places. Compare:
- This is a nice restaurant. Thanks for bringing me here.
(NOT ... thanks for taking me here.) Let's have another drink, and then I'll take you home. (NOT ... and
then I'll bring you homo.)
- (on the phone) Can we come and see you next weekend? We'll bring
a picnic. Let's go and see the Robinsons next weekend. We can take a picnic. >
page 99


bring up anu euui-aic «
speaker's/hearer's past or future position
We can also use bring for a movement to a place where the speaker or hearer already was or will be.
Compare:
- I'll be arriving at the hotel about six o'clock. Can you bring the car round at
six-thirty?
Can you take the car to the garage tomorrow? I won't have time. (NOT Can you bring the car to the
garage tomorrow?...)
- Wiere's that report?' 'I brought it to you when you were in Mr Alien's office.
Don'tyou remember?' I took the papers to John's office.
Note that these rules are not always followed in American English. The difference between come and go
is similar. See 134. For other uses of take, see 550 - 551.
bring up and educate
Bring up and the noun upbringing are mostly used for the moral and social training that children receive at
home. Educate and education are used for the intellectual and cultural training that people get at school
and university. Lucy was brought up by her grandparents and educated at the local
secondary school. Their kids are very badly brought up - always screaming and fighting.
(NOT Their kids arc very badly educated...)
Would you rather have a good upbringing and a bad education, or the opposite?
Britain, the United Kingdom, the British Isles and England
Britain (or Great Britain} and the United Kingdom (or the UK) are both used to include England, Scotland,
Wales and Northern Ireland. (Sometimes Britain or Great Britain is used just for the island which includes
England, Scotland and Wales, without Northern Ireland. Irish people generally use the words Britain and
British in this way.)
The British Isles is the name for England, Scotland, Wales, the whole of Ireland (which includes both
Northern Ireland and the Republic of Ireland, also called 'Eire'), and the smaller islands round about.
England is only one part of Britain. Scotland and Wales are not in England, and Scottish and Welsh
people do not like to be called 'English'.
A very informal word for a British person is Brit. Britisher is used only by non-British people; Briton is
hardly used except in news reports and newspaper headlines (e.g. THREE BRITONS DIE IN AIR
CRASH), and to refer to the ancient inhabitants of Britain.
page 100
um. CAl^cpl AJ.O
115
broad and wide
Wide is used for the physical distance from one side of something to the other.
We live in a very wide street. The car's too wide for the garage. Broad is used in this physical sense in a
few common expressions like broad shoulders, and in descriptions of landscape in a formal style.
Across the broad valley, the mountains rose blue and mysterious. But broad is mostly used in abstract
expressions. Some examples:
broad agreement (= agreement on most important points)
broad-minded (= tolerant) broad daylight (= full, bright daylight)
116 but ='except'
1 use
We use but to mean 'except' after all, none, every, any, no (and everything, everybody, nothing, nobody,
anywhere etc).
He eats nothing but hamburgers. I've finished all the jobs but one.
Everybody's here but George. She's done nothing but cry all day. Note the expressions next but one, last
but two etc (GB).
Jackie lives next door but one. (= two houses from me)
I was last but two in the race yesterday. The expression but for expresses the idea of 'if something had not
existed / happened'.
/ would have been in real trouble but for your help.
But for the storm, I would have been home before eight. Note also the structure Who should... but (used to
talk about surprising appearances, meetings etc).
I was just coming out of the supermarket, when who should I see but -old Beryl?
2 pronouns after but
After but, we usually use object pronouns (me, him etc). Subject pronouns . (/, he etc) are possible in a
more formal style.
Nobody but her would do a thing like that. (More formal: Nobody but she...)
3 verbs after but
The verb form after but usually depends on what came before. Infinitives are normally without to.
That child does nothing but watch TV. (does... watch) She's not interested in anything but skiing,
(interested in... skiing) Cannot but + infinitive or cannot help but + infinitive is sometimes used with the
meaning of 'can't help ... ing' (see 126). Cannot but... is very formal;
can't help but... is especially common in American English.
One cannot (help) but admire his courage. (= One has to admire...) I can't help but wonder what's going to
happen to us all. ^
page 101


4 few? meaning'only'
In older English, but was used to mean 'only', but this is now very unusual. She is but a child.
Note: but is usually pronounced /bat/, not /bAt/ (see 588).
For except, see 200.
For but as a conjunction and ellipsis after but, see 182.
117 by (method, agent) and with (tools etc)
1 the difference
By and with can both be used to say how somebody does something, but there is an important difference.
We use by when we talk about an action - what we do to get a result. We use
with when we talk about a tool or other object - what we use to get a result.
Compare:
I killed the spider by hitting it. (Note the -ing form after by.) I killed the spider with a shoe. (NOT ... by a
shoo.) 'I got where I am by hard work.' 'No you didn't. You got there with your wife's money.'
Note that without is used as the opposite of both with and by in these cases.
Compare:
- I got her to listen by shouting.
It's difficult to get her to listen without shouting.
- We'll have to get it out with a screwdriver.
We can't get it out without a screwdriver. By is also used to refer to means of transport (by bus, by train
etc). See 69.1.
2
118
passive clauses
In passive clauses, by introduces the agent - the person or thing that does the action (see 408).
/ was interviewed by three directors.
My car was damaged by a falling branch. We generally prefer with to refer to a tool or instrument used by
somebody. Compare:
He was killed by a heavy stone.
(This could mean 'A stone fell and killed him'.)
He was killed with a heavy stone.
(This means 'Somebody used a stone to kill him'.)
by: time
By can mean 'not later than'.
I'll be home by five o'clock. (= at or before five)
'Can I borrow your car?' 'Yes, butlmusthave it back by tonight.' (= tonight or before) :
By can also suggest the idea of 'progress up to a particular time'.
By the end of the meal, everybody was drunk.
page 102
By the time (that) is used with a verb, to mean 'not later than the moment that something happens'.
I'll be in bed by the time you get home.
By the time that the guards realised what was happening, the gang were
already inside the bank.
For the difference between by and until, see 575.6.
119 by and near
By means 'just at the side of; something that is by you may be closer than something that is near you.
Compare:
We live near the sea. (perhaps five kilometres away)
We live by the sea. (We can see it.)
For on the sea (meaning 'by the sea'), see 80.2.
120 call
Call (with no object) can mean 'telephone'; in British English it can also mean 'visit'. This sometimes
causes confusion.
'Alice called whileyou were out.' 'You mean she came round or she phoned?'
For other meanings of call, see a good dictionary.
121 can and could (I): introduction
1 grammar
Can and could are modal auxiliary verbs (see 344-345).
a There is no -s in the third person singular..
She can swim very well. (NOT She cans...)
b Questions and negatives are made without do. Canyouswim? (NOT Do you can swim?) I couldn't
understand her. (NOT I didn't could...)
c After can and could, we use the infinitive without to of other verbs.
I can speak a little Arabic. (NOT I can to speak...) Progressive, perfect and passive infinitives are also
possible (see 276). Do you think she can still be working? It's very late. You could have let me know you
were going out tonight. This sweater can't be washed in the machine.
d Can and could have no infinitives or participles (to can, canning, I have
could do not exist). When necessary, we use other words, for example forms
of be able (see 3) or be allowed (see 40).
I'd like to be able to stay here. (NOT.. . to can stay...)
You'll be able to walk soon. (NOT You'll can...)
I've always been able to playgames well. (NOT I've always could...)
She's always been allowed to do what she liked. >
page 103


^Clll ailU L-UU1U ^L-/.1
e Could is sometimes used as the past of can. However, it can also be used as a less definite or
conditional form of can, referring to the present or future. For details, see 122.5,123.2 and 124.1,3.
f Certain past ideas can be expressed by can or could followed by a perfect infinitive (have + past
participle). For details, see 122.8,123.6 and 124.6. I don't know where she can have gone. That was
dangerous - he could have killed somebody.
g Can has two pronunciations: a 'strong' form /kaen/ and a 'weak' form /k(a)n/. Could has a strong form
/kud/ and a weak form /k(a)d/. The weak pronunciation is used in most cases. For more details of strong
and weak pronunciations, see 588.
h Contracted negative forms (see 144) are can't (pronounced /kaint/ in standard British English and
/kaent/ in standard American English) and couldn't (/'kudnt/). Cannot is usually written as one word.
2 meanings
Can and could are both used to talk about ability and possibility, to ask for and give permission, and to
make requests and offers. And they can be used in a special way with see, hear and some other verbs to
give a kind of 'present progressive' meaning.
Can you speak French? (ability)
It could rain this afternoon, (possibility)
Do you think she could be lying? (possibility)
You can stop work early today, (permission)
Could I have some more tea? (request)
Can I help you? (offer) ;
lean hear the sea. ('present progressive' meaning)
For more detaUs of this and other uses of can and could, see the following sections.
\2 can and could (2): ability
1 present
We use can to talk about present or 'general* ability.
Look! I can do it!
lean read Italian, but I can't speak it. Be able can often be used with similar meanings - see 3.
2 future
We normally use will be able to talk about future ability. I'll be able to speak good French in a few months.-
One day people ivill be able to go to the moon on holiday. , However, we use can if we are deciding now
about the future. / haven't got time today, but I can see you tomorrow. Can you come to a party on
Saturday?
page 104
can ann couia w. aouiiy te,L.
3 past
We use could for 'general ability' - to say that somebody could do something at any time, whenever he/she
wanted. (Was/were able is also possible.) She could read when she was four. (OR She was able to
read...) My father could speak ten languages.
We do not normally use could to say that somebody managed to do something on one occasion. Instead,
we use was/were able, managed or succeeded (in.. .ing).
How many eggs wereyou able to get? (NOT ... couldyou get?) I managed to find a really nice dress in the
sale. (NOT I could find...) After six hours' climbing, we succeeded in getting to the top of the mountain.
(NOT ... we could get to the top ...)
4 could used for particular occasions in the past
In certain cases, it is possible to use could to say that somebody was able to do something on one
occasion. This happens with see, hear, taste, feel, smell, understand, remember and guess (see 125).
/ could smell burning.
I could understand everything she said. It also happens in some subordinate clauses.
I'm so glad that you could come.
In negative clauses, and with negative or limiting adverbs like only and i^ s hardly, we also use could to
refer to one occasion.
I managed to find the street, but I couldn't find her house.
I could only get six eggs.
She could hardly believe her eyes.
5 conditional
We can use could to mean 'would be able'.
You could get a better job if you spoke a foreign language. This structure can be used to criticise people
for not doing things.
You could ask me before you borrow my car. For the use of might in this sense, see 336.
6 reported speech
Could is used in past reported speech constructions, when can was used in direct speech.
'Can you phone me this evening?' 'What did you say?' 'I asked if you could phone me this evening.'
7 passive structures
Note the use of can with a passive infinitive. (Be able is not normally used in passive structures.)
This game can be played by two or more players. (NOT .. .4s-able-to be played...)
Gold can be found in the Welsh mountains. >
page 105


8 could have...
We use a special structure to talk about unrealised past ability- to say that somebody was able to do
something, but did not try to do it.
could have + past participle
I could have married anybody I wanted to.
I was so angry I could have killed her! This structure can be used to criticise people for not doing things.
You could have helped me - why did you just sit and watch ? The meaning can also be conditional (=
'would have been able').
/ could have won the race if I hadn 'tfallen. Negative sentences suggest that somebody would not have
been able to do something even if they had wanted or tried to.
I couldn 't have won, so I didn 't go in for the race.
I couldn't have enjoyed myself more - it was a perfect day.
8 speak, play
We often leave out can when we are talking about the ability to speak languages or to play instruments or
games.
She speaks Greek. I She can speak Greek. Do/Can you play the piano?
\3 can and could (3): possibility and probability
Can is used mostly to talk about 'theoretical' or 'general' possibility, not about the chances that something
will actually happen or is actually true at this moment (this meaning is usually expressed by may, might or
could).
1 theoretical or general possibility
We use can to say whether situations and events are possible theoretically, in general. '
Anybody who wants to conjoin the club. Can gases freeze? I don't think the car can be repaired. We use
could to talk about past possibility.
It was a place where anything could happen. We predict future possibilities with will be possible or will be
able. One day, it will be possible to travel to the stars.
(OR ... people will be able to travel...)
iWe often use can and could to say what is /was common or typical. Scotland can be very warm in
September. It could be quite/Tightening if you were alone in our big old house.
2 choices and opportunities
Can is often used in this way to talk about the choices that somebody has (now or in the future), or to
suggest opportunities.
There are three possibilities: we can go to the police, we can talk to a lawyer, or we can forget all about it.
'Whatshall wedo?' 'We can try asking Lucy for help.'
page 106

can ana^oulu i.37:possiumiy ana proDauiiiiy XLA
Could is also used, like can, to talk about present and future choices and opportunities, especially when
we want to make suggestions sound less definite.
'What shall we do tomorrow?' 'Well, we could go fishing.'
When you're in Spain, you could go and see Alex.
3 future probability: can not used
We do not use can to talk about future probability - the chances that something will happen. We express
this idea with may or might (see also 331).
We may/might go camping this summer. (NOT We can go...)
There may/might be a strike next week. (NOT There can be...)
/ might be given a new job soon. Could is also used in this sense - it suggests a less definite possibility.
It could rain later this evening.
War could break out any day.
Note the difference between can/could and may/might in negative sentences. Compare:
It may/might not rain tomorrow. (= Perhaps it will not rain.)
It can't/couldn't possibly rain tomorrow. (= It will certainly not rain.)
4 present ('logical') possibility
"-,; ••
We use can in questions and negative sentences, to talk about the logical possibility that something is true
or that something is happening.
'There's the doorbell. Who can it be?' 'Well, it can't be your mother. She's in
Edinburgh.'
Can is not usually possible in affirmative sentences with this meaning. Instead, we use could, may or
might.
'Where's Sarah?' 'She could/may/might be at Joe's place.'
(NOT She can be...)
But can is possible in affirmative sentences with words like only, hardly or never, which have a limiting or
negative meaning.
'Who's that at the door?' 'It can only be the postman.' (Can only is similar to must here - see 350.2.)
Note the difference between may/might not and can/could not. It may not be true. (= Perhaps it is not
true.) It can't be true. (= It is certainly not true.)
5 reported speech
Could is used in past reported speech constructions, when can was used in direct speech.
'Anybody conjoin the club.' 'What?' 'I said anybody could join the club.'
6 can/could have...
We use can/could have + past participle to guess or speculate about what has happened, whether things
(have) happened etc. Can is only used in >
page 107


Juiu ar. interpersonal us*
can ana coma 14}: interpersonal uses 1Z4
questions and negative sentences, or with 'limiting' words like only, hardly or never. In other cases we use
could/may/might.
Where can she have gone? She can't have gone to school - it's Saturday. And she can hardly have gone
to church. Specula/may/might have gone swimming, I suppose. (NOT She can have gone...) Could have +
past participle is also used to say that something was possible, but did not happen.
That was a bad place to go skiing -you could have broken your leg. Why did you throw the bottle out of the
window? Somebody could have
been hurt.
The structure can refer to present situations which were possible but have not been realised.
He could have been Prime Minister now if he hadn't decided to leave
politics.
Compare may/might have... and can/could have... in negative sentences. He may/might not have
understood. (= Perhaps he did not understand.) He can't/couldn't have understood. (= He certainly did not
understand.)
For more about may and might, and the difference between can/could and may/might, see
331.10-11. For must have + past participle, see 350.4.
124 can and could (4): interpersonal uses (permission, requests etc)
1 asking for and giving permission
We use can to ask for and give permission; can't is used to refuse permission.
'Can laskyou something?' 'Yes, of course you can.'
'Can I have some more cake?' 'No, I'm afraid you can't.'
You can go now if you want to.
We also use could to ask for permission; it is more polite or formal than can. We do not use could to give
or refuse permission (it suggests respect, so is more natural in asking for permission than in giving it.)
'Could I ask you something, if you're not too busy?' 'Yes, of course you can.'
(NOT ... of course you could.)
May and might are also used to ask and give permission (see 332). They are more formal than can/could.
Some people consider them more 'correct', but in fact can and could are normally preferred in informal
educated usage, especially in British English.
2 reporting permission
Can and could are also used to talk about permission that has already been given or refused, and about
things that are (or are not) allowed by rules and laws. (Note that may is not normally used to talk about
rules and laws -see 332.3.)
She said I could come as often as I liked. Can you park on a double yellow line on Sundays? (NOT May
you park...?)
page 108

In talking about the past, we use could to say that somebody had permission
to do something at any time ('general permission'), but we do not use could
to talk about permission for one particular action in the past. Compare:
When I was a child, I could watch TV whenever I wanted to. Yesterday evening, Peter was allowed to
watch TV for an hour. (NOT .. .-Peter-eould watch TV for an hour.)
But could not can be used to talk about one particular action that was not
allowed.
Peter couldn't watch TV yesterday because he was naughty.
(The difference between could and was/were allowed is similar to the
difference between could and was/were able - see 122.3.)
3 permission: conditional uses of could
Could has a conditional use (= 'would be allowed').
He could borrow my car if he asked. The structure could have + past participle means 'would have been
allowed'.
I could have kissed her if I'd wanted to.
4 offers
We often use can when we offer to do things for people.
'Can I carry your bag?' 'Oh, thanks very much.'
T can baby-sit for you this evening if you like.' 'No, it's all right, thanks.' Could is possible if we want an
offer to sound less definite.
I could mend your bicycle for you, if that would help. ^
5 requests, orders and suggestions
We can use can and could to ask or tell people to do things. Could is more polite, more formal or less
definite, and is often used for making suggestions.
Can you put the children to bed?
Couldyou lend me five pounds until tomorrow?
Do you think you could help me for a few minutes?
When you've finished the washing up you can clean the kitchen. Thenyou could iron the clothes, if you
like.
If you haven't got anything to do you could sort out your photos.
6 criticisms
Could can be used to criticise people for not doing things. Could have + past participle is used to talk
about the past.
You could ask before you borrow my car.
You could have told me you were getting married.
For the use of might in similar cases, see 336.
7 reported speech
Could is used in past indirect speech constructions (see 481), when can was used in direct speech.
'Can you give me a hand?' 'What?' 'I asked if you could give me a hand.'
page 109


•Can and could (5): with see, hear, etc 125
125 can and could (5): with see, hear, etc
1 see, hear, feel, smell, taste
When these verbs refer to perception (receiving information through the eyes, ears etc), we do not
normally use progressive forms. To talk about seeing, hearing etc at a particular moment, we often use
can see, can hear etc (especially in British English).
lean see Susan coming. (NOT I'm seeing...)
Can you hear somebody coming up the stairs? ' " What did you put in the stew? I can taste something
funny.
Suddenly she realised she could smell something burning. In American English, I see/hear etc are
common in this sense.
2 guess, tell
Can and could are often used with guess and with tell (meaning see, know). Can/could are not normally
used with know (see 306.5).
I could guess what she wanted.
You can tell he's Irish from his accent. (NOT You can know...)
3 understand, follow, remember
Can/could is often used with these verbs too. It does not always add very much to the meaning.
I can't/don't understand what she's talking about.
Do/Can you follow what he's saying?
I (can) remember your grandfather.
126 can't help
If you say that you cannot/can't help doing something, you mean that you can't stop yourself doing it:
something makes you, even though you are being careful not to, or should be trying not to.
She's a selfish woman, but somehow you can't help liking her.
Excuse me-I couldn't help overhearing what you said.
Sorry I broke the cup -1 couldn't help it. Can't help is sometimes followed by but+ infinitive without to (see
116);
the meaning is the same as can't help.. .ing. This is a common structure in American English.
I can't help but wonder what I should do next.
127 care: take care (of), care (about) and care for
1 take care of
Take care o/normally means 'look after'. Nurses take care of people in hospital.
It's no good giving Peter a rabbit: he's too young to take care of it properly. Ms Savage takes care of
marketing and publicity, and I'm responsible/or
production. .^
page 110
changes 129
Take care (without a preposition) means 'be careful'. Some people use it as a formula when saying
goodbye.
Take care when you're crossing the road, children.
'Bye, Ruth.' 'Bye, Mike. Take care.'
2 care (about)
Care (about) is used to say whether or not you feel something is important, or whether it interests or
worries you. It is most common in questions and negative sentences. About is used before an object, but
is usually left out before a conjunction.
I don't care aboutyour opinion.
(NOT I don't take care of your opinion.) (NOT I don't care for your opinion.) I don't care whether it rains -
I'm happy. Til never speak to you again.' 'I don't care.' 'Your mother's very upset with you.' 'I couldn't care
less.' (= 'I don't care at all.'}
3 care for
Care for can be used to mean 'look after'. This is rather formal or literary.
He spent years caring for his sick mother. A more common use is to mean 'like' or 'be fond of.
Would you care for a cup of tea?
I don't much care for strawberries.
I really care for you, Sandra.
128 change
When we talk about changing one thing for another, we often use change with a plural object.
We have to change trains at York.
I'm thinking of'changing jobs.
For the differences between change, turn, become etc, see 129.
129 changes
Become, get, go, come, grow and turn can all be used with similar meanings to talk about change. The
differences between them are complicated - they are partly grammatical, partly to do with meaning, and
partly matters of conventional usage.
1 become with adjectives and noun phrases
Become can be used before adjectives and noun phrases.
It was becoming very dark.
What do you have to do to become a pilot? Become is not usually used to talk about deliberate actions.
Please get ready now. (NOT Please become ready-new.} >
oaee 111


changes iz
2 gef with adjectives
Get can be used before adjectives (without nouns). It is less formal than become.
It was getting very dark. (informal)
You get younger every day. (informal) Get is not usually used (with this meaning) before nouns.
What do you have to do to become a pilot? (NOT.. .to get a pilot} Get can also be used before past
participles like lost, broken, dressed, married.
They got married in 1986, and got divorced two years later.
For get used to, see 578.
3 get+ infinitive
We can sometimes use get with an infinitive to talk about a gradual change. After a few weeks I got to like
the job better. She's nice when you get to know her.
For get as a passive auxiliary and other uses of get, see 228.
4 go
Go can be used before adjectives to talk about change, especially in an informal style. This is common in
two cases.
a colours
Go (and not get) is used to talk about changes of colour, especially in British English.
Leaves go brown in autumn. (US... turn brown...) (NOT Leaves get brown...)
She went white with anger.
Suddenly everything went black and I lost consciousness. Other examples (mainly British English):
go blue with cold/red with embarrassment/green with envy Turn can also be used in these cases (see
below), and so can grow when the change is gradual. Go is more informal than turn and grow.
b changes of quality
Go (and not usually get) is used before adjectives in a number of common expressions that refer to
changes for the worse. People go mod I crazy/deaf I blind/grey/bald; horses go lame; machines go wrong;
iron goes rusty (GB);
meat, fish or vegetables go bad; cheese goes mouldy; milk goes off (GB) or sour; bread goes stale; beer,
lemonade, musical instruments and car tyres goflat.
He went bald in his twenties. The car keeps going wrong. Note that we use get, not go, with old, tired and
ill.
5 come
Come is used in a few fixed expressions to talk about things finishing up all right. The most common are
come true and come right.
I'll make all your dreams come true.
Trust me - it will all come right in the end.
page 112
L/llculgCS S.C.VS
Come + infinitive can be used to talk about changes in mental state or attitude.
I slowly came to realise that she knew what she was doing.
You will come to regret your decision.
6 grow
Grow is used before adjectives especially to talk about slow and gradual changes. It is more formal than
get or go, and can sound a litde old-fashioned or literary.
Without noticing it he grew old.
When they grew rich they began to drop their old friends.
As the weather grows colder, your thoughts naturally turn to winter
holidays in the sun.
Grow + infinitive can be used (like come + infinitive) to talk about changes in attitude, especially if these
are gradual.
He grew to accept his stepmother, and she hoped that one day he would grow to love her.
7 turn
Turn is used mostly for visible or striking changes of state. It is common before colour words (and is not so
informal as go).
She turned bright red and ran out of the room.
He turns nasty after he's had a couple of drinks. ^ | .;•; J Turn into is used before nouns, to talk about a
dramatic change in the nature of somebody or something.
He's a lovely man, but when he gets jealous he turns into a monster.
A girl has to kiss a lot of frogs before one of them turns into a prince. Turn to and turn into can both be
used before the names of materials.
His worry turned (in)tofury.
Everything that King Midas touched turned (in)to gold.
They stood there as if they had been turned (in)to stone. To talk about people changing their occupation,
religion, politics etc, we sometimes use turn with a noun (with no preposition or article) or an adjective.
He worked in a bank for thirty years before turning painter.
Towards the end of the war he turned traitor.
At the end of her life she turned Catholic. Turn (in)to can also be used as a transitive verb with an object,
to talk about causing change.
In the Greek legend, Circe turned men into pigs.
a fail
Fall is used to mean 'become' in a few fixed expressions such as fall ill, fall asleep and fall in love. >
page 113


10
,- City anu LUWII xow
9 verbs related to adjectives
A number of verbs which are related to adjectives have meanings like 'get more...' or 'make more...'. Many
of them end in -en. Examples:
The fog thickened.
The weather's beginning to brighten up.
His eyes narrowed.
Could you shorten the sleeves on this jacket?
They're widening the road here.
absence of change: stay, keep, remain
To talk about things not changing, we can use stay, keep or remain before adjectives. Remain is more
formal.
How do you manage to stay young and fit?
Keep calm.
I hope you will always remain so charming. Stay and remain are also sometimes used before noun
phrases.
Promise me you will always stay/remain my little boy. Keep can be used before -ing forms.
Keep smiling whatever happens.
For other uses of the words discussed in this section, see a good dictionary.
130 city and town
According to the legal definition, a 'city' is a town that has been given a special status by a royal charter (in
Britain) or by the State (in the US). However, most people simply use city to talk about large and important
towns - examples in Britain are Belfast, Cardiff, Edinburgh, Glasgow, Manchester, Liverpool and London.
131 cleft sentences
We can emphasise particular words and expressions by putting everything into a kind of relative clause
except the words we want to emphasise: this makes them stand out. These structures are called 'cleft
sentences' by grammarians {cleft means 'divided'). They are useful in writing (because we cannot use
intonation for emphasis in written language), but they are also common in speech.
1 the person who, the thing that etc
The words to be emphasised are joined to the relative clause by is/was and an expression like the person
who, what (= the thing that), the place where, the day when/that, the reason why. We can put the words to
be emphasised first or last in the sentence. Compare:
- MAR Y keeps a pig in the garden shed.
Mary is the person who keeps a pig in the garden shed. The person who keeps a pig in the garden shed is
Mary.
page 114

- Mary keeps A PIG in the garden shed.
A pig is what Mary keeps in the garden shed. What Mary keeps in the garden shed is a pig.
- Mary keeps a pig IN THE GARDEN SHED .
The garden shed is (the place) where Mary keeps a pig. (The place) where Mary keeps a pig is the garden
shed.
- Phil is THE SECRETARY.
The secretary is what Phil is. What Phil is is the secretary.
- Jake went to London ON TUESDA Y to see Colin.
Tuesday was (the day) when/that Jake went to London to see Colin. (The day) when Jake went to London
to see Colin was Tuesday.
- Jake went to London on Tuesday TO SEE COLIN.
To see Colin was (the reason) why Jake went to London on Tuesday.
(The reason) why Jake went to London on Tuesday was to see Colin. The place, the reason etc can be
dropped, but this is rather informal, especially at the beginning of a sentence.
Why I'm here is to talk about my plans.
(More formal: The reason why I'm here is...)
Spain's where we're going this year. Instead of the person, the place, what etc, we can use less general
expressions.
You're the woman (that) I'll always love best.
Paris is the city (that) I feel most at home in. A what-clsaise is normally considered to be singular; if it
begins a cleft sentence it is followed by is/was. But a plural verb is sometimes possible before a plural
noun in an informal style.
What we want is/are some of those cakes.
For more information about ivhat-clauses, see 476.
2 emphasising verbs
When we want to emphasise a verb, we have to use a more complicated structure with what ...do. Various
verb forms are possible.
He SCREAMED.
What he did was (to) scream/screamed. This structure can be used to emphasise the verb together with
other words that follow it. Compare:
She writes science fiction.
What she does is (to) write/writes science fiction.
3 emphasising a whole sentence
A whole sentence can be given extra emphasis by using a cleft structure with what and the verb happen.
Compare:
The car broke down.
What happened was (that) the car broke down. >
page 115


cien sciiicin-co
4 preparatory it
We can use preparatory it (see 301) in cleft sentences. In this case, the words to be emphasised are
usually joined to the relative clause by that. Compare:
My secretary sent the bill to Mr Hording yesterday. It was my secretary that sent the bill to Mr Hording
yesterday.
(not somebody else) It was the bill that my secretary sent to Mr Hording yesterday.
(not something else)
It was Mr Hording that my secretary sent the bill to yesterday. (not to somebody else)
• It was yesterday that my secretary sent the bill to Mr Hording.
(not another day) Negative structures are also possible.
It wasn't my husband, that sent the bill... Who is possible instead of that when a personal subject is
emphasised.
It was my secretary who sent... When a plural subject is emphasised, the verb is plural.
-ft was the students that were angry... (NOT ... thatwas angry...) When the emphasised subject is a
pronoun, there are two possibilities. Compare:
- It is I who am responsible, (formal) It's me that's responsible, (informal)
- It is you who are in the wrong, (formal)
It's you that's in the wrong, (informal)
To avoid being either too formal or too informal in this case, we could say, for example, I'm the person/the
one who's responsible. Note that the verb cannot be emphasised with the preparatory it structure: we
cannot say It was sent that my secretary the bill...
For more about subject and object forms of pronouns, see 425. For formal and informal language, see
216.
5 other structures
All (that), and expressions with thing, can be used in cleft sentences rather like what.
All I want is a home somewhere.
All I did was (to) touch the window, and it broke.
Allyou need is love.
The only thing I remember is a terrible pain in my head.
The first thing was to make some coffee.
My first journey abroad is something I shall never forget. Time expressions can be emphasised with It was
not until... and It was only when...
It was not until I met you that I knew real happiness.
It was only when I read her letter that I realised what was happening. At the beginning of a cleft sentence,
this and that often replace emphasised here and there. Compare:
- You pay here.
This is where you pay. (OR Here is where you pay.)
page 116
-"w
come ana go 134
- We lire there.
That's where we live. (OR There's where we live.)
For more about question-word clauses, see 460.
For more general information about sentence structure and the arrangement of information in sentences,
see 289.
132 close and shut
1 use
Close and shut can often be used with the same meaning. Open your mouth and close/shut your eyes. I
can't close/shut the window. Can you help me? The shop closes/shuts at five o'clock.
2 past participles
The past participles closed and shut can be used as adjectives.
The post office is closed/shut on Saturday afternoon. Shut is not usually used before a noun.
a closed door (NOT a shut door) closed eyes (NOT shut eyes)
3 cases where close is preferred
We prefer close for slow movements (like flowers closing at night), and close is more common in a formal
style. Compare:
As we watched, he closed his eyes for the last time. Shutyour mouth! We close roads, railways etc
(channels of communication). And we close (= 'end') letters, bank accounts, meetings etc.
133 cloth and clothes
Cloth (pronounced /kloG/) is material made from wool, cotton etc, used for making clothes, curtains, soft
furnishings and so on. (In modern English, it is more common to say material or fabric.)
His suits were made of the most expensive cloth. A cloth is a piece of material used for cleaning, covering
things etc.
Could you pass me a cloth? I've spilt some milk on the floor. Clothes (pronounced /klau(o)z/) are things
you wear: skirt, trousers etc. Clothes has no singular; instead of a clothe, we say something to wear or an
article I a piece of clothing.
I must buy some new clothes; I haven't got anything to wear.
134 come and go
1 speaker's/hearer's position
We use come for movements to the place where the speaker or hearer is. 'Maria, would you come here,
please?' 'I'm coming.' (NOT ... I'm going.) When did you come to live here? Can I come and sit on your
lap? >
page 117


comparison (IT: structures isss
We use go for movements to other places.
/ want to go and live in Greece. Let's go and see Peter and Diane. In 1577, he went to study in Rome.
2 speaker's/hearer's past or future position
We can use come for a movement to a place where the speaker or hearer was or will already be at the
time of the movement. Compare:
- What time did I come to see you in the office yesterday? I went to your office yesterday, butyou weren't
in.
- Will you come and visit me in hospital when I have my operation? He's going into hospital next week.
- Susan can't come to your birthday party.
She's going to see her mother.
Come (with) can be used to talk about joining a movement of the speaker's/hearer's, even if go is used for
the movement itself.
We're going to the cinema tonight. Would you like to come with us? _
3 come to
Come to can mean arrive at.
Carry straight on till you come to a crossroads.
And come from is used (in the present) to say where people's homes are or were. She comes from
Scotland, but her mother's Welsh. ;
Originally I come from Hungary, but I've lived here for twenty years. (NOT Originally I came from
Hungary...)
Note that these rules are not always followed in American English. The difference between bring and take
is similar. See 112. For come/go and.... see 52. For come/go.. .ing, see 232. For been = come/gone, see
94.
(5 comparison (I): structures
Several different grammatical structures can be used for comparing.
1 similarity and identity
If we want to say that people, things, actions or events are similar, we can use as or like (see 320);
so/neither do I and similar structures (see 516); or adverbs such as too, also and as well (see 45). To say
that they are identical, we can use the same (as) (see 486).
It's best cooked in olive oil, us the Italians do it,
Your sister looks just like you. She likes music, and so do I.
The papers were late and the post was too.
His eyes are just the same colour as mine.
2 difference
To talk about differences, we can use the negative forms of the structures used for talking about similarity
and identity. ^
The baby doesn't look much like you.
Its eyes are not at all the same colour as yours.
page 118
comparison (^J: cumparauve aim superlative adjectives iao
3 equality
To say that people, things etc are equal in a particular way, we often use the structure as (much/many)
...as (see 70).
My hands were as cold as ice.
I earn as much money as you. In negative comparisons, we can use not so... as or not as... as.
The baby's not so/as ugly as you.
4 inequality: more
To say that people, things etc are unequal in a particular way, we can use comparative adjectives and
adverbs, or more (... than) with adjectives, adverbs, verbs or nouns.
He's much older than her.
The baby's more attractive than you.
The car's running more smoothly since it had a service.
I worry more and more every day.
If I'm going to do more work I want more money. To say which one of a group is outstanding in a particular
way, we can use most.
You're the most annoying person in the whole office.
For the use of these structures ('comparative' and 'superlative'), and the difference between
them, see the following sections. For comparatives and superlatives ending in -eri-est, see 136. For
details of the use of more and most, see 346-347.
5 inequality: less
We can also talk about inequality by focusing on the 'lower' end of the scale,
using less (than) or least.
The baby's less ugly than you.
I've got less energy than I used to have.
My ambition is to spend the least possible time working.
Note that not as/so... as is more common than less... than in informal usage.
For the difference between as and than, see 557.
For pronouns after as and than, see 70.4,138.8.
For tenses after as and than, see 556.
For more information about less, see 313. For least, see 311.
136 comparison (2): comparative and superlative adjectives
One-syllable adjectives normally have comparatives and superlatives ending in -er, -est. Some two-
syllable adjectives are similar;others have more and most. Longer adjectives have more and most. >
page 119


iwtipnii.roii \s-i. ^uiiipniauvc ana superlative adjectives iao
one-syllable adjectives (regular comparison)
Adjective

Comparative Superlative



old tall

older oldest taller tallest

}Most adjectives: + -er, -
est.

cheap

cheaper cheapest



late

later latest

1 Adjectives ending in -
e:

nice

nicer nicest

J +-r, -St.

fat big
thin

fatter fattest bigger biggest
thinner thinnest

IClne vowel + one
consonant: double
consonant.

Note the pronunciation of:
younger /'jAng9(r)/ youngest /'jAngist/ longer /'lDnga(r)/
irregular comparison
longest /'Ion gist/ stronger /'stronge(r)/ strongest /'strongist/
Adjective

Comparative

Superlative

good

better

best

bad

worse

worst

ill

worse



far

farther 1 further

farthest/furthest



(see 207)



old

older/elder

oldest/eldest



(see 180)

(see 180)

The determiners little and much/many have irregular comparatives and superlatives:
little (see 322) . fess(see313) least (see 311) much/many (see 348) more (see 346) most (see 347)
Few has two possible comparatives and superlatives: fewer/less and fewest/least. See 313, 311.
two-syllable adjectives
Adjectives ending in -y have -wr and -iest.
happy happier happiest easy easier easiest
Some other two-syllable adjectives can have -er and -est, especially adjectives ending in an unstressed
vowel, /!/ or /a(r)/.
narrow narrower narrowest simple simpler simplest clever cleverer cleverest quiet quieter quietest
page 120
comparison w. comparative and superlative adjectives 136
With many two-syllable adjectives (e.g. polite, common}, -eri-est and more/most are both possible. With
others (including adjectives ending in -ing, -ed, -ful and -less], only more/most is possible. To find out the
normal comparative and superlative for a particular two-syllable adjective, check in a good dictionary.
4 longer adjectives
Adjectives of three or more syllables have more and most.
intelligent more intelligent most intelligent practical more practical most practical beautiful more beautiful
most beautiful
Words like unhappy (the opposites of two-syllable adjectives ending in -y) are an exception.
unhappy unhappier unhappiest untidy untidier untidiest
Some compound adjectives like good-looking or well-known have two possible comparatives and
superlatives.
good-looking better-looking best-looking
QR more good-looking most good-looking well-known better-known best-known
o R more well-known most well-known
5 more, most with short adjectives
Sometimes more/most are used with adjectives that normally have -eri-est. This can happen, for example,
when a comparative is not followed immediately by than; forms with -er are also possible.
The road's getting more and more steep. (OR... steeper and steeper.) When we compare two descriptions
(saying that one is more suitable or accurate than another), we use more; comparatives with -er are not
possible.
He's more lazy than stupid. (NOT He's lazier than stupid.) In a rather formal style, most can be used with
adjectives expressing approval and disapproval (including one-syllable adjectives) to mean 'very*.
Thank you very much indeed. That is most kind of you.
(NOT .. .-That is kindest of you.) Real, right, wrong and like always have more and most.
She's more like her mother than her father. (NOT ... likcr her mother...)
For information about how to use comparatives and superlatives, see 138. For modification of
comparatives and superlatives (e.g. much older, far the best}, see 139.
page 121


137
comparison (3): comparative and superlative adverbs
Most comparative and superlative adverbs are made with more and most.
Could you talk more quietly? (NOT ... quietlier) Adverbs that have the same form as adjectives (see 21),
and a few others, have comparatives and superlatives with -er and -est. The most common are:
fast, early, late, hard, long, near, high, low, soon, well (better, best), badly (.worse, worst), and in informal
English easy, slow, loud and quick.
Can't you drive any faster?
Can you come earlier?
Talk louder, (informal)
We've all got terrible voices, but I sing worst of all. Note also the irregular comparatives and superlatives
ofyar (farther/further, farthest/furthest, see 207), much (more, most, see 346 and 347), little (less, least,
see 313 and 311).
Often sometimes has comparative and superlative oftener and oftenest, but forms with more/most are
more common.
For the use of comparatives and superlatives, see the following sections.
138 comparison (4): using comparatives and superlatives
1 the difference between comparatives and superlatives
We use the comparative to compare one person, thing, action, event or group with another person, thing
etc. We use the superlative to compare
somebody/something with the whole group that he/she/it belongs to. Compare:
- Mary's taller than her three sisters. Mary's the tallest of the four girls.
- Your accent is worse than mine.
Your accent is the worst in the class. (NOT ... the worse...)
- He plays better than everybody else in the team. He's the best in the team.
- She's richer than 90 per cent of her neighbours. She's one of the richest people in town.
2 groups with two members
When a group only has two members, we sometimes use the comparative instead of the superlative.
I like Betty and Maud, but I think Maud's the nicer/nicest of the two. I'llgiveyou the bigger/biggest steak: I'm
not very hungry. Some people feel that a superlative is incorrect in this case.
page 122
IAIH^CIX10U3 comparative meaning 'relatively', 'more than average'
Comparatives can also suggest ideas like 'relatively', 'more than average'. Used in this way, comparatives
make a less clear and narrow selection than superlatives. Compare:
They put on two classes - one for the cleverer students and one for the slower learners.
The cleverest students were two girls from York. Comparatives are often used like this in advertising to
make things sound less definite.
less expensive clothes for the fuller figure (Compare cheap clothes for fat women)
4 double comparatives
We can use double comparatives to say that something is changing.
^...erand...er ' • i more and more...
I'm getting/after and fatter. We're going more and more slowly. (NOT ... more slowly and more slowly.)
5 the... the...
We can use comparatives with the... the... to say that things change or vary together, or that two variable
quantities are systematically related.
yiVord oraer (in both clauses):
tithe + comparative expression + subject + verb
6
The older I get, the happier I am. (NOT -Older I get, more I am happy.)
The more dangerous it is, the more I like it. (NOT The more it is dangerous,...)
The more I study, the less I learn. More can be used with a noun in this structure.
The more money he makes, the more useless things he buys. Sometimes that is used before the first
verb.
The more information that comes in, the more confused the picture is. A short form of this structure is
used in the expression The more the merrier, and in sentences ending the better.
'How do you like your coffee?' 'The stronger the better.' Note that in this structure, the word the is not
really the definite article - it, was originally a form of the demonstrative pronoun, meaning 'by that much'.
all/any'/none the + comparative
Another use of the meaning 'by that much' is in all/any'/none the + comparative. This structure can be
used when we say why something is or should be'more...'
The burglary was all the more upsetting because the burglars broke up a
whole lot of our furniture.
Sunday mornings were nice. I enjoyed them all the more because Sue used to come round to breakfast. >
page 123


TOiiipaiisuii v*); icniig wiiiparanves ana superlatives i.ao
I feel all the better for that swim.
Her accident made it all the more important to get home fast. He didn 't seem to be any the worse for his
experience. He explained it all carefully, but I was still none the wiser. Note that this structure is used only
to express abstract ideas. We would not say, for example, Those pills haw made him all the slimmer.
7 three times... er etc
Instead of three/four etc times as much (see 70.6), we can use three/fouretc times + comparative. .
She can walk three times further than you.
It was ten times more difficult than I expected. Note that twice and half are not possible in this structure.
She's twice as lively as her sister. (NOT.. . twice livelier...)
8 pronouns after than
In an informal style, object pronouns are used after than. In a more formal style, subject pronouns are
used (usually with verbs).
She's older than me. (informal)
She is older than I (am), (formal) The use of object pronouns can occasionally cause confusion.
'I love you more than her.' 'You mean more than you love her or more than she loves me?'
For more details of the use of subject and object pronouns, see 425.
9 prepositions after superlatives; possessive structure
After superlatives, we do not usually use o/with a singular word referring to a place or group.
I'm the happiest man in the world. (NOT ... of the world.)
She's the fastest player in the team. (NOT ... of the team.) But o/can be used before plurals, and before
singular quantifiers like lot and bunch.
She's the fastest player of them all.
He's the best of the lot. Note also the structure with possessive 's.
He thinks he's the world's strongest man.
10 ellipsis
The second part of a comparative or superlative structure can be left out when the meaning is given by
what comes before.
You can get there faster by car, but the train is more comfortable. (=... more comfortable than going by
car.)
I like everybody who works here, but you're the nicest of all.
Look - which of these do you think is the best? Note that this is not possible when the meaning is not
given by what comes before.
Love is the most important thing in the world. (NOT Love is the most important in the world.)
page 124
11 infinitives after superlatives
We often use an infinitive after a superlative, with the same meaning as a relative clause.
She's the youngest person ever to swim the Channel.
(=... the youngest person who has ever swum...) This structure is also common after first, last and next.
Who was the first woman to climb Everest?
The next to speak was Mrs Fenshaw.
Note that this structure is only possible in cases where the noun with the superlative has a subject
relationship with the following verb. In other cases, . infinitives cannot be used.
Is this the first time that you have stayed here? (NOT ... the first time for you to stay here?)
12 thevfiih superlatives
Nouns with superlative adjectives normally have the article the (unless there is a possessive).
It's the best book I've ever read.
Superlative adjectives in predicative position also tend to have the, though it is sometimes dropped in an
informal style.
I'm the greatest.
Which of the boys is (the) strongest?
This dictionary is (the) best. The is sometimes dropped before superlative adverbs in an informal style.
Who can run (the) fastest?
The cannot be dropped when a superlative in predicative position is used with a defining expression.
This dictionary is the best I could find. (NOT This dictionary is best I could find.)
She was the quickest of all the staff.
The is not used with superlatives in predicative position or with superlative adverbs, when we compare the
same person or thing in different situations. Compare:
- He's nicest when he's had a few drinks. (NOT He's the nicest when...) I've got a lot of friends, but he's
(the) nicest.
- She works hardest when she's doing something for her family.
(NOT She works the hardest when... - a woman's work is being compared in different situations.)
She works (the) hardest; her husband doesn't know what work is. (A woman is being compared with a
man - the is possible.)
13 non-assertive words after superlatives
'Non-assertive' words like ever, yet and any are not generally used in affirmative clauses (see 374).
However, they often follow comparatives and superlatives.
You 're more stubborn than anybody I know.
Ifs the best book I've ever read.
This is my hardest job yet. ^
page 125


words left out after than
In comparative clauses, than often seems to replace a subject or object pronoun or adverbial expression,
rather like a relative pronoun or adverb (see 557.3).
She spent more money than was sensible. (NOT ... than it was sensible:)
There were more people than we had expected. (NOT ... than we had expected them.)
Iloveyou more than she does. (NOT ... than how much she does.) (In some English dialects, the above
sentences would be constructed with than what.}
For the formation of comparatives and superlatives, see 136.
For as and than, see 557.
For comparisons with as, see 70.
For tenses after than, see 556.
For pronouns after than, see 138.8. '
For more, see 346.
For most, see 347.
ForZe^,see313.
VOT least, see 311.
For thefirst/second/besti etc + present/past perfect, see 419.7.
comparison (5): much, far etc with comparatives and superlatives
much, far etc with comparatives
We cannot use very with comparatives. Instead, we use, for example, much, far, very much, a lot
(informal), lots (informal), any and no (see 56), rather, a little, a bit (informal), and even.
My boyfriend is much/far older than me. (NOT ... very older than me.)
Russian is much/far more difficult than Spanish.
very much nicer a bit more sensible (informal)
a lot happier (informal) Is your mother any better?
rather more quickly She looks no older than her daughter.
a little less expensive Your cooking is even worse than Harry's.
Quite cannot be used with comparatives except in the expression quite better, meaning 'recovered from
an illness' (see 103.1). Any, no, a bit and a lot are not normally used to modify comparatives before
nouns. There are much/far nicer shops in the town centre. (BUT NOT ... a bit nicer shops...)
many more/less/fewer
When more (see 346) modifies a plural noun, it is modified by many instead of much. Compare:
much/far/a lot/etc more money many/far/a lot/etc more opportunities
Many-is sometimes used to modify less (before a plural noun) and fewer, but
this is unusual; far, a lot etc are more common.
far less words (more common than many less words) a lot fewer accidents (more common than many
fewer accidents)
page 126
3 much, by far, quite etc with superlatives
Superlatives can be modified by much and by far, and by other adverbs of degree such as quite (meaning
'absolutely'), almost, practically, nearly and easily.
He's much the most imaginative of them all.
She's by far the oldest.
We're walking by far the slowest.
He's quite the most stupid man I've ever met.
I'm nearly the oldest in the firm.
This is easily the worst party I've been to this year.
4 very with superlatives
Note the special use of very to emphasise superlatives and first, next and lost. Bring out your very best
wine - Michael's coming to dinner. You're the very first person I've spoken to today. This is your very hist
chance.
For modification of too, see 570.2.
140 complements
1 subject and object complements
Some clauses consist of a subject, the verb be, and an expression that describes the subject.
Alice is a ballet dancer.
Philip is depressed.
The expression that describes the subject in clauses like these is often called the 'complement' of the
clause, or a 'subject complement'. Subject , complements can follow not only be, but also other 'copular
verbs' (see 147) ' like become, look, seem.
Alice eventually became a ballet dancer.
Philip looks depressed.
In some structures, the object of a verb can have a complement. This happens, for example, after make,
elect or call. For details, see 580.
You make me nervous.
Why ever did they elect him chairman?
Don't you call my husband a liar.
2 complements of verbs, nouns and adjectives
The word 'complement' is also used in a wider sense. We often need to add something to a verb, noun or
adjective to complete its meaning. If somebody says / want, we expect to hear what he or she wants; the
words the need obviously don't make sense alone; after hearing I'm interested, we may need to be told
what the speaker is interested in. Words and expressions which 'complete' the meaning of a verb, noun or
adjective are also called 'complements'.
/ want a drink, and then I want to go home.
Does she understand the need for secrecy7
I'm interested in learning to fly. >
page 127


Many verbs can be followed by noun complements or -ing forms with no preposition ('direct objects'). But
nouns and adjectives normally need prepositions to join them to noun or -ing form complements.
Compare:
- Alan criticised the plan.
Alan's criticism of the plan made him very unpopular. Alan was very critical of the plan.
- I resent working on Saturdays.
My resentment of working...
I feel resentful about working...
It is important to know what kinds of complements can come after a particular word. For example,
interested can be followed by in.. .ing or by an infinitive, but bored is not used in the same way; want can
be followed by an
infinitive, but suggest cannot; on the other hand suggest can be followed by a '' that-clause, but want
cannot.
Related verbs, nouns and adjectives often have the same kinds of complements.
/ worry about you a lot. She ignored our worries about the weather. I'm very worried about Bill. However,
this is not always the case. Compare:
- I sympathise with her.
I feel some sympathy for her. ,• I feel quite sympathetic towards her.
I hope to see you soon.
He gave up hope of seeing her. (NOT He gave up hope to see her.)
For more details, see 579 (verbs), 377 (nouns) and 12 (adjectives).
141 conditional
1 conditional clauses
Clauses constructed with if (except in reported speech) are often called 'conditional clauses'.
If you think I'm going to help you, you're wrong. You wouldn't have crashed if you'd looked where you
were going.
For details of the different kinds of structures with if, see 258-265.
2 conditional verb forms
The word conditional is also sometimes used as a name for verb forms
constructed with the auxiliary verb should/would (and sometimes could and might).
I should/would like to use the computer for an hour or two. It would be nice if he would stop talking for a
bit.
For details of these verb forms and their use, see 498.
page 128
142 conjunctions (I): general points
1 What are conjunctions?
Conjunctions are words that join clauses into sentences.
CLAUSE CONJUNCTION CLAUSE
7 went to bed early because I was extremely tired.
SENTENCE
Conjunctions not only join clauses together; they also show how the meanings of the two clauses are
related.
We brought the food and they supplied the drink, (addition)
She was poor but she was honest, (contrast)
We can go swimming, or we could stay here. (alternative)
People disliked her because she was so rude. (cause)
I'll phone you when I arrive, (time)
2 two kinds
And, but and or are often called 'co-ordinating conjunctions*. They join pairs of clauses that are
grammatically independent of each other.
Other conjunctions, like because, when, that or which, are called 'subordinating conjunctions'. A
subordinating conjunction together with its following clause acts like a part of the other clause. Compare:
- I'll phone you when I arrive. I'll phone you tomorrow.
(When I arrive is similar to tomorrow - it acts like an adverb in the clause I'll phone you.)
- He told me that he loved me. He told me a lie.
(that he loved me is similar to a lie - it acts like the object in the clause He told me...)
- It's a question which nobody can answer. It's an unanswerable question.
(which nobody can answer is similar to unanswerable - it acts like an adjective in the clause It's a
question.) Some conjunctions are made up of two or more words. I stayed an extra night so that I could
see Ann. Let me know the moment that you arrive.
In grammars, clauses that follow subordinating conjunctions are called 'subordinate clauses' or 'dependent
clauses'.
3 position of subordinate clauses
Adverbial subordinating conjunctions and their clauses can usually go either first or last in a sentence
(depending on what is to be emphasised).
- If you need help, just let me know.
Just let me know if you need help. ^
page 129


- Although the bicycle was expensive, she decided to buy it. She decided to buy the bicycle although it
was expensive.
- While I was having a, shower, I slipped on the floor. I slipped on the floor while I was having a shower.
- Because she was too angry to speak, Ann said nothing. Ann said nothing, because she was too angry to
speak.
4 punctuation
Commas are often used to separate longer or more complicated clauses. Shorter pairs of clauses are
often connected without commas. Compare:
/ came home and the others went dancing.
I decided to come home earlier than I had planned, and the others spent
the evening at the local disco.
When a subordinate clause begins a sentence, it is more often separated by a comma, even if it is short.
Compare:
If you are passing, come in and see us.
Come in and see us if you are passing.
For more information about punctuation, see 455. For punctuation in relative clauses, see 474.
5 leaving words out
Words for repeated ideas can often be left out in the second of two coordinate clauses (see 182 for
details), but not normally in a subordinate clause. Compare:
She was depressed, and didn't know what to do. (= and she didn 't know what to do.)
She was depressed, because she didn't know what to do.
(NOT She was depressed, because didn't know...) However, after if, when, while, until, once, unless and
(al)though, a pronoun subject and the verb be can often be dropped, especially in common fixed
expressions like if necessary.
I'll pay for you if necessary. (=... if it is necessary.)
If in doubt, wait and see. (= If you are in doubt...)
When in Rome, do as the Romans do.
Cook slowly until ready.
Once in bed, I read for twenty minutes and then turned out the light. Many conjunctions that express time
relations (after, before, since, when, while, whenever, once and until) can often be followed by -ing forms
or past participles instead of subjects and full verbs (see 406.6).
/ always feel better after talking to you.
Some things are never forgotten, once learnt.
6 conjunctions in separate sentences
Normally a conjunction connects two clauses into one sentence. However, sometimes a conjunction and
its clause can stand alone. This happens, for example, in answers.
'When are you going to get up?'' When I'm ready.'
"Why did you do that7''Because I felt like it.'
'I'm going out, Mum.' 'As soon as you've brushedyour hair.'
page 130
mnpnn^roiis v^7:proDieins us
Writers and speakers can also separate clauses for emphasis.
This government has got to go. Before it does any more damage. Afterthoughts may also begin with
conjunctions.
OK, I did it. - But I didn't mean to.
For tenses in subordinate clauses, see 556. For structures in which that is dropped, see 560.
See also 473-477 (relative pronouns and clauses), 480-482 (indirect speech), and the individual entries on
the various conjunctions.
143 conjunctions (2): problems
In most languages of European origin, clauses are joined together by conjunctions in similar ways.
However, students who speak non-European-type languages may have some problems in using English
conjunctions correctly.
1 one conjunction for two clauses
One conjunction is enough to join two clauses - we do not normally use two.
- Although she was tired, she went to work. She was tired but she went to work.
(NOT Although she was tired but she went to work.)
- Because I liked him, I tried to help him. I liked him, so I tried to help him.
(NOT Because I was tired, so I tried to help him.)
- As you know, I work very hard.
You know that I work very hard.
(NOT As you know, that I work very hard.) However, two conjunctions can come together when two
subordinate clauses are connected with a co-ordinating conjunction.
We came back because we ran out of money, and because Ann got ill. So and yet are like conjunctions in
some ways, but they can be used together with and.
I forgot to post the letter, and so she never heard about my divorce.
He's not really nice-looking, and yet he has enormous charm.
2 Relative pronouns are also conjunctions
Relative pronouns (who, which and that - see 473) join clauses like conjunctions.
There's the girl who works with my sister.
A relative pronoun is like the subject or object of the verb that comes after it. So we do not need another
subject or object. I've got a friend who works in a pub.
(NOT ... who he works in a pub.) The man (that) she married was an old friend of mine.
(NOT The man that she married him...) She always thanks me for the money that I give her.
(NOT ... the money that I give her it.) >
page 131


3 that, where and when
That is often used instead of which or who(m) (see 473-474), but we do not usually use that instead of
when or where.
August 31st is a national holiday, when everybody dances in the streets. (NOT ... that everybody
dances...}
The house where I live is very small.
(NOT The house that I live is very small.) But that ...in can mean the same as where.
The house that I live in is very small.
That can be used instead of where and when in a few special cases (e.g. sifter place, day); for details, see
477.3.
I'll always remember the day (that) I met you.
For conjunctions after prepositions, see 441. For now as a conjunction, see 383. For once, see 390. For
the moment and immediately, see 267.
144 contractions
1 general rules
Forms like I've, don't are called 'contractions'. There are two kinds. (llauxiliary) verb + not
They aren't ready. You won't be late, will you? lhaven'tseen him for ages. Can't you swim?
noun/pronoun/etc + (auxiliary) verb
I'm tired.
Do you know when you'll arrive?
I've no idea.
She'd like to talk to you.
Here's our bus.
My father's not very well.
Where''s the station?
There's a problem.
Somebody's coming.
Contractions are formed with auxiliary verbs, and also with be and sometimes have when these are not
auxiliary verbs.
The short form 's (= is/has) can be written after nouns, question words, here and now as well as pronouns
and unstressed there. The short forms 'II, 'd and 're are commonly written after pronouns and unstressed
there, but in other cases we more often write the full forms (especially in British English), even if the words
would be contracted in pronunciation.
'Your mother will (I'mAQwM) be surprised', she said.
I wondered what had (7'wotad/J happened. Contractions are not usually written with double subjects.
John and I have decided to split up. (NOT -fohn and I've decided...) The apostrophe (') goes in the same
place as the letters that we leave out: has not = hasn't (NOT ha'snt). But note that shan't (= shall not) and
won't (= will not) only have one apostrophe each.
Contractions are common and correct in informal writing: they represent the pronunciation of informal
speech. They are not generally used in a formal style.
page 132
2 alternative contractions
Some negative expressions can have two possible contractions. For she had not we can say she'd not or
she hadn't; for he will not we can say he'll not or he won't. The two negative forms of be (e.g. she isn't and
she's not) are both common; with other verbs, forms with n't (e.g. she hadn't) are more common in most
cases in standard southern British English and in American English. (Forms with not - e.g. she'd not - tend
to be more common in northern and Scottish English.)
Double contractions are not normally written: sho'sn'tis impossible.
3 stress
Contractions in the first group (noun/pronoun/question word + auxiliary
verb) are never stressed. When an auxiliary verb is stressed (for example at the end of a clause), a
contraction is not possible. Compare:
- I'm late.
Yes, you are. (NOT Yes, you're.)
- I've forgotten.
Yes, you have. (NOT Yes, you've.)
However, negative contractions can be stressed, and we can use them at the ends of clauses.
They really aren't.
No, I haven't.
4 list of contractions
Contraction Pronunciation
I'm

/aim/

I've

/aiv/

I'll

/ail/

I'd

/aid/

you're

/J-o:(r)/

you've

/ju:v/

you'll

/ju:l/

you'd

/ju;d/

he's

/hi:z/

he'll

/hi:l, hri/

he'd

/hi:d/

she's

/Ji:z/

she'll

/Ji:l,Jil/

she'd

/Ji:d/

it's1

/its/

it'd (uncommon)

/itad/

we're

/wra(r)/

we've

/wi:v/

we'll

/will, wri/

we'd

/wi:d/

Meaning
lam
I have
I will
I had/would
you are you have you will you had/would
he is/has
he will
he had/would
she is/has
she will
she had/would
it is / has
it had/would
we are
we have
we will
we had/would
page 133


Contraction
Pronunciation Meaning
they're

/Bea(r)/

they are

they've

/oeiv/

they have

they'll

/oeil, oel/

they will

they'd

/9eid/

they had/would

there's

/Baz/

there is/has

there'll

/aai/

there will

there'd

/oad/

there had/would

aren't2

/a:nt/

are not

can't3

/kamt/

cannot

couldn't

/'kudnt/

could not

daren't*

/desnt/

dare not

didn't

/'didnt/

did not

doesn't

/'dAznt/

does not

don't

/daunt/

do not,

hadn't

/'haednt/

had not

hasn't

/'haeznt/

has not

haven't

/'haevnt/

have not

isn't

/'iznt/

is not

mightn't

/'maitnt/

might not

mustn't

/'mAsnt/

must not

needn't

/'nildnt/

need not

oughtn't

/'3:tnt/

ought not

shan't4

/Joint/

shall not

shouldn't

/fudnt/

should not

usedn't*

/'ju:snt/

used not

wasn't

/'wnznt/

was not

weren't

/W3:nt/

were not

won't

/waunt/

will not

wouldn't

/'wudnt/

would not

Notes
1 Do not confuse it's (= it is/has) and its (possessive).
2 Am not is only normally contracted in questions, to aren't (GB) (/a:nt/). I'm late, aren't I?
3 Note the difference in pronunciation of can't in British English (/ka:nt/) and American English (/kaent/).
4 Daren't, shan't and usedn't are not often used in American English.
5 In non-standard English, ain't (pronounced /eint/ or /ent/) is used as a contraction of aw not, are not, is
not, have not and has not.
I ain't going to tell him. Don't talk to me like that-you ain't my boss. 'It's raining."No it ain't.' I ain't got no
more cigarettes. Bill ain't been here for days.
6 For the contraction let's, see 315.
7 May not is not normally contracted: mayn't is very rare.
page 134
copuiar veros 147
145 contrary
1 on the contrary and on the other hand
In modern English on the contrary is used to contradict - to say that what has been said is not true. If we
want to give the other side of a question, we use on the other hand, not on the contrary. Compare:
'I suppose the job wasn't very interesting?' 'On the contrary, it was
fascinating. I loved it.'
The job wasn't very interesting, but on the other hand it was well paid. (NOT ... on the contrary, it was well
paid.}
2 contraryand opposite
We usually use opposite, not contrary, to talk about contrasting pairs of words. 'Short'is the opposite
of'tall', and also of'long'. (NOT ... the contrary of'tall'...)
For more information about opposite, see 397.
146 control
The word control is a 'false friend' for people who speak many languages of European origin. In English,
control generally means manage, direct, not check or inspect. Compare:
- The crowd was too big for the police to control. (=... to keep in order.} The police were checking
everybody's papers. (NOT ... controlling everybody's papers.}
- I found the car difficult to control at high speeds.
I took the car to the garage and asked them to have a look at the steering.
(NOT ... to control the steering.}
Note, however, that the noun control is used with the meaning of'inspection point' in expressions like
passport/customs control.
147 copuiar verbs
1 common copuiar verbs
We use a special kind of verb to join an adjective or noun complement to a subject. These verbs can be
called 'copulas' or 'copuiar verbs'. Common copuiar verbs are: be, seem, appear, look, sound, smell,
taste, feel, become, get.
The weather is horrible. I do feel a fool.
That car looks fast. She became a racehorse trainer.
The stew smells good. It's getting late.
2 adjectives after copuiar verbs
After copuiar verbs we use adjectives, not adverbs. Compare:
He spoke intelligently. (Intelligently is an adverb. It tells you about how the person spoke.)
He looks intelligent. (Intelligent is an adjective in predicative position (see 15). It tells you about the person
himself- rather like saying He is intelligent. Look is a copuiar verb.) >
page 135


3 other uses
Note that some of these verbs are also used with other meanings as ordinary
non-copular verbs. They are then used with adverbs, not adjectives.
Compare:
The problem appeared impossible. (NOT ... impossibly.) Isabel suddenly appeared in the doorway. (NOT
... sudden...)
Other verbs used in two ways like this are look (see 324), taste (see 552) and
/ce/(see208).
4 change
Some copular verbs are used to talk about change, or the absence of change. The most common are:
become, get, grow, go, turn, stay, remain, keep.
It's becoming colder.
It's getting colder.
It's growing colder.
The leaves are going brown.
The leaves are turning brown.
How does she stay so young?
I hope you will always remain so happy.
Keep calm.
For the differences between these verbs, see 129.
5 other verbs followed by adjectives
Sometimes other verbs, too, can be followed by adjectives. This happens when we are really describing
the subject of the sentence, and not the action of the verb. It is common in descriptions with sit, stand, lie,
fall. The valley lay quiet and peaceful in the sun. She sat motionless, waiting/or their decision. He fell
unconscious on the floor. (NOT ... unconsciously...) Adjectives can also be used in the structure verb +
object + adjective, in order to describe the object of the verb.
New S UPER G UB washes clothes S UPER WHITE. (NOT.. . WHITEIY ...) He pulled his belt tight and
started off. (NOT ... tightly...)
See also the entries for particular copular verbs. For more about verb complementation, see 579.
148 countable and uncountable nouns
1 the difference between countable and uncountable nouns
Countable nouns are the names of separate objects, people, ideas etc which can be counted. We can use
numbers and the article a/an with countable nouns; they have plurals.
a cat a newspaper three cats two newspapers
Uncountable (or 'mass') nouns are the names of materials, liquids, abstract qualities, collections and other
things which we see as masses without clear boundaries, and not as separate objects. We cannot use
numbers with uncountable nouns, and most are singular with no plurals. (For plural
page 136
OUUIlLaulc CU1U uxn^uLUlLdUlC TIUUI15 A 40
2
uncountable nouns, see paragraph 7 below.) We do not normally use a/an with uncountable nouns,
though there are some exceptions (see paragraph 6 below).
water (NOT a water, two waters)
wool (NOT a wool, two wools}
weather (NOT -a weather, two weathers) Some determiners (see 157) can only be used with countable
nouns (e.g. '' many, few); others can only be used with uncountables (e.g. much, little). Compare:
How many hours do you work?
How much money do you earn?
Note that not all nouns are either simply countable or simply uncountable. Many nouns have both
countable and uncountable uses, sometimes with a difference of meaning. The following rules will help,
but to know exactly how a particular noun can be used, it is necessary to check in a good dictionary.
problem cases
Usually it is easy to see whether a noun is countable or uncountable. Obviously house is normally a
countable noun, and sand is not. But sometimes things are not so clear. For instance, travel and journey
have very similar meanings, but travel is normally uncountable (it means 'travelling in general', and we do
not talk about 'a travel'), while journey is countable (a journey is one movement from one place to
another). And many things can be seen both as a collection of separate elements and as a mass; some
names for things of this kind are countable, while others are uncountable. Compare:
Countable: bean(s), pea(s), grape(s), lentil(s), fact(s) Uncountable: rice, spaghetti, macaroni (and other
pasta foods), sugar, salt, wheat, news
English and other languages
Not all languages treat things in the same way. For example, hair can be uncountable in English, but is
plural countable in many languages; grapes is a plural countable word in English, but uncountable in some
other languages. Here is a list of some common words which are usually uncountable in English, but
which have countable equivalents in some other languages. Corresponding countable expressions are
also given.
Uncountable
accommodation
advice
baggage
bread
chess
chewing gum
equipment
furniture
grass
information
knowledge
Countable
a place to live (NOT an accommodation)
a piece of advice (NOT an advice)
a piece of baggage; a case/trunk/bag
a piece of bread; a loaf; a roll
a game of chess
a piece of chewing gum
a piece of equipment; a tool etc
a piece/article of furniture
a blade of grass
a piece of information
a fact
page 137


countaDie ana uncountaDle nouns 148
Uncountable Countable
lightning a flash of lightning
luck a bit/ stroke of luck
luggage a piece of luggage; a case/trunk/bag
money a note; a coin; a sum
news a piece of news
permission
poetry a poem
progress a step forward
publicity an advertisement
research a piece of research
rubbish a piece of rubbish
spaghetti a piece of spaghetti
thunder a clap of thunder
traffic
travel a journey/trip
work a job; a piece of work
Note that when uncountable English words are borrowed by other languages, they may change into
countable words with different meanings (for example French parking means "car park', not 'parking').
4 illnesses
The names of illnesses are usually uncountable in English, including those ending in -s.
If you've already had measles, you can't get it again.
There's a lot of flu around at the moment. The words for some minor ailments are countable: e.g. a cold, a
sore throat, a headache. However, toothache, earache, stomach-ache and backache are more often
uncountable in British English. In American English, these words are generally countable if they refer to
particular attacks of pain. Compare:
Love isn't as bad as toothache. (GB)
Love isn 't as bad as a toothache. (US)
5 mixed uses
Many nouns have both countable and uncountable uses, with some difference of meaning. Words for
materials are uncountable, but we can often use the same word as a countable noun to refer to something
made of the material. Compare:
- I'd like some typing paper.
I'm going out to buy a paper (= a newspaper)
- The window's made of unbreakable glass. Would you like a glass of water?
- Have you got any coffee?
Could I have two coffees? (= cups of coffee} And normally uncountable nouns can often be used as
countables if we are talking about different kinds of material, liquid etc.
Not all washing powders are kind to your hands.
The 1961 wines were among the best this century.
page 138

Many abstract nouns can have both uncountable and countable uses, corresponding to more 'general' and
more 'particular' meanings. Compare:
- Don't hurry-there's plenty of time. Have a good time.
- She hasn't got enough experience for the job. I had a really strange experience last week.
- It's hard to feel pity for people like that.
It's a pity it's raining.
Singular countable nouns are sometimes used as uncountables (e.g. with much, enough, plenty of or a lot
of), in order to express the idea of amount.
I've got too much nose and not enough chin.
If you buy a Volvo you get plenty of car for your money.
We've got enough paint for about 20 square feet of wall. Some countable abstract nouns can be used
uncountably after little, much and other determiners. Common examples are difference, point, reason,
idea, change, difficulty, chance and question.
There isn't much difference between 'begin' and 'start'.
I don't think there's much point in arguing about it.
We have little reason to expect prices to fall.
I haven't got much idea of her plans.
There isn't any change in his condition.
They experienced little difficulty in stealing the painting.
Do you think we have much chance of catching the train?
There's some question of our getting a new Managing Director. Note the expression have difficulty (in)..
.ing.
I have difficulty (in) remembering faces. (NOT I have difficulties...) A few uncountable nouns have plural
uses in fixed expressions.
He goes running in all weathers.
Did you meet anybody exciting on your travels?
Gulliver's Travels (novel by Jonathan Swift)
6 a/an with uncountable nouns
With certain uncountable nouns - especially nouns referring to human
emotions and mental activity - we have to use a/an when we are limiting
their meaning in some way.
We need a secretary with a first-class knowledge of German.
(NOT ... with first class knowledge of German.) She has always had a deep distrust of strangers. That
child shows a surprising understanding of adult behaviour. My parents wanted me to have a good
education.
(NOT ... to have good education.) •'
Note that these nouns cannot normally be used in the plural, and that most
uncountable nouns cannot be used with a/an at all. '
My father enjoys very good health. (NOT ... a very good fajflffh.) . ,
We're having terrible weather. (NOT ... a terrible weather.)
He speaks excellent English. (NOT.. . an excellent English.)
It's interesting work. (NOT ... an interesting work.) >
page 139


. " i-TTUinry 113
plural uncountables
Some uncountable nouns are plural. They have no singular forms with the same meaning, and cannot be
used with numbers. Common examples are groceries, arms, remains, goods, customs (at a frontier),
clothes, thanks, regards, police.
I've bought the groceries. (BUT NOT ... a grocery. OR ... three groceries) Many thanks for your help. (BUT
NOT Much thank...) Other plural uncountables include trousers, jeans, pyjamas, pants, scissors,
spectacles, glasses (meaning spectacles), and the expressions the British, the Dutch, the English, the
French, the Irish, the Spanish and the Welsh. I need some new jeans. (NOT ... a new jean.} In 1581 the
Dutch declared their independence from Spain.
For more information on the use of articles with countable and uncountable nouns, see 64.
149 country
2
countable use
Country (countable) = 'nation', 'land'.
Scotland is a cold country. France is the country I know best. How many countries are there in Europe?
uncountable use
Country (uncountable) = 'open land without many buildings'. / like wild country best.
With this meaning, we cannot say a country or countries.
My parents live in nice country near Belfast. (NOT ...in a nice cc
The expression the country (the opposite of the town) is very common. We live in the country just outside
Manchester. Would you rather live in the town or the country?
For similar general expressions with the, see 68.3a. For information about countable and uncountable
nouns, see 148.
150 dare
b
structures
Dare can be used in two ways:
as an ordinary verb, followed by the infinitive with to , He's a man who dares to say what he thinks. She
didn't dare to tell him what had happened.
as a modal auxiliary verb (see 344 - 345).
" , . ", . , f (Question and negative without do;
Dare she tell him? ., .,
, . ,. , , , • , < third person without -s;
I darent say what 1 think. ] ,. " . . " . . ., ,
" [ following infinitive without to.)
page 140
•aares lai
In modern English, dare is not a very common verb. In an informal style, people generally use other
expressions to express the same meaning. - He's not afraid to say what he thinks.
2 dare as an ordinary verb
When dare is used, it is usually as an ordinary verb, not a modal auxiliary. It is most common in negative
sentences.
She doesn't dare to go out at night.
The old lady didn't dare to open the door. The expressions You dare! (GB) and Don't you dare! are
sometimes used to discourage people from doing unwanted things.
'Mummy, can I draw a picture on the wall?' 'You dare!'
3 dare as a modal auxiliary
Modal auxiliary forms are common in a few present-tense uses. For instance, British people quite often
use daren't to say that somebody is afraid to do something at the moment of speaking.
I daren't look. How dare you? is sometimes used as an indignant exclamation.
How dare you? Take your hands off me at once! And / dare say (sometimes written / daresay) is used in
British English to mean 'I think probably', 'I suppose'.
I dare say it'll rain soon. I daresay you're ready for a drink.
4 mixed structures
Occasionally mixed ordinary/modal structures are found. Do you dare put your mind to the test?
(advertisement) He didn't dare open his eyes. The bank dares not try to call in its debts.
5 dare + object + infinitive
Children use the expression I dare you + infinitive to challenge each other to do frightening things.
I dare you to run across the road with your eyes shut.
Need can also be used both as an ordinary verb and as a modal auxiliary. See 357.
151 dates
1 writing
In Britain, the commonest way to write the day's date is as follows. Note that the names of months always
begin with capital letters.
30 March 1995 27 July 1996
The last two letters of the number word (.st, nd, rd or th) are sometimes added. Some people write a
comma before the year, but this is no longer very common in Britain except when the date comes inside a
sentence.
30th March(.) 1995 He was bom in Hawick on 14 December, 1942. >
page 141


dead ana ciieu ias
The date may be written entirely in figures.
30/3/95 30-3-95 30.3.95
In the USA it is common to write the month first and to put a comma before the year.
March 30, 1995
All-figure dates are written differently in Britain and America, since British people put the day first while
Americans generally start with the month. So for example, 6.4.94 means '6 April 1994' in Britain, but 'June
4,1994' in the USA
The longer names of the months are often abbreviated as follows:
Jan Feb Mar Apr Aug Sept Oct Nov Dec The names of decades (e.g. the nineteen sixties) can be written
like this:
the 1960s.
For the position of dates in letters, see 317.
For full stops in abbreviations, see 2.
For words that are written with initial capital letters, see 529.
2 speaking
30 March 1993 = 'March the thirtieth, nineteen ninety-three' (US 'March (the) thirtieth...') or 'the thirtieth of
March, nineteen ninety-three* 1200 = 'twelve hundred'
1305 = 'thirteen hundred and five' or 'thirteen 0 (/au/) five' 1498 = 'fourteen (hundred and) ninety-eight'
1910 = 'nineteen (hundred and) ten' 1946 = 'nineteen (hundred and) forty-six' 2000 ='two thousand' 2005
= 'two thousand and five' To announce the date, It's is used.
It'sApril the first. To ask about dates, we can say for instance:
What's the date (today) ? What date is your birthday?
3 BCandAD
To distinguish between dates before and after the birth of Christ, we use the abbreviations BC (= 'Before
Christ') andAD (= 'Anno Domini' - Latin for 'in the year of the Lord'). BC follows the date; AD can come
before or after it.
Julius Caesar first came to Britain in 55 BC.
The emperor Trajan was born in AD 53/S3 AD.
i2 dead and died
Dead is an adjective. a dead man Mrs McGinty is dead. That idea has been dead for years.
page 142
'tw^ "degree \'i r. inuumcaiiuii ui auJcuiivcs emu auvcios xaa
Died is the past tense and past participle of the verb die.
Shakespeare died in 1616. (NOT Shakespeare dead...)
She died in a car crash. (NOT She is dead in...)
So far 50 people have died in the fighting. Note the spelling of the present participle dying (see 534).
For expressions like the dead (= 'dead people'), see 18.
153 degree (1): modification of adjectives and adverbs
1 gradable and non-gradable
Some adjectives and adverbs refer to qualities which are gradable - we can have more or less of them.
For example, people can be more or less interesting or old; jobs can be more or less difficult; cars can go
more or less fast. Other adjectives and adverbs refer to non-gradable qualities -we do not usually say that
things are more or less perfect, impossible or dead.
2 gradable adjectives and adverbs
To add the idea of degree - 'how much' - to gradable adjectives and adverbs, we can use words and
expressions like too, as, so, enough, extremely, very, rather, pretty, quite (British English), fairly, a little, a
bit (informal), not very, not at all, how.
The water's too cold. I'm extremely grateful to you.
It's going to be very cold. You look rather unhappy.
You're driving a bit fast, aren't you?
I wasn't at all enthusiastic about the idea.
I can't tell you how pleased I am about the result.
How well do you speak Russian?
A little and a bit are mostly used before adjectives and adverbs that express negative ideas.
/ thought the house was a little small.
You're looking a bit tired. (BUT NOT You 're looking a bit happy.) A little and a bit are not used with
adjectives in attributive position (= before nouns-see 15).
/ had a rather unpleasant experience.
(BUT NOT I had an a bit unpleasant experience.) Note that enough follows its adjective.
He's not tall enough to be a policeman. (NOT He's not enough tall...) Indeed can be used for emphasis
after very+ adjective/adverb. It cannot normally be used without very.
It's going to be very cold indeed. (BUT NOT It's going to be cold indeed.) Most is sometimes used (with
the same meaning as very) before adjectives in a formal style.
That's most kind of you.
For more information about enough, see 193.
For word order when quite and rather are used with article + adjective + noun, see 467-468. >
page 143


3 nof wry
No? very expresses quite a low degree.
/?'s not very warm -you'd better take a coat. That meal wasn't very expensive. (=... quite cheap.)
Note that little cannot be used in this sense.
He's not very imaginative. (BUT NOT He's little ima^
4 very, too, so, as and how without much
These words are normally used without much before adjectives and adverbs. The situation is very serious.
(NOT ... very much serious.) I'm very worried about Angela. (NOT ... very much worried...) You're too kind.
(NOT You're too much kind.) I came as quickly as I could. (NOT.. . as much quickly...) I don't care how
expensive it is. (NOT.. . how much expensive...)
However, very much, too much, so much etc are used before comparatives
(see paragraph 6 below), and often before afraid (especially when I'm afraid
means I'm sorry to tell you).
I'm very much afraid that I can't come tomorrow. Very much etc can be used before some participles that
are used as adjectives. For details, see 405.4.
She was very (much) annoyed to find Jake in her room.
Before adjective + noun, we normally use such, not so. For details, see 544. Compare:
It's so cold.
It's such a cold day.
For more about so, see 513. For the use of too, so, as and how before adjective + article + noun (e.g. so
cold a day), see 16.
5 special combinations
Some adjectives are commonly used with particular modifiers. For example, as well as very reliable we
can say highly reliable, but we cannot say highly old; grossly unfair is possible, but not grossly hot. A good
dictionary will give information about the most common combinations.
6 comparatives
Different modifiers are used for comparatives. Compare:
- It's very cold. (NOT It's (very) much cold.)
It's (very) much colder than yesterday. (NOT It's very colder than yesterday
- The book's quite interesting.
The book's a lot more interesting than his last one.
(NOT ... quite more interesting.) For full details of the modification of comparatives and superlatives, see
139.
page 144
uegroc {.L,). muumcaiiuii ui nouns 134
7 non-gradable adjectives and adverbs
With non-gradable words, certain modifiers are used to stress the idea of completeness or to emphasise
the meaning of the adjective or adverb.
I'm completely exhausted. The talk was absolutely brilliant.
He played really superbly.
Two minutes ago he was fast asleep, now he's wide awake. Quite is used with non-gradable words to
mean 'completely'.
The soup's not quite ready.
See also the individual entries on too, enough, quite etc.
154 degree (2): modification of nouns
1 gradable nouns
Some nouns can be used gradably in descriptions, rather like adjectives. She's a great nuisance. (= She's
very annoying.) The meeting was a relative success. (=... relatively successful)
2 quite/rather a...
Singular countable gradable nouns can be modified by quite or rather before the article.
She's quite/rather a nuisance. It was quite/rather a success. Note that this structure is not possible with
uncountable or plural nouns. We would not say, for example, It was quite luxury or They're rather fools.
For more information about quite, see 467. For rather, see 468.
3 quantifiers with of
Another way of modifying a description is to use a quantifier with of before a singular countable noun.
How much of a mathematician are you?
He's very much of a family man.
Between ourselves, I think she's a bit of a fool.
It was more of a meeting than a party.
She's less of a scientist than a technologist.
It's not much of a place, but it's home. A lot is not used in this structure.
She's very much of an intellectual.
(BUT NOT She's a lot of an intellectual.) This structure, too, is only used with singular countable nouns.
One could not say How much of mathematicians arc they?
For more information about the use of quantifiers, see the entries on individual words.
4 such
Such (see 543) can emphasise gradable nouns. It can be used with singular and plural countables and
with uncountables.
You 've been such a help! They're such idiots!.
Don't talk such nonsense!
For such + adjective + noun, see 543.3,544.1.
page 145


5 ^Mi'tewithnon-gradables
Quite (but not rather) can be used with singular countable non-gradable nouns to express the idea that
something is remarkable or impressive. She's quite a girl! It was quite a journey! That's quite a car! We
had quite a thunderstorm last night!
5 degree (3): modification of verbs
1 gradable verbs

Some verbs are 'gradable' - they refer to things that can happen more or less completely, fully, strongly
etc. Various degree adverbs can be used with <, . verbs of this kind. Examples:
I entirely agree. She very much dislikes fish. The boss quite enjoyed the party. He half believed her story.
I didn't at all want this to happen. This weather kind of gets on my nerves. She's grown a lot since I last
saw her. His letter annoyed me a great deal.
Certain degree adverbs generally go together with certain verbs. For example, we can say I fully
understand, but not -S-futty like; I rather like, but not I rather understand; I firmly believe, but not I firmly
think. A good dictionary will give information about the most common combinations.
In a formal style, much can be used without very before certain verbs in mid-position (e.g. I much admire,
we much regret), but not before all verbs in affirmative clauses (/ much like is very unnatural). In end
position, much is not used without very in affirmative clauses.
I like your new dress very much. (B u T N o T I like your new dress much.)
For more about the use of much, see 348.
questions
Questions about degree are asked with how much.
How much do you want a Christmas holiday? But how is used with adjectives.
How old are your parents? And how much of a is used before singular countable nouns.
How much of a job would it be to rebuild the garage?
word order
Quite, half, kind o/and sort o/usually go in mid-position (see examples above). Many other common
degree adverbs can go either in mid-position or at the end of a clause. Longer and less common
expressions usually go at the end. Adverbs do not normally go between a verb and its object. / very much
like skiing. OR I like skiing very much.
(NOT / like very much skiing.) We enjoyed the party enormously.
(NOT We enjoyed enormously the party.)
For more details of the position of adverbs, see 22-23.
156 degree (4): modification of other words
1 prepositions and particles
Before prepositions and adverb particles referring to place and movement, we often use right to mean
'completely' or 'exactly*.
I hit the target right in the middle.
We drove right up to Washington in two days.
For the difference between prepositions and adverb particles, see 19.
2 quantifiers
Much, many, little and few can be modified by too, so, as, very, rather and how. (Very much and very
many are mostly used in questions and negatives:
see 348.)
There's too much noise.
How many people do you need to help you?
We've got very little time left.
We met rather few people who spoke English. A lot can be modified by quite and rather.
His firm does quite a lot of business in Egypt.
You made rather a lot of mistakes. Quite a few is used with a similar meaning to 'rather a lot'.
He speaks quite a few languages.
Too much/many/little/few can be modified by much, far and rather, but not by quite.
We bought much too much meat.
There are far too many weapons in the world.
I've been on rather too many planes and trains recently.
(NOT ... quite too many...) Enough can be modified by quite (meaning 'fully').
You 've had quite enough to drink.
For modification of more and less, see 139.
For more information about much, many, few, little, quite, rather and enough, see the entries for these
words.
157 determiners
1 What are determiners?
Determiners are words like the, a, my, this, some, either, every, enough,
several. Determiners come at the beginning of noun phrases, but they are"
not adjectives.
the moon this house every week
a nice day some problems enough trouble
my fat old cat either arm several young students
There are two main groups of determiners.
page 146
page 147


Group A determiners
These help to identify things - to say whether they are known or unknown to the hearer, which one(s) the
speaker is talking about, whether the speaker is thinking of particular examples or speaking in general,
etc.
articles: a/an, the
possessives: my, your, his, her, its, our, your, their, one's, whose
demonstratives: this, these, that, those
We cannot put two Group A determiners together. We can say the house, my house or this house, but not
the my house, the this house, this my house or my this house. In order to put together the meanings of
possessive and article/demonstrative, we have to use the structure a/this... of mine/yours etc (see 434).
Nouns with possessive 's can be used like determiners (e.g. Britain's weather).
For articles, see 62-69.
For possessives, see 433.
For demonstratives, see 565.
For articles with noun + possessive 's, see 432.
Group B determiners
Most of these are 'quantifiers': they say how much or how many we are talking about.
some, any, no
each, every, either, neither
much, many, more, most; (a) little, less, least; a few, fewer, fewest, enough; several • '"• •"
all, both, half
what, whatever, which, whichever
one, two, three etc; other
Some Group B determiners are used with singular nouns (e.g. each}, some with plurals (e.g. many), some
with uncountables (e.g. much), and some with more than one kind of noun (e.g. which).
We can put two Group B determiners together if the combination makes sense.
We meet every few days.
I've read all six novels by Jane Austen.
Have you got any more coffee?
For details of the use of Group B determiners, look up the sections on particular words.
Group B + Group A: of with determiners
Group B determiners can be used directly before nouns, without of.
Have you got any sugar? (NOT .. .any of sugar.)
Most people agree with me. (NOT Most of people...) But if we want to put a Group B determiner before a
noun which has a Group A determiner (article, possessive or demonstrative), we have to use of.
page 148
determiners 157
whichdiscs
which of your discs
enough remarks
enough of those remarks
six green apples
six of the green apples
Compare:
- some people some of the people
- each child
each of my children
- neither door
neither of these doors
- most shops most of the shops
Of can be used directly before a noun with no Group A determiner in a few cases. This happens with
proper nouns such as place names, and sometimes with uncountable nouns that refer to the whole of a
subject or activity.
Most of Wales was without electricity last night.
Much of philosophy is concerned with questions that have no answers. No and every are not used before
of; instead we use none and every one. Compare:
- no friends - every blouse
none of my friends every one of these blouses We can leave out of after all, both and half when they are
followed by nouns (but not when they are followed by pronouns).
all (of) his ideas
both (of) my parents
half (of) her income
BUT all Of US (NOT ^IUS)
Note that when each, every, either and neither are used directly before nouns without of, the nouns are
singular. Compare:
- each tree - neither partner
each of the trees neither of the partners
5 determiner + o/+ pronoun
Group B determiners can also be used with of before pronouns.
neither of them
which of us
mostofyou
6 Group A + Group B
Certain Group B determiners can be used after Group A determiners.
They are many, most, little, least wad. few.
his many friends these few poems the least time the most money a little time a few questions
For the difference between little and a little, and between few and a few, see 322.
7 ,• other determiners
There are a few other determiners that do not fit into Groups A and B. They are other, such, what (in
exclamations) and only. Other and only come after Group A determiners (.another is written as one word);
such and what come before the article a/an (see 544.1,69.14).
my other sister such a nice day
the only possibility what a pity *'
page 149


mirereni i5B
Other and SMC/! can also come after some Group B determiners. many other problems most such
requests
for more information about other, see 53. For such, see 543. For only, see 394.
8 determiners without nouns
Nouns that have already been mentioned are often dropped after determiners.
'Do you know Orwell's books?' 'I haven't read any.'
'Have we got any tomatoes?' 'A few.'
'Which chair do you want?' 'This will do.' Plural determiners are sometimes used without nouns to refer to
people in general. This is formal and generally rather old-fashioned.
Many are called but few are chosen. (The Bible)
Some say one thing, some say another.
OPEN MEETING NEXT TUESDAY EVENING. ALL (ARE) WELCOME. Possessives (except whose and
his) have different forms when they are used without nouns: mine, yours, hers, ours, theirs (see 433).
Compare:
That's my coat. That's mine. Its and one's are not used without nouns. (See 433.3.)
For others meaning 'other people', see 53.4. For all meaning everything, see 34.2.
For expressions like a lot of, a heap of, the majority of, see 326.
For more information about particular determiners, consult the entries for the individual
words (see Index). For singular and plural verbs after any, either, neither and none, see 509.5.
158 different
1 modifiers
Different is a little like a comparative (see 136,139): unlike most adjectives, it can be modified by any and
no, little and not much.
I hadn't seen her for years, but she wasn't any different.
'How's the patient, doctor?' 'No different.'
His ideas are little different from those of his friends.
The new school isn't much different from the old one. Quite different means 'completely different' (see
467.4).
/ thought you'd be like your sister, but you're quite different. Unlike comparatives, different can also be
modified by very.
She's very different from her sister.
2 prepositions
From is generally used after different; many British people also use to. In American English, than is
common.
American football is very different from/to soccer.
(US... differentfrom/than soccer.) Before a clause, different than is possible in British English.
The job's different than I expected. if (OR ... differentfrom/to what I expected.)
159 discourse markers
For the difference between different and other, see 53.5.
page 150
Discourse means 'pieces of language longer than a sentence'. Some words and expressions are used to
show how discourse is constructed. They can show the connection between what a speaker is saying and
what has already been said or what is going to be said; they can help to make clear the structure of what
is being said; they can indicate what speakers think about what they are saying or what others have said.
There are a very large number of these 'discourse markers', and it is impossible to give a complete list in a
few pages. Here are a few of the most common examples. Some of these words and expressions have
more than one use; for more information, look in a good dictionary. Some discourse markers are used
mostly in informal speech or writing; others are more common in a formal style. Note that a discourse
marker usually comes at the beginning of a clause.
1 focusing and linking
a with reference to; talking! speaking ofl about; regarding; as regards;
as far as... is concerned; as for
These expressions focus attention on what is going to be said, by announcing the subject in advance.
Some of them also make a link with previous discourse, by referring back to what was said before.
With reference to is a very formal expression used mainly at the beginning of business letters.
With reference to your letter ofl 7 March, lam pleased to inform you
that...
Speaking/talking of/about... is used to make a link with what has just been said. It can help a speaker to
change the subject.
'I saw Max and Lucy today. You know, she -' 'Talking of Max, did you know
he's going to Australia?' Regarding can come at the beginning of a piece of discourse.
Hello, John. Now look, regarding those sales figures -1 really don't think... As regards and as far as... is
concerned usually announce a change of subject by the speaker/writer.
... there are no problems about production. Now as regards marketing...
... about production. As far as marketing is concerned, I think the best
thing is...
People sometimes leave out is concerned after as far as... This is usually considered incorrect.
As far as the new development plan, I think we ought to be very careful. As for often suggests lack of
interest or dislike.
I've invited Andy, Bob and Mark. As for Stephen, I don't care if I never see him again in my life.
2 balancing contrasting points
n on the other hand; while; whereas
These expressions are used to balance two facts or ideas that contrast, but do not contradict each other.
Arranged marriages are common in many Middle Eastern countries. In the West, on the other hand, they
are unusual. ^
page 151


U1SL-UWZOC ItlW.KCS.V •
I like spending my holidays in the mountains, while/whereas my wife prefers the seaside.
While and whereas can be put before the first of the contrasting points. While/Whereas some languages
have 30 or more different vowel sounds, others have five or less.
For a comparison of on the other hand and on the contrary, see 145.
3 emphasising a contrast
a however; nevertheless; mind you; still; yet; in spite of this
However and nevertheless emphasise the fact that the second point contrasts with the first. Nevertheless
is very formal.
Britain came last in the World Children's Games again. However, we did have one success, with Annie
Smith's world record in the egg and spoon race.
Mind you (less formal) and still introduce the contrasting point as an afterthought.
I don't like the job much. Mind you/Still, the money's OK. Yet, still and in spite of this can be used to
suggest that something is surprising, in view of what was said before.
He says he's a socialist, and yet he owns three houses and drives a Rolls. The train was an hour late. In
spite of this, I managed to get to the meeting in time. (o R ... / still managed to get...)
For other meanings of yet, see 539.
4 similarity
u similarly; in the same way
These are most common in a formal style.
The roads are usually very crowded at the beginning of the holiday season.
Similarly, there are often serious traffic jams at the end of the holidays. James Carter did everything he
could to educate his children. In the same
way, they in turn put a high value on their own children's education.
5 concession and counter-argument
n concession: it is true; of course; certainly; if; may; stressed do b counter-argument: however; even so;
but; nevertheless; nonetheless; all the same; still
These expressions are used in a three-part structure: (1) the speaker/writer mentions facts that point in a
certain direction; (2) it is agreed (the concession) that a particular contradictory fact points the other way;
(3) but the speaker/writer dismisses this and returns to the original direction of argument.
... cannot agree with colonialism. It is true that the British may have done
some good in India. Even so, colonialism is basically evil. ... incapable of lasting relationships with women.
Certainly, several
women loved him, and he was married twice. All the same, the women
closest to him were invariably deeply unhappy.
page 152
discourse marKers i5
Very few people understood Einstein's theory. Of course, everybody had
heard of him, and a fair number of people knew the word 'relativity'.
But hardly anybody could tell you what he had actually said. It was a successful party. The Scottish
cousins, if a little surprised by the
family's behaviour, were nonetheless impressed by the friendly welcome
they received. I'm glad to have a place of my own. It's true it's a bit small and it's a long
way from the centre and it does need a lot of repairs done. Still, it's
home.
For other uses of still, see 539. For other uses of of course, see 386.
6 contradicting
[: on the contrary
On the contrary can be used to contradict a suggestion made by another speaker.
'Interesting lecture?' 'On the contrary, it was a complete waste of time.' The expression can also be used
when a speaker/writer strengthens a negative statement which he / she has just made.
She did not allow the accident to discourage her. On the contrary, she began to work twice as hard.
For a comparison of on the contrary and on the other hand, see 145.
7 dismissal of previous discourse
i anyway; anyhow; at any rate; at least
These expressions can be used to mean 'What was said before doesn't matter -the main point is as
follows'. ,
I'm not sure what time I'll arrive, maybe half past seven or a quarter to eight. Anyway/Anyhow/At any rate,
I'll certainly be there before eight o'clock. What a terrible experience! Anyway/Anyhow/At any rate, you're
safe,
that's the main thing.
At least can suggest that one thing is certain or all right, even if everything else is unsatisfactory. '
The car's completely smashed up-I don't know what we're going to do.
At least nobody was hurt.
Note that anyway is not the same as in any way, which means 'by any method'. Can I help you in any
way?
8 change of subject
^ by the way; incidentally; right; all right, now; OK
By the way and incidentally are used to introduce something one has just thought of that is not directly
connected with the conversation.
/ was talking to Phil yesterday. Oh, by the way, he sends you his regards.
Well, he thinks... Janet wants to talk to you about advertising. Incidentally, she's lost
a lot of weight. Anyway, it seems the budget... ^
page 153


discourse markers 159
These two expressions can also be used to change the subject completely. 'Freddy's had another crash.'
'Oh, yes? Poor old chap. By the way, have you
heard from Joan recently?' 'Lovely sunset.'Ves, isn't it? Oh, incidentally, what happened to that bike
I lent you?'
(All) right, now and OAT are often used by teachers, lecturers and people giving instructions, to indicate
that a new section of the discourse is starting. Any questions? Right, let's have a word about tomorrow's
arrangements. Now, I'd like to say something about the exam...
Is that all clear? OK, now has anybody ever wondered why it's impossible to tickle yourself?...
9 return to previous subject
D as I was saying
This is used to return to an earlier subject after an interruption or a brief change of subject.
...on the roof-Jeremy, put the cat down, please. As I was saying, if Jack gets up on the roof and looks at
the tiles...
10 structuring
D first(ly), first of all, second(ly), thirdly) etc; lastly; finally; to begin with; to start with; in the
first/second/third place; for one thing; for another thing
We use these to show the structure of what we are saying.
First(ly), we need somewhere to live. Second(ly), we need to find work. And
third(ly),... There are three reasons why I don't want to dance with you. To start with,
my feet hurt. For another thing, you can't dance. And thirdly,... Note that firstly, secondly etc are more
formal than first, second etc, and are more common in British than American English.
For at first, see 83. For at last, see 210.
11 adding
n moreover (very formal); furthermore (formal); in addition; as wellas that;
on top of that (informal); another thing is; what is more; besides; in any case
These expressions can be used to add information or arguments to what has already been said.
The Prime Minister is un willing to admit that he can ever be mistaken.
Moreover, he is totally incapable... The peasants are desperately short of food. In addition, they urgently
need
doctors and medical supplies. She borrowed my bike and never gave it back. And as well as that/on top
of that, she broke the lawnmowerand then pretended she hadn't. Besides and in any case can add an
extra, more conclusive fact or argument. What are you trying to get a job as a secretary for? You'd never
manage to work eight hours a day. Besides/In any case, you can't type.
For besides as a preposition, see 101.
page 154
12 generalising
.] on the whole; in general; in all/most/many/some cases; broadly speaking;
by and large; to a great extent; to some extent; apart from...; except for...
These expressions say how far the speaker/writer thinks a generalisation
is true.
On the whole, I had a happy childhood.
In general, we are satisfied with the work.
Broadly speaking, teachers are overworked and underpaid.
To a great extent, a person's character is formed by the age of eight.
In most cases, people will be nice to you if you are nice to them.
Apart from and except for introduce exceptions to generalisations. (For more
information, see 101.)
Apart from the starter, I thought the meal was excellent. Except for Sally, they all seemed pretty sensible.
13 giving examples
D for instance; for example; e.g.; in particular
These expressions introduce particular examples to illustrate what has been said.
People often behave strangely when they're abroad. Take Mrs Ellis, for
example I for instance,...
In writing, the abbreviation e.g. (Latin exempli gratia), pronounced /i: 'dsi:/, is often used to mean 'for
example'.
Some common minerals, e.g. silica or olivine,... In particular focuses on a special example.
We are not at all happy with the work you did on the new kitchen. In particular, we consider that the quality
of wood used for the cupboards...
14 logical consequence
a therefore (formal); as a result (formal); consequently (formal); so; then
These expressions show that what is said follows logically from what was said before.
She was therefore unable to avoid an unwelcome marriage.
So she had to get married to a man she didn't like.
'The last bus has gone.' "Then we're going to have to walk.' Therefore is used in logical, mathematical and
scientific proofs.
Therefore 2x - 15 = 17y + 6.
So is often used as a general-purpose connector, rather like and, in spoken narrative.
So anyway, this man came up to me and said 'Have you got a light?' So I told him no, I hadn't. So he
looked at me and...
For other uses of so, see 513-517. '
page 155


15 making things clear; giving details
c / mean; actually; that is to say; in other words
We use I mean when we are going to make things clearer, or give more details.
It was a terrible evening. I mean, they all sat round and talked politics
for hours.
Actually can introduce details, especially when these are unexpected. Tommy's really stupid. You know,
he actually still believes in Father
Christmas.
That is to say and in other words are used when the speaker/writer says something again in another way.
- We cannot continue with the deal on this basis. That is to say/In other words, unless you can bring down
the price we shall have to cancel the order.
For more information about I mean, see 339. For more about actually, see below and 11.
16 softening and correcting
D / think; I feel; I reckon (informal); I guess (American); in my view/opinion (formal); apparently; so to
speak; more or less; sort of (informal); kind of (informal); well; really; that is to say; at least; I'm afraid; I
suppose;
or rather; actually; I mean
I thinki feel/reckon/guess and in my view/opinion are used to make opinions and statements sound less
dogmatic - they suggest that the speaker is just giving a personal opinion, with which other people may
disagree.
Ithlnkyou oughtto try again. I really feel she's makinga mistake.
I reckon/guess she just doesn't respect you, Bill.
In my view/opinion, it would be better to postpone the decision until
the autumn.
Apparently can be used to say that the speaker has got his/her information from somebody else (and
perhaps does not guarantee that it is true).
Have you heard? Apparently Susie's pregnant again. So to speak, more or less and sort/kind of we used
to show that one is not speaking very exactly, or to soften something which might upset other people. Well
and really can also be used to soften.
I sort of think we ought to start going home, perhaps, really.
I kind of think it's more or less a crime.
'Do you like it?"Well, yes, it's all right.' , That is to say and at least can be used to 'back down' from
something too strong or definite that one has said.
I'm not working for you again. Well, that's to say, not unless you put my wages up.
Ghosts don't exist. At least, I've never seen one. ''• I'm afraid is apologetic: it can introduce a polite refusal,
or bad news.
I'm afraid I can't help you. I'm afraid I forgot to buy the stamps. I suppose can be used to enquire politely
about something (respectfully inviting an affirmative answer). ,
I suppose you're very busy just at the moment?
page 156
discourse marKers l5
It can also be used to suggest unwilling agreement.
'Can you help me fora minute?' 'I suppose so.' Or rather is used to correct oneself.
I'm seeing him in May - or rather early June. I mean can be used to correct or soften.
Let's meet next Monday -1 mean Tuesday.
She's not very nice. I mean, I know some people like her, but...
For more information about afraid, see 25. For more information about sort of and kind of, see 526. For
actually in corrections, see paragraph 20 below and 11. See also 161 for 'distancing' structures.
17 gaining time
D letmesee; let'ssee; well; you know; I don't know; I mean; kind of; sort of
Expressions of this kind (often called 'fillers') give the speaker time to think. 'How much are you selling it
for?' 'Well, letmesee...' 'Why did you do that?' 'Oh, well, you know, I don't know, really, I mean, it just sort
of seemed a good idea.'
18 showing one's attitude to what one is saying
D honestly; frankly; no doubt
Honestly can be used to claim that one is speaking sincerely.
Honestly, I never said a word to him about the money. Both honestly and frankly can introduce critical
remarks.
Honestly, John, why do you have to be so rude?
'What do you think of my hair?' 'Frankly, dear, it's a disaster.' No doubt (see 370) suggests that the
speaker/writer thinks something is probable, but does not know for certain himself/ herself.
iVo doubt the Romans enjoyed telling jokes, just like us.
19 persuading
^ after all; look; look here; no doubt
After all suggests 'this is a strong argument that you haven't taken into consideration'. Look is more
strongly persuasive.
/ think we should let her go on holiday alone. After all, she is fifteen - she's not a child any more.
You can't go there tomorrow. Look, the trains aren't running. Look here is an angry exclamation meaning
'You can't say/ do that!'
Look here! What are you doing with my suitcase? No doubt can be used to persuade people politely to do
things.
No doubtyou'll be payingyour rent soon?
For more information about after all, see 28.
20 referring to the other person's expectations ,
a actually (especially GB); in fact; as a matter of fact; to tell the truth; well
These expressions are used when we show whether somebody's expectations have been fulfilled or not.
Actually can be used to say that >
page 157


somebody 'guessed right'.
'Did you enjoy your holiday?' "Very much, actually.' Actually, in fact and as a matter of fact can introduce
additional information.
The weather was awful. Actually, the campsite got flooded and we had to come home.
'Was the concert nice?' 'Yes, as a matter of fact it was terrific.' 'Did you meet the Minister?' 'Yes. In fact, he
asked us to lunch.'
All four expressions are used when we say that the hearer's expectations
were not fulfilled.
'How was the holiday?' 'Well, actually, we didn't go.'
'How much were the carrots?' 'Well, in fact/to tell the truth, I forgot to buy them.'
'I hope you passed the exam.' 'No, as a matter of fact, I didn't.' Actually is often used to introduce
corrections.
'Hello, John.' 'Actually, my name's Philip.' Well can soften corrections, suggesting 'That's nearly right'.
'You live in Oxford, don't you?' 'Well, near Oxford.' After a new subject has been announced, well can
suggest that something new or surprising is going to be said about it.
'What did you think of her new boyfriend?' 'Well, I was a bit surprised,...'
You know that house we were looking at? Well, you'll never guess who's bought it.
For more information about actually, see 11.
21 summing up
a in conclusion; to sum up; briefly; in short
These expressions are most common in a formal style.
...In conclusion, then, we can see that Britain's economic problems were mainly due to lack of industrial
investment.
To sum up: most of the committee members supported the idea but a few were against it.
He's lazy, he's ignorant and he's stupid. In short, he's useless.
160 disinterested
Disinterested is used to say that a person has no reason to support one side or another in a disagreement
or negotiation, because he/she will not get any advantage if one side wins.
I can't give you disinterested advice, because I'm a colleague of your employer.
Disinterested is also commonly used to mean 'uninterested'. Some'people consider this incorrect.
I'm quite disinterested in politics.
161 distancing
Certain structures can be used to make a speaker's requests, questions
or statements seem less direct, more 'distant' from reality (and therefore more polite).
page 158
1 requests and statements as yes/no questions
We usually make requests less direct by putting them in the form of yes/no
questions. This suggests that the hearer can choose whether to agree or not. Couldyou tell me the time,
please? (much more polite than Please tell me the time.)
Expressions of opinion can also be made less direct by turning them into
questions. Compare:
It would be better to paint it green, (direct expression of opinion) Wouldn't it be better to paint it green?
(persuasive question-less direct) Would it be better to paint it green? (open question - very indirect)
2 distancing verb forms
We can make requests (and also questions, suggestions and statements) even less direct (and so more
polite) by using verb forms that suggest 'distance' from the immediate present reality. Past tenses are
often used to do this.
How much did you want to spend, sir?
(meaning 'How much do you want to spend?') - How many days did you intend to stay? (meaning'... do
you intend...')
I wondered if you were free this evening. Progressive forms can be used in the same way. They sound
more casual and less definite than simple forms, because they suggest something temporary and
incomplete.
I'm hoping you can lend me L10. (less definite than I hope...)
What time are you planning to arrive? (more casual-sounding than Please let us know what time you plan
to arrive.)
I'm looking forward to seeingyou again. (more casual than I look forward...)
I'm afraid we must be going. Past progressives give two levels of distancing.
Good morning. I was wondering if you had two single rooms.
Were you looking for anything special? (in a shop)
/ was thinking - what about borrowing Jake's car? Another way to distance something is to displace it into
the future. Will need/have to can be used to soften instructions and orders.
I'm afraid you'll need to fill in this form. '•
I'll have to ask you to wait a minute. And will is sometimes used to say how much money is owed.
That will be L1.65, please.
Future progressive verbs are often used to enquire politely about people's plans (see 225).
Will you be going away at the weekend?
3 would, could and might
The modal verbs would, could and might also make questions, requests and suggestions less direct.
I thought it would be nice to have a picnic.
Hi! I thought I'd come over and introduce myself. My name's Andy. >
page 159


Could you give me a hand? Could I ask you to translate this for me? We could ask Peter to help us.
I was wondering if you might be interested in a game of tennis. 'I came in and ordered some shoes from
you.' 'Oh yes, sir. When would that have been, exactly?'
Would is very often used to form requests and offers with verbs like like and prefer.
What would you like to drink?
Note the common use of would before verbs of saying and thinking, to make a statement sound less
definite.
I would say we'd do better to catch the earlier train. This is what I would call annoying. I would think we
might stop for lunch soon.
I'm surprised you didn 't like the film. I would have thought it was just your kind of thing.
4 conditional and negative expressions
Another way of distancing suggestions from reality is to make them conditional or negative.
It would be better if we turned it the other way up.
What if we stayed at home for a change?
Suppose I gave Alice a call?
If you would come this way...
I wonder if you could lend me L5?
I don't suppose you want to buy a car, do you? .
You wouldn't like to come out with us, by any chance?
5 softening expressions etc
A further form of distancing is the use of softening expressions like quite, kind of etc. And yet another is to
talk about planning or beginning things instead of about actually doing them. The following sentence
(which could easily be heard at an English party) means 'I want to go', but distances the message in six
different ways.
I'd quite like to sort of start thinking about going, so to speak.
6 one
In middle- and upper-class British speech, one is sometimes used instead of I or we. This makes a
statement sound less personally assertive. 'Hello, Charles. How's it going?' 'Oh, one can't complain.'
For more information about requests, see 483.
For more about the different structures discussed here, consult the various entries elsewhere in the book
(see Index for references).
page 160
162 do (I): introduction
Do has three main uses.
1 auxiliary verb
The auxiliary do is used with the infinitives of other verbs mainly to form emphatic, interrogative, negative
and shortened verb forms. For details,
see 163.
I do like your ear-rings. Did you remember to post my letters?
This doesn't taste very nice.
'That carpet needs cleaning.' 'Yes, it certainly does.'
2 general-purpose verb
Do is also an ordinary (non-auxiliary) verb. It can refer to almost any kind of activity, and is used when it is
not necessary or not possible to be more precise. For details, and the difference between do and make,
see 164.
What are you doing? Don't just stand there. Dosomething.
I've finished the phone calls, and I'll do the letters tomorrow.
He would rather talk about things than do them.
All I did was give him a little push.
3 substitute verb
In British English, do can be used alone as a substitute for a main verb after an auxiliary. For details, see
165.
'Do you think Phil will come?' 'He might do.' (US 'He might.') Do sol it/that can be used as a substitute
expression when we want to avoid repeating another verb and what follows. For details, see 166.
I am ready to have a nervous breakdown, and I shall do so as soon as I can find time.
He told me to open the door. I did it as quietly as I could.
4 combined forms
Auxiliary do and non-auxiliary do can occur together. Do you do much gardening? How do you do? The
company didn't do very well last year. She doesn't do much, but what she does do, she does very well.
163 do (2): auxiliary verb
The auxiliary verb do is used in a number of ways.
1 questions .
We use do to make questions with ordinary verbs, but not with other
auxiliary verbs (see 461). Compare: ,-. Do you like football? (NOT Like you football?) Can you play
football? (NOT Do you can play football?)
The auxiliary do can also be used to make questions with the ordinary
verb do.
What do you do in the evenings?
page 161


2 negatives
We use do to make negative clauses with ordinary verbs (including the ordinary verb do), but not with
other auxiliary verbs (see 358). Compare:
I don't like football. (NOT/ like not football.)
I can't play football. (NOT I don't can play football.)
I don't do much in the evenings. Don't go.
3 emphasis
We can use do in an affirmative clause for emotive or contrastive emphasis (see 189).
Do sit down. You do look nice today! She thinks I don't love her, but I do love her.
I don't take much exercise now, but I did play football a lot when I was "'' younger.
4 inversion
Do is used in some inversion (verb before subject) structures (see 298). At no time did he lose his self-
control.
5 ellipsis
In cases where an auxiliary is used instead of a whole verb phrase (see 185), do is common in affirmative
clauses as well as questions and negatives.
She doesn't like dancing, but I do. (=... but I like dancing.)
Ann thinks there's something wrong with Bill, and so do I.
You saw Alan, didn'tyou?
"That meat smells funny.' 'Yes, it does, doesn't it?'
Fordo with be, see 89.
For weak pronunciations of do and does, see 588.
For do in short answers, see 493.
164 do (3): general-purpose verb; do and make
The general-purpose verb do has several uses, and can sometimes be confused with make.
1 do for indefinite activities
We use do when we do not say exactly what activity we are talking about -for example with words like
thing, something, nothing, anything, everything, what.
Then he did a very strange thing. (NOT Then he made a very strange thing.) Do something! I like doing
nothing. (NOT ... making nothing.) What shall we do?
2 do for work
We use do when we talk about work and jobs.
I'm not going to do any work today. It's time to do the accounts. Could you do the shopping for me?
page 162
/ wouldn't like to do your job. Has Ben done his homework? Couldyou do the ironing first, and then do the
windows if you've got time?
3 do.. .ing
We use do in the informal structure do.. .ing, to talk about activities that take a certain time, or are
repeated (for example jobs and hobbies). There is usually a determiner (e.g. the, my, some, much) before
the -ing form.
During the holidays I'm going to do some walking, some swimming and a lot of reading.
Let yourfingers do the walking, (advertisement for telephone shopping) Note that the verb after do cannot
have an object in this structure.
I'm going to watch some TV. (NOT I'm going to do some watching TV.) However, do is often followed by a
compound noun that corresponds to verb + object.
/ want to do some bird-watching this weekend.
It's time I did some letter-writing.
4 make for constructing, creating etc
We often use make to talk about constructing, building, creating etc. I've just made a cake. Let's make a
plan. My father and I once made a boat.
5 do instead of make
We sometimes use do in place of make in order to sound casual about a creative activity - as if we are not
claiming to produce any very special results.
'What shall we eat?' 'Well, I could do an omelette.'
6 common fixed expressions
do good, harm, business, one's best, a favour, sport, exercise, one's hair, one's teeth, one's duty, 50 mph
make a journey, an offer, arrangements, a suggestion, a decision, an attempt, an effort, an excuse, an
exception, a mistake, a noise, a phone call, money, a profit, a fortune, love, peace, war, a bed, afire,
progress
Note that we say make a bed, but we often talk about doing the bed(s) as part
of housework. Compare:
He's old enough to make his own bed now. I'll start on the vegetables as soon as I've done the beds.
We use take, not make, in take a photo, and have, not make, in have an
(interesting) experience.
For more information about make, see 327.
page 163


165
do (4): substitute verb
auxiliary verb + do
In British English (but not American), do can be used alone as a substitute
verb after an auxiliary verb.
'Come and stay with us."Imay (do), ifI have the time.' (US 'I may, if...') 'He's supposed to have locked the
safe.' 'He has (done).' (US 'He has.') I found myself thinking of her as I had never done before. He didn 't
pass his exam, but he could have (done) if he'd tried harder. He smokes more than he used to (do).
Progressive forms are possible, but not very common. 'You should be getting dressed.' 'I am (doing).'
Note that the auxiliary verb is stressed in this structure. 'Close the door.' 'I HAVE done.' (NOT ... 'I have
DONE.')
For auxiliary do as substitute for a whole verb phrase, see 185. For other kinds of substitution, see 542.
166 do so/it/that
1 do so
The expression do so can sometimes be used to avoid repeating a verb and
its object or complement. It is usually rather formal. 'Put the car away, please.' 'I've already done so.'
Eventually she divorced Stephen. It was a pity she had not done so earlier. He told me to get out, and I did
so as quietly as possible.
2 do so and do it/that
Do it and do that can be used instead of do so.
/ promised to get the tickets, and I will do so/it as soon as possible.
She rode a camel: she had never done so/that before. We use do so mainly to refer to the same action,
with the same subject, that was mentioned before. In other cases we prefer do it/that or do alone.
I haven't got time to get the tickets. Who's going to do it? (NOT ... Who's going to do so?)
'I rode a camel in Morocco.' 'I'd love to do that. '(NOT.. . to do so.)
I always eat peas with honey. My wife never does. (NOT ... My wife never docs so.)
3 do so/it/that: deliberate actions
Do so/it/that are mainly used to refer to deliberate dynamic actions. We do not usually use these
expressions to replace verbs like/a/;, lose, like, remember, think, own, which refer to involuntary actions or
states. / like the saxophone, and I always have (done).
(NOT ... and I have-always done so fit/that.) She lost her money. I wasn 't surprised that she did.
(NOT .. .-that she did so/it/that.) They think Jake's wrong, and I do too. (N o T .. .and I do so fit/that too.)
page 164
dress 168
4 other verbs
Note that so, it and that are not normally used in this way after auxiliary verbs. It is not possible in
standard English to say I can so. She was it or I have that.
Fortheuseofsoafterf/HTifc, believe, hope and similar verbs, see 515.
For so after say and tell, see 514.
For so do I, so am I etc, see 516.
For auxiliary do as substitute for a whole verb phrase, see 185.
For other kinds of substitution, see 542.
For differences between it and that, see 566.
167 doubt
Clauses after the verb doubt can be introduced by whether, if or that.
Economists doubt whether interest rates will fall in the near future. '•* 11 J
I doubt if she'll come this evening.
The directors doubt that new machinery is really necessary. In an informal style, some people use no
conjunction.
/ doubt we'll have enough money for a holiday. After negative forms of. doubt, we use that.
I don't doubt that there will be more problems.
For no doubt meaning 'probably', see 370.
168 dress /
1 noun
The countable noun dress means an article of women's clothing (it goes from the shoulders to below the
hips).
This is the first time I've seen you wearing a dress. There is also an uncountable noun dress (not used
with the article a/an). It means 'clothing', 'clothes'. It is not very common in modern English, and is used
mostly to talk about special kinds of clothing (for example national dress, evening dress, battledress).
He looks good in evening dress. (NOT ... in an evening dress.)
2 verb: putting clothes on
The verb dress can be used to talk about putting clothes on oneself or somebody else. Undress is used
for taking clothes off.
It only takes me five minutes to dress in the morning.
Could you dress the children for me?
I'm going to undress in front of the fire. In informal English, it is common to use get dressed to talk about
dressing oneself.
Get dressed and come downstairs at once! Put on and take efface generally used when clothes are
mentioned.
I put on a sweater when I got up, but it was so warm that I had to take it qffagain.
Can you take John's boots off for him? ^
page 165


3 verb: wearing clothes
To say what somebody is/was wearing on a particular occasion, we can use the form be dressed in (note
the preposition).
I didn 't recognise him because he was dressed, in a dark suit. (NOT ... drcsscd-with... OR ... dressing
in...)
She was dressed in orange pyjamas.
Be wearing is also very common in British English; have on is more usual in American English.
She was wearing orange pyjamas. (GB)
She had on orange pajamas. (US) The active form dress (in) can be used to give the idea of repetition or
habit.
She always dresses in green. He dresses well. Note also the expression well dressed.
169 drown
In British English, both active and passive forms of drown can be used to talk
about accidental drowning.
He (was) drowned while trying to swim across a river.
In American English, only active forms are used to talk about accidental
drowning. Compare:
He drowned while trying to swim across a river. The police believe he was drowned in a gangland revenge
killing.
170 due to and owing to
Due to and owing to both mean 'because of. Phrases beginning due/owing to are often separated from the
rest of their sentence by a comma. Due/Owing to the bad weather(,) the match was cancelled. We have
had to postpone the meetingC) due/owing to the Chairwoman's
illness.
Some people believe it is incorrect to use due to at the beginning of a clause in this way, but the structure
is common in educated usage.
Due to can also follow the verb be. Owing to is not usually used like this. His success was due to his
mother. (NOT ... was owing to his mother.)
For because and because of, see 93.
171 during and for
During is used to say when something happens; for is used to say how long it
lasts. Compare:
My father was in hospital during the summer.
My father was in hospital for six weeks. (NOT ... during six weeks.)
It rained during the night for two or three hours.
I'll call in and see you for a few minutes during the afternoon.
For during and in, see 172. For/or, since, in and from, see 214.
page 166
172 during and in
We use both during and in to say that something happens inside a particular
period of time.
We'll be on holiday during/in August.
I woke up during/in the night. We prefer during when we stress that we are talking about the whole of the
period.
The shop's closed during the whole of August.
(NOT ... in the whole of August.)
We often prefer during when we say that something happens between the beginning and end of an event
or activity (not a period of time). He had some strange experiences during his military service.
(NOT ... in his military service.) • I'll try to phone you during the meeting. (NOT ... in the meeting.) I met
them during my stay in China.
173 each
1 each + singular
Each is a determiner (see 157). We use it before a singular noun. ysach + singular noun
Each new day is different. (NOT Each new days...) I enjoy each moment.
2 each of
We use each o/before a pronoun or a determiner (for example the, my, these -see 157). The pronoun or
noun is plural.
yeach ofus/you/them yifach of + determiner + plural noun
Each of us sees the world differently. I write to each of my children once a week.
A verb after each of... is usually singular, but it can be plural in an informal style. Each of them has
problems. Each of them have problems, {more informal)
3 each in mid-position
When each refers to the subject, it can go with a verb in mid-position, like all, both and some adverbs (see
36,110 and 22). In this case plural nouns, ' pronouns and verbs are used.
auxiliary verb + each are/were + each
They have each been told.
We can each apply for our own membership card.
You are each right in a different way. >
page 167


'VtOch + other verb
We each think the same. The plans each have certain advantages and disadvantages.
4 position with object
Each can follow an object (direct or indirect) as part of a longer structure. / want them each to be happy.
She kissed them each on the forehead. I bought the girls each an ice-cream. She sent them each a
present. (BUT NOT Ihclpcdthom-eaehoK I wrote to them each.)
5 one each etc
Each can follow a noun object in sentences that say how much / many of something each person gets.
They got L20,000 each when their mother died.
I bought the girls two ice-creams each. A similar structure is used in giving prices.
They cost L3.50 each.
6 each without a noun
We can drop a noun and use each alone, if the noun has already been mentioned, but each one or each
of them is more common in an informal style. Note that a following verb is normally singular.
I've got five brothers, and each (one/of them) is quite different from the others.
7 pronouns
When a pronoun or possessive is used later in a clause to refer back to each + noun/pronoun, the later
word can be singular (more formal) or plural (less formal).
Each girl wore what she liked best. (more formal) Each student wore what they liked best. (less formal) / ~
' < Each of them explained it in his/her/their own way.
For the difference between each and every, see 174.
174 each and every: the difference
1 each with two or more; every with three or more
Each and every are both normally used with singular nouns. Each can be used to talk about two or more
people or things; every is normally used to talk about three or more.
The business makes less money each/every year. (NOT ... each/every'yearss) She had a child holding on
to each hand. (NOT ... every hand.)
For expressions like every two years, every three steps, see 509.8.
page 168
"WfHIIHH^each other and one another 17S
2 difference of meaning
In many cases, both each and every can be used without much difference of meaning.
You look more beautiful each/every time I see you. But we prefer each when we are thinking of people or
things separately, one at a time. And every is more common when we are thinking of people or things
together, in a group. (Every is closer to all.) Compare:
Each person in turn went to see the doctor.
He gave every patient the same medicine. We do not use each with words and expressions like almost,
practically, nearly or without exception, which stress the idea of a whole group.
She's lost nearly every friend she had. (NOT.. . nearly each friend...)
For more information about each, see 173. For more information about every, see 199. For the difference
between every and all, see 37. For each other, see 175.
175 each other and one another
1 no difference
In modern English, most people normally use each other and one another in the same way. Perhaps one
another is preferred (like one) when we are making very general statements, and not talking about
particular people. Compare:
They sat for two hours without talking to each other/one another. The translation of'se parler' is 'to talk to
one another'. (More natural than... to talk to each other.)
2 not used as subject
Each other and one another are not normally used as subjects, though this occasionally happens in very
informal speech. They each listened carefully to what the other said.
(NOT USUALLY They listened carefully to what each other said.)
3 each other's I one another's
Both expressions have possessive forms.
They'll sit for hours looking into each other's/one another's eyes.
4 -selves and each other I one another
Note the difference between -selves and each other / one another. Compare:
They talk to themselves a lot. (Each of them talks to himself/herself.) They talk to each other a lot. (Each
talks to the other.)
5 words used without each other
Note that we do not usually use each other after meet, marry and similar. They met in 1992. They married
in 1994. Their interests are very similar.
page 169


> xwriLii diiu iiuzuidirdx/ s.sv
176 east and eastern, north and northern etc
1 adjectives: the difference
We often prefer eastern, northern etc when we are talking about vague, rather indefinite areas, and east,
north etc for more clearly defined places. Compare:
the northern part of the county the north side of the house
However, there are a lot of exceptions to this rule, especially in place names (see below).
2 place names
In place names, the use of East or Eastern, North or Northern etc is often just a matter of custom, with no
real reason for the difference. Compare:
- North/South Korea, North/South Africa, West Virginia, East Sussex, the North and South Poles
- Northern Ireland, Eastern/Western Europe,
the Northern/Southern Hemisphere, Northern Territory (in Australia),
Western Australia
Note the difference between South Africa (the country whose capital is Pretoria) and Southern Africa (the
southern part of the African continent).
3 capital letters
Capital letters are used at the beginning of East, Eastern, North, Northern etc when these come in official
or well-established place names. North Carolina Western Australia the Far East unemployment in the
North (place name meaning 'the North of England')
In other cases, adjectives and nouns normally begin with small letters, as do adverbs.
We spent the winter in southern California.
I live in north London. The sun rises in the east.
There's a strong north wind. By sunrise we were driving south.
4 prepositions
Note the difference between in the north etc of... and to the north etc of...
I live in the west of Scotland. ;;
Hawaii lies 5,500 km to the west of Mexico.
For up meaning 'north' and down meaning 'south', see 576.
177 efficient and effective
If somebody/something is efficient, he / she / it works in a well-organised way without wasting time or
energy.
He's not very efficient: he keeps filing letters in the wrong place, he works
very slowly, and he keeps forgetting things. The postal service is even less efficient than the telephone
system.
page 170
If something is effective, it has the right effect: it solves a problem or gets
a result.
My headache's much better. Those tablets really are effective. I think a wide black belt would look very
effective with that dress.
178 either: determiner
1 either + singular
We use either before a singular noun to mean 'one or the other'. either + singular noun
Come on Tuesday or Thursday. Either day is OK. Sometimes either can mean each, especially in the
expressions on either side and. at either end.
There are roses on either side of the door.
2 either of
We use either of before a pronoun or a determiner (for example the, my, these - see 157).
either ofus/you/them •either of + determiner + plural noun
I don't like either of them. I don't like either of my maths teachers.
A verb after either of is normally singular, but it can sometimes be plural in an informal style, especially in
a negative statement.
Either of the children is quite capable of looking after the baby. ;' ,f,:;
I don't think either of them is/are at home.
3 either without a noun
We can drop a noun that has already been mentioned and use either alone. 'Would you like tea or coffee?
"I don't mind. Either.'
4 pronouns
When a pronoun is used later in a clause to refer back to either +
noun / pronoun, the later pronoun can be singular (more formal) or plural
(more informal).
If either of the boys phones, tell him/them I'll be in this evening.
5 pronunciation
Either is pronounced /'aioa(r)/ or A:8a(r)/ (in American English usually
/'iioar/).
For either... or, see 179. For not... either, neither and nor, see 364.
page 171


179 either... or
We use either... or to talk about a choice between two possibilities (and sometimes more than two).
You can either have tea or coffee.
I don't speak either French or German.
You can either come with me now or walk home.
Either you'll leave this house or I'll call the police.
If you want ice-cream you can have either coffee, lemon or vanilla.
For either as a determiner, see 178.
For pronunciation, see 178.5.
For not... either, neither and nor, see 364.
180 elder and eldest
Elder and eldest can be used instead of older and oldest to talk about the order of birth of the members of
a family. They are only used attributively (before nouns). Compare:
- My elder/older brother has just got married.
He's three years older than me. (NOT ... elder than me.)
- His eldest/oldest daughter is a medical student.
She's the oldest student in her year.
Elder brother/sister are used when a person has only one brother/sister who is older; eldest is used when
there are more. An elder son/daughter is the older of two; an eldest son/daughter is the oldest of two or
more.
181 ellipsis (I): general
In:
We often leave out words to avoid repetition, or in other cases when the meaning can be understood
without them. This is called 'ellipsis'.
1 replies
i replies we usually avoid repeating information that has just been given. 'What time are you coming?'
'About ten.'
(More natural than 'I'm coming about ten.') 'Who said that? "John.'
(More natural than 'John said that.') 'How many chairs do you need?' 'Three.'
(More natural than 'I need three chairs!) 'She's out this evening?' 'Yes, working.' . -
(More natural than 'Yes, she's working this evening.')
For 'short answer' structures, see 493.
2 structures with and, but and or
Repeated words are often dropped in co-ordinate structures. For details, see 182.
a knife and fork (= a knife and a fork) She was poor but honest. (.=... but she was honest.)
page 172
<-^ll|^0l0 \JL/. gClldtll XO&
3 at the beginning of a sentence
In informal speech, unstressed words are often dropped at the beginning of a sentence, if the meaning is
clear. For details, see 183.
Seen Lucy? (= Have you seen Lucy?)
Doesn 't know what she's talking about. (= She doesn 't...)
4 at the end of a noun phrase
It is sometimes possible to drop nouns after adjectives, noun modifiers and/or determiners. For details,
see 184.
'Do you want large eggs?' 'No, I'll have small.' (='... small eggs.')
My car isn't working. I'll have to use Mary's. (=... Mary's car.)
We're going to hear the London Philharmonic tonight. (=... the London Philharmonic Orchestra.)
'Which shoes are you going to wear?' 'These.'
For substitution with one(s), see 391.
5 at the end of a verb phrase
Auxiliary verbs are often used alone instead of full verbs. For details, see 185.
'I ha ven 't paid.' 'I haven't either.' (=... 'I haven't paid either.')
She said she'd phone, but she didn't. [=... didn't phone.) This type of ellipsis can include words that follow
the verb phrase.
/ was planning to go to Paris next week, but I can't.
(=... I can't go to Paris next week.) The same structures are possible with non-auxiliary be and have.
I thought she would be angry, and she was.
He says he hasn 't any friends, but I know he has.
For substitution with do and do so, see 165,166.
6 infinitives
We can use to instead of repeating a whole infinitive. For details, see 186.
'Are you and Gillian getting married?' 'We hope to.' (= 'We hope to get married.')
I don't dance much now, but I used to a lot. Sometimes a whole infinitive, including to, is left out.
Come when you want. (.=... when you want to come.)
'Have a good time.' Til try.' (= Til try to have a good time.')
7 comparative structures with as and than
We can leave out words after as and than, if the meaning is clear. The weather isn't as good as last year.
(=... as it was last year.) I found more blackberries than you. (=..'. than you found.)
For inversion after as and than, see 298.6. For missing subject or object after as and than, see 557.3 ^
page 173


i question-word clauses
Clauses can be dropped after question words.
Somebody's been stealing our flowers, but I don't know who.
(=... I don't know who's been stealing our flowers.) Become a successful writer. This book shows you how.
} that and relative pronouns
In an informal style, the conjunction that is often dropped. For details, see 560.
/ knew (that) she didn 't want to help me. Object relative pronouns can also be dropped in an informal
style. For details, see 474-476.
This is the restaurant (which) I was talking about.
reduced relative structures
We can sometimes leave out a relative pronoun and the verb be before participles or adjectives such as
available, possible. For details, see 477.6. Who's the girl dancing with your brother? (=... who is
dancing...) Please let me have all the tickets available. (=... that are available.)
be after conjunctions
Subject pronouns with forms of be can be left out after certain conjunctions, especially in a formal style.
Start when ready. (=... when you are ready.) Though intelligent, he was very poorly educated. (= Though
he was intelligent...)
When ordering, please send L1.50 for postage and packing. Phone me if (it is) necessary.
I'm enclosing my cheque for L50, as (was) agreed. He had a small heart attack while asleep. Leave in
oven until cooked.
prepositions
In an informal style, prepositions can be dropped in a few time expressions
(see 439.2,5).
See you (on) Monday night.
We're staying here (for) another three months.
What time shall I come? (More natural than At what time...?)
For cases like We need a place to live (in), see 427.
pronouns after prepositions
In British English, pronoun objects can sometimes be dropped after prepositions. This happens, for
example, when have or with are used in descriptive structures.
My socks have got holes in (them). I'd like a piece of toast with butter on (it).
page 174
^w- t;inp3ia vc.7. wniriimi, CJtXt ixiicroi J.06
14 abbreviated styles
In certain styles, many or all non-essential words can be dropped. For
details, see 1.
Take 500g butter and place in small saucepan. Essential fee agreed before contract signed
WOMAN WALKS ON MOON
182 ellipsis (2): with and, but and or
1 various kinds of word left out
When expressions are joined by and, but or or, we often leave out repeated
words or phrases of various kinds.
a knife and (a) fork these men and (these) women
ripe apples and (ripe) pears antique (furniture) or modern furniture
in France, (in) Germany or (in) Spain
She can read, but (she) can't write.
The Minister likes golf but (the Minister) hates fishing.
We drove (across America), rode (across America), flew (across America)
and walked across America. She was poor but (she was) honest. The food (is ready) and the drinks are
ready. Phil (washed the dishes) and Sally washed the dishes.
2 word order
Note that when two verbs, objects etc are the same, it is not always the second that is left out. We leave
out the first if that will produce a simpler word order and sentence structure.
Cats (catch mice) and dogs catch mice. (NOT -Gtafe catch mice and dogs.)
I can (go) and will go.
In informal speech and writing, ellipsis does not usually interrupt the normal word order of a clause or
sentence. Sentences like the following are typical of a more formal style.
Peter planned and Jane paid for the holiday.
Kevin likes dancing and Annie athletics.
The children will carry the small boxes and the adults the large ones.
Jane went to Greece and Alice to Rome.
You seem, and she certainly is, ill. We can sometimes drop a verb that is repeated in a different form.
I have always paid my bills and I always will (pay...). But this is not common if the dropped form comes
first.
(NOT USUALLY Ialways have, and always will pay my bills.)
3 singular and plural
, When one verb follows two singular subjects connected by and, a plural verb form is of course used if
necessary.
My mother and father smoke. (NOT My mother and father smokes.) When two singular subjects are
connected by or, the verb is singular.
Either Jake or Steve was here this morning. For singular and plural verbs with neither... nor, see 365.
page 175


other conjunctions
Ellipsis is not normally possible after other conjunctions besides and, but and or.
She didn't know where she was when she woke up. (NOT ... when woke up.)
However, ellipsis of subject pronouns with forms of be is possible in some cases (e.g. if possible, when
arriving). See 261.10, 73.4,406.6.
(and) then
In an informal style, ellipsis is sometimes possible after then even if and is dropped.
Peter started first, (and) then Colin (started).
ellipsis (3): at the beginning of a sentence
words that can be left out
In informal spoken English we often leave out unstressed words at the beginning of a sentence if the
meaning is clear without them. Words that can be left out include articles [the, a/an), possessives (my,
your etc), personal pronouns (/, you etc), auxiliary verbs {am, have etc) and the preparatory subject there.
Car's runningbadly. (= The car's...)
Wife's on holiday. {= My wife's...)
Couldn't understand a word. (= I couldn't...)
Must dash. (= Imust dash.)
Won't work, you know. (= It won't work...)
Seen Joe? (= Have you seen Joe?)
Keeping well, I hope? {= You're keeping well...)
Nobody at home. (= There's nobody at home.)
Careful what you say. (= Be careful...)
Be four pounds fifty. (= That'll be...)
unstressed forms of be, will, would, have
We do not usually drop words so as to begin sentences with unstressed forms of be, will, would or
auxiliary have (though this sometimes happens in postcards, diary entries and other kinds of very informal
writing). I'm coming tomorrow. OR Coming tomorrow.
(BUT NOT Am coming tomorrow. Am is not stressed.) I'll see you soon. OR See you soon.
(BUT NOT Will sec you soon. Will is not stressed.) Haven't seen him. (BUT NOT Have seen him. Have is
not stressed.)
Jand it
Auxiliary verbs can be left out before personal pronouns except I and it. You ready? (= Are you ready?)
She want something? (= Does she want something?) (BUT NOT -Hate? It raining?) '
page 176
4 tags
Ellipsis is very common in sentences that have some sort of tag (see 465-466, 472) on the end, especially
in British English.
Can't swim, myself. Like my pint, I do. Dutch, aren't you? Getting in your way, am I? Going on holiday,
your kids?
184 ellipsis (4): in noun phrases
1 ellipsis after adjectives
A repeated noun can sometimes be dropped after an adjective, if the meaning is clear, especially when
one is talking about common kinds of choice.
'What kind of potatoes would you like?' 'Boiled (potatoes), please.'
We haven't got any large eggs. Only small (eggs). This often happens after superlatives.
I think I'll buy the cheapest. Note that nouns are not normally dropped in other situations.
Poor little boy! (NOT Poor little!)
The most important thing is to keep calm. (NOT The most important is to...)
For other structures in which adjectives are used without nouns, see 18.
2 ellipsis after determiners
Nouns can also be dropped after most determiners (see 157) and similar words, including numbers, nouns
with possessive 's, own and (an)other.
Those are Helen's gloves, and these (gloves) are mine.
I'm not sure how many packets I need, but I'll take two (packets) to start with.
Our train's the second (train) from this platform.
You take Pete's car, and I'll take Susie's (car).
'Can I borrow your pen?' 'No, find your own (pen).'
That beer went down fast."Have another (beer).'
For more information about the use of determiners without nouns, see 157. See also the entries for
particular determiners.
3 well-known names
The last words of well-known names are often dropped.
She's playing the Beethoven with the London Philharmonic tomorrow night. (=... the Beethoven violin
concerto with the London Philharmonic Orchestra...)
He's staying at the Hilton. (=... the Hilton Hotel.)
We're going to see 'Hamlet' at the Mermaid. [=... the Mermaid Theatre.) When we talk about people's
houses and shops, the words house and shop are often dropped (see 432.4).
We spent the weekend at John and Mary's.
Could you pick up some chops from the butcher's?
For the substitute word one(s), see 391. ^
page 177


185
ellipsis C5): after auxiliary verbs
1 auxiliary instead of complete verb phrase
We can avoid repetition by using an auxiliary verb instead of a complete verb phrase, if the meaning is
clear. The auxiliary verb usually has a 'strong' pronunciation (see 588), and contractions (see 144) are not
normally used except in negatives.
'Get up.' 'lam /aem/.' (= 'I am getting up.') (NOT 'I'm.')
He said he'd write, but he hasn't. (=... hasn't written.)
I'll come and see you whenlcan. (=... can come and see you.)
I wouldn't if I were you.
(Said to somebody who is just going to do something stupid.) Do can be used before ellipsis if there is no
other auxiliary to repeat. They hardly ever give a party, but when they do, they do. He said he would arrive
before seven, and he did.
2 ellipsis of verb + object, complement etc
Other words, as well as the rest of the verb phrase, can be left out after the auxiliary - for example an
object, a complement, an adverbial, or even a whole clause.
I can't see you today, but I can tomorrow. (.=... lean see you...)
I've forgotten the address.' 'I have too.'
''Vou're not trying very hard.' 'lam.'
'You wouldn't have won if I hadn't helped you."Yes, I would.' Ellipsis of an object, complement etc is also
possible after forms of non-auxiliary be and have.
'I'm tired.' 'lam too.'
'Who's the driver?' 'lam.'
'Who has a dictionary?' 'I have.'
3 more than one auxiliary
When there is more than one auxiliary verb, ellipsis most often happens after the first.
'You wouldn't have enjoyed the film.' 'Yes, Iwould.'
(= ...'I would have enjoyed the film.') However, more auxiliaries can be included. The first is stressed.
'Couldyou have been dreaming?' 'I suppose I could/COULD have/ COULD have been.'
We often include a second auxiliary verb if it has not appeared before in the same form.
'I think Mary should be told.' 'She has been.' (More natural than... 'She has.')
And we normally include a second auxiliary verb after a change of modal auxiliary.
'Mary should be told.' 'She must be.' (More natural than... 'She must.')
page 178
4 short answers etc
Ellipsis is used regularly in short answers (see 493), reply questions (see 463) and tags (see 465 - 466
and 472).
'Have you finished?' 'Yes, I have.'
'lean whistle through my fingers.' 'Canyou, dear?'
You don't want to buy a car, do you?
5 so am I etc
Ellipsis also happens after so (see 516), neither and nor (see 364). 'I've forgotten the address. "So have I.'
She doesn't like olives, and neither do I.
6 ellipted form before complete form
Ellipsis normally happens when an expression is used for a second time, after the complete form has
already been used once (see above examples). However, it can sometimes happen the other way round.
This is common in sentences beginning If/When... cani could... or If you like/wish/want/prefer.
If you can, send me a postcard when you arrive.
If you could, I'd like you to help me this evening.
If you prefer, we can go tomorrow instead.
7 substitution with do
In British English, a main verb that is left out after an auxiliary can be replaced by do. For details, see 165.
'Do you think he'll phone?' 'He might do.' (US... 'He might.')
For more about substitution, see 542.
For do so, see 166.
For ellipsis of an infinitive after to, see 186.
186 ellipsis (6): infinitives
1 to used instead of whole infinitive
We can use to instead of the whole infinitive of a repeated verb (and a following complement), if the
meaning is clear.
'Are you and Gillian getting married?' 'We hope to.'
'Let's go for a walk.' 'I don't want to.'
I don't dance much now, but I used to a lot.
Sorry I shouted at you. I didn't mean to.
'Somebody ought to clean up the bathroom.' Til ask John to.' Be and stative have (see 241) are not
usually dropped.
There are more flowers than there used to be. (NOT ... than there used to.)
She hasn't been promoted yet, but she ought to be. (NOT .. .but she ought to.)
You've got more freckles than you used to have.
(NOT You've got more freckles than you used to.) >
page 179


2
3
ellipsis of whole infinitive
In some cases the whole infinitive can be left out. This happens after nouns and adjectives, and after
verbs which can stand alone without a following infinitive.
He'll never leave home; he hasn't got the courage (to). You can't force him to leave home if he's not ready
(to). 'Can you start the car?' Til try (to).'
(would) like, want etc
We cannot usually leave out to after would like/love/hate/prefer, want and choose.
'Are you interested in going to University?' 'I'd like to.' (NOT '... I'd like:')
My parents encouraged me to study art, but I didn 't want to.
(NOT ... I didn't want.)
However, to is often dropped after want, and almost always after like, when these are used after certain
conjunctions - for instance when, if, what, as.
Come when you want (to).
I'll do what I like.
Stay as long as you like.
187 else
1 use
We use else to mean 'other' or 'more' after:
somebody, someone, something, somewhere; anybody/one/thing/where;
everybody/one/thing/where; nobody/one/thing/where; who, what, why, when, where, how; whatever,
whenever etc; little; much
Would you like anything else?
I'm sorry. I mistook you for somebody else.
Why can 'tyou wear a suit like everybody else?
'Harry gave me some perfume for Christmas."Oh, lovely. Whatelsedid you get?'
Where else did you go besides Madrid?
Whatever else he may be, he's not a mathematician.
We know when Shakespeare was born and when he died, but we don't
know much else about his life. In a very formal style, else is sometimes used after all. When all else fails,
read the instructions.
2 word order
Note that else comes immediately after the word it modifies. What else would you like? (NOT What would
you like else?)
3 else's
Else has a possessive else's. ^ You 're wearing somebody else's coat.
page 180
4 singular only
There is no plural structure with else. The plural of somebody else is (some) other people.
5 or else
Or eke means'otherwise','if not'.
Let's go, or else we'll miss the train. Or else is sometimes used with no continuation, as a threat.
You'd better stop hitting my little brother, or else!
6 elsewhere
This is a formal word for somewhere else.
If you are not satisfied with my hospitality, go elsewhere.
188 embedding and comprehension problems
1 What is 'embedding'?
Sometimes a long phrase or clause is 'embedded* in another clause - fitted into the middle of it,
interrupting the normal subject-verb-object sequence. Sentences that are constructed like this can be
difficult for learners to understand.
2 descriptive expressions after subjects
When the subject of a sentence is followed by an embedded descriptive -phrase or relative clause, the
subject is separated from the verb, and this may make the sentence confusing and hard to sort out.
That picture of the children being talked to by the Prime Minister is wonderful. (The sentence says that the
picture is wonderful, not that the Prime Minister is wonderful.) Here is a more complex example from a
newspaper.
A 24-year-old labourer who was arrested in Trafalgar Square when he allegedly attempted to knife a traffic
warden is said to have injured three policemen.
The subject (a 24-year-old labourer) and the verb (is said to have injured) are separated by 15 other
words; and the verb is said comes immediately after a noun (a traffic warden) which is not its subject. Both
of these things can cause problems for the reader.
3 relative pronouns left out
When relative pronouns are left out at the beginning of embedded clauses, this can cause difficulty.
The film she was talking about at Celia's party turned out to be very
boring. (=... the film which she was talking about...) The manager of Brown's, the chemist's, has confirmed
that bottles of shampoo he took off the shelves after animal rights protesters claimed to have put bleach
into them did contain poisonous chemicals. (=... bottles of shampoo which he took off...) ^
page 181


Pictures of the baby the judge ordered should not be identified by reporters appeared in a Sunday
newspaper. (=... the baby which...)
4 past participles that look like past tenses
Past participles (e.g. arrested, accused) are often used descriptively after nouns, rather like reduced
relative clauses (see 477.6). When these look the same as past tenses, they can cause confusion. In the
following examples, arrested means 'who was arrested', accused means 'who is accused', and asked
means 'who were asked'.
A court has heard that a young civil servant arrested after shootings on
Tyneside left one man dead is to be charged with murder. A Karnak separatist accused of leading an
attack on a French police
barracks in which four gendarmes died has been arrested. A number of the children asked for comments
on the proposals to expel
some immigrants told the police they disagreed. (Who asked? Who said
they disagreed?)
5 adverbial clauses
Embedded adverbial clauses can also make sentences complicated and hard to follow.
One way of deciding what to do when you have difficulty in choosing the
best course of action is to toss a coin. Arthur was not sure which way to go, for he had been left alone by
his
friends, and, when an old man came along the road accompanied by
a little boy, he said 'Excuse me'. (Who said 'Excuse me'?) The really important point is that because he did
not invite the one man
he certainly should have asked his father was furious. (Should he have
asked his father?)
The rebel leader found out that in spite of the precautions of the soldiers he had bought the guns from the
police had planted an informer among them. (Had he bought the guns from the police?)
6 reporting expressions
Complicated structures can be produced when reporting expressions are put into the middle of sentences.
This is the man who Ann said will tell us all about the church.
He's gone I don't know how far.
For combined relative and indirect speech structures, see 477.10-11. For other problems with
conjunctions and clauses, see 143. For difficulties with relative clauses, see 477.
9 emphasis
1 emotive and contrastive emphasis
We often emphasise ('strengthen') a particular word or expression. There are two main reasons for this.
We may wish to show that we feel strongly about what we are saying ('emotive emphasis').
You do look nice today! Your hair looks so good like that.
page 182

Or we may wish to show a contrast between, for example, true and false, or present and past, or a rule
and an exception ('contrastive emphasis').
'Why weren't you at the meeting?' 'I was at the meeting.'
I don't take much exercise now, but I did play a lot of football when I was younger.
I don't have much contact with my family, but I do see my mother
occasionally.
We can also use emphasis to show that something expected actually happened.
I thought I'd pass theexam, andldid pass.
2 pronunciation: stress
In speech, we can give words extra stress - make them sound 'stronger' -by pronouncing them louder and
with a higher intonation. We may also make the vowel longer, and pause before a stressed word. Stress is
reflected in printing by using italics or bold type, and in writing by using CAPITAL LETTERS or by
underlining.
This is the last opportunity.
He lived in Prance, not Spain.
Mary, I'm IN LOVE! Please don't tell anybody! Changes in stress can affect the meaning of a sentence.
Compare:
Jane phoned me yesterday. (Not somebody else.)
Jane phoned me yesterday. (She didn't come to see me.)
Jane phoned me yesterday. (She didn't phone you.)
Jane phoned me yesterday. (Not today.) We often stress auxiliary verbs. This can make the whole
sentence sound more emphatic, or can emphasise a contrast (see above). Most auxiliary verbs change
their pronunciation when they are stressed (see 588).
It was a nice party! You have grown!
lam telling the truth -you must believe me! In emphatic sentences without auxiliary verbs we can add do to
carry the stress.
Do sit down. She does like you.
If he does decide to come, let me know, will you? When auxiliary verbs are stressed the word order can
change (see 23.12). Compare:
You have certainly grown. You certainly have grown!
For intonation and stress, see 540.
3 vocabulary: special words
Certain words, such as so, such, really and just, can be used to show emphasis.
Thank you so much. It was such a lovely party. I really enjoyed it.
I just love the way she talks. Question words can be emphasised by adding ever (see 595) or on earth.
Why ever did he marry her? What on earth is she doing here?
page 183


4 structures
If we can move words to an unusual position, this usually gives them more importance. Words are often
'fronted' for this reason (see 217).
That film-what did you thinkofit? Asleep, then, wereyou?
I knew he was going to cause trouble, and cause trouble he did! 'Cleft* structures with it and what can be
used to focus on particular parts of a sentence and give them extra importance (see 131).
It was John who paid for the drinks. What I need is a good rest. Do can be used to emphasise an
affirmative verb (see above).
She does seem to be trying. Do come in. Myself, yourself etc can be used to emphasise nouns (see 471).
Igota letter from the Managing Director himself. Indeed can be used to emphasise very with an adjective
or adverb (see 274).
/ was very surprised indeed. Very can emphasise superlatives, next, last, first and same (see 139.4).
I'd like a bottle of your very best wine.
The letter arrived on the very next day.
We were born in the very same street in the very same year. Repetition can be used for emphasis.
She looks much, much older than she used to.
190 enable
Enable is normally used in the structure enable somebody to do something, ^j He invented a machine to
enable people in wheelchairs to getup stairs. The gears on a mountain bike practically enable you to ride
up a wall. It is less usual to use enable with a direct object and no following infinitive. The extra money will
make repairs possible. OR... will enable us to carry
out repairs. (More common than... will enable repairs.) The new machinery will make greater production
possible. OR ... will enable us to produce more. (More common than... will enable greater production.)
191 end and finish (verbs)
These verbs have similar meanings, but there are some differences, especially when they are followed by
direct objects.
1 finish + object = 'complete'
When we talk about getting to the end of something or completing an activity, we usually prefer finish.
He never lets me finish a sentence.
She's always starting something new, but she never finishes anything.
You'll never finish that hamburger- it's too big for you.
Have you finished cleaning the floor yet? Note that finish can be followed by an -ing form (see 293).
page 184
2 end+ object = 'stop'
When we talk about stopping or breaking something off, we usually prefer end.
I decided it was time to end our affair.
It's time to end the uncertainty - the Prime Minister must speak out. End cannot be followed by an - ing
form.
/ decided to stop seeing her. (NOT ... to end seeing her.)
3 end + object = 'bring to a close'
When we are talking about a special way of bringing something to a close or
'shaping' the end of something, we usually prefer end. 'How do you end a letter to somebody you don't
know?' She ended her concert with three songs by Schubert. My father ended his days (= 'died') in a
mental hospital.
4 shape
When we are referring to the shape of things, rather than to time, we normally use end. f
The road ended in a building site. (NOT The road finished...)
Nouns that end in -s have plurals in -es.
5 other cases
In other cases, there is often little or no difference of meaning,
What time does the concert end/finish? Term ends/finishes on June 23.
for finished meaning 'ready*, see 211.
192 enjoy
; enjoy+aomlpioaoun/-ing
Enjoy normally has an object. When we talk about having a good time, we can use enjoy myself/yourself/
etc.
'Did you enjoy the party?' 'Yes, I enjoyed it very much.' I really enjoyed myself when I went to Rome.
(NOT I really enjoyed when...) We're going to Paris for the weekend.' 'Enjoy yourself!'
('Enjoy!' alone would be possible in very informal American English.) Enjoy can be followed by -ing.
I don't enjoy looking after small children. (NOT ...-enjoy to look...)
L93 enough
1 adjective/adverb + enough
When enough modifies an adjective or adverb, it normally comes after the
adjective / adverb.
Is it warm enough for you? (NOT . ..enough warm...) You're not driving fast enough. ^
page 185


We haven't got a big enough house.
We'll go swimming if we get warm enough weather.
You could wear my shoes -you 've got big enough feet.
2 enough + noun
Enough can also be used before a noun phrase as a determiner.
We do not generally use of when there is no other determiner (e.g. article or possessive).
Have you got enough milk? (NOT ... enough of milk?} There isn 't enough blue paint left.
However, enough of can be used without a following determiner in a few cases - for instance, before
personal and geographical names.
We haven't seen enough of Ray and Barbara recently.
I've had enough of England for a bit. I'm going home.
Enough is occasionally used after a noun, but this is rare in modem English except in a few expressions.
If only we had time enough... I was fool enough to believe him. \ position with adjective + noun
Enough follows an adjective which it modifies (see paragraph 1 above). But
when enough modifies an adjective and noun together, it comes before the adjective. Compare:
We haven't got big enough nails.
(= We need bigger nails - enough modifies big.) We haven't got enough big nails.
(= We need more big nails - enough modifies big nails.) enough of+ determiner/pronoun
Before determiners (e.g. a, the, my, this) and pronouns, we use enough of. I think my letter gave him
enough of a shock, don 'tyou? The exam was bad. I couldn 't answer enough of the questions. Have we
got enough of those new potatoes? We didn 't buy enough of them.
enough + infinitive
We can use an infinitive structure after enough. She's old enough to do what she wants. I haven't got
enough money to buy a car.
Infinitives can be introduced by/or+ noun/pronoun. Object forms of pronouns are used.
It's late enough for the staff to stop work.
There was just enough light for us to see what we were doing. . The subject of the sentence can be the
object of the following infinitive. (For more about this structure, see 285.4.) Object pronouns are not
normally used after the infinitive in this case.
The radio's small enough to put in your pocket.
(NOT ... to put it in your pocket.) Those tomatoes aren't ripe enough to eat. (Nor... to eat them.)
page 186
TW"" especial(ly) and special(ly) 194
However, object pronouns are possible in structures with/or. The radio was small enough for me to put fit)
in my pocket. Those tomatoes aren't ripe enough for the children to eat (them).
For other examples offor + object + infinitive, see 280.
6 enough without a noun
Enough can be used alone without a noun, if the meaning is clear.
Enough is enough. That's enough, thank you.
Haifa pound of carrots will be enough. Note that we prefer to use a structure with there is where possible.
There's enough meat. (NOT -The-mcat is enough.)
There weren't enough chairs. (NOT The chairs weren't enough.)
7 the = enough; leaving out enough
The article the can be used to mean 'enough'.
I hardly had the strength to take my clothes off.
I didn't quite have the money to pay for a meal. Time and room are often used alone to mean 'enough
time' and 'enough room'.
Have you got time to look at this letter?
There isn't room for everybody to sit down.
For similar structures with too and too much/many, see 570-571.
194 especial (ly) and special (ly)
Especially and specially can often both be used With the same meaning.
It was not (e)specially cold. Especially is used to mean 'above all'.
/ play a lot of tennis, especially on Sundays.
It rains a lot, especially in the north.
The children are very noisy, especially when we have visitors.
I like all kinds of fruit, especially apples. Especially follows a subject.
All my family like music. My father, especially, goes to as many concerts as ..-. he can. (NOT ... Especially
my father goes...) Specially is used to mean 'for a particular purpose'.
These shoes were specially made for me. The adjective especial is rare. We normally use special.
He took special trouble over his work.
naps 1H7


even 135
195 even
2
3
4
5
meaning and position
We can use even to talk about surprising extremes - when people do more than we expect, or go too far,
for example. Even most often goes in mid-position (see 22). -
aauxiliaryverb + even •|te + even
She has broken all her toys. She has even broken her bike.
(NOT Even she has broken...) He's rude to everybody. He's even rude to the police.
Seven + other verb
They do everything together. They even brush their teeth together.
He speaks lots of languages. He even speaks Esperanto. Even goes at the beginning of a clause when it
refers just to the subject; and it can go just before other words and expressions that we want to
emphasise. : Anybody can do this. Even a child can do it.
He eats anything - even raw potatoes.
I work every day, even on Sundays.
not even
We use not even to talk about a negative extreme - for example, to say that we are surprised because
somebody does not manage a very small thing.
He can't even write his own name.
1 haven't written to anybody for months - not even my parents.
She didn't even offer me a cup of tea.
even and also
Also is not used to talk about surprising extremes.
Everybody helped with the packing - even the dog. (NOT ... also the dog.)
For also, too and as well, see 45.
even if said even though
Even is not used as a conjunction, but we can use even before if and though.
Even if I become a millionaire, I shall always be a socialist. (NOT .. .-Even I become...)
Even though I didn't know anybody at the party, I had a nice time. We sometimes use if in the sense of
even if, when there is no possibility of confusion.
I'll do it if it kills me. (=... even if it kills me.)
even so
Even so means 'however'.
He seems nice. Even so, I don't really trust him. (NOT ... Even though, I don't really trust him.)
page 188
ever 197
196 eventual (ly)
Eventual and eventually mean 'final(ly)', 'in the end', 'after all that'.
We use them when we say that something happens after a long time or after
a lot of effort.
The chess game lasted for three days. Androv was the eventual winner.
The car didn't want to start, but eventually I got it going. Eventually is not used to give news.
Steve has found a job at last! (NOT Steve has eventually found a job!) Note that eventual and eventually
are 'false friends' for people who speak some languages of European origin. They do not mean the same
as, for instance, eventuel or eventuellement, and are not used to express the idea of possibility. For this
meaning we use possible, perhaps, if, may, might etc.
In our new house I'd like to have a spare bedroom for possible visitors. (NOT ... eventual visitors.)
I'm notsure what I'll do nextyear. Imightgo toAmerica if I can find a job. (NOT ... Eventually I'll go to
America...)
For finally, at last and in/at the end, see 210.
197 ever
1 ever meaning 'at any time'
Ever generally means 'at any time', and is used mainly in questions (see below). Compare:
Do you ever go to Ireland on holiday7 {= at any time)
We always go to Ireland on holiday. (= every time)
We never have holidays in England. (= at no time)
2 ever meaning 'always'
Ever is not normally used to mean 'always'.
I shall always remember you. (NOT/ shall ever remember you.) But ever is sometimes used to mean
'always' in compound expressions with adjectives and participles.
his ever-open mouth an ever-increasing debt
evergreen trees his ever-loving wife Ever also means 'always' in forever (or for ever) and ever since, and
in a few other expressions like ever after and Yours ever (used at the end of letters).
I shall love you forever. I've lovedyou ever since I met you.
3 use
Ever is a 'non-assertive' word (see 374), and is used mostly in questions. It'-fe"'.
also possible in negative clauses, but never is more usual than not ever. Do you ever go to pop concerts?
I don't ever want to see you again. (OR I never want...)
We also use ever after if, and with words that express a negative idea (like
nobody, hardly or stop).
Come and see us if you are ever in Manchester.
Nobody ever visits them. I hardly ever see my sister.
I'm going to stop her ever doing that again. ^
page 189


4 superlative + ever
Ever is used in affirmative clauses after superlatives and only. What is the best book you 've ever read?
It's the largest picture ever painted. She's the only woman ever to have climbed Everest in winter.
5 ever + perfect
When ever is used with a present perfect tense (see 418), it means 'at any time up to now'. Compare:
Have you ever been to Greece?
Did you ever go to Naples when you lived in Italy? With a past perfect, ever means 'at any time up to
then'.
Had you ever thought of getting married be fore you met June?
6 than ever
After a comparative, we can use the expression than ever. You're looking lovelier than ever.
7 ever, yet and already
Ever is not used in the same way as yet and already. These two words are . used for things that happen
around the present. Corppare:
Have you been to Belfast yet? (A trip is planned.)
Good heavens. Have you been to Belfast already? (The trip has taken place earlier than expected.)
Have you ever been to Belfast? (at any time in the past)
8 ever and be fore
Ever and before can both be used to mean 'at any time in the past', but there is a slight difference. Before
refers to a present event, and asks whether it has happened at another time; ever does not refer to a
present event. Compare:
Have you been to Scotland before? (The hearer is probably in Scotland.) Have you ever been toAfrica?
(The hearer is not in Africa.) But note that ever before can refer to a present event.
What are you staring at? Haven't you ever seen somebody dancing before?
For more information about ever, see a good dictionary.
For who ever, whatever etc, see 595.
For whoever, whatever etc, see 596.
For already, yet and still, see 539.
For forever with progressive forms, see 452.
18 ever so, ever such
These expressions are often used in very informal British English to mean 'very'. Some people consider
them substandard.
She's ever so nice.
It's ever such a good film. For the difference between so and such, see 544.
page 190
every (one) 199
199 every (one)
1 every + singular
Every is a determiner (see 157). We normally use it before a singular noun (but see paragraph 5). If the
noun is a subject, its verb is also singular.
every + singular noun
I see her every day. (NOT.. .every days.) Every room is being used. (NOT Every room arc...)
2 every one of
We use every one o/before a pronoun or a determiner (for example the, my, these - see 157). The
pronoun or noun is plural, but a following verb is singular.
yfvery one ofusiyoufthem Jsvery one qf+ determiner + plural noun ,
His books are wonderful. I've read every one of them. Every one of the children was crying.
3 every one without a noun
We can drop a noun and use every one alone, if the noun has already been mentioned.
His books are great. Every one's worth reading.
4 negative structures
To negate every, we normally use not every.
Not every kind of bird can fly. (More natural than Every kind of bird
cannotfly.]
5 pronouns and possessives
When a pronoun or possessive is used later in a clause to refer back to every (one), the later word can
usually be either singular (more formal) or plural (less formal).
Every person made his/her own travel arrangements.
Every person made their own travel arrangements.
I told every single student what I thought of him/her/them. But if we are talking about something that
concerns every member of a group at the same time, a plural word is necessary.
When every passenger's ticket had been checked, the door opened and they all got on. (NOT ... and
he/she all got on.]
6 every + plural noun
Every is used before a plural noun in expressions that refer to intervals. / see her every few days. There's
a meeting every six weeks. She had to stop and rest every two or three steps. ^
page 191
Everyooay, everyone, everything and everywhere Eire used with singular verbs like every.
Everybody has gone home. (NOT Everybody haws...)
Everything I like is either illegal, immoral or fattening.
I found that everywhere was booked up. When possessives and pronouns refer back to everybody/one,
they can usually be either singular (more formal) or plural (less formal). Sometimes only a plural word
makes sense. Compare:
Has everybody got his or her ticket? (more formal)
Has everybody got their tickets? (less formal)
When everybody had finished eating, the waiters took away their plates.
(NOT .. .his or her plate.}
Note that everyone (= 'everybody') does not mean the same as every one (which can refer to things as
well as people - see paragraph 2 above).
8 everyday
Everyday is an adjective meaning 'ordinary', 'usual', 'routine'. It is not the same as the adverbial
expression every day. Compare:
In everyday life, you don't often find an elephant in a supermarket.
You don't see elephants every day.
9 common expressions
Note the following common expressions with every.
every single
She visits her mother every single day.
every other
We meet every other Tuesday. {=... every second Tuesday.)
every so often; every now and then
We go out for a drink together every so often /every now and then.
For the difference between every and each, see 174.
For every and all, see 37.
For every and any, see 55.
For more information about everybody/everyone, see 523.
0 except (for)
1 except with or without^/br
We use except (for) after general statements, especially after generalising words like all, every, no,
everything, anybody, nowhere, whole etc.
He ate everything on his plate except (for) the beans.
He ate the whole meal, except (for) the beans.
page 192
In other cases we usually use except for, not except. Compare:
- I've cleaned all the rooms except (for) the bathroom.
[Except is possible after all.) I've cleaned the house except for the bathroom. (NOT .. .-except the
bathroom.)
- Nobody came except (for) John and Mary. (after nobody) Except for John and Mary, nobody came.
(before nobody)
- You couldn't hear anything except (for) the noise of Louise typing. The house was quiet except for the
noise of Louise typing.
3 except
We use except, not except for, before prepositions and conjunctions. It's the same everywhere except in
Scotland.
(NOT ... except for in Scotland:) He's good-looking except when he smiles.
4 except (for) + pronoun
After except (for) we use object pronouns, not subject pronouns. Everybody understands except me.
We're all ready except her.
5 except + verb
A verb form after except usually depends on what came before. Infinitives are normally without to.
He does nothing except eat all day. (does... eat)
She's not interested in anything except skiing, (interested in... skiing)
6 except and without
Except (for) is only used to talk about exceptions to generalisations. In other cases, without or but for may
be preferable. Compare:
Nobody helped me except you.
Without/But for your help, I would have failed. (NOT Except for your help, I would have failed.)
For the use of but to mean 'except', see 116. For the difference between except, besides and apart from,
see 101.
201 exclamations: structures
Exclamations are often constructed with how and what or with so and such;
negative question forms are also common.
1 exclamations with how
These are often felt to be a little formal or old-fashioned. I how + adjective Strawberries! How nice! >
page 193


hsw + adjective/adverb + subject + verb
How cold it is! (NOT How it is cold!) How beautifully you sing! (NOT How you sing beautifully!)
how + subject + verb How you've grown! Forthe stmcture of expressions like How strange a remark, see
16.
2 exclamations with what
what a/an (+ adjective) + singular countaHtenoiw
What a rude man! (NOT What rude man!) What a nice dress! (NOT What nice dress!) What a surprise!
what (+ adjective) + uncountable/plural nouif
Whatbeautiful weather! (NOT What a beautiful weather!)
What lovely/lowers!
Whatfools!
3 exclamations with so and such
se + adjective You're so kind!
such a/an (+ adjective) + singular countable noun He's such a nice boy! (NOT ... a such nice boy!) swh (+
adjective) + uncountable/plural noun[
They talk such rubbish! (NOT ... such a rubbish!) They're such kind people! (NOT.. . so kind people!)
what + object + subject + verb (note word order) What a beautiful smile your sister has! (NOT ... has your
sister.)
Formore information about such and so, see 544.
4 negative question forms
Isn't the weather nice! Hasn't she grown! Americans and some British speakers may use ordinary (non-
negative) question forms in exclamations.
Boy, am I hungry! Wow, did she make a mistake!
Was I furious!
Formore information about negative questions, see 360.
202

l

2

3

a

b

c

to
page
194
expect, hope, wait and look forward
expect and hope: difference of meaning
Expecting is mental rather than emotional. If I expect something to happen, I have a good reason to think
it will in fact happen. Hoping is more emotional. If I hope for something to happen, I would like it to
happen, but I do not know whether it will. Compare:
- She's expecting a baby. (= She's pregnant.) She's hoping it will be a girl.
- I'm expecting John to phone at three o'clock. I hope he's got some good news.
One can expect good or bad things to happen, but one only hopes for good things.
/ expect it will rain at the weekend. But I hope it won't.
expect and wait: difference of meaning
One waits when somebody or something is late, when one is early for something, or when one wants time
to pass so that something will happen. Compare:
- I'm expecting a phone call from John at three o'clock.
(NOT I'm waiting for a phone call from John at three o'clock.) I hope he rings on time. I hate waiting for
people to phone. (NOT I hate expecting people to phone.)
- He expects to get a bike for his birthday. (= He thinks he'll get one.) It's hard to wait for things when
you're five years old.
- I expected her at ten, but she didn 't turn up.
I waited for her till eleven, and then went home. Can't wait often expresses impatience.
I can't wait for the holidays!
expect, hope and wait: structures
direct object
Before a direct object, hope and wait have the preposition/or. Compare:
We're expecting rain soon.
We're hoping for a lot of rain - the garden's very dry.
We've been waiting/or rain for weeks.
b infinitive
All three verbs can be used with a following infinitive. We expect to spend the summer in France. We hope
to seeAnnemarie while we're there. But we're still waiting to hear from her.
c object + infinitive
An object + infinitive structure is possible. / expect him to arrive about ten o'clock. We're hoping for John
to come up with some new ideas. I'm still waiting/or Harry to pay me back that money. >
page 195


To be cannot be left out in these structures.
She's quite short -1 expected, her to be taller. (NOT -I expected her taller.) Expect is often used with
object + infinitive to talk about people's duties. Passive versions of the structure are also common.
We expect you to work on the first Saturday of every month.
Staff are expected to start work punctually at 8.30.
d that-c\ause
Expect and hope can be followed by that-clauses.
I expect (that) she'll be here soon.
I hope (that) I'll recognise her. h • BUT NOT fm-waitingthatshe arrives:
I expect (that)... can be used to talk about the present or past, with the meaning of 'I suppose', 'I have
good reason to think'.
I expect you're all tired after your journey.
Sarah isn't here. I expect she was too tired to come. Hope is often followed by a present tense with a
future meaning (see 252).
I hope she doesn't miss the train.
e expect something of somebody
This structure refers to people's feelings about how other people ought to behave.
My parents expected too much of me when I was at school - they were
terribly upset when I failed my exams.
f progressive forms
Before a that-clause, simple and progressive forms of hope can often be used with little difference of
meaning.
We hope I We're hoping you can come and stay with us soon. Before a that-clause, progressive forms of
expect are not normally used.
I expect (that) she'll be here soon. (NOT I'm cxpccting-fthat^...)
I expect (that) you 're wondering what this is all about.
(NOT I'm expecting (that)...)
• Before an infinitive, simple and progressive forms of hope and expect can often be used with little
difference of meaning.
We hope I We're hoping to get to Scotland next weekend.
We expect/We're expecting to hear from Lucy today.
4 look forward
Look forward means 'think about (something in the future) with pleasure'. One looks forward to something
that is certain to happen, and that one is glad about.
He's looking forward to his birthday. Look forward can be followed by to.. .ing, but not by an infinitive.
/ look forward to meeting you. (NOT ... to meet you.)
I look forward to hearing from you.
(common formula at the end of a letter)
page 196
Simple and progressive forms can often be used with little difference of meaning.
I look forward/I'm looking forward to the day when the children
leave home.
A
For hope and expect in negative clauses, see 359. For not and so after hope and expect, see 515. For
and after wait, see 52.
For the 'casual' use of progressive forms, see 161. for wish, see 601.
203 experiment and experience
; An experiment is a test which somebody does to see what the result will be,
or to prove something. Experiment is generally used with the verb do. There I is also a verb to experiment.
I We did an experiment in the chemistry lesson, to see if you could get i chlorine gas from salt. (NOT We
did an experience...) | I'm experimenting with a new perfume.
; An experience is something that you live through; something that happens to you in life. Experience is
generally used with the verb have. There is also a verb to experience.
I had a lot of interesting experiences during my year in Africa.
(NOT I made a lot of interesting experiences...) Have you ever experienced the feeling that you were
going mad?
(NOT Have you ever experimented the feeling... ?) 1 The uncountable noun experience means 'the
knowledge that you get from I doing things'.
Salesgirl wanted - experience unnecessary.
204 explain
After explain, we use to before an indirect object.
/ explained my problem to her. (NOT I explained her my problem.) Can you explain to me how to get to
your house? (NOT Can you explain me...?)
205 fairly, quite, rather and pretty: ,
adverbs of degree
1 fairly
Fairly generally modifies adjectives and adverbs. It does not suggest a very high degree: if you say that
somebody is fairly nice or fairly clever, for example, he or she will not be very pleased.
'How was the film?' 'Fairly good. Not the best one I've seen thisyear.' I speak Russian fairly well - enough
for everyday purposes. >
page 197





It's quite a difficult bo^t^ suggests a higher degree than fairly. He's lived in StPetersb^ good. You ought to
go.' tee can modify verbs q^' / had trouble with it. I quite enjoyed myself^' so he speaks Russian quite well.
*^ houns. Mi-word order rules, the use ^ ^yur party. The room was quite a mess.
^ ^Kther ^ite to mean 'completely', and other details, see 467.
kther is stronger than o>
*as expected','more th^v^ 'How was the film?' ^ \^ It can suggest 'more than is usual', 'more than
Maurice speaks Russi^^s wanted', and similar ideas. I think I'll put the hea^ ^r good -1 was surprised.' I've
had rather a long \Wher well. People often think he is Russian. kther can modify verbs ^^ on-Itls rather cold.
ah,! ,-./•>,, •>-/^ 't^ .v
and nouns.
V-
Irather think we're ^ Specially verbs that refer to thoughts and feelings)
It was rather a disapi^ \
^f'g to lose. She rather likes gardening.
tor word order rules and oth^ htmpnt
\i Pretty ^tails of the use of rather, see 468.
f'etty is similar to rather dformal. '\ 'How's things?' 'Pretty ^t only modifies adjectives and adverbs. It is
^fetty well means 'almo^t\ rve pretty well finish^ od.YouOK?'
iiitonation
Note that the exact mea^ " used. ^
^cr more about structures es^ "^
She's a pretty nice girl.
\ 'g of these words may depend on the intonation
far and a 1
^ ^ssing degree, see 153-156.
ong^
hrm questions anrt ^y
^ most common in. ^ egatives How far did you wal)^\ ~
^estions and negative clauses. B long way in affirm The youth hostel is not far from here.
In affirmative clauses w^ \yyg ^USCS We walked a long wi^ \
The station is a long -^usually prefer a long way. (More natural thai^^o'1' -Wstation is far from here.)
page 198
However, far is normal in affirmative clauses with too, enough, as and so.
'Have I gone far enough?' 'A bit too far.' It's ready as far as I know.
'Any problems?' 'OK so far.'
Far is also used (in all kinds of clauses) to modify comparatives, superlatives and too.
She's far older than her husband. This bike is by far the best.
You're far too young to get married.
4 attributive adjective
Far can be used as an adjective before a noun, meaning 'distant'. This is rather formal and old-fashioned.
Long ago, in afar country, there lined a woman who had seven sons.
Much, many and long (for time) are also more common in questions and negative sentences (see 348 and
323).
207 farther and further
1 distance
We use both/artier and further to talk about distance. There is no difference of meaning.
Edinburgh is farther/further away than York.
2 'additional'
We can use further (but not farther) to mean 'additional', 'extra', 'more advanced'.
Forfurther information, see page 277:
208 feel
Feel has several different meanings. Progressive forms can be used with some meanings, but not with
others. Feel can be a 'copular verb' (see 147), followed by an adjective or noun complement. It can also
be an ordinary verb, followed by a direct object.
1 ' copular verb: I feel
Feel can be used with a personal subject (7, you etc) to mean 'experience the condition of one's own mind
or body'. Adjective 6r (in British English) noun complements are used.
I feel fine. Do you feel happy? Andrew was beginning to feel cold.
I always feel sleepy on Mondays.
When Louise realised what she had done, she felt a complete idiot. (GB) Note that in this sense feel is not
normally used with reflexive pronouns (.myself etc).
He always felt inferior when he was with her.
(More natural than He always felt himself inferior...) >
page 199






To talk about feelings that are going on at a particular moment, simple or progressive forms can be used.
There is little difference of meaning.
I feel fine. /I'm feeling fine.
How do you feel? I How are you feeling?
2 reactions and opinions
Feel is often used to talk about reactions and opinions. Progressive forms are not usually used in this
case.
I feel sure you're right. (NOT I'm feeling sure...)
He says he feels doubtful about the new plan. That-clauses are common.
I feel (that) she's making a mistake.
A structure with object + to be + complement is possible in a formal style, but it is not very often used.
I felt her to be unfriendly. (More normal: I felt that she was unfriendly.) When the object is an infinitive,
preparatory it is used and to be is often dropped (especially before adjectives). The structure with object +
to be + complement is rather more common in this case, though it is still formal.
I felt it (to be) my duty to call the police.
We felt it necessary to call the police.
3 topular verb: it feels
Feel can also be used, usually with a non-personal subject, to mean 'give somebody sensations'.
Progressive forms are not used.
The glass felt cold against my lips.
My head feels funny. '
That feels nice!
'\
4 copular verb; feel like; feel as if/though
Feel can be followed by like or as if/though.
My legs feel like cotton wool.
Alice felt as if/though she was in a very nice dream.
(Alice felt like she was... is also possible - see 74.) Note that feel like can also mean 'want', 'would like'.
I feel like a drink. Have you got any beer? In this sense, feel like is often followed by an -ing form.
I felt like laughing, but I didn't dare. Compare:
I felt like swimming. (= I wanted to swim.) I felt like/as if I was swimming. (= It seemed as if I was
swimming.)
5 ordinary verb: 'receive physical sensations'
Feel can be used with a direct object to talk about the physical sensations that come to us through the
sense of touch.
I suddenly felt an insect crawling up my leg. Progressive forms are not used, but we often use can feel to
talk about a sensation that is going on at a particular moment.
/ can feel something biting me!
page 200
6 ordinary verb:'touch'
Feel can be also used with a direct object to mean 'touch something deliberately in order to learn about it
or experience it'. Progressive forms are possible.
Feel the car seat. It's wet.
'What are you doing?' Tm feeling the shirts to see if they're dry.'
209 female and feminine; male and masculine
Female and male are used to say what sex people, animals and plants belong to.
A female fox is called a vixen. A male duck is called a drake. Feminine and masculine are used for
qualities and behaviour that are felt to be typical of men or women.
She has a very masculine laugh. It was a very feminine bathroom. Feminine and masculine are used for
grammatical forms in some languages.
The word for 'moon'is feminine in French and masculine in German.
210 finally, at last, in the end and at the end
1 finally
Finally can introduce the last element in a series.
We must increase productivity. We must reduce unemployment.
And finally, we must compete in world markets.
Finally can also suggest that one has been waiting a long time for something. In this sense, it often goes
in mid-position (with the verb - see 22). After putting it off three times, we finally managed to have a
holiday
in Greece. Steve has finally found a job.
2 at last
At last also suggests - very strongly - the idea of impatience or inconvenience resulting from a long wait or
delay.
James has passed his exams at last.
When at last they found him he was almost dead. At last can be used as an exclamation. (Finally cannot
be used in this way.)
At last! Where on earth have you been? Note that lastly (introducing the last item in a series) is not the
same as at last.
Firstly, we need to increase profits. Secondly,... Thirdly,... And lastly, we need to cut down administrative
expenses. (NOT ... And at last wo need to cut down...) ,.. • ,
3 in the end
In the end suggests that something happens after a lot of changes, problems or uncertainty.
We made eight different plans for our holiday, but in the end we went to Brighton again. >
page 201


I left in the middle of the film. Did they get married in the end? The tax man will pft wi" '" rf"' ""'*
i ne tax man will get you in the end, 4 at the end
At the end simply refers to position at the end of something. There is no sense of waiting or delay.
A declarative sentence usually has a capital letter at the beginning and a full stop at the end.
I wish I was paid at the beginning of the week and not at the end.
For other expressions with end, see a good dictionary. For the verbs end and finish, see 191. For
eventually, see 196.
211 finished
Finished can be used as a normal past participle in perfect verb forms (e.g. I've nearly finished). It can
also be used as an adjective after be, meaning 'ready' (e.g. I'm nearly finished). There is not much
difference of meaning between / etc am finished (in this sense) and / etc have finished. The adjective
construction (be finished) is common in an informal style.
How soon will you be/have finished, dear?
Hang on - I'm/I've nearly finished.
I went to get the car from the garage, but they weren't/hadn't finished.
212 fit and suit
These words do not mean exactly the same.
Fitiefers to size and shape: if your clothes fit you, they are neither too-big nor too small.
These shoes don 'tfit me - have you got a larger size? Suit refers to style, colour etc.
Red and black are colours that suit me very well.
(NOT ... colours that fit me very-well.) Do you think this style suits me? \
Suit can also be used to talk about whether arrangements and situations are | convenient.
Tuesday would suit me very well for a meeting. For other uses of these two words, see a good dictionary.
213 for: purpose and cause
1 people's purposes
For can be used to talk about somebody's purpose in doing something, but only when it is followed by a
noun.
We stopped at the pub for a drink. I went to the college for an interview with Professor Taylor.
page 202
For is not used before a verb in this sense. The infinitive alone isurili express a person's purpose (see
281).
We stopped at the pub to have a drink. (NOT .. .far-hwmg&im^
I went to the college to see Professor Taylor.
(NOT .. .for seeing Professor Taylor.)
2 the purposes of things: - ing forms and infinitives
For can be used before the -ing form of a verb to express the 'pmpB'il a thing - what it is used for -
especially when the thing is the subjeniHt
clause.
Is that cake for eating or just for looking at? An altimeter is used for measuring height above sea level.
When the clause has a person as subject, it is more common to DM
infinitive to express the purpose of a thing.
We use altimeters to measure height above sea level.
3 causes of reactions
For... ing can also be used after a description of a positive ornepin reaction, to explain the behaviour that
caused it.
We are grateful to you for helping us out.
I'm angry with you for waking me up.
They punished the child for lying.
He was sent to prison for stealing.
214 for, in, from and since (time)
1 for
We use/or when we measure duration - when we say howlong something lasts.
ribr + period of time
I once studied the guitar for three years.
That house has been empty for six months.
We go away for three weeks every summer.
My boss will be in Italy for the next ten days.
I'm going to Canada for the summer. To measure duration up to the present, we use a present perfect
teKte 418 - 420), not a present tense.
I've known her for a long time. (NOT I know her for a tongtiiiitl A present tense with/or refers to duration
into the future. Compia;
How long are you here for? (= Until when...?)
How long have you been here for? (= Since when...?) We can often leave out/or in an informal style,
especiallywithflirii;.,;
And/or is not usually used before all.
How long have you been waiting (for) ?
We've been here (for) six weeks.
I've had a headache all day. \


2 in after negatives and superlatives (US)
After negatives and superlatives, in can be used to talk about duration. This is especially common in
American English.
I haven't seen him for/in months.
It was the worst storm for/in ten years.
3 from and since
From and since give the starting points of actions, events or states: they say when things begin or began.
from/since + starting point
/'// be here from three o'clock onwards.
I work from nine to five.
From now on, I'm going to go running every day.
From his earliest childhood he loved music.
I've been waiting since six o'clock.
I've known her since January.
Since is used especially when we measure duration from-the point of view of a particular present or past
end-point. A present perfect or past perfect tense is normal. From is used in other cases. Compare:
- I've been working since six o 'clock, and I'm getting tired.
(NOT I've been working from six o'clock...) lhadbeen working since six o'clock, and I was getting tired.
- The shop was open from eight in the morning, but the boss didn't arrive till
ten. (NOT The shop was open since eight...) I'll be at home from Tuesday morning (on). (NOT .. .-since
Tuesday morning.)
From is sometimes possible with a present perfect, especially in expressions that mean 'right from the
start'.
She's been like that from her childhood. (OR ... since her childhood.} From the moment they were married,
they've quarrelled. From the dawn of civilisation, people have made war.
For from ...to and from... until, see 575.
1 for and since
For and since can both be used with perfect tenses (see 418.6). They are not the same. Compare:
for + period
I've known her for three days. (NOT ... since three days:) She's been working here for a long time. (NOT ..
.since a la
since + starting point
I've known her since Tuesday. She's been working here since July.
For more about tenses with since, see 499. For since meaning 'as' or 'because', see 72.
page
204
215 forget and leave
We can use forget to talk about accidentally leaving things behind.
Oh no! I've forgotten my umbrella. However, we normally use leave if we mention the place.
Oh no! I've left my umbrella at home.
(NOT I've forgotten my umbrella at home.)
For infinitives and -ing forms after forget, see 296.1.
216 formality and politeness
1 formal and informal language
Most people speak and write in different ways on different occasions. In some languages, for example,
there are very complicated rules about how to speak to older or more important people. English does not
have a system of this kind. However, there are some words and structures which are mostly used informal
situations - that is to say, situations when people are careful about how they express themselves, like
report writing, business meetings, conferences or polite conversations with strangers. And some words
and structures are mostly used in informal situations - for example conversations with friends, or letters to
one's family. Writing is more often formal, and speech is more often informal, but informal writing and
formal speech are used when the situation makes them necessary.
Most words and expressions are neither formal nor informal, but neutral -English speakers do not have to
know two ways of saying everything.
2 grammar
Some grammatical structures have different formal and informal versions. For example, contracted
auxiliary verbs and negatives (see 144) are common in informal speech and writing. Compare:
Formal: It has gone. It is not possible.
Informal: It's gone. It isn't possible.
Prepositions come at the end of certain structures in informal language (see 440). Compare:
Formal: In which century did he live?
Informal: Which century did he live in? , Some relative structures are different (see 474.5-6). Compare:
Formal: The man whom she married...
Informal: The man she married...
Some determiners are followed by singular verb forms in formal language, and plural forms in informal
language (see 509.5). Compare: .
Formal: Neither of us likes him.
Informal: Neither of us like him. Some pronouns have different forms (see 425). Compare:
Formal: It was she who first saw what to do.
Informal: It was her that first saw what to do.
Formal: Whom did they elect?
Informal: Who did they elect? >
page 205


Ellipsis (leaving out words - see 181 -186) is more common in informal language. Compare:
Formal:
Informal:
Formal:
Informal:
Have you seen Mr Andrews? Seen John?
We think that it is possible. We think it's possible.
3 vocabulary
Some words and expressions are used mainly in informal situations; in
neutral or formal situations other words or expressions are used. Some examples:
Formal
repair
commence
in order
Thank you
I beg your pardon?
Neutral
mend(GB) begin/start all right Thank you Pardon?/Sorry?
Informal
fix
begin/start
OK
Thanks
What?
4 polite requests and questions
Formal language is of course used when one wishes to be polite - to show respect to important people or
strangers. Requests and questions can be made more polite by making them less direct. A common way
of making requests less direct is to use yes/no questions. These suggest that the hearer can choose
whether to agree or not.
Could you tell me the time, please?
(Much more polite than Please tell me the time.) Another way of making requests and questions less
direct is to use 'distancing' verb forms (e.g. past instead of present).
How much did you want to spend, sir?
For more about polite requests, see 483. For more about'distancing', see 161.
For the language used in particular social situations, see 520. For slang, see 510.
For the use of out-of-date grammar and vocabulary in ceremonies and other situations, see 388.
217 fronting
1 normal order
Affirmative sentences most often begin with the grammatical subject. Jake is a vegetarian.
If we begin a sentence with something else, this is often to make it the topic-
the thing we are talking about - even though it is not the grammatical subject.
People like that I just can't stand.
page
206
We can also move things to the front for emphasis.
Crazy, that driver. Moving something to the beginning of a sentence in this way is called
'fronting'.
2 fronted objects and complements
It is possible to begin an affirmative clause with the object or complement, in order to make this the topic
or give it more immediate importance. This kind of fronting is common in informal speech.
Very good lesson we had yesterday.
Strange people they are! Fronting of the object is also possible in a more formal style.
This question we have already discussed at some length. In a few exclamatory expressions, a noun is
fronted before that, but these are uncommon in modern English.
Fool that I was! Question-word clauses are often fronted.
What I'm going to do next I just don't know.
How she got the gun through customs we never found out.
For the use of passive structures to bring objects to the front, see 409.1.
3 detached fronted subjects and objects
In informal speech, it is common to detach a subject or object, announce it at the front of a sentence, and
then repeat it with a pronoun.
This guy who rang up, he's an architect. Well,...
That couple we met in Berlin, we don't want to send them a card, do we?
One of my brothers, his wife's a singer, he says... This does not usually happen with pronoun subjects, but
me and myself axe -occasionally detached and fronted.
Me, I don't care.
Myself, I thinkyou're making a big mistake.
4 adverbs etc
Many adverbs and adverbial expressions can go at the beginning of a clause (see 22-23). This often
happens when we are using the adverbs to structure a piece of narrative or a description.
Once upon a time there were three little pigs. One day... Then... Soon after that... After dark,...
Inside the front door there is... Opposite the living room is...
On the right you can see ...At the top of the stairs... Adverb particles are often fronted when giving
instructions to small children.
Off we go!
Down you come! Another reason for fronting adverbs is for emphasis.
Now you tell me! (= Why didn 'tyou tell me before?) >
page 207


5
6
Inversion (see 298 - 299) is necessary after some emphatic fronted adverbs and adverbial expressions.
Under no circumstances can we accept cheques.
(NOT Under no circumstances urn can...) Round the corner came Mrs Porter.
fronting with as or though
Fronted adjectives and adverbs are possible in a structure with as or though
(see 71).
Young as I was, I realised what was happening. Tired though she was, she went on working. Fast though
she drove, she could not catch them. Much as I respect his work, I cannot agree with him.
ellipsis
In a very informal style, articles, pronouns and auxiliary verbs are often left
out, bringing a more important word to the front of the clause. This is called 'ellipsis': for details, see 183.
Postman been?
Seen John? ;
Sometimes an elliptical structure is used to front a verb and/or complement,'? while the subject is put in a
'tag' (see 472) at the end. \
Likes his beer, Stephen does. '
Funny, your brother.
Nice day, isn 't it?
See also entries on information structure (289), emphasis (189) and cleft sentences (131).
218 fun and funny
These two words are sometimes confused. Fun is normally an uncountable noun. It often comes after is
and other copular verbs (see 147), and can be used to say that things or people are enjoyable,
entertaining etc. Funny is an adjective, and is used to say that something makes you laugh. Compare:
The party was fun, wasn't it? (NOT The party was funny.)
Canoeing can be a lot of fun.
Why are you wearing that funny hat? Note that funny has another meaning: 'strange', 'peculiar'.
'Celia's got a funny way of talking.' 'Do you mean funny ha-ha or funny peculiar?'
In informal American English, fun is sometimes used as an adjective. That was a real fun party.
219 future (I): introduction
There are several ways to use verbs to talk about the futuit in English. Th&X^T'This is a complicated area
of grammar: the differences betweeBtlitiiieaningsar^^ s and uses of the different structures are not easy to
analyse andteribe clearl-^-1'1^ -= ariy. In many, but not all situations, two or more structures alipossible
with l-h similar meanings.
1 present tenses
When we talk about future events which have already bffliplanned or 'T decided, or which we can see are
on the way, we often uit present tenses - ^Sses. The present progressive is common. For details, see 220.
I'm seeing John tomorrow.
What are you doing this evening?
I The present progressive of go is often used as an auxiliaiywibinsentenc^^^-ences about the future. For
details, see 220. Sandra is going to have another baby. When are you going to get a job?
The simple present can also be used to talk about the ftitiit, but only in tt1- in
certain situations. For details, see 223.
The train leaves at half past six tomorrow morning.
2 shall/will
When we are simply giving information about the future, 01 predicting f^fi ^ 8 future events which are not
already decided or obviously on ttmyxusuall^'^^ally use shall/will + infinitive (shall is rare in American
EnglisM.Fordetails, see Lessee 221.
I shall probably be home late tonight.
Nobody will ever know what happened to her.
I think Liverpool will win. Shall and will are also used to express our intentions aiiiiattitiidestowa-r^^^'wards
other people: they are common in offers, requests, threats, promises anc^^^-and announcements of
decisions. For details, see 222.
Shall I carry your bag?
I'll hit you if you do that again.
I'll phone you tonight.
'You can have it for L50."OK. I'll buy it.'
3 other ways of talking about the future
We can use the future perfect to say that something willliecompleted, finished or achieved by a certain
time. For details, see 2M,
By next Christmas we'll have been here for eight yecss The future progressive can be used to say that
somethiiErilbeinprog^0^ 3'ogress at a particular time. For details, and other uses of this tense, see 225.
This time tomorrow I'll be lying on the beach. The structure be about + infinitive is used to say that
atoeevent is v0"^ s^_s very
close. For details, see 5.
I think the plane's about to take off. Is your seat belttoap? *'
page 208
page 209
eos 209


4
5
Be + infinitive is used to talk about plans, arrangements and schedules, and to give instructions. For
details, see 90.
The President is to visitBeijing in January. You're not to tell anybody about this.
'future in the past'
To say that something was still in the future at a certain past time, we can use a past form of one of the
future structures. For details, see 226. / knew she would arrive before long.
Something was going to happen that was to change the world. subordinate clauses
In many subordinate clauses we refer to the future with present tenses instead of shall/will + infinitive. For
details, see 556.
Phone me when you have time. (NOT .. .-when ym'Urha I'll think of you when I'm lying on the beach next
week.
(NOT ... when I'll be lying on the-befieh...) I'll follow him wherever he goes. (NOT .. .-wherever he'll g You
can have anything I find. (NOT .. .anything I'll find.]
220 future (2): present progressive and be going to
1 When do we use these present tenses to talk about the future?
We use these two present tenses to talk about future actions and events that have some present reality. If
we say that something in the future is happening
or is going to happen, it is usually already planned or decided, or it is starting to happen, or we can see it
coming now.
'What are you doing this evening?' Tm washing my hair.' Look at the sky. It's goingto rain.
Note that the simple present is not often used to talk about the. future. For details, see 223.
(NOT What do you do this evening?)
2 present progressive: arrangements and plans
The present progressive is used mostly to talk about personal arrangements
and fixed plans, especially when the time and place have been decided. We're going to Mexico next
summer. I'm seeing Larry on Saturday. Did you know I'm getting a new job? What are we having for
dinner? My car's going in for a service next week.
We often use the present progressive with verbs of movement, to talk about actions which are just
starting.
Are you coming to the pub? -
I'm just popping out to the post office. Back in a minute. Get your coat on! I'm taking you down to the
doctor!
page 210

be going + infinitive: plans
This structure, too, can be used to talk about plans, especially in an informal style. Going to often
emphasises the idea of intention, of a decision that has already been made.
We're going to get a new car soon.
John says he's going to call in this evening.
When are you going to get your hair cut?
I'm going to keep asking her out until she says 'Yes'.
I'm going to stop him reading my letters if it's the last thing I do.
4 be going + infinitive: things that are on the way
Another use of the going to structure is to predict the future on the basis of present evidence - to say that
a future action or event is on the way, or starting to happen.
Sandra's going to have another baby in June.
Look at the sky. It's going to rain.
Look out! We're going to crash!
5 differences between the two structures
In many cases, both structures can be used to express the same idea. But there are some differences.
a fixed arrangement / intention
The present progressive can emphasise the idea of 'fixed arrangement'; going to can emphasise the idea
of 'intention', or 'previous decision'. Compare:
- Are you doing anything this weekend?
(asking about arrangements - more natural than Are you going to do anything this weekend?) Are you
going to do anything about that letter from the tax people?
(pressing to know what has been decided - more natural than Are you doing anything about that letter...)
- Who's cooking lunch? (asking what has been arranged) Who's going to cook lunch? (asking about a
decision)
- I'm seeing Phil tonight, (emphasis on arrangement) I'm really going to tell him what I think of him.
(emphasis on intention - NOT I'm really telling him...)
- I'm getting a new job. (It's already arranged.) I'm going to get a new job. (I've decided to.)
b events outside people's control
The present progressive is not generally used to make predictions about events that are outside people's
control.
Things are going to get better soon. (NOT Things are getting better soon.)
He's going to have an accident one of these days. (NOT He's having an accident one of these days.)
It's going to snow before long. (NOT It's snowing before long.) •
page 211


6
permanent states
The present progressive is used for actions and events, but not usually for permanent states. Compare:
Our house is getting/is going to get new windows this winter. Their new house is going to look over the
river.
(NOT Their new house is looking over the river.) commands and refusals
Both structures can be used to insist that people do things or do not do things You're finishing /going to
finish that soup if you sit there all afternoon! She's taking/going to take that medicine whether she likes it
or not! You're not playing/going to play football in my garden. You're not wearing/going to wear that skirt to
school. The present progressive is common in emphatic refusals. I'm sorry, you're not taking my car. I'm
certainly not washing your socks!
7 gonna
In informal speech, going to is often pronounced /gana/ This is sometimes shown in writing as gonna,
especially in American English. Nobody's gonna talk to me like that.
For will and shall, see 221 -222. For was going to, has been going to etc, see 226.
'1 future (3) .shall/will /
(information and prediction)
1 forms

2
+ infinitive without to
Ishall/will you will he/she/it will we shall/will they will
questions: shall/will I? will you? etc negatives: / will/shall not, you will not etc negative questions: will/shall I
not? will you not? etc o R won 't/shan 't I? won 'tyou? etc
contractions: /'//, you'll etc; shan't /fa:nt/ (GB only), won't /waunt/
British people use / shall 11 will and we shall I we will with no difference of meaning in most situations.
(For cases where there is a difference, see 222.)
However, shall is becoming very much less common than will. Shall is not normally used in American
English.
For second- and third-person uses ofshall, see 222.6.
For strong and weak pronunciations of shall and will, see 588.
For information about all uses of will, see 600.
4
6
giving information about the future; predicting
The shall/will structure is used to give (or ask for) information about the future, in cases where there is no
reason to use a present progressive or going
to (see 220).
We shall need. the money on the 15th.
It'll be spring soon.
All the family will be at the wedding.
In another thirteen minutes the alarm will go off. This will close an electrical contact, causing the explosive
to detonate.
She'll be here in a couple of minutes.
We often use shall/will in predictions of future events - to say what we think, guess or calculate will
happen.
Tomorrow will be warm, with some cloud in the afternoon.
Who do you think will win on Saturday?
Ishall be rich one day.
You'll never finish that book.
Note that some questions beginning Will you... ? are used for giving orders, not asking for information (see
paragraph 8 below).
conditional use
The shall/will structure is often used to express conditional ideas, when we say what will happen if
something else happens.
He'll have an accident if he goes on driving like that.
If it rains the match will be cancelled.
Look out-you'll fall! (If you're not more careful.)
'Come out for a drink.' 'No, I'll miss the film on TV.'
Don't leave me. I'll cry!
'predicting' the present or past
We can use will to make a kind of prediction about the present or past - to say what we think is probably
the case, or has probably happened. Don't phone them now - they'll be having dinner. 'There's somebody
at the door.' "That'll be the postman.' As you will have noticed, there is a new secretary in the front office.
It's no use expecting Barry to turn up. He'll have forgotten.
predictions as orders
Predictions can be used as a way of giving orders - instead of telling somebody to do something, the
speaker just says firmly that it will happen. This is common in military-style orders.
The regiment will attack at dawn.
You will start work at six o'clock sharp.
shall/will and present tenses: both used
Often shall/will and present-tense forms (especially the gomg to structure) are possible with similar
meanings. The choice depends on whether we want
page 212
page 213


,---~uwiJ ~a\
to emphasise present ideas like intention/certainty (present tenses), or not (shall/will.}. Compare:
- What will you do next year? What are you doing next year? What are you going to do next year?
- All the family will be there.
All the family are going to be there.
- If your mother comes, you'll have to help with the cooking.
If your mother comes, you 're going to have to help with the cooking.
- You won't believe this.
You're not going to believe this. - Next year will be different. Next year is going to he-different.
7 differences
We prefer present tenses when we are talking about future events that have some present reality (see
220). Compare:
I'm seeing Janet on Tuesday. (The arrangement exists now.) / wonder if she'll recognise me. (no present
reference) In predictions, we use going to when we have outside evidence for what we say - for example a
page in a diary, black clouds in the sky, a person who is obviously about to fall. We prefer will for
predictions when there is not such obvious outside evidence - when we are talking more about what is
inside our heads: what we know, or believe, or have calculated. (When we use will,
we are not showing the listener something; we are asking him or her to believe something.) Compare:
- Lookout- we're going to crash! (There is outside evidence.)
Don't lend him your car. He's a terrible driver -he'll crash it. (the speaker's knowledge)
- I've just heard from the builder. That roof repair's going to cost L7,000. (outside evidence - the builder's
letter)
/ reckon it'll cost about L3,000 to put in new lights, [the speaker's opinion)
- Alice is going to have a baby. (outside evidence - she is pregnant now)
The baby will certainly have blue eyes, because both parents have. (speaker's knowledge about genetics)
'
8 other uses ofshalland will
Shall and will are not only used to give and ask for information about the future. They can also be used to
express 'interpersonal' meanings such as ' 'requests, offers, orders, threats and promises. For details, see
222. Shall I open a window?
Will you get here at nine tomorrow, please? I'll break his neck!
9 will you...?
With a verb referring to a state, will you...? asks for information. How soon will you know your holiday
dates? Will you be here next week?
lucurc v«/. OAACMI <
With a verb referring to an action, will you + infinitive usually introduces an
order or request (see 222.5).
Willyou do the shopping this afternoon, please? To ask for information about people's plans, we use a
present tense (see 220)
or the future progressive (see 225).
Are you doing the shopping this afternoon? Will you be doing the shopping...?
For This is the last time I'll... and similar structures, see 307.5.
222 future (4): shall and will (interpersonal uses)
1 differences between shall and will
Shall and will are not only used for giving information about the future. They are also common in offers,
promises, orders and similar kinds of 'interpersonal' language use. In these cases, will (or 'II) generally
expresses willingness, wishes or strong intentions (this is connected with an older use of will to mean
'wish' or 'want'). Shall expresses obligation (like a more
direct form of should).
2 announcing decisions: will
We often use will when we tell people about a decision as we make it, tor
instance if we are agreeing to do something.
OK. We'll buy the tickets if you'll buy supper after the show.
'The phone's ringing.' 'I'll answer it.' (NOT Tm going-to-answer it:')
'Remember to phone Joe, won'tyou?' 'Yes, I will.'
Shall is not used in this way.
'You can have it for L50.' 'OK. I'll buy it.' (NOT '... ^shalHmy4t:') Note that the simple present is not
normally used to announce decisions.
I think I'll go to bed. (NOT -I-think I go to bed.)
'There's the doorbell.' Tllgo.' (NOT ... -^g/) To announce decisions that have already been made, we
generally prefer the
present progressive or going to (see 220).
Well, we've agreed on a price, and I'm going to buy it. Stressed will can express a strong intention.
I will stop smoking! I really will!
3 refusals: won't
Will not or won't is used to refuse, or to talkabout refusals.
I don't care what you say, I won't do it.
The car won't start. I shan't (British only) is also sometimes used in refusals, but this is
unusual in modern English. ^
page 214
page
215


5
-*., 4 asking for instructions and decisions: shall
Questions with shall I/we are used (especially in British English) to ask f
instructions or decisions, to offer services, and to make suggestions. lVi^i1 not used in this way. ls
Shall I open a window? (NOT Will/open a window?) Shall I carry your bag?
What time shall we come and see you? What on earth shall we do? Shall we go out for a meal? Let's go
and see Lucy, shall we?
giving instructions and orders: will
We can use Will you... ? to tell or ask people to do things. (In polite request Would you... ? is preferred -
see 604.5.) '
Will you get me a newspaper when you're out? Will you be quiet, please!
Make me a cup of coffee, will you? ~ || 6 threats and promises: will J|
We often use will/'ll in threats and promises. Shall is also possible in British English, especially after / and
we, but it is less common than will. I'll hityou if you do thatagain. You'll suffer for this!
I promise I won't smoke again. (NOT 7promise Idon'tsmoke...) I shall give you a teddy bear for your
birthday. Pllphoneyou tonight. (NOT I phone...)
In older English, shall was often used with second and third person subjects in threats and promises. This
is now very unusual.
You shall have all you wish for. He shall regret this. 7 obligation: shall
In contracts and other legal documents, shall is often used with third-person '-','•• subjects to refer to
obligations and duties.
The hirer shall be responsible for maintenance of the vehicle. In other cases, we prefer must or should to
express ideas of this kind.
For details of structures used in requests, see 483. For reporting of interpersonal will and shall in indirect
speech, see 481.7.
223 future C5): simple present
1 timetables etc
We can sometimes use the simple present to talk about the future. This is
common when we are talking about events which are part of a timetable or something similar.
2 subordinate clauses
The simple present is often used with a future meaning in subordinate clauses - for example after what,
where, when, until, if, than. For details,
see 556.
I'll tellyou what I find out. (NOT ... what I'll find out.) She'll pay us back when she gets a job. (NOT.. . when
she'll got a job.)
3 other cases
In other cases, we do not usually use the simple present to talk about the
future.
Lucy's coming for a drink this evening. (NOT Lucy comes...) I promise I'll phone you this evening.
(NOT I promise I phone you this evening.) 'There's the doorbell.' Til go.' (NOT ... '/go.')
Occasionally the simple present is used with a future meaning when giving and asking for instructions.
So when you get to London you go straight to Victoria Station, you meet up with the others, you get your
ticket from Ramona and you catch the 17.15 train for Dover. OK? Well, what do we do now? Where do I
pay?
224 future (6): future perfect
shall/will have + past participle1
We can use the future perfect to say that something will have been done, completed or achieved by a
certain time in the future. (For the exact meaning of by in this case, see 118.)
By next Christmas we'll have been here for eight years.
The builders say they'll have finished the roof by Tuesday. A progressive form can be used if we want to
emphasise the continuity of a future achievement.
I'll have been teaching for twenty years this summer.
(OR I'll have taught...)
We can also use will have... to 'predict the present' (see 221.4) - to say what we think or guess has
probably happened.
It's no use phoning - he'll have left by now.
For more about perfect forms, see 423. For more about progressive forms, see 450.
SO
The summer term starts on April 10th. What time does the bus arrive in Seattle? My plane is at three
o'clock. Are you on duty next weekend? *
page
page 217


xuiure (./7: future progressive
shall/will+ Ve+ .. .ing
*.1 events in progress in the future
We can use the future progressive to say that something will be in progre (going on) at a particular
moment in the future. s
This time tomorrow I'll be lying on the beach. Good luck with the exam. We'll be thinking of you.
The future progressive is also used (without a progressive meaning) to refp to future events which are
fixed or decided, or which are expected to hannp
in the normal course of events. It does not suggest the idea of personal intention.
Professor Baxter will be giving another lecture on Roman glass-making at the same time next week.
You 'II he hearing from my solicitors. I'll he seeing you one of these days, I expect.
\
2 'predicting the present'
This tense can also be used to 'predict the present' (see 221.4) - to say what we think or guess is probably
happening now.
Don't phone now- they'll be having lunch.
3 polite enquiries
The future progressive can be used to make polite enquiries about people's plans. (By using this tense to
ask 'What have you already decided?', the
speaker shows that he/she does not want to influence the listener's intentions.) Compare:
Will you be staying in this evening?
(very polite enquiry, suggesting '1 simply want to know your plans') Are you going to stay in this evening?
(pressing for a decision) Will you stay in this evening, please? (instruction or order)
In older English, Shall you + infinitive was used to make polite enquiries in this way.
4 progressive form with going to
A progressive form of the going to structure is also possible.
I'm going to be working all day tomorrow, so I won't have time to shop.
For more about the use of progressive forms for polite 'distancing', see 161. For progressive forms in
general, see 450.
226 future (8): future in the past
Sometimes when we are talking about the past, we want to talk about something which was in the future
at that time - which had not yet , happened. To express this idea, we use the structures that are normally
to talk about the future (see 219-225), but we make the verb forms past-example, instead of is going to we
use was going to; instead of the present progressive we use the past progressive; instead of will we use
would;
instead of is to we use was to.
Last time I saw you, you were going to start a new job.
I didn 't have much time to talk to her because I was leaving for Germany in two hours.
In 19681 arrived in the town where I would spend the next ten years of my life.
I went to have a look at the room where I was to talk that afternoon. Perfect forms of be going to are also
possible.
I've been going to write to you for ages, but I've only just found time.
For was to + perfect infinitive (e.g. She was to have taken over my job, but she fell ill), see 90.1. .i
227 gender (references to males and females)
English does not have many problems of grammatical gender. Usually, people are he or she and things
are it. Note the following points.
1 animals, cars, ships and countries
People sometimes call animals he or she, especially when they are thought of as having personality,
intelligence or feelings. This is common with pets and domestic animals like cats, dogs and horses.
Once upon a time there was a rabbit called Joe. He lived...
Go and find the cat and put her out. He is sometimes used in cases where the sex of an animal is not
known.
Look at the little frog, darling. Isn't he sweet? Some people use she for cars, motorbikes etc; sailors often
use she for boats and ships (but most other people use it).
'How's your new car7 "Terrific. She's running beautifully.'
The ship's struck a rock. She's sinking! We can use she for countries, but it is more common in modern
English.
France has decided to increase its trade with Romania. (OR ... her trade...)
2 he or she
Traditionally, English has used he in cases where the sex of a person is not known, or in references that
can apply to either men or women, especially in a formal style.
If I ever find the person who did that, I'll kill him.
If a student is ill, he must send his medical certificate to the College office.
A doctor can't do a good job if he doesn 't like people. Many people now regard such usage as sexist and
try to avoid it. The Expression he or she is becoming increasingly common.
If a student is ill, he or she must send a medical certificate to the
College office. >
.218
pae6 219


...... get 22
With object + adjective, the meaning is 'make something/somebody become'.
I can't get my hands warm.
We must get the house clean before Mother arrives. It's time to get the kids ready for school.
For go + adjective (go green, go blind etc), and the differences between get, go become etc,see 129. '^
3 get + adverb particle or preposition
Before an adverb particle (like up, away, out) or a preposition, get nearly
always refers to a movement of some kind. (For the difference between set and go, see 229.)
I often get up at five o'clock.
I went to see him, but he told me to get out.
Would you mind getting off my foot?
In some idioms the meaning is different - e.g. get to a place (=-arrive at...);
get over something (= recover from); get on with somebody.
With an object, the structure usually means 'make somebody/something move'.
You can't get him out of bed in the morning. Would you mind getting your papers off my desk? Have you
ever tried to get toothpaste back into the tube? The car's OK- it gets me from A toB.
4 get + past participle
Get can be used with a past participle. This^tructure often has a reflexive meaning, to talk about things
that we 'do to^iurselves'. Common expressions are get washed, get dressed, get lost, get drowned, get
engaged/married/divorced.
You 've got five minutes to get dressed.
She's getting married in June.
Get+ past participle is also used to make passive atructures, in the same way as be + past participle.
My watch got broken while I was playing with the children. He got caught by the police driving at 120 mph.
I never get invited to parties.
This structure is less often used to talk about longer, more deliberate, planned actions.
Our house was built in 1827. (NOT Our house got built in 1827.) Parliament was opened on Thursday.
(NOT Parliamentgot^pened. • •)
5 get + object + past participle
This structure can be used to mean 'finish doing something'. The past participle has a passive meaning.
It will take me another hour to get the washing done. After you've got the children dressed, can you make
the beds? Another meaning is 'arrange for something to be done by somebody else • I must get my hair
cut. You ought to get your watch repaired.
page
222
VVe can also use the structure to talk about things that happen to us. In this
case, get means 'experience'.
We got our roof blown off in the storm last week. I got my car stolen twice last year.
For the use of have in a similar structure, see 242.
g get.. .ing', get + infinitive
Get. -ing is sometimes used informally to mean 'start.. .ing', especially in the expressions get moving, get
going.
We'd better get moving- it's late. With an object, the structure means 'make somebody/something start
...ing'.
Don'tgethim talking about his illnesses.
Once we got the heater going the car started to warm up. With an infinitive, get can mean 'manage', 'have
an opportunity' or 'be
allowed'.
We didn 't get to see her- she was too busy.
When do I get to see your new baby? There is often an idea of gradual development.
He's nice when you get to know him.
You'll get to speak English more easily as time goes by. •
Wayne's getting to be a lovely kid.
With an object, the infinitive structure means 'make somebody/something do something' or 'persuade
somebody/something to do something': there is often an idea of difficulty.
I can't get that child to go to bed. Get Penny to help us if you can.
See if you can get the car to start.
For similar structures with have + object + verb form, see 242.
7 gotand gotten
In American English the past participle of get is gotten, except in the structure
have got (see 241).
229 get and go (movement)
Go is used to talk about a whole movement.
Get is used when we are thinking mainly about the end of a movement -
the arrival. Compare:
- I go to work by car and Lucy goes by train. I usually get there first.
- I went to a meeting in Bristol yesterday.
I got to the meeting at about eight o'clock. We often use get to suggest that there is some difficulty in
arriving.
It wasn't easy to get through the crowd.
I don't know how we're going to get over the river.
Can you tell me how to get to the police station?
For other uses of get, see 228. For get and go meaning 'become', see 129.
page 223


---" ""nns ZSQ
230 give with action-nouns
We often replace certain verbs by a structure with give and a noun. Th' happens, for example, with some
verbs referring to sounds made bv n (e.g. cough, cry, scream, chuckle, laugh, shout]. P16 He gave a cough
to attract my attention. Suddenly she gave a loud scream and fell to the ground. The structure can be
used with an indirect object (e.g. She gave me a sm •/
This often happens in an informal style to replace transitive verbs like n " kick, clean. '
If the car won't start, we'll give it a push. If something doesn 't work, I usually give it a kick. Couldyougive
the carpet a clean? Examples of other common expressions:
'Perhaps salt will make it taste better.' 'OK, let's give it a try.' I'llgiveyou a ring if I hear anything. (GB)
'Are you coming to the film?' 'No, I'm tired. I'll give it a miss.' (GB)
For other structures in which nouns replace verbs, spe 573. For more about structures with give, see 583.
231 go/come for a...
We can use the structure go/come for a... in some common fixed expressions referring to actions, mostly
leisure activities. Using this structure makes the action sound casual and probably rather short. (Compare
go.. .ing - see 232.) Common examples:
go/come for a walklrunlswimlridel drivel saill drink Note also the expressions go for a bath/shower.
This structure is only used with particular action-nouns - we would probably not say, for example, Come
for a ski with us or I'm going for a read.
For other structures in which nouns are used to refer to actions, see 573.
232 go / come... ing
1 go...ing
We use go with an -ing form in a number of common expressions, mostly referring to sporting and leisure
activities.
Let's go climbing next weekend.
Did you go dancing last Saturday? Common expressions: g^g,
go: climbing, dancing, fishing, hunting, riding, sailing, shooting, s skating, skiing, swimming, walking
w .
^ come.'-wg
r me.- -WSis ^^ po^ble m certain situations (for the difference between
come andgo, see 134).
Come swimming with us tomorrow.
3 prepositions
Note that prepositions of place, not direction, are used after go/come.. .ing. I went swimming in the river.
(NOT I went swimming to the river.) She went shopping at Harrods. (NOT ... to Harrods.) It's dangerous to
go skating on the lake. (NOT.. . to the lake.)
Forgo/ora...,see231.
233 gone with be
Gone can be used like an adjective after be, to say that somebody is away, or that something has
disappeared or that there is no more. -
She's been gone for three hours - what do you think she's doing?
You can go out shopping, but don't be gone too long.
When I came back my car was gone.
Is the butter all gone?
For be with finished, see 211. For been used as a past participle of go or come, see 94.
234 had better
1 meaning
We use had better to give strong advice, or to tell people what to do (including ourselves).
You'dbetter turn that music down be fore your Dad gets angry.
It's seven o'clock. I'd better put the meat in the oven. Had better may suggest a threat. It is not used in
polite requests. Compare:
Couldyou help me, if you've got time? (request)
You'd better help me. If you don't, there'll be trouble, (order/threat) Had better refers to the immediate
future. It is more urgent than should or °ught. Compare:
I really ought to go and see Fred one of these days.' 'Well, you'd better do it
soon - he's leaving for South Africa at the end of the month.' °te that had better does not usually suggest
that the action recommended
uld be better than another one that is being considered - there is no idea 0 comparison. The structure
means 'It would be good to...', not "would be better to...'. ^
page
224
page 225


2
forms
naif
./fad better refers to the immediate future, but the form is always pasr
{have better is impossible). After had better we use the infinitive withn It's late -you had better hurry up. t0-
(NOT ... you have better...)
'fymg^t^hw-fy...)
.. .^>6 . w nurry...)
In British English, better can come before had for emphasis. 'I promise I'll pay you back." You better had.'
We normally make the negative with had. better not + infinitive. You 'd better not wake me up when you
come in.
(You hadn 't better wake me... is possible but very unusual) A negative interrogative form Hadn't... better...
? is possible. Hadn't we better tell him the truth?
Normal unemphatic short answer forms are as follows:
'Shall I put my clothes away?' 'You'd better!' 'He says he won't tell anybody.' 'He'd better not.' ' ' Had is
sometimes dropped in very informal speech. You better go now. I better try again later.
235 half
1 half (of)
We can use half or half of before a noun with a determiner (article,
possessive or demonstrative). We do not normally put a or the before half (but see below).
She spends half (of) her time travelling. (NOT She spends a/the half...) I gave him half (of) a cheese pie to
keep him quiet.
When half (of) is followed by a plural noun, the verb is plural.
Half (of) my friends live abroad. (NOT Half of my friends lives...) 0/is not used in expressions of
measurement and quantity.
/ live half a mile from here. (NOT ... half of a mile...)
How much is half a loaf of bread? (NOT ... halfofa4wf...) We use half of before pronouns.
'Did you like the books?' 'I've only read half of them.' Half of us are free on Tuesdays, and the other half
on Thursdays.
2 no following noun
Half can be used without a following noun, if the meaning is clear. I've bought some chocolate. You can
have half. (NOT .. .-Yen-can have the half)
3 the half
We use the before half if we talk about a particular half. In this case, of be used before a noun.

4 rfaandaWf
4
5
id a half hour.)
Would you like the big half or the small half? I didn 't like the second half of the film.
, 226
naij <*"" ~..-y
Half usually comes before the article a/an, but it is possible to put it after in
expressions of measurement.
Could I have half a pound of grapes? (OR ... a half pound...) We usually say a half bottle to refer to a half-
sized bottle of wine or spirits.
one and a half
The expression one and a half is plural. Compare:
I've been waiting for one and a half hours. (NOT ...-« I've been waiting for an hour and a half.
For more information about numbers and counting expressions, see 385. For half two (= 'half past two'),
see 555.
236 happen
Happen can be used with a following infinitive to suggest that something happens unexpectedly or by
chance.
If you happen to see Joan, ask her to phone me.
One day I happened to get talking to a woman on a train, and she turned
out to be a cousin of my mother's.
In sentences with if, the idea of by chance can be emphasised by using should before happen.
Let me know if you should happen to need any help.
237 hardly, scarcely and no sooner
These three expressions can be used (often with a past perfect tense) to suggest that one thing happened
very soon after another. Note the sentence structure:
,^.. hardly... when/before... fe,.. scarcely... when/before... I,;... no sooner... than...
I had hardly/scarcely closed my eyes when the phone rang. She was hardly/scarcely inside the house
before the kids started screaming. I had no sooner closed the door than somebody knocked. We no
sooner sat down in the train than I felt sick. m a formal or literary style, these structures are sometimes
used with inverted word order (see 298).
Hardly had I closed my eyes when I began to imagine the most fantastic
shapes. No sooner had she agreed to marry him than she started to have terrible
doubts.
0 ^oner did Steve start going out with Tracy than she fell in love with Jasper.
or the difference between hard and hardly, see 21. P^diy any etc, see 41.3.
uspage 227


- -""" •sag
238 have (I): introduction
Have is used in several different ways:
a as an auxiliary verb
Have you heard about Peter and Corinne?
b to talk about possession, relationships and other states They have three cars.
Have you got any brothers or sisters? Do you often have headaches?
c to talk about actions and experiences I'm going to have a bath. We're having a party next weekend.
d with an infinitive, to talk about obligation (like must) I had to work last Saturday.
e with object + verb form, to talk about causing or experiencing actions and events
He soon had everybody laughing. . I must have my shoes repaired. We had our car stolen last week.
For details of the different structures and meanings, see the following sections.
For contractions (I've, haven't etc), see 144.
For weak forms, see 588.
For had better + infinitive, see 234.
239 have C2): auxiliary verb
have + past participle \
:,J 1 perfect verb forms
We use have as an auxiliary verb with past participles, to make 'perfect verb forms.
You've heard about Peter and Corinne? (present perfect: see418-420) I realised that I had met him
before, (past perfect: see 421) We'll have been living here for two years next Sunday. (future perfect: see
224)
I'd like to have lived in the eighteenth century.
(perfect infinitive: see 276) Having been there before, he knew what to expect.
(perfect participle: see 403.1)
,228
2 questions and negatives
Like all auxiliary verbs, have makes questions and negatives without do. Have you heard the news? (NOT
Do you have heard... ?) ] haven't seen them. (NOT/ don't have seen them.)
i progressive forms
There are no progressive forms of the auxiliary verb have.
I haven't seen her anywhere. (NOT I'm not having scon her anywhere.)
For contractions, see 144. por weak forms, see 588.
240 have (3): actions
1 meaning and typical expressions
We often use have + object to talk about actions and experiences, especially in an informal style.
Let's have a drink. I'm going to have a bath.
I'll have a think and let you know what I decide. Have a good time. In expressions like these, have can be
the equivalent of 'eat', 'drink', 'enjoy*, 'experience' or many other things - the exact meaning depends on
the following noun. Common expressions:
have breakfast /lunch/ supper I dinner I tea I coffee I a drink I a meal
have a bath I a wash I a shave I a shower
have a rest I a lie-down I a sleep I a dream
have a good time I a bad day I a nice evening I a day off/ a holiday
have a good journey Iflight Itrip etc -
have a talk I a chat I a word with somebody I a conversation 1 a disagreement I a row I a quarrel I a fight
have a swim I a walk I a ride I a dance I a game of tennis etc
have a try/ago
have a look
have a baby (= 'give birth')
have difficulty I trouble (in).. .ing
have an accident/ an operation I a nervous breakdown
(Note American English take a bath/shower/rest/swim/walk.) Have can also be used to mean 'receive'
(e.g. I've had a phone call from Sue). And won't have can mean won't allow (e.g. I won't have her
boyfriend in my house).
2 grammar
n this structure, we make questions and negatives with do. Got is not used. """gressive forms are possible.
Contractions and weak forms of have are "otused.
Ridyou have a good holiday? (NOT 4ladyou a good holiday?)
^yhat are you doing?' 'I'm having a bath.'
fhave lunch at 12.30 most days. (NOT I've lunch...)
0 er rommon structures in which nouns are used to talk about actions, see 573.
page 229


• 241
241 have (4): have (got) - possession, relationships and other states
1 meanings
We often use have to talk about states: possession, relationships, illnes the characteristics of people and
things, and similar ideas. es'
Her father has aflat in Westminster.
They hardly have enough money to live on.
Have you any brothers or sisters?
The Prime Minister has a bad cold.
My grandmother didn 't have a very nice personality.
The house has got a wonderful atmosphere.
Sometimes have simply expresses the fact of being in a particular situatio She has a houseful of children
this weekend. I think we have mice.
2 short and long forms
Instead of the short forms I have, you have etc, we can use longer forms made by adding got. The short
question and negative forms have I? etc and I have not etc are often avoided (and are not normally used
in American English); instead, we use longer forms with got or do. Got- forms are especially common in an
informal style.
I've got a new boyfriend. (More natural than / have anew boyfriend.} Has your sister got a car? OR Does
your sister have a car?
(More natural than Has your sister a car?} I haven't got your keys. (More natural than / haven't your keys.)
The school does not have adequate sports facilities. (More natural than
The school has not adequate sports facilities.)
3 have got (details)
Note that have got means exactly the same as have in this case - it is a present tense of have, not the
present perfect of get. Got-forms of have are
informal, and are most common in the present. Do is not used in questions and negatives with got.
I've got a new car. My mother's got two sisters. Have you got a headache?
It's a nice flat, but it hasn't got a proper bathroom. I've got an appointment with Mr Lewis at ten o 'clock.
Go t- forms of have are not used in short answers or tags. 'Have you goto light?' 'No, I haven't.'
Anne'sgota bike, hasn't she?
Got-ioims of have are less common in the past tense. / had flu last week. (NOT ^hadgotftur...) Did you
have good teachers when you were at school? Got is not generally used with infinitives, participles or -ing
forms ot na you cannot usually say to have got a headache or having got a brother.
infinitives are sometimes possible after modal verbs (e.g. She musthav a new boyfriend).
page
230
repetition and habit
^Vhen we are talking about repeated states, got-forms of have are less often used; do is normally used in
questions and negatives. Compare:
I've got toothache.
I often have toothache. Have you got time to go to London this weekend?
Do you ever have time to go to London?
- Sorry, I haven't got any beer.
We don't usually have beer in the house.
c progressive forms, weak forms and contractions
Progressive forms of have are not used with these 'state' meanings.
I have (got) a headache. (NOT J am having cirhoadac-he^) Contractions and weak forms (see 588) are
used before got. In British English, contractions are also possible before nouns with determiners like
a/an, some, any, no, every.
I've got a problem. We've some tickets for the opera, if you're interested. (GB)
I've no idea. (GB) She's every chance of a gold medal. (GB)
6 British-American differences
Traditionally, do-forms of have have been used in British English mostly to
express habit or repetition. Compare (GB):
Do you often have meetings?
Have you got a meeting today? In American English, do-forms are not limited in this way. Compare (US):
Do you often have meetings? Do you have a meeting today? (o R Have you got a meeting today?}
In modern British English (which is heavily influenced by American English), do-forms are common even
when there is no idea of repetition.
Do you have time to go to the beach this weekend? (US / modern GB) In British English, short question
and negative forms of have are possible, though these are often formal. They are not used in American
English.
Compare:
- Have you an appointment? (formal GB only)
Do you have an appointment? (US / GB)
- Birmingham has not the charm of York or Edinburgh, (formal GB only)
Birmingham does not have the charm... (US / GB) Contracted short forms of have are used only in British
English. Compare:
We've a swimming pool in the village. (GB only)
We have /We've got a swimming pool... (US/ GB) ^.t' In very informal American speech, people may drop
've (but not's) before got.
I('ve) got a problem. Got- and do-forms may be mixed in American English, especially when short
answers, reply questions and tags follow got-forms. 'I've got a new apartment."You do?' I don't think we've
got any choice, dome?
page 231


242 have (5): + object + verb form
-""" <42
Have can be followed by object + infinitive (without to), object + -ing object + past participle. ' nQ
1 have + object + infinitive/-mgrform
In this structure, have often means 'experience'. The usage is rather informal.
I had a very strange thing happen tome when I was fourteen. We had a gipsy come to the door yesterday.
It's lovely to have children playing in the garden again. I looked up and found we had water dripping
through the ceiline Note the difference between the infinitive in the first two examples (for things that
happen(ed)), and the -ing form in the last two (for things that are/were happening). This is like the
difference between the simple and progressive past tenses (see 417).
Another meaning is 'cause somebody/something to do something'.
He had us laughing all through the meal.
We'll soon have your car going.
The infinitive structure is not common in British English with this meaning It is used in American English to
talk about giving instructions or orders.
I'm ready to see Mr Smith. Have him come in, please.
The manager had everybody fill out a form. I won't have + object + -ing form can mean 'I won't allow...'
/ won't have you telling me what to do.
2 have + object + past participle
This structure can be used to talk about arranging for things to be done by
other people. The past participle has a passive meaning.
/ must have my watch repaired. (= / want my watch to be repaired.} If you don't get out of my house I'll
have you arrested.
Another meaning is 'experience'. Again, the past participle has a passive
meaning.
We had our roof blown off in the storm. King Charles I had his head cut off.
I won't have... (= 'I won't allow...') can be followed by object + past participle.
I won't have my house turned into a hotel.
For similar structures with get, see 228.5.
243 have (6): have (got) to
1 meaning
We can use have (got) + infinitive to talk about obligation. The rnea" quite similar to must; for the
differences, see 352.
Sorry, I've got to go now.
Do you often have to travel on business?
,232
Have (got) + infinitive can also be used, like must, to express certainty. (This used to be mainly an
American English structure, but it is now becoming common in British English.)
I don't believe you. You have (got) to be joking.
Only five o'clock! It's got to be later than that!
f grammar
In this structure, have can be used like an ordinary verb (with do in Questions and negatives), or like an
auxiliary verb (without do). Got is usually added to present-tense auxiliary-verb forms.
When do you have to be back7
When have you (got) to be back? Have got to is not normally used to talk about repeated obligation.
I usually have to get to work at eight. (NOT I've usually gotto...) Progressive forms are possible to talk
about temporary continued obligation.
I'm having to work very hard at the moment.
For more details of the use of do-forms and gof-forms of have, see 241.
3 future obligation
To talk about the future, we can use have (got) to if an obligation exists now;
we use will have to for a purely future obligation. Compare:
I've got to get up early tomorrow - we're going to Devon. One day everybody will have to get permission to
buy a car. Will have to can be used to tell people what to do. It 'distances' the instructions, making them
sound less direct than must (see 352). You can borrow my car, but you'll have to bring it back before ten.
For more about 'distancing', see 161.
4 pronunciation; gotta
Have to is often pronounced /'haefta/.
He'll have to /'haefta/ get a new passport soon. Note the spelling gotta, sometimes used in informal
American English (for instance in strip cartoons) to show the conversational pronunciation ofgotto.
I gotta call home.
A man's gotta do what a man's gotta do.
244 hear and listen (to)
1 hear: meaning
ear ls Ae ordinary word to say that something 'comes to bur ears'. Suddenly I heard a strange noise.
^OT -Suddenly I listened to a strange noise.)
Lan YOU hear me?
^tenfto): meaning
in n m^K used to talk about paying attention to sounds that are going on,
gross. It emphasises the idea of concentrating, trying to hear as well as
page 233


- -,-" • .nuiuiTn 24s
possible. You can hear something without wanting to, but you can only / • to something deliberately.
Compare: en
I heard them talking in the next room, but I didn 't really listen to what they were saying.
'Listen very carefully, please.' 'Could you speak a bit louder? I can't hear very well.' you
I didn't hear the phone because I was listening to the radio. .3 complete experiences: hear
Note that listen (to) is mostly used to talk about experiences that are goine on, in progress. To talk about
experiencing the whole of a performance speech, piece of music, broadcast etc, we generally use hear.
Compare:
'-- When she arrived, I was listening to a record ofBrendel playing Beethove (NOT .. .:l-wf^s4tefn4Hg...)
I once heard Brendel play all the Beethoven concertos. (NOT I once listened-to-Brondcl play...)
- I wish I had more time to listen to the radio. (NOT.. . to hcarthe-fadie:) Did you hear/listen to the news
yesterday?
4 hear not used in progressive forms
Hear is not usually used in progressive forms. To say that one hears
something at the moment of speaking, can hear is often used, especially in British English (see 125).
lean hear somebody coming. (NOT 4wn hearing...)
5 listen and listen to
When there is no object, listen is used without to. Compare:
Listen! (NOT Listen to!) Listen to me! (NOT Listen me!)
There are similar differences between see, look (at) and waten. See 489. For hear+ object + infinitive/-wig,
see 245. y
245 hear, see etc + object + verb form
1 object + infinitive or -ing form
Hear, see, watch, notice and similar verbs of perception can be followed by object + infinitive (without to)
or object + -ing form.
I heard him go down the stairs.
I heard him going down the stairs.
(NOT I heard him went down-the stairs.) , There is often a difference of meaning. We use an infinitive after
these ve to say that we hear or see the whole of an action or event, and we use an
form to suggest that we hear or see an action or event in progress, going Compare: ,
- I saw her cross the road. (= As I looked, she crossed it from one side to
other.) ^
I saw her crossing the road. (•= As Ilooked, she was crossingit-she the middle, on her way across.)
11CCU, OCC dl/ TTfcxx'UK*«-unJ
I once heard him give a talk on Japanese politics.
As I walked past his room I heard him talking on the phone.
Watch me jump over the stream.
I like to watch people walking in the street.
I heard the bomb explode. (NOT I heard the bomb exploding.)
[saw the book lying on the table. (NOT I saw the book lie...)
A progressive form can suggest repetition.
I saw her throwing stones at the other children.
After can see/hear (which refer to actions and events that are in progress - ^^
see 125), only the - ing structure is used.
I could see John getting on the bus. (NOT I could sec John get...) These structures can be used after
passive forms of hear and see. In this case,
the infinitive has to.
He was never heard to say 'thankyou' in his life. (NOT He was never hcardwy...)
Justice must not only be done; it must be seen to be done.
She was seen walking away from the accident. Passive forms of watch and notice are not used in this
way.
2 possessives not used
After these verbs, possessives cannot be used with -ing forms. ;^ I saw Mary crossing the road. (NOT I
saw Mary's crossing the road.)
3 object + past participle
In this structure, the past participle has a passive meaning.
I heard my name repeated several times. (= My name was repeated.) Have you ever seen a television
thrown through a window?
The idea of 'action or event in progress' can be given by a progressive form
(being + past participle).
As I watched the tree being cut down... I woke up to hear the bedroom door being opened slowly.
These structures are not possible after passive forms of hear and see.
5 look at
Look at can be followed by object + - ing form, and in American English also by object + infinitive.
Look at him eating!
Look at him eat! (US)
For more about verbs that can be followed by both infinitives and -ing forms, see 296. ror the oifference
between hear and listen, see 244. w see, look and watch, see 489.
^6 hear, see etc with that-clause
page
234
^he present-tense forms I hear (that)... and I see (that)... are often used to introduce pieces of news which
one has heard, read or seen on television.
/ ^w (that) Alice is expecting a baby.
1 we (that) the police are going on strike. *
page 235


-"wnelp 2^
Some other verbs can be used like this. Common examples are undp
and gather. These are often used when the speaker or writer is check'stan'I understand you're moving to a new job.' 'Yes, that's right.' 'I gather you didn't like the party.' 'What makes
you say that?'
For cases when that can be left out, see 560.
247 help
After help, we can use object + infinitive.
Can you help me to find my ring? (NOT ^em-yw-help-me^ftndmifmufi.,,,
Thank you so much for helping us to repair the car. "s'-Tung?}
We often use the infinitive without to; in British English, this is rather inf Can you help me find my ring?
Help me get him to bed.
Help can also be followed directly by an infinitive without an object. Would you like to help wash up?
For the expression can't help... ing, see 126.
248 here and there
We use here for the place where the speaker/writer is, and there for other places. ;
(on the telephone) 'Hello, is Tom there?' 'No, I'm sorry, he's not here.' (NOT ... he's not there.]
Don't stay there in the corner by yourself. Come over here and talk to us.
(in a letter) / hope you're enjoying yourself over there in the sun. But I wish you were here with me.
Note that here and there cannot normally be used as nouns. This place is terrible. It is terrible here. ;-B u
T N o T Here is terrible. Did you like that place? BUT NOT Did you like there?
There are similar differences between this and that (see 565), come and go (see 134) and bring and take
(see 112).
For here's and there's followed by plural nouns, see 509.4. For inverted word order after here and there,
see 444.6. For Here you are, see 520.18.
249 high and tall
1 What kind of things are tall?
We use tall mostly for people, trees, buildings with many floors, and a ^
other things which are higher than they are wide (e.g. factory chininey electricity pylons).
How tall are you? (NOT How high are you?)
There are some beautiful tall trees at the end of our garden.
I'd like something cool to drink in a tall glass.
236
Tn other cases we usually prefer high.
Mount Elbruz is the highest mountain in Europe. The garden's got very high walls.
measurements
measurements, we use tall for people, but we often use high for things.
Compare:
I'm six feet tall. That tree is about eighty feet high/tall.
3 distance above the ground
We use high, not tall, to talk about distance above the ground. A child standing on a chair may be higher
than her mother, although she is probably
not taller.
That shelf is too high for me to reach. The clouds are very high today.
4 parts of the body
Parts of the body can be long, but not tall.
Alex has gotbeautiful longlegs. (NOT ... tall logs.)
For big, great and large, see 105.
250 holiday and holidays
In British English, the plural holidays is often used for the 'big holiday' of the year. In other cases we
normally use the singular holiday. Compare:
Where are you going for your summer holiday(s)?
We get five days' Christmas holiday this year.
Next Monday is a public holiday. . i. The singular is used in the British expression on holiday (note the
preposition).
I met Marianne on holiday in Norway. (NOT ... on/in holidays...) Americans normally use the word
vacation. (In British English, vacation is mainly used for the periods when universities are not teaching.)
Holiday is used in American English for a day of publicly observed celebration (such as Thanksgiving),
whether or not people work on it.
251 home
1 articles and prepositions
article is used in the expression at home (meaning 'in one's own place'). ^ ^anybody at home? (NOT ... at
the home?)
18 often dropped, especially in American English. ^" anybody home?
e (without to) can be used as an adverb referrine to direction.
•* tnivil" T'U
'IK1 "go home. (NOT ... to home.) >
page 237


""Pe 233
There is no special preposition in English to express the idea of being at somebody else's home (like
French chez, German bei, Danish/Swedish /
Norwegian hos etc). One way of saying this is to use at with a possessive We had a great evening at
Philip's.
Ring up and see ifJacqueline is at the Smiths', could you? Possessive pronouns cannot be used in this
way, though. Come round to my place for a drink. (NOT .. .to mine...)
2 house and home
House is an emotionally neutral word: it just refers to a particular type of building. Home is used mostly in
more personal senses: it is the place that
somebody lives in, and can express the idea of emotional attachment to a place. Compare:
There are some horrible new houses in our village. I lived therefor six years, but I never really felt it was
my home.
252 hope
1 tenses after hope
After / hope, we often use a present tense with a future meaning.
/ hope she likes (= will like) the flowers. I hope the bus comes soon. For a similar use of present tenses
after bet, see 102.
2 negative sentences
In negative sentences, we usually put not with the verb that comes after hope. I hope she doesn 't wake
up. (NOT / don't hope she wakes up.)
For "transferred negation' with think, believe etc, see 359.
3 special uses of past tenses
We can use / was hoping... to introduce a polite request. I was hoping you could lend me some money.
I had hoped... is used to talk about hopes that were not realised - hopes for things that did not happen.
I had hoped that Jennifer would become a doctor, but she wasn't good enough at science.
For more about the use of past tenses in polite requests, see 483. For 1hope so/not, see 515.
For the differences between hope, expect, wait and look forward, see 202.
253 hopefully
One meaning of hopefully is 'full of hope', 'hoping'.
She sat there waiting hopefully for the phone to ring. ^ Another meaning is 'it is to be hoped that' or 'I
hope'. This is a fairly use in British English, and some people consider it incorrect
Hopefully, inflation will soon be under control.
Hopefully I'm not disturbing you?
how
use and word order
How is used to introduce questions or the answers to questions.
How did you do it? Tell me how you did it. I know how he did it. We also use how in exclamations. The
word order is not the same as in Questions: the verb comes after the subject in exclamations. Compare:
- How cold is it?
How cold it is! _ How do you like my hair?
How I love weekends! (NOT How do I love weekends!)
_ How have you been ?
How you've grown! (NOT How have you grown!) When how is used in an exclamation with an adjective or
adverb, this comes
immediately after how.
How beautiful the trees are! (NOT How the trees are beautiful!)
How well she plays! (NOT How she plays-wett!)
For more information about exclamations, see 201. For the difference between how and what like, see
255.
2 comparisons: how not used
In comparisons we use as or like (see 320) or the way (see below), not how. Hold it in both hands, as I like
I the way Mummy does. (NOT ... how Mummy docs.)
3 how, what and why
These three question words can sometimes be confused. Note particularly
the following common structures.
How do you know? (NOT Why do you know?) What do you call this? (NOT How do you call this?)
~ ' • --••.,., "-----•-.tl.-t--.I,,,,,!
page
238
----- J
What's that school called? (NOT How is that school called?)
What do you think? (NOT How do you think?)
What? Whatdidyou say? (NOT How? How did you say?)
Why should I think that? (NOT -Hewshould I think that?) Both What about...? and How about... ? are used
to make suggestions.
What/How about eating out this evening? Wiat about... ? is used to bring up points that have been
forgotten.
What about the kids? Who's going to look after them? In exclamations, what is used before noun phrases;
how is used before adjectives (without nouns), adverbs and verb phrases.
What a marvellous house! How marvellous! How you've changed!
other expressions beginning with how...
Many interrogative expressions of two or more words begin with how. These are "^d to ask for
measurements, quantities etc. Examples:
How much do you weigh? How far is your house?
How many people were there? How often do you come to New York?
How old are your parents? >
page 239


5
«WTT emu wiiar... like? 2r
Note that English does not have a special expression to ask for ordinal numbers (first, second etc).
'It's our wedding anniversary.' 'Congratulations. Which one?' (NOT '... the how manyoth?')
how-clauses in sentences m
In longer sentences, how-clauses are common as the objects of verbs Mr? ask, tell, wonder or know,
which can introduce indirect questions.
Don't ask me how the journey ums.
Tell us how you did it.
I wonder how animals talk to each other. Does anybody know how big the universe is?
How-clauses can also be used as subjects, complements or adverbials
-.; especially in a more informal style.
How you divide up the money is your business. This is how much I've done since this morning.
Son, spend your money how you like, only don't buy yourself anything that eats.
Prepositions can sometimes be dropped before tow-clauses, but not in all cases.
Have you got any idea (of) how she got away?
I'm worried about how we're going to pay for the car.
Let's look (at) how the sales figures are going.
6 the way
The way can often be used instead of non-interrogative how. Note that the way and how are not used
together.
Have you ever watched the way cats wash each other?
(NOT .. .-the way how eats-welsh...) The way you organise the work is for you to decide.
(NOT -The-wayhow-yeuorganise...) \
For more about the way, see 587. /
For more information about the use of prepositions before conjunctions, see 441. For infinitives after how,
see 288. For how after learn, see 310.
255 how and what... like?
1 changes
We generally use how to ask about things that change - for example peop moods and health. We usually
prefer what... like? to ask about things that
do not change - for example people's character and appearance. Comp31 •
- 'How's Ron?' 'He's very well.'
'What's Ron like?' 'He's quiet and a bit shy.' (NOT 'How's Ron2'-. • •)
- 'How does she look today7''Tired.'
'What does your sister look like?' 'Short and dark, pretty, very cheerful-looking.'
o reactions
We often use how to ask about people's reactions to their experiences.
'How was the film?' 'Very good.'
How's your steak?
How's the new job? In cases like these, what... like? is usually also possible.
256 -ic and -ical
Many adjectives end in -;c or -ical. There is no general rule to tell you which form is correct in a particular
case.
some adjectives ending in -ic
academic
artistic
athletic
catholic
domestic
dramatic emphatic energetic fantastic linguistic
majestic
neurotic
pathetic
phonetic
public
semantic syntactic systematic tragic
Some of these words ended in -ical in older English (e.g. fantastical, majestical, tragical).
New adjectives which come into the language generally end in -ic, except for those in -logical.
2 some adjectives ending in -ical
biological (and many other adjectives ending in -logical) chemical logical musical tactical critical
mathematical physical topical cynical mechanical radical grammatical medical surgical
3 adjectives with both forms
A few adjectives can have both forms without any important difference of meaning. Examples are:
algebraic(al) egoistic(al) geometric(al)
arithmetical) fanatic(al) strategic(al)
4 differences of meaning
In some cases, both forms exist but with a difference of meaning.
a classic and classical
Classic usually refers to a famous or supreme example of its type.
Vosne Romance is a classic French wine. Classical refers to the culture of ancient Greece and Rome, or
to European works of art of the so-called 'classical' period in the 18th century. (Classical music often
refers simply to any serious music, especially older music.)
She's studying classical languages.
ft's hard to learn classical guitar. >
page
240
page 241


"_ ••^•r' "-""i-ical 2S(s b comic and comical
Comic is the normal adjective for artistic comedy. comic verse Shakespeare's comic technique comic
opera
Comical is a rather old-fashioned word meaning 'funny'. a comical expression
c economic and economical
Economic refers to the science of economics, or to the economy of a en state etc. "
economic theory economic problems Economical means 'not wasting money'.
an economical little car an economical housekeeper
d electric and electrical
Electric is used with the names of particular machines that work by electricity.
an electric motor electric blankets ,
Note also: an electric shock; an electric atmosphere (full of excitement). Electrical is used before more
general words.
electrical appliances electrical equipment
electrical components electrical engineering
e historic and historical
Historic is used in the sense of'making history'.
1 January 1973 - the historic date when Britain joined the European Common Market.
Historical means 'connected with history' or 'really existing in history'. historical research a historical novel
Was King Arthur a historical figure?
f magic and magical • ^
Magic is the more common word, and is used in a number of fixed expressions.
a magic wand (= a magician's stick)
the magic word a magic carpet
Magical is sometimes used instead of magic, especially in metaphorical senses like 'mysterious',
'wonderful' or 'exciting'.
It was a magical experience.
g politic and political
Politic is a rather unusual word for 'wise', 'prudent'.
/ don't think it would be politic to ask for a loan just now. Political means 'connected with polities'.
political history a political career
242
e adverbs
Note that whether the adjective ends in -ic or -ical, the adverb ends in -ically (pronounced /ikli/). The one
common exception is publicly
(NOT ^ubIieaHy).
c nouns ending in -ics
Many nouns ending in -ics are singular (e.g. physics, athletics). Some can be either singular or plural (e.g.
mathematics, politics). For details, see 501.3.
257
idioms and collocations
1 What are idioms?
An expression like turn up (meaning 'arrive'), break even (meaning 'make neither a profit nor a loss') or a
can of worms (meaning 'a complicated problem') can be difficult to understand, because its meaning is
different from the meanings of the separate words in the expression. (If you know break and even, this
does not help you at all to understand break even.) Expressions like these are called 'idioms'. Idioms are
usually special to one language and cannot be translated word for word (though related languages may
share some idioms).
2 verbs with particles or prepositions
Common short verbs like bring, come, do, get, give, go, have, keep, make, put, and take are very often
used with prepositions or adverb particles (e.g. on, off, up, away) to make two-word verbs. These are
called 'prepositional verbs' or 'phrasal verbs', and many of them are idiomatic.
Can you look after the cats while I'm away7
She just doesn't know how to bring up children.
I gave up chemistry because I didn't like it. Many of these two-word verbs are especially common in
informal speech and writing. Compare:
- What time are you planning to turn up? (informal)
Please let us know when you plan to arrive, (more formal)
- Just keep on till you get to the crossroads, (informal) Continue as far as the crossroads. (formal)
For details of phrasal and prepositional verbs, see 582. Por the difference between prepositions and
adverb particles, see 19.
collocations (conventional word combinations)
e can talk about a burning desire or a blazing row, but we don't say
^"^^flg^eaw or a burning row. Somebody can be a heavy smoker or a cvoted friend, but not a devoted
smoker or a heavy friend. Expressions like sse are also idiomatic, in a sense. They are easy to
understand, but not so sy tor a learner to produce correctly. One can think of many adjectives that ^ght be
used with smoker to say that somebody smokes a lot - for example '& strong, hard, fierce, mad, devoted.
It just happens that English speakers
., e ^osen to use heavy, and one has to know this in order to express the a rorrectly. (A learner who uses
the wrong words for an idea like this may
page 243


_..._", .-...- •""" a"" collocations •p ^57
be understood, but he or she will not sound natural.) These convent!
combinations are called 'collocations', and all languages have larep na^ of them. Some more English
examples: -^iber,
a crashing bore (BUT NOT a crashing nuisemee) a golden opportunity (BUT NOT -a golden chance)
change one's mind (BUT NOT change one's thoughts) Thanks a lot. (BUT NOT -Thankyou a lot.) slightly
annoyed (BUT NOT -sUghtly-interesting)
if (I): introduction 258'
, ^"nai largen1^
situational language
Tho ow- "--•-- ••
The expressions that are used in typical everyday situations are often idiomatic in the same sense. With
the help of a dictionary and a grannn one could invent various possible ways of expressing a particular
idea hr generally there are only one or two ways that happen to be used by English
speakers, and one has to know what they are in order to speak or write naturally. Some examples:
Could you check the oil? (More natural than Could you inspect the oil' or Could you see how much oil
there is in the engine?)
Is it a direct/light or do I have to change? (More natural than Does the
plane go straight there or do I have to get another one?) Sorry I kept you waiting. (More natural than
Sorry1made you wait.) Could I reserve a table for three for eight o'clock? (More natural than Could
you keep me a table for three persons for eight o'clock?)
5 using idioms
Idioms are common in all kinds of English, formal and informal, spoken and written. However, informal
spoken language is often very idiomatic.
Students should not worry because they do not know all the collocations and other idiomatic expressions
that are commonly used by English speakers. If they use non-idiomatic ways of expressing ideas, they will
normally be 'understood, and English speakers do not expect foreigners to speak perfectly idiomatically or
correctly. It is therefore not necessary for students to make a special effort to learn and use idioms: they
will learn the most common idiomatic expressions naturally along with the rest of their English. If they try
consciously to fill their speech and writing with idioms the effect will probably be very strange.
Note that books of idioms often contain expressions which are slangy, rareo out of date, and which
students should avoid unless they understand exacu5' how and when the expressions are used. This is
particularly true ofcolou
idioms like raining cats and dogs, hit the nail on the head, eat like a horse as old as the hills.
For more about formal and informal language, see 216. For slang, see 510.
if (I): introduction
uncertain events and situations
riauses after if, we usually talk about uncertain events and situations:
hines which may or may not happen, which may or may not be true, etc. Ask John if he's staying tonight.
(He may or may not be staying.) If I see Annie I'll give her your love. (I may or may not see Annie.)
2 conditions
An it-clause often refers to a condition - something which must happen first,
so that something else can happen.
If you get here before eight, we can catch the early train.
Oil floats if you pour it on water.
Clauses of this kind are often called 'conditional' clauses. Verb phrases with would/should are also
sometimes called 'conditional'.
3 if... then
We sometimes construct sentences with if... then to emphasise that one thing depends on another. (Note
that we do not use if... so in this way.) If she can't come to us, then we'll have to go and see her. (NOT ...
so we'll have to go and sec her.)
4 if meaning 'if it is true that'
Another common use of i/is to mean 'if it is true that' or 'if it is the case that'. If you were in Boston, why
didn't you come and see us? If it will help, I'll lend you some money.
5 tenses
The same tenses can be used after if as after other conjunctions (see 259 for details). However, special
tenses can also be used to give the idea that something is unlikely, imaginary or untrue (see 260). If I
married you, we would both be unhappy.
(past tense used to talk about an imaginary future situation)
6 'first', 'second' and 'third' conditionals
Some students' grammars concentrate on three common patterns with if, which are often called the 'first',
'second' and 'third' conditionals.
"first conditional'
if+ present If we play tennis 'second conditional'
t/+ past If we played tennis "third conditional'
^f+past perfect •' Vwe had played tennis
I'll win.
. would -(•_iBEiflia|ttw|| / would win.
would have * panil I would have won.
page
244
naee 245


- ,_,.^.«nriaiy tense-use ';.. ~59
Although these are useful structures to practise, it is important to real' there are many different structures
with;/, and that they do not reallvT u}at into three main kinds. As far as tenses are concerned, it is more
accn lvlc^ distinguish two kinds of structure (see paragraph 2 above): (1) if wirh e t0 ordinary tenses
(including the so-called 'first* conditional), and (2) if •, 'special' tenses (including the so-called 'second' and
'third' conditional i
For details of the use of if, see the following sections. For if in indirect speech, see 481.6.
For more information about would/should, see 498. For the difference between (/and when, see 590. For
the difference between if not and unless, see 574. For the difference between if and in case, see 271.
259 if (2): ordinary tense-use
1 the same tenses as with other conjunctions
When we do not want to suggest that a situation is unreal or imaginary we use ordinary tenses with;/- the
same tenses as with other conjunctions.
Present tenses are used to refer to the present, past tenses to the past, and | so on.
If you want to learn a musical instrument, you have to practise.
If you didn't do much maths at school, you'll find economics difficult to understand.
If that was Mary, why didn't she stop and say hello? 2 present tense with future meaning
In the (/-clause, we normally use a present tense to talk about the future. (This happens after most
conjunctions - see 556.)
If I have enough time tomorrow, I'll come and see you. (NOT If I will have enough time...)
I'll give her your love if I see her. (NOT ... if I will see her.) If it's fine tomorrow, I'm going to paint the
windows.
For will in conditional if-clauses, see next paragraph and 261.1. For iy+ willin reported speech (e.g. I don't
know if I'll he here tomorrow), see 481.
3 if... will/would
We can use;/+ will in polite requests. In this case, will is not a future auxiliary; it means 'are willing to'.
If you will come this way, I'll take you to the manager's office.
If your mother will fill in this form, I'll have her luggage taken up to M room.
Would can be used to make a request even more polite.
If you would come this way... Wait over there, if you would.
We would appreciate it if you would be so kind as to let us havey cheque by return.

P"
ssed will can also be used after if when it expresses the idea of insistence. Ifvou will get drunk every night,
it's not surprising you feel ill. (= If you insist on getting drunk...)
sentences like If it will makeyou happy, I'll stop smoking, see 261.1. nre information about the' distancing'
use of would and other past forms, see 161.
4 position of if-clause
Note that an (/"-clause can come at the beginning or end of a sentence. when an (f-clause comes first, it is
often separated by a comma. Compare:
If you eat too much, you get fat.
You get fat if you eat too much.
For if not and unless, see 574. For if and whether in indirect speech, see 593. For the use of special
tenses with if, see 260-261. For some and any with if, see 522.5,
260 if (3): special tense-use
1 unreal situations
We use 'special' tenses with if when we are talking about unreal situations -things that will probably not
happen, situations that are untrue or imaginary, past events that did not happen, and similar ideas. In
these cases, we use would and past tenses to 'distance' our language from reality.
For more about 'distancing', see 161.
2 present and future situations
To talk about unreal or improbable situations now or in the future, we use a past tense in the (/"-clause
(even though the meaning is present or future), and would + infinitive in the other part of the sentence.
If I knew her name, I would tell you. (NOT If I know...) (NOT Iflwouldlenew...) (NOT ... Iwill tell you.)
She would be perfectly happy if she had a car.
What would you do if'you lostyour job? This structure can be used to make a suggestion sound less
definite (for example, if we want to be more polite).
It would be nice if you helped me a bit with the housework.
Would it be all right if I came round about seven tomorrow?
3 would, should and 'd
er I and we, should can be used in British English with thesame meaning as would (see 498).
If I knew her name, I should tell you. J we had a map we should be able to get out of here. "se 'd as a
contraction (see 144). Set up earlier if there was a good reason to.
For Is "i"^' • • "^"ing 'I advise you to ...', see 264.2. " "'""Mintheif-ria,,^ co 9R1 n
page
246
p"1 wuid in the (/-clause, see 261.8. ^should in the (/"-clause, see 261.2.
page
247


^.~-usc 260
4 if I were etc
We often use were instead of was after if. This is common in both formal informal styles. In a formal style it
is much more common than was, and many people consider it more correct, especially in American
English Th grammatical name for this use of were is 'subjunctive' (see 541).
If I were rich, I would spend all my time travelling.
If my nose were a little shorter I'd be quite pretty.
Note that were is not normally used instead of would be in polite request', (see 259.3).
We should be grateful if you would be so kind as to let us have your cheai as soon as possible. (NOT ... if
you were so-kind...)
For the expression If I were you.... see 264.
5 special tense-use and ordinary tense-use compared
In conditional clauses, the difference between, for example, if I come and if I came is not a difference of
time. They can both refer to the present or future; the past tense suggests that the situation is less
probable, or impossible, or imaginary. Compare:
- If I become President, I'll... (said by a candidate in an election) If I became President, I'd... (said by a
schoolboy)
- If I win this race, I'll... (said by the fastest runner) If I won this race, I'd... (said by the slowest runner)
- Will it be all right if I bring a friend tonight? (direct request) Would it be all right if I brought a friend
tonight? (less direct, more polite request)
6 unreal past situations
To talk about past situations that did not happen, we use a past perfect tense
(had + past participle) in the if-clause, and would have + past participle in
the other part of the sentence.
If you had asked me, I would have told you. (NOT -If you would have asked me...) (NOT -If you asked
me...) (NOT ... I had told you.)
If you had worked harder, you would have passed your exam. I'd have been in bad trouble if Jane hadn't
helped me.
7 unrealised present and future possibilities
The same structure can sometimes be used (especially in British English) to talk about present and future
situations which are no longer possible because of the way things have turned out.
If my mother had been alive, she would have been 80 next year. (o R If my mother were alive, she would
be...)
It would have been nice to go to Australia this winter, but there's no way we can do it. (o R It would be
nice...)
If my mother hadn 't knocked my father off his bicycle thirty years ago, I wouldn 't have been here now.
(OR.../ wouldn 't be here now.)
U Wf. UL11C1 puilliy
g could and might
In unreal conditional sentences, we can use could to mean 'would be able to' and might to mean 'would
perhaps' or 'would possibly'.
If I hod another L500,1 could buy a car.
If you asked me nicely, I might get you a drink. , Could have... and might have... can be used in sentences
about the past.
If he'd run a bit faster, he could have won.
If I hadn't been so tired, I might have realised what was happening.
For other cases where a past tense is used with a present or future meaning, see 422.
For if only, see 265.
For if so and if not, see 261.12.
For ordinary tenses with if, see .259.
261 if (4): other points
1 future in ^-clauses
We normally use a present tense with if (and most other conjunctions) to refer to the future (see 556).
I'll phone you if I have time. (NOT ... if I will have time.) But we use if... will when we are talking about later
results rather than conditions (when i/'means 'if it is true that' - see 258.4). Compare:
I'll give you L100 if you stop smoking. (Stopping smoking is a condition of
getting the money - it must happen first.) I'll give you L100 if it'll help you to go on holiday. (The help is a
result - it follows the gift of money.)
For if with non-future will, see 259.3.
2 if... should', if... happen to
We can suggest that something is unlikely, or not particularly probable, by using should (not would) in the
(^-clause.
If you should run into Peter, tell him he owes me a letter. If... happen to has a similar meaning.
If you happen to pass a supermarket, perhaps you could get some eggs. Should and happen to can be
used together.
If you should happen to finish early, give me a ring. Would is not common in the main clause in these
structures.
If he should be late, we'll have to start without him. (NOT ... we'd have to start without him.)
3 l/'... was/were to
this is another way of talking about unreal or imaginary future events. If the boss was/were to come in
now, we'd be in real trouble.
(= If the boss came...) What would we do if I was/were to lose my job? >
248
page 249


nwromer points zei
It can be used to make a suggestion sound less direct, and so more Dolt
If you were to move your chair a bit, we could all sit down. This structure is not used with state verbs.
If I knew her name I would tell you. (NOT If I were to knew-her-noimi For the difference between was and
were after if, see 260.4.
4 if it was/were not for
This structure is used to say that one particular event or situation chano everything.
If it wasn't/weren't for his wife's money he'd never be a director.
(= Without his wife's money...)
If it wasn't/weren't for the children, we wouldn't have anything to talk
about. To talk about the past we use If it had not been for.
If it hadn't been for your help, I don't know what I'd have done. But for can be used to mean 'if it were not
for' or 'if it had not been for'.
But for your help, I don't know what I'd have done.
5 leaving out if: conversational
If is sometimes left out at the beginning of a sentence in a conversational style, especially when the
speaker is making conditions or threats.
You want to get in, you pay like everybody else. (= If you want...)
You touch me again, I'll kick your teeth in.
6 leaving out if: formal inversion-structures
In formal and literary styles, if can be dropped and an auxiliary verb put
before the subject. This happens with were, had and should; very rarely with
other auxiliary verbs.
Were she my daughter, ...(.= If she were my daughter...) Had I realised what you intended, ...(.= If I had
realised...) Should you change your mind,... (= If you should change...)
Negatives are not contracted.
Had we not changed our reservations, we should all have been killed in the crash. (NOT Hadn't we
changed...)
For other uses of inverted word order, see 298-299.
7 extra negative
An extra not is sometimes put into (f-clauses after expressions suggesting doubt or uncertainty.
/ wonder if we shouldn't ask the doctor to look at Mary.
(= I wonder if we should ask...) I wouldn't be surprised if she didn't get married soon. (=.., if she got
married soon.)
For more details of double negative structures, see 361.
250
IP"11'1"11"1 " ~~
parallel structures: would... would
ronditional would is sometimes used in both clauses of an i/'-sentence. This • verv informal, and is not
usually written. It is common in spoken American
English.
It would be better if they would tell everybody in advance.
How would we feel if this would happen to our family? For I would be grateful if you would... etc, see
259.3.
9 parallel structures: 'd have ...'d have
In informal spoken English, if- clauses referring to the past are sometimes constructed with 'd have. This is
frequently considered incorrect, but happens quite often in educated people's speech. It is not normally
written. If I'd have known, I'd have told you. It would have been funny if she'd have recognised him.
Instead of the contracted 'd, full forms are sometimes used for emphasis or in negatives. Both had and
would occur. I didn't know. But iflhad've known...
We would never have met if he hadn't have crashed into my car. If you wouldn't have phoned her we'd
never have found out what was happening.
10 elliptical structures
In a formal style, subject + be is sometimes left out after if. If in doubt, ask for help. (= If you are in
doubt...) If about to go on a long journey, try to have a good night's sleep.
For more details of elliptical structures, see 181-186.
11 if any etc
Note also the common rather formal use of if before non-assertive words (see 374) like any, anything,
ever and not.
There is little if any good evidence for flying saucers. (= There is little evidence, if there is any at all,...)
I'm not angry. If anything, I feel a little surprised.
He seldom if ever travels abroad.
Usually, if not always, we write 'cannot'as one word. 4;
12 if so and if not
"fter if, we can use so and not instead of repeating or negating a clause that "as come before.
Areyoufree this evening? If so, let's go outforameal.
(=... If you are free...)
1 might see you tomorrow. If not, then it'll be Saturday. (=... If I don't see you tomorrow...)
13
S^ng reasons with if
y-clause can be used when somebody admits a fact and give;
f'mabit sleepy, it's because I was up all night.
•s a reason
page 251


- - " ""• '""-* -r^-o "..^ ^.c onuic meaning 2fi?
14 (/"meaning 'I'm saying this in case'
//-clauses are quite often used to explain the purpose of a remark ••; 'I'm saying this in case...' ~ "^ggest
There's some steak in the fridge if you're hungry. If you want to go home, Anne's got your car keys.
262 if (5): other words with the same meaning
Many words and expressions can be used with a similar meaning to if often with similar structures. Some
of the commonest are imagine (that) suppose (that), supposing (that) (used to talk about what might
happeni' providing (that), provided (that), as/so long as, on condition (that) (used't make conditions).
Imagine we could all fly. Wouldn't that be fun!
Supposing you fell in love with your boss, what would you do?
You can borrow my bike providing/provided you bring it back.
I'll give you the day off on condition that you work on Saturday morning
You're welcome to stay with us as/so long as you share the expenses.
For suggestions with suppose, supposing and what if, see 546. For omission of that, see 560 For when
and if, see 590.
263 if (6): meaning 'although'
In a formal style, if can be used with a similar meaning to although. This is common in the structure if+
adjective (with no verb). If is not as definite as although; it can suggest that what is being talked about is a
matter of opinion, or not very important.
His style, if simple, is pleasant to read.
The profits, if a little lower than last year's, are still extremely healthy. The same kind of idea can be
expressed with may ...but (see 334).
His style may be simple, but it is pleasant to read.
for even if/though, see 195.4.
264 if I were you
1 advice
We often use the structure If I were you... to give advice.
Iflwereyou, I'd get that car serviced. I shouldn't worry if I wereyou' If I was you... is also possible, but some
people consider it incorrect (see 260.4).
2 I should...
Sometimes we leave out If I were you, and just use / should.. • to glve (I would... is normal in American
English.) i'. I should get that car serviced. I shouldn't worry.
In this case, I should means more or less the same as you should.
•s • ., ' • • . .
"«. 252
265 if011^
We can use If only...! to say that we would like things to be different. It means the same as I wish... (see
601), but is more emphatic. The clause with if only often stands alone, without a main clause. We use the
same tenses after If only...! as after I wish.
past to talk about the present
If only I knew more people! If only I was better- looking! We can use were instead of was (see 260.4). This
is considered more correct in a formal style.
If only I were better looking!
b would + infinitive to refer to the future
If only it would stop raining, we could go out. If only somebody would smile!
c past perfect (had + past participle) to refer to the past
If only she hadn't told the police, everything would have been all right.
266 ill and sick
III is often used to mean 'unwell' in British English. (In American English ill is unusual except in a formal
style.) Ill is most common in predicative position (after a verb).
George didn't come in last week because he was ill. In attributive position (before a noun), many British
people prefer to use sick. Sick is also the normal informal American word for 'unwell'.
He spent twenty years looking after his sick father.
The President is sick. Be sick can mean 'vomit' (= 'bring food up from the stomach').
I was sick three times in the night. She's never sea-sick.
I feel sick. Where's the bathroom? (US also I feel sick to my stomach...)
w^ immediately, the moment etc (conjunctions)
In British English, immediately and directly can be used as conjunctions, .to "lean 'as soon as'.
Tell me immediately you have any news. Kneu' something was wrong immediately I arrived. Directly I
walked in the door I smelt smoke.
e moment (that), the instant (that), the second (that) and the minute (that) an be used in the same way (in
both British and American English). ' ^Phone me the moment (that) you get the results. tovedyou the
instant (that) I saw you.
ft • •
P^ mfornlati()n about when that can be left out, see 560. e and now (that) used as conjunctions, see 383,390.
page 253


""pciauves 2gg
268 imperatives
1 forms and use
In sentences like Come here, Be quiet, Have a drink or Don't worry ah the verb forms come, he, have and
don't worry are called 'imperative out lt' Affirmative imperatives have the same form as the infinitive without
negative imperatives are constructed with do not (don't) + infinitive
Imperatives are used, for example, to tell or ask people what to do to rn i. suggestions, to give advice or
instructions, to encourage and offer and t express wishes for people's welfare.
Look in the mirror before you drive off. Try again -you nearly did n Please do not lean out of the window.
Have some more tea. Tell him you're not free this evening. Enjoy your holiday.
An imperative followed by and or or can have a similar meaning to an (/"-clause.
Walkdown our street any day and you'll see kids playing.
(= If you walk...)
Shut up or I'll lose my temper. (= If you don't shut up...) Don't do that again or you'll be in trouble.
2 emphatic imperative
We can make an emphatic imperative with do + infinitive. This is common in polite requests, complaints
and apologies.
Do sit down. Do be a bit more careful.
Do forgive me-I didn 't mean to interrupt.
3 passive imperative
To tell people to arrange for things to be done to them, we often use get + past participle.
Get vaccinated as soon as you can. For more about get as passive auxiliary, see 228.4.
4 do(n't) be
Although do is not normally used as an auxiliary with be, do is used before be in negative and emphatic
imperatives (see 89). Don't be silly! Do be quiet!
5 subject with imperative
The imperative does not usually have a subject, but we can use a noun or pronoun to make it clear who
we are speaking to.
Mary come here - everybody else stay where you are.
Somebody answer the phone. Nobody move.
Relax, everybody. You before an imperative can suggest emphatic persuasion or anger. ^
You just sit down and relax for a bit. You take your hands off we. Note the word order in negative
imperatives with pronoun subjects.
Don't you believe it. (NOT You don't believe it.)
Don't anybody say a word. (NOT Anybody don't say...)
naee 254
g question tags
After imperatives, the normal question tags (see 465-466) are will you? won't vou? wouldyou? can you?
can't you? and could you? After negative Imperatives, willyou? is used.
Give me a hand, willyou?
Sit down, won't you?
Get me something to drink, can you?
Be quiet, can't you?
Don't tell anybody, willyou?
7 word order
Always and never come before imperatives.
Always remember what I told you. (NOT Remember always...) Never speak to me like that again.
8 let
Some languages have a first person imperative form (used to suggest that 'I' or 'we' should do something).
English does not have this, but there is a structure with let + infinitive that has a similar meaning. Let us is
contracted to let's except in a very formal style.
Let me see. Do I need to go shopping today7
Let's go home. Let us pray. Let can also be used with third person nouns or pronouns.
'Mr Parker's in the waiting room.' 'Let him stay there all day as far as I'm concerned.'
For more details of this use of let, see 315.
269 in and into, on and onto (prepositions)
1 position and movement
We generally use in and on to talk about the positions of things - where they are; and into and onto to talk
about directions and destinations -where things are going. Compare:
- A moment later the ball was in the goal.
The ball rolled slowly into the goal. (NOT ... rolled slowly in the goal.)
- She's in the bedroom getting dressed.
She ran into the room carrying a paper. (NOT She walked in the room...) She was walking in the garden.
Then she walked into the house. The cat's on the roof again. How does it get onto the roof?
°te that into and onto are normally written as single words. On to is also Possible in British English. o
m and on for movement
After some verbs (e.g. throw, jump, push, put) we can use both in and into,
r on and onto, to talk about directional movement. We prefer into/onto
page 255


-" << when we think of the movement itself, and in/on when we think inn
end of the movement - the place where somebody or something will1^ Compare: e-
The children Jhwn '«• -•--- •' ~
.--. -.-.^ ^Lacu, end of the movement - the place where somebody or something wili1^01^ 2^ Compare: be-
- The children keep jumping into the flowerbeds. Go and jump in the river.
- The experiment involved putting glowing magnesium into jars of pure oxygen.
Could you put the ham in the fridge?
- He was trying to throw his hat onto the roof. Throw another log on the fire.
We always use in and on after sit down and arrive.
He sat down in the armchair, and I sat down on the floor.
(NOT Ho sat down into... and I sat down onto...) We arrive in Athens at midday. (NOT We arrive into
Athew. .}
3 into for change
We normally use into after verbs suggesting change.
When she kissed the frog, it changed into a handsome prince. (NOT ... changed in a handsome prince.)
Can you translate this into Chinese? (NOT .. .translate this in-Chinese?) Cut can be followed by into or in.
Cut the onion in(to) small pieces. And note the expression in half.
I broke it in half. (NOT .. .into half.}
4 in and on as adverbs
In and on are used as adverbs for both position and movement. I stayed in last night. What have you got
on? Come in! (NOT Come into!) Put your coat on.
For the difference between in and to, see 270.
270 in and to
1 go to school in... etc
After expressions like go to school, go to work, we use in, not to, to say where the school, work etc is
located.
He went to school in Bristol. (NOT Ho went to school to Bristol) At is also possible.
She went to university at/in Oxford. For the difference between in and at, see 80.
2 arrive etc
We use in (or at), not to, after arrive and land. We arrive in Bangkok on Tuesday morning. (NOT We arrive
to Bangkok...)
What time do we land at Barcelona? (NOT ... land to BareeloW-i
in case and if
precautions
^g is mostly used to talk about precautions - things which we do in order
i,g ready for possible future situations.
I always take an umbrella in case it rains. (=... because it might rain.) . causes which refer to the future, in
case is normally followed by a present tense (like most other conjunctions - see 556).
I've bought a chicken in caseyour mother stays to lunch. (NOT ... in caseyour mother will-stay...)
in case... should
We often use should + infinitive (with a similar meaning to might) after in case. This adds the meaning 'by
chance*.
I've bought a chicken in case your mother should stay to lunch. This structure is especially common in
sentences about the past.
J wrote down her address in case I should forget it. The meaning 'by chance' can also be expressed by
(.should) happen to.
We took our swimming things in case we happened to find a pool. (OR ... in case we should happen to
find a pool.)
3 in case and if
In British English, in case and if are normally used in quite different ways.
'I do A in case B happens' usually means 'I do A first because B might happen later'. A is first.
'I do A if B happens' means 'I do A if B has already happened'. B is first.
Compare:
- Let's buy a bottle ofwine in case Roger comes.
(= Let's buy some wine now because Roger might come later.) Let's buy a bottle of wine if Roger comes.
(= We'll wait and see. If Roger comes, then we'll buy the wine. If he doesn't we won't.)
- I'm taking an umbrella in case it rains. I'll open the umbrella if it rains.
(NOT I'll open the umbrella in case it rains.)
- People insure their houses in case they catch fire. (NOT ... if they catch fire.)
People telephone the fire brigade if their houses catch fire.
(NOT ... telephone... in case their houses catch fire.) to American English, in case can sometimes be used
in the same way as if.
In case the house burns down, we'll get the insurance money. (GB If...)
4 w case of
^"e prepositional phrase in case of has a wider meaning than the Injunction in case, and can be used in
similar situations to if. In case of fire, break glass. (= If there is afire...)
page
256
page 257


-ryuaice gy
272 in front of, facing and opposite
We do not use in front of to mean 'across a road/river/room etc fro • idea is usually expressed with
opposite or facing. (US across front) ' There's a garage opposite my house. (NOT .. •-m^vnt^ifmy-ho',^-,
She sat facing me across the table. (NOT .. .-Wrfront of me. ) In front ofis the opposite of behind.
Compare:
There's a bus stop in front of the school.
(The bus stop is on the same side of the road as the school) There's a bus stop opposite the school.
(The bus stop is on the other side of the road from the school) For the difference between before and in
front of, see 97.
273 in spite of
In spite of is used as a preposition. In spite of+ noun means more or less thp same as although + clause.
We went out in spite of the rain. (=... although it was raining.) We understood him in spite of his accent.
(=... although he had a strong accent.)
In spite of is the opposite ofbecause of. Compare:
She passed her exams in spite of her teacher. (She had a bad teacher.) She passed her exams because
of her teacher. (She had a good teacher.)
In spite of can be followed by an -ing form.
In spite of having a headache I enjoyed the film. She failed the exam in spite of having worked very hard.
In more formal English, despite can be used in the same way as in spite of.
274 indeed
1 very... indeed
Indeed is often used after an adjective or adverb, to strengthen the meaning of very.
Thank you very much indeed.
I was very pleased indeed to hear from you.
He was driving very fast indeed.
Indeed is unusual in this sense without very, and is not normally used atte extremely or quite.
(NOT He was driving fast indeed.} (NOT -He-was-dming quite/extremely fast indeed.)
2 indeed with verb
Indeed can also be used after be or an auxiliary verb in order to sugges confirmation or emphatic
agreement. This is rather formal. It is coin short answers (see 493). . -^y We are indeed in terested in your
offer, and would be glad to have p soon as possible.
page
258
•It's cold."It is indeed.' 'Henry made a fool of himself.' 'He did indeed.'
For other ways of using indeed, see a good dictionary.
975 infinitives (1): introduction
infinitives are forms like (to) write, (to) stand. Unlike verb tenses (e.g. writes, tnod) infinitives do not usually
show the actual times of actions or events. They usually refer to actions and events in a more general
way, rather like -ing forms. (See 290-296).
Infinitives are generally used with the marker to; for cases when to is not used, see 277.
Besides simple infinitives like (to) write, there are also progressive infinitives (e.g. (to) be writing}, perfect
infinitives (e.g. (to) have written} and passive infinitives (e.g. (to) be written). For details of the various
forms, see 276.
Infinitives have many functions. An infinitive can be used, for example:
a after do or a modal auxiliary verb, as part of a verb phrase
Doyou think she's ready? We must get some more lightbulbs.
b as the subject or complement of a clause (see 279) To watch him eating really gets on my nerves. The
main thing is to stay calm. It's nice to talk to you.
c to express a person's purpose (see 281) He came to London to look for work.
d as object or complement of a verb, adjective or noun (see 283-287) I don't want to go to bed. I'm
anxious to contact your brother. You have the right to remain silent.
For full details of these and other uses of infinitives, see the following sections.
276 infinitives (2): forms
Besides the ordinary infinitive (e.g. (to) go, (to) work), there are also Progressive, perfect and passive
forms.
1 Progressive infinitive: (to) be... ing
UKe other progressive forms (see 450), the progressive infinitive is used to ^ggest that actions and events
are/were/will be continuing around the time we are talking about.
ft's nice to be sitting here with you.
1 noticed that he seemed to be smoking a lot.
This time tomorrow I'll be lying on the beach. (future progressive tense: see 225)
^y's she so late? She can't still be working. >.
page 259


~" <76
2 perfect infinitive: (to) have + past participle
Perfect infinitives can have the same kind of meaning as perfect tenses f 418-420) or past tenses (see
416-417). e
It's nice to have finished work. (= It's nice that I have finished.] I'm sorry not to have come on Thursday.
(=... that I didn't come )
We often use perfect infinitives to talk about 'unreal' past events: things th did not happen, or that may not
have happened. at
I meant to have telephoned, but I forgot.
You should have told me you were coming.
For details, see 278.
3 passive infinitive: (to) be + past participle
Passive infinitives have the same kind of meaning as other passive forms (see 407-414).
There's a lot of work to be done.
She ought to be told about it.
That window must be repaired before tonight.
Sometimes active and passive infinitives can have similar meanings, especially after a noun or be (see
287).
There's a lot of work to do/to be done.
4 combinations
Perfect progressive and perfect passive infinitives are common.
I'd like to have been sitting there when she walked in.
They were lucky - they could have been killed. Progressive passive infinitives are possible but unusual.
'What would you like to be doing right now?' 'I'd like to he being massaged.' Progressive perfect passive
infinitives (e.g. It must have been beingbuiltat the time) do not normally occur.
5 negative forms
Negative infinitives are normally made by putting not before the infinitive.
Try not to be late. (NOT USUALLY Try to not be late.) (NOT Try to don't be
-late.)
llllllllllVT;a V.J/. vyrixK-n-n- \.u w •
6
to
You were silly not to have locked your car. He's very busy. I'm afraid he can't be disturbed.
The marker to is normally used before infinitives (e.g. He wanted to go) • However, in some cases we use
infinitives without to (e.g. She let him go)-See 227 for details. Note that this to is not a preposition; after
the preposition to we use -ing forms (see 295.2).
7 split infinitive
A 'split infinitive' is a structure in which to is separated from the rest oftn infinitive by an adverb.
I'd like to really understand philosophy. He began to slowly get up off the floor.
p
Solit infinitive structures are quite common in English, especially in an •nformal style. Some people
consider them incorrect or careless, and avoid them if possible by putting the adverb in another position.
He began slowly to get up off the floor.
For details of the use of infinitives, see the following sections. For the use of to instead of a whole infinitive
(e.g. I'd like to), see 186.
277 infinitives (3): without to
We usually put the marker to before the infinitive (for example I want to know, It's nice to see you). But we
use the infinitive without to in some cases.
1 after modal auxiliary verbs
After the modal auxiliary verbs will, shall, would, should, can, could, may, might and must, we use the
infinitive without to.
Imustgo now. (NOT I must to go now.)
Can you help me? I would rather go alone.
Do you think she might be joking? She will probably be elected.
I will have finished by tomorrow morning. (future perfect tense - see 224)
They would have won if they had played a bit harder. The infinitive without to can also be used after need
and dare in some cases (see 357,150), and after had better (see 234).
Needldo the washing up? How dareyou call me a liar?
You'd better see what she wants.
The to-infinitive is used after ought (see 398), used (see 577), be (see 90) and have [see 2A3).
2 after let, make, hear etc
Certain verbs are followed by object + infinitive without to. They include let, make, see, hear, feel, watch
and notice.
She lets her children stay up very late. (NOT She lets her children to stay...) (NOT She lets her children
staying...)
I made them give me the money back. I didn 't see you come in.
We both heard him say that I was leaving.
Did you feel the earth move? Help can also be used in this way (see 247).
Could you help me (to) unload the car?
This structure is also possible in certain cases with have (see 242) and know (see 306).
Have Mrs Hansen come in, please, (mainly US)
I've never known him (to) pay for a drink, (perfect tenses of know only) In passive versions of these
structures (with make, see, hear, help and know) the hnnitive with to is used.
H^ was made to pay back the money.
She was heard to say that she disagreed.
or more information about structures with let, see 316. For make, see 327. or more information about see,
hear, watch etc + object + verb, see 245, 296.5, '•or verbs that are followed by object + to-infinitive, see
284. >
page
260
page 261


, _., _Q^-v-.-./v-*.**wiTnuves 27ft
3 after why (not)
...
We can introduce questions and suggestions with why (not) + infinitive without to. For more details, see
599.
Why pay more at other shops? We have the lowest prices.
Whystandup if you can sit down? Whysitdown ifyou can liedown? You're looking tired. Why not take a
holiday?
4 after and, or, except, but, than, as and like
When two infinitive structures are joined by and, or, except, but, than as or like, the second is often without
to.
I'd like to lie down and go to sleep.
Do you want to have lunch now or wait till later?
We had nothing to do except look at the cinema posters.
I'm ready to do anything but work on a farm.
It's easier to do it yourself than explain to somebody else how to do it. It's as easy to smile as frown.
I have to feed the animals as well as look after the children. Why don't you do something useful like clean
the flat? Rather than is usually followed by an infinitive without to. Rather than wait any more, I decided to
go home by taxi.
For more information about leaving words out ('ellipsis') with and, or etc, see 182.
5 afterdo
Expressions like All I did was. What I do is etc can be followed by an infinitive without to.
All I did was (to) give him a little push. What afire-door does is (to) delay the spread of a fire.
278 infinitives (4): using perfect infinitives
1 perfect or past meaning
Perfect infinitives can have the same kind of meaning as perfect or past tenses.
I'm glad to have left school. (= I'm glad that I have left...}
She was sorry to have missed Bill. (=... that she had missed Bill.)
We hope to have finished the job by next Saturday.
(=... that we will have finished...) You seem to have annoyed Anne yesterday.
(= It seems thatyou annoyed Anne yesterday.)
2 perfect infinitive for 'unreal' past
After some verbs (e.g. mean, be, would like) we can use perfect infinitives to
refer to 'unreal' past situations that are the opposite of what really happened.
I meant to have telephoned, but I forgot. (The speaker did not telephone.) He was to have been the new
ambassador, but he fell ill.
I wish I'd been there -1 would like to have seen Harry's face when Afow walked in.
page
262
intininve clause cis'siluJci-.L, uuJc^i. ui ^,^.11^,^....
With would like, would prefer and one or two other verbs, a double perfect infinitive is sometimes used in
informal speech; the extra perfect infinitive
does not change the meaning.
I would have liked to have seen Harry's face.
3 modals
After the modal verbs could, might, ought, should, would and needn't, we often use perfect infinitives to
refer to unreal situations. Did you see him fall? He could have killed himself.
(He did not kill himself.) ! You should have written -1 was getting worried.
(The person did not write.) I would have gone to university if my parents had had more money.
(The speaker did not go to university.) She needn't have sent me flowers.
(She did send flowers.)
Note that the structure modal verb + perfect infinitive does not always refer either to the past or to an
'unreal' situation. It can also be used, for instance, when we say how confident we are that something has
happened. She could/should./'ought to/may/will/must have arrived by now.
For more details, see the entries for the different modal verbs.
279 infinitive clause as subject, object or complement of sentence
1 infinitive clause as subject
In older English, an infinitive clause could easily be the subject of a sentence.
To make mistakes is easy.
To wait for people who were late made him angry. In modem English, this is unusual in an informal style.
We more often use it as a 'preparatory subject' and put the infinitive clause later (see 301 for details).
Ifs easy to make mistakes.
It made him angry to wait for people who were late. When we are talking about an activity in general, we
often use an -ing structure at the beginning of a sentence as the subject, rather than an infinitive clause
(see 292).
Selling insurance is a pretty boring job. (More natural than To sell insurance...)
for more information about -ing forms, see 290 - 296.
infinitive clause as complement
An infinitive clause can be used after be as a subject complement.
My ambition was to retire at thirty.
Your task is to get across the river without being seen. Sentences like these can also be constructed with
'preparatory it' (see 301).
It was my ambition to retire at thirty.
It is your task to get across the river without being seen. ^
page 263


3 infinitive as object
Many verbs can be followed by an infinitive clause in the place of the di object. Compare: ect
- / like cornflakes for breakfast, (noun object)
/ like to have cornflakes for breakfast, (infinitive clause as object)
- She wants some exercise, (noun object)
She wants to dance, (infinitive object) For details of verbs that can be followed by an infinitive, see 283.
4 infinitive with its own subject
Sometimes it is necessary to make it clear who or what is the subject of an infinitive, especially if this is
not the same as the subject of the sentence The subject of the infinitive is normally introduced by/or. For
Ann to go to France would make me very happy. (NOT Ann to go to Franco would...)
For details of this structure, see the next entry. |
For the use of it as a 'preparatory object' in structures like He made it difficult to refuse, I see 302.
280 infinitive clause introduced by for + noun/pronoun
1 infinitive with its own subject
The structure for+ noun/pronoun + infinitive is very common in English. It is used when an infinitive needs
its own subject. Compare:
- Ann will be happy to help you. (Ann will help.)
Ann will be happy for the children to help you. (The children will help.)
- My idea was to learn Russian.
My idea was for her to learn Russian.
- To ask foe would be a big mistake.
For you to ask foe would be a big mistake. (NOT -Yeu-to ask Joe would be...)
Note that the subject of the infinitive is the object of the preposition/or, Object forms of pronouns are used.
Ann will be happy for them to help you. (NOT .. .for they to hclpyoik) 2 use
The structure is often used when we are referring to possibility, necessity or frequency, when we are
expressing wishes, suggestions or plans for the future, and when we are giving personal reactions to
situations. Like other infinitive structures, it is used especially after adjectives, nouns and verbs, can also
act as the subject or object of a clause. It often has the same meaning as a that-clause. Compare:
It's important/or the meeting to start on time. It's important that the meeting should start on time.
naee 264
infinitive clause introduced by for + noun / pronoun 280
after adjectives (wishes etc)
Thp structure for+ object + infinitive can be used after certain adjectives hich express wishes and other
personal feelings about the importance or alue of future events (e.g. anxious, eager, delighted, willing,
reluctant).
adjective +/or + object + infinitive
I'm anxious for the party to be a success.
She's eager for us to see her work.
Robert says he'd be delighted/or Mary to come and stay.
4 with preparatory it
For-structures with preparatory it (see 301) are common with many adjectives expressing possibility,
necessity, importance, urgency, frequency and value judgements.
(...) it (...)+ adjective +for + object + infinitiv®i
It's impossible/or the job to be finished in time.
Would it be easy for you to phone me tomorrow?
It's important for the meeting to start at eight.
It seems unnecessary for him to start work this week.
I consider it essential for the school to be properly heated.
Is it usual for foxes to come so close to the town?
I thought it strange for her to be out so late.
It's not good for the oil tank to be so close to the house. Other common adjectives that are used in this
way include vital, necessary, pointless, unimportant, common, normal, unusual, rare, right, wrong. Note
that likely and probable are not used like this.
She's likely to arrive this evening.
(NOT It's likely for her to arrive this evening.)
It's probable that she'll be in a bad temper, o R She'll probably be... (NOT It's probable for her to be...)
5 after nouns
The structure can also be used after nouns in expressions with meanings similar to the adjectives listed
above. Examples are: time, a good/bad idea, plan, aim, need, request, mistake, shame. It's time for
everybody to go to bed. His idea is for us to travel in separate cars. There's a plan for Jack to spend a
year in Japan. Our aim is for students to learn as quickly as possible. It was a big mistake for them not to
keep John as manager. It was a real shame for them not to win after all their work.
after something, anything, nothing etc
Something, anything, nothing and similar words are often followed by for + object + infinitive.
Have you got something for me to do?
There's nothing for the cats to eat.
Is there anybody for Louise to play with in the village?
I must find somewhere for him to practise the piano. >


, uluuuwcu i>yiui fiiuLin/ pronoun
280
' after verbs
ft?r-structures are not normally used in object position after verbs.
I need you to help me. (NOT -I need for you to help me.) However, verbs which are normally followed
by/or (e.g. ask, hope, waif look, pay, arrange) can often be used with/or + object + infinitive.
Anne asked for the designs to be ready by Friday.
I can't wait for them to finish talking.
Can you arrange for the gold to be delivered on Monday? (NOT .. .for the gold being delivered^)
A few other verbs can be used with this structure. Examples are suit and tal-(time) (see 551). ^
When will it suit you for us to call? It took twenty minutes for tlie smoke to clear.
In informal American English, like, hate, mean, intend and some other verb with similar meanings can be
used with a/or-structure. This is not usually possible in British English.
I would like for you to stay as long as you want.
She hates for people to feel sad.
Didyou mean for John to mail those letters?
after too and enough
A/or-structure is often used after too and enough. This is much too heavy foryou to lift. There are too many
people here for me to talk to all of them. Do you think it's warm enough for the snow to melt? I explained
enough for her to understand what was happening.
as subject or object
The/or-structure can be the subject of a clause;
For us to fail now would be a disaster. For her to lose the election would make me very happy.
However, it is more common for a structure with preparatory it to be used
(see paragraph 4 above).
It would make me very happy for her to lose the election. Preparatory it is normal when the/or-structure is
the object of a clause. He made it very difficult for us to refuse.
for there to be
The infinitive of there is (there to be) is common after/or. I'm anxious for there to be plenty of time for
discussion. It's important/or there to be afire escape at the back of the building-
that-clsaises
Instead of the for + object + infinitive structure, a that-clause with shou a subjunctive is often possible,
especially when we want to express Wis recommendations, suggestions and plans for the future. A that-
clause usually more formal than a/or-structure.
It is important that there should be afire escape.
I'm anxious that the party should be a success.
ee 266
His idea is that we should travel in separate cars. It is essential that the meeting start at eight.
For the use of should or the subjunctive in that-dwses, see 541.4. cnr more information about too and
enough, see 570,193.
For more
281 infi1111^6 Causes of purpose
We often use an infinitive to talk about a person's purpose - why he or she
does something.
I sat down to rest. (NOT I sat down for resting /for to rest.)
He went abroad to forget. I'm going to Austria to leam German.
To switch on, press red button. We can also use in order to (more formal) or so as to.
He got up early in order to have time to pack.
I moved to a new flat so as to be near my work. In order to and so as to are normal before 'stative' verbs
like be, know and have.
I watched him in order to know more about him.
(More natural than / watched him to know more about him.) We normally use in order I so as before a
negative infinitive.
I'm going to leave now, so as not to be late.
(NOT I'm going to leave now, not to be late.) A/or-structure (see 280) can be used to talk about a purpose
that involves action by somebody else.
I left the door unlocked for Harriet to get in.
For the use of/or to talk about purposes and causes, see 213. For and + verb instead of an infinitive after
go, come, try etc, see 52.
282 infinitive clauses: other uses
1 / came home to find...
Infinitive clauses can be used to say what somebody found out or learnt at the end of a journey or task.
/ arrived home to find that the house had been burgled. The idea of surprise or disappointment can be
emphasised by using only before the infinitive.
After driving all night we got to Amy's place, only to discover that she was
away. He spent four years getting a degree, only to leam that there were no jobs
for graduates.
2 to hear her talk, you'd think...
. "ifinitives of see and hear can be used to explain the reason for a false topression. The infinitive structure
is usually followed by you'd think or a
^milar expression.
0 see them together, you'd think they were an old married couple. But
they only met yesterday.
0 see him walk down the street, you'd never know he was blind. 0 hear her talk, you'd think she was made of
money.
page 267


_ ,_".,^«~«tCT^.^^.tttiorTci[)S 281
283 infinitive complements (1): after verbs
verbs that can be followed by infinitives
After many non-auxiliary verbs, we can use the infinitives of other verhn
It's beginning to rain.
I don't want to see you again.
She seems to be crying.
I expect to have finished by tomorrow evening.
The car needs to be cleaned. Common verbs that can be followed by infinitives (for more detailed entri
nri *;omp nfthpop c^f* Tnrlovl'
on some of these, see Index):
afford begin fail intend agree care forget learn appear choose goon like arrange consent happen love ask
• continue hate manage attempt dare help mean (can't) bear decide hesitate neglect beg expect hope
offer
prefer seem prepare start pretend swear promise trouble propose try refuse want regret wish remember
Some of these verbs can be followed by object + infinitive (e.g. / want her to be happy). For details, see
284. A few verbs are followed by verb +/or+ object + infinitive (e.g. / arranged for her to have violin
lessons}. For details of these, see 280.7.
After some verbs we can use not only an infinitive but also an -ing form (sometimes with a difference of
meaning). For details, see 296.
After some verbs, it is not possible to use an infinitive. Many of these can be followed by -ing forms.
I enjoy sailing. (NOT I enjoy to sail.) For details of verbs that can be followed by -ing forms, see 293.
For infinitive clause objects with preparatory it (e.g. I'll leave it to you to lock up; I find tt
difficult to run fast), see 302. For perfect infinitives after verbs, see 278. For have + infinitive (e.g. I have to
go now), see 243. For be + infinitive (e.g. You are to start tomorrow), see 90. For fee able + infinitive, see
3. For go + infinitive as future auxiliary, see 220. For and + verb instead of an infinitive after try, come, go
etc, see 52. For general information about 'verb + verb' structures, see 579. For information about the
structures that are possible with a particular verb, see a good
dictionary.
284 infinitive complements (2): after verb + object
1 verbs that can be followed by object + infinitive
Many verbs in English are followed by object + infinitive, rather than by that-c\a\ise.
She didn 't want me to go. (NOT She didn 't want that I go.)
They don't allow people to smoke.
(NOT They don't allow that people smoke.)
page 268
/ didn't ask you to pay for the meal.
(NOT I didn't ask that you pay for the meal.) Some common verbs that can be followed by object +
infinitive:
advise hate persuade
allow help (see also 247) prefer
ask instruct recommend
(can't) bear intend remind
^ga invite request
cause leave teach
command like tell
compel love tempt
encourage
expect
forbid
force
get (see also 228)
mean
need
oblige
order
permit
trouble
want
warn
wish (see also 601)
Some verbs (e.g. let, make, see, hear, feel, watch, notice, have, and sometimes know and help), are
followed by object + infinitive without to.
Why won't you let me explain?
I heard her open the door and go out. For details, see 277.
Many of the verbs listed above can also be followed by other constructions such as an -ing form or a that-
d&use.
Some verbs cannot be followed by object + infinitive; for example suggest. I suggested that she should go
home. (NOT I suggested her to go home.)
For verbs that are followed by for + object + infinitive (e.g. / arranged for her to go early),
see 295.3.
2 passive structures
Many of the verbs listed in paragraph 1 can be used in passive structures with infinitives. The normal
structure is subject + passive verb + infinitive.
We were advised to come early.
You are expected to start work at 8.00 every morning. However, some verbs can be used with infinitives in
active structures but not passives - for example like, dislike, love, hate, prefer, wish and verbs with similar
meanings.
She likes people to be happy.
(BUT NOT People arc liked to be happy by her.)
I prefer you to call me by my first name. (BUT NOT ^ourorc preferred to call...)
or general information about passive structures, see 407-414. ror object + to be + complement after verbs
of thinking and feeling (e.g. I considered Mm to
be an excellent choice), see 580. For ^niciures with take (e.g. The ferry took two hours to unload), see 551.
r ^tailed information about the structures that are possible with a particular verb, see a
good dictionary.
page 269


"-- ^«vcs 28s
285 infinitive complements (3): after adjectives
1 reactions and feelings
Infinitives are often used after adjectives which describe people's react" and feelings. lons
I'm pleased to see you. John was surprised to get Ann's letter
She's anxious to go home. We're happy to be here.
I was shocked to see how ill he was.
Most people are afraid to hear the truth about themselves. Not all adjectives of this kind are followed by
the infinitives of other verh some are followed by preposition + -ing form (see 294), or by that-clawp (see
12). Some adjectives (e.g. afraid, sure) can be followed by either an infinitive or an -ing form, often with a
difference of meaning: for details
For structures with/or (e.g. She's anxious for the children to go home), see 280.
2 other adjectives
Besides adjectives referring to reactions and feelings, many other common adjectives can be followed by
infinitives. Examples are right, wrong, stupid,
certain (see 296.15), welcome, careful, due, fit, able (see 3), likely (see 321), lucky.
We were right to start early. I was stupid to believe h im. She's certain to win. You're welcome to stay as
long as you like. Be careful not to wake the children. It's very likely to rain. You were lucky not to be killed.
For structures with preparatory it (e.g. It is important (for the children) to get to bed early), see 301.
3 superlatives etc
Superlatives can be followed by an infinitive structure. The meaning is similar to an identifying relative
clause (see 474).
He's the oldest athlete ever to win an Olympic gold medal.
(=... who has ever won...) This structure is also common with first, second, third etc, next, last and only.
Who was the first person to climb Everest without oxygen?
The next to arrive was a big black snake.
She's the only scien tist to have won th ree Nobel prizes. Note that this structure is only possible when the
noun with the superlative has a subject relationship with the following verb. In other cases, an infinitive
cannot be used.
Is this the first time that you have stayed here? (NOT ... the first time for you to stay here.)
4 subject of clause = object of infinitive
Some adjectives can be used with infinitives in a special structure, in wf the subject of the clause is really
the object of the infinitive. Example!a easy, difficult, impossible, good, ready, and adjectives after enough
and He's easy to amuse.
(= To amuse him is easy. OR It is easy to amuse him.)
Japanese is difficult for Europeans to learn.
(= It is difficult for Europeans to learn Japanese.) His theory is impossible to understand.
(= It is impossible to understand his theory.) Are these berries good to eat? The letters are ready to sign.
The apples were ripe enough to pick. The box was too heavy to lift. But note that easy, difficult and
impossible cannot be used in this structure when the subject of the clause is the subject of the infinitive.
Other
structures have to be used.
Iron rusts easily. (NOT 4rm is easy to^-ust:) She has difficulty learning maths. (NOT She is difficult to leam
maths.)
This material can't possibly catch fire.
(NOT ^fhts-matenal-is-tmpossible to catch fire.) The structure often ends with a preposition.
She's nice to talk to. He's very easy to get on with.
It's not a bad place to live in. Note that we do not put an object pronoun after the infinitive or preposition
in these cases.
Cricket is not very interesting to watch.
(NOT -Cricket is not very interesting to watch it.)
She's nice to talk to. (NOT She's nice to talk to her.) When the adjective is used before a noun, the
infinitive usually comes after
the noun.
It's a good wine to keep. (NOT It's a good to keep wine.)
For more about enough! too + adjective + infinitive, see 193, 570. For so + adjective + infinitive (e.g.
Would you be so kind as to hold this fora moment?),
see 513.6. For information about the structures that are possible with a particular adjective, see a good
dictionary.
286 infinitive complements (4):
after nouns and pronouns
1 nouns related to verbs
We can use infinitives after some nouns which are related to verbs that can be followed by infinitives (e.g.
wish, decide, need).
I have no wish to change. (= I do not wish to change.)
I told her about my decision to leave. (= I told her that I had decided to leave.)
Is there any need to ask Joyce? (= Do we need to ask Joyce?) Not all nouns can be followed by infinitives
in this way.
I hate the thought of getting old. (N o T .. .4he4heught to get old,) wd ""te that not all related verbs and
nouns are followed by the same ' structures. Compare:
- 1hope to arrive.
There's no hope of arriving.
She prefers to live alone.
1 understand her preference for living alone. •
270
page 271


- ^ _,--•°nj
- I do not intend to return.
I have no intention of returning.
2 nouns related to adjectives
We can also use infinitives after some nouns which are related to adjectiv or which have an adjectival
sense. es> You were a fool to agree. (= You were foolish to agree.) What a nuisance to have to go! (= How
annoying to have to go!) It's a pleasure to see you again. (= It's pleasant to see you again.) The car's a pig
to start. (=... difficult to start.)
3 purpose
An infinitive can be used after a noun, or an indefinite pronoun such as something, anything, to explain the
purpose or intended effect ofapanicula thing: what it does, or what somebody does with it. The noun or
pronoun can be the subject or object of the infinitive.
Subjects
Have you got a key to open this door?
It was a war to end all wars.
I'd like something to stop my toothache.
Objects
/ need some more books to read. Is there any milk to put on the cornflakes? Did you tell her which bus to
take? Is there anything to drink?
Some/any/nowhere can also be followed by infinitives. The kids want somewhere to practise their music.
If the noun or pronoun is the object of the infinitive, we do not add an object
pronoun after the infinitive.
I gave her a paper to read. (NOT ... a paper to read it.) He needs a place to live in. (NOT ... a place to live
in it.)
4 quantifiers
Quantifiers like enough, too muchlmanyllittle/few, plenty etc are often followed by noun + infinitive.
There was enough light to see what I was doing.
There's too much snow (for us) to be able to drive.
We've got plenty of time to see the British Museum. Enough is often dropped before room and time.
There's hardly (enough) room to breathe in here.
Do you think we'll have (enough) time to do some shopping?
5 infinitive with preposition
When a noun is followed by infinitive + preposition, another structure'^ possible: noun + preposition +
whom/which + infinitive. This is very ° Mary needs a friend to play with.
o R Mary needs a friend with whom to play. He's looking for a place to live in.
OR He's looking for a place in which to live.
^ae 272
This is not possible when there is no preposition. One cannot say, for example, TmeelrO-book which to
read.
6 the life to come etc
In expressions like the life to come (= 'life after death'), the world to come, his wife to be (= 'his future
wife'), the infinitive has the same meaning as a relative clause with be (= the life/world that is to come, his
wife that is to be).
For infinitives used to talk about people's purposes, see 281. For passive infinitives (e.g. There's work to
be done), see 287. For structures with/or + object + infinitive (e.g. Is there any need for Peter to ask
Joyce?),
see 280.5. For infinitives after first, next, test or superlative + noun (e.g. the first woman to climb
Everest), see 285.3.
For/or + -ing referring to purpose (e.g. stuff for cleaning silver), see 294. For detailed information about the
structures that are possible with a particular noun, see a
good dictionary.
287 infinitive complements (5): active and passive infinitive with similar meaning
1 obligation
The structure noun + infinitive can express the idea of obligation. Active and
passive infinitives are both possible.
I've got letters to write. The carpets to be cleaned are in the garage.
If the subject of the clause is the person who has to do the action, active
infinitives are used.
I've got work to do. (NOT I've got work to be done.)
If the subject is the person or thing that the action is done to, passive
infinitives are normally used after be.
These sheets are to be washed. (NOT These shoots arc to wash.) This form is to be filled in in ink. (NOT
This form is to fill in...) The cleaning is to be finished by midday. (NOT.. . is to finish...)
Active infinitives are possible in a structure with/or (see 280). This form is for you to fill in.
In other cases, active and passive infinitives are often both possible with the
same meaning.
There's a lot of work to do/to be done.
There are six letters to post/to be posted.
Give me the names of the people to contact/to be contacted.
The people to interview I to be interviewed are in the next room.
n
to be seen/found/congratulated etc
he Passive infinitives of see and find are normal after be. He was nowhere to be seen/found. (NOT He was
nowhere to sec/find.) e can use a similar structure to express value judgements with verbs like ^ngratulate,
encourage, avoid.
011 are to be congratulated. (NOT.. . to congratulate.) rhls behaviour is to be encouraged. >
page 273


..-..,, ^.,n^ now etc
288
But note the common expression to blame, meaning 'responsible' if unfortunate event). or ^Qii Nobody was
to blame for the accident.
3 nothingto do and nothingto be doneetc
Note the difference between There's nothing to do and There's noth' done. "gtobe
I'm bored - there's nothing to do. (= There are no entertainments ) There's nothing to be done - we'll have
to buy a new one. (= There's no way of putting it right.}
For structures like She's easy to amuse, see 285.4.
For structures with take (e.g. The ferry took two hours to unload}, see 551. For more about be + infinitive,
see 90. ,
;88 infinitive complements (6):
after who, what, how etc
1 indirect questions
In indirect speech (see 481), we can use an infinitive after the question words who, what, where etc (but
not usually why). This structure expresses ideas such as obligation and possibility.
/ wonder who to invite. (=... who I should invite.)
Show me what to do.
Can you tell me how to get to the station?
(=... how I can get to the station?) I don't know where to put the car. Tell me when to pay.
I can't decide whether to answer her letter. (BUT NOT -f-can't understand why to do it.)
2 direct questions
We do not usually begin a direct question with How to...? What to...? etc. After question words, we often
use shall and should.
How shall I tell her? (NOT How to tell her?)
What shall we do? (NOT -What to do?)
Who should I pay? (NOT Who to pay?)
3 titles
How to.... What to... etc are often found as titles for instructions, information leaflets, books etc.
HOW TO IMPROVE YOUR PRONUNCIATION WHAT TO DO IF FIRE BREAKS OUT
For questions beginning Why (not) + infinitive, see 599. For more information about question words, see
460.
fSfffr -w.
^formation structure
'J
different ways of organising information
When we talk about a situation, we can usually organise the information in
ious ways - for example, by choosing different elements of the situation
(PC subject of a clause or sentence.
The storm blew Margaret's roof off.
Margaret's roof was blown off in the storm.
Margaret had her roof blown off in the storm. Thp way we choose to organise information in a clause or
sentence can deoend on what has been said before, on what the listener already knows,
Qp what we want to emphasise. This is a complicated area of English erammar, and it is still not very well
understood. Some guidelines are given
below.
2 normal order: important new information last
Most often, a clause or sentence moves from 'known' to 'new': from low to high information value. So we
often choose as the subject a person or thing that is already being talked about or that has already been
mentioned, or something that speaker and hearer are both familiar with, or even some new information
that is not the main point of the message. The important new information generally comes at the end of a
clause or sentence.
'How's Joe these days ?"0h,flne. He's just got married to a very nice girl.'
(More natural than '...A very nice girl's just gat married to him.') My father was bitten by a dog last week.
(More natural than A dog bit my father last week.) Our dog bit the postman this morning.
(More natural than The postman was bitten by our dog this morning.) 'I can't find my clothes.' 'Well, your
trousers are under my coat.'
(More natural than '... My coat's on your trousers.')
To avoid beginning a clause with a completely new element, we can use the there is structure. For details,
see 563. There's a cat on the roof.
(More natural than A cat's on the roof.)
For 'known' and 'new' information with as, since and because, see 72.
3 getting the right subject: actives, passives, etc
In many situations, there is an agent (the person or thing who does something) and a recipient (the person
or thing that something is done to).
we want to make the agent the subject, we can usually do this by choosing an active verb form (see 10).
Tlu> storm blew Margaret's roof off. Somebody's stuck chewing gum all over the carpet. e want to make the
recipient the subject, we can usually do this by
.""g a passive verb form (see 407). "Margaret's roof was blown off in the storm. hewing gum's been stuck
all over the carpet. *-
page
274
page 275


ising
_ ,^. .. mwnimuun srructure 30
If we want to make something else the subject, we can often do this hv a structure with have + object +
past participle (see 242.2). su
Margaret had her roof blown off in the storm.
The carpet's had chewing gum stuck all over it.
Other structures with have can be used to 'personalise' a situation bvm i,-a person the subject. Compare:
^"g
The house is full of children. There are children all over the housp I've got the house full of children.
We can often get the subject we want by choosing the right verb. Comn
- The biscuit factory employs 7,000 people.
7,000 people work for the biscuit factory.
- He led the children through the silent streets.
The children followed him through the silent streets.
Some verbs (called 'ergative verbs') can have both agent and recipient subjects. For details, see 579.3.
She opened the door. The door opened. 4 end-weight
Longer and heavier structures usually come last in a clause or sentence. (These usually have the highest
'information-value' in any case.)
Children are sometimes discouraged by the length of time it takes to leam a musical instrument. (More
natural than The length of time it takes to leam a musical instrument sometimes discourages children.)
Because of this, we often use a structure with 'preparatory it' in order to
move a clause or infinitive subject or object to the end of a sentence. For details, see 301.
It worried me that she hadn't been in touch for so long.
(More natural than That she hadn't been in touch for so long
worried me.)
It's important to tell us everything you know.
(More natural than To tell us everything you know is important.) He made it clear that he was not in the
least interested.
(More natural than He made that he was not in the least interested clear.)
Adverbs do not normally separate the verb from the object in an English
clause (see 22.1). However, a very long and heavy object may come after a shorter adverb. Compare:
She plays the violin very well. (NOT She plays very well the vieUtk)
She plays very well almost any instrument that you can think of, aw QI several that you can't.
" i ',.« End-weight can also affect the word order of indirect questions. Cornp" • I'm not sure what the point
is.
I'm not sure what is the point of spending hours and hours discussing this.
5 emphatic structures
There are various ways of giving extra emphasis to one part of a sen e ^ One way is to use a 'cleft
sentence' with it or what: this emphasises
^f' -ing forms ('gerunds' and 'participles'): introduction 290
by putting everything else into a subordinate clause. For details, see 131.
It was my mother who finally called the police.
What I need is a hot bath and a drink.
If we move to the beginning of a sentence something that does not normally go there, this gives it extra
emphasis. This kind of structure ('fronting') is common in speech, where intonation can make the
information structure clear. For details, see 217.
The other plans we'll look at next week. Nice man, your uncle.
For more information about emphasis, see 189.
290 -ing forms ('gerunds' and 'participles'):
introduction
1 uses and terminology
We can use -ing forms (e.g. smoking, walking) not only as verbs, but also like adjectives, adverbs or
nouns. Compare:
You're smoking too much these days. (part of present progressive verb)
There was a smoking cigarette end in the ashtray. (adjective describing cigarette end)
She walked out of the room smoking, (similar to an adverb)
Smoking is bad for you. (noun: subject of sentence)
When -ing forms are used as verbs, adjectives or adverbs, they are often called 'present participles'. (This
is not a very suitable name, because these forms can refer to the past, present or future.) When they are
used more like nouns, they are often called 'gerunds'. In fact, the distinction is not really as simple as this,
and some grammarians prefer to avoid the terms 'participle' and 'gerund'. For a detailed discussion of this
point, see Section 17.54 of A Comprehensive Grammar of the English language, by Quirk, Greenbaum,
Leech and Svartvik (Longman 1985).
In Practical English Usage the expression '-ing form' is used except when there is a good reason to use
one of the other terms. Noun-like uses of-ing forms are discussed in sections 292-296. Ways of using -ing
forms like adjectives and adverbs are discussed in sections 403-406, together with similar uses of'past
participles' (e.g. invited, broken).
perfect, passive and negative -ing forms
"ote the structure of perfect, passive and negative -ing forms. Having slept for twelve hours, I felt
marvellous, (perfect) She loves being looked at. (passive) Not knowing what to do, I went home.
(negative) hesangry about nothavingbeen invited, (negative perfect passive) >
276


-ing forms used as modifiers 291
3 -ing clauses
We can combine -ing forms with other words into clause-like structures.
She went running out of the room. Collecting stamps is a hobby of his. Having lost all my money, I went
home. Who's the man sitting in the corner?
For spelling rules, see 533-535.
291 -ing forms used as modifiers
-
-ing forms can be used as modifiers before nouns. This can happen both with noun-like -ing forms
('gerunds') and adjective-like -ing forms ('participles'). The two structures do not have quite the same kind
of meaning. Compare:
- a waiting room (= a room for waiting- waiting is a gerund, used rather
like a noun) a waiting train (= a train that is waiting- waiting is a participle, used
rather like an adjective)
- a sleeping pill (sleeping is a gerund)
a sleeping child (sleeping is a participle) - working conditions (gerund)
working men and women (participle)
For more about the difference between participles and gerunds, see 290. For noun + noun structures, see
378-382. For participle structures, see 403-406.
292 -ing forms used like nouns (I): subject, object or complement
1 subject, object or complement
An -ing form can be the subject, object or complement of a verb. Smoking is bad for you. (subject) I hate
packing, (object) My favourite activity is reading, (complement)
2 -ing form with its own object
The -ing form subject, object or complement is still a verb, and can have i
own object.
Smoking cigarettes is badforyou. I hate packing suitcases.
My favourite activity is reading poetry.
3 determiners and possessives with -ing forms
We can often use determiners (for example the, my, this) with -ing i° the opening of Parliament I don't
mind your going withou Does my smoking annoy you? I hate all this useless arguing.
Possessive 's forms are also possible.
John's going to sleep during the wedding was rather embarrassing-She was angry at Una's trying to lie to
her.
-ing forms used like nouns (2): after verbs 293
4
Note that possessives and pronouns are not used before -ing forms if it is already clear who is being
talked about.
Thank you for waiting. (NOT Thank you for your waiting.) When an -ing form is used with an article, it
cannot usually have a direct object. Instead, we can use an qf-structure.
the smoking of cigarettes (NOT the smoking cigarettes) No is often used with an -ing form to say that
something is not allowed, or is impossible. The structure often occurs alone in notices; it can also follow
there is.
NO SMOKING NO PARKING NO WAITING
Sorry - there's no smoking in the waiting room.
She's made up her mind; there's no arguing with her.
object pronouns before -ing forms
In an informal style it is more common to use object forms (like me, John) instead of possessives (my,
John's) with -ing forms, especially when these come after a verb or preposition.
I don't mind you going without me.
She was angry at Una trying to lie to her. Some verbs (e.g. see, hear, watch, feel) are normally followed
by object + -ing form.
[saw him getting out of the car. (NOT I saw his getting...)
it...-ing
We can use it as a preparatory subject or object for an -ing form (see 301-302).
It's nice being with you.
I thought it pointless starting before eight o'clock. This is common with any/no good, any/no use and (not)
worth (see 603).
It's no good talking to him - he never listens.
Is it any use expecting them to be on time? ^
I didn't think it worth complaining about the meal. Possessives or object pronouns (but not subject
pronouns) can be used before the -ing forms in these structures.
It's no use his/him apologising -1 shall never forgive him. (NOT It's no use he apologising...)
nouns and -ing forms
•"hen there is a noun which has a similar meaning to an -ing form, the noun is usually preferred.
^e're all excited about his arrival. (NOT ... about his arriving;)
3 -"ig forms used like nouns (2): after verbs
verbs ^t can be followed by -ing forms
^ some verbs we can use an -ing form, but not normally an infinitive.
He^^""8"1^ (NOT I enjoy to travel.) She's lshed mendm8 ^e car. (NOT He's finished to mend...) The/1^*1 up!imoking
(NOT .. .fiverwpio smoke.) uoctor suggested taking a long holiday.
6


Some common verbs that are normally followed by -ing forms:
dislike
endure
enjoy
escape
excuse
face
fancy
feel like
finish
forgive
Some verbs can be followed by both -ing forms and infinitives -paragraph 4 below.
admit appreciate avoid burst out
(crying/laughing) consider contemplate delay deny detest
give up
(can't) help

Postpone
Practise

imagine
involve

Put off
resent

keep (on)

resist

leave off

risk

mention
mind

^an't) stand
suggest

miss

understand

see
2 verb + object + -ing form
Some of the verbs listed above, and some others, can be followed by object + -iragform.
I dislike people telling me what to think.
I can't imagine him working in an office.
Nobody can stop him doing what he wants to.
Would you rather spend time gardening or spend money paying somebody to do it for you?
Did you see her talking to the postman ? Stop (in an informal style) and prevent are often followed by
object + from + -ingform.
Try to stop/prevent them (from) finding out. Note that after many verbs we can use possessive + -iragfonn
rather than object + -iwgform, especially in a formal style. (See 292.3 for details.)
3 - ing form with passive meaning
After deserve, need and require, the -ing form has a passive sense. This structure is more common in
British English.
I don't think his article deserves reading. (=... deserves to be read.)
Your hair needs cutting. (=... needs to be cut.) In informal British English, want can also be used like this.
The car wants servicing. (=... needs to be serviced.)
4 - ing form or infinitive
After some verbs, either an -ing form or an infinitive can be used. These include:
advise allow can't bear begin continue
forbid forget
go
goon
hate
hear
intend
like
love
permit
prefer propose regret remember
start stop
try watch
see
In some cases there is a difference of meaning between the two structur see 296 for details.
-ing forms used like nouns (3):
after nouns and adjectives
noun/adjective + -mgform: examples
Some nouns and adjectives can be followed by -ing forms. A preposition is normally used to connect the
noun/adjective to the -ing form. Nouns/ adjectives that are followed by -ing forms cannot usually be
followed by infinitives (see paragraph 3 for some exceptions).
I hate the idea of getting old. (N o T ... the idea to get old.)
The thought of failing never entered his head. (NOT ^he-thought to fail...)
I'm tired of listening to this. (NOT I'm tired to listen...)
She's very good at solving problems. (NOT .. .good to solve...)
; purpose
For + -ing form can be used after a noun, or after an indefinite pronoun such as something or anything, to
explain the purpose of an object or
material - what it is for.
A strimmer is a machine for cutting grass and weeds.
I need something for killing flies.
Have you got any stuff for cleaning silver? This structure is mostly used to talk in general about types of
object and material. When we talk about an individual's purpose in using a particular object, we are more
likely to use an infinitive after the noun or pronoun
(see 213.2).
I must find something to kill that fly.
3 -ing form or infinitive
After some nouns and adjectives, we can use either an -ing form or an infinitive. Normally there is little or
no difference of meaning.
We have a good chance of making/ to make a profit.
I'm proud of having won I to have won.
For be used to.. .ing, see 578.
For infinitives after nouns and adjectives, see 285-286.
For information about the structures that are possible after a particular noun or adjective,
see a good dictionary.
95 -ing forms used like nouns (4):
after prepositions
1 Derail prepositions
When we put a verb after a preposition, we normally use an -ing form, not an 'nfinitive.
You can't make an omelette without breaking eggs. ^OT ... without to break eggs.)
For details of the structures used after a particular verb, see a good dictionary.
^ways check the oil before starting the car. (NOT ... before to start the car.)
280
page 281


"""ns 293
W? gor the job finished by working sixteen hours a day.
He's talking about moving to the country, nflfi They painted the house instead of going on holiday. (NOT ..
.-instead to go...)
I look forward to hearing from you. (NOT .. .-to hcarfrom-you.} 2 to as a. preposition
To is actually two different words. It can be an infinitive marker show that the next word is an infinitive (e.g.
to swim, to laugh). It ca t?
a preposition, followed for example by a noun (e.g. She's gone to the s!0 *36 Hook forward to Christmas). '
When to is a preposition, it can be followed by the -ing form of a verb h not normally by the infinitive.
Common expressions in which this hann" are look forward to, object to, be used to, prefer (doing one thing
to doy"8 another), get round to, in addition to.
In the following examples, note how the preposition to can be followed hv either a noun or an -ing form.
- I look forward to your next letter.
I look forward to hearing from you. (a common way of closing a letter)
- Do you object to Sunday work?
Do you object to working on Sundays?
- I'm not used to London traffic. I'm not used to driving in London.
- I prefer the seaside to the mountains. I prefer swimming to walking.
- I'll get round to the washing up sooner or later.
I'll get round to doing the washing up sooner or later. A few verbs and adjectives are used with to before
nouns, but are followed by the infinitives of verbs. Examples are agree, consent, entitled, inclined, prone.
She agreed to our plan I She agreed to do what we wanted.
He's inclined to anger I He's inclined to lose his temper. Accustomed can be followed by to + -ing form or
an infinitive (see 296.11).
3 object + infinitive after for
Note that some verbs are followed by for + object + infinitive. An -wgfonn is not usually possible in these
cases.
We're still waiting for her to arrive. (NOT ... waiting for-herwtw^ Can you arrange for us to get tickets?
(NOT ... for our gctting-tfekets2)
For the difference between used to + infinitive and be used to + -ing form, see 577-578. For -ing forms
after conjunctions (e.g. When planninga holiday.. •}, see 406.6. For time clauses with on + -ing form, see
406.6,
VVfV -ing rorms used nice nouns var. -ing rornror innmnver zu
ing forms used like nouns (5):
J^a form or infinitive?
me verbs and adjectives can be followed by either an -ing form or an
ln J started playing/ to play the violin when I was 10. She was proud of having won I to have won.
. gprne cases, there is a difference of meaning.
^ remember and forget
Remember/forget + -ing form refers back to the past - to things that one did Forget.. .ingis used mosdy in
the phrase I'll never forget.. .ing, and expressions with similar meanings.
I still remember buying my first bicycle.
I'll never forget meeting the Queen.
Remember/forgets infinitive refers forward in time - to things that one still has or still had to do at the
moment of remembering or forgetting.
You must remember to fetch Mr Lewis from the station tomorrow.
I forgot to buy the soap.
2 goon
Go on + -mgform means 'continue'.
She went on talking about her illnesses until we all went to sleep. Goons infinitive refers to a change of
activity.
She stopped talking about her illnesses and went on to tell us about all her other problems.
3 regret
Regrets -iragform refers back to the past - something that one is sorry one did.
I regret leaving school at 14-it was a big mistake. Regrets infinitive is used mostly in announcements of
bad news.
We regret to inform passengers that the 14.50 train for Cardiff will leave approximately 37 minutes late.
We regret to say that we are unable to help you.
4 advise, allow, permit and forbid
In active clauses after these verbs, we use an -ing form if there is no object. "there is an object we use an
infinitive. Compare:
Iwouldn't advise taking the car - there's nowhere to park.
I wouldn't advise you to take the car...
We don't allow/permit smoking in the lecture room.
We don't allow/permit people to smoke in the lecture room.
The headmistress has forbidden singing in the corridors.
The headmistress has forbidden children to sing... '°te the corresponding passive structures.
Smoking is not allowed/permitted in the lecture room.
People are not allowed/permitted to smoke in the lecture room. >
page
282
page 283


-ing lurms useu HKe nouns'ro.): -mg rorm or mtlnitive?
- Singing is forbidden.
Children are forbidden to sing.
- Early booking is advised.
Passengers are advised to book early.
5 see, watch and hear
After these verbs, the difference between object + -iwgform and obiert infinitive is like the difference
between progressive and simple tenses to-
-ing forms the verbs suggest that one pays attention to events or action ^ are already going on; infinitives
usually refer to complete events/action which are seen/heard from beginning to end. (Note that these
verbs are followed by the infinitive without to.) Compare:
- I looked out of the window and saw Mary crossing the road.
I saw Mary step off the pavement, cross the road and disappear into th post office.
- As I passed his house I heard him practising the piano. I once heard Brendel play all the Beethoven
concertos.
For more details, see 245. For differences between see and watch, see 489.
6 try
To talk about making an experiment - doing something to see what will happen - we use try + -ing.
I tried sending her/lowers, writing her letters, giving her presents, but she
still wouldn't speak to me.
To talk about making an effort to do something difficult, we can use either try+ infinitive or try+ -ing.
I tried to change the wheel, but my hands were too cold. (OR/ tried changing the wheel...)
7 mean
Mean in the sense of 'involve', 'have as a result* (see 339) can be followed by an -ing form.
If you want to pass the exam it will mean studying hard. In the sense of 'intend', mean is followed by an
infinitive.
I don't think she means to get married for the moment.
8 learn and teach
These verbs (and others with similar meanings) are followed by -ing foiw3 when we are referring to lessons
or subjects of study.
She goes to college twice a week to learn typing.
Mr Garland teaches skiing in the winter and rock-climbing in the
summer.
Infinitives are used when we talk about the result of the study-about successfully learning a skill.
She learnt to read German at school, but she leamt to speak it in Germany.
I taught myself to type.
284
"V -ing forms used like nouns (5): -ing form or infinitive? 296
9 like, love, hate and prefer
After these four verbs, both infinitives and -ing forms can generally be used without a great difference of
meaning.
I hate working/to work at weekends.
I don't get up on Sundays. Ipreferstaying /to stay in bed. In British English, like + -ingis used mostly to talk
about enjoyment, and like
infinitive mostly to talk about choices and habits. In American English, like + infinitive is common in both
senses. Compare:
I like climbing mountains, (more typically GB)
I like to climb mountains, (more typically US)
When I'm pouring tea I like to put the milk in first. (GB/US) After would like, would prefer, would hate and
would love, infinitives are most often used.
I'd like to tellyou something. (NOT I'd like telling you something.)
'Can I give you a lift?' 'No thanks, I'dprefer to walk.' (NOT .. .I'dprefer walking.)
Compare:
Do you like dancing? (= Do you enjoy dancing?) Wouldyou like to dance? (= Do you want to dance now?)
For more about like, see 319. For details of structures with prefer, see 435.
10 begin and start
Begin and start can be followed by infinitives or -ing forms. Usually there is no important difference.
She began playing I to play the guitar when she was six.
He started talking/to talk about golf, but everybody went out of the room. After progressive forms of begin
and start, infinitives are preferred.
I'm beginning to learn karate. (NOT I'm beginning learning karate.) Infinitives are also preferred with
stative verbs like understand, realise, know.
I slowly began to understand how she felt. (NOT ... began understanding...)
He started to realise that if you wanted to eat you had to work. (NOT ... started realising...)
11 attempt, intend, continue, can't bear, be accustomed to, be committed to
After these words and expressions we can generally use either an -ing form or an infinitive without much
difference of meaning.
I intend telling/ to tell her what I think.
Imnot accustomed to giving/give personal information about myself to strangers.
FM detaik of structures with to + -ing, see 295.2.
'^form or infinitive of purpose: stop
. " e yGrbs that are followed by -ing forms can also be followed by an nltlve of purpose (see 281). A common
example is stop. hopped running. (NOT .. A stopped to run.) hopped to rest. (=... in order to rest.) >
page 285


_-o - ,^^a ^;. -nig iurin or infinitive? to • 06
13 afraid
To talk about fear of things that happen accidentally, we prefer afraid of+ -ing.
I don't like to drive fast because I'm afraid of crashing. 'Why are you so quiet?' 'I'm afraid of waking the
children.'
In other cases we can use afraid of+ -ingai afraid + infinitive with n difference of meaning.
I'm not afraid of telling/to tell her the truth.
14 sorry
Sorryfor/about + -ingis used to refer to past things that one regrets [Th clauses are also very common in
an informal style.) I'm sorry for/about losing my temper this morning. (o R I'm sorry that I lost my temper.)
Sorry + perfect infinitive can be used with the same meaning. This is rathp formal.
I'm sorry to have woken you up. (OR I'm sorry that I woke you up.) Sorry + infinitive is used to apologise
for current situations - things that one is doing or going to do, or that one has just done.
Sorry to disturb you-could I speak to you for a moment?
I'm sorry to tellyou that you failed the exam.
Sorry to keep you waiting- we can start now.
15 certain and sure
Certain/sure of+ -ing are used to refer to the feelings of the person one is talking about.
' Before the game she felt certain of winning, but after a few minutes she
realised it wasn't going to be so easy. Youseem very sure of passing the exam. I hope you're right. •,;
Certain/sure + infinitive refer to the speaker's or writer's own feelings. The repairs are certain to cost more
than you think.
(NOT The repairs are certain of costing...) 'Kroftova's sure to win - the other girl hasn't got a chance.' Note
that He is sure to succeed means 'I am sure that he will succeed'.
16 interested
To talk about reactions to things one learns, interested + infinitive is commonly used.
/ was interested to read in the paper that scientists have found out how talk to whales.
I'm interested to see that Alice and Jake are going out together.
I shall be interested to see how long it lasts. To talk about a wish to find out something, both interested+ -
ing and interested + infinitive are common, ^gy
I'm interested in finding out/to find out what she did with all that wo
Aren't you interested in knowing/to know whether I'm pregnant.

page
286
mversiun \.i}: auAmciiy veiu cii; uciuic SUUJCL;I c,s
,^ about a wish to do something, we usually use interested with an -ing
^^m interested in working in Switzerland. Do you know anybody who could help me? (NOT -I'm interested
to work in Switzerland...)
the difference between used to + infinitive and be used to + -ing, see 577-578. For Meet + -ins form or '"""it^e
after get and have, see 228.5-6 and 242.
^97 instead (of)
1 preposition: instead of
instead is not used alone as a preposition; we use the two words instead of.
I'll have tea instead of coffee, please. (NOT ... insteadfoffw...)
Can you work with Sally instead of me today, please? Instead of is not usually followed by an infinitive.
I stayed in bed all day instead of going to work. (NOT ... instead (of) to go to work.)
2 instead o/and without
These are sometimes confused. We use instead o/when one person, thing or action replaces another. We
use without to say that a person, thing or action is not together with another. Compare:
- Ruth was invited to the reception, but she was ill, so Lou went instead of
her. (Lou replaced Ruth.) (NOT ... Lou wont without her.) Max and Jake were invited, but Max was ill, so
Jake went without him. (Normally they would have gone together.)
- She often goes swimming instead of going to school. (Swimming replaces
school.) (NOT She often goes swimming without going to school.) She often goes swimming without
telling her mother. (Swimming and telling her mother should go together.) (NOT She often goes swimming
instead of telling her mother.)
3 adverb: instead
Instead (without of) is an adverb. It most often comes at the beginning or end of a clause.
She didn 't go to Greece after all. Instead, she went to America.
Don't marry Phil. Marry me instead.
OQp •
-° "iversion (1): auxiliary verb etc before subject
auxiliary verb + subject + main verb have/be + subject + main verb :
we P"1 an auxiliary verb (and non-auxiliary have and be) before the subject -01 a clause in several different
structures.
1 questions
fiave yourfather and mother arrived?
(NOT -Have arrived your father and mother?) ^
page 287


invcraroii 11.1; auAiiiary vcru eic Derore Subject 9a
Where is the concert taking place?
(NOT -Where is taking place the concert?)
(NOT -Where the concert is taking place?) Note that spoken questions do not always have this word order
(see 46?1
You're coming tomorrow?
Indirect questions do not usually have this order (see 481.6). I wondered what time the film was starting.
(NOT .. .-what time was the film starting.) (NOT .. .-what time was starting the film.)
However, in formal writing inversion is sometimes used with be in indirp t questions after how, especially
when the subject is long.
I wondered how reliable was the information I had been given.
For more information about questions, see 461-466.
exclamations
Exclamations often have the same structure as negative questions (see 360)
Isn't it cold? Hasn't she got lovely eyes? In spoken American English, exclamations often have the same
form as ordinary (non-negative) questions.
Have you goto surprise coming! Am I mad! In a rather old-fashioned literary style, inversion is sometimes
found in exclamations after how and what.
How beautiful are the flowers! What a peaceful place is Skegness!
For more information about the grammar of exclamations, see 201.
with way
May can come before the subject in wishes. May all your wishes come true!
May he rot in hell!
after so, neither, nor
In 'short answers' and similar structures, these words are followed by auxiliary verb + subject.
'I'm hungry.' 'So am I.' 'I don't like opera.' 'Neither/Nor do I.'
For more details of these structures, see 516 and 364.
after negative and restrictive expressions
If a negative adverb or adverbial expression is put at the beginning of a
clause for emphasis, it is usually followed by auxiliary verb + subject. The
structures are mostly rather formal.
Under no circumstances can we cash cheques.
At no time was the President aware of what was happening.
Not until much later did. she leam who her real father was. ^
The same structure is possible after a complete clause beginning not «"_• Not until he received her letter
did he fully understand the depth of feelings.
. 288
299
Inversion is also used after restrictive words like hardly, seldom, rarely, little and never, and after
expressions containing only. These structures, too, are
formal or literary.
Hardly had I arrived when trouble started.
Seldom have I seen such a remarkable creature.
Uttle did he realise the danger he faced.
Never.. • was so much owed by so many to so few. (Churchill)
Only then did I understand what she meant.
Only after her death was I able to appreciate her.
Not only did we lose our money, but we were nearly killed. Inversion is not used after non-emphatic
adverbial expressions of place
and time.
Not far from here you can see foxes.
(NOT Not far from here canyou...) Inversion is used when not + object is put at the beginning of a
sentence for
emphasis.
Not a single word did she say. -*
after as, than and so
Inversion sometimes happens after as, than and emphasising so in a
literary style.
She was very religious, as were most of her friends.
City dwellers have a higher death rate than do country people.
So ridiculous did she look that everybody burst out laughing.
conditional clauses
In formal and literary conditional clauses, an auxiliary verb can be put before
the subject instead of using if.
Were she my daughter... (= If she were my daughter...) Had I realised what you intended... (= If I had
realised...)
Negatives are not contracted in this case.
Had we not spent all our money already,... (NOT -Hadnt-wc spent...)
For more details of this structure, see 261.6. For more about fronting, see 217.
inversion (2): whole verb before subject
after adverbial expressions of place
"hen an adverbial expression of place or direction comes at the beginning °ra clause, intransitive verbs are
often put before their subjects. This ^pens especially when a new indefinite subject is being introduced.
The ructure is most common in literary and descriptive writing. under a tree was lying one of the biggest
men I had ever seen. On the grass sat an enormous frog. Erectly in front of them stood a great castle.
long the road came a strange procession.
is structure is often used in speech with here, there and other short ^erbs and adverb particles. >
page 289


Here comes Freddy! (NOT -He There goes your brother.
' Freddy
I stopped the car, and up walked a policeman. If the subject is a pronoun, it goes before the verb. Here
she comes. (NOT -Here-eemes-she.^) Off we go!
2 reporting
In story-telling, the subject often comes after reporting verbs like sa'// suggested etc when these follow
direct speech. ' ^^d,
'What do you mean?'asked Henry. (OR ... Henry asked.) 'I love you,'whispered Jan.
If the subject is a pronoun, it usually comes before the verb. 'What do you mean?'he asked.
10 irregular verbs
1 common irregular verbs
This is a list of the more common irregular verbs. Students should check that
they know all of them. For a complete list of English irregular verbs, see a good dictionary.
Infinitive
arise awake
be bet beat
become begin bend bind bite bleed blow break bring build burn buy
catch
choose
come
cost
cut
Simple past
Past participle
arose

arisen

awoke

awoken

was, were

been

bet, betted

bet, betted

beat

beaten

became

become

began

begun

bent

bent

bound

bound

bit

bitten

bled

bled

blew

blown

broke

broken

brought

brought

built

built

burnt/burned

burnt/burned

bought

bought

caught

caught

chose

chosen

came

come

cost

cost

cut

cut

Infinitive
deal
dig
do
draw
dream
drink drive
eat
fall
feed
feel
fight
find
fly
forget
forgive
freeze
get give
go grow
hang
have
hear
hide
hit
hold
hurt
keep know
lay
lead
lean
learn
leave
lend
let
lie
Ught
lose
make "lean meet
Simple past
Past participle
dealt /delt/

dealt /delt/

dug did

dug done

drew

drawn

dreamt /dremt/

dreamt /dremt/

dreamed /driimd/

dreamed /driimd/

drank

drunk

drove

driven

ate /et/

eaten /'i:tn/

fell

fallen

fed

fed

felt

felt

fought found

fought found

flew

flown

forgot forgave
froze

forgotten
forgiven frozen

got

got

gave went

given gone/been

grew

grown

hung had

hung had

heard /h3:d/

heard /h3:d/

hid

hidden

hit

hit

held

held

hurt

hurt

kept knew

kept known

laid

laid

led

led

leant/leaned

leant/leaned

learnt/learned

learnt/learned

left

left

lent

lent

let

let

lay lit/lighted lost

lain lit/lighted
lost

made

made

meant /ment/

meant /ment/

met

met

, 290


Infinitive

Simple past

Past participli

pay

paid

paid

put

put

put

read /ri;d/

read /red/

read /red/

ride

rode

ridden

ring

rang

rung

rise

rose

risen

run

ran

run

say

said /sed/

said /sed/

see

saw

seen

sell

sold

sold

send

sent

sent

set

set

set

shake

shook

shaken

shine

shone /Jbn/

shone /Jbn/

shoot

shot

shot

show

showed

shown

shut

shut

shut

sing

sang

sung

sink

sank

sunk

sit

sat

sat

sleep

slept

slept

smell

smelt/smelled

smelt/smelled

speak

spoke

spoken

speed

sped

sped

spell

spelt/spelled

spelt/spelled

spend

spent

spent

spill

spilt/spilled

spilt/spilled

spin

span/spun

spun

spit

spat

spat

split

split

split

spoil

spoilt/spoiled

spoilt/spoiled

stand

stood

stood

steal

stole

stolen

stick

stuck

stuck

strike

struck

struck

swing

swung

swung

swim

swam

swum

take

took

taken

teach

taught

taught

tear

tore

torn

tell

told

told

think

thought

thought

throw

threw

thrown

Infinitive
Simple past
Past participle
understand
understood
understood
woke
wore
won
wound /waund/
wrote
woken
worn
won
wound /waund/
written
wake wear
win wind /wamd/
write
Note that the old past participle drunken is still used as an adjective in some
expressions (e.g. drunken driving).
Speed can also have regular forms.
Says is pronounced/sez/.
2 verbs that are easily confused Infinitive Simple past
fall feel fill
find
fell felt filled
found
(= 'get back something lost')
found founded
(= 'start up an organisation or institution')
flow flowed (of a liquid = 'move') fly flew (= 'move in the air')
lay laid
(= 'put down flat')
lie lay
(= 'be down')
lie lied
(= 'say things that are not true')
For more details of these three verbs, see 309.
Past participle
fallen
felt
filled
found
founded ) ' flowed
flown
laid lain lied
leave live
raise
(= 'put up')
rise
(='go/get up')
strike (= 'hit') stroke
left lived
raised rose
struck stroked
(= 'pass the hand gently over')
wind /wamd/ wound /waund/ (= 'turn, tighten a spring etc') wound /wu:nd/ wounded (= 'injure in a battle')
left lived
raised risen
struck stroked
wound/waund/ wounded
292
page 293


- * --J """JfCt 3QJ
3 American English
Note the following differences between British and American English
a burn, dream, lean, learn, smell, spell, spill and spoil are all regular in American English. In British
English, irregular past tenses and partici with -t are more common (see list in paragraph 1), but regular
forms ies occur; there may sometimes be a difference of usage. s0
b Wake can be regular in American English. c Spit has both spit and spat as past tense and participle in
American En r i,
d Quit and wet are regular in British English, but irregular in American- fit • also usually irregular in
American English. ' s fit fit fit quit quit quit wet wet wet
e Dive is regular in British English, but can be irregular in American. dive dived/dove (/douv/) dived
f The American past participle of get is either go? or gotten (see 228.7).
g Note the standard American pronunciations of ate (/ert/) and shone (usually /foun/).
01 it (1): preparatory subject
1 infinitive subjects
When the subject of a clause is an infinitive expression, this does not normally come at the beginning. We
usually prefer to start with the , 'preparatory subject' it, and to put the infinitive expression later (longer
complicated items are often put towards the end of a sentence - see 289). Preparatory it is common
before be + adjective/noun complement.
It's nice to talk to you.
(More natural than To talk to you is nice.)
It's important to book in advance.
It's my ambition to run a three-hour marathon.
It upsets me to hear people arguing all the time.
It was good of you to phone.
It can also be used as a preparatory subject for the for + infinitive structure (see 280).
It will suit me best for you to arrive at about ten o'clock. It's essential/or the papers to be ready before
Thursday.
2 clause subjects
We also normally use preparatory it when the subject of a clause is its
another clause. . -It's probable that we'll be a little late. It doesn't interest me what you think. It's surprising
how many unhappy marriages there are.
page
294
It's exciting when a baby starts talking.
It seems that he forgot to buy the tickets.
It is said that only three people in the world can understand his theory.
It's essential that she should be told immediately.
For more details of structures with should, see 497. p r the use of subjunctives in sentences about
necessity and importance, see 541.
3 -ing form subjects
It can be a preparatory subject for an -ing form. This is usually rather
informal.
It was nice seeing you.
It's crazy her going off like that. It's worth going to Wales if you have the time. It's no use trying to explain -
I'm not interested. It surprised me your not remembering my name.
For more information about structures with worth, see 603. For there as a preparatory subject with any/no
use, see 563.2.
4 it takes...+ infinitive
We can use this structure to talk about the time necessary for things to
happen (see 551).
It took me months to get to know her. How long does it take to get to London from here?
5 if, as if and as though
It is used to introduce some clauses with if, as if and as though. It looks as if we're going to have trouble
with Ann again. It's not as if this was the first time she's been difficult. It will be a pity if we have to ask her
to leave. But it looks as though we may have to.
6 emphasis: 'cleft sentences'
It can be used in 'cleft sentences' with who- and rto-clauses to emphasise one part of a sentence.
It was my aunt who took Peter to London yesterday, not my mother.
(emphasising my aunt) It was Peter that my aunt took to London yesterday, not Lucy.
(emphasising Peter) For more details of cleft sentences, see 131.
M impersonal' it in sentences like It's raining, see 424.7. passive structures with it as a preparatory
subject, see 411. it as 'preparatory object', see next section.
page 295


302 it (2): preparatory object
1 infinitive or clause object + complement
We can sometimes use it as a preparatory object. This happens when the
object of a verb is an infinitive expression or a clause with an adjective or noun complement.
subject + verb + it + complement + innnitive.Adiawe-
•" 's^^sisill XJUs!^
I find it difficult to talk to you.
My blister made it a problem to walk.
I thought it strange that she hadn't written.
George made it clear what he wanted.
Note that this structure is not normally used when there is no adjective or noun complement after the verb.
/ cannot bear to see people crying.
(NOT I cannot bear it to sec people crying.}
I remember that we were very happy. (NOT I remember it that...) But note the structure I like/love/hate it
when... I love it when you sing.
Note also the idiom I take it that... (= 'I assume that...'). / take it that you won't be working tomorrow.
2 -ing form object + complement
This structure is also possible with -ing form objects. I find it interesting talking to you.
3 (^clauses |
It is used as a preparatory object for an y-clause after would appreciate. 1 I would appreciate it if you
would keep me informed. U (NOT I would appreciate if you would...)
4 owe and leave
Note the structures owe it to somebody to... and leave it to somebody to... We owe it to society to make
our country a better place. I'll leave it to you to decide.
For it as a preparatory subject, see 301.
303 its and it's
These two words are often confused by native speakers of English as well as by foreign learners.
Its is a possessive word (like my, your).
Every country has its traditions. (NOT ... it's traditions.)
page 296 ||
yfJCdfCwf)
It's is the contracted form of it is or it has. It's raining again. (NOT Its raining again.) Haveyou seen my
camera? It's disappeared. (NOT .. .-Us
There is a similar difference between whose and who's - see 598. For more about contractions, see 144.
304 it's time
1 followed by infinitive
It's time (or it is time) can be followed by an infinitive.
It's time to buy a new car. When it is necessary to express the subject of the infinitive, the ./or + object +
infinitive structure (see 280) can be used. It's time for her to go to bed.
2 followed by past tense with present meaning
It's time can also be followed by a subject with a past tense verb. The
meaning is present.
It's time she went to bed. It's time you washed those trousers.
I'm getting tired. It's time we went home. For other structures in which a past tense has a present or future
meaning, see 422.
305 just
1 meanings
Just has several meanings.
a time
Just often emphasises the idea of 'at the present' or 'close to the present'. I'll be down in a minute - I'm just
changing my shirt. (= 'right now') Alice has just phoned. (= 'a short time ago') 'Where's my tea?' Tm just
going to make it.' (= 'immediately') 'What's happened to Keith? He seems to have disappeared.' 'No, he's
around. I saw him just last week.' (= 'as recently as') Note that just now can mean either 'at this moment'
or 'a few moments ago', depending on the tense. Compare:
She's not in just now. Can I take a message? I saw Phil just now. He wanted to talk to you. In expressions
like just after, just before and just when, just suggests closeness to the time in question.
I saw him just after lunch. (=... very soon after lunch.)
b 'only','scarcely'
Just can mean 'only', 'nothing more than'.
Complete set of garden tools for just L15.99! ;A I just want somebody to love me - that's all.
I'm just a poor boy. > page 297


-"-• miuw 306
In some contexts, the meaning is more like 'scarcely', 'with nothing to soar ' 'with nothing in reserve'.
We just caught the train. I've got just enough money for a cup ofcoffe This meaning can be emphasised by
only.
I'd only just got into the bath when she phoned. There was only just enough light to read by.
Just can be used as a 'softener', to make a request seem less demanding anri therefore more polite.
Could I just use your phone for a moment? fust sign here. Just a moment.
c 'exactly'
, . Just often means 'exactly'.
'What's the time?' 'It's just four o'clock.' Thanks. That's just what I wanted. Just then, the door opened and
Graham came in. I got home just as the sun was setting. Just as... as means 'no less than'.
She's just as bad-tempered as her father.
d emphasiser
Just can emphasise other words and expressions. It means 'simply', 'there's no other word for it'.
You 're just beautiful. I just love your dress. It just breaks my heart to see her so unhappy.
2 tenses
"When just means 'a moment ago', a present perfect tense is most commol in British English.
'Where's Eric?' 'He's just gone out.' I've just had a call from Sarah. In American English a past tense is
common in this case.
'Where's Eric?" He just went out.' 1justhad a call from Sarah. When just now means 'a moment ago', it is
used with a past tense in boti British and American English.
Did you hear a strange noise just now?
For the position of just as a focusing adverb, see 23.3.
know
know how + infinitive
Know cannot be followed directly by an infinitive. We use the structure know how to.
I know how to make Spanish omelettes. (NOT Iknowtomak^...) For more information about the use of
infinitives after how, what, whether etc, see 288.
object + infinitive
In a formal style, know is occasionally followed by object + infinitive. They knew him to be a dangerous
criminal.
page 298
However, this is unusual; rtof-clauses are generally more natural.
They knew that he was a dangerous criminal. The passive equivalent of know + object + infinitive is more
common, at
least in a formal style.
He was known to be a dangerous criminal. Know is used to mean 'experience' in the common structure
I've never known + object + infinitive; an infinitive without to is sometimes used in
British English.
I've never known it (to) rain like this. (GB)
3 tenses
Know is one of the verbs that cannot usually be used in progressive forms
(see 451).
Iknow exactly whatyou mean. (NOT I am knowing.:.) Note that a present perfect tense is used to say how
long one has known somebody or something. (See 418.6 for more details.)
We've known each other since 1974. (NOT Wo know each other since 1974.)
4 know and know about/of
Know + object is used mainly to talk about knowledge that comes from direct personal experience. In
other cases, we normally use know about/of, have heard of or another structure. Compare:
- 'You don't know my mother, do you?"No, I've never met her.' We all know about Abraham Lincoln. (NOT
We all know Abraham Lincoln.)
- I know your home town. (= I've been there.)
I've heard of your home town (but I haven't been there). I know where you come from.
(= I know the answer to the question 'Where do you come from?').
5 know and find out etc
Know is not normally used to talk about the process of finding something out: to know something is to
have leamtit, not to leam it. To talk about getting knowledge we can use for example find out, get to know,
leam, hear, can tell.
'She's married.' 'Where didyoujind that out?'
(NOT ... 'Whore did you know that?') I want to travel round the world and get to know people from different
countries. (NOT ... and know people...) He's from Liverpool, as you can tell from his accent.
(NOT ... as you can know from his accent.) s
6 I know and I know it
Note the difference between these two short answers. 1 ^ow refers to facts - it could be completed by a
that-clause.
'You're late.' 'I know.' (= I know that I'm late.) (NOT ... 'I know it.') ^ow it generally refers to things - it
replaces a noun. 1 went to a nice restaurant called The Elizabeth last night.' 'I know it.'
page 299


307
last and the last
f~
1 fowf week, month etc
La?? (without the) contrasts with this and next. Last week, last month et • the week, month etc just before
the one in which the words are said or s written. (On 20 July 1994, for example, last month is June 1994.)
Note th t
these time expressions are normally used with past tenses, without anid and without prepositions. '
/ had a cold last week.
(NOT / have had a cold last week.) (NOT / had a cold the last week.)
(NOT ...in last week.) Were you at the meeting last Tuesday? We bought this house lastyear.
2 the last week, month etc
The last week, the last month etc can mean the period of seven/thirty/etc days up to the moment of
speaking or writing. (On 20 July 1994, for example the last month is the period from 20 June to 20 July
1994.) Note that these time expressions are normally used with perfect tenses and with prepositions.
I've had a cold for the last week. (for the seven days up to now) We've lived here for the lastyear. (since
twelve months ago)
The last week etc can also be used to refer to a period up until a particular
past moment. A past perfect tense is normally used.
I decided to see the doctor, because I'd been feeling ill during the last two months.
Note the word order in expressions like the last three weeks etc. I've been busy for the last three months.
(NOT .. .for the three last months.)
We generally say the last few days/weeks etc, not the last days/weeks etc. The last few days have been
very wet. (NOT The last days have beenrvery-wek)
' 3 the last in a series
The last can also refer to the last item in a series (with no relation to present time).
In the last week of the holiday something funny happened. This is going to be the last Christmas I'll spend
at home.
4 last and latest
In talking about events, actions and productions, we use latest, not last, to refer to new or very recent
things. Last can mean 'before this'. Compare:
- She says her latest book's being published next week. (her most recent
book) (NOT -She-says her last book's being published next week.) She thinks it's much better than her
last one. (her previous one)
- He's enjoying his latest job. (NOT He's enjoying his last job.) But it doesn't pay as much as his last one.
•'"
^ ...-__ "
Jntest suggests there may be more to come; last can mean 'final' (see
paragraph 3 above). Compare:
Have you seen Bill's latest car?He seems to buy'a new one every week.
This is the last car we buy. I'm afraid I'm getting too old to drive.
c tenses with This is the last...
present and future tenses are both possible with This is the last..., and
similar structures with last.
This is the last time I'm paying for you.
(o B This is the last time I'll pay for you.) That's the last letter he gets from me.
(o R That's the last letter he'll get from me.) ••.
The difference between next and the next is like the difference between last and the last,
See 367. For tenses with this is the first/second... etc, see 419.7.
308 later and in
With a time expression, later generally means 'after that time'.
She was so happy when she got married. But six months later she was
divorced. So you and Penny will come on the Monday, and Colin will arrive about
a week later.
With a time expression, we usually use in, not later, to say 'after now'.
I'll see you in a few days. (NOT I'll sac you a few days later.) But without a time expression, later can be
used to mean 'after now'. Bye! See you later!
309 lay and lie
There are three sinular verbs that can be confused: lay (regular except for spelling), lie (irregular) and lie
(regular).
1 lay
Lay is a regular verb except for its spelling. Its forms are:
a infinitive: (to) lay
a -ing form: laying
n past: laid
a past participle: laid
Lay means 'put down carefully' or 'put down flat'. It has an object.
I laid the papers on the table. (NOT I lay...) Lay the tent down on the grass and I'll see how to put it up.
Note the expressions lay a table (= put plates, knives etc on a table) and lay an egg (a bird's way of
having a baby). >
page 300
page
301


2 lie (irregular)
The forms of the irregular verb lie are:
a infinitive: (to) lie D -ing form: lying D past: lay
D past participle: lain (used mostly in a formal/literary style) Lie (irregular) means 'be down', 'be/become
horizontal'. It has no object
Don't lie in bed all day. Get up and do some work. (NOT -Don't lay in bed...)
I lay down and closed my eyes. (NOT I laid down...)
3 lie (regular)
The regular verb lie (lied} means 'say things that are not true'. You lied to me when you said you loved me.
4 dialect forms
In many British and American dialects, different forms of lay and irregular lie are used. Lay is often used in
cases where standard English has lie.
I'm going to lay down for a few minutes. (Standard English ...lie down. .)
For more information about irregular verbs, see 300.
310 learn
1 structures before a verb
Learn can be followed by how + infinitive or by an infinitive alone. There is not usually much difference of
meaning: learn (how) can be used to talk both about the process of learning and its result.
She enjoyed learning (how) to look after young animals.
Last year I leamt (how) to water-ski.
It takes a long time to learn (how) to drive in city traffic.
He soon leamt (how) to help his wife in her work. How is common especially in cases where there is a
method or technique to be learnt. In other cases it is not generally used. Compare:
It's time you leamt (how) to change the oil in the car.
In the new job, I soon leamt to keep my mouth shut.
(More natural than... / soon leamt how to keep my mouth shut.}
2 forms
Learn is usually irregular in British English (learn/learnt) and regular in American English (learn/learned).
For other verbs like this, see 300.3.
• For the adjective learned (/'l3:md7), see 13.
page
302
leas i anu rewesi ill
311
least and fewest the least as determiner: superlative oflittle
The least is used before uncountable nouns as a determiner referring to quantity (see 157); it is the
superlative of little (= 'not much'), and the opposite of most.
In a 'slow bicycle race', the winner is the person who travels the least distance in one minute without
falling off or turning round.
I think I probably do the least work in this office. The least can be used without a noun if the meaning is
clear from what comes before.
Jan earns the most money in our family; Pete earns the least.
"Thanks for your help.' 'Oh, it was the least I could do.' Note also the expression the leastof'(= 'the
smallest of), used before plural abstract nouns.
'What will your mother think?' "That's the least of my worries.'
any ...at all
The least can have a similar meaning to 'any... at all'. This happens mostly before singular abstract nouns
in 'non-assertive' contexts (see 374): for instance in questions, negative clauses and if-c\auses.
Do you think there's the least chance of/ones winning the election?
'What's the time?' 'I haven't got the least idea.'
If you have the least difficulty with the arrangements for the conference, phone me at once.
She's not the least bit afraid of horses.
For countable and uncountable uses of words like chance, idea and difficulty, see 148.5.
the fewest as determiner: superlative of few
The fewest is used before plural nouns as the superlative of few.
The translation with the fewest mistakes isn't always the best. Least is often used instead offewest before
plural nouns (... the least mistakes), especially in an informal style. Some people feel this is incorrect.
(the) least with adjectives: the opposite of (the) most or (the).. .est
(The) least is used before adjectives in the same way as (the) most or (the).. .est (see 136), but with the
opposite meaning.
The least expensive holidays are often the most interesting.
Don't give the job to Keith: he's the least experienced.
I'm least happy when I have to work at weekends.
For the use of the with superlatives, see 65.4,138.12.
5 teost as adverb
Least can be used as an adverb (the opposite of most). She always arrives when you least expect it. I
don't much like housework, and I like cooking least of all. •
3
4
page 303


6 at least
At least means 'not less than (but perhaps more than)'.
'How old do you think he is?' 'At least thirty.'
He's been in love at least eight times this year. We can also use at least as a discourse marker (see 159)
to suggest that onp thing is certain or all right, even if everything else is unsatisfactory.
We lost everything in the fire. But at least nobody was hurt.
7 not in the least
We can use not in the least in a formal style to mean 'not at all', especially when talking about personal
feelings and reactions.
I was not in the least upset by her bad temper.
She did not mind working late in the least.
For little and. few, see 322. For less and fewer, see 313. ,
312 left
The past participle of leave, left, can be used in a special way, to mean 'remaining', 'not used', 'still there'.
What did you do with the money that was left?
After the explosion, only two people were left alive. Left is very common in the following structures:

there is have got
noun
something / anything / nothing somebody/anybody/nobody someone/anyone/no one
Note the position of left: at the end of the structure. There are two eggs left, if you're hungry. There's
nothing left in the fridge. I haven't got any money left: can you get the tickets? Now that her friends have
moved to London she hasn't got anybody left to play bridge with.
313 less and fewer
1 the difference
Less is the comparative of little (used especially before uncountable nouns). Fewer is the comparative of
few (used before plural nouns). Compare:
learn less money than a postman.
I've got fewer problems than I used to have. Less is quite common before plural nouns, as well as
uncountables, especially in an informal style. Some people consider this incorrect.
I've got less problems than I used to have.
page
304
ci iiluuoii^iiig imperatives a*a
2 less/fewer with and withouto/
Less of and fewer of are used before determiners (like the, my or this) and
pronouns.
I'd like to spend less of my time answering letters. At the college reunions, there are fewer of us each
year.
Before nouns without determiners, a/is not used.
If you want to lose weight, eat less food. (NOT ... less of food.) Fewer people make their own bread these
days. (NOT Fewer of people...)
3 less and fewer without nouns
Nouns that have already been mentioned can be dropped after less and fewer, if the meaning is clear.
Some people in our village still go to church, but less/fewer than
20 years ago. Less can be used as an adverb (the opposite of the adverb more).
I worry less than I used to.
4 lesser
Lesser is used in a few expressions (in a rather formal style) to mean 'smaller' or 'not so much'.
the lesser of two evils a lesser-known writer
For little and few, see 322.
For least and fewest, see 311.
For the use of much, far, a lot etc with fewer and less, see 139.
314 lest
Lest has a similar meaning to in case (see 271) or so that... not (see 519). It is very rare in modern British
English, and is found mostly in older literature and in ceremonial language. It is a little more common in
formal American English.
They kept watch all night lest robbers should come.
We must take care lest evil thoughts enter our hearts. Lest can be followed by a subjunctive verb (see
541).
The government must take immediate action, lest the problem of child
poverty grow worse. For fear that is used in a similar way, and is also unusual in modern English.
He hid in the woods for fear that the soldiers would find him.
For more about older English, see 388.
"15 let introducing imperatives
Let can be used to introduce suggestions and orders, when these are not addressed to the hearer/reader
(or not only to the hearer/reader). This structure can be considered a kind of imperative (see 268). >
page 305


^. oiiti^iuica aig
1 first-person plural imperative
We can use let us (formal) or let's (informal) to make suggestions or to giv orders to a group that includes
the speaker.
Let us pray.
Let's have a drink.
OK, let'sail get moving.
Shall we? is used as a question tag (see 465-466) in British English; let's is used as a short answer.
'Let's go fora walk, shall we?' 'Yes, let's.' There are two possible negatives, with let us not and do not let
us (informal let's not/ don't let's).
Let us not despair, (formal)
Let's not get angry, (informal)
Do not let us forget those who came before us. (formal)
Don't let's stay up too late tonight, (informal) Forms with don't let's (and let's don't in American English) are
very .informal
2 first-person singular imperative
Let me is used to 'give instructions to oneself; the expressions Let me see and Let me think are very
common.
'What time do you want to have breakfast?' 'Let me think. Yes, I reckon
eight o'clock will be early enough.' Now what's the best way to get to Manchester? Let me see - suppose I
take
the MGfrom Birmingham... Let me just get my coat and I'll be with you.
In a very informal style, let's is often used to mean let me (see 424.9). Let's see. Suppose I take the
MGfrom Birmingham...
3 third-person imperative
Let can also introduce a suggestion or order for someone or something else, not the speaker or hearer.
This is common in formal and ceremonial language, but informal uses are also possible.
Let the prayers begin.
Let our enemies understand that we will not hesitate to defend our territory and our interests, wherever
they may be.
'Your boyfriend's going out with another girl."Let him. I don't care.' Note the structure with let+ the infinitive
of there is.
Let there be no doubt in your minds about our intentions.
316 let: structures
1 followed by infinitive without to
Let is followed by object + infinitive without to.
We usually let the children stay up late on Saturdays.
(NOT ... let the children to stay/staying...) She didn 't let me see what she was doing. (NOT .. .let me
saw...) 'We'll take you to London.' 'Well, let us pay for the petrol.'
page
306
Note also the expressions let... know (= 'tell', 'inform') and let... have (='send', 'give').
I'll letyou know my holiday dates next week.
Could you let me have the bill for the car repair? Let goof means 'release'.
Don't let go of Mummy's hand.
2 not used in passives
Let is unusual in passive forms; we prefer allow. After questioning he was allowed to go home.
3 with object + preposition/adverb particle
Let can be followed by an object and a prepositional phrase or adverb
particle expressing movement.
You'd better let the dog out of the car. Let him in, could you? Those kids let my tyres down.
For more about infinitives without to, see 277. For let in first- and third-person imperatives, see 315.
317 letters
Each culture has its own way of organising a letter and arranging it on a page. English-speaking people
generally observe the following rules.
1 Put your own address at the top on the right. Addresses generally follow the rule of'smallest first': house
number, then street, then town. Postcode and telephone number come last. Don't put your name with the
address.
2 Put the date directly under the address. A common way to write the date is to put the number of the day,
followed by the month and year (e.g. 17 May 1992). For other ways (and differences between British and
American customs) see 151.
3 In formal letters and business letters, put the name and address of the person you are writing to on the
left side of the page, starting on the same level as the date or slightly below.
4 Different styles are common in formal letters on paper which has the address ready-printed at the top of
the page. For example, the date may be put on the left, and the address of the person written to may
come at the end of the letter or of the first page.
Begin the letter (DearX) on the left. Common ways of addressing people are:
n by first name (informal): Dear Penny
by title and surname (more formal): Dear Ms Hopkins
Dear Sir(s), Dear Sir or Madam, Dear Madam (especially to somebody
whose name is not known)
Some people like to use the first name and surname (Dear Penny Hopkins)
^en writing to strangers or people that they do not know well.
"o not use a title like Mr together with a first name
^OT -Bear Mr James Carter).
page 307


----- ws toners '317
6 After 'Dear X', put a comma or nothing at all, not an exclamation mark m (In American English, a comma
is preferred in personal letters, and a col in business letters.) Either leave an empty line after 'Dear X' and
start a on ^ on the left, or start again on the next line, a few spaces from the left Dn^111 same for each new
paragraph. (The first method is now the most cornm e in Britain.) on
7 Letters which begin Dear Sir(s) or Dear Madam usually finish Yours
faithfully. Formal letters which begin with the person's name (e.e. Dear M-Hawkins, Dear Peter Lewis}
usually finish Yours sincerely. Informal letters ^ may finish, for example, Yours, See you or Love. (Love is
not usually used h one man to another.) In formal letters, many people put a closing formula before
Yours..., especially when writing to people they know: common expressions are With best wishes and
With kind regards.
8 Sign with your first name (informal) or your full name (formal), but without writing any title (Mr I Ms I Dr I
etc). Ways of writing one's full name: Alan Forbes, A Forbes, A} Forbes.
In a formal typewritten letter, add your full typewritten name after your handwritten signature. Friendly
business letters are often signed with the first name only above the full typewritten name:
Yours sincerely A/^^ Alan Forbes
9 In informal letters, afterthoughts that are added after the signature are usually introduced by P S (Latin
post scriptum = 'written afterwards').
10 On the envelope, put the first name before the surname. People usually write a title (Mr, Mrs etc)
before the name. You can write the first name in full (.Mrs Angela Brookes), or you can write one or more
initials (Mrs A EBrookes}. It was once common to put the abbreviated title Esq (= Esquire) after a man's
name; this is now very unusual.
11 British people now usually write abbreviated titles, initials, addresses, dates, and opening and closing
formulae without commas or full stops.
12 American usage is different from British in some ways:
G Commas are sometimes used at the ends of lines in addresses; full stops
may be used at the ends of addresses; full stops are used after abbreviate
titles. After the opening salutation, Americans may put a colon, especially
in business letters (.Dear Mr. Hawkes:), or a comma. D Gentlemen is used instead of Dear Sirs. a Dates
are written differently (month before day) - see 151. a Yours faithfully is not used; common endings are
Sincerely, Sincerely
yours or Yours truly, followed by a comma. " D Americans are often addressed (and sign their names) with
the first n
in full, followed by the initial of a middle name (Alan]. Parker). This is
less usual in Britain.
page
308
13
Letters to strangers often begin with an explanation of the reason for writing.
DearX I am writing to ask...
One does not normally begin a letter to a stranger with an enquiry about
health.
(NOT Dear X
-How arc you getting on?)
For more information about names and titles, see 353.
For more information about the use of commas and full stops, see 455,457.
For more information about paragraphing, see 401. •;;
For the use of polite enquiries about health etc Wow are you getting on?), see 520.1.
Examples of letters and envelopes Formal
14 Plowden Road
Torquay
Devon
TQ6 1RS
Tel 0742 06538
The Secretary 16 June 1995
Hall School of Design
39 Beaumont Street
London
W4 4LJ
Dear Sir or Madam
I should be grateful if you would send me information about the regulations for admission to the Hall
School of Design. Could you also tell me whether the School arranges accommodation for students?
Yours faithfully
Ki^t^ fe^fc^f--
Keith Parker

The Secretary
Hall School of Design
39 Beaumont Street
London
W4 4LJ
page 309


Informal
""un
A ^{^5^ iff^d^
WB 6 DR 7'hohfOJioa^ if fl4wT?h.

T^La^AwtShaw
14-^^^Vmi^ 'Sic^j^C
Oxjvrpf 0^ 5JP
318 life: countable or uncountable noun
ss.^"0^^0160^?^^
,
/^^S^^^^-^^al^^^^
319
page
310
w
AThen life means 'tne situation someone is living in', it is normally
rountable if used alone. However, a/an is common if there is an adjective ""other denning expression.
Compare:
She enjoys life.
She has a wonderful life.
more about countable and uncountable nouns, see 148.
9 like (verb)
, not used in progressive forms
Like is one of those verbs which are not usually used in progressive forms (see 451), even when we are
talking about temporary present events. •What do you think of the soup?"! like it.' (NOT ... 'I'm liking it.')
2 not used without an object
Like cannot normally be used without an object.
'How do you feel about ballet?' 'I like it.' (NOT ... 'Hike.') 'Doyou like music?' 'Yes, I do.' (NOT ... 'Yes, I
like.')
3 position of adverbs
Note that very much does not come between like and its object. ' ' I like you and your sister very much. OR
I very much likeyou and your sister.
(NOT / like very much you and your sister.) I very much like going to parties and meeting people. '• (NOT I
like very much going...)
For more information about adverb position, see 22-23.
4 like + verb
In British English, like + -ingform is used mostly to talk about enjoyment, and like + infinitive mostly to talk
about choices and habits. In American English, like + infinitive is common in both senses. Compare:
- I like climbing mountains, (more typically GB) / like to climb mountains, (more typically US)
- When I'm pouring tea I like to put the milk in first. (GB /US)
Not like to can mean 'think it better not to'.
'Why didn't you tell me before?"! didn't like to disturb you while you were having breakfast.'
Like can be followed by object + verb form.
I don't like people phoning me in the middle of the night. She likes people to feel at home when they stay
with her.
5 would like
The conditional would like (+ infinitive) is often used as a polite way of ^ying 'want', especially in requests
and offers.
I'd like two kilos of tomatoes, please.
'Would you like to dance?' 'Yes, OK.' (NOT 'Would you like dancing?'...) >
page 311


like and as (similarity, function) 320
Do you like... ? is not used in this way.
(NOT Do you like some more coffee?) To can be used instead of repeating a whole infinitive (see 186).
'How about playing tennis?"! 'd like to.' Polite requests often begin If you would like...; the following clause
is
sometimes dropped.
If you would like to take a seat, I'll see if Mr Smithers is free.
If you would like to come this way. Would is sometimes dropped in this structure. If you like to come this
way.
For more about the 'distancing' use ofconditionals and past tenses, see 161. For would like with a perfect
infinitive (e.g. I would like to have seen that}, see 278.
6 if you like etc
In subordinate clauses after if, any, as soon as, who(ever), what(ever), when(ever), where, where(ever)
and how(ever), we often use like to mean
'want (to)'. Note that to is not used.
'Can I go now?' 'If you like.' (NOT If you like to.) Do it any way you like. Come when you like. You can sit
wherever you like.
320 like and as (similarity, function)
We can use like or as to say that things are similar.
1 similarity: like (preposition)
Like is similar to a preposition. We use it before a noun or pronoun.
like + noun / pronoun
You look like your sister. (NOT ... as your sister:) He ran like the wind. Like his brother, he is a vegetarian.
She's dressed just like me. We can use very, quite and other adverbs of degree (see 153) to modify hte-
He's very like his father. She looks a bit like Queen Victoria. We can use like to give examples.
She's good at scientific subjects, like mathematics.
(NOT ... as mathematics.) In mountainous countries, like Peru,...
2 similarity: as (conjunction)
As is a conjunction. We use it before a clause, and before an expressio beginning with a preposition.
as + clause ' as + preposition phrase
Nobody knows her as I do.
We often drink tea with the meal, as they do in China.
In 1939, as in 1914, everybody seemed to want war.
•• ---..-•>l !," ,,tft W
like and as (similarity, function) 320
3 informal use of like
In informal English like is often used as a conjunction instead of as. This is very common in American
English. It is not generally considered correct in a formal style.
Nobody loves you like I do.
You look exactly like your mother did when she was 20.
4 as with inverted word order
In a very formal style, as is sometimes followed by auxiliary verb + subject (note the inverted word order -
see 298).
She was a Catholic, as were most of her friends.
He believed, as did all his family, that the king was their supreme lord. And as can sometimes replace it as
the subject of a clause (rather like the relative pronoun which), especially before happen and verbs with
similar meanings.
An earthquake can destroy one part of a city while leaving other parts untouched, as happened in Mexico
in 1986. (NOT ... as it happened.. •)
5 as you know etc '"
Some expressions beginning with as are used to introduce facts which are 'common ground' - known to
both speaker/writer and listener/reader. Examples are as you know, as we agreed, as you suggested.
As you know, next Tuesday's meeting has been cancelled.
lam sending you the bill for the repairs, as we agreed. There are some passive expressions of this kind -
for example as is well known; as was agreed. Note that there is no subject it after as in these expressions.
As is well known, more people get colds in wet weather.
(NOT As it is well known...) • .
lam sending you the bill, as was agreed. (NOT ... as it was agreed.)
6 comparison with as and like after negatives
After a negative clause, a comparison with as or like usually refers only to the
positive part.
I don't smoke, like fane. (Jane smokes.)
lam not a Conservative, like Joe. (Joe is a Conservative.)
lam no orator, as Brutus is. (Shakespeare, Julius Caesar)
Before a negative clause, the comparison refers to the whole clause. Like Mary, I don't smoke. (Mary
doesn't smoke.)
"ttction or role: as used as a preposition
other use of as is to say what function or role a person or thing has - what to s people do> what purposes things
are used for, what category they belong • Gtc. In this case, as is used like a preposition, before a noun. e
worked as a waiter for two years. (NOT.. . like a waiter.) fase don't use that knife as a screwdriver. ,
^^ocodile starts life as an egg. ^


-u<.e|y3^
Compare this use of as with like.
As your brother, I must warn you to be careful. (I am your brother Like your brother, I must warn you to be
careful.
(I am not your brother, but he and I have similar attitudes)
Note that as is usually pronounced /az/ (see 588).
For like used instead of as if, see 74.
For What... like?, see 255.
For alike, see 32.
For comparisons with as... as, see 70.
For the same as, see 486.
For such as, see 543.9.
For like used to join two infinitive structures, see 277.4
321 likely
1 meaning
Likely is an adjective with a similar meaning to probable.
I don't think a Labour victory is likely.
What's a likely date for the election? Note also the informal adverb phrases very/most likely.
I think she'll very/most likely be late.
2 it is likely + that-clsaise
When a fW-clause is the subject of is likely, we usually use it as a 'preparatory subject' (see 301).
It's likely that the meeting will go on late.
It can also be used as a 'preparatory object' with likely (see 302). I didn 't think it likely that she would
come back.
3 infinitive after be likely
Be + likely is often followed by an infinitive. (Probable cannot be used in this way.)
I'm likely to be busy tomorrow.
Are you likely to be staying in this evening?
Do you think it's likely to rain?
He's unlikely to agree.
It is not used as a preparatory subject in this structure. He's likely to succeed. (NOT It's likely for him to
succeed-.}
322 (a) little and (a) few
I uncountable and plural
We use (a) little with singular (usually uncountable) words, and(a)fow plurals. Compare:
/ have little interest in politics. Few politicians are really honest. We've got a little bacon and a few eggs.
page
314
i w lime ana w lew szz
of after (a) little and (a) few
r^ ^tie of and (a) few o/before a pronoun or determiner (for ^iple the, my, these - see 157).
(a) little of'it/this/yours etc
(a] fewofus/you/them/these/mineetc
(a) little/few of+ determiner + noun
Few people can say that they always tell the truth.
Few of us can say that we always tell the truth.
Could I try a little wine?
Could I try a little of your wine?
Only a few children like maths.
Only a few of the children in this class like maths.
3 use of a/an
There is a difference between little and a little, and between few and a few.
Without articles, little and few usually have rather negative meanings. They may suggest 'not as
much/many as one would like', 'not as much/many as expected', and similar ideas.
The average MP has little real power.
Few people can speak a foreign language perfectly. A little and a few are more positive: their meaning is
generally closer to some. They can often suggest ideas like 'better than nothing' or 'more than expected'.
Would you like a little soup?
You don't need to go shopping. We've got a few potatoes and some steak. Compare:
- Cactuses need little water, (not much water)
Give the roses a little water every day. (not a lot, but some)
- His ideas are difficult, and few people understand them.
His ideas are difficult, but a few people understand them. Quite a few (informal) means 'a considerable
number'.
We've got quite a few friends in the village.
4 formal and informal language
Little and/en; (with no article) are rather formal. In an informal style (G-g- ordinary conversation), we
generally prefer not much/many, or only a little/few.
Come on! We haven't got much time!
Only a few people speak a foreign language perfectly.
5 little and few without nouns
e can drop a noun and use little/few alone, if the noun has already been Mentioned.
^me more soup?"Just a little, please.' >
page 315


•"•"5 allu ^"r; a long time a?..
6 coniplements
Note that (a) little and (a) few are quantifiers, and are normally used h f nouns. They can be used alone if
a noun has been dropped (see above^t0^ they can rarely be used alone as complements after be when a
noun ha ut been dropped. not
They had little hope. (BUT NOT Their hope was little.)
7 (a) little as a modifier
(A) little can modify comparatives.
'How are you?' 'A little better, thanks.'
The new model is little faster than the old one. Little is not normally used to modify other adjectives or
adverbs.
It's not very interesting. (NOT It's little interesting.)
A little can be used like a bit (see 106), before adjectives and adverbs with a critical or negative meaning.
It's a little inconvenient.
You must forgive her-she's a little confused. They arrived a little late.
The negative form not a little (e.g. She was not a little shaken by her experience) is rare and literary.
Note also the expression little known.
He's studying the work of a little known German novelist.
For less and fewer, see 313. For the adjective little, see 511.
323 long and (for) a long time
1 long in questions and negatives
Long (meaning '(for) a long time') is most common in questions and negative clauses, and with restrictive
words like hardly, seldom.
Have you been waiting long?
It doesn't take long to get to her house.
She seldom stays long. ^
(for) a long time in affirmative clauses ||
In affirmative clauses we usually prefer (for) a long time. ^ I waited (for) a long time, but she didn't arrive.
(NOT / waited long. • •) It takes a long time to get to her house. (NOT It takes long...)
long in affirmative clauses
However, long is normal even in affirmative clauses with too, enough, as and so.
The meeting went on much too long.
I've been working here long enough. Time to get a new job.
You can stay as long as you want. J
Sorry I took so long. \ |
2
3
F1
neis also used in affirmative clauses to modify adverbs and conjunctions,
and in a few other common expressions.
We used to live in Paris, but that was long before you were born. Lone after the accident he used to
dream that he was dying. Lone ago, in a distant country, there lived a beautiful princess.
(rather formal) This is a problem that has long been recognised.
(pre-verb use - rather formal) She sits dreaming all day long. (also all night/week/year long}
I'll be back before long.
4 for a long time in negative clauses
When for a long time is used in a negative clause, it sometimes has a different meaning from/or long.
Compare:
- She didn't speak for long. (= She only spoke for a short time.) She didn 't speak for a long time. (= She
was silent for a long time.)
- He didn't work for long. (= He soon stopped working.)
He didn't work for a long time. (= He was unemployed for a long time.) The reason for the difference is to
do with the 'scope of negation': in the first and third sentences, not goes with/or long, but in the second
and fourth for a long time is outside the influence of not (it could go at the beginning of the clause).
5 How long are you here for?
Note that the question How long are you here for? refers to (or includes) the future. Compare:
'How longareyou here for?' 'Until the end of next week.'
'How long have you been here for?' 'Since last Monday.'
6 comparative
The comparative of fora longtime is (for) longer.
I hope you'll stay longer next time. (NOT .. .fora longer time.)
For no longer, see 372. Much, many and far are also more common in questions and negative clauses
(see 348 and
324 look
1 copular verb (='seem')
Look can mean 'seem' or 'appear'. In this case it is a copular verb (see 147) and can be followed by
adjectives.
You look angry - what's the matter? (NOT You look angrily...) Kw noun phrases can be used after look in
the same way as adjectives. / looked a real fool when I fell in the river. The garden looks a mess.
° talk about a temporary appearance, we can use simple or progressive torms; there is not much
difference of meaning.
You look I You're looking very unhappy. What's the matter? >
page
316
page 317


""~ """ wuse 323
Look can be followed by like or as if. (Progressive forms are not usually in this case.) eu She looks like her
mother.
It looks as if it's going to rain. (NOT It's looking as if...) She looks as if she's dreaming.
She looks like she's dreaming, (informal) (NOT She looks Uke^FeaninsL) Look like being... is occasionally
used informally in British English with future reference.
It looks like being a wet night. (= It looks as if it will be...} For more about as if, and the use of like for as if,
see 74.
2 ordinary verb (= 'direct one's eyes')
When look means 'direct one's eyes', it is used with adverbs, not adjectives Before an object, a
preposition is necessary (usually at). A preposition is not used when there is no object.
The boss looked at me angrily. (NOT The boss looked at-me-angry:) Look carefully - it's changing colour.
(NOT Look careful...)
(NOT Look at carefully...)
3 not followed by if
We do not normally use if or whether after look. Instead, we use see or look to see.
Could you see if Ann's in the kitchen?
(NOT Could you look if Ann's in the kitchen?) 'What are you doing?' 'I'm looking to see whether these
batteries are OK.'
(NOT I'm looking whether...)
4 look after and look for
Note the difference between these two prepositional verbs. Look after means 'take care of; look for means
'try to find'. Compare:
Could you look after the kids while I go shopping?
I spent ages looking for her before I found her. Look for is not used to talk about going to get people or
things if one knows where they are.
I'm going to the station at three o'clock to fetch Daniel. (NOT ... to look for Daniel.)
For other phrasal and prepositional verbs with look, see a good dictionary. For the difference between look
(at), watch and see, see 489. For Look! and Look here! used as discourse markers, see 159.19.
325 lose and loose
Lose (pronounced /lu;z/) is an irregular verb (lose-lost-lost). Loose (pronounced /lu:s/) is an adjective (the
opposite of tight). I must be losing weight - my clothes all feel loose. (NOT I must be loosing weight...)
page
318
i26 a lot, lots, plenty, a great deal, a large number, the majority
1 introduction; use of of
These expressions have similar meanings to the determiners much, many and most, but the grammar is
not quite the same. In particular, of is used after these expressions even before nouns with no determiner.
Compare:
There's not a lot of meat left. (NOT -There's not a lot meat left.) There's not much meat left. (NOT There's
not much of meat loft.) Plenty of shops open on Sunday mornings. (NOT Plenty shops...) Many shops
open on Sunday mornings. (NOT Many ofshops^...)
For much, many and most with and without of, and other details of their use, see 348 and 347.
2 a lot o/and lots of
These are rather informal. In a more formal style, we prefer a great deal of, a large number of, much or
many. (Much and many are used mostly in questions and negative clauses - see 348.)
There is not much difference between a lot of and lots of: they are both used mainly before singular
uncountable and plural nouns, and before pronouns. It is the subject, and not the form lot/lots, that makes
a following verb singular or plural. So when a lot of is used before a plural subject, the verb is • plural;
when lots of is used before a singular subject, the verb is singular.
A lot of time is needed to learn a language.
Lots of patience is needed, too. (NOT Lots of patience arc needed, too.)
A lot of my friends want to emigrate. (NOT A lot of my friends wants...)
Lots of us think it's time for an election.
3 plenty of
Plenty of is usually rather informal. It is used mostly before singular uncountables and plurals. It suggests
'enough and more'.
Don't rush. There's plenty of time. Plenty of shops take cheques.
4 a large amount of, a great deal of and a large number of
These are used in similar ways to a lot of and lots of, but are more formal.
•A large amount of and a great deal of are generally used with uncountable
nouns.
I've thrown out a large amount of old clothing. Mr Lucas has spent a great deal of time in the Far East:
•A large number of is used before plurals, and a following verb is plural. A large number of problems still
have to be solved. (More natural than A large amount of problems ... o R A great deal of problems...)
Por articles after the number I amount of, see 69.8.
5 the majority of
T^e majority of (= 'most' or 'most of) is mostly used with plural nouns ^nd verbs.
The majority of criminals are non- violent. ^
page 319


6 measurement nouns
These expressions are not generally used before words for units ofmeas like pounds, years or miles.
Other words have to be used. re>
It cost several pounds. (NOT It cost a lot of pounds:)
They lived many miles from the town.
(NOT They lived plenty of miles from the town.)
7 use without following nouns
These expressions can be used without nouns if the meaning is clear. In rh'
case, of is not used.
'How much did it cost?' 'A lot.' (= 'A lot of money.') We should be all right for cheese - I've bought plenty.
He stays silent for long periods, but when he does speak he says a great deal.
8 use as adverbs
A lot and a great deal can be used as adverbs. On holiday we walk and swim a lot.
(BUT NOT ... we walkplenty OR ... swim lots.) The government seems to change its mind a great deal.
327 make
1 object + infinitive
When make + object is followed by another verb, we use the infinitive without to.
I made her cry.
(NOT I made her to cry.) (NOT I made her crying.) Note that the infinitive must follow the object. I can't
make the washing machine work.
(NOT I can't make work the washing machine.) In passive structures the infinitive with to is used. She was
made to repeat the whole story.
For information about other verbs which are used in similar structures, see 277.
2 reflexive object + past participle
In a few cases make can be followed by myself, yourself etc and a past participle. The structure is
common with understood, heard and liked/disliked/hated.
I don't speak good French, but I can make myself understood. (NOT ... make myself understand.)
She had to shout to make herself heard.
In his three months in the job he made himself thoroughly disliked.
320
3 with two objects
Make (meaning 'prepare', 'manufacture' etc) can be used in a structure with
two objects.
Can you make me a birthday cake by Friday?
For more information about verbs with two objects, see 583.
4 with object + object complement
Make can be followed by an object, with an adjective or noun referring to a change in the object. Note the
word order.
The rain made the grass wet. (NOT The rain made wet the grass.)
You have made me a very happy man.
For more information about verbs with object complements, see 580.
5 with subject complement
Make is sometimes followed by a subject complement - a noun phrase saying what somebody or
something becomes, or what job he/she/it does. This is most common in the expression make a good...
That wood will make a good hiding place.
Terriers make good hunting dogs. An indirect object can be put into this structure.
He made her a good husband. (= He was a good husband to her.)
For the difference between make and do, see 164. For prepositions after make, see 328. -
328 make: prepositions
We usually say made o/when we are identifying the material used to make something.
Most things seem to be made of plastic these days.
What are your loudspeakers made of?
When we are thinking about the process of manufacture, out of is more often used.
They made all the furniture out of oak. (More natural than... of oak.) When a material is changed into a
completely different form to make something, we often use make from.
Paper is made from wood. (NOT Paper is made of wood.)
My mother makes wine from blackberries. To mention just one of the materials that something is made of
we use make with.
'The soup's good.' 'Yes, I make it with lots of garlic.'
For sentence structures with make, see 327.
page 321


---w aza
329 marry and divorce
1 get married/divorced
When there is no object, get married and get divorced are more common than marry and divorce in an
informal style.
Lu/u and Joe got married last week.
(Lulu and Joe married... is more formal.)
When are you going to get married?
The Robinsons are getting divorced. In a more formal style, marry and divorce are preferred.
Although she had many lovers, she never married.
After three very unhappy years they divorced.
2 no preposition before object
Before a direct object, marry and divorce are used without prepositions. She married a builder. (NOT She
married with a builder.) Will you marry me? Andrew's going to divorce Carola.
3 get/be married to
We can also use get/be married to with an object. She got married to her childhood sweetheart. I've been
married to you for sixteen years and I still don't understand you.
330 may and might (1): introduction
1 grammar
May and might are modal auxiliary verbs (see 344-345).
a There is no -s in the third person singular.
She may be here tomorrow. (NOT She mays...) It might rain this afternoon.
b Questions and negatives are made without do. May I help you? (NOT Do I may...) We might not be
home before midnight.
c After may and might we use the infinitive without to of other verbs. You may be right. (NOT You may to
be right.) She might not want to come with us.
Progressive, perfect and passive infinitives are also possible (see 276). 'Why hasn 't Laurie come?' 'He
might be working late.' 'She didn 't say hello.' 'She may not have recognised you.' Do you think we might
be asked for our opinion?
d May and might do not have infinitives or participles (to may, maying, mightcd do not exist). When
necessary, we use other words.
She wants to be allowed to open a bank account. (NOT .. .-te-may^P^- •''
page
322
Might does not normally have a past meaning. It is used in the same way as may, to talk about the present
and future. The difference is that might usually refers to situations which are less probable or less definite
(see 331.2 and 332.1). Might also replaces may in past indirect speech (see 481).
However, certain past ideas can be expressed by may or might followed by a perfect infinitive (have +
past participle).
She's late. I think she may have missed the train.
Why did you do that? You might have killed yourself.
Might has a contracted negative mightn't. Mayn't is very unusual. For more information about contractions,
see 144.
meanings
May and might are used mainly to talk about possibility (especially the chances of something happening),
and to ask for and give permission (especially in a more formal style).
I may see you tomorrow.
Do you think I might borrow your typewriter?
For more details of the use of may and might, see the following sections. For may and might after so that
and in order that, see 519.
331 may and might (2): possibility
1 chances
We often use may and might to say that there is a chance that something is true, or that there is a
possibility of it happening.
'/ think Labour are going to win.' 'You may be right.' (= 'It is possible that you are right.')
We may go climbing in the Alps next summer.
'Where's Emma?' 'I don't know. She may be out shopping.' ff
Peter might phone. If he does, ask him to ring later.
'I might get a job soon: 'Yes, and pigs might fly: (= 'It's very unlikely:)
You might be needed at the office on Saturday. May well can be used to suggest a strong possibility.
'/ think it's going to rain: 'You may well be right- the sky's really black.'
2 may and might: the difference
Might is not used as a past form of may: both may and might are used to talk about the present or future.
Might is mostly used as a less definite or more hesitant form of may, suggesting a smaller chance - it is
used when people think something is possible but not very likely. Compare:
I may go to London tomorrow, (perhaps a 50% chance)
Joe might come with me. (perhaps a 30% chance)
For the 'distancing' use of past forms to express uncertainty, hesitation etc, see 161. >
page 323


^o-i""'"miy 331
3 typical occurrences: may
May can be used to talk about typical occurrences - things that can h
in certain situations. This is common in scientific and academic lanei ppen
Might is only used in this way to talk about the past. ^e'
After having a baby, a woman may suffer from depression for several months.
The flowers may have five or six petals; colour may range from light n • to dark red. •nk
Children of divorced parents may have difficulty in forming stable
relationships themselves.
In those days, a man might be hanged for stealing a sheep. Can is used in a similar way, especially in a
less formal style. See 123 l
4 questions
May is not normally used in direct questions about probability. Are you likely to go camping this summer?
(NOT May you go camping ...?} Do you think Emma's gone shopping?
(NOT May Emma have gone shopping?} But may is possible in negative questions about probability.
May we not be making a big mistake? (very formal) And may is possible in indirect questions (for example
after Do you think). Doyou thinkyou may go camping this summer?
5 negatives
Note the difference between may/might not and cannot/can't. ' . May/might not means 'It is possible that...
not...' Cannot/can't means 'It is not possible that...' Compare:
It may/might not be true. (= It is possible that it is not true.)
It can't be true. (= It is not possible that it is true.}
6 conditional: might meaning 'would perhaps'
Might (but not may) can have a conditional meaning (= 'would perhaps'). If you went to bed for an hour
you might feel better.
{=... perhaps you would feel better.} Don't play with knives. You might get hurt. (= Perhapsyou would
gethurt
if you did.}
7 indirect speech: might
Might is used as the indirect speech equivalent of both may and might after a past reporting verb.
Compare:
'What are you doing at the weekend, Anne?' 'Oh, I may go to Scotland -
or I just might stay at home.'
Anne said that she might go to Scotland at the weekend, or she might stay at home.
page
324
8 P^1
" gnd might cannot normally be used to say that something was possible
in the past. Other words have to be used.
J couldn't think clearly, and I felt hot. Perhaps I was ill.
(NOT .. .-l-might be ill.}
However, might can refer to the past in indirect speech (see paragraph 7 above). For the use of
may/mights perfect infinitive, see next paragraph.
9 may/might + perfect infinitive
To say that it is possible that something happened or was true in the past, a special structure can be used:
may/might + perfect infinitive (have + past
participle).
'Polly's very late.' 'She may have missed her train.'
(= 'It is possible that she missed...'} 'What was that noise?' 'It might have been a cat.' We can use the
same structure (especially with might} to say that something
was possible but did not happen.
You were stupid to try climbing up there. You might have killed yourself. If she hadn't been so bad-
tempered, I might have married her.
May is occasionally used in the same way in British English, but many people
feel that this is incorrect.
You were stupid to try climbing up there. You may have killed yourself.
May/might^ perfect infinitive can also refer to the present or future (like
present perfect and future perfect tenses).
I'll try phoning him, but he may have gone out by now. By the end of this year I might have saved some
money.
For the use of could have + past participle in similar senses, see 123.6. For more information about
perfect infinitives, see 278.
10 may, might and can
Can is not used in affirmative clauses to talk about the chances that something actually will happen or is
happening (= 'It is possible that...'). To express this meaning, we use may I might I could. We use can to
talk about a more general or theoretical kind of possibility (= 'It is possible to ...'). Compare:
- There may/might be a strike next week. (= It is possible that there will be...} (NOT There can be a strike
next week.}
Strikes can happen at any time. (= It is possible for strikes to happen...}
I mayfly to Amsterdam on Tuesday.
One can travel to Holland by boat or by air. However, in questions and negative clauses can is sometimes
used to talk about present possibilities, especially the question of whether something is rogically possible.
(This is not quite the same as the use of may and might to w- about the chance of something happening.)
Can that be Mike? I thought he was in Greece.
Jake's getting married? You can't mean it. >
page 325


11 may, might and could
Could is often used in similar ways to may and might, to talk about th chance of something happening or
being true.
War could break out any day. (OR War might...)
You could be right. (OR You may...)
For more about the use of can and could to talk about possibility, see 123. For basic grammatical
information about may and might, see 330. For the use of may and might to refer to permission, see 332.
For other uses of may and might, see 333-336.
332 may and might (3): permission
1 asking for permission
May and might can both be used to ask for permission. They are more formal than can and could. Might is
very polite and formal; it is not commnn and is mostly used in indirect question structures.
May I put the TV on?
I wonder if I might have a little more cheese.
(Very formal; more natural than Might I have...?}
For the use of past forms to express politeness and hesitation, see 161.
2 giving and refusing permission
May is used to give permission; may not is used to refuse permission and to forbid.
'May I put the TV on?' 'Yes, of course you may.' 'May I borrow the car?' 'No, I'm afraid you may not.'
Students may not use the staff car park.
These are rather formal. In an informal style can and cannot/can't are more common (see 124).
Must not is also used to forbid (see 351.3). It is a little stronger or more emphatic than may not.
Students must not use the staff car park.
3 talking about permission
We do not usually use may and might to talk about permission which has already been given or refused,
about freedom which people already have, or about rules and laws. Instead, we use can, could or be
allowed. These days, children can /are allowed to do what they like.
(NOT ... children may do what they like.) I could I was allowed to read what I liked when I was a child.
(NOT/ might rcad-wha^I liked-...)
Can you I Are you allowed to park on both sides of the road here? (More natural than May you park...?)
4 indirect speech
wever, may and might can be used in indirect speech to report the giving fnerroission. May is used after
present reporting verbs and might after past
The Manager says that we may leave our coats in the downstairs toilet. 'What are you doing here?' 'Peter
said that I might look round.' (very formal)
133 may and might (4): may in wishes and hopes
May (but not might] is used in formal expressions of wishes and hopes.
I hope that the young couple may enjoy many years of happiness together.
Let us pray that peace may soon return to our troubled land. May often comes at the beginning of the
sentence.
May you both be very happy!
May the New Year bringyou all your heart desires.
May God be with you. May she rest in peace, (prayer for a dead person)
For more information about inverted word order (auxiliary verb before subject), see 298.
334 may and might (5): may/might... but
May (and sometimes might) can be used in a discussion rather like although: to introduce a fact, when
one is going to say that the fact makes nor' difference to the main argument. They are often followed by
but. It may be a comfortable car, but it uses a lot of petrol.
(= Although it is a comfortable car, it uses...) He may be clever, but he hasn't got much common sense.
You might have plenty of money, but that doesn't mean you're better
than me.
She may have had a lovely voice when she was younger, but... Note that in this structure, may is often
used to talk about things that are definitely true, not just possible. It may be a comfortable car, but...
means 'I agree that it is comfortable, but...', not 'There's a chance that it is comfortable...'
In indirect speech, might is used after a past reporting verb.
I said that he might be clever, but that he hadn't got much common sense.
^S may and might (6): may/ might as well
This expression is used in an informal style to suggest that one should do ^mething because there is
nothing better, nothing more interesting or nothing more useful to do. May as well is perhaps a little more
definite than
"fight as well.
There's nobody interesting to talk to. We may as well go home. 'Shall we go and see Fred?' 'OK, might as
well.' >>
page
326
page 327


- - - ^ •.-'BB'-anuns etc) 33g
Note the difference between may/might as well and had better (see 2t4i Compare: "
IV(= There is nothing more interesting to do.) We'd better have something to eat.
(= We ought to eat; there is a good reason to eat now.) Might as well is also used to compare one
unpleasant situation with an This holiday isn't much fun. We might just as well be back home ° r"
(= Things wouldn't be any different if we were at home.) You never listen -I might as well talk to a brick
wall.
336 may and might (7): might (requests, suggestions and criticisms)
Might is often used in affirmative clauses to make requests and suggestions You might see if'John's free
this evening. You might try asking your uncle for a job.
The structure can be used to criticise. Might have + past participle is used to talk about the past.
You might ask before you borrow my car. She might have told me she was going to stay out all night.
For the use of could in similar senses, see 124.
337 maybe and perhaps
These two words mean the same. In British English both are common:
maybe is used mostly in an informal style. Compare:
Maybe/Perhaps it'll stop raining soon.
Julius Caesar is perhaps the greatest of Shakespeare's early plays.
Perhaps is often pronounced 'praps' by British people. In American English perhaps is less common, and
is rather formal.
338 meals
Not everybody uses the same names for meals: there are quite wide regional and social differences.
1 British usage
a midday: dinner or lunch
The midday meal is called dinner by many people, especially if it is the rnai meal of the day. Middle and
upper class people usually call it lunch.
b afternoon: tea
Some people have a light meal of tea and biscuits or cakes, called tea, at or five o'clock in the afternoon.
However, this is no longer very common.
page
328
r "-°"
early evening: (high) tea or supper
Many people have a cooked meal around five or six o'clock. This is often called tea or high tea; some
people call it supper.
A later evening: supper or dinner
A meal later in the evening is often called supper (and some people use the same word for a bedtime
snack). Some people use dinner for the evening meal if it is the main meal of the day. A more formal
evening meal with guests, or in a restaurant, is usually called dinner, especially by middle and upper class
people.
2 American usage
Americans generally use lunch for the midday meal and dinner for the ' evening meal. Celebration meals
at Christmas and Thanksgiving are called Christmas/Thanksgiving dinner, even if they are eaten at
midday.
339 mean
1 questions
Note the structure of questions with mean.
Excuse me. What does 'hermetic'mean? (NOT What means 'hermetic'?) Note also the preposition in What
do you mean by 'hermetic'? (=In what sense are you using the word?)
2 mean and think, meaning and opinion
Mean and meaning are 'false friends' for speakers of some European languages. They are not usually
used to mean 'think' or 'opinion' (but see paragraph 4 below). . I think that Labour will win the next
election.
(NOT I mean that Labour will win...) What's your opinion? (NOT -What's your meaning?)
3 structures
Mean (in the sense of 'intend', 'plan') can be followed by (object) + infinitive.
I mean to find out what's going on.
Sorry -1 didn't mean to interrupt you.
Did you mean John to post those letters? In the sense of 'involve', 'have as a result', mean can be
followed by a noun oran-wgform.
The Fantasians have invaded Utopia. This means war!
If you want to pass the exam it will mean studying hard.
4 I mean
^an is used informally as a 'discourse marker' (see 159) to introduce explanations or additional details. In
this use, it is separated from what follows by a pause.
He's funny -1 mean, he's really strange.
page 329


--w .w -^.means 340
7? was a terrible evening. I mean, they all sat round and talked nnlif whole time. "wsthe
Would you like to come out tonight? I mean, only if you want to of
I mean, used before a pause in this way, can also introduce expressior^0"^' opinion. In this case, it is close
to / think or I feel.
A hundred pounds for a thirty hour week. I mean, it's not right, is it? if
not right. (BUT NOT 4 mean that it's not-right...) ' ' s Another use is to introduce corrections.
She lives in Southport -1 mean Southampton.
In informal speech, I mean is also very common as a general-purpose connector or 'filler', with little real
meaning.
Let's go and see Phil on Saturday. I mean, we could make an early start
5 What do you mean...?
What do you mean...? can express anger or protest. What do you mean, I can't sing? What do you mean
by waking me up at this time of night?
6 no progressive form
Mean is not normally used in progressive forms when it refers to meanings.
What does that strange smile mean?
(NOT What is that strange smile meaning?) But progressive forms can be used to refer to intentions.
I've been meaning to phone you for weeks.
340 means
1 singular and plural ending in -s
Both the singular and the plural of means end in -s.
In the 19th century a new means of communication was developed -
the railway. (NOT ... a new mean of communication...) There are several means of transport on the island.
For other words with singular forms ending in -s, see 501.3.
2 by all/any/no means
By all means is not the same as by all possible means. It is used to give permission or to encourage
somebody to do something, and means 'of course' or 'it is all right to ...' Compare:
- 'Can I borrow your sweater?' 'By all means.'
By all means get a new coat, but don't spend more than L80. If there isn 't a bus, then by all means take a
taxi.
- We must help her by all possible means.
(NOT We must help her by all means.) .
By no means (or not by any means) is not the opposite of byallmeans.
similar to definitely not, or not by a long way. 'Is that all you 've got to say?' 'By no means.' Galileo was by
no means the first person to use a telescope. Schumann is not by any means my favourite composer.
page
330
lAl measurements: 'marked' and 'unmarked' forms
Many adjectives that are used in measurements come in pairs (e.g. tall/short, old/young, heavy/light,
fast/slow). The word that is used for the 'top' end of the measurement scale can usually be used in
another sense, to talk about the quality in general. For instance, one can ask how long something is even
if it is relatively short. Grammarians call these uses of words 'unmarked'.
Compare:
She's very tall and he's very short, (marked) Exactly how tall are they both? (unmarked) (NOT -Exaetty
how short arc they both?)
- He's very young for the job. (marked)
I don't really know how old he is. (unmarked)
(NOT .. .-hew young he is.) He's only twenty-three years old. (unmarked) (NOT .. .twenty three years
young.)
- Lead is one of the heaviest metals, (marked)
Scales are used to measure how heavy things are. (unmarked) (NOT ... how light things arc.)
Some nouns are used in similar 'unmarked' ways. Compare:
- Age brings wisdom but I'd rather haveyouth and stupidity, (marked) What is her exact age? (unmarked)
(NOT What is her exact youth?)
- The worst thing about the film was its length, (marked) What's the length of a football field? (unmarked)
(NOT What's the shortness... ?)
342 mind
Mind can mean 'dislike', 'be annoyed by', 'object to'. We use mind mostly in questions and negative
clauses.
I don't mindyou coming in late if you don't wake me up.
'Do you mind the smell of tobacco?' 'Not at all.' Would you mind...? and Do you mind...? are often used to
ask people to do things, or to ask for permission. We can use -ing forms or if-clauses.
Would/Do you mind... ing?
Would/Do you mind opening the window? (= Please open...) Would/Do you mind my opening the window?
(= Can I open...?)
Would/Do you mind if...?
Would you mind if I opened the window? °o you mind if I smoke?
o ask general questions about people's feelings, we can use Do you """d... ? but not usually Would you
mind...? "o you mind people smoking in your house? 00 you mind if people smoke in your house?
(B u T N o T Would you mind people smoking in your house?) >
page 331


""ss 343
Note that the answer No or Not at all is used to give permission afrp Would/Do you mind...? (but we
usually add more words to make th meaning quite clear). e
'Doyou mind if I look atyour paper?' 'No, please do.' In subordinate clauses after mind, a present tense is
usually used ifw to express a future meaning (see 556). e want
I don't mind what you do after you leave school. (NOT I don't mind what you will-do-...)
343 miss
1 'fail to contact', 'be late for'
Miss often expresses the idea of failing to contact somebody /something
being late for somebody / something. She threw a plate at me, but missed. How could he miss an easy
goal like that? If you don't hurry we'll miss the train. (NOT ... lose the-tmm:) You've just missed her-she
went home five minutes ago.
The station's about five minutes'walk, straight ahead. You can't miss it. An -ing form can be used after
miss.
I got in too late and missed seeing the news on TV.
2 'be sorry to be without'
We can use miss to say that we are sorry because we are no longer with somebody, or no longer have
something. Will you miss me when I'm away?
He doesn't like going to the country- he misses the noise and the bright
lights. An -ing form is possible.
I miss living in the mountains. Note that regret is not used in the same way. Compare:
I'll always miss being with you.
(= I'll always be sorry I'm not with you any more.) I'll always regret being with you. (= I'll always be sorry I
was with you.)
3 'notice the absence of
Another meaning of miss is 'notice that somebody/something is not there. The child ran away yesterday
morning, but nobody missed her till lunchtime.
4 miss not used
Miss is not used simply to say that somebody has not got something. In some of the villages they haven't
got electricity.
(NOT .. .-they miss electricity.)
In a formal style, the verb or noun lack can be used to express this idea. ... they lack electricity.
lam sorry that lack of time prevents me from replying at greater length to your enquiry.
page
332
5 missing
Missing is often used as an adjective, meaning 'lost'. When did you realise that the money was missing?
The missing children were found at their aunt's house.
We can use missing after a noun. This often happens in clauses beginning
with there is.
There's a page missing from this book. In an informal style, a structure with have... missing is also
possible.
We've got some plates missing-do you think Alan's borrowed them?
He had several teeth missing.
144 modal auxiliary verbs: introduction
1 What are modal auxiliary verbs?
The verbs can, could, may, might, will, would, shall (mainly British English), should, must and ought are
called 'modal auxiliary verbs'. They are used before the infinitives of other verbs, and add certain kinds of
meaning connected with certainty or with obligation and freedom to act (see next section). Need (see 357)
and dare (see 150) can sometimes be used like modal auxiliary verbs, and the expression had better (see
234) is also used like a modal auxiliary.
2 grammar
a Modal verbs have no -s in the third person singular. She may know his address. (NOT She mays...)
b Questions, negatives, tags and short answers are made without do. Can you swim? (NOT Doyou can
swim?)
He shouldn't be doing that, should he? (N o T He doesn't should...)
c After modal auxiliary verbs, we use the infinitive without to of other verbs. Ought is an exception - see
398.
/ must water the flowers. (NOT I must to water...) Progressive, perfect and passive infinitives are also
possible (see 276),
I may not be working tomorrow.
She was so angry she could have killed him.
The kitchen ought to be painted one of these days.
Modal verbs do not have infinitives or participles (to may, maying, mayod do not exist), and they do not
normally have past forms (though would, could, should and might can sometimes be used as past tenses
of will, can, wall and may). Other expressions are used when necessary.
I'd like to be able to skate. (NOT.. . to can skate.)
People really had to work hard in those days. ^01 -People really mustcd work...)
or more about infinitives without to, see 277. I
page 333


^. JI^U.U e However, certain past ideas can be expressed by a modal verb follow d perfect infinitive (have + past
participle). ed hy a
You should have told me you were coming.
I think I may have annoyed Aunt Mary. For details of these uses, see the entries on particular modal verbs
f Modal verbs have contracted negative forms (can't, won't etc) which used in an informal style. (Shan't
and mayn't are only used in British ^re r mayn't is very rare.) Will and would also have contracted
affirmative f n ^ ('II, 'd). For details, see 144. Some modals have both 'strong' and 'weair'"118
pronunciations. For details, see 588.
g There is quite often used as a preparatory subject with modal verbs especially when these are followed
by be (see 562). There may be rain later today.
3 meanings
We do not normally use modal verbs to say that situations definitely exist or that particular events have
definitely happened. We use them, for examole to talk about things which we expect, which are or are not
possible, which we think are necessary, which we want to happen, which we are not sure about which
tend to happen, or which have not happened.
He may arrive any time.
She could be in London or Paris or Tokyo - nobody knows.
I can't swim.
I think you ought to see a lawyer.
We really must tidy up the garden.
What wouldyou do if you had a free year?
Edinburgh can be very cold in winter.
I think they should have consulted a doctor earlier.
You might have told me Frances was ill.
For further general information about the meanings of modal auxiliary verbs, see next section. For more
detailed information, see the sections for each verb.
•5 modal auxiliary verbs: meanings
1 two kinds of meaning
Most of the meanings of modal verbs can be divided into two groups. One is to do with degrees of
certainty: modal verbs can be used to say for instance that a situation is certain, probable, possible or
impossible. The other is to with obligation, freedom to act and similar ideas: modal verbs can be used o
say that somebody is obliged to do something, that he / she is able to do something, that there is nothing
to stop something happening, that it wou be better if something happened (or did not), or that something is
perrni or forbidden.
page
334
' iiluucu av
2 degrees of certainty
Modal verbs can express various degrees of certainty about a fact or an event.
complete certainty (positive or negative)
I shall be away tomorrow. It won't rain this evening.
I shan't be late on Tuesday. You must be tired.
There's the phone. That'll be Tony. That can't be John - he's in Dublin.
Things will be all right. I knew it couldn't be John.
Thev knelt in front of the child who would one day rule all England.
I told you you wouldn't be ready in time.
b probability/possibility
She should /ought to be here soon.
It shouldn't / oughtn't to be difficult to get there.
We may be buying a new house.
The water may not be warm enough to swim.
c weak probability
I might see you again - who knows? Things might not be as bad as they seem. We could all be
millionaires one day.
d theoretical or habitual possibility
How many people can get into a telephone box?
New England can be very warm in September.
Small children may have difficulty in understanding abstract ideas.
e conditional certainty or possibility
If we had enough time, things would be easy.
I wouldn't do this if I didn't have to.
If John came we could all go home.
I couldn't do anything without your help.
If you stopped criticising I might get some work done.
It mightn't be a bad thing if we took a short holiday.
3 obligation and freedom to act
Modal verbs can express various aspects of obligation and freedom. These uses of modal verbs are very
important in the polite expression of requests, suggestions, invitations and instructions.
a strong obligation
Students must register at the tutorial office in the first week of term. All sales staffwill arrive for work by
8.40a.m. Need I get a visa for Hungary?
b Prohibition
Students must not use the staff car park.
Books may not be taken out of the library.
^u can't come in here. ^
page 335


,,,...,^-....M. wwm .mm«uy ciua. meanings tJe
c weak obligation; recommendation
yoy should try to work harder. She really ought to wash her hai That child had better start saying thank-
youfor things. You might see what John thinks. What shall we do?
d willingness, volunteering, resolving, insisting and offering If you will come this way...
I should be grateful if you would let me know your decision as soon as possible.
I'll pay for the drinks. I'll definitely work harder next term. She will keep interrupting people. Shall I give you
a hand?
e permission
Can I borrow your keys? May we use the phone? Do you think I might take a break now?
f absence of obligation
You needn't work this Saturday.
g ability
She can speak six languages.
Note that obligation, permission etc are usually seen from the speaker's point of view in statements and
the hearer's in questions. Compare:
- You must go and see Ann. (I think it is necessary.)
Must you go and see Ann? (Do you think it is necessary?)
- You can borrow my car. (.1 give permission.)
Can I borrow your car? (Will you give permission?)
4 other meanings
Besides the meanings discussed in paragraphs 2 and 3, will and would are used to talk about habitual
behaviour (see 600,604).
Most evenings he'll just sit in front of the TVandgo to sleep.
When we were kids, my mum would take us out on bikes all round
the countryside.
Used to + infinitive (see 577) is similar to a modal verb structure in some ways. It is used to talk about
habitual behaviour and (unlike would) habitual states.
/ used to play a lot of tennis when I was younger.
The grass used to look greener when I was a child.
(NOT -The grass would look greener when I was a child:)
5 subject-independence
An interesting, rather complicated point about modal verbs is that their meaning usually 'spreads over' a
whole clause. This means that one can change a modal structure from active to passive, for example,
without affecting the meaning very much. Compare:
- A child could understand his theory. His theory could be understood by a child.
page
336
You mustn't put adverbs between the verb and the object.
Adverbs mustn't be put between the verb and the object.
Dogs may chase cats.
Cats may get chased by dogs.
With most other verbs that are followed by infinitives, their meaning is attached to the subject, so that a
change from active to passive changes the sense of the sentence completely. Compare:
- Dogs like to chase cats.
Cats like to be chased by dogs. (different and - of course - untrue)
- pete wants to phone Ann. ;
Ann wants to be phoned by Pete. (not the same meaning)
For more details of the use of the various modal verbs, see the entries for each verb.
346 more
1 more + noun
We can use more before a noun phrase as a determiner (see 157). We do not generally use of when there
is no other determiner (e.g. article or possessive). We need more time. (NOT ... more of-Ume:) Could I
have some more pie? (NOT ... more of pic.) More university students are having to borrow money these
days.
(NOT More of university students...) However, more of can be used without a following determiner in a few
cases
- for instance, before personal and geographical names. It would be nice to see more of Ray and Barbara.
Five hundred years ago, much more of Britain was covered with trees.
2 more of+ determiner/pronoun
Before determiners (e.g. a, the, my, this) and pronouns, we use more of. He's more of a fool than I
thought. Three more of the missing climbers have been found. Could I have some more of that smoked
fish ? I don't think any more of them want to come.
3 more without a noun
We can drop a noun after more if the meaning is clear. I'd like some more, please.
4 one more etc
Note the structure one more, two, more etc + noun phrase. There's just one more river to cross.
For wother used in a similar way, see 53.
5 wore as an adverb
^ore can also be used as an adverb.
1hate this job more every day. ^•
page 337


"lost 347
6
comparative structures
2
More is used to make the comparative forms of longer adjectives anri adverbs (see 136 and 137). "^t
As you get older you get more tolerant. Please drive more slowly.
For no more, not any more/longer, see 372. Toifar more, much more, many more etc, see 139.
347 most
1 most + noun
We can use most before a noun phrase as a determiner (see 157). We do not generally use o/when there
is no other determiner (e.g. article or possessive) Most cheese is made from cow's milk. (NOT Most of
cheese...) Most Swiss people understand French. (NOT Most of Swiss-people ) However, most of can be
used without a following determiner in a few cases - for instance, before personal and geographical
names. : Most of George seemed to be covered with hair. The Romans conquered most of England.
mostof+ determiner/pronoun
Before determiners (e.g. a, the, my, this) and pronouns, we use most of. He's eaten two pizzas and most
of a cold chicken. You've got most of the bed, as usual. Most of the people here know each other. Most of
my friends live abroad. (NOT Most my friends...) She's eaten most of that cake. Most of us thought he was
wrong.
most without a noun
We can drop a noun after most if the meaning is clear.
Some people had difficulty with the lecture, but most understood. Ann and Robby found a lot of
blackberries, but Susan found the most.
the most with nouns
In comparisons (when most has a superlative meaning) it is normally used with the, though this is
sometimes dropped in an informal style in British English.
Susan found (the) most blackberries.
Which country produces (the) most wine? However, the is not used when there is no comparison, and
most sirnp'y means 'the majority of.
Most children like ice-cream. (NOT -The most children...}
3
4
338
- (the) most as an adverb
(The) most can also be used as an adverb. The is often dropped in an
informal style.
They all talk a lot, but your little girl talks (the) most.
The truth hurts most.
6 superlative adjectives and adverbs
(The) most is used to make the superlative forms of longer adjectives and most adverbs (see 136 and
137).
I wasn 't as clever as the others, but I was the most beautiful.
Which car goes fastest?
7 most meaning 'very*
Most can be used before adjectives to mean 'very' in evaluating expressions, especially in a formal style.
That is most kind of you.
Thank you for a most interesting afternoon.
The experience was most distressing.
348 much and many
1 the difference
Much is used with singular nouns; many is used with plurals. I haven't got much time. How much of the
roof needs repairing? You can have as much of the milk as you like. I don't know many of your friends.
She didn 't stay for as many days as she had intended.
2 much/many + noun
We can use much and many before noun phrases as determiners. We do not generally use o/when there
is no other determiner (e.g. article or possessive).
She didn't eat much breakfast. (NOT ... much of breakfast.)
There aren't many large glasses left. (NOT ... many of large glasses left.) However, much of can be used
without a following determiner in a few cases ~ for instance, before personal and geographical names.
I've seen too much of Howard recently.
Not much of Denmark is hilly.
0
winch/many of+ determiner + noun
Before determiners (e.g. a, the, my, this) and pronouns, we use much of and
many of.
You can't see much of a country in a week.
How much of the house do you want to paint this year?
I won't pass the exam: I've missed too many of my lessons.
^ou didn't eat much of it.
How many of you are there? >
page 339


«UUVM 1MJU *CTlly «f4J|
much/many without a noun
We can drop a noun after much or many, if the meaning is clear.
You haven't eaten much.
'Did you find any mushrooms?' 'Not many.' Note that much and many are only used like this when a noun
has been dropped. They are not used as the complements of nouns: other structurp are used. Compare:
There wasn 't much (food).
That's too much (food).
BUT NOT The food wasn't much.
(Because you couldn't say The food wasn't much food.) Many is not usually used alone to mean 'many
people'.
Many people think it's time for a change. (NOT Many think...)
not used in affirmative clauses
In an informal style, we use much and many mostly in questions-and negative clauses. They are unusual
in affirmative clauses except after so, as and too; other words and expressions are used. Compare:
'Howmuch money have you got?' 'I've got plenty.' (NOT 'I've got much.') He's got lots of men friends, but
he doesn't know many women.
(More natural than He's got many men friends.) There was so much traffic that it took me an hour to get
home. And there was a lot of bad driving on the road. (More natural than... there was much bad driving...)
You make too many mistakes - lots of spelling mistakes, for example.
(More natural than... many spelling mistakes...) Very much is common in affirmative clauses as an adverb,
but not as a determiner. Compare:
/ liked it very much. Thank you very much. There's a whole lot of water coming under the door.
(NOT There's very much water coming...)
In a formal style, much and many are not so unnatural in affirmative clauses. Much has been written about
the causes of unemployment. In the opinion of many economists,...
Far and long (= 'a long time') are also used mostly in questions and negative clauses. See 20b and 323.
much as adverb
We can use much as an adverb.
I don't travel much these days. , Much can come before some verbs expressing enjoyment, preference an
similar ideas, especially in a formal style.
/ much appreciate your help.
We much prefer the country to the town.
Janet much enjoyed her stay with your family.
page
340
must 11.1: introduction 349
Before some other verbs (e.g. like, dislike), this is only possible in negative structures and after very.
Compare:
I very much like your brother.
Idon'tmuch like your sister.
I like your parents a lot. (NOT I much like your parents.)
For more information about a lot (of), lots (of), plenty (of) etc, see 326.
For much and many modifying comparatives (e.g. much older, many more), see 139.
For much and very as modifiers before past participles (e.g. much/very amused), see 405.4.
349 must (I): introduction
1 grammar
Must is a modal auxiliary verb (see 344-345).
a There is no -s in the third person singular.
He must start coming on time. (NOT -Ho musts...)
b Questions and negatives are made without do. Must you go? (NOT Do you must go?) You mustn't
worry. (NOT You don't must worry.)
c After must, we use the infinitive without to of other verbs (see 277).
I must write to my mother. (NOT I must to write...) Progressive, perfect and passive infinitives are also
possible (see 276). You must be joking.
It must have been terrible to live during the war. Dogs must be kept on a lead.
d Must has no infinitive or participles (to must, musting, mustod do not exist), and it has no past tense.
When necessary, we use other words, for example forms of have to (see 243).
It's annoying to have to get up early on Sundays.
(NOT .. .to must get up...)
He'll have to start coming on time. (NOT He'll must...) She's always had to work hard. (NOT -She's always
mustcd...) We had to cut short our holiday because my mother was ill. (NOT Wo mustcd...)
6 However, ideas about the past can be expressed by must followed by a Perfect infinitive (have + past
participle). See 350.4.
/ can 'tfind my keys. I must have left them at home. Must can also be used with a past sense in indirect
speech.
Everybody told me I must stop worrying.
^here is a contracted negative mustn't (/'mAsnt/).
"fust has two pronunciations: a 'strong' pronunciation /mASt/ and a 'weak'
Pronunciation /m(a)st/. The weak pronunciation is used in most cases
t^e 588). ^.
page 341


nig nidi ouiiictiiing is Lciiain 350
2 meanings
MMrt is used mostly to express the conclusion that something is certain (see 350), and (less often in
American English) to talk about necessity anrt obligation (see 351).
You must be Anna's sister-you look just like her.
You really must get your hair cut.
For the difference between must and have to, see 352. For the difference between must and should, see
496.
350 must (2): concluding that something is certain
1 statements
Must can be used to express the conclusion that something is certain or highly probable - to suggest that
there are excellent arguments for believing something.
If A is bigger than B, and B is bigger than C, then A must be bigger than C.
Mary must have a problem - she keeps crying.
'I'm in love.' 'That must be nice, dear.'
There's the doorbell. It must be Roger.
2 questions and negatives; can
Must is not often used to express certainty in questions and negative clauses. In questions we use can.
There's somebody at the door. Who can it be? (NOT ... Who must it be?) In negative clauses we generally
use cannot/can't to say that something is certainly not the case.
It can't be the postman at the door. It's only seven o'clock.
(NOT 4tmustn't be the postman...) However, must not I mustn't is occasionally used in this sense,
especially in American English.
I haven't heard Molly moving about. She mustn't be awake yet. Heralarm mustn't have gone off.
(OR ... She can't be awake yet. Her alarm can't have gone off.) And mustn't is normal in this sense in
British English in question tags (see 465-466) after must, and in negative questions.
It must be nice to be a cat, mustn't it? (NOT ... can't it?)
Mustn't it have been strange to live in the Middle Ages?
3 need not
Need not is used in British English to say that something is not necessarily s0' does not have to can also
be used. Must not is not used in this sense. , 'Look at those tracks. That must be a dog.' 'It needn't be - it
could be a fox-
(OR ... 'It doesn't have to be...')
(NOT ... It mustn't bo...)
,342
4 conclusions about the past
We can use must with a perfect infinitive (have-f- past participle) to express
conclusions about the past.
'We went to Rome last month.' 'That must have been nice.' 'A woman phoned while you were out.' 'It must
have been Kate.'
Can is used in questions and negatives.
Where can John have put the matches? He can't have thrown them away.
5 indirect speech
Must can be used after a past reporting verb as if it were a past tense. I felt there must be something
wrong.
6 must and should
Should can be used as a weaker form of must. Compare:
Ann must be at home by now. (= I think she's certainly at home.) Ann should be at home by now. (= I think
she's very probably at home.)
For more about the difference between must and should, see 496.
351 must (3): necessity and obligation
1 statements: the speaker's point of view
In affirmative statements, we can use must to say what is necessary, and to give strong advice and orders
to ourselves or other people. This is especially common in British English; in American English have to is
generally preferred, particularly in speech.
Plants must get enough light and water if they are to grow properly.
British industry must improve its productivity.
I really must stop smoking.
You must be here before eight o'clock tomorrow. Must is common in emphatic invitations.
You really must come and see us soon.
In statements about obligation with must the obligation normally comes from the speaker. To talk about an
obligation that comes from 'outside' (for instance a regulation, or an order from somebody else), we
usually prefer have to (see 352).
I have to work from nine to five.
(More natural than / must work from nine to five.)
In my job I have to travel a lot.
(More natural than In my job I must travel a lot.)
~ questions: the hearer's point of view
In questions, British people can use must to ask about what the hearer thinks ^ necessary. (Americans
generally prefer have to.)
Must I clean all the rooms? (US Do I have to...?)
Why must you always leave the door open? *•
page 343



- "vz 3 negatives: prohibitions
British people can use must not/mustn't to say that things should not h
done, or tell people not to do things. Can't is also possible, and is norm ? • American English. ln
The government really mustn't/can't expect people to work hard for no money.
You mustn't/can't open this parcel until Christmas Day. .
Note that must not I mustn 't is not used to say that things are unnecessa This idea is expressed by do not
need to or do not have to.
You don't need to get a visa to go to Scotland. (NOT You mustn't get a visa to go to Scotland.)
In British English, we can give permission not to do things with need not You needn't work tomorrow if you
don't want to. (US You don't have to work...)
4 past necessity and obligation
Must is not normally used to talk about past obligation (except in'indirect speech - see below). This is
because must is used mainly for giving orders and advice and for making recommendations, and one
cannot do these
things in the past. Had to is used to talk about 'outside' obligation in the past. I had to cycle three miles to
school when I was a child.
For must+ perfect infinitive expressing conclusions about the past, see 350.4.
5 indirect speech
Must can be used (especially in British English) after a past reporting verb as if it were a past tense.
The doctor said that I must stop smoking. Obligation can also be reported with had to and would have to.
The doctor said that I had to I would have to stop smoking.
must and should
Should can be used as a weaker form of must. Compare:
That carpet must be cleaned. (= It is absolutely necessary.) That carpet should be cleaned. (= It would be
a good idea.)
For more about the difference between must and should, see 496.
For more information about have (got) to, see 243; for more about the difference between must and have
to, see 352.
352 must C4): must and have (got) to
There are some differences between must and have to. 1 concluding that something is certain
Both must and have (got) to can be used to express the conclusion that something is certain. Must is
unusual in this sense in American English, especially in speech. Have (got) to used to be unusual in
British English in
6
page
niusi \ti. IIIUSL ananave tgoiJ TO ~sss~L
this sense, but it is now becoming common. Tfzis must be the worst job in the world. (GB)
(OR This has (got) to be the worst job...) You must be joking. (GB) (OR You have (got) to be joking.)
Negative conclusions are not usually expressed with must not. That can't be his mother - she's not old
enough.
(NOT in British English That mustn't be his mother...) Does not have to is used to say that something is
not necessarily true. 'A dog's been killing our chickens.' 'It doesn't have to be a dog - it could be
a fox.' ^ , :, Conclusions about the past are usually expressed with must followed by the perfect infinitive
(have + past participle).
I hear you've been toPatagonia. That must have been interesting. (NOT -That has to have been
interesting.)
2 necessity and obligation
Must and have (got) to can both be used in British English to talk about necessity. In American English,
have to is more common, especially in speech.
Plants must/have to get enough light and water if they are to grow properly. Both verbs can be used in
British English to talk about obligation. (In American English, have to is the normal form.) British English
often makes a distinction as follows. Must is used mostly to talk about the feelings and wishes of the
speaker and hearer - for example, to give or ask for orders. Have (got) to is used mostly to talk about
obligations that come from 'outside' - for example from laws, regulations, agreements and other people's
orders. Compare:
- I must stop smoking. (I want to.)
I've got to stop smoking. Doctor's orders.
- This is a terrible party. We really must go home.
This is a lovely party, but we've got to go home because of the baby-sitter.
- I've got bad toothache. I must make an appointment with the dentist. I can't come to work tomorrow
morning because I've got to see the dentist at ten o'clock.
- You really must go to church next Sunday-you haven't been for ages.
(I am telling you to.) Catholics have to go to church on Sundays. (Their religion tells them to.)
- Must you wear dirty old jeans all the time? (Is it personally important for you?)
Do you have to wear a tie at work? (Is there a regulation?) Opinions about what people should do can be
expressed with must or should, but not usually with have to in British English.
People must/should understand that the world is changing.
3 future obligation: will have to, have (got) to and must
Will have to is used to talk about future obligation, but have (got) to is Preferred when arrangements for
the future have already been made. Compare:
When you leave school you'll have to find a job. I've got to go for a job interview tomorrow. >
page 345


Must can be used to give orders or instructions for the future.
You can borrow my car, but you must bring it back before ten. Will have to can be used to 'distance' the
instructions, making them sound
less like direct orders from the speaker.
You can borrow my car, but you'll have to bring it back before ten. Will need to can be used in the same
way (see 357.3).
4 talking about the past: had to... and must have...
" flad to is used to talk about past obligation. Must is used with the perfect infinitive (have + past participle)
to express certainty about the past (see
'paragraph 1, above). Compare:
Edna isn 't in her office. She had to go home.
(= It was necessary for her to go home.) Edna isn't in her office. She must have gone home. (= It seems
certain that she has gone home.)
5 negative forms
The negative forms must not and do not have to I have not got to have quite different meanings. Must not
is used to prohibit (to tell people not to do | things) and to refer to prohibitions; do not have to I have not
got to is use(t| say that there is no obligation. Compare: |
- You mustn't tell George. (= Don't tell George.)
You don't have to tell George. (= You can if you like but it isn't necessary.)
- You mustn't park on double yellow lines in England. You don't have to carry identity papers in England.
For more about have (got) to, see 243.
For more about the use of must to express conclusions about certainty, see 350. For more about the use
of must to express necessity and obligation, see 351. For needn't and don't need to, see 357.
353 names and titles
Names and titles are used both when talking about people and when talking to them. There are some
differences.
1 talking about people
When we talk about people we can name them in four ways.

friends
a first name
This is informal. We use first names mostly to talk about relatives,
and children.
Where's Peter? He said he'd be here at three. How's Maud getting on at school?
b first name + surname
This is neutral - neither particularly formal nor particularly informal. Isn't that Peter Connolly the actor?
We're going on holiday with Mary and Daniel Sinclair.
346
c title (Mr, Mrs etc) + surname
This is more formal. We talk like this about people we do not know, or when we want to show respect or
be polite.
Can I speak to Mr Lewis, please?
We've got a new teacher called Mrs Campbell.
Ask Miss Andrews to come in, please.
There's a Ms Sanders on the phone.
Note that it is less usual to talk about people by using title + first name + surname (e.g. Mr John Parker).
d surname only
We often use just the surname to talk about public figures - politicians, sportsmen and sportswomen,
writers and so on.
Do you think Roberts would make a good President?
The women's 5,000 metres was won by/ones.
[don't think Eliot is a very good dramatist. Surnames alone are sometimes used for employees (especially
male employees), and by members of groups (especially all-male groups like soldiers, schoolboys, team
members) when they refer to each other.
Tell Patterson to come and see me at once.
Let's put Billows in goal and move Carter up.
2 talking to people
When we talk to people we generally name them in one of two ways. a first name
This is informal, used for example to relatives, friends and children. Hello, Pamela. How are you?
b title + surname
This is more formal or respectful.
Good morning. Miss Williamson.
Note that we do not usually use both the first name and the surname of a person that we are talking to. It
would be unusual to say 'Hello, Peter Matthews', for example.
Members of all-male groups sometimes address each other by their surnames alone, but this is unusual in
modern English.
Mr, Mrs and Ms are not generally used alone. Excuse me. Can you tell me the time?
(^01 -Excuse me, Mr or Excuse me, Mrs.)
octor can be used alone to talk to medical doctors whom one is consulting, "ut not usually in other cases.
Doctor, I've got this pain in my elbow.
and madam are used in Britain mostly by people in service occupations '"' ^"P assistants). Some
employees call their male employers sir, and e ^hoolchildren call their teachers sir or miss. Dear Sir and
Dear Madam comrnon ways of beginning letters to strangers (see 317) - note the capital
page 347


letters. In other situations sir and madam are unusual in British English
Excuse me. Can you tell me the time? (NOT Excuse me, sir...) In American English, sir and ma'am are
less formal than in British English and are quite often used (especially in the South and West) when
addressin people. °
notes on titles
Note the pronunciations of the tides Mr, Mrs and Ms (used before names)-
Mr/'mista(r)/ Mrs/'misiz/ Ms/miz/ Mr (= Mister) is not normally written in full, and the other two cannot be
like Mr, Ms does not show whether somebody is married or not. It is often used, especially in writing, to
talk about or address women when one does not know (or has no reason to say) whether they are
married. Many women also choose to use Ms before their own names in preference to Mrs or Miss Ms is a
relatively new title: it has been in common use in Britain since the 1970s, and a little longer in the United
States.
Dr (= Doctor) is used as a title for medical and other doctors (but see
paragraph 2 for its use.)
Professor does not mean 'teacher'; it is used only for certain very senior
university teachers.
Note that we do not normally combine two titles such as ProfDr or Mrs Dr.
For ways of addressing people in letters, see 317.
For ways of introducing people, see 520.1.
For full stops with abbreviated titles and initials, see 2.
nationalities, countries and regions
introduction
In order to refer to a nation or region and its affairs it is usually necessary to
know four words:
n the name of the country or region
Denmark, Japan, France, Catalonia D the adjective
Danish, Japanese, French, Catalan D the singular noun used for a person from the country
a Dane, a Japanese, a Frenchman/woman, a Catalan D the plural expression the... used for the
population as a whole
the Danes, the Japanese, the French, the Catalans Usually the singular noun is the same as the adjective
(e.g. Japanese, Mexican), and the plural expression is the same as the adjective + -ste'" Mexicans). See
paragraph 2 below for more examples. However, there number of exceptions (see paragraph 3). All words
of this kind (including adjectives) begin with capital letters.
American literature (NOT american literature) . A-cW6-The name of a national language is often the same
as the national a ) Danish is difficult to pronounce. Do you speak Japanese2
..,<. 348
•ticmuca, LULiniries ana regions' 354
2 examples

Country/region

Adjective

Person

Population

America

American

an American

the Americans

(The United







States)







Belgium Brazil

Belgian
Brazilian

a Belgian a
Brazilian

the Belgians the
Brazilians

Europe Italy

European
Italian

a European an
Italian

the Europeans
the Italians

Kenya Morocco
Norway Tyrol

Kenyan
Moroccan
Norwegian
Tyrolean

a Kenyan a
Moroccan a
Norwegian a
Tyrolean

the Kenyans the
Moroccans the
Norwegians the
Tyroleans

Greece

Greek

a Greek

the Greeks

Iraq Israel

Iraqi Israeli

an Iraqi an Israeli

the Iraqis the
Israelis

Thailand

Thai

a Thai

the Thais

China

Chinese

a Chinese

the Chinese

Congo Portugal
Switzerland

Congolese
Portuguese
Swiss

a Congolese a
Portuguese a
Swiss

the Congolese
the Portuguese
the Swiss

3 exceptions

Country/region

Adjective

Person

Population

Britain

British

a British person

the British

England

English

(Briton) an
English-

the English

France

French

, woman/man a
Frenchman/

the French

Ireland



woman





Irish

an Irishwoman/

the Irish

Spain
The Netherlands/
Holland

Spanish Dutch

man a Spaniard a
Dutchwoman/

the Spanish the
Dutch

Walcc v


man





Welsh

a Welshman/

the Welsh

Denmark
Rnland

Danish

woman a Dane

the Danes

Poland

Finnish

a Finn

the Finns

Gotland

Polish

a Pole

the Poles

^eden

Scottish,
Scotch

a Scot

the Scots

Turkey

Swedish
Turkish

a Swede . a Turk

the Swedes the
Turks

page 349


near (to) 333
Notes
a The Scots prefer the adjective Scottish, but other people often use Scotch
b The word Briton is unusual except in newspaper headlines - for examni TWO BRITONS KILLED IN AIR
CRASH. Brit is sometimes used informal (But most British people call themselves Scottish, Welsh, Irish 01
English ^
c English is not the same as British, and is not used for Scottish, Welsh or I • k people (see 114).
d Although American is the normal English word for United States citizens a affairs, people from other
parts of the American continent may object to th' use, and some people avoid it for this reason.
e Arabic is used for the language spoken in Arab countries; in other cases, the normal adjective is Arab.
Arabian is used in a few fixed expressions and place names (e.g. Saudi Arabian, the Arabian Sea).
f Note the pronunciation of words like Irishman/men, Dutchman I men: the singular is the same as the
plural (/'ainJman, 'dAtJman/).
355 near (to)
The adjective near can be used like a preposition, with or without to. To is not normally used when we are
talking about physical closeness.
We live near the station. When we are not talking about physical closeness, near to is often preferred.
I came very near to hitting him.
Nearer and nearest are generally used with to, though to can be dropped in an informal style.
Come and sit nearer (to) me. Who's the girl sitting nearest (to) the door?
For the difference between nearest and next, see 356.
356 nearest and next
1 place and time
Nearest is used for place -it means 'most near in space'. , Excuse me. Where's the nearest tube station?
(v or .. .-thewxt-tub^statferk-
Ifyou want to find Alan, just look in the nearest pub. Next is used to talk about time or series - it means
'nearest in the future
'after this/that one'. . We get off at the next station. (= the station that we will come to first.) I'm looking
forward to her next visit. As soon as he had finished one trip, he started planning the next.
2 exceptions: next used for place
' The rno^ We use next in a few fixed expressions to mean 'nearest in space. i
common are next door and next to.
My girl-friend lives next door. Come and sit next to me.
For next and the next, see 367.
pag"
350
357 "eed
When need is followed by another verb, it can have the forms either of an ordinary verb or (in British
English) of a modal auxiliary verb.
1 ordinary verb
Need most often has the same forms as ordinary verbs: the third person singular has -s, and questions
and negatives are made with do. Need is usually followed by an infinitive with to.
Everybody needs to rest sometimes.
Do we need to reserve seats on the train?
2 modal auxiliary verb
In British English, need can also have the same present-tense forms as modal auxiliary verbs: the third
person singular has no -s, and questions and negatives are made without do. In this case, need is
normally followed by an infinitive without to.
We needn't reserve seats - there'll be plenty of room. These modal forms are used mainly in negative
sentences, but they are also possible in questions, after if, and in other 'non-assertive' structures (see
374).
You needn't fill in a form. Need I fill in a form?
I wonder if I need fill in a form. This is the only form you need fill in.
(BUT NOT You need fill in a form.)
Modal forms of need normally refer to immediate necessity. They are often used to ask for or give
permission - usually permission not to do something. Modal verb forms are not used to talk about habitual,
general necessity. Compare:
It's OK- You needn't pay for that phone call.
(OR... You don't need to pay for that phone call.}
You don't need to pay for emergency calls in most countries.
(NOT You needn't pay ...in most countries.) Modal forms of need are rare in American English.
3 talking about the future
Present tense forms of need are used when making decisions about the future.
Need I come in tomorrow? Tell her she doesn't need to work tonight. Will need to... can be used to talk
about future obligation, and give advice for the future. It can make orders and instructions sound less
direct.
We'll need to repair the roof next year.
You'll need to start work soon if you want to pass your exams.
You'll need to fill in this form before you see the Inspector.
^t similar uses of have to, see 243.3.
4 need...ing
er need an -ing form can be used in British English, with the same "leaning as a passive infinitive.
l hat sofa needs cleaning again. {=... needs to be cleaned...)
^cture with object +.. .ing is also possible in some cases.
"on need your head examining. (OR ... examined.} >
page 351


-^twes 3sg
5 need not + perfect infinitive
If we say that somebody need not have done something (GB), we mp he or she did it, but that it was
unnecessary - a waste of time. You needn't have woken me up. I don't have to go to work today I needn't
have cooked so much food. Nobody was hungry. On the other hand, if we say that somebody did not need
to do someth' are simply saying that it was not necessary (whether or not it was donelg> we Compare:
I needn't have watered the/lowers. Just after I finished it started rain' It started raining, so I didn't need to
water the/lowers. ^'
6 need not and must not
Need not (GB) is used to say that there is no obligation; must not is used to say that there is an obligation
not to do something. Compare:
You needn't tell Jennifer - she already knows.
You mustn't tell Margaret -1 don't want her to know. Need not is also sometimes used to say that
something is not necessarily true
'She looks quite ill. I'm sure it's flu.' 'It needn't be - maybe she's just over-tired'
For there is no need to..., see 563.2.
For more about verbs followed by perfect infinitives, see 278.
For more about modal auxiliary verbs, see 344-345.
358 negative structures (I): basic rules
1 negative verb forms
We make negative verb forms by putting not after an auxiliary verb.
We have not forgotten you. It was not raining. She can't swim. Do is normally used if there is no other
auxiliary verb.
/ like the salad, but I don't like the soup. (NOT I like not the soup.) Do is followed by the infinitive without
to.
I didn't think.
(NOT I didn't to think, I didn't thinking OR I didn't thought) Do is not used with another auxiliary verb.
You mustn't worry. (NOT You don't must worry.) Do is not normally used with be (even when be is the
main verb).
The supper isn't ready. (NOT The supper doesn't be read)1;) Do is not used with negative subjunctives
(these are mainly US - see 541), infinitives or -ing forms.
It is important that she not realise what is happening.
Remind me not to come here again. (NOT ... to do notwrw. • •)
For negative forms of have, dare, need and used with and without do, see the entries on
these verbs.
For the dialect form ain't, see 144.4. For negatives without do in older English (e.g. / like him not), see
388.
2 imperatives
Negative imperatives are made with do not/don't-^- infinitive (see 268). Do not expect quick results when
you start learning a language-(NOT Expect not...)
page
352
Don't worry - I'll look after you. (NOT Worry not...) Do not/don't is also used to make the negative
imperative of be. Don't be rude.
3 infinitives and -ing forms
We put not before infinitives and -ing forms. Do is not used. It's important not to worry. (NOT ... to don't-
worry:) The best thing about a holiday is not working.
4 other parts of a clause
We can put not with other parts of a clause, not only a verb. Ask Jake, not his wife. Come early, but not
before six.
It's working, but not properly.
We do not usually put not with the subject. Instead, we use a structure with if. It was not George that
came, but his brother. (NOT Not George came...)
For the difference between not and no with nouns, see 375.
5 other negative words
Other words besides not can make a clause negative. Compare:
He's not at home.
He's never at home.
He's seldom I rarely I hardly ever at home. We do not normally use the auxiliary do with these other
words. Compare:
He doesn't work.
He never works. (NOT He docs never work.} He seldom I rarely I hardly ever works. However, do can be
used after one of these negative words for emphasis or
contrast.
/ never did like her.
6 question tags
Affirmative question tags are used after negative clauses.
You don't work on Sundays, do you?
You seldom work on Saturdays, do you?
(NOT -You seldom work on Saturdays, don'tyou?) Clauses with little and/ew (see 322) also have a
negative sense, and are followed by affirmative question tags
There's little point in doing anything about it, is there? (NOT... isn't there?)
He has few reasons for staying, has he?
For more information about question tags, see 465-466.
'non-assertive words'(any etc)
"e do not usually use some, somebody, something etc in negative clauses. Instead, we use the 'non-
assertive' words any, anybody, anything etc. Compare:
/ w found some mushrooms.
1 haven't found any mushrooms. ^
page
353


! ,.-.---,,.-,..-...•--,..., -o-""ll 359
Some other words (e.g. ever, yet) are 'non-assertive', and found mosti • questions and negative clauses.
See 374 for more details. ^ m
For transferred negation (e.g. I don't think he's coming), see 359. For negative questions, see 360. For
double negatives, see 361.
359 negative structures (2): transferred negation
1 think, believe etc
When we introduce negative ideas with think, believe, suppose, imasdn words with similar meanings, we
usually make the first verb (think etc) negative, not the second.
I don't think you've met my wife.
(More natural than I think you haven't met my wife.)
I don't believe she's at home.
(More natural than I believe she isn 't at home.) However, surprise is often expressed with I thought +
negative.
'Would you like a drink?' 'I thought you'd never ask.'
Hello! I thought you weren't coming.
2 hope
Transferred negation is not used with hope.
I hope it doesn 'train. (NOT I don't hope it rains.)
3 short answers
In short answers, think, believe, hope etc can be followed by not (see 515).
'Are we going to see Alan again?' 'I believe/suppose/hope not.' Another possible short answer
construction is I don't... so (see 515). (Hope is not used in this structure.)
'Do you think there'll be snow tomorrow?' 'I don't believe/suppose/think so.'
(BUT 'I hope not.') I don't think so is more common than I think not, which is rather formal.
4 verbs followed by infinitives
Many verbs can be followed by infinitives (see 283). In an informal style we often prefer to make the first
verb negative rather than the infinitive, _ although this may not change the meaning at all. This happens,
for example. with appear, seem, expect and happen. Sibyl doesn't seem to like you.
(Less formal than Sibyl seems not to like you.) I don't expect to see you before Monday.
(More natural than / expect not to see you...) ^ Angela and I were at the same university, but we never
happened t
(Less formal than... we happened never to meet.) ., ^ug With intend and want + infinitive, we almost
always put not/never wi first verb.
I don't want to fail this exam. (NOT I want not to fail...) After I've finished this contract I never intend to
teach again.
354
5 always, almost
w usually use never... any and hardly... any/ever, rather than always ...no
and almost... no/never.
She never gives people anything. (NOT She always gives people nothing.)
Hardly anyone turned up. (More natural than Almost no one turned up.)
ifiO negative structures (3): negative questions
1 structure
Fontracted and uncontracted negative questions have different word order. (Uncontracted negative
questions are usually formal.)
auxiliary verb + n't + subject
Doesn't she understand? Why haven't you booked your holiday yet? auxiliary verb + subject + wot
Does she not understand? Why have you not booked your holiday yet? Non-auxiliary have (British
English) and non-auxiliary be go in the same position as auxiliary verbs.
Hasn't she any friends to help her? (GB - see 241)
Have they not at least a room to stay in ? (GB)
Aren'tyou ready? Is Mrs Alien not at home?
2 two meanings
Negative questions can have two different kinds of meaning. It is usually clear from the situation and
context which kind of question is being asked.
a 'Isn't it true that... ?' A negative question can ask for confirmation of a ::, positive belief. In this case the
question expects the answer Yes, and means 'Isn't it true that... ?'
Didn't you go and see Helen yesterday? How is she?
(= / believe you went and saw Helen yesterday...) Expressions of opinion can be made less definite by
expressing them as negative questions.
Wouldn't it be better to switch the lights on? Negative questions of this kind are common in exclamations
(see 201) and rhetorical questions (see 464).
Isn't it a lovely day!
'She's growing up to be a lovely person.' 'Yes, isn't she!'
Isn't the answer obvious? (= Of course the answer is obvious.)
slt true that... not...?' A negative question can also ask for confirmation 0 a negative belief. In this case the
question expects the answer No, and ""•ans 'is it true that... not...?'
Oon'tyoufeel well? (= Am 1right in thinking you don't feel well?)
Th ' dear' can't ^ come this ewnm?7
is kind of negative question can show that the speaker is surprised that
"^tiling has not happened or is not happening. ' "«sn't the postman come yet?
nltthe alarm go off? I wonder what's wrong with it. >
page 355


-s'TOves"
3 polite requests, invitations, offers, complaints and criti •
^Sll^c
Pressing invitations and offers often begin Won'tyou...? Wouldn't or Why don't you...? y°u...?
Won'tyou come in for a few minutes?
Wouldn't you like something to drink?
Why don't you come and spend the weekend with us? But in other cases we do not usually use negative
questions to ask DP do things. This is done with ordinary questions, or with negative state e t0 + question
tag.
Excuse me, can you help me for a moment? (ordinary question, used as a request)
You can't help me for a moment, can you?
(negative statement + question tag, common in informal requests)
BUT NOT Can't you help me for a moment? Negative questions may be understood as complaints or
criticisms.
Can't you lend me your pen for a minute? (Meaning something like Are you too selfish to lend me...?)
Don't you ever listen to what I say?
4 yes and no
In a reply to a negative question, Yes suggests an affirmative verb, and No suggests a negative verb.
Compare:
- 'Haven't you written to Mary?' 'Yes.' (= 'I have written to her.') 'Haven't you told her about us?' 'No.' (= 'I
haven't told her about us.')
- 'Didn 't the postman come this morning?' 'Yes, he did.' 'Didn't he bring anything for me?' 'No, he didn't.'
361 negative structures (4): double negatives
1 English and other languages
In some languages, a negative word like nobody, nothing or never has to be used with a negative verb. In
standard English, nobody, nothing, never etc are themselves enough to give a negative meaning, and not
is unnecessary. I opened the door, but I could see nobody. (NOT I couldnt^ee-nebwty.) Nothing matters
now- everything's finished.
(NOT Nothing docsn 't matter...) I've never understood what she wants. (NOT I haven't never
understood...)
2 nobody and not anybody, etc
Nobody, nothing, never etc are rather emphatic. We often prefer to use anybody, not anything, not ever etc.
Note that anybody, anything, eve.^ are not themselves negative words - they have to be used with not to g
negative meaning.
I opened the door, but I couldn't see anybody. (NOT ... but I could sec anybody.)
I'm sorry, I can't tell you anything.
356
,.i-g beginning of a clause, only nobody, nothing etc are used. Nothing matters. (NOT Not anything
matters.) Nowhere is safe.
more information about 'non-assertive' words like any, anybody, anything, ever etc,
see 374.
double and multiple negatives and their meaning
Double negatives are possible in standard English, but then both words normally have their full meaning.
Compare:
Say nothing. (= Be silent.)
Don't just say nothing. Tell us what the problem is. (= Don't be silent...) Multiple negatives are sometimes
used instead of simple positive structures for special stylistic effects. This is rather literary; in spoken
English it can seem unnatural or old-fashioned.
Not a day passes when I don't regret not having studied music in my youth. (More natural; Every day I
regret not having studied music when I was younger. OR I wish I had studied music when I was younger.)
4 dialects
In many British, American and other dialects, two or more negatives can be
used with a single negative meaning.
I ain't seen nobody. (Dialect for I haven't seen anybody.) I ain't never done nothing to nobody, and I ain't
never got nothing from nobody no time. (American song by Bert Williams)
For more information about ain't, see 144.4.
5 extra negative in expressions of doubt
In informal standard spoken English, a negative verb (without a negative meaning) is sometimes used
after expressions of doubt or uncertainty. I shouldn't be surprised if they didn't get married soon.
(=... if they got married soon.)
I wonder whether I oughtn't to go and see a doctor - I'm feeling a bit funny. (=... whether I ought to...)
6 '-.I don't think etc
fa informal speech, expressions like I don't think or I don't suppose are often added after negative
statements. In this case, the extra negative makes no difference to the meaning of the statement.
She hasn't got much chance of passing the exam, I don't think.
We won't be back before midnight, I don't suppose.
3fi9
"egative structures (5): ambiguous sentences
a negative structure, not can refer to different parts of a sentence.
A^hw ^n't write to Sue yesterday - he phoned her.
Ath didn't write t0 sue yesterday - he wrote to Ann.
ur didn't write to Sue yesterday - he wrote this morning. >
page 357


"--•• • • •-" 1---- ..- ---.,. "-« 00.1
The exact meaning is shown in speech by stress and intonation, and p writing it is usually clear from the
context and situation. However ven ln confusions sometimes arise. They can usually be avoided by reorean-
• sentence. Compare: ^•"•'ingthe
The car crash didn't kill him. (Did he live, or did something else kill n
It wasn't the car crash that killed him. (Only one possible meanine 1 lln?^ Negative sentences with
because-clauses are often ambiguous.
/ didn't sing because Pam was there. This sentence could mean 'My reason for not singing was that Pam
wa or 'My reason for singing was not that Pam was there'. The first meaning ere could be shown clearly by
putting the because-clause at the beginning
Because Pam was there, I didn 't sing.
363 neither (of): determiner
1 neither + singular noun
We use neither before a singular noun to mean 'not one and not the other (of two)'.
'Can you come on Monday or Tuesday?' 'I'm afraid neither day is possible'
2 neither of+ plural
We use neither of before a determiner (for example the, my, these), and before a pronoun. The noun or
pronoun is plural.
Neither of my brothers can sing. (NOT Neither my brothers can sing.)
Neither of us saw it happen. After neither of + noun / pronoun, we use a singular verb in a formal style.
Neither of my sisters is married. In an informal style, a plural verb is possible.
Neither of my sisters are married.
3 neither used alone
We can use neither alone, without a noun or pronoun. 'Which one do you want?' 'Neither.'
4 pronunciation
In British English, neither can be pronounced both /'naioa(r)/ and /'ni:oa(r)/. In American English, the usual
pronunciation is /'ni:oar/.
364 neither, nor and not... either
1 neither and nor
We can use neither and nor as adverbs to mean 'also not'. Neither and come at the beginning of a clause,
and are followed by inverted word or auxiliary verb + subject. (In American English, nor is not used after
an
awither/nor + auxiliary verb •• subject
'I can't swim.' 'Neither can I.' (NOT 'I also can't.') -A^it-te^--Ruth didn't turn up, and nor did Kate. (GB)
(NOT .. .-md^atfww1'1^
naee 358
o not either
We can also use not... eitherwith the same meaning and normal word order.
'I can't swim."! can't either.'
Ruth didn't turn up, and Kate didn't either. In very informal speech, me neither (and occasionally me
either) can be used instead of I.. .n't either.
'I can't swim.' 'Me neither.'
3 not...nor
Nor can follow not, especially after a pause; it is more emphatic than or. She didn't phone that day, nor the
next day. (More emphatic than... that
day or the next day.) (NOT ... neither the next day.) Our main need is not food, nor money. It is education.
For the pronunciation of neither, see 363.
For other uses of either, see 178-179.
foisoami, so do I etc, see 516.
For the difference between too/also and either in negative sentences, see 46.
For more about inverted word order, see 298-299.
365 neither... nor
This structure is used to join two negative ideas. (It is the opposite of both... and.) It is usually rather
formal.
I neither smoke nor drink, (less formal: I don't smoke or drink.)
The film was neither well made nor well acted. Sometimes more than two ideas are connected by
neither... nor.
He neither smiled, spoke, nor looked at me. When singular subjects are connected by neither... nor, the
verb is normally singular, but it can be plural in a less careful style.
Neither James nor Virginia was at home. (normal)
Neither James nor Virginia were at home. (less careful)
See also both... and... (Ill) andet/ier...or(179).
^G newspaper headlines
1 special language
Headlines are the short titles above newspaper reports (e.g. RUSSIAN WOMAN LANDS ON MOON). The
headlines in English-language newspapers can be very difficult to understand. One reason for this is that
newspaper headlines are often written in a special style, which is very different from ordinary English. In
this style there are some special rules of grammar, and words "e often used in unusual ways. >
page 359


2 grainrnar
b
d
Headlines are not always complete sentences. Many headlines con • noun phrases with no verb. slst °^
MORE WAGE CUTS
HOLIDA YHO TEL DBA TH
EXETER MAN 'S DOUBLE MARRIAGE BID
Headlines often contain strings of three, four or more nouns; nouns the string modify those that follow. ' Ier
in
FURNITURE FACTORY PAY CUT ROW
Headlines like these can be difficult to understand. It sometimes hein read them backwards. FURNITURE
FACTORY PAY CUT a ow refers to a nn (disagreement) about a CUT (reduction) in PAY at a FACTORY
that makes
FURNITURE.
Headlines often leave out articles and the verb be.
SHAKESPEARE PLAY IMMORAL, SAYS HEADMASTER WOMAN WALKS ON MOON
In headlines, simple tenses are often used instead of progressive or perfect forms. The simple present is
used for both present and past events.
BLIND GIRL CLIMBS EVEREST (= ... has climbed...) STUDENTS FIGHT FOR COURSE CHANGES (= . .
. are fighting...)
The present progressive can be used, especially to talk about changes. Be is usually dropped.
BRITAIN GETTING WARMER, SAY SCIENTISTS TRADE FIGURES IMPROVING
Many headline words are used as both nouns and verbs, and nouns are often used to modify other nouns
(see paragraph 2b). So it is not always easy to work out the structure of a sentence. Compare:
US CUTS AID TO THIRD WORLD
(= The us reduces its help... CUTS is a verb, AID is a noun.) AID CUTS RO w (= There has been a
disagreement about the reduction in
aid. AID and CUTS are both nouns.) curs AID REBELS (= The reduction is helping the revolutionaries.
CUTS is a
noun, AID is a verb.)
Headlines often use infinitives to refer to the future.
PM TO VISIT AUSTRALIA HOSPITALS TO TAKE FEWER PATIENTS
For is also used to refer to future movements or plans.
TROOPS FOR GLASGOW? (= Are soldiers going to besentto Glasgow.)
g Auxiliary verbs are usually dropped from passive structures, leaving p participles.
MURDER HUNT: MAN HELD (=... a man is being held by police.} six KILLED IN EXPLOSION (= Six
people have been killed. ••) ,yg Note that forms like held, attacked are usually past participles with pas
meanings, not past tenses (which are rare in newspaper headlines).
Compare: Hacked-)
- AID now: PRESIDENT ATTACKED (=... the Presidenthasbeena
AID ROW: PRESIDENT ATTACKS CRITICS
(=... the President has attacked her critics.)
. 360
BOY FOUND SAFE (= The missing boy has been found safe.) BOY FINDS SAFE (= A boy hasfound a
safe.)
A colon (:) is often used to separate the subject of a headline from what is said about it.
STRIKES: PM TO ACT MOTORWAY CRASH: DEATH TOLL RISES
Quotation marks ('...') are used to show that words were said by somebody else and that the newspaper
does not necessarily claim that they are true.
CRASH DRIVER 'HAD BEEN DRINKING '
A auestion mark (?) is often used when something is not certain.
CRISIS OVER BY SEPTEMBER? For other styles with special grammar, see I.
3 vocabulary
Short words save space, and so they are very common in newspaper headlines. Some of the short words
in headlines are unusual in ordinary language (e.g. curb, meaning 'restrict' or 'restriction'), and some are
used in special senses which they do not often have in ordinary language (e.g. bid, meaning 'attempt').
Other words are chosen not because they are short, but because they sound dramatic (e.g. blaze, which
means 'big fire', and is used in headlines to refer to any fire). The following is a list of common headline
vocabulary.
act take action; do something
FOOD CRISIS: GOVERNMENT TO ACT
aid military or financial help; to help
MORE AID FOR POOR COUNTRIES UNIONS AID HOSPITAL STRIKERS
alert alarm, warning
FLOOD ALERT ON EAST COAST
allege make an accusation
WOMAN ALLEGES UNFAIR TREATMENT
appear appear in court accused of a crime
MP TO APPEAR ON DRUGS CHARGES
axe abolish, close down; abolition, closure
COUNTRY BUS SER VICES AXED SMALL SCHOOLS FACE AXE
BA British Airways
BA MAKES RECORD LOSS
^ck support
AMERICA BACKS BRITISH PEACE MOVE
"an forbid, refuse to allow something; prohibition
CHINA BANS US IMPORTS NEW BAN ON DEMONSTRATIONS
w "^se / refusal to allow entry
^OTEL BARS FOOTBALL FANS .ElV BAR ON IMMIGRANTS
u"1 attempt
JAPANESE WOMEN IN NEW EVEREST BID I page 361


blast explosion; criticise violently
BLAST A T PALACE PM BLASTS EC
blaze fire
SIX DIE IN HOTEL BLAZE
block stop, delay
TORIES BLOCK TEACHERS ' PAY DEAL
blow bad news; discouragement; unfortunate happening
SMITH ILL: BLOW TO WORLD CUP HOPES
bolster give support/encouragement to
EXPORT FIGURES BOLSTER CITY CONFIDENCE
bond political / business association
INDIA CUTS TRADE BONDS WITH PAKISTAN
boom big increase; prosperous period
SPENDING BOOM OVER, SAYS MINISTER
boost encourage(ment); to increase; an increase
GOVERNMENT PLAN TO BOOST EXPORTS
BR British Rail
BR CLAIMS 50% OF TRAINS ON TIME
brink edge (of disaster)
WORLD ON BBINK OF WAR
call (for) demand/appeal (for)
CALL FOR STRIKE TALKS HOSPITAL ROW: MP CALLS FOR ENQUIRY
campaign organised effort to achieve social or political result
MP LA UNCHBS CAMPAIGN FOR PRISON REFORM
cash money
MORE CASH NEEDED FOR SCHOOLS
charge accusation (by police)
THREE MEN HELD ON BOMB CHARGE
chop abolition, closure
300 BANK BRANCHES FACE CHOP
City London's financial institutions
NEW TRADE FIGURES PLEASE CITY
claim (make) a statement that something is true (especially when there may be disagreement); pay claim
demand for higher wages
SCIENTIST CLAIMS CANCER BREAKTHROUGH RACISM CLAIM IN NAVY TEACHERS ' PA Y CLAIM
REJECTED
clamp down on deal firmly with (usually something illegal)
POLICE TO CLAMP DOWN ON SPEEDING
clash quarrel, fight (noun or verb)
STUDENTS CLASH WITH POLICE
clear find innocent
DOCTOR CLEARED OF DRUGS CHARGE
Commons the House of Commons (in Parliament)
MINISTERS IN COMMONS CLASH OVER HOUSING
con swindle ,
TEENAGERS CON WIDOW OUT OF LIFE SA VINGS
,362
f"
rackdown firm application of the law
0 GOVERNMENT PROMISES CRACKDOWN ON DRUGS DEALERS
crash financial failure
pANK CRASH THREATENS TO BRING DOWN GOVERNMENT
curb restrict; restriction
f^EW PRICE CURBS
cut reduce; reduction
BRITAIN CUTS OVERSEAS AID NEW HEALTH SERVICE CUTS
cutback reduction (usually financial)
TEACHERS SLAM SCHOOL CUTBACKS
dash (make) quick journey
PM IN DASH TO BLAST HOSPITAL
deadlock disagreement that cannot be solved
DEADLOCK IN PEACE TALKS
deal agreement, bargain
TEACHERS REJECT NEW PAY DEAL '
demo demonstration
30 ARRESTED IN ANTI-TAX DEMO
dole unemployment pay
DOLE QUEUES LENGTHEN
drama dramatic event; tense situation
PRINCE IN AIRPORT DRAMA
drive united effort
DRIVE TO SAVE WATER
drop give up, get rid of; fall (noun)
GOVERNMENT TO DROP CHILD LABOUR PLAN BIG DROP IN IND USTRIAL INVESTMENT
due expected to arrive
QUEEN DUE IN BERLIN TODAY
EC The European Community
EC TRADE MINISTERS TO MEET
edge move gradually
WORLD EDGES TOWARDS WAR
envoy ambassador
FRENCH ENVOY DISAPPEARS
face be threatened by
HOSPITALS FACE MORE CUTS STRIKERS FACE SACK
feud long-lasting quarrel or dispute
fAMlLYFEUD EXPLODES INTO VIOLENCE: SIX HELD
""d something that is found
BEACH FIND MAYBE BONES OF UNKNOWN DINOSAUR
m ^termined not to change
PM FIRM ON TAX LEVELS
ak "Gavy criticism
'GOVERNMENT FACES FLAK OVER VAT
"are begin violendy
ftro TS FLARE IN ULS TER


_,-- -~'llJ"-I"cTWELVE-YEAR-OLD FOILS BANK RAIDBRS
fraud swindle, deceit
JAIL FOR TICKET FRA UD MEN
freeze keep (ing) prices etc at their present level; block(ing) a bank ace
MINIS TES WANTS TWO - YEAR PA Y FREEZE unt DRUG PROFITS FROZEN
gag censor(ship), prevent(ion) from speaking
AFRICAN PRESIDENT ACTS TO GAG PRESS
gaol older British spelling for jail gems jewels
L2M GEMS STOLEN
go resign; be lost, disappear PMTOGO?
4,000 JOBS TO GO IN NORTH
go for be sold for
PICASSO DRAWING GOES FOR L5M
go-ahead approval
SCOTTISH ROAD PLAN GETS GO-AHEAD
grab take violently
GERMANS GRAB SHARES IN BRITISH COMPANIES
grip control; hold tightly
REBELS TIGHTEN GRIP ON SOUTH COLD WAVE GRIPS COUNTRY
gun down shoot
TERRORISTS GUN DOWN PRIEST
hail welcome, praise
PM HAILS PEACE PLAN
halt stop
CAR PLANT TO HALT PRODUCTION
haul amount stolen in robbery, or seized by police or customs
TRAIN ROBBER Y: BIG GOLD HAUL RECORD DRUGS HAUL AT AIRPORT
head lead; leader
PM TO HEAD TRADE MISSION COMMONWEALTH HEADS TO MEET IN OTTAWA
head for move towards
ECONOMY HEADING FOR DISASTER, EXPERTS WARN
hike (US) rise in costs, prices etc
INTEREST HIKE WILL HIT BUSINESS
hit affect badly
SNOWSTORMS HIT TRANSPORT
hit out at attack (with words)
PM HITS OUT AT CRITICS
hitch problem that causes delay
LAST-MINUTE HITCH DELAYS SATELLITE LAUNCH
hold arrest; keep under arrest
POLICE HOLD TERROR SUSPECT '". MAN HELD AFTER STATION BLAST
^ee 364
newspaper headlines 366 in (the) red in debt; making a financial loss
BRITISH STEEL IN RED
IRA Irish Republican Army
IRA LEADER MAKES STATEMENT
jail prison
fAIL FOR PEACE MARCHERS
jobless unemployed (people)
THREE MILLION JOBLESS BY APRIL?
key important, vital
KEY WITNESS VANISHES
landslide victory by large majority in election
LANDSLIDE FOR SCOTTISH NATIONALISTS
lash criticise violently
BISHOP LASHES TV SEX AND VIOLENCE
launch send (satellite etc) into space; begin (campaign etc); put (new product) on market
SPACE TELESCOPE LAUNCH DELAYED
ENVIRONMENT MINISTER LAUNCHES CAMPAIGN FOR CLEANER BEACHES
BRITISH FIRM LAUNCHES THROW-AWAY CHAIRS
lead clue (in police enquiry)
NEW LEAD IN PHONEBOX MURDER CASE
leak unofficial publication of secret information
PM FURIOUS OVER TAX PLAN LEAKS
leap big increase
LEAP IN IMPORTS
life imprisonment 'for life'
LIFE FOR AXE MURDERER
link connection, contact
NEW TRADE LINKS WITH PERU
loom threaten to happen
VAT ON FOOD: NEW ROW LOOMS
Lords the House of Lords (in Parliament)
LORDS VOTE ON DOG REGISTRATION
mar spoil
CROWD VIOLENCE MARS CUP FINAL
mercy intended to save lives
DOCTOR IN MERCY DASH TO EVEREST
mission delegation (official group sent to conference etc)
SHO TS FIRED AT UN MISSION
"lob angry crowd; organised crime / Mafia (US)
MOBS RAMPAGE THROUGH CITY STREETS MOB LEADERS HELD
"•ove step towards a particular result (often political)
MOVE TO BOOST TRADE LINKS WITH JAPAN
WP Member of Parliament
MP DENIES DR UGS CHARGE


newspaper Headlines ,
°l>6
nail force somebody to admit the truth
MP NAILS MINISTER ON PIT CLOSURE PLANS
net win, capture
TWO SISTERS NET L3M IN POOLS WIN
odds chances, probability
JONES RE-ELECTED AGAINST THE ODDS
on about, on the subject of, concerning
NEW MOVE ON PENSIONS
opt (for) choose
WALES OPTS FOR INDEPENDENCE
oust drive out, replace
MODERATES OUSTED IN UNION ELECTIONS
out to intending to ,
SCOTS NATIONALISTS OUT TO CAPTURE MASS VOTE
over about, on the subject of, because of
ROW OVER AID CUTS
pact agreement
DEFENCE PACT RUNS INTO TROUBLE
pay wages
TRANSPOR T PAY TALKS BREAK DOWN
PC police constable
PC SHOT IN BANK RAID
peak high point
BANK LENDING HITS NEW PEAK
peer lord; Member of the House of Lords
PEERS REJECT GOVERNMENT WAGE-FREEZE PLAN
peg hold (prices etc) at present level
BANKS PEG INTEREST RATES
peril danger
FLOOD PESIL IN THAMES VALLEY
pit coalmine
THREAT OF MORE PIT CLOSURES
plant factory
STEEL PLANT BLAZE
plea call for help
BIG RESPONSE TO PLEA FOR FLOOD AID
pledge promise
GOVERNMENT GIVES PLEDGE ON JOBLESS
PM Prime Minister
EGG THROWN AT PM
poll election; public opinion survey
TORIES AHEAD IN POLLS , yf
pools football pools: a form of gambling in which people guess the res football matches
SISTERS SHARE BIG POOLS WIN
premier head of government
GREEK PREMIER TO VISIT UK
press the newspapers :
BID TO GAG PRESS OVER DEFENCE SPENDING
page
366

nress (for) urge) encourage• ask for urgently
MINISTER PRESSED TO ACT ON HOUSING OPPOSITION PRESS FOR ENQUIRY ON AIR CRASHES
orobe investigation; investigate
CALL FOR STUDENT DRUGS PROBE POLICE PROBE RACING SCANDAL
null out withdraw; pull-out withdrawal
US PULLS OUT OF ARMS TALKS CHURCH CALLS FOR BRITISH PULL-OUT FROM ULSTER
push (for) ask for, encourage
SCHOOLS PUSH FOR MORE CASH
quake earthquake
HOUSES DAMAGED IN WELSH QUAKE
quit resign, leave
CHURCH LEADER QUITS MINISTER TO QUIT GOVERNMENT
quiz question (verb)
POLICE QUIZ MILLIONAIRE SUPERMARKET BOSS
raid enter and search; attack (noun and verb), rob, robbery
POLICE RAID DUCHESS 'S FLAT BIG GEMS RAID
rampage riot
FOOTBALL FANS RAMPAGE THROUGH SEASIDE TOWNS
rap criticise
DOCTORS RAP NEW MINISTRY PLANS
record bigger than ever before
RECORD LOSS BY INSURANCE FIRM
riddle mystery
MISSING ENVOY RIDDLE: WOMAN HELD
rift division, disagreement
LABOUR RIFT OVER DEFENCE POLICY
rock shock, shake
BANK SEX SCANDAL ROCKS CITY IRELAND ROCKED BY QUAKE
row noisy disagreement, quarrel
NEW ROW OVER PENSION CUTS
rule out reject the possibility of
PM RULES OUT AUTUMN ELECTION
aack dismiss(al) from job
STRIKING POSTMEN FACE SACK
^ga long-running news story
NEW REVELATIONS IN BANK SEX SAGA
scare public alarm, alarming rumour
TYPHOID SCARE IN SOUTHWEST
^rap throw out (as useless)
f^OVERNMENT SCRAPS NEW ROAD PLANS
^ek look for
POLICE SEEK WITNESS TO KILLING


newspaper Headlines ^
seize take (especially in police and customs searches)
POLICE SEIZE ARMS AFTER CAR CHASE L3M DRUGS SEIZED AT AIRPORT
set to ready to; about to
INTEREST RATES SET TO RISE
shed get rid of
BRITISH RAIL TO SHED 5,000 JOBS
slam criticise violently
BISHOP SLAMS DEFENCE POLICY
slash cut, reduce drastically
GOVERNMENT TO SLASH HEALTH EXPENDITURE
slate criticise
PM SLATES BISHOP
slay (US) murder
FREEWAY KILLER SLAYS SIX
slump fall (economic)
EXPORTS SLUMP CITY FEARS NEW SLUMP
snatch rob, robbery
BIG WA GES SNA TCH IN WEST END
soar rise dramatically
IMPORTS SOAR FOR THIRD MONTH
spark cause to start
REFEREE 'S DECISION SPARKS RIOT
split disagree (merit)
CABINET SPLIT ON PRICES POLICY
spree wild spending expedition
BUS DRIVER SPENDS L30,000 IN THREE-DAY CREDIT CARD SPREE
stake financial interest
JAPANESE BUY STAKE IN BRITISH AIRWAYS
storm angry public disagreement
STORM OVER NEW STRIKE LAW
storm out of leave angrily
TEACHERS ' LEADERS STORM OUT OF MEETING
stun surprise, shock
JOBLESS FIGURES STUN CITY
surge sudden increase; rise suddenly
SURGE IN JOBLESS FIGURES
swap exchange
HEART SWAP BOY BETTER
sway persuade
HOSPITAL PROTEST SWAYS MINISTERS
switch to change; a change
DEFENCE POLICY SWITCH
swoop to raid; a police raid
POLICE IN DA WN SWOOP ON DRUGS GANG
threat danger
TEACHERS ' STRIKE THREAT
toll number killed
QUAKE TOLL MAYBE 5,000
,368
top (adJ^ senior, most important
TOP BANKER KIDNAPPED
top (verb) exceed
IMPORTS TOP LAST YEAR 'S FIGURES
Tory Conservative
VICTORY FOR TORY MODERATES
trio three people
JAILBREAK TRIO RECAPTURED
troops soldiers
MORE TROOPS FOR BORDER AREA
UK The United Kingdom (of Great Britain and Northern Ireland)
EC CRITICISES UK JAIL CONDITIONS
Ulster Northern Ireland
PM IN SECRET TRIP TO ULSTES
UN The United Nations
UN IN RED: CANNOT BALANCE BUDGET
urge encourage
GOVERNMENT URGED TO ACT ON POLLUTION
US The United States of America
US URGED TO PULL OUT OF ARMS DEAL
VAT value added tax
NEXT, VAT ON BABYFOOD?
vow promise
EXILED PRESIDENT VOWS TO RETURN
walk out leave in protest
CAR WORKERS WALK OUT OVER WAGE FREEZE
wed marry
BISHOP TO WED ACTRESS
367 next and the next
1 next
Next week, next month etc is the week or month just after this one. If I am speaking in July, next month is
August; if I am speaking in the year 2006, next year is 2007.
Goodbye - see yo u next week. (NOT ... sec you the next week.) I'm spending next Christmas with my
family.
(for -I'm spending the next Christmas...) Nextyear will be difficult, (the year starting next January)
•^positions are not generally used before these time expressions.
2 ^xt Sunday etc
n ne^ is used with the names of days or months, it is not always clear exactly what is meant.
fie you next Sunday.' 'Do you mean this coming Sunday or the one after?' e closer the day/ month referred
to, the more likely people are to Grstand next as meaning 'the one in next week/year'; the further away it
page 369


• "'u none
is, the more likely they are to interpret next as meaning 'the one in rh-week/year'; the dividing line (where
confusion is greatest) is prob hi18
somewhere about three days/months before the time referred to R ^ everybody uses next in exactly the
same way in this situation. To av111)"01 misunderstanding, one can say for example (1) on Sunday, this
Sundn the/this Sunday coming, the/this coming Sunday or (on) Sunday th' y' and (2) on Sunday week, a
week on Sunday or (on) Sunday next wee5^^
3 the next
One meaning of the next is 'counting forward from this moment' Th week, the next month etc can mean
the period of seven days, thirty da next starting at the moment of speaking. On July 15th, 1992, the
nextmontri\^
period from July 15th to August 15th; the next-year is the period from July 1992 to July 1993. '
I'm going to be very busy for the next week. (= the seven days starting today)
The next year will be difficult. (= the twelve months starting now} Note the word order in the next six weeks
etc. When there is no number we generally say the next few days, not the next days.
I'll be at college for the next three years. (NOT , the three ncxtycuih.} The next few days are going to be
wet.
(NOT The next days are going to be wet:)
For other uses of the next, and the difference between the next and the nearest, see 356. For last and the
last, see 307.
368 no and none
1 the difference
We use no (= 'not a', 'not any') immediately before a singular or plural noun. No aeroplane is 100% safe. ,
We've got no plans for the summer. There is no time to talk about it now.
Before a determiner (e.g. the, my, this} we use none of. We also use none of before a pronoun.
None of the keys would open the door.
None of my brothers remembered my birthday.
None of this cheese is any good. • • •'
None of it is worth keeping.
None of us speaks French.
When we use none of with a plural noun or pronoun, the verb can be singular (more formal) or plural
(more informal).
None of my friends is interested, (formal)
None of my friends are interested, (informal)
2 none without a noun
We can use none alone, without a noun, if the meaning is clear from comes before.
'How many of the books have you read?' 'None.'
not used to talk about two
•^w r,f nnt nnnc of. to
JHH. *---
We use neither of, not none of, to talk about two people or things. Neither of my parents could be there.
(NOT None of my parents-...)
pnr the difference between no/none and not a/any, see 369.
For no and not, see 375.
For none and no one, see 373.
For no as a modifying adverb (e.g. no better), see 56.
For more information about neither, see 363.
169 no/none and not a/any
page
370
1 emphatic
No can be used instead of not a or not any when we want to emphasise the
negative idea.
Would you believe it? There's no wardrobe in the bedroom!,
(More emphatic than... There isn't a wardrobe...) Sorry I can't stop. I've got no time.
(More emphatic than... I haven't got any time.) There were no letters for you this morning, I'm afraid.
(More emphatic than There weren't any letters...) None of can be used instead of not any of. She's done
none of the work I told her to do.
(More emphatic than She hasn't done any...) After no, countable nouns are usually plural unless the sense
makes a singular noun necessary. Compare:
He's got no children. (More natural than He's got no child.) He's got no wife. (More normal than He's got
no wives.) We prefer not a/any in objects and complements when the sense is not emphatic. Compare:
He's no fool. (= He's not a fool at all. - emphatic negative) A spider is not an insect.
(NOT -A spider is no insect - the sense is not emphatic.)
2 subjects
Not any cannot normally be used with subjects. No and none o/are used
instead.
No brand of cigarette is completely harmless. (NOT Not any brand...) No tourists ever came to our village.
(NOT Not any tourists...) None of my friends lives near me. (NOT Not any of my friends...)
3 nobody etc
nobody, nothing, no one and nowhere are used in similar ways to no. Isawnobody. (More emphatic than I
didn't see anybody.) Nobody spoke. (NOT Not anybody spoke.)
01 ttle aifference between no and none, see 368.
°r more about the difference between no and not, see 375.
°r more about no one, see 373.
ot more about any, see 54.
, page 371


370
no doubt
' K'f •
HA Vt- VWIWCT- I
No doubt is often used to mean 'probably' or "I suppose'.
No doubt it'll rain soon.
You're tired, no doubt. I'll make you a cup of tea. No doubt is not used alone to say that something is
certain. Possiblp expressions are there is no doubt that (formal), without any doubt (fn certainly, definitely.
nnal)'
There is no doubt that the world is getting warmer. (NOT No doubt the world is getting warmer.)
Cycling is certainly healthier than driving.
(NOT No doubt cycling is healthier than driving.) Note that doubtless is similar to no doubt (but more
formal), while undoubtedly is similar to there is no doubt that.
For structures with the verb doubt, see 167.
71 no matter
1 conjunction
No matter can be used with who, whose, what, which, where, when and how. These expressions are
conjunctions, used to join clauses together. The meaning is similar to 'it doesn't matter who/what/etc'.
I'll love you no matter what you do.
No matter where you go, I'll follow you, Note the use of a present tense with a future meaning after no
matter (see 556).
No matter who telephones, say I'm out.
No matter where you go, you'll find Coca-Cola.
You'll be welcome no matter when you come.
2 no matter who etc and whoever etc
The conjunctions no matter who/what etc are used rather like whoever, whatever etc (see 596). Compare:
- No matter whatyou say, I won't believeyou. Whatever you say, I won't believe you.
- Phone me when you arrive, no matter how late it is.
Phone me when you arrive, however late it is. , However, clauses with whoever, whatever and whichever
can be used as subjects or objects of other clauses. Clauses with no matter wholwhatlui cannot be used in
this way.
I'll believe whatever you say.
(BUT NOT I'll believe no matter whatyou say.)
3 use without a verb
Sometimes no matter who/what etc can be used at the end of a clau without a following verb. ^ I'll always
love you, no matter what. (=.,. no matter what happr
no matter and it doesn't matter
it doesn't matter is not a conjunction, and can be used to introduce a
ntence that has only one clause. No matter cannot be used in this way. s n doesn't matter what you think.
(BUT NOT -No matter whatyou think.) Note that the verb matter is not used in progressive forms (see
451). Your opinions don't matter. (NOT Your opinions aren't mattering.)
c r more about the use of preparatory it (as in It doesn't matter what...), see 301-302.
372 no more, not any more, no longer, not any longer
We use no more with nouns, to talk about quantity or degree - to say
how much.
There's no more bread. She's no more a great singer than lam. We do not use no more in standard
modern English as an adverb to express the idea of actions and situations stopping. Instead, we use no
longer (usually before the verb), not... any longer or not... any more (informal).
I no longer support the Conservative party. (NOT I no more support...)
This can't goon any longer. Annie doesn't live here any more. Anymore may be written as one word,
especially in American English.
She felt that he did not love her anymore.
373 no one and none
1 no one
No one (also written no-one in British English) means the same as nobody. It cannot be followed by of.
No one wished me a happy birthday. (NOT No one of my friends...)
I stayed in all evening waiting, but no one came.
2 none
To express the idea 'not a single one (of)', we can use none (of), not any (of) or not one (of) (more
emphatic). No one is not used in this way.
None of my friends wished me a happy birthday.
I haven't read any of his books.
Not one of my shirts is clean. (NOT JVo one of my shirts...)
'Have you found any blackberries?' 'Not one.'
For more about none, see 368.
374
page
372
^n- assertive words
"hat are assertive and non-assertive words?
"ere are some words that are used mainly in affirmative sentences. samples are some (and somebody,
someone, something and somewhere), nce, sometimes and already. These are called 'assertive', because
they
page 373


""mnuno 371.
are mainly used when we assert - that is, when we say that something is true. In questions and negatives
we more often use other words like anv anybody etc, ever and yet. These are not generally used when we
assert ' things, and are called 'non-assertive'. Compare:
- Somebody telephoned, (assertive)
Did anybody telephone? (non-assertive)
- I've bought you something, (assertive)
I haven't bought you anything, (non-assertive)
- I met the Prime Minister once. (assertive)
Have you ever met the Prime Minister? (non-assertive)
- I sometimes go to the theatre, (assertive) Do you ever go to the theatre? (non-assertive)
- She's already here. (assertive) Is she here yet? (non-assertive)
2 Where are they used?
Non-assertive words are used in questions and negative sentences, in if-clauses, in comparisons, and
together with adverbs, verbs, prepositions adjectives and determiners that have a negative kind of
meaning.
Let me know if you have any trouble.
I wonder if she found anything.
She writes better than anybody I know.
He seldom says anything.
I've hardly been anywhere since Christmas.
He denied that he had ever seen her.
Please forget that I ever told you anything about it.
I'd rather do it without anybody's help.
It's difficult to understand anything he says.
Few people have ever seen her laugh.
assertive words in questions etc
Assertive words can be used in questions, ;y-clauses etc in order to give a more positive feeling to a
sentence.
Did you say something? (Suggests 'I think you said something'.)
Would you like some more chips? (invitation to have some more)
If you've already finished, let's go. (The person seems to have finished.)
For information about particular non-assertive words, see the entries for the words in question.
For assertive uses of my, see 54
375 not and no
To make a word, expression or clause negative, we use not.
Not surprisingly, we missed the train. (NOT No surprisingly-- • •) The students went on strike, but not the
teachers.
(NOT ... but no the teachers.} lean see you tomorrow, but not on Thursday. I have not received his
answer.
11UI-111 ^Ulllyl/tlll/11 td L1U1X V •
We can use no with a noun or -ing form to mean 'not any', or 'not a/an'. No teachers went on strike. (=
There weren't any teachers on strike.) I've got no Thursdays free this term. (= I haven't got any
Thursdays...) I telephoned, but there was no answer. (= There wasn't an answer.)
NO SMOKING
Sometimes sentences constructed with verb + not and no + noun have similar meanings. The structure
with no is usually more emphatic.
There wasn't an answer. I There was no answer.
For no.. .ing, see 292.3. For more information about no, see 368.
376 not only
3
page
374
In the rather formal structure not only... but also, not only and but also can go immediately before the
words or expressions that they modify.
We go there not only in winter, but also in summer.
Not only the bathroom was flooded, but also the rest of the house.
The place was not only cold, but also damp. Mid-position with the verb (see 15) is also possible. In this
case, not only is generally used without do.
She not only sings like an angel, but also dances divinely.
She not only plays the piano, but also the violin. Not only can be moved to the beginning of a clause for
emphasis. It is then followed by auxiliary verb + subject; do is used if there is no other auxiliary (for more
about this word order, see 298). But can be left out in this case.
Not only has she been late three times; she has also done no work.
Not only do they need clothing, but they are also short of water. Note that in informal English not only...
but also is not very common; other structures are generally preferred.
We don't only go there in winter. We go in summer too.
377 noun complementation
Many nouns, especially abstract nouns, can be followed by 'complements' -other words and expressions
that 'complete' their meaning. These complements can be prepositional phrases, infinitive expressions or
clauses (with or without prepositions).
Alan's criticism of the plan made him very unpopular.
I hate the thought of leaving you.
Does she understand the need to keep everything secret?
I admire your belief that you are always right.
There's still the question of whether we're going to pay her. Many nouns can be followed by more than
one kind of complement.
He didn't give any reason for the changes.
You've no reason to get angry.
The main reason why I don't believe her is this. Not all nouns can be followed by all kinds of complement.
the idea of marriage
the idea that I might get married
BUT NOT -the-idca to get married > page 375


TW> nuuii muuiners 370
- freedom to choose
freedom of choice
BUT NOT -freedom of choosing Note that a related noun and verb may have different kinds of commie
I have no intention of resigning. ent-
I do not intend to resign.
To find out what complement structures are possible with a particula it is necessary to consult a good
dictionary. oua'
For complementation in general, see 140.
For more information about -ing forms after nouns, see 294.
For infinitives after nouns, see 286.
for should in clauses after nouns, see 497.
For subjunctives in clauses after nouns, see 541.
For the prepositions that are used after some common nouns, see 437.
For prepositions before clauses, see 441.
For structures with preparatory it (e.g. It's a pity that we can't see him), see 301-302
378 noun modifiers
It is common in English to use nouns in a similar way to adjectives, to modify other nouns. Noun modifiers
are especially common in attributive position (before other nouns); for details of this structure, see 379.
We need some new garden chairs.
That shoe shop's closed down.
He's a Birmingham man.
Some nouns can also be used as modifiers in predicative position (after be and sometimes after other
copular verbs). This happens especially with nouns which refer to material or origin.
It's not leather, you know; it's plastic.
He doesn't sound Birmingham; I think he's Liverpool. Noun modifiers can be modified themselves.
That sports shoe shop's closed down.
It's not real leather, you know.
My family were all working class.
379 nouns in groups (1): introduction and general rules
1 three structures
There are three main ways in which we can put nouns together so that one modifies another.
a noun + noun
a bicycle factory
b
a war film the table leg coffee beans
noun + s+ noun
my sister's car a bird's nest cow's milk the prisoner's complaint
.376
a man from Birmingham a book on modem music
noun + preposition + noun
the top of the page a feeling of disappointment
choice of structures
A particular idea is normally expressed in only one of these ways, though sometimes there are two
possibilities.
a table leg (NOT a table's log or a leg of a table)
cow's milk (NOT cow milk or milk of a cow)
the top of the page (NOT the pagc('s) top)
the earth's gravity OR the gravity of the earth (NOT the earth gravity)
a Birmingham man OR a man from Birmingham
(NOT a Birmingham's-maft)
Unfortunately the exact differences between the three structures are complicated and difficult to analyse -
this is one of the most difficult areas of English grammar. The following paragraphs give general
information about the three structures; sections 380-382 give more details and some information about the
differences. Note that the 'rules' given in these sections only describe tendencies, and there are quite a
number of exceptions. In order to be certain which structure is used to express a particular idea, it is
necessary to consult a good dictionary.
noun + noun
In the noun + noun structure, the first noun modifies or describes the
second, a little like an adjective.
a horse race (a kind of race) milk chocolate (a kind of chocolate) a race horse (a kind of horse) chocolate
milk (a kind of milk)
a book case (a kind of case)
mineral water (a kind of water)
Noun + noun expressions can often be changed into structures where the second noun becomes a
subject and the first an object.
an oil well (= a well that produces oil)
a sheepdog (= a dog that looks after sheep)
a Birmingham man (= a man who comes from Birmingham)
the airport bus (= the bus that goes to the airport) Note that the first noun is usually singular in form, even
if it has a plural meaning. (For exceptions, see 508.)
a shoe shop (= a shop that sells shoes) a horse race (= a race for horses)
a toothbrush (= a brush for teeth) trouser pockets (= pockets in trousers)
a ticket office (= an office that sells tickets) Articles belonging to the first (modifying) noun are dropped in
noun + noun combinations. Compare:
Officers in the army are well paid.
Anny officers are well paid. (NOT The army officers are well paid.) "•ore than two nouns can be put
together. A group of two nouns can modify a third noun, these can modify a fourth, and so on.
oil production costs road accident research centre "is kind of structure is very common in newspaper
headlines (see 366) "ccause it saves space.
{!UItN'TURE FACTORY PAY CUT ROW '>
page 377


-,-,---t-""'-~~~"^~-~B-"<.;IOIrules 37q
4 noun + *s + noun
In the noun + 's + noun structure, too, the first noun modifies or ripe •.-
the second. • • ' ^cnbes
my mother's car (a particular car) a child's bicycle (a kind of h • These expressions often correspond to
structures in which the first no^0101 subject and the second is a verb or object (the opposite of the noun . un
ls a structure), -'-noun
my mother's car (my mother has a car)
the committee's report (the committee made a report)
a child's bicycle (a child rides this kind of bicycle)
goat's milk (goats give this kind of milk)
the train's arrival (the train arrived)
For more information about the grammar of possessive 's structures, see 432.
5 noun + preposition + noun
Sometimes the noun + noun or the noun + 's + noun structure is not possible, and it is necessary to use a
structure with of or another preposition
a feeling of disappointment (NOT a disappointmcnt('s) feeling)
letters from home (NOT homc('s) letters)
6 pronunciation
Most noun + noun combinations have the main stress on the first noun.
a'bicycle factory 'coffee beans a'fruit drink 'ski boots However, there are quite a number of exceptions.
a garden'chair afruit'pie
The difference between noun modifiers and adjectival modifiers is sometimes shown by stress. Compare:
a 'French teacher (noun modifier: a person who teaches French)
a French 'teacher (adjective modifier: a teacher who is French) Noun + 's + noun combinations have the
main stress on the first noun mostly in classifying expressions (see 380), which name a certain kind of
thing. Compare:
- a 'doll's house (a kind of house)
my brother's 'house (not a kind of house)
- 'goat's milk (a kind of milk)
the goat's' tail (not a kind of tail) Here, too, there are exceptions.
a child's 'bicycle (a kind of bicycle)
To be sure of the stress on a particular combination, it is necessary to chec in a good dictionary.
For the stressing of road and street names, see 485.
7 spelling
Some short, common noun + noun combinations are generally written
together like single words.
bathroom lampshade seaside BUT NOT -Failwenysta^eit Others may be written with a hyphen (e.g. girl-
friend) or separately {e'0' ^ furniture shop). In many cases usage varies, and some combinations
''ymouris mgruupa UJ:UIC- ssLim-iuicaiiu incur simcx-ore
found written in all three ways (e.g. skiboots, ski-boots or ski boots;
headmaster, head-master or head master). Hyphens are becoming less ominon in modem English, and
(except with very common short ombinations like bathroom) it is usually acceptable to write the two words
c narately. For information about the spelling of particular combinations,
see a good dictionary.
g0 nouns in groups (2): classifying expressions
1 noun + noun
The noun + noun structure is mostly used to make 'classifying' expressions, which name a particular kind
of thing.
a sheep dog (a particular kind of dog)
mountain plants (a special group of plants)
mineral water (a sort of water)
We use the noun + noun structure especially to talk about things that belong to common well-known
classes (so that the two nouns really describe a single idea). In other cases we prefer a preposition
structure. Compare:
the postman, the milkman, the insurance man (all well-known kinds of people who may call regularly at a
British home)
a man from the health department (not a regular kind of visitor) More examples:
- He was reading a history book. (a common class of book) He was reading a book about the moon. (NOT
a moon-beek)
- She was sitting at a comer table in the restaurant.
(Restaurants often have corner tables.) Who's the girl in the comer? (NOT -Who's the comer girl?) What
does that road sign say?
page
37S
She was showing signs of tiredness. (NOT ... tiredness signs.)
2 noun + 's + noun
The 's structure is also used with a classifying meaning in certain expressions. These expressions usually
refer to something that is used by or produced by or from a person or animal; the first noun refers to the
person or animal. Generally, either both nouns are singular or both are plural. a child's toy children's
clothes a man's sweater a pair of women's jeans cow's milk birds'nests ' ;
BUT a women's magazine See 382.3-4 for more details.
81 nouns in groups (3): the *s structure and the of structure
1 meanings of the 's structure
e can use the possessive 's to talk about several different sorts of ideas; for Sample possession,
relationship, physical features and characteristics, ^"'Physical qualities and measurement. The's structure
often corresponds
page 379


, ^^-^,- HUU115 ut gluups w. special cases ano
to a sentence in which the first noun becomes the subject of have n other verb. "i-sorne
That's my father's house. (My father has that house.) Mary's brother is a lawyer. (Mary has a brother who
is a lawyer ) Pete's eyes are like yours. (Pete has eyes like yours.) the plan's importance (the importance
that the plan has) I didn 't believe the girl's story. (The girl told a story.) Have you read John's letter? (John
wrote a letter.) the government's decision (The Government made a decision) the train's arrival (The train
arrived.) In some cases, the first noun may correspond to the object of a verb the prisoner's release
(Somebody released the prisoner.)
2 possessive's and of
We express these ideas with the possessive 's structure most often when th first noun refers to a person
or animal, or to a country, organisation or oth group of living creatures, especially if the relationship
between the two nouns could be expressed with have.
my father's name (NOT the name of my father)
Ann's back (NOT the back of Ann)
a bird's nest (NOT a nest of a bird)
America's gold reserves In other cases, we more often use a structure with of.
the name of the street (NOT the street's name)
the back of the room (NOT the room'shock) Sometimes both structures are possible.
the earth's gravity o R the gravity of the earth
the Queen's arrival OR the arrival of the Queen
the plan's importance OR the importance of the plan
Algeria's history OR the history of Algeria
the concerto's final movement o R the final movement of the concerto In place names like Cologne
Cathedral or Birmingham Airport, the noun + noun structure is normal. (For the in place names, see
69.18.)
For the use of the 's structure in expressions of time, see 382.8. For details of the grammar of the
possessive's structure, see 432.
382 nouns in groups (4): special cases
1 parts
We use the 's structure to talk about parts of people's and animals' bodies.
a man's leg an elephant's trunk a sheep's heart But to talk about parts of non-living things, we usually use
the noun + "° structure or the of structure.
a table leg (NOT a table's leg)
the car door (NOT the car's door)
the roof of a house
page
380
With words like top, bottom, front, back, side, edge, inside, outside, beginning, middle, end, part, we
usually prefer the of structure.
the top of the page (NOT the page top)
the back of the bus (.NOT the bus back}
the bottom of the glass (NOT -the glass bottom)
the end of the film
There are a number of common exceptions - for example the water s edge, the seaside, the roadside, a
mountain top.
2 units, selections and coUections
We also prefer the of structure with words that refer to units, selections and collections, like piece, slice,
lump (of sugar), bunch (of flowers), blade (of grass), pack (of cards), herd, flock, group and so on.
a piece of paper (NOT a paper piece)
a bunch of flowers (NOT a flower bunch)
3 'used by'
The 's structure can refer to something that is used by a person or animal: the first noun refers to the user.
children's clothes women's magazines a bird's nest There are some exceptions.
baby clothes a birdcage British and American usage sometimes differ. Compare:
a baby's bottle (GB) a doll's house (GB) a baby's pram (GB)
a baby bottle (US) a doll house (US) a baby carriage (US)
4 'produced by/from'
The's structure is often used for products from living animals.
cow's milk lamb's wool sheep's wool
a bird's egg a hen's egg
BUT camel hair, horsehair
When the animal is killed to provide something, we usually use noun + noun.
calfskin chamois leather fox fur
chicken soup a lamb chop tortoise shell
5 containers
The noun + noun structure is used for particular kinds of container.
a matchbox a paint tin a coffee cup But we use the of structure to talk about a container together with its
contents.
a box of'matches a tin of paint a cup of coffee
6 'made of
The noun + noun structure is normally used to say what things are made of.
a silk dress a stone bridge an iron rod a gold ring n older English, the of structure was more common in
this case (e.g. a dress °fsilk, a bridge of stone), and it is still used in some metaphorical cessions. •
page 381


He rules his family with a rod of iron.
The flowers were like a carpet of gold.
A few pairs of nouns and adjectives (e.g. gold, golden} are used as modifip with different meanings.
Generally the noun simply names the material rs something is made of, while the adjective has a more
metaphorical mean'
a gold watch -golden memories T\^-
silk stockings-silken skin
a lead pipe-a leaden sky (grey and depressing)
a stone roof-a stony silence But wooden and woollen just mean 'made of wood/wool'.
measurement
The noun + noun structure is used in measurements, with a number before the first noun. The number is
usually joined to the first noun by a hyphen (-) Note that the first noun is normally singular in form in these
cases.
a five-litre can a ten-pound note
(NOT a five litres can, a ten-pounds note)
a six-pound chicken a three-mile walk a five-day course
a two-person tent ten two-hour lessons The number one is often left out.
a pint mug In fractions, the plural -s is not dropped.
a two-thirds share (NOT a two-third share) Note the use of the 's structure before worth.
a pound's worth of walnuts
three dollars' worth of popcorn
measurement of time
The 's structure (or the plural with s') is often used to say how long things last.
a day's journey three hours'journey twenty minutes'delay The second noun's article is sometimes
included, and the apostrophe 0 is sometimes dropped, but this is not generally considered correct.
a three hours(') journey (= a journey of three hours) Noun + noun structures are also possible.
a three-hour journey a twenty-minute delay
other expressions of time
We use the noun + noun structure for the names of things that happen or appear regularly.
the evening news a Sunday paper But we prefer the 's structure to talk about particular moments and
events.
yesterday's news last Sunday's match
page
382
383 now (that)
Now (that) can be used as a conjunction. In an informal style, that is often dropped (see 560).
Now that Andrew is married, he has become much more responsible.
Now the exams are over I can enjoy myself.
For now as a discourse marker used to structure talk, see 159.8. For the use of once as a conjunction,
see 390. For conjunctions in general, see 142-143.
384 nowadays
Nowadays is an adverb meaning 'these days', 'at the present time'.
People seem to be very depressed nowadays.
Nowadays we think nothing of space travel. Nowadays cannot be used as an adjective or possessive.
I don't like modem fashions. (NOT I don't like the nowadays fashions.)
385 numbers
1 fractions and decimals
We say simple fractions like this:
Vs one eighth • 3/? three sevenths ^s two fifths :::
"/is eleven sixteenths ^4 hour three quarters of an hour '71w mile seven tenths of a mile More complex
fractions can be expressed by using the word over.
"'''/sos three hundred and seventeen over five hundred and nine We write and say decimals like this:
0.375 nought point three seven five (US zero point three...) (NOT -0,375 nought comma three seven five)
(NOT nought point throe hundred and seventy-five) 4.7 four point seven
2 singular and plural with fractions and decimals
With fractions below 1, we normally use of a + singular noun. The same structure is common with
decimals below 1.
three quarters of a ton
0.1625 cm nought point one six two five of a centimetre However, decimals below 1 can also be followed
directly by a plural noun.
nought point one six two five centimetres "actions and decimals over 1 are normally followed directly by a
plural noun.
one and a half hours (NOT one and a half hour) 1.3 millimetres (NOT 1.3 millimetre) "ote also the
structure a... and a half. fve been waiting for an hour and a half.
page 383


4
-.-....-.,^J|iir-~.a ,HJ3
Singular verbs are normally used after fractions and other expression referring to amounts (for more
details, see 504).
Three quarters of a ton is too much. (NOT -Three-efuartors -of-a-ten-m.^ 3.6 kilometres is about 2 miles. '
• ••I
3 nought, zero, nil etc
The figure 0 is usually called nought in British English, and zero in Am •
English. When we say numbers one figure at a time, 0 is often called o^?^ the letter 0). •"ke
My account number is four one three oh six.
In measurements of temperature, 0 is called zero in both British and American English. Zero is followed by
a plural noun.
Zero degrees Celsius is thirty-two degrees Fahrenheit. Zero scores in team games are called nil
(American zero or nothine) in tennis and similar games, the word love is used (originally from French
I'oeuf, meaning 'the egg' - the figure 0 is egg-shaped).
And the score at half-time is: Scotland three, England nil. Forty-love; Andrews to serve.
telephone numbers
We say each figure separately, pausing after groups of three or four (not two) When the same figure
comes twice, British people usually say double. 307 4922 three oh seven, four nine double two (US three
zero seven, four nine two two)
5 Roman numbers
Roman numbers (/, //, ///, IV etc) are not common in modern English, but they are still used in a few cases
- for example the names of kings and queens, page numbers in the introductions to some books, the
numbers of paragraphs in some documents, the numbers of questions in some
examinations, the figures on some clock faces, and occasionally the names of centuries.
It was built in the time of Henry V.
For details, see Introduction page ix.
Do question (vi) or question (vii), but not both.
a fine XVIII Century English walnut chest of drawers
The Roman numbers normally used are as follows:
1 . / ; 10 X x 40 XL xl
2 II ii 11 XI xi 45 XLV xlv
3 /// Hi 12 XII xii 50 L I
4 IV iv 13 XIII xiii 60 LX Ix
5 V v 14 XIV xiv 90 XC xc
6 VI vi 19 XIX xix 100 C c
7 VII vii 20 XX xx 500 D
8 VIII viii 21 XXI xxi 1000 M
9 IX ix 30 XXX xxx 1995 MCMXCV
page
3fl4
rardinal and ordinal numbers: books, chapters etc;
kings and queens
After a noun we usually use a cardinal number instead of an ordinal number. This structure is common in
titles. Compare:
the fourth book - Book Four
the third act-Act Three
Mozart's thirty-ninth symphony-Symphony No. 39, by Mozart
the third day of the course - Timetable for Day Three However, the names of kings and queens are said
with ordinal numbers.
Henry VIII: Henry the Eighth (NOT Henry Eight)
Louis XIV: Louis the Fourteenth
Elizabeth II: Elizabeth the Second
7 centuries
Note how the names of centuries relate to the years in them. The period from 1701 -1800 is called the
18th century (not the 17th); 1801 -1900 is the 19th century, etc.
8 floors
The ground floor of a British house is the first floor of an American house;
the British first floor is the American second floor, etc.
9 and', punctuation
In British English we always use and before the tens in a number. In American English, and can be
dropped.
310 three hundred and ten (US also three hundred ten)
5,642 five thousand, six hundred and forty-two In measurements containing two different units, and is
possible before the smaller, but is usually left out.
two hours (and) ten minutes
two metres (and) thirty centimetres
In writing we generally use commas (,) to divide large numbers into groups of three figures, by separating
off the thousands and the millions. Full stops (.) are not used in this way.
3,127 (NOT -3rW) 5,466,243
We do not always use commas in four-figure numbers, and they are not used in dates.
4,126 OR 4126
the year 1648 Spaces are also possible in British English.
There are 1,000 (OR 1000) millimetres in a metre.
10 a and one
e can say a hundred or one hundred, a thousand or one thousand, a ^llwn or one million. One is more
formal.
"wuto live for a hundred years. (NOT .. .for hundred years.) ^ay Mr ] Baron one thousand pounds, (on a
cheque) >
page 385


' """'"ers 38s
A can only be used at the beginning of a number. Compare:
a/one hundred three thousand one hundred
(NOT -three thousand a hundred)
A thousand can be used alone, and before and, but not usually befo number of hundreds. Compare: re a
a/one thousand
a/one thousand and forty-nine
one thousand, six hundred and two
(More natural than a thousand, six hundred and two.} We can use a or one with measurement words. The
rules are similar
a/one kilometre (BUT one kilometre, six hundred metres]
an/one hour and seventeen minutes (BUT one hour, seventeen minut a/one pound (BUT one pound
twenty-five}
numbers with determiners
Numbers can be used after determiners. Before determiners, a structure with of is necessary.
You're my one hope. One of my friends gave me this. (NOT One my friend...)
eleven hundred etc
In an informal style we often use eleven hundred, twelve hundred etc instead of one thousand, one
hundred etc. This is most common with round numbers between 1,100 and 1,900.
We only got fifteen hundred pounds for the car. This form is used in historical dates (see 151).
He was born in thirteen hundred.
It was built in fifteen (hundred and) twenty-nine.
billion
In American English, a billion is a thousand million. This is now generally true in British English, but a
British billion used to be a million million, and this still occasionally causes misunderstandings among
British speakers.
singular forms with plural meanings
After a number, dozen, hundred, thousand, million and billion have no final
-s, and of is not used. This also happens after several and a few. Compare.
- five hundred pounds hundreds of pounds
- several thousand times It cost thousands.
- a few million years millions of years
page
386
15
16
17
(.'neular forms are used as modifiers before nouns in plural measuring
expressions.
a five-pound note a three-mile walk
six two-hour lessons a three-month-old baby
a four-foot deep hole a six-foot tall man Tn an informal style, we often use foot instead of feet in other
structures, especially when we talk about people's heights.
My father's just over six foot two.
For the use of be in measurements, see 91. vnr the use of possessive forms in expressions of time (e.g.
ten minutes' walk; four days'
journey}, see 382.8. For of after half, see 235. For singular verbs after expressions referring to amounts
and quantities, see 504.
British money
There are 100 pence in a pound. Sums of money are named as follows:
i p onepenny (informal one p (/pi:/) OR apenny) 5 p five pence (informal ./we p) L3.75 three pounds
seventy-five (pence) o R three pounds and
seventy-five pence (more formal) Some people now use the plural pence as a singular in informal speech;
pound is sometimes used informally as a plural. That's two pounds and one pence, please. It cost me
eight pound fifty.
Singular forms are used in expressions like a five-pound note (see above). However, pence is often used
instead of penny (a five pence stamp).
American money
There are 100 cents (fl:) in a dollar ($). Sums of money are named very much as in British English. Some
coins have special names: one-cent coins are called pennies; five-cent coins are nickels; ten-cent coins
are dimes;
a twenty-five cent coin is a quarter.
non-metric measures
In recent years, Britain has adopted some metric measurement units, but non-metric measures are still
quite widely used. America uses mainly non-metric units. Approximate values are as follows:
I inch (1 in) = 2.5 cm
12. inches = 1 foot (30 cm)
3 feet (3ft) = l yard (90 cm)
5,280 feet/1,760 yards =1 mile (1.6 km)
5 miles =8 km
1 ounce (1 oz) = 28 gm
16 ounces = 1 pound (455 gm)
2-2 Pounds (2.2 Ib) = 1 kg
i4 pounds (14 Ib) = 1 stone (6.4 kg) (British only) I
page 387


numbers
38S
18
1 British pint = 56.8 cl 1 US pint = 47.3d 8 pints (8 pt) = 1 gallon 1 British gallon = 4.55 litres 1 US gallon =
3.78 litres
1 acre = 4,840 square yards =0.4 hectares 1 square mile = 640 acres = 259 ha
British people usually measure their weight in stones and pounds; Ame • just use pounds. Height is
measured m feet; distance can also be rneasur10?"5
AM/- l^.lt l^r-./Trt.- /-lir.*^"/'"^ /"-" /'f^"" ",...---- -I •-- '
feet, but longer distances are often measured in yards. I weigh eight stone six. (NOT ... eight stones six}
We are now flying at an altitude of 28,000 feet. The car park's straight on, about 500 yards on the right.
areas
We say, for example, that a room is twelve feet by fifteen feet, or that a garden is thirty metres by forty-
eight metres.
A room twelve feet by twelve feet can be called twelve feet square; the total area is 744 square feet.
19 asmdper
When we relate two different measures, we usually use a/an; per is often
used in formal writing.
/(costs two pounds a week. {... L2 per week.) We're doing seventy miles an hour. (... 70 miles per hour /
mph.)
20 numbers as complements
Numbers are used as subjects or objects, but not usually as complements after be.
I've got three sisters. (NOT My sisters arc three.)
There are twelve of us in my family. (More natural than We arc twelve...)
21 spoken calculations
Common ways of saying calculations in British English are:
2+2=4 Two and two is/are four. (informal) Two plus two equals/is four. (formal)
7-4=3 Four from seven is/leaves three, (informal)
Seven take away four is/leaves three, (informal) Seven minus four equals/is three, (formal)
3x4=12 Three fours are twelve, (informal)
Three times four is twelve, (informal) Three multiplied by four equals/is twelve, (formal)
9-3=3 Three(s) into nine goes three (times), (informal) Nine divided by three equals/is three, (formal)
388

beginning:
next line:
next line:
the addition:
example of a ''•P01"'11 calculation
for interest, is a multiplication (146 x 281) together with all its steps, in Here1 J-^s that a British English
speaker might have used as he/she was king it out on paper before the days of pocket calculators.
146 x 281
29200 11680 146
41026 A hundred and forty-six times two hundred and eighty-one. ,
Put down two noughts. Two sixes are twelve; put down two and carry one; two fours are eight and one are
nine; two ones
are two.
Put down one nought. Eight sixes are forty-eight; put down
eight and carry four; eight fours are thirty-two and four is
thirty-six; put down six and carry three; eight ones are eight
and three is eleven.
One times 146 is 146.
Six and nought and nought is six; eight and four and nought is
twelve; put down two and carry one; six and two are eight and
one is nine and one is ten; put down nought and carry one;
nine and one are ten and one is eleven; put down one and carry one; two and one are three and one are
four. total: forty-one thousand and twenty-six.
Note how is and are can often be used interchangeably.
For ways of saying and writing dates, see 151. For ways of telling the time, see 555.
386 of course
We use of course to mean something like 'as everybody knows' or 'as is obvious'.
It looks as if the sun goes round the earth, but of course the earth really
goes round the sun.
We'll leave at eight o'clock. Granny won't be coming, of course. his means that of course is not a very
polite reply to a statement of fact. Compare:
'Could you help me?' 'Of course.'
t scold.' 'It certainly is.' ('Of course it is' would be quite rude, because it would suggest that the first speaker
had said something too obvious to Be worth mentioning.)
"'•another way of using o/couree, see 159.5.
page 389


387 often
Often is used to mean 'frequently on different occasions'. If we want to s •frequently on the same
occasion', we generally use a different expression^ (e.g. a lot of times, several times, frequently}, or the
structure keep.. .ine Compare:
loftenfellin love when I was younger.
I fell several times yesterday when I was skiing.
(OR I kept falling yesterday...) (NOT I often fell yesterday-. .) Note that often has two common
pronunciations: /'ofan/and /'oftan/
For the position of often and other adverbs of indefinite frequency, see 23.2.
388 older English verb forms
The English that was used a few hundred years ago was different in very many ways from modern English
- grammar, vocabulary, pronunciation and spelling have all changed greatly since Shakespeare's time.
Some of the most striking differences are in the way verbs are used. For example, older English had
distinct second-person singular verb forms ending in -st, with a corresponding second-person singular
pronoun thou (object form thee possessives thy, thine). There were also third-person singular verb forms
ending in -th, and ye could be used as a second-person plural pronoun.
Tell me what thou knowest.
How can I help thee?
Where thy master goeth, there goest thou also.
Oh come, all ye faithful. Older forms of be included art and wert.
I fear thou art sick.
Wert thou at work today?
Questions and negatives were originally made without do; at a later stage, forms with and without do
(including affirmative forms with do) were both quite common.
Came you by sea or by land?
They know not what they do.
Be not afraid.
Then he did take my hand and kiss it. Simple tenses were often used in cases where modem English has
progressive forms.
We go not out today, for it raineth. Subjunctives (see 541) were more widely used than in modem English.
If she be here, then tell her I wait her pleasure. Inversion (see 298-299) was more common, and infinitives
and past participles could come later in a clause than in modem English.
Now are we lost indeed.
Hamlet, thou hast thy father much offended. (Shakespeare)
And she me caught in her arms long and small and therewithal so sweetly did me kiss and softly said
'Dear heart, how like you this?' (Wyatt)
390
These forms were not only common in older literature; some of them continued to be used by 19th-century
and early 20th-century writers fnarticularly in poetry) long after they had died out of normal usage. Modem
writers of historical novels, films or plays often make their characters use some of these older forms in
order to give a 'period' flavour to the language. And the forms also survive in certain special contexts
where tradition is especially valued - for example the language of religious services, public ceremonies
and the law. Some dialects, too, preserve forms which have disappeared from the rest of the language -
second-person pronouns (thou etc) are still used by many people in Yorkshire.
389 once (adverb)
When the adverb once has the indefinite meaning 'at some time', we use it to talk about the past but not
the future. To refer to an indefinite time in the future, we can use sometime or one day. Compare:
- I met her once in Venezuela.
Once upon a time there were three baby rabbits.
- Come up and see me sometime. (NOT Come up and sec me once.)
- We must have a drink together one day.
(NOT We must have a drink together once.)
When once has the more precise meaning of 'one time (not twice or three times)', it can be used to talk
about any time, including the future. I'm only going to say this once.
390 once (conjunction)
Once can be used as a conjunction, meaning 'after', 'as soon as'. It often suggests that something is
finished or completed, and is most often used with a perfect tense.
Once you've passed your test I'll letyou drive my car.
I'd like to go for a walk once the rain's stopped.
Once he had found somewhere to live he started looking for work.
Once you know how to ride a bike you never forget it. Note that we do not use that after once (NOT .. .-
once that the rain's stopped).
For present perfect instead of future perfect after conjunctions, see 556. For the use of now (that) as a
conjunction, see 383.
39! one: substitute word
1 use
We often use one instead of repeating a singular countable noun. 'Which is your boy?' 'The one in the
blue coat.' I'd like a cake. A big one with lots of cream. 'Can you lend me a pen?' 'Sorry, I haven't got one.'
>
page 391


unc.auusuimeword 39,
2 a... one
We drop a if there is no adjective. Compare:
I'm looking for aflat. I'd like a small one with a garden. I'd like one with a garden. (NOT ... a one with a
gardcfk)
3 ones
One has a plural ones.
'I'd like to try on those shoes.' Which ones?' 'The ones at the front ofth
window.'
Green apples often taste better than red ones. 'What sort of sweets do you like?' 'Ones with chocolate
inside.'
4 leaving out one(s)
One(s) can be left out immediately after superlatives, this, that, these tho either, neither, another and
some other determiners.
/ think my dog's the fastest (one).
'Which (one) would you like?' "That (one) looks the nicest.'
Either (one) will suit me.
She looked at each (one) very carefully before she chose.
Let's have another (one).
In American English, ones is not generally possible immediately after these and those (and it is unusual in
British English).
I don't think much of these. (GB... these ones also possible) We do not use one(s) immediately after my,
your etc, some, any, both or a number.
Take your coat and pass me mine. (NOT ... pass me my one.}
'Are there any grapes?' 'Yes, I bought some today.' (NOT ... I bought some ones today.)
I need some matches. Have you got any? (NOT ... any ones?)
I'll take both. (NOT ... both ones.)
She bought six. (NOT ... six ones.) But one(s) is used in all these cases if there is an adjective.
I'd like that green one. (NOT ... that green.)
I don't think much of those new ones. (NOT ... those new.)
I bought some sweet ones today. (NOT I bought some sweet today:)
'Has the cat had her kittens?' 'Yes, she had four white ones.' (NOT .. -four white.)
5 uncountable and abstract nouns
We do not use one(s) for uncountable nouns. Compare:
If you haven't got a fresh chicken I'll take a frozen one. If you haven't got fresh cream I'll take tinned
(cream).
(NOT ... tinned one.) And it is unusual to use one for abstract nouns.
The Dutch grammatical system is very similar to the English system-(More natural than... to the English
one.)
page
392
^^^^^•F^ 1ffW^ UI1C, yuu dliu Lucy. muciiiiiLC pcisuimi piuiiumra aac,
w^
Q nounmodifers
nne(s) is not generally used after noun modifiers, except those which refer to
materials.
Do you need coffee (cups) or tea cups? (NOT.. .or tea ones.)
B u T We can lend you plastic chairs or metal ones.
7 one(s) always refers back
WP use one(s) to avoid repeating a noun which has been mentioned before. It cannot normally be used in
other cases.
Then I saw a round thing in the sky with flashing lights. (NOT .. .-amumi-onc with flashing lights.)
Let's go and ask the old man for advice. (NOT.. .ask the old one...)
8 that of
One(s) is not normally used after a noun with possessive 's. Instead, we can either just drop one(s), or use
a structure with that! those of (more formal). A grandparent's job is easier than a parent's. (NOT ... than a
parent's one.} A grandparent's job is easier than thatofa parent.
(NOT .. .-than the one of a parent.)
Trollope's novels are more entertaining than those of Dickens. (NOT ...-than Dickens' ones I the ones of
Dickens.)
9 one and it
To refer to one particular thing that has already been clearly identified, we use it, not one. Compare:
'Canyou lendmeapen?' 'Sorry, I haven't got one.' (NOT 'Sorry, I haven't got it.')
'Can I borrow your pen?' 'Sorry, I need it.' (NOT 'Sorry, I need one.')
For substitution in general, see 542. -For repetition and avoidance of repetition in general, see 479.
392 one, you and they:
indefinite personal pronouns
1 one and you: meaning
We can use one or you to talk about people in general, including the speaker and hearer.
One always thinks other people's lives are more interesting.
(OR -You always think...) One/You can't learn a language in six weeks. One/You should never give people
advice. o
one and you: formality and class
ne is rather more formal than you. Compare:
ffyou want to make people angry, you just have to tell them the truth. Vone wishes to make oneself
thoroughly unpopular, one has merely
to tell people the truth. >
page 393


^.ai pronouns 393
- 'How do you get to Newbury?"Go straight down theA34.'
There are three principal routes by which one can drive to North W One is often considered typical of
more upper-class and intellectual es
and is avoided by many people for this reason; it is rare in informal A ^ English. eri
3 one and you: only used in generalisations
{~)yii> a nrl -tn~fii 'T---> .rt.i"-----1*
One and you are only used in this way in very general statements wh are talking about'anyone, at any
time'. Compare: ' we
- One/You can usually find people who speak English in Sweden English is spoken in this shop. OR They
speak English in this shoo
(NOT One speaks English. ..-the meaning is not 'people in general'
- One/You should knock before going into somebody's room. Somebody's knocking at the door. (NOT -
One is knocking...)
- It can take you/one ages to get served in this pub.
Thanks, I'm being served. (NOT Thanks, one is serving me:)
One generally has a singular meaning (= 'any individual'); it is not used to refer to groups.
We speak a strange dialect where I come from.
(NOT -One-speaks a strange dialect where I come from.)
4 people including the speaker/hearer
One is not used to generalise about people who could not include the
speaker; you is not used to generalise about people who could not include the hearer. Compare:
One/You must believe in something. In the sixteenth century people believed in witches.
(NOT... ^ne/you believed in witches - this could not include the speaker or hearer.)
5 one/you as subject, object etc
One can be a subject or object; there is a possessive one's and a reflexive pronoun oneself.
He talks to one like a teacher. One's family can be very difficult. One should always give oneself plenty of
time to pack. You/your/yourself'can be used in similar ways.
8 pronouns referring back: American English
When one is used in American English, he, him and his are generally used later in a sentence to refer
back to one. This is not normal in British Engus One cannot succeed at this unless he tries hard.
(GB... unless one tries hard.) One should always be polite to his bank manager. (GB... to one's bank
manager.}
i they
Thpv has a rather different, less general kind of meaning than one and you.
sually refers to a particular but rather vague group (for example the Itu pbours, the people around, the
authorities). " They don't like strangers round here.
They're going to widen the road soon.
I bet they put taxes up next year. Note also the common expression they say (= people say).
They say her husband's been seeing that Mrs Hastings again. (NOT -One-s393 one of...
One of is followed by a determiner and a noun phrase (usually plural), or by a plural pronoun. Of cannot
be dropped in this structure.
one of my friends
(NOT -ene-efmyfriend) (NOT one my friend)
one of them After one of, a noun phrase must have a determiner.
one ofthe/my/those horses (BUT NOT one of horses) Occasionally one of is used with a singular noun
referring to a group.
Why don't you ask one of the crew? When one of. ..is a subject, the verb is singular.
One of my friends is a pilot. (NOT One of my friends arc a pilot.)
One of our cats has disappeared. (NOT One of our cats have disappeared.)
For sentences like She's one of the only women who have/has climbed Everest, see 506.
394 only (focusing adverb)
Only can be used as a 'focusing adverb' (see 23.3). It can refer to different parts of a sentence.
1 referring to the subject
Only normally comes before a subject that it refers to. Only you could do a thing like that. Only my mother
really understands me.
referring to other parts of a sentence
When only refers to another part of a sentence, it often goes in 'mid-position' with the verb (see 23.10 for
details). She only reads biographies.
I only like swimming in the sea.
She is only on duty on Tuesdays.
She was only talking like that because she was nervous.
II ve only been to India once. >
page
394
page 395


3 ambiguous sentences
Sometimes sentences with only are ambiguous (they can be understood in more than one way).
I only kissed your sister last night.
(The sense can be 'only kissed', 'only your sister' or 'only last night'.) In speech, the meaning is usually
clear because the speaker stresses the part of the sentence that only refers to. Even in writing, the context
generally stops sentences like these from being really ambiguous. However, if necessary only can be put
directly before the object, complement or adverbial expression that it refers to. This is rather formal.
Compare:
They only play poker on Saturday nights, (could be ambiguous)
They play only poker on Saturday nights.
They play poker only on Saturday nights. Another way of making the meaning more precise is to split the
sentence by using a relative structure.
Poker is the only game they play on Saturday nights.
Saturday nights are the only time they play poker.
4 only today etc
Only with a time expression can mean 'as recently as', 'not before'. I saw her only today - she looks much
better. My shoes will only be ready on Friday. Only last week you said you would never smoke again. That
didn't last
long, did it? Only then did she realise what she had agreed to.
For inverted word order after only, as in the last example above, see 298.
)5 open
1 open and opened
We normally use open, not opened, as an adjective.
lean readyou like an open book. (NOT ... an oponed-beek}
Are the banks open this afternoon? (NOT Arc the banks-opened. ..-I Opened is used as the past tense
and past participle of the verb open, to about the action of opening.
She opened her eyes and sat up.
The safe was opened with dynamite.
2 when open is not used
Note that open is not the most normal word to refer to the fastenings
clothes, or to switches or taps. ,,iacfl-\ I can't untie/undo this shoelace. (NOT I can't open this^heelaee-.i
How do you unfasten this belt?
Could you turn/switch the radio on? (NOT .. .^pen-the-Foafw)
Who left the taps turned on? (NOT -Who left the tapfr0pe2)
For closed sad shut, see 132.
,396
196 opportunity and possibility
We often say that somebody has the opportunity to do I of doing something.
/ have the opportunity to go to Denmark next year. (= I can go...) possibility is not often used in this
structure. We more often say that there is a possibility of something happening.
There's a possibility of my going to Denmark next year. (= I may go...) (NOT I have the possibility to go to
Denmark...)
397 opposite: position
We put the adjective opposite before a noun when we are talking about one of a pair of things that
naturally face or contrast with each other.
I think the picture would look better on the opposite wall.
She went off in the opposite direction.
I've got exactly the opposite opinion to yours.
His brother was fighting on the opposite side. We put opposite after the noun when it means 'facing the
speaker or listener' or 'facing a person or place that has already been mentioned'.
/ noticed that the man opposite was staring at me. (NOT ... the opposite man was staring at me-}
The man you're looking for is in the shop directly opposite.
The people in the house opposite never draw their curtains. In American English, this idea is usually
expressed by using across (from).
the man sitting across from me
the house across the street
For opposite and in front of, see 272. For opposite and contrary, see 145.
398 ought
forms
Ought is a modal auxiliary verb (see 344-345). The third person singular has
no -.s.
She ought to understand. (NOT She oughts...) Questions and negatives are made without do.
Ought we to go now? (NOT Do we ought... ?)
A oughtn't to rain today.
^er ought, we use the infinitive with to. (This makes ought different from other modal auxiliary verbs.)
You ought to see a dentist.
ls I\ot used in question tags (see 465).
We ought to wake Helen, oughtn't we? (NOT ... oughtn't-we-te?) n American English, interrogative and
contracted negative forms of ought to •-"ire; should is generally used instead.
"e ought to be here soon, shouldn't he? ^
page 397


""Bin aaa
2 obligation
We can use oug^ to advise people (including ourselves) to do things- to people that they have a duty to do
things; to ask about our duty. The meaning is very similar to that of should; it is not so strong as must (see
WR)
What time ought I to arrive? ' •
I really ought to phone Mother.
People ought not to drive like that.
He ought to be given a medal for living with her.
There ought to be traffic lights at this crossroads.
3 deduction
We can use ought to say that we guess or conclude that something is
probable (because it is logical or normal).
Henry ought to be here soon - he left home at six.
'We're spending the winter in Miami.' 'That ought to be nice.'
The weather ought to improve after the weekend.
4 questions and negatives
Some people feel that the normal question and negative forms of ought are rather formal. In an informal
style, it is common to avoid them by using a structure with think... ought or by using should.
Do you think we ought to go now? (Less formal than Ought we to...?)
Should we go now?
I don't think people ought to drive like that. In some dialects, questions and negatives are made with did
(e.g. She didn't ought to do that), but this structure is not used in standard English.
5 ought to have...
Ought has no past form, but we can use ought to have + past participle to express certain ideas about the
past. This structure can be used to talk about things which were supposed to happen but did not, or to
make guesses or draw conclusions about things which are not certain to have happened.
/ ought to have phoned Ed this morning, but I forgot. (NOT I ought to phone Ed this morning, but I forgot.)
The Parkers ought to have got back from holiday yesterday. Has anybody
seen them?
It is also possible to talk about things that ought to have happened by now, or by a future time.
Ten o 'clock. She ought to have arrived at her office by now.
We ought to have finished painting the house by the end of next week.
6 word order
'Mid-position' adverbs like always, never, really (see 23.10) can go before or after ought in a verb phrase.
The position before ought is less formal. You always ought to carry some spare money, (less formal) You
ought always to carry some spare money, (more formal) In negative clauses, not comes before to. > You
ought not to go. I You oughtn't to go. (NOT -^eurWtght-te-nff^
^oe 398
399 out of
1 movement
The opposite of the preposition into is out of.
She ran out of the room.
(NOT -She ran out the room.) (NOT ^he-Ffm-eutfrom the room;)
I took Harry's letter out of my pocket. Note that out of can be used not only when we mention the place
that somebody / something leaves, but also when we mention the opening through which somebody/
something passes.
/ walked out of the front door without looking back.
Why did you throw the paper out of the window?
He sat staring out of the window. In informal American English, out can be used without of in this case.
She turned and went out the back door.
;,
2 position
Out of can also be used to talk about position - the opposite of in.
I'm afraid Mr Pallery is out of the country at the moment. He should be back next week.
For into and in, see 269. For other ways of using out of, see a good dictionary.
400 own
1 after possessives
We only use own after a possessive word. It cannot directly follow an article. It's nice ifa child can have his
or her own room. (NOT .. .^« own room.) Car hire is expensive. It's cheaper to take one's own car.
(NOT ... the own car.) I'm my own boss.
She likes to have things her own way. It was my mother's very own engagement ring.
2 a/some... of one's own
This structure makes it possible to include a/an, some or another determiner in the phrase.
I'd like to have a car of my own.
It's time you found some friends ofyourowh.
He's got no ideas of his own.
^r the structure a... of mine etc, see 434.
3 own with no following noun
•ve cannot use mine, yours etc with own, but we can drop a noun after w^ °wn, your own etc if the meaning
is clear.
Wouldyou like to use my pen?' 'No, thanks. lean only write with
my own.' (NOT ... mine own.) ^
page 399


t--El111!-"!!! 4()|
4 own and -self
The emphatic and reflexive pronouns myself, yourself etc (see 471) do " have possessive forms. My own
etc is used instead. ot
I'll do it myself, and I'll do it in my own way. (NOT .. •-wmyse1fs-wav,\ She can wash herself and brush her
own hair now. "wt*•l (NOT ... brush herself's hair.)
5 on one's own
Note the two meanings of on one's own.
My mother lives on her own. (without company) Don't help him. Let him do it on his own. (without help)
For by oneself used in similar ways, see 471.6.
401 paragraphs
Written English text is usually divided into blocks called 'paragraphs' in order to make it easier to read. The
divisions between paragraphs break the material up into easily 'digestible' sections, providing places
where it is easy for the reader to pause and think for a moment if necessary. And in addition, a good writer
can show the structure of his / her text by making the paragraph divisions in suitable places.
A paragraph division is usually shown, as in the passage below, by starting the text on a new line and
'indenting' (leaving a space at the beginning of the line).
Bill decided that it was too late to start slimming, and put some more sugar in his coffee. The way things
were, he needed all the help he could get. Everything was going wrong at work, everything had already
gone wrong at home, and the weather in Edinburgh in November was lousy. The only remaining question
was: should he commit suicide now or wait till after payday and get drunk first? Three months ago
everything had seemed so perfect. His boss had.. •
Another practice, common in typed letters and documents, and used in this book, is to leave a blank line
without indenting.
Dear Sirs
Three months ago I sent you an order for one of your 'Bouncewipe inflatable doormats, together with my
cheque for L35. You wrote acknowledging my order, and said that the doormat would be dispatched within
15 days. Since then I have heard nothing, and repeated phone calls to your offices have had no result
beyond vague promises to 'look into the matter'.
lam afraid that my patience is now at an end. If...
,400
402 P^1
s is usually dropped before part if there is no adjective.
Part of the roof was missing. (BUT A large part of the roof was missing.) Part of the trouble is that I can't
see very well.
(More natural than A part of the trouble...) Jan was in Australia part of last year.
403 participles (-ing and -ed forms) (I):
introduction
1 names
When -ins forms are used in certain ways (see below) they are called 'present participles'. Forms like
broken, gone, opened, started are called 'past participles'. These are not very suitable names: both forms
can be used to talk about the past, present or future.
She was crying when I saw her. Who's the man talking to Elizabeth?
This time tomorrow I'll be lying on the beach.
It was broken in the storm. You're fired.
The new school is going to be opened next week. Present and past participles can be put together to
make progressive and perfect forms (e.g. being employed, having arrived, havingbeen invited).
For the spelling of participles, see 533-535.
2 use
a verb forms
Participles are used with the auxiliary verbs be and have to make progressive, perfect and passive verb
forms.
It was raining when I got home. I've forgotten your name.
You'll be told as soon as possible.
b adjectives
Participles can be used like adjectives.
I love the noise of falling rain. She says she's goto broken heart. John has become very boring. The house
looked abandoned.
c adverbs
Sometimes participles are used like adverbs. She ran screaming out of the room.
d clauses
srticiples can combine with other words into clause-like structures. Who's the fat man sitting in the comer?
Having lost all my money, I went home. ^ost of the people invited to the party didn't turn up. "ejected by all
his friends, he decided to become a monk.
For e °^ these uses, see the following sections. 'lns fo^ns used like nouns ('gerunds'), see 292-296.
page 401


• yaasive 4Q4
404 participles (2): active and passive
1 active present participles, passive past participles
When -ing forms are used like adjectives or adverbs, they have simi] meanings to active verbs.
falling leaves (= leaves that fall)
a meat-eating animal (= an animal that eats meat}
She walked out smiling. [= She was smiling.} Most past participles have passive meanings when they are
used like adjectives or adverbs.
a broken heart (= a heart that has been broken}
He lived alone, forgotten by everybody. (= He had been forgotten by everybody.}
2 interested and interesting etc
The past participles interested, bored, excited etc are used to say how-people feel.
/ was very interested in the lesson.
(NOT I was very interesting in the lesson.} I didn 't enjoy the party because I was bored.
(NOT ... because I was boring.} The children always get terribly excited when Granny comes.
(NOT The eh ildrcn always get terribly exciting...} His explanation made me very confused.
(NOT ... made me very confusing.}
The present participles interesting, boring etc describe the people or things that cause the feelings.
Compare:
She's an interesting writer, and I'm very interested in the subjects that she ,;,1 writes about.
Boring teachers make bored students.
3 exceptions: active past participles
A few intransitive verbs have past participles that can be used as adjectives with active meanings,
especially before nouns. Examples:
a fallen leaf (= a leaf that has fallen}
advanced students (= students who have advanced to a high level, NOT students who have been
advanced...}
developed countries a grown-up daughter
increased activity an escaped prisoner
vanished civilisations faded colours
a retired general swollen ankles
Rescuers are still working in the ruins of the collapsed hotel. Some more past participles can only be used
in this way in phrases wi adverbs. Examples:
a well-read person (BUT NOT a read person}
a much-travelled man
recently-arrived immigrants c,,^.
The train just arrived at platform six is the delayed 13.15 from W
page
402
" g active past participles can also be used after be. Examples:
She is retired now.
Mv family are all grown up now- except my husband, of course.
Those curtains are badly faded. This class is the most advanced.
Recovered, camped, stopped, finished (see 211) and gone (see 233) are used
in this way after be, but not before nouns.
Why are all those cars stopped at the crossroads?
(BUT NOT .. .^-stopped car...} 1 hope you're fully recovered from your operation. We're camped in the
field across the stream. I'll be finished in a few minutes. Those days are gone now. He has been gone for
hours-where do you think he is? ,
Note that worry can be used both actively and passively with similar
meanings.
/ worry about you. I'm worried about you.
405 participles (3): details
1 used as adjectives
Participles can often be used as adjectives before nouns, or after be and other copular verbs.
an interesting book a lost dog
a falling leaf The upstairs toilet window is broken.
screaming children His idea seems exciting. An -ing form with an object can be used as an adjective. Note
the word order.
English-speaking Canadians. (NOT speaking English Canadians.)
a fox-hunting man Is that watch self-winding? Other compound structures with participles are also
common before nouns.
quick-growing trees government-inspired rumours
home-made cake the above-mentioned point
a recently-built house
Not all participles can be used as adjectives before nouns - for example, we can say a lost dog, but not a
found dog. It is not possible to give clear rules for this - it is a complicated area of English grammar which
has not yet been completely analysed.
2 after nouns
We often use participles after nouns in order to define or identify the nouns, in the same way as we use
identifying relative clauses (see 474). we wuldn't agree on any of the problems discussed. (=... the
problems that were discussed.} (NOT .. .-the-discussed problems.} ne People questioned gave very
different opinions. (= The people who were questioned...} ^01 ^hfHfucstioncd people...) Etched the match
because I knew some of the people playing.
^OT .. .^heplaying people.) 1 got the only ticket left. (N o T ... the only left ticket.) >
page 403


_. "."".,.-• -clans 4Q
Those is often used with a participle to mean 'the ones who are/wp ' Most of those questioned refused to
answer. Those selected will begin training on Monday.
3 differences of meaning
A few participles change their meaning according to their position Compare:
- a concerned expression (= a worried expression)
the people concerned (= the people who are/were affected)
- an involved explanation (= a complicated explanation) the people involved (= the same as the people
concerned)
- an adopted child (= a child who is brought up by people who are not his/her biological parents)
the solution adopted (= the solution that is/was chosen)
4 very with past participles
When a past participle is used as a gradable adjective, it can usually be
modified by very. This is common with words referring to mental states feelings and reactions.
a very frightened animal (NOT a much frightened animal) a very shocked expression
The children were very bored. She looked very surprised. Common exceptions:
That's Alice, unless I'm (very) much mistaken.
(NOT ... unless I'm very mistaken.) He's well known in the art world. (NOT ... very known...) When a past
participle is part of a passive verb, much or very much is normal. He's very much admired by his students.
(NOT ... very admired...) Britain's trade position has been (very) much weakened by inflation. (NOT ...
veryweakened...)
With some words referring to emotional states and reactions, usage is divided.
/ was very amused I much amused I very much amused by Miranda's performance.
To be sure whether a particular participle is used with very or much, it is necessary to look in a good
dictionary.
5 by with past participles
By is used after passive verbs to introduce the agent (the person or thing tna does the action - see 408).
Most of the damage was caused by your sister.
After past participles that are used like adjectives, we prefer other prepositions. Compare:
- She was frightened by a mouse that ran into the room.
(Frightened is part of a verb referring to an action.) She's always been terribly/Tightened of dying.
(Frightened is an adjective referring to a state of mind.)
- The kids were so excited by the noise that they couldn 't get to sleep-Joe's excited about the possibility
of going to the States.
w ,-.^.-^-^
J was annoyed by the way she spoke to me.
rm annoyed with you. The burglar was surprised by the family coming home unexpectedly.
I'm surprised at/byyour attitude. He wasbadly shocked byhis fall. We were shocked at/by the prices in
London. Other examples:
His whereabouts are known to the police.
The hills are covered in snow.
The room was filled with thick smoke.
g special past participle forms
A few older forms of past participles are still used as adjectives before nouns
in certain expressions.
drunken driving/laughter I singing etc
a shrunken head
a sunken wreck/ship etc
rotten fruit/vegetables etc
406 participles (4): clauses
1 structures
Participles can combine with other words into participle clauses. There's a woman crying her eyes out
over there. Most of the people invited to the reception were old friends. Not knowing what to do, I
telephoned the police. Served with milk and sugar, it makes a delicious breakfast.
2 after nouns; reduced relative clauses
Participle clauses can be used after nouns.
We can offer you a job cleaning cars.
In came the first runner, closely/allowed by the second. Participle clauses are often very like relative
clauses (see 473-474), except that they have participles instead of complete verbs.
Who's the girl dancing with your brother? (=... the girl who is dancing...)
Anyone touching that wire will get a shock. (= Anyone who touches...)
There's Neville, eating as usual.
Half of the people invited to the party didn't turn up.
I found him sitting at a table covered with papers. Perfect participles are not often used in this way.
Do you know anybody who's lost a cat?
(NOT -De
nybody having lost a cat?)
3 adverbial clauses
Participle clauses can also be used in similar ways to full adverbial clauses, Expressing condition, reason,
time relations, result etc. (This can only h^pen, of course, when the idea of condition, reason etc is so
clear that no
page
404
page 405


.- ,- ^ r-'-"'-muses 4og
conjunction is needed to signal it.) Adverbial participle clauses are us rather formal. "'"V
Used economically, one tin will last for six weeks. (= If it is used ) Having/ailed my medical exams, I took
up teaching. (= As I hadfn 7 Putting down my newspaper, I walked over to the window. ed--.) (= After I had
put down my newspaper,...)
It rained for two weeks on end, completely ruining our holiday
(=... so that it completely ruined our holiday.) Note that -ing clauses can be made with verbs like be, have,
wish and k which are not normally used in progressive tenses (see 451). In these cas01"' the participle
clause usually expresses reason or cause.
Being unable to help in any other way, I gave her some money.
Not wishing to continue my studies, I decided to become a dress designer
Knowing her pretty well, I realised something was wrong.
4 subjects; misrelated participles
Normally the subject of an adverbial participle clause is the same las the subject of the main clause in a
sentence.
My wife had a long talk with Sally, explaining why she didn't want the
children to play together. (My wife is the subject ofexplaining.} It is often considered a mistake to make
sentences in which an adverb clause has a different subject from the main clause. The following sentence,
with its 'misrelated participle' (also called 'hanging' or 'dangling participle'), would be considered incorrect
by many people.
Looking out of the window of our hotel room, there was a wonderful range of mountains. (This could sound
as if the mountains were looking out of the window.)
However, sentences with 'misrelated participles' are common and often seem quite natural, particularly
when the main clause has preparatory it or there as a subject.
Being French, it's surprising that she's such a terrible cook. Having so little time, there was not much that I
could do. 'Misrelated participles' are normal in some expressions referring to the . speaker's attitude.
Examples:
Generally speaking, men can run faster than women.
Broadly speaking, dogs are more faithful than cats.
Judging from his expression, he's in a bad mood.
Considering everything, it wasn 't a bad holiday.
Supposing there was a war, what would you do?
Taking everything into consideration, they ought to get another chance.
5 participle clauses with their own subjects
A participle clause can have its own subject. This happens most often in rather formal style.
Nobody having any more to say, the meeting was closed.
All the money having been spent, we started looking for work.
A little girl walked past, her doll dragging behind her on the pavernen •
Hands held high, the dancers circle to the right.
406
The subject is often introduced by with when the clause expresses
accompanying circumstances.
A car roared past with smoke pouring from the exhaust. With Peter working in Birmingham, and Lucy
travelling most of the week, the house seems pretty empty.
narticiple clauses after conjunctions and prepositions
Participle clauses can be used after many conjunctions and prepositions, such as after, before, since,
when, while, whenever, once, until, on, without, instead of, in spite o/and as. Note that -ing forms after
prepositions can often be considered as either participles or gerunds - the dividing line is not clear (see
290).
After talking to you I always feel better.
After having annoyed everybody he went home.
Depress clutch before changing gear.
She's been quite different since coming back from America.
When telephoning from abroad, dial 865, not 0865.
Once deprived of oxygen, the brain dies.
Leave in oven until cooked to a light brown colour.
On being introduced, British people often shake hands.
They left without saying goodbye.
She struck me as being a very nervy kind of person,
For clauses like when ready, see 73.4. For other (more noun-like) uses of-ing forms after prepositions, see
295.
7 object complements
The structure object + participle (clause) is used after verbs of sensation (e.g. see, hear, feel, watch,
notice, smell) and some other verbs (e.g. find, get, have, make).
I saw a small girl standing in the goldfish pond.
Have you ever heard a nightingale singing?
I found her drinking my whisky.
We'll have to get the car repaired before Tuesday.
Do you think you can get the radio working?
We'll soon have you walking again.
lean make myself understood pretty well in English.
For more about structures with see, see 245. For hear, see 245. Forget, see 228. For have, see
241.Formafce,see327.
passives (1): passive structures and verb forms
active and passive structures
Compare:
They built this house in 1486. (active) This house was built in 1486. (passive) Channel Islanders speak
French and English, (active) drench is spoken in France, Belgium, Swizerland, the Channel Islands...
(passive) ^.
page 407


- - -- v, ,cio rorrns 407
- A friend of ours is repairing the roof. (active)
The roof is being repaired by a friend of ours. (passive)
- This book will change your life. (active)
Your life will be changed by this book. (passive) When we say what people and things do, we use active
verb forms lik speak, is repairing, will change. When we say what happens to peonie ullt' things - what is
done to them - we often use passive verb forms like anc* built, is spoken, is being repaired, will be
changed.
The object of an active verb corresponds to the subject of a passive ve h OBJECT
Active: They built this house \ in 1486.
Passive: This house was built in 1486.
SUBJECT
In most cases, the subject of an active verb is not expressed in the corresponding passive sentence. If it
does have to be expressed, this usually happens in an expression with by; the noun is called the 'agent'
(see 408) This house was built in 1486 by Sir John Latton.
passive verb forms
We normally make passive forms of a verb by using tenses of the auxiliary be followed by the past
participle (= pp) of the verb. (For get as a passive auxiliary, see 228.4.) Here is a list of all the passive
forms of an ordinary English verb, with their names.
Tense

Structure

Example

simple present

am/are/is + pp

English is spoken here.

present

am/are/is being + pp

Excuse the mess; the

progressive



house is being painted.

simple past

was/were + pp

I wasn't invited, but I





went anyway.

past
progressive

was/were being + pp

I felt as if I was being





watched.

present perfect

have/has been + pp

Has Mary been told?

past perfect

had been + pp

I knew why I had been





chosen.

will future

will be + pp

You'll be told when the





time comes.

future perfect
going to future

will have been + pp
am/are/is going to be +
pp

Everything will have been
done by Tuesday.
Who's going to be
invited^

Future progressive passives (will be being + pp) and perfect progressiv passives (e.g. has been being +
pp) are unusual. Examples of passive infinitives: (to) be taken; (to) have been invited-Examples of passive
-ing forms: being watched; havingbeen invite •
page
408
P-
t that verbs made up of more than one word (see 582) can have passive
io'rrns if they are transitive.
The furniture was broken up for firewood.
She likes being looked at. I need to be taken care of. [ie hates being made a fool of.
thp rules for the use of the different passive forms, see the entries on the various
tenses etc.
3 verbs not used in the passive
Not all verbs can have passive forms. Passive structures are impossible with intransitive verbs like die or
arrive, which cannot have objects, because there is nothing to become the subject of a passive sentence.
Some transitive verbs, too, are seldom used in the passive. Most of these are 'stative verbs' (verbs which
refer to states, not actions). Examples saeflt, have, lack,
resemble, suit.
They have a nice house. (BUT NOT A nice house is had. by them.) My shoes don't fit me. (BUT NOT I'm
not fitted by my shoos.) Sylvia resembles a Greek goddess.
(BUT NOT A Greek goddess is resembled by Sylvia.) Your mother lacks tact. (BUT NOT fastis lacked...)
She was having a bath. (BUT NOT A bath was being had by her.)
Some prepositional verbs are mainly used in the active.
- r- - r
Everybody agreed with me. (BUT NOT I was agreed with by everybody.) We walked into the room. (BUT
NOT The room was walked into.)
There are no clear rules about this, and students have to learn by experience
which verbs cannot be used in the passive.
confusing forms
Students often confuse active and passive verb forms in English. Typical mistakes:
^-was very interesting in the lesson:
-We- were questioning by the immigration officer.
^hehas put in prison for life. Mistakes like these are not surprising, because:
(1) Be is used to make both passive verb forms and active progressive tenses.
(2) Past participles are used to make both passive verb forms and active perfect tenses.
Compare:
He was calling, (active - past progressive)
He was called, (passive - simple past)
He has called, (active - present perfect simple)
or more about transitive and intransitive verbs, see 579.2. r Me position of prepositions in passive clauses,
see 440. or •^ve verb forms, see 10.
page 409


r'""^^gent 4oa
408 passives (2): agent
In a passive clause, we usually use a phrase beginning with by ifwp mention the agent - the person or
thing that does the action, or thar^"110
what happens. (Note, however, that agents are mentioned in onlyah^11888 per cent of passive clauses.) ut
20
All the trouble was caused by your mother.
I was shocked by your attitude.
These carpets are made by children who work twelve hours a dav After the past participles of some
stative verbs, including some which used like adjectives, other prepositions can be used instead of by (see
^ ^
We were worried about/by her silence. "
Are you frightened of spiders?
With is used when we talk about an instrument which is used by an agent do an action.
He was shot (by the policeman) with a rifle. For more about with and by, see 117.
409 passives (3): choice of passive structures
1 active or passive?
We often choose to use passive structures when we want to talk about an action, but are not interested in
saying who or what does / did it. Passives
without 'agents' (see 408) are common in academic and scientific writing for this reason.
The positive hydrogen atoms are attracted to the negative oxygen atoms.
Those pyramids were built around 400 AD.
Too many books have been written about the Second World War. We often prefer to begin a sentence
with something that is already known, or that we are already talking about, and to put the 'news' at the
end. This is another common reason for choosing passive structures - often including agents. Compare:
John's painting my portrait, (active verb so that the 'news' - the portrait-can go at the end) 'Nice picture.'
'Yes, it was painted by my grandmother.' (passive verb so
that the'news'- the painter - can go at the end) Longer and heavier expressions often go at the end of a
clause, and this can also be a reason for choosing a passive structure.
I was annoyed by Mary wanting to tell everybody what to do. , (More natural than Mary wanting to tell
everybody what to da annoys me - the phrase Mary ...do would make a very long subject.)
2 meaning and grammar
Meaning and grammar do not always go together. Not all active verbs 'active' meanings; for instance, if
you say that somebody receives soine or suffers, you are really saying that something is done to him/her.
io English active verbs might be translated by passive or reflexive verbs i certain other languages (e.g.
My shoes are wearing out; She is sitting'
passives \.tr. veros'wiin iwu uojecis 410
r
ddenlv the door opened). And some English passives might be translated
active or reflexive verbs (e.g. / was bom in 1956; English is spoken here). c"e verbs can be used in both
active and passive forms with similar anings: for example to worry I to be worried; to drown I to be
drowned
ig9). Sometimes active and passive infinitives can be used with very •milar meanings: for example There's
a lot of work to do/to be done (for details, see 287).
For more about verbs like open ('ergative verbs'), see 579.3.
For more about reflexive verbs, see 471.
For active and passive past participles, see 404.3.
For -ins forms with passive meanings after need and want (e.g. My watch needs cleaning),
see 293.3. For more about the way information is organised in sentences, see 289.
410 passives (4): verbs with two objects
Many verbs, such as give, send, show, lend, can be followed by two objects, an 'indirect object' and a
'direct object'. These usually refer to a person (indirect object) and a thing (direct object). Two structures
are possible.
A. verb + indirect object + direct object
She gave her sister the car. I had already shown the policewoman Sam's photo.
B. verb + direct object + preposition + indirect object;
She gave the car to her sister. I had already shown Sam's photo to the policewoman.
Both of these structures can be made passive.
A. indirect object becomes subject of passive verb
Her sister was given the car. The policewoman had already been shown Sam's photo.
B. direct object becomes subject of passive verb
The car was given to her sister. Sam's photo had already been shown to the policewoman.
The choice between the two passive structures may depend on what has been said before, or on what
needs to be put last in the sentence (see 289 for more about 'information structure'). Structure A (e.g. Her
sister was given the Mr) is probably the more common of the two. More examples:
I've just been sent a whole lot of information.
You were lent ten thousand pounds last year.
The visitors were shown a collection of old manuscripts.
The headmaster was sent an invitation.
structure B (e.g. The car was given to her sister), prepositions are ^nietirnes dropped before indirect
object pronouns.
Oth watch "^S^6" (t0^me ^ my father.
er t^mmon verbs used in these structures include pay, promise, refuse,
410
page 411


that with say the infinitive structure is only possible in the passive. His company is said to be in trouble.
(BUT NOT ^Fhey-say his company to be in trouble.) g other cases, the infinitive structure is more common
in the passive than in the active (see 580.3).
, infinitives without to
" ^e, make and help can be followed, in active structures, by object + • finitive without to (see 277). In
passive structures ro-infinitives are used.
Compare:
I saw him come out of the house.
He was seen to come out of the house. They made him tell them everything. He was made to tell them
everything.
3 preparatory there
With some verbs (e.g. say, think, feel, report, presume, understand), the passive structure is possible with
there as a 'preparatory subject'.
There are thought to be more than 3,000 different languages in the world.
(= It is thought that there are...)
There was said to be disagreement between the Prime Minister and the Home Secretary.
4 perfect, progressive and passive infinitives
A passive verb can be followed by a perfect, progressive or passive infinitive. He is believed to have
crossed the frontier last night. I was told to be waiting outside the station at 6 o'clock. The hostages are
expected to be released today.
5 exceptions: wanting and liking
Verbs that refer to wanting, liking and similar ideas cannot usually be used in passive structures with
following infinitives. Everybody wanted Doris to be the manager.
(BUT NOT Doris was wanted to be the manager.) We like our staff to say what they think.
(BUT NOT Our staff arc liked to say what they think.)
413 passives (7): object complements
^ter some verbs the direct object can be followed by an 'object complement' - a noun or adjective which
describes or classifies the object.
Queen Victoria considered him a genius.
They elected Mrs Sanderson President.
We all regarded Kathy as an expert.
Most people saw him as a sort of clown.
The other children called her stupid.
You've made the house beautiful.
page
413
that with say the infinitive structure is only possible in the passive. His company is said to be in trouble.
(BUT NOT They say his company to be in trouble) me other cases, the infinitive structure is more common
in the passive San in the active (see 580.3).
2 infinitives without to
Hear see, make and help can be followed, in active structures, by object + • finitive without to (see 277). In
passive structures ro-infinitives are used.
Compare:
I saw him come out of the house. '. •
He was seen to come out of the house. They made him tell them everything. He was made to tell them
everything.
3 preparatory there
With some verbs (e.g. say, think, feel, report, presume, understand), the passive structure is possible with
there as a 'preparatory subject'.
There are thought to be more than 3,000 different languages in the world.
(= It is thought that there are...)
There was said to be disagreement between the Prime Minister and the Home Secretary.
4 perfect, progressive and passive infinitives
A passive verb can be followed by a perfect, progressive or passive infinitive. He is believed to have
crossed the frontier last night. I was told to be waiting outside the station at 6 o'clock. The hostages are
expected to be released today.
5 exceptions: wanting and liking
Verbs that refer to wanting, liking and similar ideas cannot usually be used in passive structures with
following infinitives. Everybody wanted Doris to be the manager.
(BUT NOT Don's was wanted to be the manager) We like our staff to say what they think.
(BUT NOT Our staff are liked to say what they think.)
413 passives (7): object complements
^er some verbs the direct object can be followed by an 'object complement' - a noun or adjective which
describes or classifies the object.
Queen Victoria considered him a genius.
They elected Mrs Sanderson President.
We all regarded Kathy as an expert.
"lost people saw him as a sort of clown.
The other children called her stupid.
you've made the house beautiful.
page
413


-icami VCTDS 4^,
In passive clauses these are subject complements; they come after the v He was considered a genius by
Queen Victoria. Mrs Sanderson was elected President. Kathy was regarded as an expert. He was seen as
a sort of clown. She was called stupid by the other children. The house has been made beautiful.
For more about object complements, see 580.
passives (8): finished-result verbs
Some verbs refer to actions that produce a finished result. Examples are cut build, pack, close. Other
verbs do not: for example push, live, speak, hit, carry. The past participles of finished-result verbs, and
some of their passive tenses, can have two meanings. They can refer to the action, or they can describe
the result (rather like adjectives). Compare:
The theatre was closed by the police on the orders of the mayor.
(refers to the action of closing) When I got there I found that the theatre was closed.
(refers to the state of being shut - the result of the action) Because of this, for example, present passive
forms can have similar meanings to present perfect passives.
The vegetables are all cut up- what shall I do now?
(= The vegetables have all been cut up...] I got caught in the rain and my suit's ruined.
(,=... has been ruined.) I think your ankle is broken. (=... has been broken.)
past time (I): talking about the past in English
six different tenses
In English, six different tenses are used to talk about the past:
D the simple past (7 worked)
a the past progressive (/ was working)
D the simple present perfect (7 have worked)
a the present perfect progressive (7 have been working)
D the simple past perfect (I had worked)
c the past perfect progressive (I had been working)
The differences between these tenses are quite complicated. Some English
tenses express meanings (e.g. completion, continuation, present
importance) which are not expressed by verb forms in all other languages,
and this can make the use of tenses difficult for students to learn. The most
important rules for past and perfect tenses are given in the following
sections.
page 414
2 progressive forms
progressive forms (also called 'continuous' forms) are used especially when we describe a past event as
going on or continuing (perhaps at a particular time, or up to a particular time).
When you phoned I was working in the garage.
[ was tired because I had been working all day.
For general information about progressive verb forms, see 450. For details of the use of particular
progressive forms to talk about the past, see the following sections.
3 perfect forms
Perfect forms are used especially when we want to suggest a connection between a past event and the
present, or between an earlier and a later past
event.
I have worked with children before, so I know what to expect in my newjob.
After I had worked with Jake for a few weeks, I felt I knew him pretty well. Perfect forms can also suggest
completion.
I've done the shopping. What shall I do now?
For general information about perfect verb forms, see 423.
For details of the use of present and past perfect tenses, see the following sections.
For a list of all active verb forms, see 10.
For passive verb forms, see 407.
416 past time (2): the simple past tense
1 forms (regular verbs)
Affirmative

Question

Negative

I worked you
worked he/she/it
worked etc

did I work? did you
work? did he/she/it
work? etc

I did not work you did not
work he/she/it did network
etc

Contracted negatives (see 144): I didn't work, you didn't work etc. Negative questions (see 360): did I not
work? or didn 't I work? etc. For the affirmative past forms of common irregular verbs, see 300. Questions
and negatives of irregular verbs are made in the same way as those of regular verbs (with did+ infinitive).
For detailed information about question structures, see 461 -466.
For negatives, see 358-362.
For passive forms (e.g. Work was done), see 407.
page 415


pronunciation of -ed
The regular past ending -ed is pronounced as follows:
ci /d/ after vowels and voiced consonants
(except /d/): IQI, Ibl, N1, IT.I, 1^1, /ds/, /g/, Iml, /n/, 7n/, /!/
fried /traid/ clothed /klaufld/
Msed /juizd/ /a/Zed /feild/ n /t/ after unvoiced consonants
(except /t/): /9/, /p/, /f/, /s/, /J7, /tf/, /k/
stopped /stopt/ laughed /la:ft/ worked /w3:kt/ passed /pa'.st/ watched /wotJt/ a /id/ after /d/ and /t/
ended /'endid/ started /'staitid/ 3 spelling of regular affirmative past tense forms
work worked i- -1 ' -
•*B
Most regular verbs:
^-J J - _T
add -ed
Verbs ending in-e:
add-d
Verbs ending in one stressed vowel + one consonant (except w ory):
double the consonant and add -ed
helpwhelped start-started rain^rained stay - stayed
show> showed wonder - wondered visit> visited gallop -galloped
hope > hoped decide -decided
shop shopped plan-+planned refer-+referred regret regretted
Verbs ending in consonant + -y:
changer to i and add -ed
hurry hurried cry Y cried study> studied
Verbs ending in -c have ck in the past (e.g. picnic > picnicked).
In British English, -/ is doubled in the past after a short vowel even if the
vowel is not stressed: travel^ travelled.
use
We use the simple past tense to talk about many kinds of past events: short, quickly finished actions and
happenings, longer situations, and repeated
pwn t-c
events.
Peter broke a window last night. I spent all my childhood in Scotland. Regularly every summer, Janet fell
in love.
The simple past is common in story-telling and when we are telling people
about past events.
One day the Princess decided that she didn't like staying at home all day,
so she told her father that she wanted to get a job... The simple past is often used with references to
finished periods and moments of time.
I saw John yesterday morning. He told me... In general, the simple past tense is the 'normal' one for
talking about the past;
we use it if we do not have a special reason for using one of the other tenses.
For the use of the simple past with a present or future meaning, see 422. For special uses in subordinate
clauses, see 556.
417 past time (3): the past progressive tense
1 forms
Affirmative

Question

Negative

I was working you
were working etc

was I working? were
you working? etc

I was not working you were
not working etc

For passive forms (e.g. Work was beingdone), see 407.
2 use
We use the past progressive to say that something was in progress (going on) around a particular past
time.
'What were you doing at eight o'clock yesterday evening?' 'I was watching TV.'(NOT 'What did you do...?'
'I watched W.')
When I got up this morning the sun was shining, the birds were
singing,... (NOT ... the sun shone, the birds sang...) Another use of the past progressive is to stress that
an activity was in progress at every moment during a period of time.
I was painting all day yesterday.
They were quarrelling the whole time they were together. Some verbs are not used in progressive forms
(see 451).
I tried a bit of the cake to see how it tasted. (NOT.. . how it was tasting.)
past progressive and simple past: 'background' events
"e often use the past progressive together with a simple past tense. The past Progressive refers to a
longer 'background' action or situation; the simple Past refers to a shorter action or event that happened in
the middle of the ^nger action, or that interrupted it.
^s I was walking down the road, I saw Bill.
The phone rang while I was having dinner.
Mozart died while he was composing the Requiem.
TTie Presidential motorcade was moving slowly through the Central Square. The crowds were cheering.
Photographers were jostling each other for the best positions. Suddenly a woman screamed... >
416
page 417


-"°c -ng
4 past progressive and simple past: temporary and Derma
The past progressive, like other progressive forms (see 450), is used f temporary actions and situations.
When we talk about longer, morp permanent situations we use the simple past. Compare:
- It happened while I was living in Eastbourne last year. I lived in London for ten years while I was a child.
- When I got home, I found that water was running down the kitchen Explorers believed that the river ran
into the Atlantic. •
5 past progressive and simple past: repeated actions
The past progressive is not the normal tense for talking about repeated habitual past actions. The simple
past is usually used with this meaning
/ rang the bell six times. (NOT / was ringing thc-beVrStXrtmws-)
When I was a child we made our own amusements. (NOT ... we were making our own amusements^)
However, the past progressive is possible if the repeated actions form a 'background' for the main action.
At the time when it happened, I was seeing a lot of Belinda, and I was also going to the opera a lot.
See also 'special uses', below. 6 special uses
Because we often use the past progressive to talk about something that is a 'background', not the main
'news', we can make something seem less important by using this tense.
/ was talking to the President last night, and she said... (as if there was nothing special for the speaker
about talking to the President) The past progressive can be used with always, continually and similar
words
to talk about things that happened repeatedly and unexpectedly, or in an unplanned way.
Aunt Lucy was always tumingup without warning and bringing us presents.
I didn't like him - he was continually borrowing money.
For more about this use of progressive forms with always etc, see 452.
For the 'distancing' use of past progressives (e.g. / was wondering whether you'd like to come out with me
this evening), see 161.
418 past time (4): the simple present perfect tense
1 forms
Affirmative
Question
I have worked you have worked etc
have I worked? have you worked? etc
Negative
I have not worked you have not worked etc
page
418
In older English, some present perfect forms were made with be, not have (a a Winter is come). This does
not normally happen in modern English.
For passive forms (e.g. The work has been done), see 407. For sentences like The potatoes are all gone,
see 233. For sentences like Are you finished yet, see 211. For other active uses of be + past participle,
see 404.
other languages
In some other languages there are tenses which are constructed like the English present perfect (compare
English I have worked, French/a; travaille, German ich habe gearbeitet, Italian ho lavorato, Spanish he
trabajado). Note that the English present perfect is used rather differently from most of these similar
tenses in other languages.
finished events connected with the present
We can use the simple present perfect to say that a finished action or event is connected with the present
in some way. If we say that something has happened, we are thinking about the past and the present at
the same time.
I can't go on holiday because I have broken my leg.
(NOT I can 'tgoon holiday because I broke my leg.) We could often change a simple present perfect
sentence into a present sentence with a similar meaning.
I've broken my leg. (My leg is broken now.)
Have you read the Bible? (-+ Do you know the Bible?}
Some fool has let the cat in. (The cat is in.)
Utopia has invaded. Fantasia. (Utopia is at war with Fantasia.)
Mary has had a baby. (Mary now has a baby.)
Our dog has died. (> Our dog is dead.)
All the wars in history have taught us nothing. (+ We know nothing.)
My experience at school, all those years ago, has given me a permanent
hatred of authority. (I hate authority.) The present perfect is often used to express the idea of
completion or achievement.
At last! I've finished!
Have you done all the housework?
We do not use the present perfect if we are not thinking principally about the present. Compare:
- I've travelled in Africa a lot. (I know Africa.)
Some people think that Shakespeare travelled a lot in Germany. (NOT Some people think that
Shakespeare has travelled...)
- We've leamt enough to pass the exam. (The exam is still to come.)
We leamt enough to pass the exam. (The exam is over.)
Look what John's given me! (focus on the gift)
Wzo gave you that? (focus on the past action of giving) We do not use the present perfect in story-telling.
Once upon a time there was a beautiful princess who lived... >
page 419


- - -^~wnse4l8
4 finished events: news
The simple present perfect is the most normal tense for giving news nf events. ' ^cent
And here are the main points of the news again. The pound has fallp against the dollar. The Prime
Minister has said that the government economic policies are working. The number of unemployed has
reach five million. There has been afire... ^*
The present perfect is not often used to talk about a finished event ifw when it happened (see below).
Compare; ' swf
- There has been an explosion at Edinburgh Castle. There was an explosion at Edinburgh Castle last
night. (NOT There hasbeen...-last-night-.}
- I've had a word with the boss, and he says it's OK.
I had a word with the boss today, and he says it's OK. Note that after using the present perfect to
announce a piece of news, we usually change to simple or progressive past tenses to give the details.
There has been a plane crash near Bristol. Witnesses say that there was an explosion as the aircraft was
taking off,...
The Prime Minister has had talks with President Kumani. During a three-hour meeting, they discussed the
economic situation, and agreed on the need for closer trade links between the two countries.
For more further details, exceptions and notes onAmerican usage, see 419.5.
5 finished events with expressions of 'tune up to now'
We often use the simple present perfect for past events when we are thinking of a perio d of time
continuing up to the present - for example when we use
indefinite time adverbs that mean 'at some / any time up to now', like ever, before, never, yet, already.
Have you ever seen a ghost?
You've only ever called me 'darling' once.
I'm sure we've met before.
She's never apologised for any thing in her life.
'Has Ben come yet?' 'Yes, and he's already started to make trouble.' If we use a more definite expression
of 'time up to now' (e.g. today, this week), we usually prefer a simple past tense in affirmative clauses.
Compare:
- I've already spoken to the boss about my holiday. I spoke to the boss today about my holiday.
(More natural than I've spoken to the boss today...)
- Have you seen John this week?
I haven, 't seen John this week.
I saw John this week, and he says...
(More natural than I've seen John this week...) . And with adverbs of finished time (e.g. yesterday, last
weekend) theprese perfect is very unusual (see paragraph 7 below).
For the present perfect progressive with 'time up to now', see 420.3. For other tenses with ever, see 197.
420
repetition and continuation to now
We can use the simple present perfect to say that something has happened
several times up to the present.
I've written six letters since lunchtime.
How often have you been in love in your life? We often use the simple present perfect to talk about how
long present •tuations have lasted. Note that present tenses are not used in this way.
I've studied hard for years. (NOT I study hard for years.) ;,
We've known each other since i960. (NOT We know each other since 196ftf
I've never liked you. How longhaveyou been a doctor? (NOT How long are you a doctor?)
We've always lived here. We can also use the present perfect progressive in this way. For the
difference, see 420.4-6.
In an informal style, simple past tenses are sometimes possible with always,
ever and never when they refer to 'time up to now'.
lalways knew I could trustyou. (OR I've always known..,) Didyou ever see anything like that before? (OR
Have you ever seen... ?)
For the difference between/or and since, see 214. For tenses with since, see 499. For sentences like This
is the first time I have been here, see 419.7.
7 expressions of finished time: present perfect not used
We do not often use the present perfect with expressions that refer to a completely finished period of time,
like yesterday, last week, then, when, three years ago, in 1970. This is because the present perfect
focuses on the present, and time-expressions like these focus on the past, so they contradict
each other.
I saw Lucy yesterday. (NOT -I have seen Lucy yesterday.) Tom was ill last week. (NOT Tom has been ill
last week.) Whatdidyou do then? (NOT What have you done then?) She died three years ago. (NOT She
has died three years ago.) He was bom in 1970. (NOT He has been bom in 1970.)
For tenses with just and just now, see 305.
8 time not mentioned
We use the present perfect when we are thinking of a period of 'time up to now', even if we do not mention
it. On the other hand, we do not use the present perfect when we are thinking of a particular finished time,
even if we do not mention it. Compare:
Have you seen'Romeo and Juliet'?
(Have you ever seen it? OR Have you seen the current production?)
Didyou see 'Romeo and Juliet'?
(Did you see the production on TV last night?)
You've done a lot for me. (...up to now)
^fy grandfather did a lot for me. (... when he was alive) >
page 421


In some cases, there is little difference between the two points of view, and past and perfect tenses are
both possible.
Welcome home! I('ve) missed you. ^ We (have) heard that you have rooms to let. |
For present perfect tenses in clauses referring to the future (e.g. 777 take a rest when I've finished
cleaning the kitchen), see 556.
419 past time (5): simple present perfect and simple past (advanced points)
1 origins
We normally use the simple present perfect when we are thinking about pasr events together with their
present results (see 418.3).
/ can't come to your party because I've broken my leg. However, we usually prefer a simple past tense
when we identify the person thing or circumstances responsible for a present situation (because we are
focusing on the past cause, not the present result). Compare:
- Some fool has let the cat in.
Who let that cat in? (NOT Who has let that cat in?)
- Look what John has given me!
Who gave you that watch? (NOT Who's given you that watch?) Other examples:
'Whyareyou crying?' 'Granny hit me.' (NOT .. .-'Grwmy has hitme^)
The Chinese invented paper. (NOT The Chinese have4nvented paper;) That's a nice picture. Did you
paint it yourself?
Some people think that 'Pericles' was not written by Shakespeare. I'm glad you were born. How did you
get that bruise?
expectation and reality
We use a past tense to refer to a belief that has just been shown to be true or false.
It's not as big as I expected. (NOT.. . as I have-expected.) You're older than I thought. (NOT .. .-them-l-
have thought.) But you promised...! (NOT But you have promised...!)
present perfect with past time adverbs
Grammars usually say that the present perfect tenses cannot be used together with expressions of
finished time - we can say I have seen him or I saw him yesterday, but not-Lhave-seen-hmi-yesterday: In
fact, such structures are unusual but not impossible (though learners should avoid them). Here are some
real examples taken from news broadcasts, newspap articles, advertisements, letters and conversations. "
France has detonated a Hiroshima-sized nuclear bomb on Mururoa Aw in the South Pacific at 17.02
GMTon Wednesday.
Police have arrested more than 900 suspected drugs traffickers in raw throughout the country on Friday
and Saturday.
...a runner who's beaten Linford Christie earlier this year.

2
3
A. 24-year-old soldier has been killed in a road accident while on patrol
last night.
A lot of the drivers will be thinking about the circuit, because we've had
some rain earlier today. The horse's trainer has had a winner here yesterday.
indicating that the geological activity has taken place a very long
time ago.
Perhaps what has helped us to win eight major awards last year alone...
I have stocked the infirmary cupboard only yesterday. Jam pleased to confirm that Lloyds Bank... has
opened a Home Loan account for you on 19th May 1982.
4 simple past for news
Recently, some British newspapers have started regularly using the simple past for smaller news
announcements - probably to save space. Some authentic examples from the front page of one
newspaper:
The Swedish prosecutor leading the OlafPalrne murder hunt resigned
after accusing police chiefs of serious negligence. An unnamed Ulster businessman was shot dead by
terrorists... Driving wind and rain forced 600 out of 2,500 teenagers to abandon the annual 'Ten Tor' trek
across Dartmoor.
5 American English
In American English the simple past is often used to give news.
Did you hear? Switzerland declared/has declared war on Mongolia!
(GB Have you heard? Switzerland has declared war...) Uh, honey, I lost I I've lost the keys. (GB.. .I've
lost...) Lucy just called. (GB Lucy has just called.)
In American English, it is also possible to use the simple past with indefinite , past-time adverbs like
already, yet, ever and before. ' ;! Didyou eat already? (OR Haveyou eaten...?)
(GB Haveyou eaten already?)
I didn't call Bobby yet. (OR I haven't called...) ' (GB I haven't called...)
For more about tenses with just, see 305. For more about British-American differences, see 50.
6 bad rules
Grammars sometimes say that the present perfect is not used with expressions referring to 'definite time'.
This is confusing - the present perfect is not often used with finished time expressions, but it actually is
very common with definite time expressions. Compare:
I've lived here for exactly three years, seven months and two days. (present perfect with very definite time-
reference)
Once upon a time a little girl lived with her mother in a lonely house in a
dark forest, (simple past with very indefinite time-reference) Note also that the choice between simple
present perfect and simple past does not depend on whether we are talking about finished actions, as
page
422
page 423


- . - - • -,-ie^sive tense 42n
learners' grammars sometimes suggest (though it has a lot to do with whether we are talking about
finished time periods). Compare-
That cat has eaten your supper. (finished action - present perfect late the last of the eggs this morning,
(finished action - simple nasti The choice also does not depend directly on whether events are rec (though
recent events are more likely to be 'news', and we are more 1'lr
be concerned about their present results, so many present perfect sent6 ^t0 are in fact about recent
events). Compare: ences
The French revolution has influenced every popular radical movement •
Europe since 1800. (200-year-old event-present perfect) ;" Ann phoned five minutes ago. (very recent
event - simple past)
7 this is the first time etc
We use a simple present perfect tense in sentences constructed with this/it/that is the
first/second/third/only/best/worst/ etc. This is the first time that I've heard her sing.
(NOT This4s-tho first time that I hear her sing.) This is the fifth time you've asked me the same question.
(NOT This is the fifth time you ask...) That's the third cake you've eaten this morning. It's one of the most
interesting books I've ever read.
When we talk about the past, we use past perfect tenses in these structures. It was the third time he had
been in love that year. (NOT ... the third time he was in love.. J
For tenses with since, see 499. -
For present perfect and simple present passives with similar meanings (e.g. The shop has been /is
closed), see 414.
420 past time (6): the present perfect progressive tense
1 forms
Affirmative
I have been working you have been working
etc
Question
have I been working? have you been working?
etc
Negative
I have not been
working you have not been
working etc
2
use: general
We use the present perfect progressive, in general, to talk about situati which started in the past and are
still going on, or which have just stopp and have present results.
I've been keeping the bread in the top cupboard - is that OK? Sorry I'm late. Have you been waiting long?
'You look hot.' 'Yes, I've been running.'
naee424
past i
" cannot use the present perfect progressive with expressions that refer to
a finished period of time.
'You look tired.' 'Yes. I was cycling non-stop until five o'clock.' (NOT ... 'I've been cycling non stop until five
o'clock.')
present perfect progressive and present
Roth the present perfect progressive and the present (simple or progressive) can be used to talk about
situations which started in the past and are still going on. The difference is that the present perfect
progressive has an 'up to now' focus. It is common when we are talking about situations which are just
coming to an end or may change, or when we are talking about how long a situation has lasted. Compare:
- / have violin lessons every two weeks.
I've been having violin lessons every two weeks, but I think I'll make it every week from now on.
- Who is she talking to?
'Sorry I'm late, darling.' "That's all right. I've been talking to this nice boy.'
- it's raining again.
It's been raining since Christmas. (NOT It's raining since Christmas.)
- Are you learning English?
How longhaveyou been learning English? (NOT How longarcyou learning English?)
- 'I hear you're working at Smiths.'
'Yes, I've been working therefor about three months.' (NOT ... I'm working therefor about throe months.')
For the difference between since and/or in this situation, see 214.
4 progressive and simple: continuation/completion
Both the present perfect tenses (simple and progressive) can be used to talk about recent actions and
situations that have present results. There is an important difference. The present perfect progressive
focuses on the action/situation itself, looking at it as a continuous, extended activity (not necessarily
finished). The simple present perfect, on the other hand, looks more at the ideas of completion and
present result. Compare:
~ I must have a bath. I've been gardening all afternoon. (focus on continuous activity)
I've planted a lot of new rose bushes, (focus on result) ~ I've been reading your book. (focus on
continuous activity)
I've read your book. (focus on completion) ~ I've been learning irregular verbs all afternoon. (focus on
continuous activity)
I've learnt all my irregular verbs, (focus on completion) ~ Sorry about the mess - I've been painting the
house. (focus on continuous activity)
I've painted two rooms since lunchtime. (focus on completion)
Who's been sleeping in my bed? (emphasis on continuous activity -makes the action sound longer and
more annoying)
I think she's slept enough - I'll wake her up. >
page 425


5
_--.-^.perfect tenses 42, progressive and simple: repeated actions
We can use the present perfect progressive to talk about repeated
and events, but not if we say how often they have happened fhp actlons
stresses the idea of completion - see above). Compare: ^use this
I've been playing a lot of tennis recently.
I've played tennis three times this week.
6 progressive and simple: temporary and permanent
We often prefer the present perfect progressive to talk about more actions and situations; when we talk
about longer-lasting or perma ^"^ situations we often prefer the simple present perfect. Compare- nt
- That man has been standing on the corner all day.
For 900 years the castle has stood on the hill above the village.
- I haven't been working very well recently. He hasn't worked for years.
- I've been living in Sue's flat for the last month. My parents have lived in Bristol all their lives.
Generally, however, both progressive and simple tenses are possible in cases like these, with a slight
difference of emphasis.
It's been raining/It's rained steadily since last Saturday. Harry has been working/has worked in the same
job for thirty years.
We generally use the progressive to talk about continuous change or
development, even if this is permanent.
Scientists believe that the universe has been expanding steadily since the beginning of time.
7 non-progressive verbs
Some verbs are not used in progressive forms (see 451), even if the meaning
is one for which a progressive form is more suitable.
I've only known her for two days. (NOT I've only been knowing hef...) She's had a cold since Monday.
(NOT She's been having a cold...)
421 past time (7): the past perfect tenses
1 forms
simple past perfect
Affirmative
I had worked you
had worked etc

Question

Negative


had I worked? had
you worked? etc

I had not worked you had
not worked
etc

page
426

past perfect progressive



[Affirmative"Question

Negative

I had been working had I been working?
you had been had you been working
working?
etc etc

I had not been working
you had not been
working etc



For passives (e.g. The work had been done), see 407.
2 simple past perfect: use
The basic meanings of the simple past perfect are 'earlier past' and 'completed in the past'. A common
use is to 'go back' when we are already talking about the past, so as to make it clear that something had
already happened at the time we are talking about.
I realised that we had met before. (NOT I realised that we met before.)
(NOT -I rcalised-tha^wo have met before.) When I arrived at the party, Lucy had already gone home.
(NOT .. .-fcucy already went home.) (NOT ... Lucy has already gone homo.)
The past perfect is common after past verbs of saying and thinking, to talk about things that had happened
before the saying or thinking took place. I told her that I had finished. (NOT ... that I (have) finished.) I
wondered who had left the door open. I thought I had sent the cheque a week before.
For sentences like / arrived before she had finished unpacking (where a past perfect refers to
a time later than the time of the main verb), see 96.3. For more about tenses in indirect speech, see 481.
3 past perfect progressive: use
We use the past perfect progressive to talk about longer actions or situations which had continued up to
the past moment that we are thinking about, or
shortly before it.
At that time we had been living in the caravan for about six months. When I found Mary, I could see that
she had been crying.
4 progressive and simple: differences
Progressive tenses are often used to talk about more temporary actions and situations; when we talk
about longer-lasting or permanent situations we prefer simple tenses (though both forms are often
possible in the same situation, with a slight difference of emphasis). Compare:
My legs were stiff because I had been standing still for a long time. They lived in a castle which had stood
on a hill above the village for
800 years.
Progressive forms generally emphasise the continuation of an activity; we •'• use simple tenses to
emphasise the idea of completion. Compare:
I had been reading science fiction, and my mind was full of strange images. I had read all my magazines,
and was beginning to get bored. >
page 427


._._,.-,.-__--.---.--.. ...i -I^-^L tenses 421
Some verbs are not normally used in progressive forms (see 451) gyp ." meaning is one for which a
progressive form would be more suitable ttle / hadn't known her for very long when we got married. (NOT
44wdn't been knowing-her...)
5 time conjunctions
We can use time conjunctions to talk about two actions or events that
happen one after the other. Usually the past perfect is not necessary in rti cases, though it can often be
used. ese
After he (had) finished his exams he went to Paris fora month She didn 'tfeel the same after her dog (had)
died. As soon as I (had) put the phone down it rang again. The past perfect can help to mark the first
action as separate, independent the second, completed before the second started. In contrast, the simole
n can suggest that the first action 'leads into' the other, or that there is a caus and-effect link between
them. Compare:
- When I had opened the windows I sat down and had a cup of tea.
(NOT -When I opened the windows I-sa^down...) When I opened the window the cat jumped out.
(More natural than When I had opened the windows...)
- When I had written my letters I did some gardening.
(NOT When I wrote my letters-! did some gardening.) When I wrote to her she came at once.
The past perfect is rather more common with when than with other time conjunctions (when has several
meanings, so the exact time relations may have to be shown by the verb tense).
6 unrealised hopes and wishes; things that did not happen
The past perfect can be used to express an unrealised hope, wish etc.
/ had hoped we would be able to leave tomorrow, but it's beginning to Iwk difficult.
He had intended to make a cake, but he ran out of time. After if, wish and would rather, the past perfect
can be used to talk about past events that did not happen.
If I had gone to university I would have studied medicine.
I wish you had told me the truth.
I'd rather she had asked me before borrowing the car.
7 past perfect not used
Past perfect tenses are normally only used as described above. The past perfect is not used simply to say
that something happened some time ag . to give a past reason for a present situation.
General Gary, who commanded a parachute regiment for OTfl/9''^efl.J i
now living in retirement. (NOT General Car)', who hadem^^ma{"'^ I left some photos to be developed. Are
they ready yet? (NOT I had left some photos...)
99 past verb form with present or future meaning
A oast tense does not always have a past meaning. In some kinds of sentence pcan use verbs like I had,
you went or I was wondering to talk about the
present or future.
1 after if, unless, supposingetc
After if unless and words with similar meanings, we often use past forms to refer to the present or future.
If I had the money now I'd buy a car.
If you caught the ten o'clock train tomorrow you could be in Edinburgh by supper-time, unless the train
was delayed, of course.
You look as if you were just about to scream.
Supposing we didn't go on holiday next year?
For more about structures with if,.see 258-264. For supposing etc, see 546. For unless, see 574. For oil/;
see 74.
2 after it's time, would rather and wish
After these expressions, too, past forms can have present or future meanings. Ten o'clock - it's time you
went home. Don't come and see me today - I'd rather you came tomorrow. I wish I had a better memory.
For structures with it's time, see 304. For would rather, see 469.2-3. f of wish, see 601.
3 distancing in questions, requests etc
We can make questions, requests and offers less direct (and so more polite) by using past tenses. (For
more about 'distancing' of this kind, see 161.) Common formulae we. I wondered, I thought, I hoped, did
you want. Past progressive forms (/ was wondering etc) make sentences even less direct.
I wondered if you were free this evening.
I thought you might like some flowers.
Did you want cream with your coffee, sir?
I was hoping we could have dinner together.
4 'past'modals
The 'past' modal forms could, might, would and should usually have present or future reference; they are
used as less direct, 'distanced' forms of can, ^y, will and shall.
Couldyou help me for a moment?
I think it might rain soon.
Wouldyou come this way, please?
Alice should be here soon. >
page
428
page 429


423
past focus on continuing situations
If we are talking about the past, we usually use past tenses even for th' which are still true and situations
which still exist. ^s
Are you deaf? I asked how old you were.
I'm sorry we left Liverpool. It was such a nice place.
Do you remember that nice couple we met on holiday^ They were C weren't they? '7na".
I got this job because I was a good driver.
Bill applied to join the police last week, but he wasn't tall enough
For indirect speech examples, see 482. For past tenses with conditional meanings, see 556.
423 perfect verb forms
1 construction
Perfect verb forms are made with have + past participle.
She has lost her memory, (simple present perfect tense) They have been living in France for the last year.
(present perfect progressive tense)
' ' / told him that I had never heard of the place, (simple past perfect tense) When I got there the house
had been pulled down.
(simple past perfect passive tense) We will have finished by tomorrow afternoon.
(simple future perfect tense) I'm sorry to have disturbed you. (perfect infinitive) Havingseen the film, I don't
want to read the book. (perfect -ing form)
terminology and use
A perfect verb form generally shows the time of an event as being earlier than some other time (past,
present or future). But a perfect form does not only show the time of an event. It also shows how the
speaker sees the event -perhaps as being connected to a later event, or as being completed by a certain
time. Because of this, grammars often talk about 'perfect aspect' rather than 'perfect tenses'.
For details of the use of the various perfect verb forms, see the individual entries in the book.
personal pronouns (I): general
terminology and use
The words /, me, you, he, him, she, her, it, we, us, they and them are usu ^ called 'personal pronouns'.
(This is a misleading name: it, they and the used to refer to things as well as people.) One is also used as
a person pronoun (see 392). Who is an interrogative personal pronoun (see 59 I-
2
424
page
430
i-
sonal pronouns are used when it is not necessary to use or repeat more p^act noun phrases.
John's broken his leg. He'll be in hospital for a few days.
(NOT -fehn's broken his leg. John'11 be in hospital...) Tell Mary I miss her. (NOT Tell MaryImiss-Mwy-.}
2 you: dialect forms
Although standard modern English uses you for both singular and plural, pnarate forms exist in certain
dialects. Some speakers in Yorkshire use thu nr tha as a singular subject form and thee as a singular
object form; Irish dialects have a separate plural form ye, youse oryiz. Many Americans use you MVS (to
both men and women) as an informal second-person plural. In -southern US speech there is a familiar
second-person plural form you all (pronounced y'all), used instead of you when people wish to sound
friendly or intimate; there is also a possessive written you all's or (informally) y 'all's. Hi, everybody. How're
you all doing? What are you all's plans for Thanksgiving?
For the older English forms thee and thou, see 388.
For the use of he and she to refer to animals, ships etc, see 227.
For they, them, their with singular reference, see 505.
3 modification of you
You can be modified by adjectives in a few informal British expressions such as Poor/Clever/Lucky (old)
you! (This occasionally happens also with me.)
Note also the expressions you people, you lot, you guys, you two/three/etc. What are you guys doing
tonight?
4 subject and object forms
I, he, she, we and they are used mainly as subjects before verbs. Me, him, her, us and them are used as
objects and (especially in an informal style) in most other cases. (See 425 for details.)
/ need help. It's me that needs help.
Can you help me? You don't need help as much as me.
'Who needs help?' 'Me.' She's taller than him.
For pronoun-verb agreement in sentences like It's me that needs help, see 425.7.
5 it used to identify
We use it to refer to a person when we are identifying him or her. 'Who's that over there?' 'It's John Cook.'
(NOT 'He's John Cook.1} 'Is that our waiter?' 'No, it isn't.' (NOT Wo, he isn't.')
On the phone: Hello. It's Alan Williams. (NOT ... I'm Alan Williams.) I fs your sister who plays the piano,
isn't it?
Preferring to nothing etc
h not only refers to the names of things. We can also use it to refer to Whing, everything and all. f
Nothing happened, did it? Everything's all right, isn 't it?
I did all I could, but it wasn't enough.
page 431


r -,--"-•.^•y""-icu ^4
7 ft as 'empty' subject
We use it as a meaningless subject with expressions that refer to time weather, temperature, distances, or
just the current situation.
It's ten o'clock.
It's Monday again.
It rained for three days.
It's thirty degrees.
It's ten miles to the nearest petrol station.
It's terrible - everybody's got colds, and the central heating isn't workine Wasn 't it to vely there!
8 inclusive and exclusive we
We and us can include or exclude the listener or reader. Compare:
Shall we go and have a drink? (We includes the listener.) We're going for a drink. Would you like to come
with us? {We and us exclude the listener.)
9 MS meaning'me'
In very informal British speech, us is quite often used instead of me (especially as an indirect object). Give
us a kiss, love.
10 'general' uses of pronouns
We can refer to people in general, including the speaker and hearer.
We must love one another or die. One can refer to people in general, including the speaker (see 392).
One should never take advice. You can refer to people in general, including the hearer (see 392).
If you want adventure, romance and excitement, don't live in Lower Barton.
They can mean 'the people around' or 'the authorities' (see 392).
They say she's pregnant again. Why don't they pay nurses enough?
11 politeness
It is considered polite to use names or noun phrases, rather than he, she or they, to refer to people who
are present. . 'Dad said I could go out.' 'No, I didn't.'
(More polite than 'He said I could go out.'...) This lady needs an ambulance. However, pronouns need to
be used to avoid repetition (see 479).
Dad said he didn't mind... (NOT Dad said Dad didn 't-mind.. •) People usually mention themselves last in
phrases like you and I, she a Whydon'tyou and I go away for the weekend?
(NOT Why don't I and you...?) The invitation was for Tracyand me. (More polite than... for me and Tracy.)
432
9 personal pronouns cannot normally be left out
We cannot normally leave out personal pronouns, even if the meaning is clear without them (for some
exceptions, see below).
It's raining. (NOT Is raining.)
She loved the picture because it reminded her of home. (NOT .. .because reminded her of home.)
They arrested Alex and put him in prison. (NOT ... and put in prison.)
'Have some chocolate.' 'No, I don't like it.' (NOT '... I don't like.') However, in informal speech, subject
pronouns and/or auxiliary verbs are sometimes left out at the beginning of a sentence. For details of this,
see 183.
Can't help you, I'm afraid. (= I can't...)
Seen Paul? (= Have you seen Paul?) , Note that we seldom put it after know. See 306 for details.
'It's getting late.' 'I know.' (NOT 'I know it.') After certain verbs (e.g. believe, think, suppose), we use so
rather than it. (For details, see 515.)
'Is that the manager?' 'I believe so.' (N o T ... 'I believe (it).') In British English, personal pronouns can be
dropped after prepositions in descriptive structures with have and with.
All the trees have got blossom on (them).
He was carrying a box with cups in (it).
13 infinitive clauses
Object pronouns are not normally used in infinitive clauses if the object of the infinitive has just been
mentioned. (See 285.4 for details and exceptions.) She's easy to please. (NOT She's easy to please her.)
The pie looked too nice to eat. (NOT ... too nice to cat it.} The bridge wasn't strong enough to drive over.
(NOT ... to drive over it.) This dish takes two hours to prepare.
14 one subject is enough
One subject is enough. We do not usually use a personal pronoun to repeat a subject that comes in the
same clause.
My car is parked outside. (NOT My car it is parked outside.)
The boss really gets on my nerves.
(NOT The boss he really gets on my nerves.)
The situation is terrible. (NOT It is terrible the situation.) However, structures like this are sometimes
possible in very informal speech.
That woman, I'll be glad when she goes back home.
Ifs terrible, the unemployment down there.
He's not a bad bloke, Jeff.
It's a horrible place, London.
^or more about 'reinforcement tags', see 472.
^or it as a 'preparatory subject' for an infinitive or a clause, see 301.
Por it as a 'preparatory object', see 302. ^•
page 433


,.mv -"fins 43;.
15 personal and relative pronouns
We do not use personal pronouns to repeat the meaning of relative pronouns (see 473.5).
That's the girl who lives in the flat upstairs. (NOT .. .n>he-she4nie& Here's the money (that) you lent me.
(NOT Here's the money (that) you lent me it.)
In modern English, the structure he/she who... (meaning 'the person wh is very unusual. °J The narsf^fi
siftif^ //a^-,**/," /""*"'-- - '
is very unusual. The pel
(OR
<_, ^ fCtS i^iy uilUSUcU.
The person who leaves last should put the lights out.
(OR Whoever leaves last...) (NOT He/Shc who leaves last...)
425 personal pronouns (2): subject and object forms
1 pronouns with two forms
Six English pronouns have one form when they are used as subjects, and a
different form for other uses - for example, when they are the objects of verbs or prepositions.
Subject

Object

I

me

he

him

she

her

we

us

they

them

who

whom

Compare:
- I like dogs.
Dogs don't like me.
- We sent her some flowers. She sent us some/lowers.
- This is Mr Perkins, who works with me.
This is Mr Perkins, with whom I am working at the moment. Whomever is not normally used in modern
English.
2 informal use of object forms
In informal English, we use object forms not only as the objects of verbs an prepositions, but also in most
other cases where the words do not come before verbs as their subjects. Object forms are common, for
example, in one-word answers and after be.
'Who said that?' '(It was) him.' 'Who's that?' '(It's) me.'
In a more formal style, we often prefer to use subject form + verb wher possible.
'Who said that?' 'He did.' (BUT NOT ^Her')
page
434
3
4
y
nssible to use a subject form after be, but this is extremely formal, and is n '^Iv considered over-correct
(especially in British English).
us it is I. It was he.
. forms are sometimes used in co-ordinated subjects with and in
f1 mal speech; this is considered incorrect in more formal usage. ln John and me are going skiing this
weekend. (More correct: John and I...)
I in objects
J is often used informally in co-ordinated objects; this is also considered
incorrect in more formal usage.
Between you and I, I think his marriage is in trouble. (More correct: Between you and me...)
That's a matter for Peter and I. (More correct:... for Peter and me.) Some people use forms like you and I
as objects because they have been corrected at school for using you and me as a subject, and
consequently have a vague sense that you and me is always wrong.
who(m) in questions
Whom is not often used in informal English. We prefer to use who as an object, especially in questions.
Who did they arrest?
Who did you go with?
We use whom in a more formal style; and we must use whom after a preposition. '
Whom did they arrest? (formal)
With whom did you go? (very formal)
who(m) in relative clauses
In identifying relative clauses, (see 474), whom is unusual. Either we leave out the object pronoun, or we
use that or who (see 473-474 for details).
There's the man (that)f(who) we met in the pub last night. In non-identifying relative clauses (see 474), we
usually use whom as an object when necessary (but these clauses are not very common in informal
English).
This is John Perkins, whom you met at the sales conference. I have a number of American relatives, most
of whom live in Texas.
who(m) he thought etc
In a sentence like He was trying to find an old school friend, who(m) he thought was living in New
Zealand, people are often unsure whether to use whom (because it seems to be the object of the first
following verb) or who (because it is the subject of the second verb). Who is considered more correct, but
whom is quite often used. Another example:
There is a child in this class who(m) I believe is a musical genius. h cases with a following infinitive, usage
is mixed, but whom is considered "lore correct.
There is a child in the class who(m) I believe to be a musical genius. >
page 435


- o «2g
7 Jt is/was me/I + relative clause
When a relative clause comes after an expression like It is/was me/I thp two possibilities: are
object form + that (very informal)
It's me that needs your help. It was him that told the police.
subject form + who (very formal)
It is I who need your help. It was he who told the police.
We can avoid being too formal or too informal by using a different structur He was the person/the one who
told the police.
8 mixed subject and object
Sometimes a pronoun is the object of a verb or preposition, but the subject of a following infinitive or
clause. Normally an object form is used in this case.
It's for him to decide. (NOT -it's for he to decide.} I think it's a good idea for you and me to meet soon.
(Considered more correct than... for you and I to meet soon.) Everything comes to him who waits.
(Considered more correct than ...to he who waits.)
9 as, than, but and except
After as and than, object forms are generally used in an informal style, especially in British English.
My sister's nearly as tall as me.
I can run faster than her.
In a more formal style, subject forms are used; they are usually followed by verbs.
My sister's nearly as tall as I am. I can run faster than she can.
But and except are followed by object forms (see 116 and 200). Everybody but me knew what was
happening. Everybody except him can come.
426 piece-and group-words
1 pieces
To talk about a limited quantity of something we can use a word for a pie^ or unit, together with of, before
an uncountable noun. The most general words of this kind are piece and bit. Bit is informal, and usually
suggests a small quantity.
a piece/bit of cake/bread
some pieces/bits of paper/wood
a piece/bit of news/information
436
Other words are less general, and are used before particular nouns. Some common examples:
a bar of chocolate I soap
a blade of grass
a block of ice
a drop of water/oil/vinegar
a grain ofsandl salt! rice/corn
an item of informationlnewslclothingi furniture
a length of material
a loaf of bread
a lump of sugar/coal
a slice of bread I cake I meat
a speck of dust
a sheet of paper/metal/plastic/stamps
a stick of dynamite I chalk/celery
a strip of cloth/tape/land/water
a suit of clothes/armour
not a... of...
Some of these 'piece' words can be used in a negative structure meaning 'no... at all'.
There's not a grain of truth in what he says.
There hasn't been a breath of air all day.
We haven't got a scrap (of food) to eat.
He came downstairs without a stitch of clothing on.
pairs
Pair is used for many things that normally go in twos, and with plural nouns
that refer to some two-part objects (see 501.7).
a pair of shoes/socks! ear-rings a pair of glasses I binoculars a pair of trousers/jeans I pyjamas a pair of
scissors/pliers ^-
collections
Special words are used before certain nouns to talk about groups or collections.
a bunch of flowers a crowd of people
a flock of sheep/birds a herd of cattle I goats
a pack of cards (US a deck of cards)
Set is used before many uncountable and plural nouns referring to groups which contain a fixed number of
things.
a set ofcutlery/napkinsldishesltyreslsparking plugs/spanners
rm "bit as a modifier before adjectives and adverbs, see 106. ror a too/a..., see 154.
Fora" amount, a lot, a large number etc, see 326. rorsort, type, kind etc, see 526.
page 437


place 437
427 place
In an informal style, place can often be followed directly by an infinitiv relative clause, with no connecting
relative word or preposition. This is or particularly common in American English. I'm looking for a place to
live.
(More formal:... a place to live in OK ...a place in which to live} There's no place to sit in this room.
You remember the place we had lunch?
(More formal:... the place we had lunch at? OK ...the place at wh' h where we had lunch?)
I went back to the place I bought the scarf, but it was closed. Note also the informal expression go places,
meaning 'become very successful in life'.
They always said I'd go places, but they never told me how bonne the places would be.
For similar structures with way, time and reason, see 477.3.
428 play and game
1 nouns
A play is a piece of dramatic literature/written for the theatre, radio or television.
'Julius Caesar' is one of Shakespeare's early plays. A game is an activity like, for example, chess, football
or bridge.
Chess is a very slow game. (NOT ... a very slowplay.) The uncountable noun play can be used to mean
'playing' in general.
Children learn a great deal through play.
2 verbs
People act in plays or films, and play games or musical instruments.
My daughter is acting in her school play this year.
Have you ever played rugby football? , . Play can be used with the same meaning as act before the name
of a character in a play or film.
I'll never forget seeing Olivier play Othello.
429 please and thank you
1 requests
We use please to make a request more polite.
Could I have some more rice, please?
'Would you like some help?' 'Yes, please.' Note that please does not change an order into a request.
Compare:
Stand over there, (order)
Please stand over there, (more polite order)
Couldyou stand over there, please? (polite request)
page
438
F1
^Q is a rather formal answer to a request for permission. e•no you mind if I open the window?' 'Please do.'
For more about requests, see 483.
when please is not used
We do not use please to ask people what they have said. 'I've got a bit of a headache.' 'I beg your
pardon?'
(NOT.-.-'Ptease^')
We do not use please when we give things to people. 'Haveyou got a pen I could use?' 'Yes, hereyou are.'
(NOT .. .-Weaser')
please is not used as an answer to Thank you (see below). •Thanks a lot.' 'That's OK.' (N o T ... 'Please.')
3 thank you and thanks
Thanks is more informal than thank you.
Thankyou. (NOT Thanks you.) Thankyou very much.
Thanks very much. Thanks a lot. (B u T N o T Thank you a lot.)
Thank goodness it's Friday. (NOT Thanks goodness...) Indeed can be used to strengthen very much.
Thankyou very much indeed. (BUT NOT normally Thankyou indeed.) Thank you for I Thanks for can be
followed by an -ing form. Possessives are unnecessary and are not used.
'Thankyou for coming.' 'Notatall. Thank you for having me.' (NOT -'Thank you for your coming.'...)
4 accepting and refusing
We often use Thankyou I Thanks like Yes, please, to accept offers.
'Would you like some potatoes?' 'Thankyou.' 'How many?' To make it clear that one wishes to refuse
something, it is normal to say No, thank you I No, thanks.
'Another cake?' 'No, thanks. I've eaten too many already.' Note that Yes, thanks is not used to accept
offers, but to confirm that things are all right.
'Have you got enough potatoes?' 'Yes, thanks.'
5 replies to thanks
In English, there is not an automatic answer to Thankyou; British people, especially, do not usually answer
when they are thanked for small things. If a reply is necessary, we can say Not at all (rather formal),
You're welcome, Don't mention it, That's (quite) all right or That's OK (informal British). Compare:
'Couldyou pass the salt?' 'Hereyou are.' 'Thanks.' (no answer)
'Here's your coat: "Thanks: (no answer)
'Thanks so much for looking after the children.' "That's all right. Any time.' (answer necessary)
or more about the language of common social situations, see 520.
page 439


430 point of view
431
432

From somebody's point of view is not quite the same as in somebodv'v view/opinion. It usually means
something more like 'from somebody's position in life' (for example as a student, as a woman, as a Greek
or as Catholic), and is used to talk about how somebody is affected by what happens. Compare:
- In my opinion, war is always wrong.
(NOT From my point of vie
ays wrong:)
He wrote about the war from the point of view of the ordinary soldi? In my view, it's a pretty good school.
You have to judge a school from the child's point of view. - In Professor Lucas's opinion, everybody should
work a 20-hour week
From the employers' point of view, a 20-hour week would cause a lot nf problems.
politics and policy
Politics (usually singular but always with -s - see 501.3) is used to talk about the theory and practice of
government, the profession of government, conflicts between governing groups, and related ideas.
I don't know much about politics, but I always support the Radical Conservative Centre Coalition Party.
You talk beautifully - you should be in politics. Policy means a 'political line' or a rule of behaviour (not
necessarily connected with politics).
After the war, British foreign policy was rather confused. (NOT ... British foreign politics...)
It's not my policy to believe everything I hear.
It's the firm's policy to employ a certain number of handicapped people.
possessive's: forms and grammar
spelling
singular noun + 's my father's car plural noun+' my parents'house regular plural + 's the children's room
"'etimes just add an apostrophe (') to a singular noun ending in -s, Mer and foreign names. '<.
•m.
\ Tess's family ^is's dog

starSfot^ Could you stand ffk.
page
440
, pronunciation
The ending 's is pronounced just like a plural ending (see 502). doctor's /'doktaz/ dog's /dogz/ president's
/'prezidsnts/ lack's /dsaeks/ Madge's /'maedyz/ Alice's /'aelisiz/
James's /'dseimziz/
The apostrophe in a word like parents' does not change the pronunciation at 11 But with singular classical
(ancient Greek and Roman) names ending in s', sometimes pronounce a possessive 's even when it is not
written. Oedipus' little problem /'i:dipas(iz)/
, possessive's and other determiners
A noun cannot normally have an article or other determiner with it as well as a possessive word (see 157).
Definite articles are usually dropped when
possessives are used.
the car that is John's = John's car (NOT the John'scar or John's the car) But a possessive word may of
course have its own article.
the car that is the boss's = the boss's car Compound nouns beginning with possessive words ('classifying
genitives') are treated differently. Articles belonging to the possessive word are
dropped.
He works as a Queen's Messenger. (NOT ... a the Queen's Messenger.) When we want to use a noun
with a/an or this/that etc as well as a possessive, we usually use the 'of mine' construction (see 434).
She's a cousin of John's. (NOT ... a John's cousin.)
I saw that stupid boyfriend of Angle's yesterday. (NOT ... that Angle's stupid boyfriend...)
4 possessive without a noun
We can use a possessive without a following noun, if the meaning is clear.
'Whose is that?' 'Peter's.'
We often talk about people's houses, shops, firms and churches in this way. The apostrophe is often
dropped in the names of shops and firms.
We had a nice time at John and Susan's last night.
I bought it at Smiths.
She got married at St Joseph's.
In modern English, expressions like the doctor, the dentist, the hairdresser, the butcher are often used
without's.
Alice is at the hairdresser('s).
Por the meanings and use of possessive 's forms, see 379,381. For double possessive structures like a
friend of John's, see 434.
433 possessives: my, mine etc
determiners: my, your etc
"fy, your, his, her, its, our and their are determiners (see 157), and are used 31 the beginning of noun
phrases. They are not adjectives (although they are sometimes called 'possessive adjectives' in grammars
and dictionaries). Have you seen my new coat? >
page 441


430
430 point of view
From somebody's point of view is not quite the same as in somebod • view/opinion. It usually means
something more like 'from someh ^' position in life' (for example as a student, as a woman, as a Greek0 s
Catholic), and is used to talk about how somebody is affected bv or as a happens. Compare: at
- In my opinion, war is always wrong.
(NOT From my paint nfiicw, u'nr is always wrens.) He wrote about the war from the point of view of the
ordinary sold'
- In my view, it's a pretty good school. r' You have to judge a school from the child's point of view.
- In Professor Lucas's opinion, everybody should work a 20-hour week From the employers' point of view,
a 20-hour week would cause a lot f problems.
431 politics and policy
Politics (usually singular but always with -s - see 501.3) is used to talk about the theory and practice of
government, the profession of government, conflicts between governing groups, and related ideas.
I don't know much about politics, but I always support the Radical Conservative Centre Coalition Party.
You talk beautifully - you should be in politics. Policy means a 'political line' or a rule of behaviour (not
necessarily connected with politics).
After the war, British foreign policy was rather confused. (NOT ... British foreign politics...)
It's not my policy to believe everything I hear.
It's the firm's policy to employ a certain number of handicapped people.
432 possessive's: forms and grammar
1 spelling
singular noun + 's my father's car plural noun + ' my parents' house irregular plural + 's the children's room
We sometimes just add an apostrophe (') to a singular noun ending in -s, especially older and foreign
names.
Socrates' ideas. But's is more common.
Denis's terrible wife Tess's family
Dickens's novels Mr Lewis's dog We can add 's or' to a whole phrase.
the man next door's wife
Paul and Mary's dog
Henry the Eighth's six wives
page
440
pronunciation
The ending 's is pronounced just like a plural ending (see 502).
doctor's /'doktaz/ dog's /dogz/ president's /'prezidants/
Jack's /dgaeks/ Madge's /'maedsiz/ Alice's /'aelisiz/
James's /'dseimziz/
The apostrophe in a word like parents' does not change the pronunciation at ail But with singular classical
(ancient Greek and Roman) names ending in s',
sometimes pronounce a possessive's even when it is not written.
Oedipus' little problem /'i:dipas(iz)/
possessive 's and other determiners
A noun cannot normally have an article or other determiner with it as well as a possessive word (see 157).
Definite articles are usually dropped when possessives are used.
the car that is John's = John's car (NOT the John's car or John's the car) But a possessive word may of
course have its own article.
the car that is the boss's = the boss's car
Compound nouns beginning with possessive words ('classifying genitives') are treated differently. Articles
belonging to the possessive word are dropped.
He works as a Queen's Messenger. (NOT ... a the Queen's Messenger.) When we want to use a noun
with a/an or this/that etc as well as a ' possessive, we usually use the 'of mine' construction (see 434).
She's a cousin of John's. (NOT ... a John's cousin.)
I saw that stupid boyfriend of Angle's yesterday. (NOT .. .-thatAngie's stupid boyfriend...)
4 possessive without a noun
We can use a possessive without a following noun, if the meaning is clear.
•Whose is that?' 'Peter's.'
We often talk about people's houses, shops, firms and churches in this way. The apostrophe is often
dropped in the names of shops and firms.
We had a nice time at John and Susan's last night.
I bought it at Smiths.
She got married at St Joseph's.
In modern English, expressions like the doctor, the dentist, the hairdresser, the butcher are often used
without's.
Alice is at the hairdresser('s).
For the meanings and use of possessive 's forms, see 379,381. For double possessive structures like a
friend of John's, see 434.
433 possessives: my, mine etc
1 determiners: my, your etc
My, your, his, her, its, our and their are determiners (see 157), and are used at the beginning of noun
phrases. They are not adjectives (although they are sometimes called 'possessive adjectives' in grammars
and dictionaries). Have you seen my new coat? ^
page 441


•'•3', uune etc
One's is used in the same way.
It's easy to lose one's temper when one is criticised. Note the spelling of the possessive its. The
contraction it's is not a it means it is or it has (see 303). Compare: P^essive:
The dog's in a good mood. It's just had its breakfast. (NOT ... it's breakfast.)
2 possessives and other determiners
My, your etc already have a 'definite' meaning, and so do not need t with the. '""eused
She's lost her keys. (NOT ... the her keys.)
Other determiners like a, this, that cannot be used together with my Instead, we use the'... of mine'
structure (see 434). °' A friend of mine has just invited me to Italy. (NOT -Amy-friend ) How's that brother
of yours? (NOT ... that your brother?)
3 pronouns: mine, yours etc
Mine, yours, his, hers, ours and theirs are pronouns, used without followin nouns. °
That coat is mine.
Which car is yours? We do not use articles with mine etc.
Can I borrow your keys? I can 'tfind mine. (NOT I can 'tfind the nww.) Its and one's cannot be used as
pronouns, but one's own can be.
Other people's jobs always seem more interesting than one's own. (NOT ... than one's.)
4 whose
Whose is used both as a determiner and as a pronoun.
Whose bag is that? (determiner)
Whose is that bag? (pronoun)
Note the difference between whose (possessive) and who's (= who is or who has).
5 distributive use
After a plural possessive, we do not normally use a singular noun in the sense of'one each'. (For details,
see 507.)
The teacher told the children to open their books. (NOT .. .-thew-bwk)
6 articles and possessives
We sometimes use articles instead of my, your etc. This happens in prepositional phrases which refer to
the subject or object, mostly when we are talking about blows, pains and other things that happen to parts
of people's bodies. Compare:
/ patted her on the shoulder.
She's got a pain in the shoulder.
She's goto parrot on her shoulder.
(NOT She's got a parrot on the shoulder.)
rffi • m.wmm' '.«..miinM«ipu prerer iaa
other cases we do not normally use articles instead of possessives. KatY broke her arm mountain
climbing. (NOT Katy broke the arm...) He stood there, his eyes closed and his hands in his pockets,
looking half asleep. (NOT ... the eyes closed and the hands in the pockets...)
7 my own etc
Mv own, your own etc act as the possessive forms of the reflexive / emphatic pronouns myself, yourself
etc. Compare:
I'll do it myself. I'll do it in my own way. (NOT ... in myself's way.)
For southern US you all's, see 424.2. For the older English forms thy and thine, see 388. • For details of
myself etc, see 471. For own, see 400. For possessive forms of nouns (e.g. John's, the government's),
see 432.
434 possessives with of (a friend of mine etc)
We cannot usually put a possessive before another determiner and a noun. We can say my friend, Ann's
friend, a friend or that friend, but not a my friend or that Ann's friend. Instead, we use a structure with o/+
possessive.
determiner + noun + o/+ possessive
That policeman is a friend of mine. How's that brother of yours?
I met another boyfriend of Lucy's yesterday.
He's a cousin of the Queen's. She's a friend of my father's.
Have you heard this new idea of the boss's?
He watched each gesture of hers as if she was a stranger.
My work is no business of yours. The structure has a variant in which the noun does not have possessive
's:
this is sometimes used when talking about relationships.
He's a cousin of the Queen. She's a friend of my father. The word own is used in a similar structure (see
400).
I wish I had a room of my own.
435 prefer
When we say that we prefer one activity to another, two -ing forms can be used. The second can be
introduced by to or rather than (more formal). / prefer riding to walking. (NOT I prefer riding to walk.) She
prefers making toys for her children rather than buying them in
the shops.
Prefer can also be followed by an infinitive (this is normal after would prefer). The structure can be
continued by rather than with an infinitive or an -ing ," form.
/ would prefer to spend the weekend at home rather than drive/driving all the way to your mother's.
For "ore about to with -ing forms, see 295.2.
442
page 443


prepositions w: introduction
436
436 prepositions (I): introduction
1 vocabulary problems
It is difficult to learn to use prepositions correctly in a foreign laneuae English prepositions have several
different functions (for instance, one st known dictionary lists eighteen main uses of at), and these may
corresn to several different prepositions in another language. At the same time different prepositions can
have very similar uses (in the morning, on M morning, at night). Many nouns, verbs and adjectives are
normally used with particular prepositions: we say the reason for, arrive at, angry with somebody, on a
bus. Often the correct preposition cannot be guessed and one has to learn the expression as a whole. In
some expressions English h no preposition where one may be used in another language; in other
expressions the opposite is true. For details of some difficult cases of prepositional usage, see 437-442.
2 word order
In English, prepositions can come at the end of clauses in certain structures especially in an informal style.
For details, see 440.
Whatareyou thinking about? You're just the person I was looking for. She's not very easy to talk to. I hate
being shouted at.
3 -ing forms
When we use verbs after prepositions, we use -ing forms, not infinitives. For details, see 295,442.
She saved money by giving up cigarettes. When to is a preposition, it is also followed by -ing forms. For
details, see 295.2.
I look forward to seeing you soon.
4 prepositions before conjunctions
Prepositions are sometimes dropped before conjunctions and sometimes not. For details, see 441.
I'm not certain (of) what I'm supposed to do.
The question (of) whether they should turn back was never discussed.
5 prepositions and adverb particles
Words like on, off, up, down can function both as prepositions and as adverb particles. For the difference,
see 19. For verbs with prepositions and particles, see 582.
She ran up the stairs, (preposition) She rang me up. (adverb particle)
437 prepositions (2): after particular words and expressions
It is not always easy to know which preposition to use after a particular noun, verb or adjective. Here are
some of the most common con'lblnatloat' including a number which cause difficulty to students of English.
Note alternatives are sometimes possible, and that American and British us g
oaee444
^prcp^si^^iio \^i. diLci pdiLimiai wuiua aiiu cApicaaiorra" "wrr"'
rnetimes differ. There is only room for very brief notes here; for more s0 pjete information about usage with
a particular word, consult a good
dictionary.
accuse somebody of something (NOT 4w)
She accused me of poisoning her dog. afraid of (NOT^)
Are you afraid of spiders? agree with a person, opinon or policy
/ entirely agree with you.
He left the firm because he didn 't agree with their sales policy. agree about a subject of discussion
We agree about most things. agree on a matter for decision
Let's try to agree on a date. agree to a suggestion
I'll agree to your suggestion if you lower the price. angry with (sometimes at) a person for doing
something.
I'm angry with her for lying to me. angry about (sometimes at) something
What are you so angry about? anxious about (= worried about)
I'm getting anxious about money. anxious for (= eager to have)
We're all anxious for an end to this misunderstanding. anxious + infinitive (= eager, wanting)
She's anxious to find a better job. apologise to somebody for something
I think we should apologise to the Smiths.
I must apologise for disturbing you. arriveatorh^NOT^te)
What time do we arrive at Cardiff?
When did you arrive in England? ask: see 78.
bad at (NOT w)
I'm not bad at tennis. believe a person or something that is said (= accept as truthful/true)
(no preposition)
Don't believe her.
I don't believe a word she says. ^ believe in God, Father Christmas etc (= believe that,.. exists; trust)
/ half believe in life after death.
If you believe in me I can do anything. belong in/on/etc (= go, fit, have its place in/on/etc)
Those glasses belong on the top shelf. belong to (= be a member of)
I belong to a local athletics club. •"lie with cold, red with anger etc
My hands were blue with cold when I got home. wrrow: see 108.
page 445


--- "° ana expressions 4,
'3? care: see 127.
clever at (NOT 4fr)
I'm not very clever at cooking.
congratulate/congratulations on something (US also for) I must congratulate you on your exam results.
Congratulations on your new job!
congratulate/congratulations on/for doing something
He congratulated the team on/for having won all their games crash into (NOT USUALLY against)
/ wasn 't concentrating, and I crashed into the car in front. depend/dependent on (NOT-from or-of)
We may play football - it depends on the weather.
He doesn 't want to be dependent on his parents.
But: independent of details of
Write now for details of our special offer. die of or from
More people died of flu in 1919 than were killed in the First World War A week after the accident he died
from his injuries. different: see 158.
difficulty with something, (in) doing something (NOT difficulties to...) I'm having difficulty with my travel
arrangements.
You won't have much difficulty (in) getting to know people in Italy. disappointed with somebody
My father never showed if he was disappointed with me. disappointed with/at/about something
You must be pretty disappointed with/at/about your ex& (a) discussion about something
We had a long discussion about politics. (to) discuss something (no preposition)
We'd better discuss your travel plans. divide into (NOT -in)
The book is divided into three parts. dream of (= think of, imagine)
I often dreamed of being famous when I was younger. dream about/of (while asleep)
What does it mean if you dream about/of mountains? dress(ed) in (NOT -with)
Who's the woman dressed in green? drive into (NOT against)
Granny drove into a tree again yesterday.
enter into an agreement, a discussion etc
We've just entered into an agreement with Carsons Ltd. enter a place (no preposition)
When I entered the room everybody stopped talking. example of (NOT ier)
Sherry is an example of a fortified wine.
explain something to somebody (NOT explain somebody somethiflg) Could you explain this rule to me?
Sitiolo v-" •
t your exam results.
ft^' ^'"^'^S^0 weeks fighting with the tax office. J:SS"oforby:see405.5.
^nd out of a car, taxi or small boat get in(to) a"" ^ I found the radio had been stolen.
^Tl and off a train, plane, bus, ship, (motor)bike or horse S^yie getting off-the train in ten minutes.
_.,lat (NOT 4n) ff^ re you any good at tennis?
ithol idea of.. .ing (NOT 4he4dea^...)
I don't like the idea of getting marriedyet.
w ^L boss has been ill with flu this week.
Impressed with /by
I'm very impressed with/by your work.
Increase in activity, output etc (NOT -of) I'd like to see a big increase in productivity.
Independent of or sometimes from; independence from
She got a job so that she could be independent of her parents. When did India get its independence from
Britain?
Insist on (NOT^to)
George's father insisted on paying.
Interest/interested in (NOT 4or)
When did your interest in social work begin ? Not many people are interested in grammar.
klndto(NOTWHfr)
People have always been very kind to me.
(a) lack of
Lack of time prevented me from writing. (to) lack (no preposition)
Your mother lacks tact. (to) be lacking in
She is lacking in tact. laugh at
I hate being laughed at. laugh about
We'll laugh about this one day. listen to
.fy011 ^on't listen to people, they won't listen toyou. rook at (= 'point one's eyes at')
Stop looking at me like that. look after (= take care of)
i1^"^0'" ^^mg after me when I was ill. "ookfo^trytofind)
^an you help me look for my keys?
"'^e, made of/from: see 328.
page
446


marriage to; get/be married to (NOT -with)
Her marriage to Philip didn 't last very long.
How long have you been married to Sheila? marry somebody (no preposition)
She married her childhood sweetheart.
near (to): see 355. nice to (NOT with)
You weren't very nice to me last night.
operate on a patient
They operated on her yesterday evening.
pay for something that is bought (NOT pay something)
Excuse me, sir. You haven't paid for your drink. . pleased with somebody
The boss is very pleased with you. pleased with/about/at something
/ wasn 't very pleased with/about/at my exam results. polite to (NOT with)
Try to be polite to Uncle Richard for once. prevent... from.. .ing (NOT -to)
The noise from downstairs prevented me from sleeping. proof of (NOT-for)
/ want proof of your love. Lend me some money.
reason for (NOT -eH
Nobody knows the reason for the accident. remind of (and see 478)
She reminds me of a girl I was at school with. responsible/responsibility for
Who's responsible for the shopping this week? rude to (NOT with)
Peggy was pretty rude to my family last weekend. run into (= meet)
/ ran into Philip at Victoria Station this morning.
search (without preposition) (= look through; look everywhere in/on) They searched everybody's luggage.
They searched the man in front of me from head to foot. search for (= look for)
The customs were searching for drugs at the airport. shocked at/by
/ was terribly shocked at/by the news of Peter's accident. shout at (aggressive)
If you don't stop shouting at me I'll come and hit you. shout to (= call to)
Mary shouted to us to come in and swim. smile at
If you smile at me like that I'll give you anythingyou want. sorry about something that has happened I'm
sorry about your exam results.
tor/about something that one has done sorly yyrryfpr/about breaking your window.
," for a person J feel really sorry for her children. oeak to; speak with (especially US) , Could I speak
to/with your father for a moment?
suffe^01" My wife is suffering from hepatitis.
surprised at/by
Everybody was surprised at/by the weather.
take part in (NOT at)
I don't want to take part in any more conferences. think of/about (NOT 4hink-te)
I'm thinking of studying medicine.
I've also thought about studying dentistry. the thought of (NOT tho thought to)
/ hate the thought of going back to work. throw... at (aggressive)
Stop throwing stones at the cars. throw... to (in a game etc)
If you get the ball, throw it to me. translate into (NOT -ifh)
Could you translate this into Greek for me? trip over
He tripped over the cat and fell downstairs. typical of (NOT -for)
The wine's typical of the region.
write: see 583. wrong with
What's wrong with Rachel today?
For of after determiners, see 157. For by and other prepositions with frightened, surprised, shocked and
similar words,
see 405.5. For more on complementation of nouns, see 377. For complementation of verbs, see 579.
For complementation of adjectives, see 12. For more details of the use of the words listed here, and for
prepositions used after words
not listed here, see a good dictionary.
page
448
page 449


8 prepositions (3): before particular words and expressions
This is a list of a few expressions which often cause problems. For
information about other preposition + noun combinations, see a e dictionary. ' " od
at the cinema; at the theatre; at a party; at university What's on at the cinema this week?
a book (written) by Joyce; a concerto (composed) by Mozart; a film (di byFassbinder (NOT ^f or-from)
I've never read anything by Dickens.
by car/bike/bus/train/boat/plane/land/sea/air; on foot (but in the car on a bus etc) ,
Let's take our time and go by boat.
for... reason
My sister decided to go to America for several reasons.
from... point of view (NOT according to or-after) Try to see it from my point of view.
in... opinion (NOT according to or -after - see 8)
In my opinion, she should have resigned earlier. In the end = finally, after a long time
In the end, I got a visa for Russia. at the end = at the point where something stops
/ think the film's a bit weak at the end. in pen, pencil, ink etc
Please fill in the form in ink. in a picture, photo etc (NOT -ea)
She looks much younger in this photo. in the rain, snow etc
/ like walking in the rain. in a suit, raincoat, shirt, skirt, hat etc
Who's the man in the funny hat over there? in a... voice
Stop talking to me in that stupid voice.
on page 120 etc (NOT in/at)
There's a mistake on page 120. on the radio; on TV; on the phone
Is there anything good on TV tonight?
It's Mrs Ellis on the phone: she says it's urgent. on time = at the planned time; neither late nor early
Peter wants the meeting to start exactly on time. in time = with enough time to spare; before the last
moment
He would have died if they hadn't got him to the hospital in time-
prepositions (4): expressions without prepositions
This is a list of some common expressions in which we do not use -,,-epositions, or can leave them out.
discuss, enter, marry, lack, resemble and approach
These verbs are normally followed by direct objects without prepositions. V/e must discuss your plans.
(NOT .. ,-diseuss about your plans.) Conversation stopped as we entered the church.
(NOT ... entered in(to) the church.) She married a friend of her sister's. (NOT ... married with...) He's
clever, but he lacks experience. (NOT ... lacks of...)
HC S l/n^l/i", •-/"•- • *"-' - ^.^^. .^..^~. ^.. *, ^ ... ... «,^ . . ./
The child does not resemble either of its parents. (NOT .. .resemble to...) The train is now approaching
London Paddington. (NOT .. .approaching to...)
next, last etc
prepositions are not used before a number of common expressions of time beginning next, last, this, that
(sometimes), one, every, each, some, any (in an informal style), all.
See you next Monday. (NOT ... on next Monday.)
The meeting's this Thursday.
I'll never forget meeting you that afternoon.
We met one Tuesday in August.
Come any day you like.
The party lasted all night. Note also tomorrow morning, yesterday afternoon etc.
days of the week
In an informal style, we sometimes leave out on before the names of the days of the week. This is very
common in American English.
Why don't you come for a drink (on) Monday evening? ,-
a meaning'each'
No preposition is used in expressions like three times a day, sixty miles an hour, eighty pence a kilo.
Private lessons cost L20 an hour.
For Per in expressions like these, see 385.19.
^at time...? etc
^ usually leave out at before what time.
What time does Granny's train arrive?
(More natural than At what time...?) n an informal style, we can also leave out on before what/which
day(s).
What day is your hair appointment?
^Vhich day do you have your music lesson? >
,450
page 451


6 about
In an informal style, at is often dropped before about+ time exorp • /'// see you (at) about 3 o 'clock. sx'
7 duration
In an informal style, for is often left out in expressions that say ho' something lasts.

iositions (5): at the ends of clauses
I've been here (for) three weeks now. How long are you staying (for)?
'wiono
8 measurement expressions etc after be
Expressions containing words like height, weight, length, size, shape
colour are usually connected to the subject of the clause by the verb 'be without a preposition.
What colour are her eyes? (NOT Of what colour... ?) He is just the right height to be a policeman. She's
the same age as me. His head's a funny shape.
"rt i I'm the same weight as I was twenty years ago. • . What shoe size are you?
9 fin) this way etc
We often leave out in (especially in informal speech) in expressions like (in) this way, (in) the same way,
(in) another way etc.
They plant corn (in) the same way their ancestors used to SOOyearsago.
10 home
We do not use to before home (see 251). I'm going home.
In informal English (especially American), at can be left out before home. Is anybody home?
11 place
In an informal style, to can be dropped in some expressions with the word
place. This is normal in American English. Let's go (to) some place where it's quiet. I always said you'd go
places. (= become successful)
12 infinitive structures
In an informal style, prepositions can be dropped in the structure noun + infinitive + preposition (see
286.5).
She has no money to buy food (with). We have an hour to do it (in). This is particularly common with the
noun place. We need a place to live (in). She had no place to go (to).
For the use of prepositions after near, see 355.
440 P^ , introduction
sition often connects two things: (1) a noun, adjective or verb that A prepo ^ ^^ ^ ^ 'prepositional object' - a
noun phrase or pronoun
peonies after the preposition.
This is a present for you. He's looking at her. Fin really angry with Joe. They live in a small village.
me structures we may put the prepositional object at or near the In ^ning of a clause. In this case, the
preposition does not always go with it -•av stay together with 'its' verb, adjective or noun at the end of the
clause. ^his happens especially in four cases:
^-questions: Who's the present for?
relative structures: It's Joe that I'm really angry with.
passives: She likes to be looked at.
infinitive structures: The village is pleasant to live in.
2 u/ft-questions
When a question word is the object of a preposition, the preposition most often comes at the end of the
clause, especially in informal usage.
Who's the present for? [For whom is the present? is extremely formal.)
What are you looking at? Who did you go with?
Where did she buy it from? Which flight is the general travelling on?
What kind of films are you interested in? This also happens in indirect wft-questions, and in what-clauses
which are not questions.
Tell me what you're worried about. What a lot of trouble I'm in! Some questions consist simply of question
word + preposition.
What with? Who for?
However, this structure is unusual when there is a noun with the question word.
With what money? (NOT What money with?)
For more information about question structures, see 461-466.
3 relative clauses
When a relative pronoun is the object of a preposition, the preposition also often goes at the end of the
clause, especially in informal usage.
This is the house (that) I told you about.
(Less formal than... about which I told you.)
You remember the boy (who) I was going out with?
She's the only woman (who) I've ever really been in love with.
That's what I'm afraid of.
Because whom is unusual in an informal style, it is very rare in clauses that Gnd with prepositions (see
474.7).
Por more information about relatives, see 473-477. ^
page
452
page 453


r ^ --,."'causes 44g
passives
In passive structures, prepositions go with their verbs. I don't know where he is - his bed hasn't been slept
in. Carol was operated on last night. I hate being laughed at.
For more information about passives, see 407-414.
infinitive structures
Infinitive complements (see 285 - 286) can have prepositions with th She needs other children to play
with. "'cm.
Can you get me a chair to stand on? I've got lots of tapes to listen to. It's a boring place to live in. Their
house isn 't easy to get to.
exceptions
Many common adverbial expressions consist of preposition + noun nhra.
(e.g. with great patience, in a temper}. In these cases, the preposition is closely connected with the noun,
and is kept as near as possible to if it cannot usually be moved to the end of a clause. / admired the
patience with which she spoke.
(NOT ... the patience she spoke with-.} During and since are not normally put at the ends of clauses.
During which period did it happen?
(NOT Which period did it happen awing?) Since when have you been working for her?
(NOT When have you been working for her since?)
formal structures
In a more formal style, a preposition is often put earlier in questions and relative structures, before the
question word or relative pronoun.
With whom did she go?
It was the house about which he had told them.
She was the only woman with whom he had ever been in love. This can also happen in infinitive
complements, in a very formal style. A relative pronoun is used.
She needs other children with whom to play.
It is a boring place in which to live.
Note that after prepositions which and whom can be used, but not normally who and that.
Even in a very formal style, prepositions are not often put at the beginning °
questions which have be as the main verb.
Who is it for, madam? (NOT For whom is it?) , -jer.
And the structures where ...to, what... like and what ...for have a fixed Where shall I send itto? (BUT NOT
To where shall ^send-it?) What does she look like? (BUT NOT Like what-dees-she-leek?) What did you
buy that for? (BUT NOT For what did yeurbuy-th^^
page
454
Prepositions cannot be moved away from passive verbs even in a forma In my family, money was never
spoken about. (NOT ... about money was never spoken.)
p more information about formal and informal language, see 216.
For sentences like It's got a hole in (it); I like cakes with cream on (them), see 181.13.
For structures with worth, see 603.
AAl prepositions (6): before conjunctions
Prepositions can be followed by conjunctions in some cases but not in i
1 indirect speech; words for emotional reactions:
prepositions not used before that
Prepositions are not used directly before the conjunction that. In indire speech - after words that refer to
saying, writing, thinking etc - preposil are usually dropped before that-clauses. Compare:
- I knew about his problems. I knew that he had problems.
(NOT I knew about that he had problems.)
- She had no idea of my state of mind. She had no idea that I was unhappy.
(NOT -She had no idea of that I was unhappy.}
- I wasn 't aware of the time. I wasn't aware that it was so late.
(NOT -[-wasn't aware of that it was so late.) Prepositions are also dropped before that after many common
words ti refer to emotional reactions. Compare:
- We are sorry about the delay. We are sorry that the train is late.
(NOT ... sorry about that the train is late.)
- I was surprised at her strength.
I was surprised that she was so strong.
2 the fact that
In other cases (not involving indirect speech or words referring to emol reactions) prepositions cannot so
often be dropped before that-clauses Instead, the expression the fact is generally put between the
prepositio:
and that.
The judge paid a lot of attention to the fact that the child was unhappy at home.
(NOT -The^udgc paid a lot of attention to that the child...) (NOT -The-judgc paid a lot of attention that the
child...) He said the parents were responsible for the fact that the child had run away.
(NOT ... responsible for that the child had run away.} (NOT ... responsible that the child had run away.)
por "tore about the fact that, see 559.3.
page 45!


, , _,-_.. ,--_,._-.-.,. -..e *""'"o-*t"a niuilllives 44
3 question words
After some very common words like tell, ask, depend, sure, idea, look prepositions can be dropped before
who, which, what and other quest' words. This is especially common in indirect questions. Compare- lon
- Tell me about your trip.
Tell me (about) where you went.
- I asked her about her religious beliefs. I asked her whether she believed in God.
(More natural than / asked her about whether she believed in God.}
- We may be late - it depends on the traffic.
We may be late - it depends (on) how much traffic there is.
- I'm not sure of his method. I'm not sure how he does it.
(More natural than I'm not sure of how he does it.) • - Look at this.
Look (at) what I've got.
In other cases it is unusual or impossible to leave out the preposition. I'm worried about where she is.
(NOT -fm-worried where she is.) The police questioned me about what I'd seen.
(NOT The police questioned me what I'd seen:) There's the question of who's going to pay.
(More natural than... the question who's going to pay.) People's chances of getting jobs vary according to
whether they live in the
North or the South. (NOT .. .-according whether...) If does not follow prepositions; we use whether instead.
I'm worried about whether you're happy. (NOT -I'm worried about if you're happy.)
For the structures (with and without preposition) that are possible after a particular verb,
noun or adjective, see a good dictionary. For more about if and whether, see 593.
2 prepositions (7): -ing forms and infinitives
Prepositions are not normally used before infinitives in English. After verb/noun/adjective + preposition, we
usually use the -ing form of a following verb.
He insisted on being paid at once. (NOT He insisted on to be paid- • •) 1 An^'f in,,, !.--•-*-- -^-^-•--- • ' '
... " - --"
I don't like the idea of getting married. (NOT
I'm not very good at cooking. (NOT ... good at to cook.) In some cases we drop the preposition and use an
infinitive. Compare:
- He asked for a loan.
He asked to borrow some money.
- She was surprised at his mistake.
She was surprised to see what he had done.
- We're travelling for pleasure.
We're travelling to enjoy ourselves.
Sometimes two structures are possible. There is often a difference ot meaning or use. For more details,
see 296.
page
456
I'm interested in learning more about my family. I was interested to learn that my grandfather was Jewish.
For details of the structures that are possible after a particular verb, noun or adjective, see a good
dictionary.
A43 pr^6111 tenses (1): introduction
1 the two present tenses
Most English verbs have two 'present' tenses. Forms like I wait, she thinks are called "simple present' or
'present simple'; forms like/am waiting or she's thinking are called 'present progressive' or 'present
continuous'. Modal verbs like can or must (see 344-345) do not have progressive forms, and some other
verbs such as know or contain are rarely used in progressive forms (see 451). The two 'present' tenses
are used to refer to several different kinds of time.
2 general time: simple present
When we talk about permanent situations, or about things that happen regularly or all the time (not just
around now), we usually use the simple present (see 444 for details).
My parents live near Dover. Water freezes at 0 ° Celsius.
I go to London about three times a week.
3 around now: present progressive
When we talk about temporary continuing actions and events that are going on around now, we usually
use a present progressive tense (see 445 for details).
'What are you doing?' 'I'm reading.'
I'm going to a lot of parties these days.
4 series of events: simple present
When we talk about series of actions and events that are completed as we speak, we usually use simple
present tenses (see 446 for details).
Watch carefully. First I take a bowl and break two eggs into it. Next...
Taylor shoots -and it's a goal!
5 future time
In subordinate clauses, we often use present tenses to refer to the future (see 556 for details).
I'll go wherever you go.
Come and see us next week if you're passing through London.
6 duration
Note that we use a perfect tense, not a present tense, to say how long a present action or situation has
been going on. (See 418 and 420 for details.)
I've known her since 1960. (N o T I know her since 1960.)
I've been learning English for three years. (NOT I'm learning English for three years.)
page 457


- ""rouse ^
444 present tenses (2): the simple present tense
1 forms

I work you work he/she/it works we work they work
do I work? do you work?
does he/she/it work? do we work?
do they work?
I do not work you do not work
he/she/it does not work we do not work
they do not work
For passives (e.g. The work is done), see 407.
2 spelling of third person singular forms
Most verbs:
add -s to infinitive
Verbs ending in consonant +y:
change y to i and add -es
Verbs ending in -s, -z, -ch, -sh or -x:
add -es to infinitive
cry-+cries hurry-> hurries reply-replies
missmisses buzz-buzzes
watch-swatches push -pushes fix-> fixes

^
3 pronunciation of third person singular forms
The pronunciation of the - (e)s ending depends on the sound that comes
before it. The rules are exactly the same as for the pronunciation of the plural -(e)s ending-see 502 for
details.
Note the irregular pronunciation of says (/sez/, not /seiz/) and does (/dAZ/, not/du:z/).
4 use; general time
We often use the simple present to talk about permanent situations, or abou things that happen regularly,
repeatedly or all the time.
What do frogs eat? (NOT What are frogs eating?]
Water boils at 100" Celsius. (NOT Water is boiling
I play tennis every Wednesday.
Alice works for an insurance company.
page
458
oresent time: series of events
rh we talk about completed actions and events that happen as we speak write we usually use the simple
present. This happens, for example, in ^moiis'trations and commentaries (see 446 for more details). First I
take a bowl and break two eggs into it. Next...
(NOT firstrlam taking a bowl...) Lvdiard passes to Taylor. Taylor to Morrison, Morrison back to Taylor...
and Taylor shoots - and it's a goal!
g here comes... etc
Note the structures here comes... and there goes... Here comes your husband. (NOT Here is coming...)
There goes our bus - we'll have to wait for the next one.
7 promises etc
Sometimes we do things by saying special words (e.g. promising, swearing). We usually use the simple
present in these cases.
I promise never to smoke again. (NOT I'm promising...)
I swear that I will tell the truth...
I agree. (NOT I am agreeing.)
He denies the charge. (NOT -He is denying...)
8 formal correspondence
Some fixed phrases that are used in letter-writing can be expressed either in the simple present (more
formal) or in the present progressive (less formal). We write to advise you... (Less formal: We are writing
to let you know...) I enclose my cheque for L200. (Less formal: I am enclosing...) J look forward to hearing
from you.
(Less formal: I'm looking forward to hearing...)
9 instructions
The simple present is often used when we ask for and give directions and instructions (see 446.3 for more
details).
'How do I get to the station?' 'You go straight on to the traffic lights, then
you turn left,...'
10 stories
The simple present is common in informal narrative and in summaries of plays, stories etc (see 446 for
more details). In Act I, Hamlet meets the ghost of his father.
11 temporary situations: non-progressive verbs
We do not usually use the simple present to talk about temporary situations or actions that are only going
on around the present.
The kettle's boiling-shall I make tea? (NOT The kettle boils...) However, the simple present is used with
verbs that cannot normally be used in progressive forms (see 451).
1 like this wine very much. (NOT I'm liking...)
I like this wine very much. (NOT I'm liking. I believe you. (NOT I'm believing you.)
page 459


. ._.-- ^_.-.io-^'Mvc rense 443
12 talking about the future
We do not normally use the simple present to talk about the future I promise I won't smoke any more.
(NOT I promise I don't smoke any more.) We're going to the theatre this evening.
(NOT We go to the theatre this evening.) , "There's the doorbell.' Til get it.' (NOT -fget it.'}
However, the simple present is used to refer to future events which are timetabled (see 223).
His train arrives at 11.46. I start my new job tomorrow. And the simple present is often used instead of
will... in subordinate clauses that refer to the future. (For details, see 556).
I'll kill anybody who touches my possessions. (NOT.. .^vhe-wiU^eueh ) I'll phone you when I get home.
(NOT .. .-whenfVrget-hsme,) Note also the use of the simple present in suggestions with Why don't you
Why don't you take a day off tomorrow?
13 I hear etc
The simple present is used with a perfect or past meaning in introductory expressions like I hear, I see, I
gather, I understand (see 246).
/ hear you 're getting married.
I see there's been trouble down at the factory.
I gather Peter's looking for a job. Quotations are often introduced with... says.
No doubtyou all remember what Hamlet says about suicide.
It says in the paper that petrol's going up again.
For simple and progressive tenses in older English, see 388.
445 present tenses (3): the present progressive tense
1 forms
Affirmative

Question

Negative

I am working

am I working?

I am not working

you are working

are you working?

you are not working

etc

etc

etc

For passive forms (e.g. The work is being done), see 407.
2 use: 'around now*
We use the present progressive to talk about temporary actions an situations that are going on 'around
now': before, during and art moment of speaking.
Hurry up! We're all waiting for you! (NOT -We^tll-ivatt. -^ ^,s1) 'Whatareyou doing?' 'I'm writing letters.'
(NOT .. .^wifte^ettenr-
pag®
460
uftiv are you crying? Is something wrong? (NOT Why do you cry?...) He's working in Saudi Arabia at the
moment.
^Iso use the present progressive to talk about what is going on und a particular time that we are thinking
of. 310 At seven, when the post comes, I'm usually having breakfast. She doe'sn 't like to be disturbed if
she's working. You look lovely when you're smiling.
3 changes
WP also use the present progressive to talk about developing and changing
situations, even if these are very long-lasting. That child's getting bigger every day. The climate is getting
warmer. (NOT The climate gets warmer.) The universe is expanding, and has been since its beginning.
4 talking about the future
We often use the present progressive to talk about the future. For details,
see 220.
Whatareyou doing tomorrow evening? Come and see us next week if you're passing through London.
5 present progressive and simple present:
permanent situations
We do not usually use the present progressive to talk about more long-lasting or permanent situations.
Compare:
- My sister's livingat home for the moment. You live in North London, don't you?
- Why is that girl standing on the table?
Chetford Castle stands on a hill outside the town.
6 present progressive and simple present: repeated actions
The present progressive can refer to repeated actions and events, if these are happening around the
moment of speaking.
Why is he hitting the dog?
lake's seeing a lot of Felicity these days.
But we do not normally use the present progressive to talk about repeated actions and events which are
not closely connected to the moment of speaking.
I go to the mountains about twice a year.
(NOT I'm going to the mountains about twice a year.) Water boils at 100° Celsius. (NOT Water is boiling at
100° Celsius.)
7 Physical feelings
.erDS Aat refer to physical feelings (e.g. feel, hurt, ache) can often be used in "niple or progressive tenses
without much difference of meaning. How do you feel? OR How are you feeling? "fy head aches. OR My
head is aching. >
page 461


-"""uctions 8 verbs not used in progressive forms
Some verbs are not normally used in progressive forms. For details Hike this wine. (NOT -fm4iking this
wine.)
, ---.-^.-.A.Ai^y LtOl^U 1.
Hike this wine. (NOT -fm4iking mis wine.) Do you believe what he says? (NOT Are you believing....?) The
tank contains about 7,000 litres at the moment. (NOT The tank is containing...)
For progressive forms with always and similar words (e.g. She's always losins- h
see 452. snerlceys), For progressive forms in general, see 450.
For present-tense story-telling, see 446.
For tense simplification in subordinate clauses, see 556.
For the 'distancing' use of progressive forms, see 161.
446 present tenses (4): stories, commentaries and instructions
1 stories
Present tenses are often used to tell stories, especially in an informal style The simple present is used for
the events - the things that happen one after another. The present progressive is used for 'background' -
things that are already happening when the story starts, or that continue through the siory.
(This is like the difference between the simple past and past progressive:
see 417.)
Solopen thedoor, and I look out into thegarden, and I see this man.
He's wearing a pink skirt and a policeman's helmet. 'Good morning,' he says...
There's this Scotsman, you see, and he's walking through the jungle when he meets a gorilla. And the
gorilla's eating a snake sandwich. So the Scotsman goes up to the gorilla...
The simple present is common in summaries of plays, stories, etc. In Act I, Hamlet meets the ghost of his
father. The ghost tells him... Chapter 2: Postman Pat goes to Scotland and makes friends with a sheep.
2 commentaries
In commentaries, the use of tenses is similar. The simple present is used for the quicker actions and
events (which are finished before the sentences tha describe them); the present progressive is used for
longer actions and situations. There are more simple and fewer progressive tenses in a footo
commentary, for instance, than in a commentary on a boat race. Smith passes to Devaney, Devaney to
Barnes, Barnes to Lucas - aw "
intercepts... Harris to Simms, nice ball - and Simms shoots! ^ , Oxford are drawing slightly ahead of
Cambridge now; they're rowing a beautiful rhythm; Cambridge are looking a little disorganised. • •
3
"v-
. actions and demonstrations
se present tenses in a similar way to give instructions,
we orations and directions. jenioii ^^ ^ again. You wait outside the bank until the manager
rrives. Then you radio Louie, who's waiting round the corner, and he
drives round to the front entrance. You and Louie grab the manager... T- r I nut a lump of butter into a
frying pan and light the gas; then while
the butter's melting I break three eggs into a bowl, like this... 'Hoiv do I get to the station?' 'You go straight
on to the traffic lights, then
you turn left...'
447 presently
462
y-
p esently is often used in British English to mean 'not now, later', 'in a minute'. ''•Mummy, can I have an
ice-cream?' 'Presently, dear:
He's having a rest now. He'll be down presently. In American English, the usual meaning of presently is
'now', 'at present'. This is becoming very common in British English too.
Professor Holloway is presently working on plant diseases.
448 price and prize
The price is what you pay if you buy something. A prize is what you are given if you have done something
exceptional, or if you win a competition. What's the price of the green dress? (NOT ... the prize of the
green dress?) She received the Nobel prize for physics. (NOT ... the Nobel price...)
449 principal and principle
These two words have the same pronunciation. The adjective principal means 'main', 'most important'.
What's your principal reason for wanting to be a doctor?
(NOT .. .your principle reason...)
The noun principal means 'headmaster' or 'headmistress' (especially, in Britain, of a school for adults).
If you want to leave early you'll have to ask the Principal. A principle is a scientific law or a moral rule.
Newton discovered the principle of universal gravitation. (NOT ... the principal of-universal gravitation^
She's a girl with very strong principles.
450 progressive verb forms (I): general
1 construction
Progressive verb forms (also called 'continuous' forms) are made with
^e + -ing.
lam waiting for the shops to open. (present progressive tense) Your suit is being cleaned, (present
progressive passive tense) ^•
page 463


__- . - r--D"She phoned while I was cooking, (past progressive tense) / didn 't know how long she had been sitting
there. (past perfect progressive tense)
Will you be going out this evening? (future progressive tense) I'd like to be lying on the beach now.
(progressive infinitive)
2 terminology and use
A progressive form does not simply show the time of an event. It also h how the speaker sees the event -
generally as ongoing and temporary "^ than completed or permanent. (Because of this, grammars often
talk ah8 'progressive aspect' rather than 'progressive tenses'.) Compare: out
- I've rend your letter, (completed action)
I've been reading a lot of thrillers recently, (not necessarily completed!
- The Rhine runs into the North Sea. (permanent)
: We'll have to phone the plumber - water's running down the kitchen wan (temporary)
When a progressive is used to refer to a short momentary action, it often suggests repetition.
Why are you jumping up and down? The door was banging in the wind For more details of the use of
progressives, see the individual entries on the various forms.
51 progressive verb forms (2):
non-progressive verbs
1 verbs not used in progressive forms
Some verbs are never or hardly ever used in progressive forms. Hike this music. (NOT I'm liking this
music.) I rang her up because I needed to talk. (NOT ... because I was needing to talk.)
Some other verbs are not used in progressive forms when they have certain meanings. Compare:
I'm seeing the doctor at ten o 'clock.
I see what you mean. (NOT I'm seeing what you mean.) Many of these non-progressive verbs refer to
states rather than actions. Some refer to mental states (e.g. know, think, believe); some others refer to the
use of the senses (e.g. smell, taste).
2 common non-progressive verbs
Here is a list of some common verbs which are not often used in progress forms (or which are not used in
progressive forms with certain meaning I-
mental and emotional states
believe love see (= 'understand') doubt hate suppose . . " feel (= 'have an opinion') prefer think (= 'have an
opinion imagine realise understand know recognise want (dis)like remember^ wish
464
seem smell
use of the senses
appear look (= 'seem') hear see communicating and causing reactions
Qgree deny impress please astonish disagree mean promise
sound taste
satisfy surprise
other
i.g deserve measure (= 'have length etc')
belong fit need
concern include owe
consist involve own
contain lack possess
depend matter weigh (= 'have weight')
More details of the use of some of these verbs are given in other entries in the book. See the Index for
references.
3 progressive and non-progressive uses
Compare the progressive and non-progressive uses of some of the verbs
listed above.
- I'm feelingfine. (OR Jfeel fine. -see 445.7)
I feel we shouldn't do it. (NOT I'm feeling wo shouldn't do it.)
- What are you thinking about?
What do you think of the government?
(NOT What arc you thinking of the government?)
- I'm seeing Leslie tomorrow, -4 I see what you mean. (NOT I'm seeing what you meftfh} Why are you
smelling the meat? Is it bad?
Does the meat smell bad? (NOT Is the meat smelling bad?) - I'm just tasting the cake to see if it's OK.
The cake tastes wonderful. (NOT The cake's tasting wonderful.) - The scales broke when I was weighing
myself this morning.
I weighed 68 kilos three months ago - and look at me now!
(NOT/ was weighing 68 kilos^...) Note also that many 'non-progressive' verbs are occasionally used in
progressive forms in order to emphasise the idea of change or developmient.
These days, more and more people are preferring to take early retirement.
The water's tasting better today.
can see etc
Can is often used with see, hear, feel, taste, smell, understand and remember to give a kind of progressive
meaning, especially in British English. For Stalls, see 125.
I can see Sue coming down the road.
Can you smell something burning? >
page 465


5 -ingforms
Even verbs which are never used in progressive tenses have -ii
d\V\ hp ncp*rl IT"* /-t+l-t"*- 1""^1" r --'--
ich
can be used in other kinds of structure.
Knowing her tastes, I bought her a large box of chocolates. I don't like to go to a country without knowing
something ofthr 1
0-'
452 progressive verb forms (3): with always etc
We can use always, continually and similar words with a proeressiv f mean 'very often'. onn t0 I'm always
losing my keys.
Granny's nice. She's always giving people little presents. I'm continually running into Paul these days.
That cat's forever getting shut in the bathroom. This structure is used to talk about things which happen
very often (perha
more often than expected), but which are unexpected or unplanned. Compare:
- When Alice comes to see me, I always meet her at the station. (a regular, planned arrangement)
I'm always meeting Mrs Bailiff in the supermarket. (accidental, unplanned meetings)
•.- - When I was a child, we always had picnics on Saturdays in the summer. (regular, planned)
Her mother was always arranging little surprise picnics and outings. (unexpected, not regular)
453 punctuation (I): apostrophe (/9'pDStrafi/)
We use apostrophes (') for three main reasons.
1 missing letters
Apostrophes show where we have left letters out of a contracted form (see 144).
can't (= cannot} it's (= it is/has} I'd (= I would/had) who's (= who is/has)
2 possessives
We use apostrophes before or after the possessive -5 ending of nouns (see 432).
the girl's father Charles's wife three miles'walk Possessive determiners and pronouns do not have
apostrophes.
Has the cat had its food yet? (NOT .. .it's food...) , ^ , This isyours. (NOT .. .your's.) Whose is that coat?
(NOT -Whff^- • •
3 special plurals
Words which do m when a plural form
It's a nice idea, but there are a lot ofif's.
Words which do not usually have plurals sometimes have an apostrop when a plural form is written.
ostrophes are used in the plurals of letters, and often of numbers and
abbreviations.
He writes b's instead ofd's.
it was in the early 1960's. (OR ... 2960s.)
J ^ow two MP's personally. (OR... MPs.) Tt is not correct to put apostrophes in normal plurals.
JEANS - HALF PRICE (NOT JEAN'S. ..)
454 punctuation (2): colon
1 explanations
Colons (:) are often used before explanations.
We decided not to go on holiday: we had too little money. Mother may have to go into hospital: she's got
kidney trouble.
2 direct speech
A colon is used when direct speech is introduced by a name or short phrase (as in the text of a play, or
when famous sayings are quoted).
POLONIUS: What do you read, my lord?
HAMLET: Words, words, words.
In the words of Murphy's Law: 'Anything that can go wrong will go
wrong.' In other cases, direct speech is generally introduced by a comma (see 455.6).
Stewart opened his eyes and said, 'Who's your beautiful friend?' But a long passage of direct speech may
be introduced by a colon:
Introducing his report for the year, the Chairman said: 'A number of factors have contributed to the firm's
very gratifying results. First of all,...'
3 lists
A colon can introduce a list.
The main points are as follows: (1)..., (2)..., (3).... We need three kinds of support: economic, moral and
political.
4 subdivisions
A colon can introduce a subdivision of a subject - for instance, in a title or heading.
punctuation: colon
5 capitals
to British English, it is unusual for a capital letter to follow a colon (except at the beginning of a quotation).
However, this can happen if a colon is followed by several complete sentences. ^fy main objections are as
follows:
First of all, no proper budget has been drawn up. Secondly, there is no guarantee that... n American
English, colons are more often followed by capital letters. >
page
466
page 467


-- .-.. -__"""" ^gg
6 letters
Americans usually put a colon after the opening salutation (Dear...) in a business letter.
Dear Mr. Callan:
lam writing to... British usage prefers a comma or no punctuation mark at all in this case
455 punctuation (3): comma
Commas (,) generally reflect pauses in speech.
1 lists
We use commas to separate items in a series or list. In British English, a
comma is not usually used with and between the last two items unless these are long. Compare:
I went to Spain, Italy, Switzerland, Austria and Germany. •a(. (US:... Austria, and Germany.)
You had a holiday at Christmas, at New Year and at Easter. I spent yesterday playing cricket, listening to
jazz records, andtalkine about the meaning of life.
2 adjectives
In predicative position (see 15), commas are always used between adjectives.
The cowboy was tall, dark and handsome.
Before a noun, we generally use commas between adjectives which give similar kinds of information. ',
This is an expensive, ill-planned, wasteful project.
Commas are sometimes dropped between short adjectives.
a tall(,) dark(,) handsome cowboy
Commas cannot be dropped when modifiers refer to different parts of something.
a green, red and gold carpet (NOT a green red...)
concrete, glass and plastic buildings
Commas are not normally used between adjectives that give different kinds of information.
Have you met our handsome new financial director? (NOT ... our handsome, new, financial director?)
3 word order
If words or expressions are put in unusual places or interrupt the normal progression of a sentence, we
usually separate them off by commas.
My father, however, did not agree.
Jane had, surprisingly, paid for everything.
We were, believe it or not, in love with each other.
Andrew Carpenter, the deputy sales manager, was sick. Two commas are necessary in these cases.
(NOT Andrew Carpenter the deputy sales manager,
page
468
w
4 identifying expressions
When nouns are followed by identifying expressions which show exactly who ,yhat is being talked about,
commas are not used. Compare:
The driver in the Ferrari was cornering superbly.
(The phrase in the Ferrari identifies the driver.)
(NOT -jpfec driver, in the Ferrari, was cornering superbly o R The driver
ifirthefemn4rwas cornering superbly.) Stephens, in the Ferrari, was cornering superbly.
(The phrase in the Ferrari does not identify the driver; he is already
identified by his name, Stephens.) The woman who was sitting behind the reception desk gave Parker
a big smile. Mrs Grange, who was sitting behind, the reception desk, gave Parker
a big smile. For more about identifying and non-identifying relative clauses, see 474.
5 co-ordinate clauses
Clauses connected with and, but or or are usually separated by commas
unless they are very short. Compare:
- Jane decided to try the home-made steak pie, and Andrew ordered Dover
sole with boiled potatoes. Jane had pie and Andrew had fish.
- She had very little to live on, but she would never have dreamed of taking
what was not hers. ? She was poor but she was honest.
6 direct speech
A comma is generally used between a reporting expression and a piece of
direct speech.
Looking straight at her, he said, "There's no way we can help him, is there?'
If a reporting expression follows a piece of direct speech, we usually put a comma instead of a full stop
before the closing quotation mark. T don't like this one bit,'said Julia.
7 subordinate clauses
When subordinate clauses begin sentences, they are often separated by
commas. Compare:
If you are ever in London, come and see me.
Come and see me if you are ever in London. Commas are not used before thai-causes.
It is quite natural that you should want to meet your father. (NOT It is quite natural, that...)
indirect speech: no comma before that etc
We do not put commas before that, what, where etc in indirect speech Structures.
Everybody realised that I was a foreigner.
(NOT everybody realised, that...) *
page
469


They quickly explained what to do.
(NOT They quickly explained, what...) I didn't know where I should go. (NOT Ididn't kn
" 4se
vhere...)
9 grammatically separate sentences
We do not usually put commas between grammatically separate sentenr (in places where a full stop or a
semi-colon would be possible - see 457 a s The blue dress was warmer. On the other hand, the purple one
was vrew 459^ (o R The blue dress was warmer; on the other hand...) er' (NOT The blue dress was warmer,
on the other-hand...)
10 numbers
Commas are used to divide large numbers into groups of three figures bv separating off the thousands
and millions. 6,435 (NOT -6A3S) 7,456,189
We do not always use commas in four-figure numbers, and they; are never used in dates.
3,164 OR 3164 the year 1946 Spaces are sometimes used instead of commas.
There are 1000 millimetres in one metre. We do not use commas in decimals (see 385.1).
3.5 = three point five OR three and a half (NOT -3rż three comma five)
456 punctuation (4): dash
Dashes (-) are especially common in informal writing. They can be used in the same way as colons, semi-
colons or brackets.
There are three things I can never remember - names, faces, and I've forgotten the other.
We had a great time in Greece - the kids really loved it. My mother - who rarely gets angry - really lost her
temper.
A dash can introduce an afterthought, or something unexpected and surprising.
We'll be arriving on Monday morning- at least, I think so. And then we met Bob - with Lisa, believe it or
not!
"For the use of hyphens (as in hard-working Of cooperative), see 532.
punctuation (5): full stop, question mark and exclamation mark
sentence division
Full stops, question marks and exclamation marks are used to close sentences. A new sentence that
follows one of these has a capital letter. / looked out of the window. It was snowing again. Why do we try
to reach the stars? What is it all for? They have no right to be in our country! They must leave at once!
457
We do not normally put full stops, question or exclamation marks before or after grammatically incomplete
sentences. She phoned me as soon as she arrived.
(NOT -She-phoned me. As soon as she arrived.) In his job he has to deal with different kinds of people.
(NOT In his job. He has to deal with different kinds of people.) Did you understand why I was upset7
(NOT -Didyou understand? Why I was upset?) However, sometimes we can emphasise a clause or
phrase by separating it
with a full stop and capital letter.
People are sleeping out on the streets. In Britain. In the 1990s. Because
there are not enough houses.
2 abbreviations
Full stops can be used after abbreviations (see 2). This is becoming less common in British English.
Dr. Andrew C. Burke, M.A. OR Dr Andrew C Burke, MA
3 indirect questions
We do not use question marks after indirect questions (see 481.6). tasked her what time it was. (NOT ...
what time it was?)
458 punctuation (6): quotation marks
Quotation marks ('...' "...") are also called 'inverted commas' in British English.
1 special use of words
We often put quotation marks round words which are used in special ways -for example when we talk
about them, when we use them as titles, or when we give them special meanings.
Quotation marks are also called 'inverted commas'.
People disagree about how to use the word 'disinterested'.
His next book was 'Heart of Darkness'.
A textbook can be a 'wall' between teacher and class.
2 direct speech
We use quotation marks when we quote direct speech. Single quotation marks ('...') are more common in
British English, and double quotation marks ("...") in American English. For quotations inside quotations,
we use double quotation marks inside single (or single inside double). 'His last words,' said Albert, 'were
"Get that woman out of here".'
Ft"" commas in quotations, see 455. For colons, see 454.
page
470
page 471


---"" •*ag
459 punctuation (7): semi-colon
1 instead of full stops
Semi-colons (;) are sometimes used instead of full stops, in cases where sentences are grammatically
independent but the meaning is closely connected. Semi-colons are not nearly as common as full stops or
conim
Some people work best in the mornings; others do better in the evenine s
It is a fine idea; let us hope that it is going to work. Commas are not usually possible in cases like these
(see 455).
2 in lists
Semi-colons are also used to separate items in a list, particularly when thes are grammatically complex.
You may use the sports facilities on condition that your subscription is void regularly; that you arrange for
all necessary cleaning to be carried out-that you undertake to make good any damage;...
460 question words
1 interrogative use
The words who, whom, whose, which, what, when, where, why and how are used in questions to show
what kind of information is wanted.
Who said that? (asking for a personal subject) ' What did she want? (asking for a non-personal object)
When will it be ready? (asking for a time expression) Why are you laughing? (asking for a reason)
Who and whom are pronouns, and act as subject or object in their clauses. When, where, why and how
act as adverbs. What, which and whose can be pronouns or determiners. Compare:
••'"«• - What do you want? (pronoun) ' '•' What sort do you want? (determiner)
- Which is mine? (pronoun)
Which coat is mine? (determiner)
- Whose is the red car7 (pronoun) Whose coat is this? (determiner)
2 word order and structure
Question words normally come at the beginning of their clauses. When a question word is the subject (or
included in the subject), it comes before the verb, and do cannot normally be used (see 461.6). Compare:
Who (subject) said that? (NOT Who did say that?]
Who (object) didyou invite?
For more details of word order in questions, see 461-462. For the position of prepositions with question
words, see 440.
page
472
a longer interrogative expressions
Fnelish does not have a single question word for every situation. In order to find out some kinds of
information, we need to use expressions of two or
more words.
What time is the meeting? How much did you pay? What's her new boyfriend like? How many people are
coming? What sort of music do you like? How far do you travel to work?
English has no special word to ask for an ordinal number. 'It's our wedding anniversary.' 'Congratulations.
Which one?' (NOT '... the how manycth?')
4 asking for a verb
Question words and expressions can be used to ask for most kinds of word -for example a subject (who,
what), an object (who (m), what), a determiner (what, which, whose), an adjective (what... like) or an
adverbial expression (when, where, why, how). But there is no simple word or expression that can be
used to ask for a verb. For this purpose we normally make a sentence using what with do.
'What are you doing next weekend7''Resting.' The answer to what ...do can include a verb together with
what follows it.
'What's Helen doing?' 'Getting all the rubbish out of the car.' To ask for a transitive verb when the subject
and object are both mentioned, we use what... do to/with.
'What have you done to your leg?' 'Broken it.'
What are yo u doing with my camera ? To ask for complete information about an event, we use what...
happen.
What's happening in the office these days? When the object is mentioned, we use what... happen to.
'What happened to that chair?' 'Stan tried to dance on it.'
5 question-word clauses
Clauses beginning with question words can refer both to questions and to the answers to questions. They
often act as the objects of verbs -for example, when questions and their answers are reported (see 481).
I asked who wanted to come.
She wondered why he wasn 't wearing a coat.
We need to decide where Ann's going to sleep.
He told me when he was arriving, but I've forgotten.
She explained what the problem was.
Mary hasn't said why she doesn't want to come. Question-word clauses can act not only as objects, but
also as subjects, complements or adverbials. This structure is often rather informal (especially with how-
clauses - see 254).
Who you invite is your business. Where we stay doesn't matter.
A hot bath is what I need. This is how much I've done.
I'm surprised at how fast she can run.
You can eat it how you like. (very informal) The 'preparatory if structure is often used with subject clauses
(see 301).
If s your business who you invite. It doesn't matter where we stay. >
page 473



461
2
,- -• "•"•"-rules 4ft i
Question-word clauses can give more information about nouns. In th' they are called 'relative clauses' (see
473-477 for details). case
There's that man who threw stones at your dog.
The place where Mary works has just had afire.
Whether is a question word that is only used in indirect questions. We need to know whether he's coming
tomorrow.
For more about whether, see 592-593. For details of indirect question constructions, see 480-482.
For more information about particular question words and expressions, see the sena entries for the
various words. e
For singular and plural verbs with who, what and which, see 594. For differences between how, what and
why, see 254.3. For who ever, whatever etc, see 595. For whoever, whatever etc, see 596. ' For who else,
what else etc, see 187.
For question words after prepositions, in sentences like I'm not sure (of) where we are
see 441.
For infinitives after question words (e.g. How to succeed in business}, see 288.
questions (I): basic rules
These rules apply to almost all written questions and most spoken questions.
For 'declarative questions' (in which the subject comes before the verb), see the next section.
1 auxiliary verb before subject
In a question, an auxiliary verb normally comes before the subject. Have you received my letter of June
17? (NOT Ynu hfiiw >-^"- ""i
n rt
^ ---."-, ^. nuAiiitiiy vero normally comes before tl Have you received my letter of June 17? (NOT You hai
Whyareyou laughing? (NOT Why you are laufhiiw2)
./ ---"•• ^JJHIIC Ä… I :
Whyareyou laughing? (NOT Whyyou What are all those people looking at?
(NOT -What all those people arc loot Hnin miifh /." *'----
hmg?)
wed... ?)
do
,-.-^ , r, i.un«n muse people arc looki How much does the room cost? (NOT -HE
looking at?)
If there is no other auxiliary verb, we use do, does or did to form a question. Do you like Mozart? (NOT
Hkcyou Mozart?) Whatdoes 'perivhrasti^' mor,^? < "" -
.... ^.^x unwfuu wiozartf] What does 'periphrastic' mean? (NOT -What-m Did you like the concert?
riphrastic'?)
3 do not used with other auxiliaries
Do is not used together with other auxiliary verbs or with be. Can you tell me the time? (NOT Doyouwn tell
me the time?)
Have you seen John? (NOT Doyou have-secn John?) Are you ready?
4 infinitive without to
After do, we use the infinitive without to.
What does the boss want? (NOT -What does the bi Did you go climbing last weekend? (NOT Didyou
(NOT Did you to go... ?]
vants?) vewt... ?)
only auxiliary verb before subject
, ^g auxiliary verb goes before the subject, not the whole of the verb.
Is yourmothercoming tomorrow?
(NOT -Is^omingyour mother tomorrow?)
When was your reservation made?
(NOT -When was made your reservation?) This happens even if the subject is very long. Where are the
President and his family staying?
(NOT -Micro arc staying the President... ?)
fi word order with question word as subject
When who, which, what or whose is the subject (or part of the subject), the Question word comes before
the verb, and do cannot normally be used. Who left the door open? (NOT Who did leave... ?) Which costs
more - the blue one or the grey one?
(NOT Which docs cost-mere... ?) Which type of battery lasts longest?
(NOT Which type of battery does last longest?) What happened? (NOT What did happen?) How many
people work in your office?
(NOT How many people do work... ?) But do can be used after a subject question word for emphasis, to
insist on
an answer.
Well, tell us - what did happen when your father found you?
So who did marry the Princess in the end? When a question word is the object, do is used.
Who do you want to speak to?
Which type of battery do you use?
What do you think?
For singular and plural verbs with who and what, see 594.
7 indirect questions
In an indirect question, we do not put an auxiliary before the subject, and we do not use a question mark.
For details, see 481.6. Tell me when you are going on holiday.
(NOT Tell me when are you going on holiday?)
8 questions about that-clsaises
A wh-question usually refers to the words in the main clause which starts with the question word.
However, questions can also refer to subordinate that-clauses after verbs like wish, think or say.
Who do you wish (that) you'd married, then?
How long do you think (that) we should wait?
What did you say (that) you wanted for Christmas? >
page
474
page
475


ers
_ _ ^ipicsnons 4^3
TTzaf is usually dropped; it must be dropped when the question word rpf to the subject of the subordinate
clause. *
Who do you think is outside? (NOT -Whe-doyou think that4s-eutsidt>2\ What do you suppose will happen
now?
(NOT -What do you suppose that will happen-now?)
For negative questions, see 360.
For more about question words, see 460.
For ellipsis in questions (e.g. Seen John? Coming tonight?}, see 183.
462 questions (2): declarative questions
In spoken questions, we do not always use 'interrogative' word order. You're working late tonight?
These 'declarative questions' can be used when the speaker thinks he/she
knows or has understood something, but wants to make sure or express surprise. A rising intonation is
common.
This is your car? (= I suppose this is your car, isn't it?) That's the boss? I thought he was the cleaner.
f; 'We're going to Hull for our holidays.' 'You're going to Hull?' This word order is not normally possible after
a question word. Where are you going? (NOT -Where you are going?)
463 questions (3): reply questions
1 short questions
We often answer a statement by asking for more information. In informal speech, questions of this kind
may have a very simple structure - perhaps
just a question word, or a short phrase beginning with a question word. 'Anne's leaving her job.' 'When?'
'I'm going out.' 'Who with?'
'•boss wants toseeyou.' 'What for?'
-u talk to Tom this afternoon?' 'Why me?' •wen't running.' 'Why not?'
'a said, a speaker may simply repeat ('echo') what ^onation is common. siting married.?'
"ve can repeat the rest of the sentence, "e of the part we are asking about. hat?'
'' invited how many?' 're going where?'
hat?'
ing with the verb, do

infinitive without tb
After do, we use the infinitive TV What does the boss want? (NO^ Did you go climbing last weekend (NOT
Did you to go... ?)
^&e)r
476
w
aker may question a question, by repeating it with a rising intonation. " sr J^ ^ye use normal question
structures with inverted word order, not
•direct question structures, in this case.
"1 -Where areyou going?' 'Where am I going? Home:
(NOT .. .^Where4'mfoing?...') 'What does he want?' 'What does he want? Money, as usual.'
(NOT .. .^VJzat ho wants?...') •Areyou tired?' 'Am I tired? Of course not:
(NOT .. .^WhetherI'm tired?..:) 'Do sauirrels eat insects?' 'Do squirrels eat insects? I'm not sure:
(NOT .. .JWhether squirrels cat insects?..:)
3 attention signals
Short questions are often used in conversation to show that the listener is paying attention and interested.
Common attention signals are Oh, yes? Really? and a 'question tag' structure (see 465), consisting of
auxiliary verb +
pronoun.
'It was a terrible party."Was it?"Yes..:
Note that these questions do not ask for information - they simply show that the listener is reacting to what
has been said. More examples:
'We had a lovely holiday: 'Did you?' 'Yes, we went..:
Tvegota headache: 'Haveyou, dear? I'll get you an aspirin:
'John likes that girl next door: 'Oh, does he?'
'I don't understand: 'Don't you? I'm sorry:
Negative questions in reply to affirmative statements express emphatic agreement (like negative-question
exclamations - see 201.4).
'It was a lovely concert: 'Yes, wasn't it? I did enjoy it:
'She's put on a lot of weight: 'Yes, hasn't she?'
For similar structures, see 493 (short answers) and 465-466 (question tags).
464 questions (4): rhetorical questions 1 questions that do not expect an answer
Questions do not always ask for information. In many languages, including English, a question with an
obvious answer can be used simply as a way of drawing attention to something. Questions of this kind are
called 'rhetorical questions'.
Do you know what time it is? (= You're late.) Who's a lovely baby? (= You're a lovely baby.) 'I can't find my
coat: 'What's this, then?' (= 'Here it is, stupid:) ery often, a rhetorical question draws attention to a negative
situation - to
•"e fact that the answer is obviously 'No', or that there is no answer to the question.
What's the use of asking her? (= It's no use asking her.) How do you expect me to find milk on a Sunday
night? Where am I going to find a shop open? (= You can't reasonably expect.. .There aren't any shops
open.) >
page 477


^_-__ "" uvc questions ^
That is usually dropped; it must be dropped when the question wo ri to the subject of the subordinate
clause, ^fers
Who do you think is outside? (NOT Who do you think that-is-outr • What do you suppose will happen
now? "'""•wee?)
(NOT -What do you suppose that will happen now?)
For negative questions, see 360.
For more about question words, see 460.
For ellipsis in questions (e.g. Seen John? Coming tonight?), see 183.
462 questions (2): declarative questions
In spoken questions, we do not always use 'interrogative' word order You're working late tonight?
These 'declarative questions' can be used when the speaker thinks he/she knows or has understood
something, but wants to make sure or express surprise. A rising intonation is common.
This is your car? (= I suppose this is your car, isn'tit?)
That's the boss? I thought he was the cleaner. • '•' 'We're going to Hull for our holidays.' 'You're going to
Hull?' This word order is not normally possible after a question word.
Where are you going? (NOT Where you are going?)
463 questions (3): reply questions
1 short questions
We often answer a statement by asking for more information. In informal speech, questions of this kind
may have a very simple structure - perhaps just a question word, or a short phrase beginning with a
question word.
'Anne's leaving her job.' 'When?'
'I'm going out.' 'Who with?'
'The boss wants to see you.' 'What for?'
'Can you talk to Tom this afternoon?' 'Why me?'
"The buses aren 't running.' 'Why not?'
2 echo questions
To question what has been said, a speaker may simply repeat ('echo') what
he/she has heard. A rising intonation is common. 'I'm getting married."You're getting married?'
To question one part of a sentence, we can repeat the rest of the sentence,
and put a stressed question word in place of the part we are asking about. 'Just take a look at that.' 'Take
a look at what?' 'She's invited thirteen people to dinner.' 'She's invited how many?' 'We're going to Tierra
del Fuego on holiday."You're goingwhere? "' 'I've broken the fettle gauge.' 'You've broken the what?'
To question a verb, or the part of a sentence beginning with the verb, do
what is used.
'She set fire to the garage.' 'She did what (to the garage) ?'
page
476
paker may question a question, by repeating it with a rising intonation. t that we use normal question
structures with inverted word order, not direct question structures, in this case. ln -Where are you going?'
'Where am I going? Home.'
(NOT .. .^Whcra I'm going?...') 'What does he want?' 'What does he want? Money, as usual.'
(NOT .. .-'What he wants?...') 'Are you tired?' 'Am I tired? Of course not.'
(NOT .. .'Whether I'm tired?..:)
'Do squirrels eat insects?' 'Do squirrels eat insects? I'm not sure.' (NOT ... 'Whether squirrels oat
insects?...')
3 attention signals
Short questions are often used in conversation to show that the listener is paying attention and interested.
Common attention signals are Oh, yes? Really? and a 'question tag' structure (see 465), consisting of
auxiliary verb +
pronoun.
'It was a terrible party.' 'Was it?' 'Yes...'
Note that these questions do not ask for information - they simply show that the listener is reacting to what
has been said. More examples:
'We had a lovely holiday.' 'Didyou?' 'Yes, we went...'
'I've got a headache.' 'Have you, dear? I'll get you an aspirin.'
'John likes that girl next door.' 'Oh, does he?'
T don't understand.' 'Don't you? I'm sorry.' Negative questions in reply to affirmative statements express
emphatic agreement (like negative-question exclamations - see 201.4).
'It was a lovely concert.' 'Yes, wasn't it? I did enjoy it.'
'She's put on a lot of weight.' 'Yes, hasn't she?'
For similar structures, see 493 (short answers) and 465-466 (question tags).
464 questions (4): rhetorical questions
1 questions that do not expect an answer
Questions do not always ask for information. In many languages, including English, a question with an
obvious answer can be used simply as a way of drawing attention to something. Questions of this kind are
called 'rhetorical
questions'.
Do you know what time it is? (= You're late.) Who's a lovely baby? (= You're a lovely baby.) 'I can't find my
coat.' 'What's this, then?' (= 'Here it is, stupid.') Very often, a rhetorical question draws attention to a
negative situation - to the fact that the answer is obviously 'No', or that there is no answer to the
question.
What's the use of asking her? (= It's no use asking her.) How do you expect me to find milk on a Sunday
night? Where am I going to
find a shop open? (= You can't reasonably expect... There aren't any shops open.) >
page 477


,- - ---CT-V-~ "^xniiauon) 4cr
Where's my money? [= You haven't paid me.} 'lean run faster than you.'"Who cares7' (= 'Nobody cares.')
Are we going to let them do this to us? (= We aren 't...) Have you lost your tongue? (= Why don't you say
anything?}
Whatdoyou think you're doing? (= You can'tjustify what you're doinf) Who do you think you are?
(= You aren't as important as your behaviour suggests.) Why don't you take a taxi? (= There's no reason
not to.)
2 why/how should...?
Why should...? can be used aggressively to reject suggestions, requests and instmctions.
'Ann's very unhappy.' 'Why should I care?'
'Could your wife help us in the office tomorrow?' 'Why should she? She doesn't work for you.'
How should I know? (American also How would... ?) is an aggressive reply to a question.
'What time does the film start?' 'How should I know?'
3 negative yes/no questions
Negative yes/no questions often suggest a positive situation. Haven't I done enough for you? (= 1have
done enough foryou.) Didn 't I tell you it would rain ? (=1 told you...) 'Don't touch that!' 'Why shouldn't!?' (=
'I have a perfect right to.')
For more about negative questions, see 360.
465 questions (5): question tags (basic information)
1 What are question tags?
'Question tags' are the small questions that often come at the ends of sentences in speech, and
sometimes in informal writing. Not a very good film, was it?
Negatives are usually contracted, but full forms are possible in formal speech.
That's the postman, isn't it?
You do take sugar in tea, don't you?
They promised to repay us within six months, did they not? (formal)
Question tags can be used to check whether something is true, or to ask for agreement.
2 negative after affirmative, and vice versa
Question tags are used after affirmative and negative sentences, but not after questions.
You're the new secretary, aren'tyou? You're not the new secretary, are you?
(BUT NOT Arc you the now secretary, aren'tyou?)
page
478
To check information or ask for agreement, we most often put negative tags after affirmative sentences,
and non-negative tags after negative sentences.
[J===3 I: , _ ^
It's cold, isn't it? It's not warm, is it? For 'same-way' tags, see 466.8.
3 auxiliaries
If the main sentence has an auxiliary verb (or non-auxiliary be), this is repeated in the question tag.
Sally can speak French, can't she?
^I The meeting's at ten, isn't it?
T
You didn't speak to Luke, did you?
T
You wouldn't like a puppy, wouldyou? If the main sentence has no auxiliary, the question tag has do.
You like oysters, don'tyou?
T
Harry gave you a cheque, didn't he?
4 meaning and intonation
In speech, we can show the exact meaning of a question tag by the intonation. If the tag is a real question
- if we really want to know something and are not sure of the answer - we use a rising intonation: the voice
goes up.
The meeting's at four o'clock, isn't it?
If the tag is not a real question - if we are sure of the answer - we use a falling intonation: the voice goes
down.
It's a beautiful day, isn't it? In writing, the exact meaning of a question tag is normally clear from the
context. , ,
5 requests
We often ask for help or information by using the structure negative statement + question tag.
You couldn't lend me a pound, couldyou? You haven't seen my watch anywhere, have you?
For more information about requests, see 483. For details of other kinds of tags, see 472.
page 479


-"•l"nitS) 4fic
466 questions (6): question tags (advanced points
1 aren't I?
The question tag foil am is aren't I? I'm late, aren't I?
2 imperatives
After imperatives, won'tyou? is often used to invite people to do thine
(especially in British English), and will/would/can/can't/could you? torp]i ask people to do things. or
Give me a hand, will you? Do sit down, won'tyou? (GB) Open a window, wouldyou? Shut up, can't you?
After a negative imperative, we use will you? Don't forget, will you?
3 let's
After let's..., we use shall we? Let's have a party, shall we?
4 there
There can be a subject in question tags. There's something wrong, isn't there? There weren't any
problems, were there?
5 negative words
Non-negative tags are used after sentences containing negative words like never, no, nobody, hardly,
scarcely and little.
You never say whatyou're thinking, do you? (NOT .. .Won'tyou?)
It's no good, is it? (NOT ... isn't it?)
It's hardly rained at all this summer, has it?
There's little we can do about it, is there?
6 nothing, nobody, somebody etc
We use it in question tags to refer to nothing and everything. Nothing can happen, can it?
We use they to refer to nobody, somebody and everybody (and no one etc). Nobody phoned, did they?
Somebody wanted a drink, didn't they? Who was it? For more about this use of they, see 505.
7 non-auxiliary have
After non-auxiliary have (referring to states), question tags with have ^
and do are often both possible in British English. (Do is normal in Ana English.)
Your father has a bad back, hasn't/doesn't he? For more about the use of do with have, see 240-243.
page
480
o -same-way'question tags
Non-negative question tags are quite common after affirmative sentences. These are often used as
responses to something that has been said, like ' ttention signals' (see 463.3): the speaker repeats what
he/she has just heard learnt, and uses the tag to express interest, surprise, concern or some
other reaction.
So you're getting married, are you? How nice!
So she thinks she's going to become a doctor, does she? Well, well.
You think you're funny, do you?
'Same-way' tags can also be used to ask questions. In this structure, we use me main sentence to make a
guess, and men ask (in the tag) if it was correct.
Your mother's at home, is she?
This is the last bus, is it?
You can eat shellfish, can you?
Negative 'same-way' tags are occasionally heard in British English; they usually sound aggressive.
I see. You don't like my cooking, don'tyou?
9 ellipsis
In sentences with question tags, it is quite common to leave out pronoun subjects and auxiliary verbs.
(This is called 'ellipsis'. For details, see 183.)
(It's a) nice day, isn't it?
(She was) talking to my husband, was she? In very informal speech, a question tag can sometimes be
used after a question with ellipsis.
Have a good time, did you?
Your mother at home, is she?
John be here tomorrow, will he?
Por details of other kinds of tags, see 472.
467 quite
1 two meanings
Quite has two meanings in British English. Compare:
It's quite good, but it could be better.
It's quite impossible. (= It's completely impossible.) Good is a 'gradable' adjective: things can be more or
less good. With gradable adjectives and adverbs, quite is used in British English affirmative sentences to
mean something like 'fairly' or 'rather' (for the differences, see 205). Impossible is non-gradable: things are
either impossible or they aren't, but Aey cannot be more or less impossible. With non-gradable adjectives
and adverbs, quite means 'completely'. Compare:
~ I'm quite tired, but I can walk a bit further.
I'm quite exhausted -1 couldn't walk another step.
It's quite surprising, (similar to fairly surprising)
It's quite amazing. (= absolutely amazing)
He speaks French quite well, but he's got a strong English accent.
He speaks French quite perfectly. >
page 481



- -*07 wore that some adjectives and adverbs can have both gradable and n
gradable uses; with these, quite has two possible meanings in British p
In American English quite generally means something like 'very', not 'fairly/rather'.
2 with verbs
Quite can be used to modify verbs, especially in British English. The m depends on whether the verb is
gradable or not. Filing
I quite like her, but she's not one of my closest friends. Have you quite finished? (= Have you completely
finished?)
3 word order with nouns
Quite can be used with a/an + noun. It normally comes before a/an ifther is a gradable adjective or no
adjective.
It's quite a nice day. We watched quite an interesting film last nieht She's quite a woman! The party was
quite a success.
With non-gradable adjectives, quite normally comes after a/an.
It was a quite perfect day. (NOT It was quite a perfect day:) In British English, quite is sometimes used
before the.
You 're quite the most exciting man I've ever known. He's going quite the wrong way.
4 comparisons
Quite is not used directly before comparatives. She's rather/much/a bit older than me. (BUT NOT She's
quite older than me.)
But note the expression quite better, meaning 'completely recovered' (from an illness).
Quite similar means (in British English) 'fairly/rather similar'; quite different means 'completely different'.
5 quite a bit/few/lot etc
Quite a bit and quite a few (informal) have fairly positive meanings - they are almost the same as quite a
lot.
We're having quite a bit of trouble with the kids just now.
We thought the place would be empty, but actually there were quite a few people there.
6 not quite
Not quite means 'not completely' or 'not exactly'. It can be used before adjectives, adverbs, verbs and
nouns, including nouns with the. I'm not quite ready - won't be a minute.
She didn't run quite fast enough for a record.
I don't think you're quite right, I'm afraid.
I don't quite agree. That's not quite the colour I wanted-
r the differences betwpp" """'" '-'' '
muroiwr. pieicience 409
For the differences between quite, fairly, rather and pretty, see 205. For other structures used to express
degree, see 153 -156.
page
482
/.a rather (I): adverb of degree
, meaning
British English, rather can be used as an adverb of degree. The meaning is "milar to 'quite' or 'fairly', but
more emphatic. Rather is not often used in this way in American English.
2 with adjectives and adverbs
With adjectives and adverbs, rather often suggests 'more than is usual', 'more than was expected', 'more
than was wanted' and similar ideas. 'How was the film?' 'Rather good -1 was surprised.' She sings rather
well - people often think she's a professional. It's rather warm in here. Let's open a window.
3 with nouns
Rather can modify noun phrases, with or without adjectives. It generally comes before articles, but can
also come after a/an if there is an adjective. He's rather a fool. That's rather the impression I wanted to
give. , Jane's had rather a good idea. (OR Jane 'shad a rather good idea.) Rather is not normally used
before a plural noun with no adjective. (NOT They're rather fools.)
4 with verbs
Rather can modify verbs (especially verbs that refer to thoughts and feelings). / rather think we're going to
lose. She rather enjoys doing nothing. Some people rather like being miserable. We were rather hoping
you could stay to supper.
5 with comparatives and too
Rather can modify comparatives and too.
It's rather later than I thought. He talks rather too much.
For the difference between rather, fairly, quite and pretty, see 205.
For other uses of rather, see 469.
For other structures used to express degree, see 153-156.
469 rather (2): preference
1 rather than
This expression is normally used in 'parallel' structures: for example with two adjectives, adverbials,
nouns, infinitives or -ing forms. I'd call her hair chestnut rather than brown. I'd prefer to go in August rather
than in July. It ought to be you rather than me that signs the letter. We ought to invest in machinery rather
than buildings. I always prefer starting early rather than leaving everything to the last minute. >
page 483


- - ---^ence 4eg When the main clause has a to-infinitive, rather than is usually f
by an infinitive without to. An -ing form is also possible, especi 1'? owed beginning of a sentence. ^ at the
/ decided to write rather than phone/phoning.
It's important to invest in new machinery rather than increas
(OB... rather than increasing wages.) e ^Ses.
Rather than using/use the last of my cash, I decided to write a ch 2 would rather
This expression means 'would prefer to', and is followed by the infi • • without to. We often use the
contraction 'a rather. lve Would you rather stay here or go home?
'How about a drink?' 'I'dratherhave something to eat.'
Note that would rather like does not mean 'would prefer'; in this exnrp • rather means 'quite', and does not
suggest preference. Compare: lon' 'I'd rather like a cup of coffee.' (.= 'I'd quite like...')
'Oh, would you? I'd rather have a glass of beer.'(=... I'd prefer ')
3 would rather: past tense with present or future meaning
We can use would rather to say that one person would prefer another or others to do something. We use
a special structure with a past tense. would rather + subject + past tense
I'd rather you went home now. Tomorrow's difficult. I'd rather you came next weekend. My wife would
rather we didn't see each other any more. 'Shall I open a window?' Tdratheryou didn't.'
A present tense is sometimes used in this structure (e.g. I'd rather you go home now), but this is unusual.
To talk about past actions, a past perfect tense is possible. I'd rather you hadn't done that.
However, it is more common to express this kind of idea with / wish (see 601).
/ wish you hadn 't done that.
In older English, had rather was used in the same way as would rather. This
structure is still found in grammars, but it is not normally used in modem British English.
For other structures where a past tense has a present or future meaning, see 422.
4 or rather
People often use or rather to correct themselves. He's a psychologist - or rather, a psychoanalyse (NOT ...
or bettor, a psychoanalyse
For rather as an adverb of degree, see 468.
page
484
,70 r^8011
n can be followed by why... or that... was0 ,gason why I came here was to be with my family. ln ^.nin reason
why he lost his job was that he drank. nvou know the reason that they're closing the factory?
^formal style, why/that is often left out. In The reason she doesn 't like me is that I make her nervous. The
reason I'm asking is that I'm short of money.
The normal preposition after reason is for. chat's the real reason for your depression?
(NOT .. .reason of your depression?)
Some people consider it incorrect to use a because-clause as complement ftpr reason (as in Sorry I'm late
- the reason is because I overslept.)
471 reflexive pronouns
1 What are reflexive pronouns?
Reflexive pronouns are myself, yourself, himself, herself, itself, oneself, ourselves, yourselves,
themselves.
2 use
A common use of reflexive pronouns is to talk about actions where the
subject and object are the same person.
I cut myself shaving this morning. (NOT Icutme...} We got out of the water and dried ourselves. (NOT ..
.dried us.) I'm going to the shops to get myself some tennis shoes. Talking to oneself is the first sign of
madness.
A reflexive pronoun can refer to other things besides the subject of a clause.
His letters are all about himself.
I'm going to tell her a few facts about herself.
I love you for yourself, not for your money.
3 after prepositions
After prepositions of place, we often use a personal pronoun (me, you etc) instead of a reflexive to refer
back to a previous noun or pronoun, in cases when only a reflexive meaning makes sense. Compare:
She took her dog with her. (NOT ... with herself.)
(She could hardly take her dog with somebody else.) She's very pleased with herself.
(She could be pleased with somebody else.)
4 emphatic use
e can use reflexives as subject or object emphasisers, to mean 'that Person / thing and nobody /
nothing else'.
h's quicker if you do it yourself.
The manageress spoke to me herself.
The house itself is nice, but the garden's very small.
Til go and see the President himself if I have to.
page 485


^
3 reflexives used instead of personal pronouns *•
Reflexives are often used instead of personal pronouns after as, like, but Ft and except (for). '
These shoes are specially designed for heavy runners like yourself. (OR ... like you.)
Everybody was early except myself. (OR ... except me.)
Reflexives can also be used instead of personal pronouns in co-ordinated noun phrases.
There will be four of us at dinner: Robert, Alison, Jenny and myself. (OR ... and I/me.)
6 by oneself
By myself/yourself etc can mean either 'alone, without company' or 'without help'.
I often like to spend time by myself. 'Do you need help?' 'No, thanks. I can do it by myself.'
7 -selves and each other/one another
Note the difference between -selves and each other/one another (see 175). They talk to themselves a lot.
(Each of them talks to him / herself.) They talk to each other a lot. (Each of them talks to the other.) >««
own
There are no possessive reflexives. Instead, we use my own, your own etc (see 400).
I always type my own letters. (NOT ... myself's letters.) 9 reflexives not used
Certain verbs which are reflexive in some other languages are not used with
reflexive pronouns in English. For example, we do not normally use reflexive pronouns with wash, dress or
shave.
Do you shave on Sundays? (NOT Do you shewe-yewsclfon Sundays?)
However, reflexives can be used if it is necessary to make it clear who does the action.
She's old enough to dress herself now.
The barber shaves all the people in the town who don't shave themselves.^ So does he shave himself or
not?
A few other examples of verbs which are not normally reflexive in English^ Suddenly the door opened.
(NOT Suddenty-the-aeer-epcned itsetf:) | His book's selling well. (NOT His book's selling itself well.) Try to
concentrate. (NOT -Try-to concentrate yourself.) I feel strange. (NOT 4fcel myselfstmnge:) Hurry! (NOT
4bmy-yourself!)
For more about structures like The dooi
'r opened and His book's selling well, see 579.3^
page
,72 reinforcement tags
1 repeated subject and auxiliary verb
In informal spoken English (especially British English), a sentence sometimes ends with a 'tag' which
repeats the subject and auxiliary verb.
You've gone mad, you have.
I'm getting fed up, lam. If the main clause has no auxiliary verb, do is used in the tag.
He likes his beer, he does.
2 use
One reason for using a reinforcement tag is simply to emphasise the idea of the main clause by repeating
it.
You're really clever, you are.
A tag can also move the subject to the end of the sentence, so that the verb comes earlier and gets more
immediate attention. (This is called 'fronting';
for details, see 217.)
Getting in my way, you are.
Likes his beer, John does.
It is possible to 'announce' the subject with a pronoun, and put the full subject in a tag.
He hasn't a chance, Fred hasn't.
She really got on my nerves, Sylvia did.
3 subject-only tags
It is possible to have reinforcement tags without verbs. Ellipsis (see 183) of the subject and verb is
possible.
(You're) living in the clouds, you lot.
(They're) very polite, your children. Pronouns are not usually used alone in tags, except for reflexives.
Don't think much of the party, myself.
For similar structures, see 465-466 (question tags), 463 (reply questions) and 493 (short answers).
473 relatives (I): relative clauses and pronouns (introduction)
1 relative clauses
Clauses beginning with question words (e.g. who, which, where) are often used to modify nouns and
some pronouns - to identify people and things, or to give more information about them. Clauses used like
this are called 'relative clauses'.
Have you ever spoken to the people who live next door? Those who have not yet registered should do so
at once. There's a programme on tonight which you might like. He's got a job in a new firm, where they
don't work such long hours. Relative clauses can also be introduced by that.
Here's the book that you were looking for. >
page 487


V-vrtiunion) 4y. 2 relative pronouns
When who, whom etc are used to introduce relative clauses, they are r li 'relative pronouns'. Who, which
and that can be the subjects of verbs •
relative clauses. Who refers to people and which to things; that can ref both people and things. er to
What's the name of the tall man who just came in? (NOT ... the taU. man which...)
It's a book which will interest children of all ages. (NOT .. .-ft-beek-wha. The people that live next door
keep having all-night parties. '' These are the keys that open the front and back door.
Who, whom, which and that can also be used as the objects of verbs in relative clauses. Who is informal
as an object; in a more formal style, whom is used, especially in certain kinds of relative clause (for
details, see 4741 He's married somebody who I really don't like. (informal) He has married somebody
whom I really do not like. (formal) I gave him an envelope, which he put in his pocket at once. Here are the
papers that you were looking for.
3 relative when, where and why
When and where can introduce relative clauses after nouns referring to time and place. They are used in
the same way as preposition + which. I'll never forget the day when I first met you. (=... the day on
which...)
Do you know a shop where I can find sandals?
(=... a shop at which...) Why is used in a similar way after reason.
Do you know the reason why she doesn 't like me? (=... the reason for which...)
4 leaving out object pronouns
In some kinds of relative clause (see 474), object pronouns can be left out. She's somebody I really can't
stand. (=... somebody that...) Here are the papers you were looking for. (=... the papers that...)
5 double use of relative pronouns
Relative pronouns have a double use: they act as subjects or objects inside relative clauses, and at the
same time they connect relative clauses to nouns or pronouns in other clauses - rather like conjunctions.
As subjects or
objects they replace words like she or him: one subject or object in a relative clause is enough. Compare:
- He's got a new girl-friend. She works in a garage. He's got a new girl-friend who works in a garage. (NOT
... who she works in a garage.)
- This is Mr Rogers. You met him last year. This is Mr Rogers, whom you met last year. (NOT .. .-
whemyou met him last year.)
- Here's an article. It might interest you. Here's an article which might interest you. (NOT ... which it might
intcrest-yeik)
I've found the car keys. You were looking for them. I've found the car keys which you were looking for.
(NOT .. .which you were looking for-them;)
Q whose
Whose is a possessive relative word, used as a determiner before nouns.
It replaces his/her/its. For more details, see 475. r saw a girl whose hair came down to her waist. (NOT • •
• whose her hair-eame-deumr...)
7 which referring to a whole clause
Which can refer not only to a noun, but also to the whole of a previous clause. Note that what, thatmd how
cannot be used in this way. He got married again a year later, which surprised everybody.
(NOT ..., what/that surprised everybody.) She cycled from London to Glasgow, which is pretty good for a
woman of 75.
(NOT She cycled..., what/that is pretty good...) I was impressed by the way in which she did it. (NOT I was
impressed by the way how she-did-it.)
8 separating a noun from its relative pronoun
Relative pronouns usually follow their nouns directly. . The idea which she put forward was interesting.
(NOT The idea was interesting which she put forward.) I rang up Mrs Spencer, who did our accounts.
(NOT I rang Mrs Spencer up, whe-did our accounts.) However, a descriptive phrase can sometimes
separate a noun from its
relative pronoun.
I rang up Mrs Spencer, the Manager's secretary, who did our accounts.
For the use of what and how in nominal relative clauses, see 476.
For more about relative clauses and pronouns, see the following sections.
For other ways of using question-word clauses, see 460.5.
474 relatives (2): identifying and non-identifying clauses
1 two kinds of relative clause
Some relative clauses identify or classify nouns: they tell us which person or thing, or which kind of person
or thing, is meant. (In grammars, these are called 'identifying', 'defining' or 'restrictive' relative clauses.)
What's the name of the tall man who just came in?
Is that your car that's parked outside?
Paris is a city I've always wanted to visit.
People who take physical exercise live longer.
Have you got something that will get ink out of a carpet? Other relative clauses do not identify or classify;
they simply tell us more about a person or thing that is already identified. (In grammars, these are
page
488
page
489


J"tB i-iauses 474
called 'non-identifying', 'non-defining' or 'non-restrictive' relative r] This is Ms Rogers, who's joining the firm
next week. ses-) In 1908 Ford developed his Model Tear, which sold for $500.
There are several grammatical differences between the two kinds ofrl
clause. There are also stylistic differences: non-identifying clauses arp atlve generally more formal, and are
less frequent in informal speech.
2 pronunciation and punctuation
Identifying relative clauses usually follow immediately after the nouns rh they modify, without a break: they
are not separated by pauses or intonaf movements in speech, or by commas in writing. (This is because
the noun0" would be incomplete without the relative clause, and the sentence would make no sense or
have a different meaning.) Non-identifying clauses are
normally separated by pauses and/or intonation breaks and commas Compare:
- - The woman who does my hair has moved to another hairdresser's.
Dorothy, who does my hair, has moved to another hairdresser's. - She married a man that she met on a
bus.
She married a very nice young architect from Belfast, whom she met on a bus.
Note how the identifying clauses cannot easily be left out.
The woman has moved to another hairdresser's. (Which woman?) She married a man. (!)
When a non-identifying clause does not come at the end of a sentence, two commas are necessary.
Dorothy, who does my hair, has moved...
(NOT Dorothy, who docs-my hair has moved...)
3 use of that
That is common as a relative pronoun in identifying clauses. It can refer to
things, and in an informal style to people. In non-identifying clauses, that is unusual. Compare:
- Have you got a book that's really easy to read? (OH... which is...) I lent him 'The Old Man and the Sea',
which is realty easy to read.
(NOT -^len^wi-Tfw^kl-Man and the Soa^that is realty easywwui.)
- Where's the girl that sells the tickets? (OR... who sells...) This isNaomi, who sells the tickets.
(NOT This isNaomi, that sells the tickets.)
4 all that, only... that etc
That is especially common after quantifiers like all, everything), somefthing)' any(thing), no(thing), none,
little, few, much, only, and after superlatives.
Is this all that's left? (More natural than... all which is left?)
Have you got anything that belongs to me? (More natural than... anything which...)
The only thing that matters is to find our way home.
I hope the little that I've done has been useful.
It's the best film that's ever been made about madness.
page
490
r
^nat what (see 476) cannot be used in these cases. AH thatyou say is certainly true. (NOT All what you
say...)
who and whom
M/foo can be used as an object in identifying clauses in an informal style.
whom is more formal.
The woman who I marry will have a good sense of humour.
(More formal: The woman whom I marry...)
- non-identifying clauses, who is less common as an object, though it is
sometimes used in an informal style.
In that year he met Rachel, whom he was later to marry. (OR . • • Rachel, who he was later to marry. -
informal)
R leaving out object pronouns
In identifying relative clauses, -we often leave out object pronouns, especially in an informal style. In non-
identifying clauses this is not possible. Compare:
- I feel sorry for the man she married.
She went to work with my brother, whom she later married. (NOT -She wcn^te-werk-with my brother, she
later married.)
- What didyou think of the wine we drank last night? I poured him a glass of wine, which he drank at once.
(NOT 4-powcd him a glass of wine, he drank at once.)
For omission of when, where and why, see 477.3. ^
7 position of prepositions
Prepositions can come either before relative pronouns (more formal) or at the end of relative clauses
(more informal). Compare:
- He was respected by the people with whom he worked, (formal)
He was respected by the people (that) he worked with. (informal) - This is the room in which I was born.
(formal)
This is the room (that) I was born in. (informal) Who and that are not used after prepositions.
... the people with whom he worked.
(NOT ... the people with who/that he worked.)
For more about prepositions at the end of clauses, see 440. For tenses in identifying clauses, see 556.
^S relatives (3)'.whose
1 relative possessive
Whose is a relative possessive word, used as a determiner before nouns in the same way as his, her, its
or their. It can refer back to people or things. In a relative clause, whose + noun can be the subject, the
object of a verb or the
object of a preposition.
I saw a girl whose beauty took my breath away. (subject) It was a meeting whose purpose I did not
understand, (object) >
page 491


MichelCroz, with whose help Whymper climbed the Matterhorn, was of the first professional guides,
(object of preposition) c
/ went to see my friends the Forrests, whose children I used to look after when they were small, (object of
preposition)
Whose can be used in both identifying and non-identifying clauses.
2 of which; that ...of
Instead of whose, we can use of which or that ...of (less formal) to refer tn things, and these are
sometimes preferred. The most common word ordpr • noun + of which or that... of, but of which...+ noun is
also possible Compare the following four ways of expressing the same idea.
He's written a book whose name I've forgotten.
He's written a book the name of which I've forgotten.
He's written a book that I've forgotten the name of.
He's written a book of which I've forgotten the name. We do not normally use noun + of whom in a
possessive sense.
3 only used as a determiner
Relative whose is only used as a possessive determiner, before a noun. In other cases we use of
which/whom or that... of.
- ----"-... VJ.
He's married to a singer of whom you may have heard. OR ... that you may have heard of. (NOT ... a
singer whose you may have heard.}
4 formality
Sentences with whose are generally felt to be rather heavy and formal; in an informal style other
structures are often preferred. With (see 602) is a
common way of expressing possessive ideas, and is usually more natural than whose in descriptions.
I've got some friends with a house that looks over a river.
(Less formal than... whose house looks over a river.) You know that girl with a brother who drives lorries?
(Less formal than... whose brother drives lorries?) She's married to the man over there with the enormous
ears.
(More natural than... the man over there whose ears are enormous.)
For whose in questions, see 597.
476 relatives (4): what and other nominal relative pronouns
1 what: meaning and use
What does not refer to a noun that comes before it. It acts as noun + relative pronoun together, and
means 'the thing(s) which'.
What she said made me angry.
I hope you 're going to give me what I need.
Clauses beginning with what act as subjects or objects, and are called 'nominal relative clauses'.
For singular and plural verbs after what (e.g. Whatweneed mostIs/arebooks), see 506.
page
492
w " "
^ whatnotused
What is only used as a nominal relative, meaning 'the thing(s) which'. It rannot be used as an ordinary
relative pronoun after a noun or pronoun. We haven't got everything thatyou ordered. (NOT ... everything
what...) The only thing that keeps me awake is coffee.
(NOT -The only thing what...)
We use which, not what, to refer to a whole clause that comes before. Sally married George, which made
Paul very unhappy. (NOT ... what made Paul very unhappy.)
3 what as a determiner
What can be used as a determiner with a noun in a nominal relative clause. What money he has comes
from his family. I'll give you what help I can. {•=... any help that I can.)
4 other nominal relatives
Other words that are used as nominal relatives include whatever, whoever,
whichever, where, wherever, when, whenever and how. Take whatever you want. (=... anything thatyou
want.) I often think about where I met you. (.=... the place where...) We've bought a cottage in the country
for when we retire.
(=... the time when...)
Whenever you want to come is fine with me. (= Any day that...) Look at how he treats me. (=... the way in
which...)
For details of the use of whoever, whatever and other words ending in -ever, see 596. For more about
/low-clauses, see 254.
5 older English: who and that which
In older English, who could be used as a nominal relative, meaning 'whoever', 'anybody who' or 'the
person(s) who'. In modern English, this is
very unusual.
Who steals my purse steals trash. (Shakespeare, Othello)
(Modern English: Whoever/Anybody who...) That which used to be used in the same way as what. This,
too, is very
unusual in modem English.
We have that which we need. (Modern English: We have what we need.)
For other uses of question-word clauses, see 460.5.
W relatives (5): advanced points
1 some of whom, none of which etc
In non-identifying clauses, quantifying determiners (e.g. some, any, none, all, both, several, enough, many
and/ew) can be used with of whom, of which and of whose. The determiner most often comes before of
which/whom/'whose, but can sometimes come after it in a very formal style. They picked up five boat-
loads of refugees, some of whom had been
at sea for several months. (OB ... of whom some...) •
page 493


We've tested three hundred types of boot, none of which is completely waterproof. (OR ... of which
none...)
They've got eight children, all of whom are studying music. (OR ... of whom all are studying...)
She had a teddy-bear, both of whose eyes were missing.
This structure is also possible with other expressions of quantity, with superlatives, with first, second etc,
and with last.
a number of whom three of which half of which the majority of whom the youngest of whom
2 which as determiner
Which can be used as a determiner in relative clauses, with a general noun which repeats the meaning of
what came before. This structure is rather formal, and is mainly used after prepositions, especially in some
fixed phrases like in which case and at which point.
She may be late, in which case we ought to wait for her. Helosthis temper, at which point I decided to go
home.
He was appointed Lord Chancellor, in which post he spent the rest of his life.
He spoke in Greek, which language I could only follow with difficulty.
3 when, where etc replaced by that or dropped
After common nouns referring to time, when is often replaced by that or dropped in an informal style.
Come and see us any time (that) you 're in town. I'll never forget the day (that) we met. That was the year
(that) I first went abroad.
The same thing happens with where after somewhere, anywhere, everywhere, nowhere and place (but
not after other words).
Have you got somewhere (that) I can liedownforan hour? We need a place (that) we can stay fora few
days.
(BUT NOT We need a house we can stay for a few days.)
After way, in which can be replaced by that or dropped in an informal style. / didn 't like the way (that) she
spoke to me.
Do you know a way (that) you can earn money without working? The same thing happens with why after
reason.
The reason (that) you're so bad-tempered is that you're hungry. For more about place, see 427. For way,
see 587. For reason, see 470.
4 relative + infinitive
When a noun or pronoun is the object of a following infinitive, a relative pronoun is not normally used.
/ can't think of anybody to invite. (NOT.. .-anybedy^whom to invite:) However, relative pronouns are
possible with preposition structures.
We moved to the country so that the children would have a garden in which to play.
He was miserable unless he had neighbours with whom to quarrel.
page
494
This structure is rather formal, and it is more common to use infinitive + preposition without a relative
pronoun.
... so that the children would have a garden to play in.
(NOT ... which to play in.)
unless he had neighbours to quarrel with.
(NOT ... whom to quarrel with.)
5 agreement of person
Most relative clauses have third-person reference; I who..., you who... and we who... are unusual, though
they sometimes occur in a very formal style.
You who pass by, tell them of us and say
For their tomorrow we gave our today.
(Allied war memorial at Kohima)
A different kind of first- and second-person reference is common in the relative clauses of cleft sentences
(see 131). However, the verb is usually third-person, especially in an informal style.
It's me that's responsible for the organisation. (More formal: It is I who am responsible...)
You're the one that knows where to go. (NOT ... the one that know...)
6 reduced relative clauses
A participle can often be used instead of a relative pronoun and full verb. Who's the girl dancing with your
brother?
(=... who is dancing with your brother?) Anyone touching that wire will get a shock.
(=... who touches...) Half of the people invited to the party didn't turn up.
(=... who were invited...) I found him sitting at a table covered with papers.
(=... which was covered with papers.) Reduced structures are also used with the adjectives available and
possible. Please send me all the tickets available. (=... that are available.) Tuesday's the only date
possible.
7 omission of subject
In a very informal style, a subject relative pronoun is sometimes dropped after there is.
There's a man at the door wants to talk to you.
8 relative clauses after indefinite noun phrases
The distinction between identifying and non-identifying clauses (see 474) is most clear when they modify
definite noun phrases like the car, this house, my father, Mrs Lewis. After indefinite noun phrases like a
car, some nurses or friends, the distinction is less clear, and both kinds of clause are often possible with
slight differences of emphasis. He's got a new car that goes like a bomb.
o R He's got a new car, which goes like a bomb. We became friendly with some nurses that John had met
in Paris. OR We became friendly with some nurses, whom John had met in Paris. > page 495


..-_-",.,^,v,t;u points 47^
In general, 'identifying' clauses are used when the information they g,v felt to be centrally important to the
overall message. When this is not s e ls non-identifying clauses are preferred. '
9 relative pronouns as general-purpose connectors
In non-identifying clauses, the pronouns who and which sometimes general-purpose connecting words,
rather like and + pronoun. as She passed the letter to Moriarty, who passed it on to me. (=... and he passed
it on...)
I dropped the saucepan, which knocked over the eggs, which went all
the floor. (=... and it knocked... and they went...) r I do a lot of walking, which keeps me fit. (=... and this
keeps me fit}
10 relative clauses with indirect statement etc
It is often possible to combine relative clauses with indirect statements and similar structures, e.g. I
know/said/feel/hope/wish (that).... especially in an
informal style. Expressions like I know, I said etc come after the position of the relative pronoun.
We're going to meet somebody (who/that) I know (that) you'll like. It's a house (which/that) we feel (that)
we might want to buy. That's the man (who/that) I wish (that) I'd married.
Note that the conjunction (the second that) is usually dropped in this structure; it must be dropped if the
relative pronoun is a subject. This is the woman (who/that) Ann said could show us the church.
(NOT This is the woman (who/that) Ann said that could-sheww...) In this structure, people sometimes use
whom as a subject pronoun. This is not generally considered correct.
This is a letter from my father, whom we hope will be out of hospital soon. (More correct:... who we hope
will be out...)
Relative clauses can also be combined with (/-clauses insentences like the •r1: following.
lam enclosingan application/arm, which I should be grateful if you would sign and return.
11 a car that I didn't know how fast it could go, etc
We do not usually combine a relative clause with an indirect question structure. However, this sometimes
happens in informal speech.
I've just been to see an old friend that I'm not sure when I'm going to see again.
There's a pile of washing-up in the kitchen that I just don't know how I'm going to do.
There is no grammatically correct way of doing this when the relative pronoun is the subject of the relative
clause. However, sentences like the
following (with added pronouns) are also sometimes heard in informal British speech.
/ was driving a car that I didn't know how fast it could go. It's ridiculous to sing songs that you don't know
what they mean. There's a control at the back that I don't understand how it works. There's still one kid
that I must find out whether she's coming to the party or not.
2 double object
Occasionally a relative pronoun acts as the object of two verbs. This happens necialty when a relative
clause is followed by before... ing, after... ing or
without... ing.
We have water that it's best not to drink before boiling. (OR ... boiling it)
I'm sending you a letter that I want you to destroy after reading.
(OR ... after reading it.) He was somebody that you could like without admiring.
(OR ... admiring him.)
478 remind
1 remind + object + infinitive; remind + that-clause
The infinitive structure refers to actions: you remind somebody to do something that he/she might forget.
Please remind me to go to the post office.
(NOT -Please remind me-ofgoing...) The structure with a that- clause refers to facts.
I reminded him that we hadn't got any petrol left. This kind of idea can also sometimes be expressed with
remind... about. I reminded her about her dental appointment. (=... that she had to go to the dentist.)
2 remind... of...
We use remind... of to say that something makes us remember the past, or makes us think about things
that have been forgotten.
The smell of hay always reminds me of our old house in the country.
(NOT ... reminds me our old house^...) Remind me of your phone number. We can also use remind... of to
talk about similarities. She reminds me of her mother. (= She is like her mother.)
3 remind and remember
These two verbs are not the same. Reminding somebody means 'making
somebody remember'. Compare:
- Remind me to pay the milkman. (NOT Remember me to pay...)
I'm afraid I won't remember to pay the milkman.
- This sort of weather reminds me of my home.
(NOT This sort of weather remembers me...)
This sort of weather makes me remember my home. •• °' But note the idiomatic use of remember in
Remember me to your parents and similar sentences.
page
496
page
497



8 literary examples
fl Here are two contrasting examples of repetition used deliberately for litera '
purposes. In the first, by John Steinbeck, structures and key vocabulary (nouns and verbs) are repeated
and rhythmically balanced in order to creat an impressive (or mock-impressive) effect - to make the story
and charact e sound striking and important. s This is the story ofDanny and ofDanny's friends and
ofDanny's house ft • a story of how these three became one thing, so that in Tortilla flat if you speak
ofDanny's house you do not mean a structure of wood flaked with old white-wash, overgrown with an
ancient untrimmed rose of Castile. Nn when you speak ofDanny's house you are understood to mean a
unit of which the parts are men, from which came sweetness and joy, philanthropy, and, in the end, a
mystic sorrow. For Danny's house was not unlike the Round Table, and Danny's friends were not unlike
the knights of it. And this is the story of how the group came into being, of how it flourished and grew to be
an organisation beautiful and wise. This story deals with the adventuring of Danny's friends, with the good
they'did, with their thoughts and their endeavors. In the end, this story tells how the talisman was lost and
how the group disintegrated. John Steinbeck, Tortilla Flat)
In contrast, the following text, by Ernest Hemingway, uses a kind of style which 'good' writers would
normally avoid, repeating pronouns and simple structures in an apparently monotonous way.
Hemingway's purpose is to show the simplicity of his hero, an uneducated old fisherman, by using a style
that is supposed to reflect the way he thinks and speaks.
He did not remember when he had first started to talk aloud when he was by himself. He had sung when
he was by himself in the old days and he haiS sung at night sometimes when he was alone steering on his
watch in the smacks or in the turtle boats. He had probably started to talk aloud, when alone, when the
boy had left. But he did not remember. (Ernest Hemingway, The Old Man and the Sea)
480 reporting (I): introduction
There are two main ways of reporting people's words, thoughts, beliefs etc.
1 'direct speech'
We can give the exact words (more or less) that were said, or that we imagine were thought. This kind of
structure is called 'direct speech'.
So he said, 'I want to go home,'and just walked out.
Did she say, 'What do you want?' '
And then I thought, 'Well, does he really mean it?'
For the use of quotation marks with direct speech, see 458. For commas before and after direct speech,
see 455.
page 500
2 'indirect speech'
We can make a speaker's words or thoughts part of our own sentence, using conjunctions (e.g. that), and
changing pronouns, tenses and other words where necessary. This kind of structure is called 'indirect
speech' or
'reported speech'.
So he said that he wanted, to go home, and just walked out.
Did she just ask what I wanted? And then I wondered whether he realty meant it.
3 mixing structures
These two structures cannot normally be mixed (but see 482). She said to me 'I have got no money' and
asked me for help. o R She said to me that she had. got no money and asked me for help. BUT NOT
^he^atd to me that I have got no money and asked me
fr\r h^Jn ~ftfffn/t^/.
For details of direct and indirect speech, see the following sections.
481 reporting (2): basic rules for indirect speech
1 change of situation
Words that are spoken or thought in one place by one person may be reported in another place at a
different time, and perhaps by another person. Because of this, there are often grammatical differences
between direct and indirect speech. These changes are mostly natural and logical, and it is not necessary
to learn complicated rules about indirect speech in English.
BILL (on Saturday evening): I don't like this party. I want to go home now. PETER (on Sunday morning):
Bill said that he didn't like the party, and he wanted to go home right away.
2 pronouns
A change of speaker may mean a change of pronoun. In the example above, Bill says I to refer to himself.
Peter, talking about what Bill said, naturally
uses he.
Bill said that he didn't like the party...
(NOT Bill said that-I-didn't like the party...)
3 'here and now' words
A change of place and time may mean changing words like here, this, now, today. Peter, reporting what
Bill said, does not use this and now because he
is no longer at the party.
Bill said that he didn't like the party...
(NOT -BiH-saM-theit4ie'didn't like this party...) Note that next and last are also 'here and now' words.
Original words Reported words I'll be back next week. She said she'd be back the next week,
but I never saw her again. I got my licence last Tuesday. He said he'd got his licence the Tuesday
before. ^ page 501


4 tenses
A change of time may mean a change of tense: the person reporting uses
tenses that relate to the time when he/she is making the report, not to the time when the original words
were used.
Bill said that he didn 't like the party...
(NOT -Sill said that-he doesn't like the party...)
So after past reporting verbs, the verbs of the original speech are usually 'backshifted* - made more past.
Compare:
Original words
Will you marry me?
You look nice.
Ican'tswim.
Reported words
I asked him if he would marry me.
(NOT ... if ho will marry me.) I told her she looked nice.
(NOT / told her she looks nice.) He pretended he couldn't swim.
(NOT -He pretended he can't swim.) She said she was learning French.
I'm learning French. " -. _, .^,..
(NOT -She-said she is learning French,) I've forgotten. He said he had forgotten.
(NOT -He^cad he has forgotten.) John phoned. She told me that John (had) phoned.
Sometimes this means that past verbs are used to talk about the present or the future.
Your mother said that I could play here today. 'I wondered how you were.' 'You can see how I am.' I knew
you were American. Sorry, I didn't realise this wasyourseat.
After present, future and present perfect reporting verbs, tenses are usually the same as in the original
(because there is no important change of time).
He says he doesn't want to play any more.
I'll tell her your idea is great.
The government has announced that taxes will be raised. 5 dropping that
The conjunction that is often dropped, especially after common reporting verbs (e.g. say, think) in informal
speech.
She said (that) she'd had enough. I think (that) you 're probably right.
That cannot be dropped after certain verbs (e.g. reply, telegraph, shout), and it is not usually dropped after
nouns.
/ replied that I did not intend to stand for election. (NOT I replied I did not intend...)
She shouted that she was busy. (NOT She shouted she was busy.) He disagreed with Copernicus's view
that the earth went round the sun. (NOT ... Copernicus's view thc-earth went...)
For more about omission of that, see 461.8,560.
page 502
questions and answers
Tn reported questions the subject normally comes before the verb in standard English, and auxiliary do is
not used (except in negative questions -see 482.7). The same structure is used for reporting the answers
to questions, and in other uses of question-word clauses.
He wanted to know when I was leaving. (NOT ... when was I leaving.)
I asked where the President and his wife were staying. (NOT I asked where were...)
I knew how they felt. (NOT ... how did they feel.)
Nobody told me why I had to sign the paper. (NOT ... why did I have to sign...)
How you get there is your problem. (NOT How do you get there...) Question marks are not used in
reported questions.
We asked where the money was. (NOT ... where the money was?) Yes/no questions are reported with if
or whether (for the difference, see 593).
The driver asked if/whether I wanted the town centre.
Idon'tknow if/whether I can helpyou. Say and tell are not used to report questions.
NOT The driver said whether I wanted the town centra. But say and tell can introduce the answers to
questions.
Please say whether you want the town centre.
He never says where he's going. I told her what time it was.
For the difference between say and tell, see 487. For more about question-word clauses, see 460.5.
7 actions: promises, orders, requests, advice etc
Speech relating to actions (e.g. promises, agreements, orders, offers, requests, advice and suggestions)
is often reported with infinitives, or object + infinitive.
He promised to write. She agreed to wait for me.
I told Andrew to be careful.
The lady downstairs has asked us to be quiet after nine o'clock.
Ann has offered to baby-sit tonight.
I advise you to think again before you decide.
The policeman told me not to park there. The structure question word + infinitive is common (see 288).
He asked her how to make a white sauce. Don't tell me what to do. We do not use infinitive structures
after suggest or (usually) after say. However, after these and many other verbs, instructions etc can be '•
reported with that- clauses, usually with modal verbs (see 344) or subjunctives (see 541).
He suggested that I try the main car park. (NOT He suggested me to try...)
The policeman said that I mustn't park there. (NOT The policemen said me not to park there.)
I told Andrew that he ought to be careful.
For ought, must and other modal verbs in indirect speech, see 482.5.
For suggest, see 545.
For the structures that are possible after particular verbs, see a good dictionary.
page 503


- "points 4g,
482 reporting (3): advanced points
1 direct speech: word order with reporting verbs
In informal spoken reports, say and think are the normal reporting v
They can go before sentences or at other natural breaks (e.g. between6 i or after discourse markers).
^Uses
So I said 'What are you doing in our bedroom?' 'I'm sorry', he said 'I thought it was my room.'Well,
[thought, that's funny, he'sgotrnv
handbagopen. 'If that's the case,'I said, 'what are you doing with mv handbag?'
In novels, short stories etc, a much wider variety of reporting verbs arp for example ask, exclaim, suggest,
reply, cry, reflect, suppose, grunt, snarl ' hiss, whisper. And inversion (see 299) is often used. 'Is this Mr
Rochester's house?'asked Emma.
'Great Heavens!' cried Celia. 'Is there no end to your wickedness? I imolor
you - leave me alone!' 'Never,'hissed the Duke... Inversion is not normal with pronoun subjects.
'You monster!' she screamed. (NOT ... screamed she.)
In literary writing, reporting expressions often interrupt the normal flow of the sentences quoted.
Your information,' I replied, 'is out of date.' For more about inversion, see 298, 299.
2 indirect speech: word order with what, who and which
When we report questions constructed with who/what/which + be+ complement, be can be put before or
after the complement.
1 '' - Direct: Who's the best player here?
Indirect: She asked me who was the best player.
She asked me who the best player was.
- Direct: What's the matter?
Indirect: / asked what was the matter. I asked what the matter was.
- Direct: Which is my seat?
Indirect: She wondered which was her seat. She wondered which her seat was.
3 indirect speech: reporting past tenses
In indirect speech, a speaker's present perfect and past tenses are often reported using past perfect
tenses (because the events he/she spoke about had happened before he/she spoke, and because the
reporter's point otvie is not the same as the original speaker's point of view).
- Direct: I've just written to John.
Indirect: She told me she had just written to John. - Direct: I saw Penny at the theatre a couple of day
sago.
Indirect: In his letter, he said he'd seen Penny at the theatre a couple of days before.
page
504

r-
However, it is often unnecessary to show the time relationship between the ents spoken about and the
original speech. When this is so - when the norter sees the past events from the same point of view as the
original
r eaker - past perfect tenses are not used.
This man on TV said that dinosaurs were around for 250 million years.
(NOT .. .-tha^dinosaurs had been around...) Hold you John phoned this morning, didn'tl? We were glad to
hear you enjoyedyour trip to Denmark.
. indirect speech: reporting present and future tenses
If somebody talked about a situation that has still not changed - that is to say, if the original speaker's
present and future are still present and future -a reporter can often choose whether to keep the original
speaker's tenses or change them. Both structures are common.
- Direct: The earth goes round the sun.
Indirect: He proved that the earth goes/went round the sun.
- Direct: How old are you?
Indirect: Areyou deaf? I asked how oldyou are/were.
- Direct: Where does she work?
Indirect: I've often wondered where she works/worked.
- Direct: It will be windy tomorrow.
Indirect: The forecast said it will/would be windy tomorrow.
We do not keep the original speaker's tenses if we do not agree with what he/she said, if we are not
certain of its truth, or if we wish to make it clear that the information comes from the original speaker, not
from ourselves.
The Greeks thought that the sun went round the earth. (NOT ... that the sun goes round the earth.)
Did you hear that? She just said she was fourteen!
He announced that profits were higher than forecast.
5 modal verbs in indirect speech
The modals would, should, could, might, ought and must are usually unchanged after past reporting verbs
in indirect speech. This is also true of modal need (see 357) and had better (see 234). ,
~ Direct: It would be nice if I could see you again.
Indirect: He said it would be nice if he could see me again.
- Direct: It might be too late.
Indirect: 7 was afraid that it might be too late.
- Direct: It must be pretty late. I really must go.
Indirect: She said it must be pretty late and she really must go. ~ Direct: You needn't pretend to be sorry.
Indirect: I said he needn't pretend...
First-person shall and conditional should may be reported as would in indirect speech (because of the
change of person).
Direct: We shall/should be delighted to come.
Indirect: They said they would be delighted to come.
page 505


cupumrs 490
Note the different ways of reporting questions beginning Shall I...? (depending on whether the speaker is
asking for information or making
- Direct: Shall I be needed tomorrow?
Indirect: He wants to know if he will be needed tomorrow.
- Direct: Shall I carry your bag?
Indirect: He wants to know if he should/can carry your bag.
6 conditionals
After past reporting verbs, conditional sentences referring to 'unreal' situations are often reported with past
conditionals.
Direct: If I had any money I'd buy you a drink. Indirect: She said if she had had any money she would have
bought me
drink. (OR She said if she had any money she would buy.. }
(Compare the first example in paragraph 5, which does not refer to an 'unreal' situation.)
For details of conditional structures, see 258-264. Vox had to as a past of must, see 349,351.
7 negative questions
Do can be used in indirect negative questions, as a negative auxiliary. Direct: 'Why don't you work
harder?' Indirect: She asked why he didn 't work harder.
Note that negative questions often express emotions such as surprise or enthusiasm (see 360), and these
are usually reported in special ways.
Direct: Don't the children like ice-cream ?
Indirect: She was surprised that the children didn't like ice-cream. (NOT She asked if the children didn't
like ice cream.)
Direct: Isn 't she lovely!
Indirect: / remarked how lovely she was.
(NOT ^-askeeU^she wasn 't lovely:)
8 embedded reporting expressions
Complicated structures can be produced in informal speech when reporting expressions are put into
sentences with question-word clauses or relatives.
She's written I don't know how many books.
He's gone I don't know where.
This is the man who Ann said would tell us about the church.
For more about relative structures of this kind, see 477.10-11. For more about embedding in general, see
188.
9 • indirect speech without reporting verbs
In British npwcnat-tor ro,-l;^ r,^^ 'nr.-- -^
In British debates
i newspaper, radio and TV reports, reports of parliamentary ^ records of conferences, minutes of meetings
etc, the indirect sp
construction is often used with very few reporting verbs. The use of tenses is
enough to make it clear that a text is a report.
The Managing Director began his address to the shareholders by summarising the results for the year.
Profits on the whole had been high, though one or two areas had been disappointing. It was, however,
important to maintain a high level of investment, and he was sure that the shareholders would
appreciate...
In literary narrative, similar structures are common. The reported speech
may be made more vivid by using direct question structures and 'here and
now' words.
At breakfast, Peter refused to go to school. Why should he spend all his time sitting listening to idiots?
What use was all that stuff anyway? If he stayed at home he could read books. He might even learn
something useful. His father, as usual, was unsympathetic. Peter had to go to school, and he had better
get moving now, or there'd be trouble.
483 requests
1 yes/no questions
We usually ask people to do things for us by making yes/no questions. (This
is because ayes/no question appears to leave people free to refuse.) Some
typical structures used in requests:
Could you possibly help me for a few minutes? (very polite)
Wouldyou mind helping me for a few minutes?
Wouldyou like to help me for a few minutes?
Couldyou help me for a few minutes? (more informal)
You couldn't help me for a few minutes, could you? (informal) 1:
Indirect yes/no questions are also used in polite requests. I wonder if you could (possibly) help me for a
few minutes.
2 other structures: telling people to do things
If we use other structures (for example imperatives, should, had better), we are not asking people to do
things, but telling or advising them to do things. These structures can therefore seem rude if we use them
in requests, especially in conversation with strangers or people we do not know well. Please makes an
order or instruction a little more polite, but does not turn it into a request. The following structures can be
used perfectly correctly to give orders, instructions or advice, but they are not polite ways of requesting
People to do things.
Please help me for a few minutes.
Help me, would you?
Carry this for me, please.
Please answer by return of post.
Please type your letter.
Yououghtto tell me your plans.
You should shut the door.
You had better help me.
You are kindly requested not to smoke.
s use of imperatives to give advice, make suggestions etc, see 268.
506
page 507


'" (.me) rest
3 shops, restaurants etc
Typical structures used in shops, restaurants etc are:
Can I have one of those, please?
Could I have a look at the red ones?
I'd like to see the wine list, please.
I would prefer a small one.
In places where only a few kinds of thing are sold and not much needs to be said, it is enough just to say
what is wanted and add please.
'The Times', please.
Pint of bitter, please.
Two cheeseburgers, please.
Second-class return to Lancaster, please.
4 negative questions
Negative questions are not used in polite requests.
Couldyou give me a light?
(NOT Couldn't you give me a light? - this sounds like a complaint.) But negative statements with question
tags are used in informal requests.
You couldn't give me a light, couldyou?
I don't suppose you could give me a light, couldyou? (very polite) |
For more about negative questions, see 360. ^ For (I should be grateful) if you would..., see 259.3. For
other rules of 'social language', see 520. For formality and politeness, see 216.
14 (the) rest
The rest means 'what is left'. It is always singular in form, and the is always used.
We only use three rooms. The rest of the house is empty. To talk about what is left after something has
been used up, eaten, destroyed etc, we often use other words.
There were remains of the meal all over the floor. (NOT There were rests...)
Supper tonight is leftovers from lunch. (NOT .. .^ests...) When the rest refers to a plural noun, it has a
plural verb.
There are four chocolates for Penny, four for Joe and the rest are mine. (NOT ... the rest is mine.)
15 road and street
1 the difference
A street is a road with houses on either side. We use street for roads in towns or villages, but not for
country roads.
Cars can park on both sides of the street here.
Our village has only got one street. Road is used for both town and country.
Cars can park on both sides of our road. \-
The road out of our village goes up a steep hill. (NOT The street out of our village...)
page 508
street names: stress
In street names we normally stress the word Road, but the word before Street. Marylebone 'Road ' Oxford
Street
436 (the) same
again, please.)
We normally use the before same.
Give me the same again, please. (NOT Give me sai Before a noun or pronoun, we use the same as.
I want a shirt that's the same as the one in the window. (NOT I want a same shirt like-...)
You've got the same idea as me. (NOT ...my same idea.)
Her hair's the same colour as her mother's. Before a clause, the same... that or the same... who can be
used.
That's the same man that/who asked me for money yesterday. As is also possible before a clause,
especially with a noun that is the object of •the following verb. There is no difference of meaning between
the same...
that and the same... as in this case.
He was wearing the same shirt that/as he'd had on the day before. As/who/that can be left out when they
refer to the object of the following verb.
He was wearing the same shirt he'd had on the day before.
Note also the expression do the same.
Why do you always try to do the same as your brother? Joe and Carol went on a camping holiday, and I
think we're going to do the
same.
For do that and do so, see 166. For other uses of the same, see a good dictionary.
487 say and tell
1 meaning and use
Both say and tell are used with direct and indirect speech. (Say is more common than tell with direct
speech.) Say refers to any kind of speech; tell is only used to mean 'instruct' or 'inform'.
- 'Tu rn righ t, 'I said.
OR 'Turn right,'I told him.
- She said that it was my last chance.
o R She told me that it was my last chance. He said,'Good morning.'
(BUT NOT He told them, 'Good morning.") Mary said., 'What a nice idea.'
(BUT NOT Mary told us, 'What a nice idea.')
'What's your problem ?' I said.
(BUT NOT 'What's your problem?'I told her.)
page 509


4
2 objects
After fe//, we usually say who is told.
She told me that she would be late. (NOT She told-that...) Say is most often used without a personal
object.
She said that she would be late. (NOT She said me.,.) If we want to put a personal object after say, we
use to.
And I say to all the people of this great country... Tell is not used before objects like a word, a name, a
sentence, a phrase.
Alice said a naughty word this morning. (NOT Alice told...) We do not usually use it after tell to refer to a
fact.
'What time's the meeting?' Til tell you tomorrow.' (NOT -fH-tell-you it tomorrow.')
3 infinitives
Tell can be used before object + infinitive, in the sense of 'order' or 'instruct'. Say cannot be used like this.
/ told the children to go away. (NOT I said the children to go away.) tell without a personal object
Tell is used without a personal object in a few expressions. Common examples: tell the truth, tell a lie, tell
a story ijoke.
I don't think she's telling the truth. (NOT.. . saying the truth.)
Note also the use of tell to mean 'distinguish', 'understand', as in tell the difference, tell the time.
5 indirect questions
Neither tell nor say can introduce indirect questions. Bill asked whether I wanted to see a film.
(NOT Bill said whether I wanted to see a film.) (NOT Bill told me whether...) "' But say and tell can
introduce the answers to questions. " Has she said who's coming? 1! He only told one person where the
money was.
For indirect speech, see 480-482. For so after say and tell, see 514.
i see
I progressive forms not used
When see means 'perceive with one's eyes', progressive forms are not normally used. To talk about
seeing something at the moment of speaking' can see is often used in British English (see 125).
lean see an aeroplane. (US also I see an airplane.) (NOT lam seeing an aeroplane:)
But we can say that somebody is seeing things if we mean that he/she is imagining things that are not
there.
'Look! A camel!' 'You 're seeing things,'

When see means 'understand' or 'have heard' (see 246), progressive forms are not normally used.
'We've got a problem.' 'I see.'
I see they're talking about putting up taxes again. Note that we say have a dream, not see a dream.
2 changes
Progressive forms are occasionally used to talk about changes in people's
ability to see.
I'm seeing much better since I got those new glasses. I'm reading 'War and Peace' again, and I'm seeing
a lot of things that I missed the first time.
3 'consider', 'think', 'find out'
See is used to mean 'consider' or 'think' in some expressions, like I'll see and let me see. Note that a
preposition is necessary before the object in these
cases.
We'll see about that tomorrow. (NOT We'll see that tomorrow.)
You 'd better see about that with Jim. (NOT You'd bettor sec that with Jim.) See can be used with
if/whether to mean 'find out'.
Can you look out of the window and see if it's still snowing?
I think I'll go round and see whether Janet's at home. See if... can often means 'try to'.
See if you can get him to stop talking.
4 'meet', 'arrange' etc
When see means 'meet', 'interview', 'talk to', 'go out with' or'arrange', 'supervise', progressive forms are
possible.
I'm seeing the dentist tomorrow.
Are you still seeing that Henderson woman?
John's down at the docks. He's seeing that our stuff gets loaded properly.
For see + object + infinitive/-irag form, see 245.
For the difference between see, look and watch, see 489.
For see above and see over, see 6.6.
489 see, look (at) and watch
1 see s
See is the ordinary verb to say that something 'comes to our eyes', whether or not we are paying attention.
Suddenly I saw something strange.
(NOT Suddenly I looked at something strange.)
Did you see the article about the strike in today's paper? Progressive forms of see are not normally used
with this meaning.
I (can) see a light. (NOT I'm seeing a light.) >
page
510
page 511


-«OS
2 Zoofc ^
We use look to talk about concentrating, paying attention, trying to see wh
is there. You can see something without wanting to, but you can only look a something deliberately.
Compare:
/ looked at the photo, but I didn 't see anybody I knew.
'Do you see the man in the raincoat?' 'Yes.' 'Look again.' 'Good heavens' It's Moriarty!'
He looked at her with his eyes full of love.
When look has an object it is followed by a preposition. When there is no object there is no preposition.
Compare:
Look at me! (NOT Look me!) Look! (NOT Look at!) Note that at is often dropped before a w/;-clause.
Look (at) what you 've done! Look who's here! Look where you 're going.
3 watch
Watch is like look at, but suggests that something is happening or going to happen. We watch things that
change, move or develop. . : Watch that man -1want to know everythinghe does.
I usually watch a football match on Saturday afternoon, -dta The police have been watching the house for
three days. |H
4 complete experiences: see 1I||
Watch is typically used to talk about experiences that are going on, in
progress. We often prefer see to talk about the whole of a performance, play, cinema film, match etc.
Compare:
He got into a fight yesterday afternoon while he was watching a football match. (NOT .. .-while-hc-wof^^0^"
" c" -"'
,-.^ ...^ wwf M/Mtt/f
rnatcn. (NOT ... while he was seeing a football-match.) Have you ever seen Chaplin's 'The Great
Dictator'?
(NOT _EJ/i,."•-• -
5
Watch is normally used with TV; watch and see are both used to talk about TV programmes and films.
You spend too much time watching TV. We watched/saw a great film on TV last night. Did you watch/see
'Top of the Pops'on Thursday? 6 see if/whether
See can be followed by if/whether, in the sense of 'find out'. Look and watch are not normally used in this
way.
See if that suit still fits you. (NOT -Look if that suit...) I'm looking to see whether there's any food left.
(NOT -I'm looking whether there's...) Ring up and see whether she's in.
There are similar differences between hear and listen (to). See 244. For infinitives and -ing forms after
these verbs, see 245.
For other meanings of see (and progressive uses), see 246,451.2. For other meanings of look, see
159.19. For (/and whether, see 593.
page 512
490 seem
1 copular verb: used with adjectives
Seem is a 'copular verb' (see 147); it is followed by adjectives, not adverbs. You seem angry about
something. (NOT You seem angrily...)
2 seem and seem to be
Seem is often followed by to be. In general, seem to be is preferred when we are talking about objective
facts - things that seem definitely to be true; seem is used without to be when we are talking about
subjective impressions. (The difference is not always clear-cut, and in many cases both are possible.)
Compare:
- The milk seems to be sterilised. She seems excited.
- The doctors have done all the tests, and he definitely seems to be insane. It seems insane, but I think I'm
in love with the postman. (NOT It seems to be insane...)
- According to the experts, the north side of the castle seems to be about 100
years older than the rest. He seems older than he is.
(NOT He seems to be older than he is - this would suggest that he might actually be older than he is.)
- She doesn 't seem to be ready yet. She seems (to be) very sleepy today.
3 with nouns
Seem to be is normal before noun phrases.
/ looked through the binoculars: it seemed to be some sort of large rat.
(NOT ... it seemed some sort of large rat.) I spoke to a man who seemed to be the boss.
(NOT ... who seemed the boss.)
However, to be can be dropped before noun phrases which express more subjective feelings, especially in
British English. She seems (to be) a nice girl. The cup seemed almost doll's size in his hands. It seems a
pity, but I can't see you this weekend. (NOT It seems to be a pity...)
4 other infinitives
Seem can be followed by the infinitives of other verbs besides be.
Ann seems to need a lot of attention. Perfect infinitives (see 276) are possible.
The tax people seem to have made a mistake. To express a negative idea, we most often use a negative
form of seem; but in a more formal style not can go with the following infinitive. Compare:
He doesn't seem to be at home.
He seems not to be at home. (formal) >
page 513


Note the structure can't seem to... Ican'tseem to get anything right.
(More formal: I seem not to be able to get anything right.) For other examples of 'transferred negation', see
359.
5 seem like
We can use like, but not as, after seem.
North Wales seems (like) a good place for a holiday. (NOT ... seems as a good place...)
6 it seems
It can be used as a preparatory subject for that-clauses and as ^-clauses after seem.
It seems that Bill and Alice have had a row. It seemed as if the night was never going to end.
7 there seems
There can be used as a preparatory subject for seem to be. There seems to be some m is take.
For like and as, see 320. For it as a preparatory subject, see 301.
For there as a preparatory subject, see 562. For appear, see 58.
491 sensible and sensitive
A sensible person has 'common sense', and does not make stupid decisions.
7want to buythatdress."Be sensible, dear. You haven't got that much money.'
A sensitive person feels things easily or deeply, and may be easily hurt. Don't shout at her - she's very
sensitive. (NOT .. .very sensible.) Have you got a sun cream for sensitive skin? (NOT .. .-fer-sensible
skin7)
Note that sensible is a 'false friend' - similar words in some languages mean 'sensitive'.
492 shade and shadow
Shade is protection from the sun.
I'm hot. Let's find some shade to sit in. The temperature's 30 degrees in the shade.
We say shadow when we are thinking of the 'picture' made by an unlighted area.
In the evening your shadow is longer than you are. There's an old story about a man without a shadow.
493 short answers
Answers are often grammatically incomplete, because they do not need to repeat words that have just
been said. A typical 'short answer' pattern is subject + auxiliary verb, together with whatever other words
are really necessary.
'Can he swim2' 'Yes, he can.'
(More natural than 'Yes, he can swim.')
'Has it stopped raining?' 'No, it hasn't.'
'Are you enjoying yourself?' 'I certainly am.'
'You'll be on holiday soon.' 'Yes, I will.'
'Don't forget to telephone.' 'I won't.'
'You didn't phone Debbie last night."No, but I did this morning.' Non-auxiliary be and have are also used in
short answers.
'Is she happy?"! think she is.' 'Have you a light7''Yes, I have.' We use do and did in answers to sentences
that have neither an auxiliary verb nor non-auxiliary be or have.
'She likes cakes.' 'She really does.' 'That surprised you.' 'It certainly did.' Short answers can be followed by
tags (see 465-466).
'Nice day.' 'Yes, it is, isn't it?' Note that stressed, non-contracted forms are used in short answers.
Yes, I am. (NOT Yes, I'm.)
For similar structures, see 463 (reply questions), 465-466 (question tags) and 185 (ellipsis). For So am /
etc, see 516.1. For So lam etc, see 516.2.
494 should (I): the difference between should and would
There are really three different verbs: should, would, and the mixed verb
should/would.
1 should
This verb (I should, you should, he/she/it should etc) is used to talk about
(obligation, and in some other ways. For details, see 495-497. Everybody should wear car seat belts. She
should be back tomorrow.
2 would
This verb (I would, you would, he/she/it would etc) can be used to talk about past habits. For details, see
604.
When we were kids we would spend hours kicking a ball about, dreaming of being soccer internationals.
3 should/would
This verb - often considered as a 'conditional auxiliary' - has mixed forms:
I should/would, you would, he/she/it would, we should/would, they would. In general, should/would is used
as a past form, or less definite form, of
page 514
page 515


shall/will. It is common in requests, offers and sentences with if. For more details, see 498.
/ told them we should/would probably be late. I should/would be grateful for an early reply. Would you like
some help? If they could sing in tune it wouldn't be so bad. If you would come this way, madam.
495 should (2): obligation, deduction etc
1 forms
Should is a modal auxiliary verb (see 344-345). It has no -s in the third person singular.
The postman should be here soon. (NOT The postman shoulds...) Questions and negatives are made
without do.
Should we tell Judy? (NOT Do we should...?) Should is followed by an infinitive without to.
Shouldlgo? (NOT Should I to go?} She should be told the truth. There is a contracted negative shouldn't.
The meeting shouldn't take long.
Should has a weak pronunciation /J"(a)d/, often used when should is not stressed (see 588).
2 obligation
We often use should to talk about obligation, duty and similar ideas. It is less ; strong than must.
People should drive more carefully.
You shouldn't say things like that to Granny.
Applications should be sent before December 30th.
(More polite than Applications must be sent...] In questions, should is used to ask for advice or
instructions, like a less definite form of shall (see 222).
Shouldlgo and see the police, do you think? What should we do? Should can also act as a past form of
shall in indirect speech.
Direct speech: What shall we do ?
Indirect speech: They asked what they should do.
For the differences between should, ought to and must, see 496. For the difference between should and
had better, see 234.
3 deduction
We can use should to say that something is probable (because it is logical or
normal).
Henry should get here soon - he left home at six. 'We're spending the winter in Florida.' 'Thatshouldbe
nice.'
4 past uses
Should + infinitive can be used to talk about the past in indirect speech
(see 482.5).
I knew that I should write to Jane, but it seemed too difficult.
page 516

/ In other cases, should + infinitive is not normally used to talk about^
Instead, we can use for example was/were supposed to... (see 547). «;
It was going to be a long day. I was supposed to clean up all thesS11
and then start on the garden. (NOT .. .{should clean up...) She was supposed to be in her office, but she
wasn't.
(NOT She should be in her office, but she wasn't.)
5 should have... j
Should can be used with a perfect infinitive to talk about past events did not happen, or which may or may
not have happened.
I should have phoned Ed this morning, but I forgot, i Ten o'clock: she should have arrived in the office by
now. / Should not have... refers to unwanted things that happened, or to 11
probabilities.
You shouldn't have called him a fool - it really upset him. Nine o 'clock: they shouldn't have left home yet -
I'll phone them.
for should in if-clauses, see 261.2.
For should after in case, see 271.2.
For should after so that and in order that, see 519.
For How should...? and Why should... ?, see 464.2.
For special uses of should in other subordinate clauses, see 497.
496 should (3): should, ought and must
1 should and ought
Should and ought are very similar, and can often replace each othe'' (
They ought to be more sensible, shouldn't they? JI They are both used to talk about obligation and duty, to
give advice' / say what we think it is right for people to do or have done. Should i8
more frequent than ought.
You should I ought to see 'Daughter of the Moon'- it's a great fill11'
You should I ought to have seen his face! Should and ought are not used in polite requests.
Couldyou move your head a bit? I can't see.
(NOT You should Iought to move yow'head a bit...) , Should and ought are both also used to talk about
logical probabil'"
I've bought three loaves - that should/ought to be enough, if
That should Iought to be Janet coming upstairs now. J Note that should is followed by the infinitive without
to, and ought to- infinitive.
2 mustand should/ought A1
Wi
Must has similar meanings to should and ought, but is stronger or* (;
definite. It expresses great confidence that something will happen' f something is true; should and ought
express less confidence. Coiw - The doctor said I must give up smoking.
(an order which is likely to be obeyed) You really ought to give up smoking.
(a piece of advice which may or may not be followed) /


- Rob must be home by now. (= I'm sure he is home.)
Rob should be home by now. (= I think he is probably home.)
Should can be used instead of must to make orders and instructions sound more polite.
This form should be filled in in ink.
Applications should be sent by 31 January. Should and ought can be used for predictions. Must is not
used in this way.
It should be fine tomorrow. (BUT NOT It must be fine tomorrow:) Should and ought can be used with
perfect infinitives to talk about unfulfilled obligation in the past. Must is not used like this.
You should have been nicer to Annie.
(BUT NOT -You must have bi
For more about should, see 494-495.
For details of the use of must, see 349-352.
For the difference between should/ought and had better, see 234.
97 should (4): in subordinate clauses
1 importance
In formal British English, should can be used in that-clauses after adjectives
and nouns expressing the importance of an action (e.g. important, necessary,
vital, essential, eager, anxious, concerned, wish).
It's important that she should talk tome when she gets here.
Is it necessary that my uncle should be informed?
I'm anxious that nobody should be hurt.
It is his wish that the money should be given to charity.
This also happens after verbs expressing similar ideas, especially in
sentences about the past.
He insisted that the contract should be read aloud. I recommended that she should reduce her
expenditure.
In a less formal style, should is less often used and other structures are preferred.
It's important that she talks to me when she gets here. Was it necessary to tell my uncle?
In American English, this use of should is unusual; subjunctives may be used (see 541).
It's important that she talk to me when she gets here. Was it necessary that my uncle be informed? I
recommend that she reduce her expenditure.
2 reactions
Should is also used in subordinate clauses after words expressing personal judgements and reactions,
especially to facts which are already known or have already been mentioned. (This use, too, is more
common in British than American English.)
It's astonishing that she should say that sort of thing to you. I was shocked that she shouldn't have invited
Phyllis. I'm sorry you should think I did it on purpose. Do you think it's normal that the child should be so
tired?
page 518
In American English, would is usual in this kind of case.
It was natural that they would want him to go to a good school.
(GB... that they should...) Sentences like these can also be constructed without should. Subjunctives
cannot be used.
It's astonishing that she says/said that sort of thing to you.
(BUT NOT It's astonishing that she say...) I was shocked that she didn't invite Phyllis.
3 other cases
Should can be used in (f-clauses (see 261.2 for details), after in case (see 271.2), after for fear that and
lest (see 314) and after so that and in order that (see 519).
If you should see Caroline, tell her I've got the tickets. I'll get a chicken out of the freezer in case Aunt
Mary should come. He turned the radio down so that he shouldn't disturb the old lady downstairs.
498 should (5) .should/would
1 mixed forms
! This modal auxiliary verb has the following forms:
; I should/would ; youwould
he/she/it would
we should/would
they would
After I and we, both should and would can be used with the same meaning. I However, first-person should
is rare in American English, and is becoming I less common in British English.
| In an informal style the contraction 'd is often used instead of should/would, especially after pronouns.
2 past /less definite form of shall/will
Should/would can be used like a past or less definite form of the future auxiliary shall/will. This happens,
for example, in indirect speech and in 'future in the past' constructions (see 226). Compare:
- / shall/will be home soon.
I knew that I should/would be home soon.
- That's the college where Sue will be studying in October.
Sue looked at the college where she would be studying in October.
- Will you be able to baby-sit tomorrow night? (definite enquiry)
Would you be able to baby-sit tomorrow night?
(less definite, more hesitant enquiry)
Should/would is commonly used in polite offers and requests with the verbs like, love and prefer.
'Wouldyou like some tea?' Td prefer coffee, ifyou don'tmind.' >
page 519


3

4
conditional sentences
Because of its less definite meaning, should/would is used in some
conditional structures (see 260), and is often called a 'conditional auxiliary' If I had a free weekend, I
should/would go and see Liz. (NOT If'1had.... Ishall/will...)
If your father were alive now, he would be shocked to see how you're living Supposing war broke out,
what would you do?
should/would have...
Should/would can be used with a perfect infinitive to talk about situations that are different from what
actually happened.
I should/would have liked to study medicine, but it wasn't possible.
If we'd known you were coming we should/would have taken the day off.
He would not have succeeded without his parents' help.
Note the structure 1should/would have thought..., used in British English to express surprise.
It's funny that she doesn 't like him. I should have thought they'd get on terribly well.
5 subordinate clauses
Should/would is most common in main clauses. In most kinds of
subordinate clauses, the same meanings are expressed with past tenses (see 556).
In a situation like that, I would scream until somebody came to help me. (NOT ... until somebody would
come...}
For more about the 'indirect' use of past forms ('distancing'), see 161. For Ishould meaning 'If I were you, I
should...', see 264.
(9 since: tenses
1 tenses in the main clause
In sentences with since, we normally use present perfect and past perfect tenses in the main clause.
They've known each other since 1980.
(NOT They know each other since-...) We haven't seen famie since Christmas.
I was sorry when Jacky moved to America; we had been good friends since university days.
However, present and past tenses are also occasionally found, especially! sentences about changes.
You're looking much better since your operation. She doesn't come round to see us so much since her
marriage. Since last Sunday I can't stop thinking about you. Since he went on that course he thinks he
knows everything. Things weren't going so well since Father had lost his job. This often happens in the
structure It is/was... since... '""" • " g last meeting.
' of tennis, (o R It had been ages since...) page 520
m
no uiien nappens in the structure It is/was... It's (been) a long time since the last meeting. It was ages
since our last game of tennis, (o H
2 tenses in swce-clauses
In the examples above, since is used as a preposition. But since can also be used as a conjunction of
time, introducing its own clause. The tense in the since-clause can be perfect or past, depending on the
meaning. Compare:
- I've known her since we were at school together. I've known her since I've lived in this street.
- We visit my parents every week since we bought the car. We visit my parents every week since we've
had the car.
- You've drunk about ten cups of tea since you arrived.
You've drunk about ten cups of tea since you've been sitting here.
- They had been close friends since Alice was small.
They hadn't seen much of each other since Polly (had) moved away. Sometimes a present perfect tense
is used in a since-clause, exceptionally, to refer to a finished point of time.
It is now a year since we have last discussed your future. (More normal:... since we last discussed...)
For more about present perfect tenses, including American usage, see 418-420.
For past perfect tenses, see 421.
For the difference between since and/or, see 214.
For the difference between since and from, see 214.
For since meaning 'as' or 'because', see 72.
500 singular and plural (1): regular plurals
The plural of most nouns is made by just adding -s to the singular. But there are some special cases.
1 plural of nouns ending in consonant +y
If the singular ends in consonant +y (for example -by, -dy, -ry, -ty), the plural is normally made by
changing}/ to i and adding -es.
Singular Plural
ip;.. consojaaft^l .... consQirt||HSii

baby lady
ferry party
babies ladies
ferries parties
If the singular ends in vowel + y (e.g. day, boy, guy, donkey), the plural is made by adding -s (days, boys,
guys, donkeys).
Proper names ending in consonant + y usually have plurals in -ys. Do you know the Kennedys? I hate
Februarys.
page 521


2 plural of nouns ending in sh, ch, s, x or z
If the singular ends in -sh, -ch, -s, -x or -z, the plural is made by adding -, Singular Plural
.. .ch/shfsfx/y '.. .ches/shes/ses/xes/ses church churches crashes buses boxes buzzes
Nouns ending in a single -z have plurals in -zzes: quiz/quizzes, fez/fezzes.
3 plural of nouns ending in o
Some nouns ending in -o have plurals in -es. The most common:
Singular Plural Singular Plural
echo echoes potato potatoes
hero heroes tomato tomatoes negro neeroes
crash bus box buzz
echoes heroes negroes
Nouns ending in vowel + o have plurals in -s (e.g. radios, zoos). So do the following, and most new words
that come into the lantmaw
Singular
commando
concerto
Eskimo
kilo
logo
come into the language:
Plural
commandos
concertos
Eskimos
kilos
logos
A few common words ending in -o can have plurals in -s or -es. Singular Plural Singular
buffalo buffalo(e)s tornado mosquito mosquito(e)s volcano
Singular

Plural

photo

photos

piano

pianos

solo

solos

soprano

sopranos

Plural
tornado(e)s volcano(e)s
501 singular and plural (2): irregular and special plurals
1 irregular plurals in -ves
The following nouns ending in -f(e) have plurals in -ves.
Singular

Plural

calf

calves

elf

elves

half

halves

knife

knives

leaf

leaves

life

lives

loaf

loaves

Singular

Plural

self

selves

sheaf

sheaves

shelf

shelves

thief

thieves

wife

wives

wolf

wolves

Dwarf, hoof, scarf and wharf can have plurals in either -ft or 'ves. Other words ending in -f(e) are regular.
page
522
-OlIlULlldl dllU UiU.l.CU \L-J. 11-i^gixioi a.nu ay^^tws- yxvo.vo.cy
9 other irregular plurals
Singular Plural
child

children

foot

feet

goose

geese

louse

lice

man

men

Singular

Plural

ox

oxen

penny
person
tooth

pence
people
teeth

woman

women

mouse
mice
The regular plural pennies can be used to talk about separate penny coins (and one-cent coins in the
USA); pence is used to talk about prices and sums of money. Some British people now use pence as a
singular (e.g. That'll be three pounds and one pence, please}.
Persons is sometimes used as a plural of person in official language. There is also a singular noun people
(plural peoples) meaning 'nation'.
plural same as singular
Some words ending in -s do not change in the plural. Common examples:
Singular Plural Singular Plural
barracks barracks series series crossroads crossroads species species headquarters headquarters works
(= factory) works means means Swiss Swiss
Note that some singular uncountable nouns end in -s. These have no plurals. Examples are news,
billiards, draughts (and some other names of games ending in -s), measles (and some other illnesses).
Most words ending in -ics (e.g. mathematics, physics, athletics, politics) are normally singular uncountable
and have no plural use. Too much mathematics is usually taught in schools. (NOT Too many mathematics
are...)
Some words ending in -ics (e.g. politics, statistics) can also have plural uses. Politics is a complicated
business. (BUT What are your politics?) Statistics is useful in language testing.
(BUT The unemployment statistics are disturbing.)
Other nouns which do not change in the plural are craft (meaning 'vehicle'), aircraft, hovercraft, spacecraft,
Chinese, Japanese (and other nationality nouns ending in -ese), sheep, fish, deer, and the names of some
other living creatures (especially those that are hunted or used for food).
Dozen, hundred, thousand, million, stone (= 14 pounds) and foot (= 12 inches) have plurals without -s in
some kinds of expressions. For details, see 385.14.
Dice (used in board games) is originally the plural of die, which is not now often used in this sense; in
modern English dice is generally used as both Angular and plural. Data is originally the plural of datum,
which is not now ysed; in modern English data is used as both singular and plural. >
page 523


4
Singular
analysis appendix bacterium basis cactus crisis criterion diagnosis formula
fungus
hypothesis
kibbutz
medium
nucleus
oasis
phenomenon
radius
stimulus
vertebra
foreign plurals
Some words which come from foreign languages have special plurals. Examples:
Plural
analyses (Latin)
appendices (Latin) or appendixes
bacteria (Latin)
bases (Greek)
cacti (Latin) or cactuses
crises (Greek)
criteria (Greek)
diagnoses (Greek)
formulae (Latin) or formulas
fungi (Latin) or funguses
hypotheses (Greek)
kibbutzim (Hebrew)
media (Latin) or mediums
nuclei (Latin) or nucleuses oases (Greek) phenomena (Greek) radii (Latin) or radiuses stimuli (Latin)
vertebrae (Latin) or vertebras
Note that some foreign plurals (e.g. agenda, spaghetti) are singular in English (see 148.2). :
i plurals in 's
An apostrophe (') is used before the -'s in the plurals of letters of the
alphabet, and sometimes in the plurals of dates and abbreviations. She spelt 'necessary' with two c's.
I loved the 1960's. (OR ...the 1960s.) Do you think MP's do a good job? (OR ... MPs...) It is not correct to
use - 's in other plurals (e.g. Joan's).
compound nouns
In noun + adverb combinations, the plural -s is usually added to the noun. Singular Plural passer-by
passers-by runner-up runners-up
The plural ofmother-in-law and similar words is generally mothers-in-law etc, but some people use mother-
in-laws etc; the plural of court martial
(= 'military court') is either courts martial (more formal) or courtmartials (less formal).
In noun + noun combinations, the first noun is usually singular in form even
if the meaning is plural (e.g. shoe shop). There are some exceptions. For details, see 508.

-• 7
502
2
plurals with no singular forms
Cattle is a plural word used to talk collectively about bulls, cows and calves;
it has no singular, and cannot be used for counting individual animals (one cannot say, for instance, three
cattle).
Many cattle are suffering from a disease called BSE.
(NOT Much cattle is...) Police is normally used as a plural.
The police are looking for a fair-haired man in his twenties.
(NOT The police is looking...) '• Trousers, jeans, pyjamas (US pajamas), pants, scales, scissors, glasses,
binoculars, pliers, and the names of many similar divided objects are plural, and have no singular forms.
(The equivalent words in some other languages are singular.)
Your jeans are too tight. (NOT Your jean is...) 'Where are my glasses?' "They're on your nose.' Other
common words which are normally plural include:
clothes (see 133), congratulations, contents, customs (at a frontier), funds (= money), goods, manners (=
social behaviour), the Middle Ages (a period in history), oats (but corn, wheat and barley are singular
uncountable), odds (= chances), outskirts, premises (= building), regards, remains, savings, stairs (= a
flight ofstairs), steps (= a flight ofsteps), surroundings, thanks
For more information about 'plural uncountable' nouns, see 148.7.
For cases where plural nouns are used with singular verbs and pronouns (and the opposite), see 503-504.
singular and plural (3): pronunciation of regular plurals
nouns ending in /s/, /z/ and other sibilants
After one of the sibilant sounds /s/, /z/, /J7, IT,I, /tJ7 and Id's/, the plural ending -es is pronounced /iz/.
buses /DASIZ/ crashes /'kraefiz/ watches /'wotJiz/ quizzes /'kwiziz/ garages /'gseia'.yzl bridges /'bndyz/
nouns ending in other unvoiced sounds
After any other unvoiced sound (/p/, /f/, /9/, /t/ or /k/), the plural ending -(e)s is pronounced /s/.
cups /kAps/ cloths /klo9s/ books /buks/ beliefs /bi'li:fs/ plates /plerts/ >
page
524
page 525


3
nouns ending in other voiced sounds
After vowels, and all voiced consonants except /z/, /3/ and /dg/, the plural ending -(e)s is pronounced 1-z.l.
days /deiz/ clothes /klauoz/ legs /legz/ boys /boiz/ ends /endz/ dreams /driimz/ frees /tri:z/ /u7fe /hilz/
songs /sonz/ knives /narvz/
4 plurals with irregular pronunciation
Plural
baths fba'.Qz/ OR /ba:6s/ houses /'hauziz/
mouths /mauoz/ OR /mauGs/ pflf/K /pa;oz/ OR /pa:0s/ roo/s /ru:fs/ OR /ru:vz/ truths /tru'.Qz./ OR /tru:6s/
Singular
W/i /ba;e/ house /haus/ mouth /mau6/ parft /pa:9/ roof/iu:f/ truth /tru;9/ wreath /ri:Q/ your/; /ju:9/
wreaths /ri;oz/ OR /ri;0s/ youths /ju:oz/ OR /ju:6s/
Third person singular forms (e.g. catches, wants, runs) and possessive forms (e.g. George's, Mark's,
Joe's) follow the same pronunciation rules as regular plurals.
singular and plural (4): singular nouns with plural verbs
groups of people
In British English, singular words likefamily, team, government, which refer
to groups of people, can be used with either singular or plural verbs and pronouns.
This team is/are going to lose.
Plural forms are common when the group is considered as a collection of people doing personal things
like deciding, hoping or wanting; and in these cases we use who, not which, as a relative pronoun.
Singular forms (with which as a relative pronoun) are more common when the group is seen as an
impersonal unit. Compare:
- My family have decided to move to Nottingham. They think it's a better place to live.
The average British family has 3.6 members. It is smaller and richer than 50 years ago.
- The government, who are hoping to ease export restrictions soon,. • • The government, which is elected
by a simple majority,...
- My firm are wonderful. They do all they can for me.
My firm was founded in the 18th century. When a group noun is used with a singular determiner (e.g. a/an,
each, every, this, that), singular verbs and pronouns are normal. Compare:
The team are full of enthusiasm.
A team which is full of enthusiasm has a better chance of winning. (More natural than A team who are
full...)

Sometimes singular and plural forms are mixed.
The group gave its first concert in June and they are already booked up for
the next six months. Examples of group nouns which can be used with both singular and plural
verbs in British English:
party
public
school
staff
team
bank
theBBC
choir
class
club
committee
family
firm
government
jury
ministry
orchestra
union
504
England (the football team)
In American English singular verbs are normally used with most of these nouns in all cases (though family
can have a plural verb). Plural pronouns
can be used.
The team is in Detroit this weekend. They have a good chance of winning.
quantifying expressions
Many singular quantifying expressions can be used with plural nouns and pronouns; plural verbs are
normally used in this case.
A number of people have tried to find the treasure, but they have all failed.
(More natural than A number of people has tried...) A group of us are going to take a boat through the
French canals. A couple of my friends are going to open a travel agency.
(NOT -A couple ofmyfricnds4s^...) A lot of social problems are caused by unemployment.
(NOT A lot of social problems is caused...) The majority of criminals are non-violent. Some of these people
are friends of mine and the restore people from
the office.
Half of his students don't understand a word he says. (NOT -Half of his students doesn't...)
For more about a lot and lots, see 326. For the rest, see 484. For (a) few, see 322. For singular and plural
nouns with fractions, see 509.9.
singular and plural (5): plural expressions with singular verbs
amounts and quantities
When we talk about amounts and quantities we usually use singular determiners, verbs and pronouns,
even if the noun is plural.
Where is that five pounds I lent you? (NOT Where are those five pounds...?)
Twenty miles is a long way to walk.
'We've only got five litres of petrol left.' "That isn't enough.' ^
page
526
page
527


2 calculations
Singular verbs are often possible after plural number subjects in spoken calculations.
Two and two is/are four.
Ten times five is fifty. (OR Ten fives are fifty.)
For more about spoken calculations, see 385.21 -22.
3 more than one
The expression more than one is generally used with a singular noun and verb If things don't get better,
more than one person is going to have to find a new job.
4 one of...
Expressions beginning one of normally have a plural noun and a singular verb One of my friends is going
to Honolulu next week.
For singular and plural verbs in relative clauses after one of..., see 506.1.
5 and
Some expressions joined by and have singular determiners, verbs and pronouns. This happens when the
two nouns are used together so often that we think of them as a single idea.
This gin and tonic isn't very strong, is it?
War and Peace' is the longest book I've ever read.
6 countries and organisations
Plural names of countries usually have singular verbs and pronouns.
The United States is anxious to improve its image in Latin America. Plural names of organisations may
also have singular verbs and pronouns.
Consolidated Fruitgrowers has just taken over Universal Foodstores.
For singular and plural verbs with nouns referring to groups, see 503.1. For singular verbs after none of+
plural noun, see 509.5.
505 singular and plural (6): they with singular reference
1 singular indefinite person
They/them/their is often used to refer to a singular indefinite person who has already been mentioned.
This structure is common after a person, anybody/one, somebody/one, nobody/one, whoever, each,
every, either, neither and no.
If a person doesn 't want to go on living, they are often very difficult to help-If anybody calls, take their
name and address and tell them to call again ^ later.
Somebody left their umbrella behind yesterday. Would they please collec it from the office?

Nobody was late, were they?
Whoever comes, tell them to go away.
Tell each person to help themselves to what they want.
Everybody thinks they're different from everybody else.
This use of they I them I their is convenient when the person referred to could be male or female (as in
most of the examples above). He or she, him or her and his or her are clumsy, especially when repeated,
and many people dislike the traditional use of he/him/his to refer to people who may be male or female
(see 227).
They/them/their is not only used when the person's sex is unknown.
I swear more when I'm talking to a boy, because I'm not afraid of shocking
them.
No girl should have to wear school uniform, because it makes them look like a sack of potatoes.
2 other uses
They I them! their is occasionally used to refer to a particular person who has been mentioned but not
identified.
I had a friend in Paris, and they had to go to hospital for a month,...
3 correctness
This use of they/them/their has been normal in English for centuries, and is perfectly correct. It is most
common in an informal style, but can also be found in formal written English. Here is an example from a
British passport
application form.
Dual nationality: if the child possesses the nationality or citizenship of another country they may lose this
when they get a British Passport.
506 singular and plural (7): mixed structures
In some complex structures, the same verb seems to belong with two different expressions, one singular
and the other plural.
one of the... + relative clause
In sentences like She's one of the few women who have climbed Everest, the verb have is plural, because
its subject (who) has a plural reference (the few women). However, the sentence is also saying She has
climbed Everest, and in an informal style many people would therefore say She's one of the few women
who has climbed Everest. Although this is not strictly correct (the verb in the relative clause should agree
with the subject of the relative clause, not with the subject of the main clause), structures of this kind are
very common in informal English.
One of the things that really make/makes me angry is people who don't answer letters.
Alice was one of the students that were/was late for the lecture. >
page
528
page
529


2 singular subject, plural complement
In English a verb normally agrees with the subject of a sentence, not with following complement.
S V C
ir^

The biggest timewaster is meetings.
(NOT The biggest timewastcr are
meetii

S V C

A serious problem in our garden is
wasps. (NOT A serious problem... are
wasps.)



However, if the subject is a long way from the verb, people sometimes make the verb agree with a
complement.
i The most interesting thing on radio and television last
V C
III1
weekend, without any doubt, was/were the tennis championships.
This often happens, too, when the subject is a relative what-cia especially when the complement is long.
•(-clause,

.. n II
What I am most interested in is/are your immediate personal reactions.
C

'I
What we need is/are a few bright young engineers.
For singular and plural verbs after interrogative what and who, see 509.3.
3 singular subject, plural continuation, plural verb
When a singular subject is modified by a following plural expression, people sometimes use a plural verb.
This is not usually considered correct. Nobody exeepthis best friends like him:
(More correct: Nobody... likes him.) A good knowledge efthrvo languages are nccesi (More correct: A
good knowledge ...is...)
For problems with kind, sort, type etc, see 526.
page 530
en7 singular and plural (8): distributive plural
1 people doing the same thing
To talk about several people each doing the same thing, English usually prefers a plural noun for the
repeated idea.
Tell the kids to bring raincoats to school tomorrow.
(More natural than Tell the kids to bring a raincoat...) Plural forms are almost always used in this case with
possessives.
Tell the children to blow their noses. (NOT ... to blow their nose.)
Six people lost their lives in the accident. Uncountable nouns cannot of course be used in the plural. i"
They were all anxious to increase their knowledge. (NOT ... their knowledges.)
For singular and plural forms after every, see 199.
2 repeated events
In descriptions of repeated single events, singular and plural nouns are both possible. When no details are
given, plural nouns are more natural.
I often get headaches. (NOT I often get a headache.)
She sometimes goes for rides over the hills. When details of the time or situation are given, nouns are
often singular.
I often get a headache when I've been working on the computer.
She often goes for a ride over the hills before supper. Singular nouns may also be used to avoid
misunderstanding.
I sometimes throw a stone into the river and. wish for good luck. (NOT I sometimes thmw-stoncs... - only
one stone is thrown
each time.) To refer to the time of repeated events, both singular and plural expressions
are often possible with little difference of meaning. We usually go and see my mother on Saturday(s). He's
not at his best in the moming(s).
j 3 generalisations and rules
In generalisations and rules, singular and plural nouns are both possible.
We use a past participle in a perfect verb form.
o R We use past participles in perfect verb forms. Mixtures of singular and plural are possible.
Subjects agree with their verb.
Children usually inherit some characteristics from their/other and some
from their mother. This often happens when fixed singular expressions like at the beginning
are used.
Discourse markers usually come at the beginning of sentences.
page
531


_ wu
ou singular and plural (9): noun modifiers
1 first noun singular
In noun + noun structures (see 378), the first noun is normally singular in form even if it has a plural
meaning.
a shoe shop (= a shop that sells shoes) a toothbrush (= a brush for teeth} trouser pockets (= pockets in
trousers) a ticket office (= an office that sells tickets}
2 exceptions
Some nouns have the plural -s even when they modify other nouns. These include nouns which have no
singular form (like clothes), nouns which are not used in the singular with the same meaning (like
customs), and some nouns which are more often used in the plural than in the singular (like savings). In
some cases (e.g. sport(s), drug(s)), usage is divided, and both singular and plural forms are found. In
general, the use of plural modifiers is becoming more common in British English; American English often
has a singular forms where British has plurals. Some examples: 1 a clothes shop a savings account | a
glasses case the accounts department 1| a customs officer the sales department '1
arms control an antique(s) dealer (but an antique shop) the outpatients department (of a hospital) a
greetings card (US greeting card) the drug(s) problem (US drug problem) the arrivals hall (US arrival hall)
". j a drinks cabinet (US drink cabinet) a goods train (British English) a sports car sport(s) shoes
Note also that singular nouns ending in -ics can be used as modifiers. athletics training an economics
degree
We use the plurals men and women to modify plural nouns when they have a
'subject' meaning; man and woman are used to express an 'object' meaning. "Compare:
- men drivers (= men who drive)
women pilots (= women who fly planes)
- man-eaters (= lions or tigers that eat people) woman-haters (= people who hate women)
509 singular and plural (10): miscellaneous points
1 uncountable nouns
Certain English singular uncountable nouns correspond to plural nouns in some other languages.
Your hair is very pretty. (NOT Yourhairs are...) My baggage has been sent to Greece by mistake.
(NOT My baggages have...) \ For a list of words of this kind, see 148.3.
For plural uncountables, see 148.7. cg^

2 co-ordinated subjects
When two singular subjects are joined by and, the verb is normally plural.
Alice and Bob are going to be late.
But note that some phrases with and are treated like single ideas, and used with singular verbs (see
504.5).
'Romeo and Juliet' is one of Shakespeare's most popular plays.
(NOT 'Romeo and Juliet' are...)
When two subjects are joined by as well as, together with or a similar expression, the verb is usually
singular if the first subject is singular. The Prime Minister, as well as several Cabinet Ministers, believes in
a
tough financial policy. The Managing Director, together with his heads of department, is
preparing a new budget.
When two subjects are joined by or the verb is usually singular if the second subject is singular, and plural
if it is plural. Compare:
The room's too crowded - either two chairs or a table has got to be
moved out. The room's too crowded - either a table or two chairs have got to be
moved out.
When two singular subjects are joined by neither... nor, the verb is singular in a formal style, but is usually
plural in an informal style. Neither she nor her husband has arrived, (formal) Neither she nor her husband
have arrived, (informal)
3 who and what
When who and what are used to ask for the subject of a clause, they most often have singular verbs, even
if the question expects a plural answer.
'Who is working tomorrow?' 'Phil, Lucy and Shareena (are working tomorrow).' (More natural than Who
are working tomorrow?)
Who was at the party? (More natural than Who were at the party?)
'What lives in those little holes?' 'Rabbits (do).' (NOT What live...) When who and what are used to ask for
the complement of a clause, they can have plural verbs.
'Who are your closest friends?' '(My closest friends are) Naomi and Bridget.'
'What are your politics?" (My politics are) extreme left-wing.' Relative what-c\auses are normally the
subject of a singular verb.
What she needs is friends. (More natural them What she needs are friends.) However, plural verbs are
often used before longer plural complements, especially if what is a long way from the verb (see 506).
What we need most of all are some really new ideas.
4 here's, there's and where's ; p,
In an informal style, here's, there's and where's are often used with plural nouns. Some people consider
this incorrect.
Here's your keys.
There's some children at the door.
Where's those books I lent you? >
page 533


5 determiners
When none, neither, either and any are followed by of+ plural noun/pronoun, they are normally used with
singular verbs in a formal style in British English. Plural verbs are common in informal British usage and
generally in American English.
None of the cures really works, (formal British)
None of the cures really work. (informal British; American)
Neither of my brothers has/have been outside England.
Has/Have either of them been seen recently?
If any of the children gets/get hungry, they can have an orange.
6 another, a/an + adjective
Plural expressions of quantity can be used with another (see 53) and with a/an + adjective.
/ want to stay for another three weeks.
We 'II need an extra ten pounds.
He's been waiting for a good twenty-five minutes.
She spent a happy ten minutes looking through the photos.
I've had a very busy three days.
' ' Note also the expression a good many/few + plural (informal). I've lain awake a good many nights
worrying about you. I bet that house could tell a good few stories.
7 kind, sort and type
In an informal style, we sometimes mix singular and plural forms when we use demonstratives with kind,
sort or type. For details, see 526. I don't like those kind of boots.
8 every (frequency)
Every (which is normally used with singular nouns) can be used before plural expressions in
measurements of frequency. I go to Ireland every six weeks.
9 fractions
Fractions between 1 and 2 are normally used with plural nouns. It weighs one and a half tons. (NOT.. .
one and a halftone The house has about 1.75 hectares of land.
For more about the grammar of fractions and other numbers, see 385.
9t0 slang
1 What is slang?
'Slang' is a very informal kind of vocabulary, used mostly in speech by people who know each other well.
Examples:
See you down at the boozer, {pub) He's a real prat. (fool) OK, let's shove off. (go) Wait a minute - my
shoelace has bust. (broken)
page 534
Slang expressions are not usually written, and would be considered out of place in formal kinds of
communication.
2 strong feelings
Many English slang expressions relate to things that people feel strongly about (e.g. sex, family and
emotional relationships, drink, drugs, conflict between social groups, work, physical and mental illness,
death).
I spent the weekend at my gran's, (grandmother's)
We got smashed last night, (drunk)
Prods out! (Protestants)
Can you get that sitrep to the MD by five? '•^ (situation report; Managing Director)
I've got some sort of bug. (illness)
He's lost his marbles, (gone mad)
When I kick the bucket, I want you all to have a big party, (die) Slang is often used in order to be offensive.
Shut your gob! (mouth)
3 group membership; using slang
Many slang expressions are used by members of particular social and professional groups, and nearly all
slang is used between people who know each other well or share the same social background. So it is
usually a mistake for 'outsiders' (including foreigners) to try deliberately to use slang. This can give the
impression that they are claiming membership of a group that they do not belong to. There is also the
danger that the slang may be out of date - when slang gets into books, it is often already dead. It is best to
wait until one is really becoming accepted as part of a community; one will then start using their slang
naturally and correctly along with the rest of their
language.
511 small and little
Small simply refers to size. It is the opposite of big or large (see 105).
Could I have a small brandy, please?
You're too small to be a policeman. , ' Usually, the adjective little not only refers to size, but also
expresses some
kind of emotion.
Poor little thing-come here and let me look after you.
'What's he like?' 'Oh, he's a funny little man.'
What's that nasty little boy doing in our garden? Tell the little so-and-so
to get out.
They've bought a pretty little house in the country. In a few fixed expressions, little is used in the same
way as small or short. little finger the little hand of a clock a little while a little way ^
page 535


In British English, little is unusual in 'predicative' position (after a verb), and comparative and superlative
forms are not normally used. In American
English, predicative use is normal, and comparative and superlative forms are more common.
Sorry, honey, you're too little to watch horror movies. (GB ...you're too small...)
He's the Uttlest baby I ever saw. (GB... the smallest baby...) For little used as a determiner (e.g. There's
little hope), see 322.
512 smell
1 British and American forms
In British English, smell has an irregular past tense and past participle: smelt. American forms are usually
regular.
2 copularverb
Smell can be used as a 'copular verb', followed by adjective or noun
complements (see 147), to say what sort of smell something has. Progressive forms are not used.
Those roses smell beautiful. (NOT ... smell bcauttfittty:) The soup smells funny. What's in it? (NOT .. .4s
smelling funny...)
Before a noun, smell of and smell like are used. The railway carriage smelt of beer and old socks. His
aftershave smelt like an explosion in a flower shop.
Smell is sometimes used to mean 'smell bad'. That dog smells.
3 transitive verb: 'perceive'
Smell can be used as a transitive verb, followed by an object, to say what we
perceive with our noses. Progressive forms are not used. We often use can smell (see 125).
As we walked into the house, we smelt something burning. I can smell supper.
4 transitive verb: 'investigate'
Another transitive use is to say that we are using our noses to find out something. Progressive forms can
be used.
'What are you doing?' Tm smelling my shirt to see if it will do for another day.'
He picked the scarf up and smelt it carefully. 'Chanel No 5,'he said.
513 so (degree adverb; substitute word)
1 degree
So can have a similar meaning to 'to that extent' or 'that much'. It is often ' used when we are talking about
a high degree of some quality - in situations where very is also a suitable word.
page 536
I'm sorry you're so tired. (= I know you're very tired, and I'm sorry.) It was so cold that we couldn't go out.
(= It was very cold weather, and because of that we couldn't go out.)
2 before adjectives etc
We can use so before an adjective alone (without a noun) or an adverb.
He's so silly. The milk was so good that we couldn't stop drinking it.
Why are you driving so fast? So is not used with adjective + noun.
It's such terrible weather. (NOT It's so terrible weather.)
I enjoyed my stay in your country, which is so beautiful. ~ ' v • ' - ------ '----^A.I/,/,,.,,*^,,^
(NOT -1-ewfeyi
nystayinyi
so beautiful country.)
l,l1\JÄ… t^,^^J^.~ ...J J ... ^ - .
So can be used before the quantifiers much, many, few and little (with or
without nouns).
There was so much to eat and so few people to eat it. We use so much, not so, before comparatives.
She's looking so much older. (NOT ... so older.)
For the difference between such and so, see 544. For more about so much and so many, see 518.
3 so and very
Very is used when we are simply giving information. So is mainly used (in the same way as like this/that)
to refer to information which has already been given, which is already known, or which is obvious.
Compare:
- You're very late. (giving information)
I'm sorry I'm so late. (referring to information which is already known)
- It was very warm when we were in Scotland, (giving information)
If I'd known it would be so warm I'd have taken lighter clothing, (referring to information which is already
known)
4 emphatic use
In an informal style, so can also be used like very to give new information, when the speaker wishes to
emphasise what is said. This structure is rather
like an exclamation (see 201).
He's so bad-tempered! (= How bad-tempered he is!) You're so right!
5 that-clsaises
Structures with very cannot be followed directly by that-clauses. Instead, we
can use so... that.
It was so cold that we stopped playing.
(NOT It was very cold that wo stopped playing.) He spoke so fast that nobody could understand.
6 so... us to...
There is also a structure with so followed by adjective + as to + infinitive.
This is formal and not very common.
Would you be so kind as to tell me the time? (=... kind enough to...)
(NOT Would you be so kind and...) (NOT Would you be so kind to...) ^
page 537


7 so... a ...
There is a rather formal structure so + adjective + a/an + singular countable
noun (see 16).
/ had never before met so gentle a person. (=... such a gentle person.)
8 adverbial uses; like that
So is not normally used adverbially to mean 'like this/that', 'in this/that wav' Look -hold it up in the air like
this. (NOT ... hold it up in the air-so:)
When he laughs like that I want to scream. (NOT When he4emghs-s. .) I don't think we should do it in
that way.
(NOT / don't think we should do it so.) 9 substitute word
So can be used in some structures instead of repeating an adjective or adverb.
The weather is stormy and will remain so over the weekend. I read the frontpage very carefully, and the
rest of the paper less so.
For so as a clause substitute in think so, hope so etc, see 515. For w am / etc, see51G.l.
For so after say and tell, see 514. Poidoso,see 166.
10 so-and-so, so-so
Note these informal expressions.
What's happened to old so-and-so (= what's his name?) who you used to play chess with?
She's an old so-and-so, (replacing a swearword or insult)
'How are you feeling?' 'So-so.' (= 'Not too well.') (NOT .. .-'So and-so.')
Was the concert any good?' 'So-so.' (= 'Not too good.')
For the use of thislthat to mean 'so', see 565.7. For more about very, see 153.
For other ways of expressing the idea of degree, see 153-156. Forw that and in order that, see 519.
514 so after say and tell
1 instead of that-clauses
So can be used after say and tell instead of repeating information in a that-clause.
She's going to be the next president. Everybody says so.
(=... Everybody says that she's going to be the next president.)
'You've got to clean the car.' 'Who says so?' Taxes are going up. Bob told me so.
Note that so is used in this way mostly when we are talking about the authority for statements, about
reasons why we should believe them. When we simply want to identify the speaker, we prefer that.
Compare:
'Jane's crazy.' 'Whosaysso?' 'Dr Bannister.' i
'Jane's crazy.' 'Who said that?' 'I did.'
2 Itoldyouso
The expression / told you so is generally used to mean "I warned you, but you wouldn't listen to me*.
'Mummy, I've broken my train.' 'I toldyou so. You shouldn't have tried to
ride on it.'
3 other verbs
So cannot be used after all verbs of saying. We cannot say, for example, -She promised me so.
515 so and not with hope, believe etc
page 538
1 instead of that- clauses
We can often use so instead of repeating information in a that-clause. This happens with believe, hope,
expect, imagine, suppose, guess, reckon, think, be afraid.
'IsAlex here?' 'I think so.' (NOT ... 'I think it.')
'Do you think we'll have good weather?' 'Yes, I hope so.' (NOT ... 'Yes, I hope.')
'Did you lose?' 'I'm afraid so.' We do not use so before a that-clause.
I hope that we'll have good weather.
(NOT I hope so, that we'll have good weather.) Note the special use of I thought so to mean 'my
suspicions were correct'.
Show me what's in your pockets. Ah, I thought so! You've been stealing
biscuits again. So is not used after know (see 306).
'You're late.' 'I know.' OR 'I know that.' (NOT ... 'I know so.')
2 negative structures
We can make these expressions negative in two ways. affirmative verb + not
'Did you win?' 'I'm afraid not.' 'We won't be in time for the train.' 'No, I suppose not.'
negative verb + so
'You won't be here tomorrow?' 'I don't suppose so.'
'Will it rain?"! don't expect so.' Hope and be afraid are always used in the first structure.
I hope not. (NOT I don't hopese:) Think is more common in the second structure.
I don't think so. (More common than / think not.)
3 so at the beginning of a clause
A structure is possible with so at the beginning of a clause, with say, hear, understand, tell, believe and a
number of other verbs. This structure is used
page 539


to say where the speaker's opinion comes from, or what evidence he/she has for it.
It's going to be a cold winter, or so the newspaper says. 'Mary's getting married.' 'Yes, so I heard.' "The
Professor's ill.' 'So I understand.' This structure is not used with the verbs think, hope or suppose.
For so after tell and say, see 514.
so am I, so do I etc
so + auxiliary + subject
We can use so with a similar meaning to also, in the structure so + auxiliary verb + subject. The structure
is used to answer or add to the sentence before and uses the same auxiliary verb. Note the word order.
Louise can dance beautifully, and so can her sister.
'I've lost their address.' 'So have I.'
The structure is also used with non-auxiliary be and have.
I was tired, and so were the others.
'I have a headache.' 'So have I.' After a clause with no auxiliary verb, we use do/does/did,
'He just wants the best for his country.' 'So did Hitler.' It is not normally possible to use a more complete
verb phrase in this
structure. We can say, for example, So can her sister, but not So can hoi dance
so + subject + auxiliary
So can also be followed by subject + auxiliary verb (note the word order) to
express surprised agreement.
'It's raining.' 'Why, so it is!' 'You've just put the teapot in the fridge.' 'So I have!'
For neitherI nor am I etc, see 364.
For short answer structures, see 493.
For other examples of inverted word order, see 298-299.
For do with non-auxiliary have, see 240-241.
so and then
So and then can both be used to mean 'since that is so'. There is a slight difference. Then is most often
used when one speaker replies to another:
it means "It follows from what you have said'. We do not normally use then when the same speaker wants
to connect two ideas ('It follows from what I have said'). So can be used in both ways. Compare:
- It's more expensive to travel on Friday, so I'll leave on Thursday evening. (NOT ... Then I'll leave on
Thursday evening.)
'It's more expensive to travel on Friday.' 'Then/So I'll leave on Thursday evening.'
- I'll be needing the car, so you 'II have to take a taxi.
Til be needing the car.' 'Then/So I suppose I'll have to take a taxi.'
page 540

SU UlttL U11U 111 U1UC1 LlldL OA9
- I'm off on holiday, so I won't be seeing you for a bit.
Tm off on holiday.' "Then/So I won't be seeing you for a bit. Have a good time, then.'
518
i
so much and so many
2
the difference
The difference between so much and so many is the same as between much and many. So much is used
with singular (uncountable) nouns; so many is used with plurals.
/ had never seen so much food in my life.
She had so many children that she didn't know what to do.
(N o T ... so much children...)
Note that we use so, not so much, to modify adjectives and adverbs. For details, see 513.
You're so beautiful. (NOT You 're so much beautiful.) But so much is used before comparatives (see 139).
She's so much more beautiful now.
so much/many without a noun
We can drop a noun after so much/many, if the meaning is clear. I can't eat all that meat - there's so
much! I was expecting a few phone calls, but not so many. I have so much to tell you.
so much as an adverb
So much can be used as an adverb. I wish you didn 't smoke so much.
special structures with so much
We can use not so much... as or not so much... but to make corrections and
clarifications.
She didn't so much wake up as explode out of the bed. It's not so much that I dislike her as that I'm just
not interested. It wasn't so much his appearance I liked as his personality. It's not so much that I don't
want to come, but ISimply haven't got the time.
In negative and non-assertive clauses, so much as can be used to mean 'even'. He didn't so much as say
thank you, after all we'd done for him. If he so much as looks at another woman, I'll kill him.
For more details of the use of much and many, see 348.
519 so that and in order that
1 purpose
These structures are used to talk about purpose. So that is more common than in order that, especially in
an informal style. They are normally followed
3
4
page
541


2
3
by modal auxiliary verbs such as can or will; may is more formal. She's staying here for six months so that
she can perfect her English. I'm putting it in the oven now so that it'll be ready by seven o'clock.
We send them monthly reports in order that they may have full information about progress.
In an informal style, that can be dropped after so; this is very common in American English.
I've come early so I can talk to you. For more about omission of that, see 560.
present tenses for future
Present tenses are sometimes used to refer to the future after sothatI'in order that.
Send the letter express so that she gets /she'll get it before Tuesday.
I'm going to make an early start so that I don't/won't get stuck in the traffic.
We ought to write to him, in order that he does not/will not feel we are
hiding things from him.
past structures
In sentences about the past, would, could or should (British English only) are
generally used with verbs after so that/in order that. Might is possible in a very formal style.
Mary talked to the shy girl so that she wouldn't feel left out. I took my golf clubs so that I could play at the
weekend. They held the meeting on a Saturday in order that everybody should be free to attend. (US... in
order that everybody would be free...)
Whole populations of natives were wiped out in order that civilisation might advance.
For the infinitive structures in order to and so as to, see 281. For so... that expressing result, see 513.5.
For lest meaning 'so that... not', see 314.
520 'social'language
Every language has fixed expressions which are used on particular social occasions - for example when
people meet, leave each other, go on a
journey, sit down to meals and so on. Here are some of the most important English expressions of this
kind.
1 introductions
Common ways of introducing strangers to each other are:
John, do you know Helen? Helen, this is my friend John. Sally, I don't think you 've met Elaine.
I don't think you two know each other, do you? Can/May I introduce John Willis? (more formal)
page 542
2
3
When people are introduced, they usually say How do you do? (formal), Hello, or Hi (very informal).
Americans often say How are you? Note that How do you do? is not a question, and the normal reply is
How do you do? (It does not mean the same, in British English, as How are you?)
People who are introduced often shake hands. For the use of first names, surnames and titles, see 353.
greetings
When meeting people (formal):
Good morningi afternoon/evening. When meeting people (informal):
Hello. Hi. (very informal) When leaving people: ^
Good morningi afternooni evening! night, (formal)
Goodbye, (less formal) Bye. (informal)
Bye-bye, (often used to and by children) Cheerio.
See you. (informal) See you later I tomorrow/next week/etc, (informal)
Cheers, (informal - British only) Take care. (informal)
It was nice to meet you.
Note that Goodnight is used only when leaving people, not when meeting them.
4
5
asking about health etc
When we meet people we know, we often ask politely about their health or
their general situation.
How are you? How are things?/How's things? (very informal) How's it going? (informal) -How (are) you
doing? (especially American)
Formal answers:
Very well, thankyou. And you? Fine, thank you.
Informal answers:
Fine/Great, thanks. Not too bad. OK. So-so. (NOT So and so.) All right. (It) could be worse.
British people do not usually ask How are you? when they are introduced to
people. And neither British nor American people begin letters to strangers by
asking about health (see 317).
special greetings
Greetings for special occasions are:
Happy birthday! OR Many happy returns! Happy New Year/Easter! Happy/Merry Christmas!
small talk
British people often begin polite conversations by talking about the weather. 'Nice day, isn't it?' 'Lovely.' ^
page 543


6 getting people's attention
Excuse me! is commonly used to attract somebody's attention, or to call a
waiter in a restaurant. I beg your pardon! is also possible, especially in American English.
7 apologies
British people say Excuse me before interrupting or disturbing somebody, and Sorry after doing so.
Compare:
Excuse me. Could I get post? Oh, sorry, did I step onyourfoot? Excuse me, could you tell me the way to
the station? Americans also use Excuse me to apologise after disturbing somebody.
I beg your pardon is a more formal way of saying 'Sorry'. I beg your pardon. I didn 't realise this was your
seat.
8 asking people to repeat
If British people do not hear or understand what is said, they may say Sony? (GB), What? (informal), (I
beg your) pardon? or Pardon me? (US).
'Mike's on the phone.' 'Sorry?' 'I said Mike's on the phone.'
'Seeyou tomorrow.' 'What?' 'Seeyou tomorrow.'
'You're going deaf'I beg your pardon?'
9 journeys etc
Common ways of wishing people a good journey are:
Have a good trip. Have a good journey. (GB) Safe journey home. (GB)
After a journey (for example when we meet people at the airport or station), we may say:
Did you have a good journey/trip/flight?
How was the journey/trip/flight?
If somebody is leaving for an evening out or some kind of pleasant event, people might say Have a good
time! or Enjoy yourself! (in American English sometimes just Enjoy!). Good luck! is used before
examinations or other difficult or dangerous events.
When people return home, their friends or family may say Welcome back.
10 holidays
Before somebody starts a holiday, we may say:
Have a good holiday. (US... vacation.) o R Have a good time. When the holiday is over, we may say:
Did you have a good holiday?
11 meals
We do not have fixed expressions for the beginnings and ends of meals. It is ^. common for guests or
family members to say something complimentary ; about the food during the meal (for example This is
very nice), and after (for
example That was lovely/delicious; thank you very much). Some religious
people say 'grace' (a short prayer) before and after meals. Waiters often say
Enjoy your meal after serving a customer.
For the names of meals, see 338.
page
544
12 drinking
When people begin drinking alcoholic drinks socially, they often raise their glasses and say something.
Common expressions are Cheers! (GB) and Your health! When we drink to celebrate an occasion (such
as a birthday, a wedding or a promotion), we often say Here's to...!
Here's to Betty! Here's to the new job!
Here's to the happy couple!
13 sending good wishes
Typical expressions are Give my best wishes/regards/greetings/love to X and Remember me to X.
Americans often say Say hello to Xfor me. When the wishes are passed on, common expressions are X
sends his/her best wishes/regards etc.
14 sympathy
Common formulae in letters of sympathy (for example on somebody's death) are I was
very/terribly/extremely sorry to hear about... and Please accept my deepest sympathy.
15 invitations and visits
Invitations often begin:
Would you like to...? Possible formal replies:
Thank you very much. That would be very nice.
Sorry. I'm afraid I'm not free. It is normal to thank people for hospitality at the moment of leaving their
houses.
Thank you very much. That was a wonderful evening.
16 offers and replies
Offers often begin Would you like... ?or Can i'May Igeti'offeryou... ? (more formal). Offers to do things for
people can begin Would you like me to...?, Can/May I... ? or Shall I...? (British). Typical replies are Yes
please, No thank you, I'd love some, I'd love to, That's very nice/kind of you.
Note that thank you can be used for accepting as well as refusing (see below).
17 asking for things
We normally ask for things by using yes/no questions. (For more details,
see 483.)
Could you lend me a pen? (NOT Please lend me a pen.)
18 handing over things
We do not have an expression which is automatically used when we hand over things. We sometimes say
Here you are, especially when we want to attract people's attention to the fact that we are passing
something to them. Americans may also say There you go in this situation.
'Have you got a map of London?"! think so. Yes, here you are."Thanks.' ^
page 545


19 thanks
Common ways of thanking people are:
Thank you very much. Thank you. Thanks (a lot), (informal) Possible replies to thanks are:
Not at all. Don't mention it. That's OK. (informal) You're welcome. That's (quite) all right.
But note that British people do not always reply to thanks, especially thanks for small things.
For more information about thanking and the use of please, see 429.
20 sleep
When somebody goes to bed, people often say Sleep well. In the morning, we may ask Did you sleep
well? or How did you sleep?
For expressions used when telephoning, see 554.
521 some
1 meaning: indefinite quantity/number
Some is a determiner (see 157). It often suggests an indefinite quantity or
number, and is used when it is not important to say exactly how much/many we are thinking of.
/ need some new clothes. Would you like some tea?
2 pronunciation
When some has this indefinite meaning, it usually has a 'weak' pronunciation /s(a)m/ before (adjective +)
noun.
some /s(a)m/ new clothes some /s(a)m/ tea
For more about 'strong' and 'weak' pronunciations, see 588.
3 some and any
With this meaning, some is most common in affirmative clauses, and in questions which expect or
encourage the answer 'Yes'. In other cases, any is generally used. For details, see 522. Compare:
- There are some children at the front door. Do you mind if I put some music on?
- Did you meet any interesting people on holiday? She hasn 't got any manners.
4 some and a/an
Some (used in this sense) is quite similar to the indefinite article a/an. However, it is not normally used
with the same kind of nouns (but see paragraph 6 below). Compare:
I need a new coat. (singular countable noun) (NOT .. .-smmwu^eeat-) I need some new shirts, (plural
countable noun) I need some help shopping, (uncountable noun)
page
546
5 some and no article
With an uncountable or plural noun, some usually suggests the idea of an indefinite (but not very large)
quantity or number. When there is no idea of a limited quantity or number, we usually use no article. For
details, see 67. Compare:
- We've planted some roses in the garden, (a limited number)
We've decided to put roses under the back fence this year instead of chrysanthemums, (no idea of
number)
- Can you put some blankets in the back of the car in case the children get
cold?
The President has appealed for blankets and warm clothing for the earthquake victims.
6 some and some of', some with no following noun
Before another determiner (article, demonstrative or possessive word) or a pronoun, we use some of.
Compare:
- I've got tickets for some concerts next month. (NOT ... some of concerts...) Pete's coming to some of the
concerts with me. (NOT ... some the concerts...)
- Some people want to get to sleep. (NOT ... some of people...)
Some of us want to get to sleep. (NOT Some us...) Some of the is possible before a singular countable
noun in certain cases.
Move over and give me some of the bed. Nouns can be dropped after some, if the meaning is clear.
I've got too many strawberries. Would you like some? Before of, or with no following noun, some is
pronounced /SAm/.
some /SAm/ of us Would you like some /SAm/ ?
7 contrast with others etc
Some (pronounced /SAm/) can have a more emphatic meaning, contrasting
with others, all or enough.
Some people like the sea; others prefer the mountains. Some of us were late, but we were all there by ten
o'clock. . I've got some money, but not enough.
8 with singular countable noun
With a singular countable noun, some (/SAm/) can refer to an unknown person or thing.
Some idiot has taken the bath plug.
There must be some job I could do.
She's living in some village in Yorkshire. We can use this structure to suggest that we are not interested in
somebody or something, or that we do not think much of him/her/it.
Mary's gone to America to marry some sheep farmer or other.
I don't want to spend my life doing some boring little office job. In informal American English, some can
also be used to show enthusiastic appreciation.
That's some bike you 've got there! (GB... quite a bike._..)
It was some party!
page 547


9 with numbers
Some (/sAm/), with a number, is used to suggest that the number is a high or impressive one.
We have exported some four thousand tons of bootlaces this year.
For somebody and anybody, something and anything etc, see 523. For some time, sometime and
sometimes, see 524. For any, see 54.
\2 some and any
1 indefinite quantities
Both some and any can refer to an indefinite quantity or number. They are used when it is not easy, or not
important, to say exactly how much/many we are thinking of.
I need to buy some new clothes.
Is there any milk left?
2 the difference
In this indefinite sense, some is most common in affirmative clauses. Any (used in this sense) is a 'non-
assertive' word (see 374), and is common in questions and negatives. Compare:
I want some razor blades. (NOT I want any razor blades.)
Have you got any razor blades?
Sorry, I haven't got any razor blades.
(NOT Sorry, I haven't got some razor blades.)
For other uses of any, see 54.
3 some in questions
We use some in questions if we expect people to answer 'Yes', or want to encourage them to say 'Yes' -
for example in offers and requests.
Have you brought some paper and a pen? (The hearer is expected to bring them.)
Shouldn't there be some instructions with it?
Would you like some more meat?
Could I have some brown rice, please?
Have you got some glasses that I could borrow?
4 any in affirmative clauses
We use any in affirmative clauses after words that have a negative or limiting ;; meaning: for example
never, hardly, without, little. You never give me any help. There's hardly any tea left. We got there without
any trouble. There is little point in doing any more work now. I forgot to get any bread.
For other uses of any in affirmative clauses (e.g. Any ten^year-old child could do this), see
page
548

5 if-clauses
Both some and any are common in if-clauses.
If you want some/any help, let me know. Sometimes any is used to suggest 'if there is/are any'.
Any cars parked in this road will be towed away.
(= If there are any cars parked in this road, they will...)
For more information about some, see 521. For somebody and anybody, something and anything etc, see
523.
523 somebody, someone, anybody, anyone etc
1 -body and -one
There is no significant difference between somebody and someone, anybody and anyone, everybody and
everyone or nobody and no one. The forms with
-one are more common; those with -body are a little more informal.
2 some- and any-
The differences between somebody and anybody, something and anything, somewhere and anywhere etc
are the same as the differences between some and any (see 522 for details). Compare:
- There's somebody at the door. Did anybody telephone?
- Let's go somewhere nice for dinner, y ^'. I don't want to go anywhere too expensive.
- Can I get you something to drink?
If you need something/anything, just shout.
3 singular
When these words are subjects they are used with singular verbs.
Everybody likes her. (NOT Everybody ftfee-feefO
Is everything ready? (NOT Are everything ready?) Somebody normally refers to only one person.
Compare:
There's somebody outside who wants to talk to you.
There are some people outside who want to talk to you.
use of they
They, them and their are often used with a singular meaning to refer back to
somebody etc (see 505). <•;
If anybody wants a ticket for the concert, they can get it from my office.
'There's somebody at the door.' 'Tell them I'm busy.'
Someone left their umbrella on the bus. Nobody phoned, did they?
complementation
Somebody etc can be followed by adjectives or adverbial expressions. I hope he marries somebody nice.
She's going to meet someone in the Ministry. I feel like eating something hot.
Let's go somewhere quiet this weekend. * page 549
4
5


They can also be followed by else (see 187).
Mary-are you in love with somebody else?
I don't like this place - let's go somewhere else. Note also the informal use of much after any- and no-.
We didn 't do anything much yesterday.
There's nothing much on TV tonight.
6 someplace
Someplace is common in informal American English. Let's go someplace quiet.
7 anyone and any one; everyone and every one
Anyone means the same as anybody; any one means 'any single one (person or thing)'. Compare:
Does anyone know where Celia lives? You can borrow any one video at a time. There is a similar
difference between everyone and every one. Compare:
Everyone had a good time at the party. There aren 't any cakes left - they've eaten every one.
For the difference between no one and none, see 373. For question tags after everything and nothing, see
466. For some time, sometime and sometimes, see 524.
524 some time, sometime and sometimes
Some time (with two stresses: /'SAM 'taim/) means 'a considerable amount of time', 'quite a lot of time'.
I'm afraid it'll take some time to repair your car. She's lived in Italy for some time, so she speaks Italian
quite well.
Sometime (/'SAmtaim/) refers to an indefinite time, usually in the future; it
often means 'one day'.
Let's have dinner together sometime next week. When will I get married - this year, next year, sometime,
never? Sometimes (/'sAmtaimz/) is an adverb of frequency (see 23.2). It means 'on some occasions',
'more than once' (past, present or future). I sometimes went skiing when I lived in Germany.
Sometimes, in the long winter evenings, I sit and wonder what life is all about.

525 soon, early and quickly
Not all languages have separate equivalents for these three words, and soine students may confuse them.
soon
Soon usually relates to the time when one is talking or writing-it means 'a short time after now'.
Get well soon. (NOT Get well early.)
Soon can also relate to the time one is talking or writing about - it can mean 'a short time after then'.
The work was hard, but she soon got used to it.
For no sooner... than, see 237.
2 early
The adverb early means 'near the beginning of the time-period that we are talking or thinking about*. It
does not usually mean 'a short time after now'.
Early that week, Luke was called to the police station.
We usually take our holidays early in the year. (NOT ... soon in the year.)
I usually get up early and go to bed early. (NOT I usually get up soon...) Sometimes early means 'before
the expected time'.
The plane arrived twenty minutes early. Early can also be used as an adjective (e.g. an early train). The
adjective early can sometimes have the same kind of meaning as soon.
I should be grateful for an early reply. Best wishes for an early recovery. Note the common use of be
early/late to mean 'arrive early/late'.
That woman is never early. A watch or clock is fast or slow, not early or late.
My watch is five minutes fast.
3 quickly
Quickly refers to the speed with which something is done. Compare:
- Come and see us quickly. (= Hurry - make the arrangements fast.) Come and see us soon. (= Come and
see us before long.)
- He did the repair quickly but not very well.
I hope you can do the repair soon -1 need the car.
526 sort of, kind of and type of
1 articles
The article a/an is usually dropped after sort of, kind of and type of, but structures with articles are
possible in an informal style.
That's a funny sort of (a) car. What sort of (a) bird is that?
2 singular and plural; these sort of etc
When we are talking about one sort of thing, we can use sort of, kind of or type of followed by a singular
noun.
This sort of car is enormously expensive to run.
I'm interested in any new type of development in computer science. Singular sort of, kind of and type of
can also be followed by plural nouns, especially in an informal style.
I'm interested in any new kind of developments... Plural demonstratives (these and those} can also be
used.
These sort of cars are enormously expensive to run.
Do you smoke those kind of cigarettes?
This structure is often felt to be incorrect, and is usually avoided in a formal style. This can be done by
using a singular noun (see above), by using plural
page
550
page 551


." souna 527'^IH
sorts/kinds/types, or by using the structure... of this/that sort/kind/type. This sort of car is... These kinds
ofcarfs) are... Cars of that type are...
3 softeners
In an informal style, sort of and kind of can be used before almost any word or expression, or at the end of
a sentence, to show that we are not speaking very exactly, or to make what we say less definite.
We sort of thought you might forget.
Sometimes I sort of wonder whether I shouldn 't sort of get a job.
I've had sort of an idea about what we could do.
She's kind. of strange. I've changed my mind, kind of.
527 sound
>;: Sound is a 'copular verb' (see 147). It is followed by adjectives, not adverbs.
You sound unhappy. What's the matter? Progressive forms are not very common.
Your idea sounds great. (NOT Your idea's sounding groat.) However, progressive forms are possible
when there is an idea of change.
The car sounds I is sounding a bit rough these days. Sound is often followed by like or as if.
That sounds like Bill coming up the stairs.
It sounds as if he's had a hard day.
528 speak and talk
1 little difference
There is not very much difference between speak and talk. In certain situations one or the other is
preferred (though they are usually both possible).
2 formality
Talk is the more usual word to refer to conversational exchanges and
informal communication.
When she walked into the room everybody stopped talking. Could I talk to you about the football match for
a few minutes?
Speak is often used for one-way communication and for exchanges in more
serious or formal situations.
I'll have to speak to that boy - he's getting very lazy.
They had a terrible row last week, and now they're not speaking to one another.
After she had finished reading the letter, nobody spoke.
3 lectures etc
Talk is often used for the act of giving an informal lecture (a talk); speak is preferred for more formal
lectures, sermons etc.
This is Mr Patrick Alien, who's going to talk to us about flower arrangement.
page 552
4
5
This is Professor Rosalind Bowen, who is going to speak to us on recent
developments in low-temperature physics. The Pope spoke to the crowd for seventy minutes about world
peace.
languages
Speak is the usual word to refer to knowledge and use of languages, and to
the physical ability to speak.
She speaks three languages fluently.
We spoke French so that the children wouldn't understand.
His throat operation has left him unable to speak.
other cases
One usually asks to speak to somebody on the phone (US also speak with).
Hello. Could I speak to Karen, please? Talk is used before sense, nonsense and other words with similar
meanings.
You're talking complete nonsense, as usual. (NOT You're speaking complete-nonsense...)
529
spelling (I): capital letters
We use capital (big) letters at the beginning of the following kinds of words:
the names of days, months and public holidays (but not usually seasons)
Sunday March Easter
Tuesday September Christmas
(BUT summer, autumn) the names of people and places, including stars and planets
John Mars The Ritz Hotel
Mary North Africa The Super Cinema
Canada the Far East the United States
(BUT the earth, the sun, the moon) people's titles ' ' •"•••
Mr Smith Professor Blake the Managing Director
Dr Jones Colonel Webb nouns and adjectives referring to nationalities and regions, languages, ethnic
groups and religions
He's Russian. I speak German. Japanese history Catalan cooking She's Jewish. He's a Sikh.
the first word (and often other nouns, verbs, adjectives and adverbs) in the titles of books, films, plays,
pictures, magazines etc
Gone with the Wind OR Gone with the wind
New Scientist
For more about the use of capitals with East, North etc, see 176.
page
553


- • -w- opcmilg ^^,7;*Iy 3«fU
530 spelling (2) :-ly
1 adverb formation
We normally change an adjective into an adverb by adding -ly. late > lately real + really (NOT rcaly)
right-+ rightly definite definitely hopeful hopefully pale patefy complete completely (NOT
completly}
Exceptions:
true* truly dueY duly wholeY wholly full•> fully
2 yandi
-y usually changes to -i- (see 534).
happy happily easybeastly dry > drily or dryly gay gaily
Exceptions:
shy-shyly sly slyly coy^ coyly
3 adjectives ending in consonant + Ie
-Ie changes to -ly after a consonant.
idle z'dfy «ofote raofcfy afcfe > a&fy
4 adjectives ending in ic
If an adjective ends in -ic, the adverb ends in -ically (pronounced /ikli/),
tragic > tragically phonetic* phonetically Exception:
public publicly
531
spelling (3): -ise and -ize
Many English verbs can be spelt with either -ise or -ize. In American English, -ize is preferred in these
cases. Examples:
realise/realize (GB) realize (US) mechanise/mechanize (GB) mechanize (US) computerise/computerize
(GB) computerize (US) baptise/baptize (GB) baptize (US)
Most words of two syllables, and some longer words, have -ise in both British and American English.
Examples:
surprise (NOT -surprize)
revise
advise
comprise
despise compromise
exercise improvise supervise televise
advertise (US also sometimes advertize)
page
554
Capsize has -ize in both British and American English. Note also analyse and paralyse (US analyze and
paralyze).
If in doubt, remember that in British English -ise is almost always acceptable. For American English,
consult an American dictionary.
532 spelling (4): hyphens
1 What are hyphens?
Hyphens are the short lines (-) that we put between words in expressions like ticket-office or ex-husband.
2 two-part adjectives
We usually put a hyphen in two-part adjectives in which the second part ends in -ed or -ing.
blue-eyed broken-hearted nice-looking We also often hyphenate two-part adjectives or noun modifiers
which contain the sense of 'between'.
grey-green (= between grey and green)
the London-Paris flight
the Scotland-France match
an Anglo-American agreement
3 phrases used as adjectives
When we use a longer phrase as an adjective before a noun, we often use hyphens. Compare:
- an out-of-work miner. He's out of work.
- a shoot-to-kill policy
They were ordered to shoot to kill.
4 two-part nouns; stress
In British English, hyphens are common in two-word compound nouns when the first word has the main
stress.
a 'paper-shop (compare a paper 'bag)
some 'make-up (compare to make 'up)
'running-shoes (compare running'water)
'lorry-driver (compare hotel 'waiter)
5 prefixes
The prefixes co-, non- and ex- are sometimes separated from what follows by
hyphens.
It's a British and American co-production.
We have a policy of non-involvement.
He's one of her ex-lovers. And other prefixes may be separated by hyphens in order to avoid unusual or
misleading combinations of letters.
un-American pre-emptive counter-revolution ^
page 555


6
word division
We use a hyphen to separate the parts of a long word at the end of a written or printed line. (To see where
to divide words, look in a good dictionary.)
... is not completely in accordance with the policy of the present government, which was...
7 Are hyphens disappearing?
The rules about hyphens are complicated, and usage is not very clear. Perhaps because of this, people
seem to be using hyphens less. Many common short compounds are now often written 'solid', with no
division between the words (e.g. weekend, wideawake, takeover); other less common or longer
compounds are now more likely to be written as completely separate words (e.g. train driver, living room).
The situation at present is rather confused, and it is not unusual to find the same expression spelt in three
different ways (e.g. bookshop, book-shop, bookshop). If one is not sure whether to use a hyphen between
words or not, the best thing is to look in a ^_ dictionary, or to write the words without a hyphen.
533 spelling (5): finale
1 when finale is dropped
When an ending that begins with a vowel (e.g. -ing, -able, -ous} is added to a word that ends in -e, we
usually drop the -e.
hope hoping note notable shade > shady make making fame famous
Some words have two possible forms before -able and -age. The form without -e is more common in most
cases.
like lik(e)able move mov(e)able love lov(e)able mile mil(e)age (more common with e]
Final -e is not dropped from words ending in -ee, -oe or -ye.
see* seeing canoe> canoeist agree agreeable dye dyeing
2 when final e is not dropped
Before endings that begin with a consonant, final -e is not normally dropped.
excite excitemen t complete completeness definite > definitely
Exceptions: words ending in -lie " due-* duly true-+ truly argue argument
In words that end with -ce or -ge, we do not drop -e before a or o.
replace > replaceable courage courageous
(BUT charge charging, face > facing) }udg(e)ment and acknowledgement can be spelt with or
without the -e after g-
For words ending in -ie, see 534.4. For adverbs ending in -ly, fee 530.
page 556
534 spelling (6): y and i
1 changing y to i
When we add an ending to a word that ends in -y, we usually change -y to -i:
hurrychurned fury furious merry merriment
marry > marriage easy easier busy business
happy happily
Generally, nouns and verbs that end in -y have plural or third person singular forms in -ies.
story -* stories spyespies hurrydhurries
Two spellings are possible for the nouns dryer/drier and flyer/flier, and for words made from the adjective
dry (dryer/drier, dryly/drily, dryness/driness). Other exceptions: slyer, slyest, slyly, slyness.
2 no change before i
We do not change -y to -- before i (for example when we add -ing, -ism,
-ish, -ise).
try trying Tory -Toryism baby babyish
3 no change after a vowel
We do not change -y to -i- after a vowel letter.
buy > buying play > played enjoy enjoyment grey Y greyish
Exceptions:
say- said pay^ paid lay^ laid ''
4 changing ie toy
We change -ie to -y- before -ing.
die dying lieflying (BUT dye dyeingi
535 spelling (7): doubling final consonants
1 doubling before vowels
We sometimes double the final consonant of a word before adding -ed, -er,
-est, -ing, -able, -y (or any ending that begins with a vowel).
stop> stopped sit^ sitting big^ bigger
2 Which consonants are doubled?
We double the following letters:
b: rub> rubbing n: win-* winnable d: sad-+ sadder p: stopestopped g: bigY bigger r: prefer-+
preferred I: travel* travelling t: sit> sitting m: slim slimming i (
page 557


We double final -s in gassing, gassed (but not usually in other words), final -z mfezzes, and final -/in iffy (a
colloquial word for 'questionable', 'uncertain').
3 only at the end of a word
We only double consonants that come at the end of a word. Compare:
hop* hopping BUT hope* hoping
fat-* fatter BUT lateplater
plan* planned BUT phone* phoned
4 one consonant after one vowel letter
We only double when the word ends in one consonant after one vowel letter Compare:
fat -* fatter BUT fast * faster (NOT fasttor) betabetting BUT beat* beating (NOT boatting)
5 only stressed syllables
We only double consonants in stressed syllables. We do not double in longer words that end in
unstressed syllables. Compare:
up''set* up'setting BUT 'visit* 'visiting be''gin* be'ginning BUT 'open*'opening re'fer> re'ferring
BUT 'offer-* 'offering
Note the spelling of these words:
'gallop-* 'galloping^ 'galloped (NOT gallopping, galloppcd) de'velop^ developing* de'veloped (NOT
dcvolopping, dewloppcd}
6 exception: final Z in unstressed syllables
In British English, we double -/ at the end of a word after one vowel letter, in most cases, even in
unstressed syllables.
'travel^ travelling 'equal-* equalled In American English, words like this are normally spelt with one /:
traveling.
7 other exceptions
Consonants are sometimes doubled at the end of final syllables that are pronounced with full vowels (e.g.
/ae/), even when these do not carry the main stress.
kidnap> kidnapped
handicap * handicapped
worship-^ worshippers (US also worshipers)
combat^ combating OR combatting
Final -s is sometimes doubled infocus(s)ing, focus(s)ed, bias(s)ed and similar words.
8 finale
Final -c changes to cfc before -ed, -er, -ing etc.
picnic-* picnickers panic-* panicking mimic-* mimicked
.558
9 Why double?
The reason for doubling is to show that a vowel is pronounced short. This is because, in the middle of a
word, a stressed vowel letter before one consonant is usually pronounced as a long vowel or as a
diphthong (double vowel). Compare:
hoping /'haupin/ hopping /'hopiq/ later /'leita(r)/ latter /'laeta(r)/ diner /'dama(r)/ dinner /'dina(r)/
536 spelling (8): ch and tch, k and ck
After one vowel, at the end of a word, we usually write -ck and-tch for the sounds /k/ and /tJ7.
back neck sick lock stuck
catch fetch stitch botch hutch
Exceptions:
yak tic (and many other words ending in -ic) rich which such much attach detach
After a consonant or two vowels, we write -fc and -ch.
bank work talk march bench break book week peach coach
537 spelling (9): ie and ei
The sound /i:/ (as in believe) is often written ie, but not usually ei. However, we write ei after c. English-
speaking children learn a rhyme: 'i before e, except after c'.
believe chief field grief piece shield ceiling deceive receive receipt
Exceptions: seize, Neil, Keith.
538 spelling and pronunciation
In many English words, the spelling is different from the pronunciation. This is mainly because our
pronunciation has changed a good deal over the last few hundred years, while our spelling system has
stayed more or less the same. Here is a list of some difficult common words with their pronunciations.
1 usually two syllables, not three
The letters in brackets are usually not pronounced. asp(i)rin ev(e)ning om(e)lette business ev(e)ry
rest(au)rant choc(o)late marri(a)ge sev(e)ral diff(e)rent med(i)cine (US three syllables) >
page 559


2 usually three syllables, not four
The letters in brackets are usually not pronounced.
3
comf(or)table
interesting
secret(a)ry (US four syllables)
temp(e)rature
us(u)ally
veg(e)table
silent letters
The letters in brackets are usually not pronounced.
a clim(b) com(b) dum(b)
D mus(c)le
a han(d) kerchief san(d)uiich We(d)nesday
a champa(g)ne forei(g)n si(g)n
a bou(gh)t cau(gh)t ou(gh)t thou(gh)t
D dau(gh)ter hei(gh)t hi(gh) li(gh)t mi(gh)t nei(gh)bour ni(gh)t ri(gh)t strai(gh)t throu(gh) ti(gh)t wei(gh)
o w(h)at w(h)en w(h)ere w(h)ether w(h)ich w(h)ip w(h)y (Some speakers use an unvoiced /w7 in these
words.)
a (h)onest (h)onour (h)our
D (k)nee (k)nife (k)nob (k)nock (k)now
D ca(l)m cou(l)d ha(l)f sa(l)mon shou(l)d ta(l)k wa(l)k wou(l)d
D autum(n) hym(n)
a (p)neumatic (p)sychiatrist (p)sychology (p)sychotherapy (p)terodactyl
D cu(p)board
D i(r)on (British pronunciation)
a i(s)land i(s)le
a cas(t)le Chris(t)mas fas(t)en lis(t)en of(t)en whis(t)le (Often can also be pronounced /'nJ'tan/.)
a g(u)ess g(u)ide g(u)itar a (w)rap (w)rite (w)rong D (w)ho (w)hose (w)hole
a=/e/ D any many Thames
ch=fk/ ci ache architect character chemist Christmas stomach
6 ea= /e/
a bread breakfast dead death head health heavy instead lead (the metal) leather pleasure read (past)
ready sweater
7 ea= /ei/
J break great steak
8 gh=/fl
3 cough enough laugh rough
9 0=/A/
:i brother colour come comfortable company cover glove government honey London money month mother
none nothing one onion other some son stomach ton wonder worry
10 OM = /A/
D country couple cousin double enough trouble
11 U=lvl
D butcher cushion pull push put
12 words pronounced with /ai/
u biology buy dial height idea iron microphone science society either (many British speakers) neither
(many British speakers)
other strange spellings
area /'eana/ Australia /os'treilia/ bicycle /'baisikl/ biscuit /'biskit/ blood /blAd/ brooch /brautf/ business
/'bizms/ busy /'bizi/ Europe /'juarap/ foreign /'reran/ friend /frend/ fruit /fruit/
heard /haid/
heart /ho:t/
juice /dguis/
minute /'minrt/
moustache /ma'staif/ (US /'mAstaef/)
once /wAns/
one IwAn/
theatre /'6iBta(r)/
two /tu:/
woman /'woman/
women /'wimm/
page 561


14 silent r
In standard southern British English, r is not normally pronounced before a consonant or at the end of a
word.
hard /ha:d/ first /f3:st/ order /bida/ car /ka:/ /our Itv.l more /my./
But r is pronounced at the end of a word if a vowel follows immediately. four islands /'fy.i 'ailandz/ more
eggs /'my.i 'egz/
Note the pronunciation of iron, and of words ending in -ered and -re. iron /aran/ (US /'airan/) centre
/'senta(r)/ wondered /'WAndad/ theatre /'9iBta(r)/ bothered /'bo9ad/
We often add /r/ after words ending in the sound /a/ even when this is not written with r, if another vowel
follows immediately. India and Africa /'indiar and 'aefnka/
In most varieties of American English, and in many regional British accents, r is pronounced whenever it is
written.
$9 still, yet and already
1 meanings
Still, yet and already can all be used to talk about things which are going on, or expected, around the
present. We use these words to say where something is in relation to the present moment.
2 still
Still is used to say that something is in the present, not the past - it has, perhaps surprisingly, not finished.
She's still asleep. Is it still raining?
I'vebeen thinking for hours, but I still can't decide.
You're not still seeing that Jackson boy, areyou?
For the use of not any longer/more or no longer to say that something has finished, see 372.
3 yet
Not yet is used to say that something which is expected is in the future, not the present or past.
'Is Sally here?' 'Not yet.' The postman hasn't come yet. In questions, we use yet to ask whether something
expected has happened.
Is supper ready yet? Has the postman come yet? Yet is normally used in questions and negative
sentences, but it is occasionally used in affirmative sentences (with a similar meaning to stwlu* a formal
style.
We have yet to hear from the bank. (= We are still waiting to hear...)
4 already
Already is used to say that something is in the present or past, not the futur • It may express some
surprise - for example, because something has

page
562
happened sooner than expected.
'When's Sally going to come?' 'She's already here.' 'You must go to Scotland.' 'I've already been.' Have
you already finished? That was quick!
5 related to a past moment
All three words can be related to a past moment instead of to the present. I went to see if she had woken
up yet, but she was still asleep. This was embarrassing, because her friends had already arrived.
6 tenses
Various tenses are possible with all three words. In British English, perfect tenses are common with
already and yet; Americans often prefer past tenses.
Compare:
- Have you called the garage yet? (GB) Did you call the garage yet? (US)
- She's already left. (GB) She already left. (US)
7 position
Already and still usually go in 'mid-position' (see 22).
Are you already here?
She's still working. Already is not usually put with time adverbials.
When I was fourteen I already knew that I wanted to be a doctor. (NOT Already when I was fourteen...)
In 1970 Britain's car industry was already in serious trouble.
(NOT Already in 1970...) Already can also go at the end of a clause for emphasis.
Areyou here already? You must have run all the way. Yet usually goes at the end of a clause, but it can go
immediately after not in
a formal style.
Don't eat the pears - they wren't ripe yet. The pears are notyet ripe. (more formal)
For other meanings of still and yet, see a good dictionary. For the difference between these words and
ever, see 197.
540 stress, rhythm and intonation
1 stress
Stress is the word for the 'strength' with which syllables are pronounced. In speech, some parts of English
words and sentences sound much louder than others. For example, the first syllable ofCARpet, the
second syllable of inSPECtion or the last syllable ofconFUSE are usually stressed, while the other
syllables in these words are not. In the sentence Don't look at HIM -HE didn't do it, the words him and he
are stressed in order to emphasise them. Stressed syllables are not only louder; they may also have
longer vowels, and they may be pronounced on a higher pitch. >
page 563


2 word stress
English words with more than one syllable mostly have a fixed stress pattern. There are not many rules to
show which syllable of a word will be stressed:
one usually has to learn the stress pattern of a word along with its meaning, spelling and pronunciation.
Examples:
Stressed on first syllable:
AFter, CApital, HAPpen, Exercise, EAsy
Stressed on second syllable:
inSTEAD, proNOUNCE, aGREEment, parTIcularly Stressed on third syllable:
enterTAW, underSTAND, concenTRAtion The stressed syllable of a word is the one that can carry an
intonation movement (see paragraph 6 below).
Many short phrases also have a fixed stress pattern.
frontDOOR (NOT fROW-dew)
LIVingroom (NOT UvingROOM) Related words can have different stress patterns.
to inCREASE an iNcrease
PHOtograph phoTOgrapher photoGRAphic
3 variable stress
Some words have variable stress. In these, the stress is at or near the end when the word is spoken
alone, but it can move to an earlier position when
the word is in a sentence, especially if another stressed word follows. Compare:
- afterNOON (stress at the end)
It's time for my Afternoon SLEEP, (stress at the beginning)
- JapanESE
JApanese cooking
- nineTEEN
The year NINEteen TWENty
Many short phrases - for instance, two-word verbs - have variable stress.
- Their marriage broke UP.
Money problems BROKE up their marriage.
- It's dark BLUE. a DARK blue SUIT
4 stress and pronunciation
Unstressed syllables nearly always have one of two vowels: /a/ or /if. Compare the first syllables in the
following pairs of words:
- CONfident (/'konfidant/) conFUSED (/kan'fju.-zd/)
- PARticle (/'pa:tikl/)
parTlcular (/pa'tikjala(r)/)
- Expert (/'eksp3:t/)
exPERience (/ik'sprarrans/)
page
564
Many short words (mostly pronouns, prepositions, conjunctions and auxiliary verbs) have two quite
different pronunciations: a normal 'weak' unstressed form, and a 'strong' form used when the word has
special stress. (For details, see 588.)
'Iwas (/waz/) here first.' 'Noyou weren't.' 'Yes I was (/WDZ/).'
5 stress in sentences; rhythm
Rhythm is the word for the way stressed and unstressed syllables make patterns in speech. In sentences,
we usually give more stress to nouns, ordinary verbs, adjectives and adverbs, and less stress to
pronouns, determiners, prepositions, conjunctions and auxiliary verbs.
She was SURE that the BACK of the CAR had been DAMaged. Many linguists feel that the rhythm of
spoken English is based on a regular pattern of stressed syllables. These follow each other at roughly
regular intervals, and are pronounced more slowly and clearly. Unstressed syllables are pronounced more
quickly and less clearly, and are fitted in between the regular stressed syllables. If several unstressed
syllables come together, these are pronounced even more quickly so as not to disturb the rhythm.
Compare the following two sentences. The second does not take much longer to say than the first:
although it has three more unstressed syllables, it has the same number of stressed syllables.
She KNEW the DOCtor.
She KNEW that there was a DOCTor.
• Note, however, that this is a very complicated question, and not all experts agree about the way English
rhythm works.
6 intonation
Intonation is the word for the 'melody' of spoken language: the way the musical pitch of the voice rises and
falls. Intonation systems in languages are very complicated and difficult to analyse, and linguists disagree
about how English intonation works.
One way in which intonation seems to be used is to show how a piece of information fits in with what
comes before and after. For instance, a speaker may raise his or her voice when taking over the
conversation from somebody else, or to indicate a change of subject. A rise or fall on a particular word
may show that this is the 'centre' of the message - the place where the new information is being given; or
it may signal a contrast or a special emphasis. When a speaker ends on a falling tone, this often
expresses some kind of conclusion or certainty; a rising tone at the end of a sentence may express
uncertainty, suggest that there is more to be said, or invite another speaker to take over.
Intonation (together with speed, voice quality and loudness) can also say things about the speaker's
attitude. For instance, when people are excited or angry they often raise and lower their voices more.
page 565


541
l
subjunctive
forms and meanings
The subjunctive is a special kind of present tense which has no -s in the third person singular. It is
sometimes used in that-clauses in a formal style, especially in American English, after words which
express the idea that something is important or desirable (e.g. suggest, recommend, ask, insist,
vital, essential, important, advice). The same forms are used in both present and past sentences.
It is essential that every child have the same educational opportunities. We felt it was important that
James write to Uncle Arthur as soon as possible.
Our advice is that the company invest in new equipment.
The judge recommended that Simmons remain in prison for at least three years.
Do is not used in negative subjunctives. Note the word order.
We considered it desirable that he not leave school before finishing
: his exams.
2 be
Be has special subjunctive forms: I be, you be etc.
It is important that Helen be present when we sign the papers. The Director asked that he be allowed to
advertise for more staff. The forms / were and he/she/it were, used for example after if (see 260.4) and
wish (see 601) in a formal style, are also a kind of subjunctive. If I were you I should stop smoking. I wish
it were Saturday.
3 fixed phrases
Subjunctives are also used in certain fixed phrases. Examples:
God save the King/Queen! Long live the bride and groom! God bless you. Heaven forbid.
He's a sort of adopted uncle, as it were. (=... in a way.)
Be that as it may... (= Whether that is true or not...)
If we have to pay L2,000, then so be it. (= We can't do anything to change it.)
4 other structures
Most subjunctive structures are formal and unusual in British English. In ^ay-clauses, British people
usually prefer should+ infinitive (see 497), oi ordinary present and past tenses.

...^-clauses, Lmiaii pcupic usuauy prerer should + infinitive (see 497), or ordinary present and past tenses.
'
It is essential that every child should have the same educational
opportunities. (OR ... thatevery child has...) We felt it was important that James should write to Uncle
Arthur as soon
as possible. (OR ... that fames wrote...)
older English
Older English had more subjunctive forms, and used them in many kinds ot 'unreal' sense to talk about
possible, desirable or imaginary situations. Many
of these forms have disappeared from modern English, being replaced by uses of should, would and other
modal verbs, by special uses of past tenses (see 422), and by ordinary verb forms.
542 substitution
1 What is substitution?
We often avoid repeating a word or expression that has been used before. One way of doing this is to use
a general-purpose substitute word or 'pro-form' like it, that, one, do, there, so.
She folded the letter and put it away in a drawer. (=... put the letter away...)
'How about a swim?' 'I'd like that.' (=... 'I'd like a swim!)
'What sort of cake would you like?' 'One with lots of cream.'
'Joe thinks it's time to go.' 'I do too.'
'Let's meet at the station." OK, see you there.'
'Do you think we'll win2' 'I hope so.'
Substitute words are also used when the meaning is so clear from the situation that a more precise word
is unnecessary.
Those look nice. Can I have one?
Isn'tshe beautiful!
For structures in which words are left out with no substitute ('ellipsis'), see 181-For repetition (and
avoidance of repetition) in general, see 479.
186.
page
566
2 pronouns
Pronouns substitute for nouns or noun phrases. They include personal pronouns like she, it (see 425),
reflexive pronouns like himself, herself (see 471), possessives like her, theirs (see 433), relatives like who,
that (see 473), interrogatives like what, who (which substitute for unknown expressions -see 460), the
demonstratives this/that/these/those (see 565), indefinite ' pronouns like somebody (see 523), and one
(which replaces countable nouns-see 391).
Liz went home because she was tired.
He's started talking to himself again.
Look at Mary with her new boyfriend.
You ought to meet the people who live next door.
What happened?
Can I have a look at that?
I'd like somebody to help me.
3 the pro-verb do
We can use do so and do it/that as substitutes to avoid repeating a verb and words that follow. For details,
see 166.
lashed him to givemea contract, blithe wasn't prepared todoso.
'Could you fix my bike?' Til do it at once.' In British English, do can also be used alone as a substitute for a
verb after an
auxiliary (see 165).
'Do you think Phil will come?' 'He might do.' (US... 'He might.') >
page 567


4 adverbial and adjectival substitutes
There and then are used as substitutes for adverbial expressions of place and time.
'Let's meet at the station.' 'OK, seeyou there.' 'I got married in 1986.' 'How old were you then?'
The question words where, when, how and why are used as substitutes for unknown adverbial
expressions - for details, see 460. Where did you hide the chocolates?
Such and so substitute for expressions like 'of the kind already mentioned' or 'to the degree already
mentioned or perceived'. For details, see 513 and 543
Such a plan would be disastrous.
I didn 't realise you were so ill. So can sometimes substitute for an adjective.
The weather is stormy, and will remain so through the weekend. 'Is she still depressed?' 'Less so than
yesterday.'
5 clause substitutes
So and not are used as substitutes for clauses in certain cases. For details, see 514, 515 and 261.12.
'You 're in big trouble.' 'Who says so?'
'Have we got enough bread?' 'I think so.'
'We're not going to be in time.' 'No, I suppose not.'
I may be free this evening. If so, I'll come round and see you.
6 substitution with auxiliaries
An auxiliary verb can be used as a substitute for a complete verb phrase (and
often for what follows). This is dealt with in the section on ellipsis: see 185. 'Give my love to Granny.' 'I
will.'
543 such
1 'of the kind just mentioned'
In a formal style, such + noun can be used to mean 'like this/that', 'of the kind that has just been
mentioned'. Such comes before a/an.
The committee is thinking of raising the subscription. I would oppose such a decision. (NOT .. .-a-such
dceisierk)
There are various ways of composing secret messages. Such systems are called 'codes' or 'ciphers'.
Many long-term prisoners come to regard prison as their home; when such prisoners are released they
have serious problems.
In an informal style we prefer other expressions, for example like this/that or this/thatkind of.
... systems like that are called... ... when this kind of prisoner is released...
2 when such cannot be used
Such refers back to what has been said. It is not generally used demonstratively, to refer to things in the
present siruation. To express the
page 568

3
4

5
6
idea 'of the kind that lam showing you' or 'of the kind that we can see/hear
now', we prefer like this/that or this/that kind/sort of. Look over there! Would you like to have a car like
that?
(NOT Would you like to have such a car?) Where can I get trousers like those? (NOT ... such trousers?) I
don't like this sort of music. (NOT I don't like such music.)
high degree
Such is often used when we are talking about a high degree of some quality -in situations where very is
also a suitable word (for the difference, see paragraph 4). In this sense, such is common before adjective
+ noun.
I'm sorry you had such a bad journey.
(= You had a very bad journey, and I'm sorry.)
It was a pleasure to meet such interesting people. Such is also possible with this meaning before a noun
alone, when the noun has an emphatic descriptive meaning.
I'm glad your concert was such a success.
Why did she make such a fuss about the dates?
such and very
Very is used when we are simply giving information. Such is mainly used (in the same way as like
this/that), to refer to information which has already been given, which is already known, or which is
obvious. Compare:
- I've had a very bad day. (giving information) Why did you have such a bad day?
(referring to information which is already known)
- The weather was very cold. (giving information) I wasn 't expecting such cold weather.
(referring to information which is already known) Used directly before nouns, such can be compared to
words like great,
extreme etc. Compare:
- There was great confusion, (giving information) Why was there such confusion?
(referring to information which is already known)
emphatic use
In an informal style, such can also be used to give new information, when the speaker wishes to
emphasise what is said.
He's such an idiot!
She has such a marvellous voice!
This is such wonderful soup - what do you put in it?
that-clsaises
Structures with very cannot be followed directly by that-clauses. Instead, we
can use such... that.
It was such a cold afternoon that we stopped playing.
(NOT It was a wry cold afternoon that...) >
page 569


7 such ...us to...
There is also a structure with such followed by... + as to + infinitive. This is formal and not very common.
It was such a loud noise as to wake everybody in the house. (Less formal:... such a loud noise that it
woke...)
8 such-and-such
Note this informal expression.
When you 're studying medicine, you learn that such-and-such a symptom (= one or other symptom}
corresponds to such-and-such an illness.
9 such as
Note the use of such as with a noun to introduce examples. . My doctor told me to avoid fatty foods such
as bacon or hamburgers.
In such areas as North Wales or the Lake District, there are now too many walkers and climbers.
For the difference between such and so, see 544.
For more about very, see 153.
For other ways of expressing the idea of degree, see 153-156.
544 such and so
1 such before (adjective +) noun
We use such before a noun (with or without an adjective). Such comes before a/an.
She's such a baby. (NOT She's so-a baby.) I'm surprised that he's got such patience. They're such fools.
It was such good milk that we couldn 't stop drinking it. (NOT It was so good milk that...)
I've never met such a nice person. (NOT.. . a such/so nice person.) You ve got such strange friends.
2 so before adjective, adverb etc
We use so before an adjective alone (without a noun) or an adverb. She's so babyish. (NOT -She's-
suehibabyish.) He's so patient with her.
The milk was so good that we couldn't stop drinking it. She's so nice.
Why do you talk so slowly? We can also use so before much, many, few and little.
We've got so much to do, and so little time. We use so much, not so, before comparatives.
I'm glad you're feeling so much better. (NOT ... so bettor.}
For so beautiful a day etc, see 16. For more about the meaning and use of such, see 543. For more about
so, see 513.
page
570
545 l
2
3
OLl^{-l-aC OUpj-JUOHlg CTlM-l T«t tl WWW
suggest
infinitive not used
Suggest is not followed by object + infinitive. TTiar-clauses and -ing structures are common.
Her uncle suggested that she (should) get a job in a bank.
Her uncle suggested getting a job in a bank.
(NOT Her uncle suggested her to get a job in a bank.)
verb forms in ^feat-clauses
In that-clauses after suggest, various verb forms are possible.
Ordinary present and past tenses can be used in British English. Her uncle suggests that she gets a job in
a bank. He suggested that she got a job in a bank.
In a formal style, subjunctives are possible, especially in American English. See 541 for details.
He suggests that she get a job in a bank.
He suggested that she get a job in a bank.
In British English, should + infinitive is common. (This is rare in American English.)
He suggests that she should get a job in a bank.
He suggested that she should get a job in a bank.
direct suggestions
In direct suggestions ('/ suggest...'), should is not generally used. I suggest (that) you get... (NOT I suggest
that you should get...)
objects
We can use a direct object after suggest.
'What shall we give the children?' 'I suggest hamburgers.' Suggest is not normally followed by an indirect
object without a preposition.
Canyou suggest a restaurantto us? (NOT Can you suggest us a restaurant?)
546 suppose, supposing and what if
Suppose, supposing and what if can all be used to introduce suggestions. (Supposing is less common in
American English.) The verb can be present or past; a past form makes the suggestion sound less
definite. 'I haven't got a table cloth." Suppose we use a sheet.' What if we invite your mother next weekend
and go away the week after? 'Daddy, can I watch TV?' 'Supposing you did your homework first?' What if I
came tomorrow instead of this afternoon? These expressions can also be used to talk about fears. 'Let's
go swimming.' 'Suppose there are sharks?' 'I'm going to climb up there.' 'No! What if you slipped?' >
page 571


supposed to 347
In sentences about the past, past perfect tenses are used to talk about situations that did not occur.
That was very clever, but supposing you had slipped?
For other uses of suppose, see 451.2, 515, 359. For other cases where past tenses are used with present
or future meanings, see 422.
547 supposed to
Be supposed + infinitive can be used to talk about what is generally believed He's supposed to be quite
rich, you know.
This stuff is supposed to kill/lies. Let's try it. Often, be supposed to is used rather like should, to talk about
what people have to do according to the rules or the law, or about what is expected to happen.
You're supposed to start work at 8.30 every morning.
Catholics are supposed to go to church on Sundays. Be supposed to can express a contrast between
what should happen and what actually happens.
Lucy was supposed to come to lunch. What's happened? Cats are supposed to be afraid of dogs, but our
Tibby has just chased Mr
Glidewell's bulldog right down the road. That's a lovely picture, but what's it supposed to be?
Not supposed to can refer to prohibitions.
You're not supposed to park on double yellow lines. People under eighteen aren't supposed to buy
alcoholic drinks.
Note the pronunciation: /sa'paust ta/, not /sa'pauzd ta/.
548 surely
1 not the same as certainly
Surely does not usually mean the same as certainly. Compare:
That's certainly a plain-clothes policeman.
(= / know that's a plain-clothes policeman.) Surely that's a plain-clothes policeman? "'-' (= That really
seems to be a plain-clothes policeman. How surprising!)
2 meaning: belief in spite of...
Surely is normally used to say that the speaker believes something in spite of appearances, in spite of
reasons to believe the opposite, or in spite of
suggestions to the contrary. Sentences with surely often have question marks.
Surely that's Henry over there? I thought he was in Scotland.
Tm going to marry Sonia.' 'Surely she's married already?'
'Is it tonight we're going out?' 'No, tomorrow, surely?' Surely (with heavy stress) can suggest that the
speaker would like to believe something, but is beginning to lose hope.
Surely she's going to stop crying soon ? '- (It looks as if she's going to go on for ever.)
Surely there's somebody in the house? Why don't they answer the door?
Surely somebody's going to help him? He'll drown!
page 572
Surely not expresses difficulty in believing something. Surely you're not going out in that hat? 'Tim failed
his exam.' 'Oh, surely not?' You don't think I'm going to pay for you, surely?
3 American English
In American English, surely can also be used in replies to mean 'certainly*. 'Do you want something to
eat?' T surely do.' 'Could you help me for a moment?' 'Surely.'
549 sympathetic
Sympathetic is a 'false friend' for speakers of certain languages. It does not usually mean the same as, for
example, sympathise, sympathiser
sympatisk or simpdtico.
The people in my class are all very nice/pleasant/easy to get on with.
(NOT ... arc all very sympathetic.) Sympathetic usually means 'sharing somebody's feelings' or 'sorry for
somebody who is in trouble'.
I'm sympathetic towards the strikers. She's always very sympathetic when people feel ill.
550 take
1 the opposite of give
Take can be used as the opposite ofgi're, with a similar meaning to 'gain possession of, 'receive', 'obtain'
or 'remove'. . | She takes more than she gives. I He likes to give advice, but he won't take it. 'i Andrew's
not in just now. Can I take a message? Who's taken my bicycle? She took my plate and gave me a clean
one. We take something^rom a person. She took the letter from the postman. I won't take a penny from
him. Take cannot be used with two objects in this sense.
They took everything away from me when they arrested me. (NOT They took me everything...)
2 the opposite of put "
Take can be used as the opposite of put, to talk about moving things away
from their places.
I took off my coat and put on a dressing gown.
We take something out of/from/off a place.
Could you take some money out of my wallet? (NOT ... in my wallet?) He took a ring out of his pocket,
walked across the room and put it on her
finger.
He took a letter from the pile on his desk. Take that stupid smile off your face.
page 573


__... _ . _.. icu^e (.nine.) 551
3 the opposite of bring
Take can also mean 'transport' or 'carry'. In this sense, it is the opposite of bring, and is used for
movements which are not towards the speaker or hearer. See 112 for details.
Can you take me to the station tomorrow morning? (NOT Can you bring me to the station...-?)
Take this form to Mr Collins, ask him to sign both copies, and then briny it straight back.
In this sense, take can be used with two objects. I'm just going to take your mother a cup of coffee.
4 'have', 'experience'
Take + noun is used in many common expressions referring to activities. In these expressions take
generally means 'have', 'experience'; have is often preferred in British English (see 240).
/ think I'll take a bath. (GB also... have a bath.}
Let's take a break. (GB also... have a break.) Other examples:
take a wash take a shower take a vacation take a rest take a swim take a walk take a look take a deep
breath take a guess
Note that have, not take, is used with the names of meals (e.g. have breakfast).
For more about the use of nouns for activities, see 573.
5 two-word verbs
Take is used in a large number of common idiomatic two-word verbs. Wiydon'tyou take off your coat and
sit down? The policeman took down her statement. (='... wrote down...') Harry's taken up golf. (='... started
playing...') Our firm has been taken over by a Japanese company. I didn't take to him at all when I first met
him. (='... like...') You didn't take in a word I said, didyou? He takes after his father. (='... resembles...')
For more details of these and other two-word verbs beginning with take, see a good dictionary.
For the grammar of two-word verbs, see 582.
take (time)
four structures
We can use take to say how much time we need to do something. Four structures are common:
The person is the subject:
person + take + time + infinitive / took three hours to get home last night.
page
574
She takes all day to get out of the bathroom.
They took two hours to unload the ferry.
Why do the tax people take so long to answer letters?
b The activity is the subject:
('activity + take (+ person) +
The journey took me three hours. Gardening takes a lot of time. Unloading the ferry took them three
hours. Everything takes longer than you expect.
c The object of the activity is the subject:
object of activity + take (+ person.)'+'ir(^^^e'..:- ' LCV.
^&S!'&.' •
The ferry took them two hours to unload.
This house will take all week to clean.
The book took longer to write than he had expected.
Those forms take ages to fill in.
d Preparatory it is the subject:
ft+ take (+ person) + time ^immWj^
It took me three hours to get home last night.
It takes ages to do the shopping.
I don't know how long it will take me to learn Chinese.
It only takes a few minutes to do the operation.
2 take and last
Take and last are both used to talk about the length of experiences and events. In general, we say that
something takes a certain time when we see it as an active experience - a job or task that somebody
does, for which time is needed - and we say that it lasts a certain time when we see it as a more passive
experience, which somebody goes through without controlling it. (Often, both words are possible with a
slight difference of emphasis.)
Compare:
It was a terrible job -1 thought it would take forever.
It was a wonderful holiday -1 wished it would last forever.
552 taste
1 copular verb
Taste can be used as a 'copular verb', followed by adjective complements (see 147), to say what sort of
taste something has. Progressive forms are
not used.
This tastes nice. What's in it? (NOT .. .-tastes-nicely.)
The wine tastes funny. (NOT ... is tasting funny...) Before a noun, taste of and taste like are used. The fish
soup tasted, mostly of garlic. Her lips tasted like wild strawberries.
page 575


2
3
transitive verb: 'perceive'
Taste can be used as a transitive verb, followed by an object, to say what we
perceive with our sense of taste. Progressive forms are not used. We often use can taste (see 125).
lean taste garlic and mint in the sauce. (NOT lam tasting...) transitive verb: 'investigate'
Another transitive use is to say that we are using our sense of taste to find out something. Progressive
forms can be used.
'Stop eating the cake.' 'I'm just tasting it to see if it's OK.'
553 technique and technology
Technology is the normal word for 'scientific and industrial manufacturing processes and skills'.
Modern technology has improved our standard of living.
(NOT Modern technique...) A technique is a method of doing something.
Barnard developed a new technique in heart surgery. Technique can be used for the way an artist or
athlete performs.
He's not only very fast, but he's also got marvellous technique.
Joyce was not the first novelist to use the 'stream of consciousness' technique. '
554 telephoning
1 answering a private phone
British people usually give their name or number. Hello. Albert Packard.
Hello. Ardington three seven oh double two. (= 37022) (US Hello. Packard residence. Albert Packard
speaking.}
asking for a person
Could I speak to Jane Horrabin? (US also Could I speak with...?) saying who you are
Hello, this is Corinne. (NOT USUALLY ... I'm Corinno.} 'Could I speak to Jane Horrabin?' 'Speaking.'(o^
This is Jane Horrabin
(speaking).} (US This is she.)
4 asking who somebody is
Who is that? (US Who is this/Who's there?) Who am I speaking to? Who is that speaking?
2
3
page 576
asking for a number
Could I have extension two oh four six?
What's the (dialling) code for London? (US... area code...?)
How do I call the operator?
6 if you want the person that you are calling to pay for the call
I'd like to make a reversed (o R transferred) charge call to Bristol 37878. (US I'd like to make a collect
call...)
7 if somebody is not there
I'm afraid she's not in at the moment.
Can I take a message?
Can I leave a message?
I'll ring/call again later. (US I'll call...)
Could you ask her to ring/call me back?
Could you ask her to ring/call me at/on Ardington 37022?
Could you just tell her Jake called?
8 asking people to wait
9
10
11
Just a moment. Hold on a moment, please.
Hold the line, please. Hang on. (informal)
things the operator may say
One moment, please. (I'm) trying to connect you. (The number's) ringing for you. (I'm) putting you through
now. I'm afraid the number/line is engaged (GB) / busy (US). Will you hold? I'm afraid there's no reply from
this number/from her extension.
wrong number
/ think you've got the wrongnumber. I'm sorry. I've got the wrong number.
problems
Could you speak louder? It's a bad line. (US... bad connection.) It's a very bad line. I'll hang up and call
again. I rang you earlier but I couldn't get through.
555 telling the time
1 saying what time it is
There are two common ways of saying what time it is.
8.05 eight (oh) five OB five past eight
8.10 eight ten OR ten past eight
8.15 eight fifteen OR a quarter past eight
8.25 eight twenty-five OR twenty-five past eight
8.30 eight thirty OR half past eight
page 577






8.35 eight thirty-five OR twenty-five to nine 8.45 eight forty-five ov. a quarter to nine 8.50 eight fifty OR ten
to nine 9.00 nine o'clock
Many British people prefer to say minutes past/to for times between the five-minute divisions (e.g. seyen
minutes past eight, three minutes to nine)
The expression o'clock is only used at the hour. Compare:
Wake me at seven (o'clock).
Wake me at ten past seven. (NOT ... ton past seven o'clock.] Past is often dropped from half past in
informal speech.
OK, see you at naif two. (=... half past two.) In American English after is often used instead of past (e.g.
ten after six}; but Americans do not say half after. And in American English of, before and 'till are possible
instead of to (e.g. twenty-five of three).
asking what time it is
Common ways of asking about time are:
What time is it? Have you got the time? (informal) What's the time? Could you tell me the time? (more
formal) What time do you make it? OR What do you make the time?
(GB; = What time is it by your watch?) What time does the game start? (NOT USUALLY At what time...?)
the twenty-four hour clock
The twenty-four hour clock is used mainly in timetables, programmes and official announcements. In
ordinary speech, people usually use the twelve-hour clock. Compare:
- Last check-in time is 20.15.
We have to check in by a quarter past eight in the evening.
- The next train from platform 5 is the seventeen fifty-three departure for Carlisle.
'What time does it leave?' 'Seven minutes to six.' If necessary, times can be distinguished by using in the
morning/afternoon/ evening. In a more formal style, we can use am (= Latin ante meridiem -'before
midday') and pm (= post meridiem - 'after midday').
09.00 = nine o'clock in the morning (OR nine am)
21.00 = nine o'clock in the evening (OR nine pm)
tense simplification in subordinate clauses
reasons for tense simplification
If the main verb of a sentence makes it clear what kind of time the speaker is talking about, it is not always
necessary for the same time to be indicated again in subordinate clauses. Compare:
- This discovery means that we will spend less on food. This discovery will mean that we spend less on
food.
page
578
- It is unlikely that he will win.
I will pray that he wins.
Verbs in subordinate clauses are often simpler in form than verbs in main clauses - for example present
instead of future, simple past instead of conditional, simple past instead of past perfect.
You'll find Coca-Cola wherever you go. (NOT ... wherever you willgo.)
He would never do anything that went against his conscience. (More natural than... that would go against
his conscience.)
I hadn't understood what she said.
(More natural than... what she had said.)
2 present instead of future
Present tenses are often used instead of will + infinitive to refer to the future in subordinate clauses. This
happens not only after conjunctions of time like when, until, after, before, as soon as, but in most other
subordinate clauses -for instance after if, whether and on condition that, after question words and
relatives, and in indirect speech.
I'll write to her when I have time. (NOT ... when I will have time.)
I'll think of you when I'm lying on the beach next week. (NOT ... when I will be lying...)
Will you stay here until the plane takes off?
It will be interesting to see whether he recognises you.
I'll have a good time whether I win or lose.
I'll lend it to you on condition that you bring it back tomorrow.
I'll go where you go.
He says he'll give five pounds to anybody who finds his pen.
One day the government will really ask people what they want.
If she asks what I'm doing in her flat, I'll say I'm checking the electricity meter.
I think you'll find the windslowsyou down a bit. This can happen even if the main verb does not have a
future form, provided it refers to the future.
Phone me when you arrive. Make sure you come back soon.
You can tell who you like next week, but not until then. Present perfect tenses can be used to express the
idea of completion.
I'll tell you when I've finished. In comparisons with as and than, present and future verbs are both possible.
She'll be on the same train as we are/will tomorrow.
We'll get there sooner than you do/will.
3 future in subordinate clauses
A future verb is necessary for future reference in a subordinate clause if the main verb does not refer to
the future (or to the same time in the future).
I don't know where she will be tomorrow.
I'm sure I won't understand a word of the lecture.
I'll hide it somewhere where he'll never find it. (two different future times)
If she rings, I'll tell her that I'll ring back later, (two different future times)
page 579


Future verbs are used in ^-clauses when if means 'if it is true that...' (see 261.1).
If the office will be open until five o'clock, then we'll have plenty of time to go there this afternoon.
4 in case, I hope, I bet, it doesn't matter etc
A present tense is normally used with a future meaning after in case even if the main verb is present or
past. For details, see 271.
I've got my tennis things in case we have time for a game tomorrow. In an informal style, present verbs
are often used with future meanings after I hope (see 252) and I bet (see 102).
I hope you sleep well.
I bet he gets married before the end of the year. Present tenses are also used with future reference after it
doesn't matter, Idon'tcare, Idon'tmind, it's not important and similar expressions.
It doesn't matter where we go on holiday.
I don't care what we have for dinner if I don't have to cook it.
5 past instead of conditional
Just as will is avoided in subordinate clauses referring to the future, would is avoided in subordinate
clauses referring to the past. Instead of would + infinitive, past verbs are generally used with conditional
meanings in subordinate clauses. This happens not only in (/-clauses, but also after most other
conjunctions.
If I had lots of money, I would give some to anybody who asked for it.
(NOT If I would have... who would ask for it.) Would you follow me wherever I went? (NOT ... wherever I
would go?) In a perfect world, you would be able to say exactly what you thought.
(NOT ,. .-what you would think:)
I would always try to help anybody who was in trouble, whether I knew them or not.
To see him walk down the street, you'd never know he was blind.
6 exceptions
These rules do not usually apply to clauses beginning because, although, since or as (meaning'because').
I won't mind the heat on holiday because I won't have to move about
much.
I'll come to the opera with you, although I probably won't enjoy it.
7 simplification of perfect and progressive verbs
Simple past verb forms are used quite often in subordinate clauses instead ot present perfect and past
perfect tenses, if the meaning is clear. It's been a good time while it('s) lasted. I've usually liked the people
I('ve) worked with. For thirty years, he had done no more than he (had) needed to. He had probably
crashed because he had gone to sleep while he was driving. (More natural than... while he had been
driving.)
page
580
Progressive forms are quite often replaced by simple forms in subordinate
clauses. Compare:
He's working. But at the same time as he works, he's exercising.
(OR ...at the same time as he's working...)
For tenses in indirect speech, see 481. For past tenses with present or future meanings, see 422.
557 than, as and that
1 than after comparatives
Than is used after comparative adjectives and adverbs (see 135). As and that are not used after
comparatives. My sister's taller than me. (NOT ... taller as me.) (NOT ... taller that me.) She's got longer
hair than I have. (NOT ... longer hair as/that I have.)
2 as...as
As is used in 'comparisons of equality' (as... as...; the same ...as...). Than and that are not used in this
way.
My hands areas cold as ice. (NOT ... as cold than/that ice.)
Your eyes are the same colour as mine. (NOT ... the same colour than/that mine.)
3 as- and ^/ion-clauses with missing subject or object
As and than can introduce clauses in which there is no subject or object pronoun (rather as if as and than
were relative pronouns). Clauses with no subject pronoun are mainly used in a formal style.
k Their marriage was as stormy as had been expected.
H (NOT ... as it had been expected.)
H Anne's going to join us, as was agreed last week.
(NOT ...as it i
reed last weak.)
He worries more than is good for him.
(NOT -Ho worries more than it/what is good for him.) Don't lose your passport, as I did lastyear.
(NOT ... as I did it lastyear.) They sent more than I had ordered.
(NOT ... more than I had ordered it.) She gets her meat from the same butcher as I go to.
(NOT .. .as I go to him.)
For subject and object pronouns after than, see 138.8.
For tfeaf-clauses, see 559.
For the pronunciation of than, as and that, see 588.
page 581


thankful and grateful
Grateful is the normal word used to talk about people's reactions to kindness, favours etc.
I'm very grateful for all your help. (NOT I'm very thankful...}
She wasn 't a bit grateful to me for repairing her car. Thankful is used especially to talk about people's
feelings of relief at having avoided a danger of some kind, or at having come through an unpleasant
experience.
I'm thankful that we got home before the storm started.
We feel very thankful that she didn 't marry him after all.
Well, I'm thankful that's over.
9 that-clauses
1 that as a connector
That is a conjunction with little real meaning. It is simply a connector-it shows that a declarative clause
forms part of a larger sentence. Compare:
I understood. He was innocent, (two separate sentences) Iunderstood thathe was innocent. (The clause
he was innocenthas become the object of the verb in the larger sentence.)
2 that-clsoises in sentences
That-clauses can have various functions in sentences. A that-clause can be the subject.
That she should forget me so quickly was rather a shock. It can be the complement.
The main thing is that you're happy. Many verbs can have rto-clauses as objects.
We knew that the next day would be difficult.
I regretted that I was not going to be at the meeting. And many nouns and adjectives can be followed by
that-clauses as complements.
I admire your belief that you are always right.
The Minister is anxious that nothing should get into the papers.
3 the fact that...
It is unusual for that-clauses to stand alone as subjects. They are more often introduced by the expression
the fact.
The fact that she was foreign made it difficult for her to get a job.
(NOT That she was foreign made it difficult...)
The fact that Simon had not been home for three days didn't seem to worry anybody. (More natural than
That Simon had not been home for three days didn't...)
The fact also introduces that-clauses after prepositions (that-clauses canno follow prepositions directly).
The judge paid no attention to the fact that she had just lost her husband. (NOT ... paid no attention to that
she had just...)

He held her completely responsible for the fact that she took food without
paying for it. (NOT ... responsible for that she took..) In spite of the fact that she had three small children,
he sent her to prison
for six months. (NOT In spite of that she had...)
For cases when prepositions are dropped before rfiat-clauses, see 441.
4 preparatory it
In many cases, it is used as a 'preparatory' subject or object for a that-clause. For details, see 301-302.
It surprised me that he was still in bed.
(More natural than That he was still in bed surprised me.) She made it clear that she was not interested.
(NOT She made that she was not interested clear.)
For reasons why that-clause subjects and objects are often moved to the end of sentences, see 289.
5 (feat-clauses after verbs, nouns and adjectives
Not all verbs, nouns or adjectives can be followed by that-dauses. Compare:
- / hope that you'll have a wonderful time.
I want you to have a wonderful time. (NOT I want that you'll have...)
- I understood his wish that we should be there. I understood the importance of our being there. (NOT ...
the importance that we should be there.)
- It's essential that you visit the art museum.
It's worth your visiting the art museum. (NOT It's worth thatyou visit...)
For complementation in general, see 140.
For complementation of verbs, see 579. For nouns, see 377. For adjectives, see 12. For the structures
that are possible after particular verbs, nouns and adjectives, see a good dictionary.
6 verbs in that-clsaises
In some kinds of that-clause, should + infinitive or subjunctives are often used instead of ordinary verb
forms. For details, see 497,541. I insisted that she (should) see the doctor at once.
7 compound conjunctions
Some conjunctions are made up of two or more words, including that. Common examples: so that, in
order that, provided that, providing that, seeing that, given that, now that.
I got here early so that we could have a few minutes alone together. I'll come with you providing that Bill
doesn't mind. Now that the kids are at school, the house seems very quiet.
8 omission of (feat
That can be left out in some cases, especially in an informal style. For details, see 560.
She said (that) she didn't mind. >
page
582
page 583


I'm surprised (that) she hasn't phoned. He was so cold (that) he couldn't feel his fingers.
For rfiaf-clauses after reporting verbs ('indirect speech'), see 480-482. For the relative pronoun that, see
473.
560 that: omission
We can often leave out the conjunction that, especially in an informal style.
1 indirect speech
That can be left out informally after many common reporting verbs.
James said (that) he was feeling better. •. I thought (that) you were in Ireland.
The waiter suggested (that) we should go home.
That cannot be dropped after certain verbs (e.g. reply, telegraph, shout}, and it is not usually dropped after
nouns. James replied that he was feeling better.
(NOT James replied ho was feeling bettor.} She shouted that she was busy. (NOT She shouted she was
busy.} He disagreed with Copernicus' view that the earth went round the sun. (NOT ... Copernicus' view
the earth went...}
For omission of that in questions referring to rhat-clauses, see 461.8.
2 after adjectives
We can use that-clauses after some adjectives (see 12). That can Deleft out in more common
expressions.
I'm glad (that) you're all right.
It's funny (that) he hasn't written.
We were surprised (that) she came.
3 conjunctions
That can be left out in an informal style in some common two-word conjunctions, such as so that, such...
that, now that, immediately that, providing that, provided that, supposing that, considering that, assuming
that.
Come in quietly so (that) she doesn't hear you.
I was having such a nice time (that) I didn't want to leave.
The garden looks nice now (that) we've got some flowers out.
You can borrow it provided (that) you bring it back tomorrow.
Assuming (that) nobody gets lost, we'll all meet again here at six o'clock.
4 relative structures
We can usually leave out the relative pronoun that when it is the object in a relative clause (see 474).
Look! There are the people (that) we met in Brighton. Do it the way (that) I showed you.
page
584
561 the matter (with)
The expression the matter (with) is used as a complement after be.
It follows something, anything, nothing and what, and means something like
'wrong (with)'.
Something's the matter with my foot.
Is anything the matter?
Nothing's the matter with the car - you're just a bad driver.
What's the matter with Frank today?
There is often used as a 'preparatory subject' for anything, something and nothing (see 563).
Is there anything the matter?
There's something the matter with the TV.
562 there
The spelling there is used for two words with completely different pronunciations and uses.
1 adverb of place
There (pronounced /oe9(r)/) is an adverb meaning 'in that place'. What's that green thing over there?
There's the book I was looking for.
For the difference between here and there, see 248.
2 introductory subject
There (pronounced /oa(r)/) is used as an introductory subject in sentences beginning there is, there are,
there seems to be, there might be etc. For details,
see 563.
There's a book under the piano.
563 there is
I use
In sentences which say that something exists (or does not exist) somewhere, we usually use there as a
kind of preparatory subject, and put the real subject after the verb. Note the pronunciation of there: usually
/oa(r)/, not /oea(r)/.
There's a hole in my tights. (More natural than A hole is in my tights.)
There's ice on the lake. (More natural than Ice is on the lake.) It cannot be used in this way.
There is a lot of noise in the street. (NOT It is a lot of noise in the street.) There are is used with plural
subjects.
I don't know how many people there are in the waiting room.
(NOT .. .-how many people there is...) However, there is is also common before plural subjects in informal
speech.
There's two policemen at the door. Dad.
There's some grapes in the fridge, if you're still hungry. >
page 585


2 indefinite subjects
We use there in this way particularly with subjects that have indefinite articles, no article, or indefinite
determiners like some, any, no; and with indefinite pronouns like somebody, nothing.
There are some people outside. There were no footsteps to be seen.
Is there anybody at home? There's something worrying me. Note the use of wrong and the matter after
something, anything and nothing.
There's something wrong. Is there anything the matter? Note also the structures with sense, point, use
and need.
There's no sense in making him angry.
Is there any point in talking about it again?
Do you think there's any use trying to explain?
There's no need to hurry - we've got plenty of time.
For more about the matter, see 561. For more about any/no use, see 56.
3 all tenses
There can be used in this way with all tenses of be.
Once upon a time there were three wicked brothers.
There has never been anybody like you.
There will be snow on high ground. And there can be used in tags.
There'll be enough for everybody, won't there?
t structures with auxiliary be
There can also be used in structures where be is a progressive or passive auxiliary. Note the word order.
There was a girl water-skiing on the lake. (=A girl was water-skiing...) (NOT There was water skiing a
girl...]
There have been more Americans killed in road accidents than in all the
wars since 1900. (= More Americans have been killed...)
(NOT There hewe-beeH-killed-inore-AmeriefiHS^...) There'll be somebody meeting you at the airport.
more complex structures
There can be used with modal verb + be and with some other verbs (e.g.
seem, appear, happen, tend) before to be. There might be drinks if you wait for a bit. There must be
somebody at home - ring again. If the police hadn't closed the road there could have been a bad accident.
There seem to be some problems. (NOT There seems to be...) Could you be quiet? There happens to be
a lecture going on. There tends to be jealousy when anew little brother or sister comes along. Note also
the structure there is certain/sure/likely/bound to be. There is sure to be trouble when she gets his letter.
Do you think there's likely to be snow?
page 586
Structures with infinitives (there to be) and -ing forms {there being) are also
possible.
I don't want there to be any more trouble. What's the chance of there beingan election thisyear?
6 other verbs
In a formal or literary style, some other verbs can be used with there besides be. These are verbs which
refer to states, or to the arrival of somebody or
something.
In a small town in Germany there once lived a poor shoemaker. There remains nothing more to be done.
Suddenly there entered a strange figure dressed all in black. There followed an uncomfortable silence.
7 definite subjects
There is not normally used in a sentence with a definite subject (e.g. a noun with a definite article, or a
proper name).
The door was open. (NOT There was the door open.)
fames was at the party. (NOT There was fames at the party) One exception to this is when we simply
name people or things, in order to draw attention to a possible solution to a problem.
'Who could we ask?' 'Well, there's James, or Miranda, or Ann, or Sue,...'
'Where can he sleep?' 'Well, there's always the attic.' Another apparent exception is in stories that begin
There was this..., when
this has an indefinite sense.
There was this man, see, and he couldn't get up in the mornings. So he...
564 think
1 'have an opinion'
When think is used to talk about opinions, progressive forms are not
normally used.
I don't think much of his latest book. (NOT I'm not thinking much...) Who doyou think will win the election?
(NOT Who arc you thinking...?)
2 other meanings
When think has other meanings (e.g. plan or consider) progressive forms are
possible.
You're looking worried. What are you thinking about?
(NOT ... What do you think about?) I'm thinking of changing my job.
3 -ing forms
After think, -ing forms can be used, but infinitives are not usually possible unless there is an object (see
paragraph 4 below). She's thinking of going to university next year.
(NOT She's thinking to go...) ^
page 587


However, think + infinitive is used when we talk about remembering to do something, or having the good
sense to do something.
Did you think to close the windows when it started raining?
4 think + object (+ to be) + complement
In a very formal style, think is sometimes followed by an object and an adjective or noun complement.
They thought her fascinating.
We thought him a fool. It can be used as a preparatory object for an infinitive.
/ thought it better to pretend that I knew nothing. To be is occasionally used before the complement
(suggesting objective judgement rather than subjective impression), but this is very unusual.
They thought him to be a spy. In more normal styles, that-clauses are preferred after think.
They thought that she was fascinating.
We thought that he was a fool.
However, the passive equivalent of the object + complement structure is reasonably common, usually with
to be.
She was thought to be a terrorist.
5 transferred negation
When think is used to introduce a negative clause, we most often put not with think, rather than with the
following clause (see 359).
/ don't think it will rain. (More natural than / think it won't rain.}
Mary doesn't think she can come. However, we can express surprise with I thought... not.
Hello! I thought you weren't coming!
6 indirect speech
Think does not usually introduce indirect questions. :
/ was wondering if I could do anything to help. (More natural than I was thinking if...)
7 I thought...
Note the use of stressed I thought... to suggest that the speaker was right. Compare:
'It isn't very nice.' 'Oh, dear. I thought you'd like it.' ('But I was wrong.') 'It's beautiful!"0h, I am glad. I
thought you'd like it.' ('And I was right.')
S I had thought..., I should think etc
Past perfect forms can suggest that the speaker was mistaken or disappointed.
1 had thought that we were going to be invited to dinner.
I should think and I should have thought (US / would...) can introduce guesses.
/ should think we'll need at least twelve bottles of wine. I should have thought we could expect at least
forty people.
page 588
I should have thought can also introduce criticisms.
I should have thought he could have washed his hands, at least.
for I (don't) think so and I thought so, see 515. For if as a preparatory object in sentences like I think it
strange that..., see 302.
565 this and that (demonstrative pronouns and determiners)
1 people and things
This/that/these/those can be used as determiners with nouns that refer to
either people or things.
this child that house But when they are used as pronouns without nouns, this/that/these/those
normally only refer to things. Compare:
- This costs more than that.
This little boy says he's tired. (NOT This says he's tired.)
- Put those down - they're dirty.
Tell those men to go away. (NOT Tell those to go away.) However, this etc can be used as pronouns
when we are identifying people.
Hello. This is Elisabeth. Is that Ruth?
Who's that? That looks like Mrs Walker. These are the Smiths. Note also Those who... (see paragraph 6
below).
For a similar use of it to refer to people, see 424.5.
2 the difference
We use this/these to talk about people and things which are close to the
speaker.
This is very nice - can I have some more?
Get this cat off my shoulder. Do you like these ear-rings? Bob gave them to me. I don't know what I'm
doing in this country. (NOT.. . in that country:) We use that/those to talk about people and things which are
more distant
from the speaker, or not present.
That smells nice - is it for lunch? Get that cat off the piano.
I like those ear-rings. Where didyou get them? All the time I was in that country I hated it.
3 time
This/these can refer to situations and experiences which are going on or ju;
about to start.
I like this music. What is it?
Listen to this. You'll like it. (NOT Listen to that...)
Watch this. This is a police message.
page
589


That/those can refer to experiences which have just finished, or which are more distant in the past. '
That was nice. What was it? (NOT ^Fhis was nice...) Did you see that? Who said that?
Have you ever heard from that Scottish boy you used to go out with?
(NOT .. .-this-Scottish bey-yeu used to go out with.) That can show that something has come to an end. ...
and that's how it happened.
'Anything else?"No, that'sall, thanks."Right, that'llbe L7.50 altogether.' (in a shop)
OK. That's it. I'm leaving. It was nice knowingyou. Well. that's that. Another day's work finished. Let's go
home. Note that this morning can refer to a finished period (if one is speaking later
the same day); this afternoon and this spring/summer/autumn are used in similar ways.
For this, that and it used to refer back to what has just been said or written, see 566.
acceptance and rejection
We sometimes use this/these to show acceptance or interest, and that/those to show dislike or rejection.
Compare:
Now tell me about this new boyfriend of yours. I don't like that new boyfriend of yours.
5 on the telephone
On the telephone, British people use this to identify themselves, and that to ask about the hearer's
identity.
Hello. This is Elisabeth. Is that Ruth?
Americans can also use this to ask about the hearer's identity. Who is this?
4
6 that, those meaning 'the one (s)'
In a formal style, that and those can be used with a following description to mean 'the one(s)'. Those
who... means 'the people who ...'
A dog's intelligence is much greater than that of a cat.
Those who can, do. Those who can't, teach.
7 this and that meaning 'so'
In an informal style, this and that are often used with adjectives and adverbs in the same way as so.
I didn 't realise it was going to be this hot. If it goes on raining this hard, we'll have to swim to work. If your
boyfriend's that clever, why isn 't he rich ? In standard English, only so is used before a following clause. It
was so cold that I couldn't/eel my fingers.
(NOT It was that cold that...) Not all that can be used to mean 'not very'. 'How was the play?' 'Notall that
good.'
page 590
8 other uses
Note the special use of this (with no demonstrative meaning) in conversational story-telling.
There was this travelling salesman, you see. And he wanted... That/those can suggest that an experience
is familiar to everybody.
/ can't stand that perfume of hers. This use is common in advertisements.
When you get that empty feeling - break for a biscuit.
The perfect hobby for those long winter evenings - astrology. Send for our free brochure...
The differences between this and that are similar to the differences between here and there
(see 248), come and go (see 134) and bring and take (see 112). For this one, that one etc, see 391. For
these and those with singular kind of, sort of, see 526. For that which, see 476.5. For the difference
between this/that and it, see 566.
~.^ ^••; -, -^
566 this/that and it in discourse
This, that and it can all be used to refer back to things that have been talked or written about earlier. The
differences between them are not well understood, but the following suggestions may be useful.
1 things mentioned
All three words can be used in the sense of 'the thing or situation I have just mentioned'.
It does not give any special emphasis to the thing or situation.
So she decided to paint her house pink. It upset the neighbours a bit. This and that are more emphatic;
they seem to suggest 'an interesting new fact has been mentioned'.
So she decided to paint her house pink. This/That really upset the
neighbours, as you can imagine.
This seems to be preferred when the speaker has more to say about a new subject of discussion.
So she decided to paint her house pink. This upset the neighbours so much
that they took her to court, believe it or not. The case came up last week.. Then in 1917 he met Andrew
Lewis. This was a turning point in his career:
the two men entered into a partnership which lasted until 1946, and... (More natural than... That was a
turning point...)
2 last thing mentioned
When more than one thing has been mentioned, it generally refers to the main subject of discussion; this
and that generally select the last thing mentioned. Compare:
We keep the ice-cream machine in the spare room. It is mainly used by the
children, incidentally. (The machine is used by the children.) We keep the ice-cream machine in the spare
room. This/That is mainly used by the children, incidentally. (The spare room is used by the children.) >
page 591


3 focus
It is only used to refer to things which are 'in focus' - which have already been talked about. This can be
used to 'bring things into focus' before anything has been said about them. Compare:
I enjoyed 'Vampires'Picnic'. It/This is a film for all the family... VAMPIRES' PICNIC: This is a film for all the
family...
(NOT -VAMPIRES'PICNIC: It is a film for all the family...)
, 4 referring forward
Only this can refer forward to something that has not yet been mentioned. Now what do you think about
this? I thought I'd get a job in Spain for six months, and then... (NOT Now what do you think about
that/it...)
For more about this and that and the differences between them, see 565. For more about it, see 424.
S7 through (time)
In American English, through can be used in time expressions to mean 'up to and including'.
The park is open from May through September. In British English, through is not used in this way. When it
is necessary to be precise, British people generally use to... inclusive, or structures like until the end of...
The park is open from May to September inclusive. OR... from May until the end of September.
8 time
1 countability and article use
Time has various uses, some countable and some uncountable (for full details see a good dictionary).
Most of these are straightforward, but there are problems in two areas.
a measure of duration
When we talk about the number of hours, days etc that are needed to
complete something, time is generally uncountable. How much time do we need to load the van? It took
quite some time to persuade her to talk to us. Don't worry - there's plenty of time. This is a complete waste
of time.
However, time is countable in certain expressions like a long/short time and
quite a time.
I took a long time to get to sleep. She was away for quite a time-The time can be used to mean 'enough
time'; the is often dropped. Just come with me -1 haven't got (the) time to explain.

2
3
clock times
When we talk about clock times, time is countable.
Six o'clock would be a good time to meet.
She phoned me at various times yesterday. However, the is dropped in the expression it's time.
It's time to stop. (NOT It's the time to stop.)
I'm hungry. It's time for a little something.
For the use of take with expressions of time, see 551.
without preposition
Prepositions are often dropped before common expressions with time meaning 'occasion'.
He's busy. Why don't you come another time? (More natural than. ..at another time.)
What time does the match start?
(More natural than At what time...?)
You won't fool me this time.
In relative structures after time, that is often used instead of when in an informal style (or dropped).
Do you remember the time (that) Freddy pretended to be a ghost?
You can come up and see me any time (that) you like.
The first time (that) I saw her, my heart stopped.
For similar structures with other time words, and with place, way and reason, see 477.3.
on time and in time
On time means 'at the planned time', 'neither late nor early'. The opposite is 'early' or 'late'. It is often used
to refer to timetabled events.
Only one of the last six trains has been on time. (NOT ... in time.}
Peterwants the discussion to start exactly on time. (NOT ... in time.) In time means 'with enough time to
spare', 'before the last moment'. The opposite is too late.
We arrived in time to get good seats.
(NOT Wo arrived on time to get good scats.}
He would have died if they hadn't got him to hospital in time. (NOT ... got him to hospital on time.)
I nearly drove into the car in front, but I stopped just in time.
For structures after It's time, see 304.
For ways of telling the time, see 555.
For by the time, see 118.
For tenses with this is the first time... and similar structures, see 419.7.
For this is the last time etc, see 307.5.
569 tonight
Tonight refers to the present or coming night, not to the past night (last night). Compare:
/ had a terrible dream last night. (NOT I had a terrible dream tonight.)
I hope I sleep better tonight.
page
592
page 593


570 too
1 structures
We can use an infinitive stmcture after too + adjective/adverb/detenniner He's too old to work.
It's far too cold to play tennis. We arrived too late to have dinner. There was too much snow to go walking.
tfthe infinitive has its own subject, this is introduced by for (see 280). It's too late for the pubs to be open.
The runway's too short for planes to land. There was too much snow for us to go walking. The subject of a
sentence with too can also be the object of the following
infinitive. (For more about this structure, see 285.4.) Object pronouns are not normally used after the
infinitive in this case.
The water is too salty to drink. (NOT ^fhe-wettw4s too salty to drink4t.) However, object pronouns are
possible in structures with/or. " The water is too salty for us to drink (it).
Note the two possible meanings of sentences like He's too stupid to teach
(= He's too stupid to be a teacher OR He's too stupid for anyone to teach - he can't be taught}.
2 modification
Expressions which modify comparatives (see 139) also modify too. much too old (NOT very too old} a little
too confident a lot too big a bit too soon far too young rather too often
3 too and too much
Before adjectives without nouns and before adverbs we use too, not
too much.
You're too kind to me. (NOT You 're too much kind to me.] I arrived too early. (NOT I arrived too much
early.)
4 other determiners
Too is not normally used before adjective + noun. I put down the bag because it was too heavy.
(NOT I put down thctoo heavy bag.) She doesn 't like men who are too tall.
(NOT -She doesn't like too tall men.) Let's forget this problem - it's too difficult.
(NOT -Let's forget this-too difficult^problem.)
In a rather formal style, too can be used before adjective + a/an + noun (see 16). Note the word order.
It's too cold a day to go out.

5 too and very
Too is different from very- too means 'more than enough', 'more than necessary' or 'more than is wanted'.
Compare:
- He's a very intelligent child.
He's too intelligent for his class - he's not learning anything.
- It was very cold, but we went out.
It was too cold to go out, so we stayed at home. However, in informal speech too can sometimes be used
to mean 'very'.
Oh, that's really too kind of you - thank you so much.
I'm not feeling too well.
The expression only too is used to mean 'very', 'extremely'. It is common in formal offers and invitations.
We shall be only too pleased if you can spend a few days with us.
For more about too much, see 571. For too meaning 'also', see 45.
571 too much and too many
1 the difference
The difference between too much and too many is the same as the difference between much and many.
Too much is used with singular (uncountable) nouns; too many is used with plurals.
You put too much salt in the soup.
I've had too many late nights recently. (NOT ... too much late nights...)
For more details of the use of much and many, see 348.
2 modification
Expressions which modify comparatives and too (see 139) can also modify too much and too many.
She's wearing a bit too much make-up for my taste.
I've been to rather too many parties recently. However, much too many is unusual.
You ask far too many questions. (NOT ... much too many questions.)
3 too much/many without a noun
We can drop a noun after too much/many, if the meaning is clear. You've eaten too much. 'Did you get
any answers to your advertisement?"Too many.'
For too and too much, see 570.3 For structures like too much of an effort, see 154.
572 travel, journey, trip and voyage
Travel means 'travelling in general'. It is normally uncountable.
My interests are music and travel. >
page
594
page 595


me piural form travels is sometimes used for a long tour in which several places are visited.
Did you meet anybody interesting on your travels? 'Travels with a Donkey' (book by R L Stevenson) K
journey (mainly British English) is one 'piece' of travelling.
Did you have a good journey7 (NOT -Btdyeu^havc a good travel?)
A trip is a return journey together with the activity which is the reason for th journey.
I'm going on a business trip next week.
(= I'm going on a journey and I'm going to do some business.) Compare;
'How was your journey?' 'The train broke down.' 'How was your trip?' 'Successful.'
We do not so often use trip for expeditions which have a very serious purpose, are very hard and / or take
a very long time.
In 1863 the President travelled to Dakota to make peace with the Indians (NOT ... made a trip-te-Daketa
to make peace...)
Amundsen made his journey to the South Pole in 1911.
(NOT Amundsen made his-trip-to the South Pole...) A long sea journey is often called a voyage.
573 turning verbs into nouns
1 using nouns for actions
It is very common to refer to an action by using a noun instead of a verb. Nouns of this kind often have the
same form as the related verbs. The structure is especially common in informal British English. There was
a loud crash. Did I hear a cough?
I need a wash. (GB) Let's have a talk about your plans.
Let your sister have a go on the swing, (informal GB) Just take a look at yourself. What about a drink?
Would you like a taste? Come on - one more try!
common structures
Nouns of this kind are often introduced by 'general-purpose' verbs such as have, take, give, make, go for.
I'll have a think and let you know what I decide, (informal GB)
Hike to take a bath before I go to bed. (especially US - see 551.4) I fit won't start, let's give it a push.
I don't know the answer, but I'm going to make a guess. I try to go for a run every day.
We can use -ing forms in a similar way, for example after go and do. Would you like to go swimming
tomorrow?
She does a bit of painting, but she doesn 't like to show people.
For details of 'action-nouns' with have, and a list of common expressions, see 240. Forgive, see 230.
Forgo/or, see 231. Forgo.. .ing, see 232. For do.. .ing, see 164.3.
page 596
2
3 clauses ending with verbs
Clauses that end with simple tenses or infinitives of intransitive verbs can seem unnatural in English, as if
they end too suddenly. In an informal style, people often prefer to avoid this structure by using nouns for
actions. Compare:
I'd like to have a drink. (More natural than I'd like to drink.) Do you want to go swimming? (More natural
than Do you want to swim?) 'What did you do this afternoon?"! went for a walk.' (More natural than /
walked.}
574 unless
1 meaning
Unless has a similar meaning to if not, in the sense of 'except if.
Come tomorrow unless I phone. (=... if I don't phone I except if I phone.) I'll take the job unless the pay is
too low.
(= if the pay isn't too low I except if the pay is too low.) I'll be back tomorrow unless there's a plane strike.
Let's have dinner out- unlessyou're too tired. I'm going to dig the garden this afternoon, unless it rains.
2 when unless cannot be used
Unless (= 'except if) can be used instead of if not when we refer to exceptional circumstances which would
change a situation (see above examples). We do not use unless to refer to something negative that would
be the main cause of the situation that we are talking about. My wife will be very upset if I don't get back
tomorrow.
(NOT My wife will be very upset unless I got back tomorrow. If the speaker does not get back, this will be
the main cause of his wife's unhappiness - if not doesn't mean 'except if' here.) She'd look nicer if she
didn't wear so much make-up.
(NOT She'd look nicer unless she wore so much make up. If not doesn't mean 'except if here.)
I'll be surprised if he doesn't have an accident soon. (NOT I'll be surprised unless he has an accident
soon.)
3 tenses
In clauses with unless, we usually use present tenses to refer to the future. I'll be in all day unless the
office phones. (NOT ... unless the office will phone.)
For more about sentences with if, see 258-264. For more about tenses in subordinate clauses, see 556.
page 597


575 until
1 until and till
These two words can be used both as prepositions and conjunctions. Thp
mean exactly the same. Till is informal British English (in American Eneli h 'til is the preferred informal
spelling). '
OK, then, I won't expect you until/till midnight. I'll wait until/till I hear from you.
The new timetable will remain in operation until June 30.
2 until/till and to
To can sometimes be used as a preposition of time with the same meanine a until/till. This happens
afteifrom...
I usually work from nine to five. (OR .. .from nine until/till five.) We can also use to when counting the time
until a future event.
It's another three weeks to the holidays. (OR ... until/till theJiolidays.} In other cases, to is not generally
used.
I waited for her until six o 'clock, but she didn 't come. (NOT I waited for her to six o'clock...)
For American from... through, see 567.
3 place and quantity: until/till not used
Until/till is used only to talk about time. To talk about distance, we use to, as far as or up to; up to is also
used to talk about quantity. We walked as far as/up to the edge of the forest.
(NOT ... till the edge of the forest.) The minibus can hold up to thirteen people.
(NOT .. .-until-thirtccn -people.) You can earn up to L500 a week in this job.
It is sometimes possible to use until/till before a place name in the sense of 'until we get to...'.
You drive until Phoenix and then I'll take over.
4 tenses with until
Present tenses are used to refer to the future after until (see 556).
I'll wait until she gets here. (NOT ... until she will got here.) Present and past perfect tenses can
emphasise the idea of completion.
You're not going home until you've finished that report.
I waited until the rain had stopped.
5 structure with Not until...
In a literary style it is possible to begin a sentence with Not until..., using
inverted word order in the main clause (see 298).
Not until that evening was she able to recover her self-control. Not until I left home did I begin to
understand how strange my family was.
page 598
g until and by', states and actions
We use until to talk about a situation or state that will continue up to a certain moment. We use by to say
that an action or event will happen at or
before a future moment. Compare:
_ 'Can I stay until the weekend?'
'Yes, but you'll have to leave by Monday midday at the latest.'
(= at twelve on Monday or before.} - 'Can you repair my watch if I leave it until Saturday?'
'No, but we can do it by next Tuesday.' (NOT ... until next Tuesday.)
7 until and before
Not until/till can mean the same as not before. I won't be seeing Judy until/before Tuesday. And both until
and before can be used to say how far away a future event is,
It'll be ages until/before we meet again. There's only six weeks left until/before Christmas.
576 up and down
1 'towards/away from the centre'
Up and down are not only used to refer to higher and lower positions (or movements to and from these
positions). They can also refer to more or less important or central places. (Trains to London used to be
called 'up trains',
and trains from London 'down trains').
The ambassador walked slowly up the room towards the Queen's throne. She ran down the passage, out
of the front door and down the garden. We'll be going down to the country for the weekend.
But note that in the US downtown usually means' (in/to) the central
business / entertainment area'.
2 north and south
People often use up for movements towards the north, and down for movements towards the south
(perhaps because north is at the top of
a map page).
I work in London, but I have to travel up to Glasgow every few weeks.
3 'along'
Sometimes both up and down are used to mean 'along', 'further on', with
little or no difference of meaning.
The nearest post office is about half a mile up/down the road.
577 used + infinitive
1 meaning
We use used + infinitive to talk about past habits and states which are now
d to smoke...)
finished.
I used to smoke, but now I've stopped. (NOT -I-wi
That bingo hall used to be a cinema.
page 599


2 only past
Used to... has no present form (and no progressive, perfect, infinitive or -inp forms). To talk about present
habits and states, we usually just use the simple present tense (see 444).
He smokes. (NOT He uses to smoke.) Her brother still collects stamps.
3 question and negative forms
In a formal style, used to... can have the forms of a modal auxiliary verb (questions and negatives without
do), especially in British English. The modal question forms are rare.
/ used not to like opera, but now I do. (OR I used to not like opera...) Used you to play football at school?
These forms are not used in tags.
You used not to like him, did you? (NOT ... usedyou?)
In an informal style, it is more common to use ordinary question and negative forms with auxiliary do.
Did you use to play football at school?
I didn't use to like opera, but now I do. ' These forms are not often written; when they are, they are
sometimes spelt
did... used to and didn't used to; many people consider these spellings incorrect.
The contraction use(d)n 't is also occasionally used.
4 when used to... is not used
Used to refers to things that happened at an earlier stage of one's life and are now finished: there is an
idea that circumstances have changed. It is not
used simply to say what happened at a past time, or how long it took, or how many times it happened.
/ worked very hard last month. (NOT -l-usedrto work very hard last month.) I lived in Chester for three
years.
(NOT I used to live in Chester for three years.) I went to France seven times last year.
(NOT 4 used to go to France-seven times last year.)
5 word order
Mid-position adverbs (see 22-23) can go before or after used. The position before used is more common
in an informal style.
I always used to be afraid of dogs. (informal)
/ used always to be afraid of dogs. (formal)
6 pronunciation
Note the pronunciation of used /ju:st/ and use /ju;s/ in this structure.
used + infinitive and be used to.. .ing
Used + infinitive has a quite different meaning from be used to.. .ing (see
next section). Compare:
I didn't use to drive a big car.
(= Once I didn't drive a big car, but now I do.) (NOT I wasn't used to drive a big car.)
I wasn't used to driving a big car. (= Driving a big car was a new and difficult experience -1 hadn't done it
before.)
For the difference between used to and would, see 604.8.
578 (be) used to
1 meaning
If a person is used to something, it is familiar; he or she has experienced it so
much that it is no longer strange or new.
I've lived in Central London for six years now, so I'm used to the noise. At the beginning I couldn't
understand Londoners because I wasn't used to
the accent.
2 structures
Be used to can be followed by nouns or - ing forms (NOT infinitives). I'm used to driving in London now,
but it was hard at the beginning.
(NOT I'm used to drive in London-...) It was a long time before she was completely used to working with
old
people. Used is an adjective in this structure, and can be modified by adverbs such as
quite or very.
I'm quite used to her little ways.
3 get used to... ing etc
Get, become and grow can also be used before used to (... ing). You'll soon get used to living in the
country. I lived in France for six years, but I never got used to shaking hands with
people all the time.
Little by little, he became used to his new family. It took them a long time to grow used to getting up in the
middle of
the night.
4 pronunciation
Note that used is pronounced /ju;st/ in this structure.
For more about -ing forms after the preposition to, see 295.2. For the differences between get, become
and grow, see 129.
page
600
page 601


579 verb complementation: what can follow a verb?
1 different verbs, different structures
Different verbs can be followed by different kinds of word and structure. This is partly a matter of meaning:
after a verb like eat or break, for instance, it is normal to expect a noun; after try or stop, it is natural to
expect a verb. It is also partly a matter of grammatical rules that have nothing to do with meaning. Before
an object, wait is followed by the preposition/or; expect has no preposition. One can tell somebody
something, but one cannot -explain somebody something. One hopes to see somebody, but one looks
forward to seeing somebody. One advises somebody to see the doctor but one does not -suggest
somebody to sec the doctor. There are no simple rules for this kind of
problem; it is necessary to learn, for each verb, what kind of structures can J , follow it.
2 verb + object; transitive and intransitive verbs W
Some verbs are usually followed by nouns or pronouns that act as direct
objects. In grammars these verbs are called 'transitive'. Examples are invite, surprise.
Let's invite Sally and Bruce. (B u T N o T -Let's invite.) You surprised me. (BUT NOT -yeu-swprisea:)
Some verbs are not normally followed by direct objects. These are called 'intransitive'. Examples are sit,
sleep.
Do sit down. CB UT N o T -Off sit that-ehw:) I usually sleep well. (BUT NOT -She slept the baby.) Many
verbs can be both transitive and intransitive. England lost. Let's eat. England lost the match. I can't eat
this.
Some transitive verbs can be followed by two objects (indirect and direct). For details, see 583.
Send me the form when you've filled it in. I'm going to buy Sarah some flowers.
3
ergative verbs
Some verbs are used transitively and intransitively with different kinds of subject; the intransitive use has a
meaning rather like a passive (see 407) or
reflexive (see 471) verb. Modern grammarians call these verbs 'ergative'. Compare:
- She opened the door. - The wind's moving the curtain. The door opened. The curtain's moving.
- Something woke her. - I can't start the car. Suddenly she woke. The car won't start.
- Marriage has really changed her.
She's changed a lot since she got married.
- We're selling a lot of copies of your book. Your book's selling well.
For verb structures used as objects, see paragraphs 7-9 below. For structures with object complements,
see paragraph 10 below.
page 602
C1U ^UlllUldlldlLCIL"-
4 verbs with prepositions and particles
Many verbs need prepositions before their objects.
Why are you looking at me like that? (NOT Why arc you looking me ...?) I'd like you to listen to this. (NOT
... to listen this:) Let's talk about your plans. (NOT -Let's talk your plans.)
The preposition is dropped when there is no object.
Look! (NOT -Look at!) Other verbs are used with adverb particles. Some of these combinations are
transitive; others are intransitive.
We'll have to put off our visit to Scotland. It's time to get up.
For more about two-part verbs like these, see 582.
5 complements of place
Usually, a preposition is necessary before an expression of place.
She arrived at the station last night. (NOT -She-arrived the station...)
Don't walk on the grass. (NOT Don't walk the grass.) A few verbs can be used with direct objects referring
to place.
I like climbing mountains. (NOT I like climbing on mountains.) Some verbs are incomplete without an
expression of place. • He lives in York. (BUT NOT He lives.)
She got off the bus. (BUT NOT Shogot.)
For information about the position of place and other adverbials, see 23.
6 copular verbs
Some verbs are followed not by an object, but by a subject complement -an expression which describes
the subject. These are called 'copular verbs'.
For details, see 147.
Your room is a mess. That looks nice. The toilets are upstairs. I felt a complete idiot.
7 verb + verb structures: auxiliaries
Many verbs can be followed by forms of other verbs. Auxiliary verbs are used with other verbs to make
questions and negatives, progressive forms, perfect forms, and passives. For details, see 84.
Do you want some tea?
It doesn't matter.
Is it raining?
Where have you been?
These are made in France.
Modal auxiliary verbs are used with other verbs to add ideas such as certainty, probability, futurity,
permission and obligation. For details, see
344-345.
You must be tired.
The car may need a new engine.
The lecture will start at ten.
Can I borrow your paper?
We ought to invite the Maxwells this weekend. ^
page 603


8 verb + verb structures: other verbs
Many verbs besides auxiliaries can be followed by forms of other verbs (or bv structures including other
verbs). This can happen, for example, if we talk about our attitude to an action: the first verb describes the
attitude and the
second refers to the action. The second verb structure is often rather like the direct object of the first verb.
/ enjoy playing cards. I hope to see you soon. I saw that she was crying.
Different structures are possible, depending on the particular verb. Some verbs can be followed by
infinitives (with or without to), some verbs can be followed by -ing forms, some by past participles, and
some by clauses. Many verbs can be followed by two or more of these structures, often with a
difference of meaning or use. For each verb, it is necessary to know which structures are possible.
We seem to have a problem. (NOT We seem having-a problem.) Can I help wash up?
It's not very easy to stop smoking. (NOT .. .-te-step-h Did you see that the police station got burnt down?
J siifrv^t1* /*--- -
fke.)
,, .-..^^^^^wngui.vu.rniaown!'
I suggest that you see a solicitor. OR I suggest seeing a solicitof. (NOT I suggest you to sec a solicitor:)
In some cases, the first verb does not really say what the subject does -
it simply gives more information about the action which the second verb refers to.
I happened to see Alice the other day. Now he's getting older he tends to forget things.
We're starting to get invited to some of the neighbours'parties. .,,; My keys seem to have disappeared.
It is possible to have 'chains' of verbs following each other.
/ keep forgetting to go shopping. Don't let me stop you working. He seems to be trying to sit up.
I don't want to have to get her to start telling lies.
For more about verbs followed by infinitives, see 283-284. For verbs followed by 'i/igtoti see 293. For it as
a preparatory subject, see 301.
See the Index for problems with the structures after some common verbs. For information about other
verbs, see a good dictionary.
9 verb + object + verb structure
Many verbs can be followed by an object as well as a verb structure. Can I help you wash up? I'd like you
to meet Sally.
We all want you to be happy. (NOT -We-aH want that you arc happy:
We've got to stop him makingafool of himself. When are you going to get the clock repaired? Nobody told
me that you were here.
For more about verb + object + infinitive, see 284. For structures with object + -ingform, see 293.
10 verb + object + complement
Some transitive verbs can be followed by an object together with an object complement (an expression
that gives more information about the object). For details, see 580.
You make me nervous.
Let's paint it blue.
That cat regards Bill as his father.
The police believe him to be dangerous.
11 short verbs without complements
A short verb form without any kind of following complement can sometimes sound unnatural in English,
and structures like this are avoided in some cases.
Let's go swimming. (More natural than Let's swim.)
I Why don't you go shopping? (More natural than Why don 'tyoushop?) I think I'll have a shower. (More
natural than / think Til shower.)
For more about structures like these, see 573.3. For the structures that are possible after a particular verb,
see a good dictionary.
580 verb + object + complement
1 adjective and noun complements
Some transitive verbs can be followed by an object together with an object complement (an expression
that gives more information about the object). This is often an adjective or noun phrase.
You make me nervous.
She's driving us crazy.
Let's cut it short.
I find her attitude strange.
Don't call me a liar.
I don't know why they elected him President.
'Would you like to join the committee?' 'twould consider it an honour.'
2 structures with as
After some verbs, an object complement is introduced by as. This is common when we say how we see or
describe somebody/something.
I see you as a basically kind person.
She described her attacker as a tall dark man with a beard.
His mother regards him as a genius.
After tests, they identified the metal as gold. The structure is also possible with as being.
The police do not regard him as being dangerous. >
page 604
page 605


3 verbs of thinking and feeling
Some verbs that refer to thoughts, feelings and opinions (e.g. believe, consider, feel, know, find, think,
understand) can be followed by object +
infinitive (usually to be) in a formal style. In an informal style, that-clauses are more common.
/ considered him to be an excellent choice.
(Less formal: [considered that he was...) We supposed them to be married.
(Less formal: We supposed that they were...) They believed her to be reliable. This structure is very
unusual with think. I thought that she was mistaken.
(More natural than I thought her to be mistaken.)
After believe, consider, find and think, it is often possible to drop to be before adjectives, and sometimes
(especially with consider) before nouns. We found her delightful. I considered him an excellent choice.
Passive forms of these structures may be less formal than active forms (see paragraph 5 below).
For more details of structures with/erf, see 208; for know, see 306; for think, see 564.
4 structures with preparatory it
When the object of a verb is a clause, infinitive structure or -ing structure, and there is an object
complement, it is common to use it as a preparatory object.
He thought it strange that she had not written.
(More natural than He thought that she had not written strange.) The government regard it as necessary to
raise taxes. We found it impossible to understand her. She felt it necessary to put her views in writing. He
considered it his duty to call the police. I found it interesting being back at school again.
5 passive structures
Passive versions of these structures are common. It was painted blue.
He was elected President. ' Her attacker was described as a tall man with a beard. The metal was
identified as gold. He is not regarded as being dangerous. For a long time he was thought to be a spy.
She was believed to belong to a revolutionary organisation. Seven people are understood to have been
injured in the explosion. It was considered impossible to change the date.
For more about the structures that can follow verbs, see 579. For the structures that are possible after a
particular verb, see a good dictionary.
page
606
581 verbs of movement
When we want to talk about a movement, its direction and its nature, there are various ways of doing this.
We can use three separate words for the three
ideas:
She came out dancing.
We can use a verb which includes the idea of direction, and describe, the
nature of the movement separately:
She entered dancing. Or we can use a verb which makes clear the nature of the movement, and
describe the direction separately: ,
She danced in.
In English, the third of these solutions is the most common.
She danced across the garden.
(More natural than She crossed the garden dancing.)
I jumped down the stairs.
(More natural than I came down the stairs jumping.)
He ran into the room.
(More natural than He entered the room running.)
They crawled out of the cellar.
(More natural than They left the cellar crawling.)
We flew past Mont Blanc.
(More natural than We passed Mont Blanc flying.)
582
verbs with prepositions and particles
1 two-word verbs
Many English verbs can be followed by prepositions or adverb particles
(for the difference, see 19).
Alan walked down the road without looking at anybody.
Do sit down.
Some verbs and prepositions / particles are regularly used together: for
example look at, listen to, stand up, switch off. These combinations are rather like two-word verbs. They
are often called 'phrasal verbs' in grammars. The meaning of a two-word verb is sometimes very different
from the meanings of the two parts taken separately. Could you look after the kids while I'm out?
(Look after is not the same as look + after.) We had to put off the meeting till Tuesday. (Put off is not the
same as put + off.)
2 verbs with prepositions and particles together
Some verbs can be used with both an adverb particle and a preposition.
I get on with her quite well. If you're on the road on Saturday night, look out for drunk drivers.
page 607


" nui u uraer with objects
Prepositions and particles do not always go in the same place in clauses with objects. Prepositions
normally go before objects.
He fell off the bridge. (NOT He fell thc^bridge off.)
Particles can go before or after noun objects.
She switched off the light. OR She switched the light off. But particles can only go after pronoun objects.
She switched it off. (NOT -She switched off it.) Is that the light which you switched off? (NOT ... the light
off which you switched?)
Give me back my watch. OR Give me my watch back. (NOT Give back me my watch.)
4 objects at the beginning of clauses
When an object comes at the beginning of a clause (e.g. in a question or relative clause), a two-word verb
usually stays together, so that a preposition
can be separated from its object and go at the end of the clause. For details of this and other preposition-
final structures, see 440.
What are you thinking about? (NOT About what arc you thinking?) I've found the book which I was
looking/or.
(More natural in an informal style than... the book for which I was looking.)
5
stress
At the end of a clause, a preposition is usually unstressed, while an particle is usually stressed. Comnarp-
rm
.-..^^ la usually stressed. Compare:
They were 'called on. (preposition) They were called 'up. (particle)
adverb
For details of particular two-word verbs, see the Ox ford Dictionary of Phrasal Verbs Volume 1, or the
Longman Dictionary of Phrasal Verbs.
583 verbs with two objects
I indirect and direct objects
Many verbs can be followed by two objects - one indirect and one direct. Usually the indirect object refers
to a person, and comes first.
He gave his wife a camera for Christmas.
Could you send me the bill?
I'll lend you some.
I wish you a Merry Christmas.
Let me make you some tea.
Some common verbs which are used like this:
bring leave pass refuse buy lend pay send cost make play
offer promise owe read
get give
show
sing
take
teach
tell
wish
write
page 608
2 indirect object last
We can also put the indirect object after the direct object. In this case it normally has a preposition (usually
to or/or).
I handed my licence to the policeman.
Mrs Norman sent some flowers to the nurse who was looking after her daughter.
Mother bought the ice-cream for you, not for me.
3 two pronouns
When both objects are pronouns, it is common to put the indirect object last. To is occasionally dropped
after it in informal British English.
Lend them to her.
Send some to him.
Give it (to) me. It is also possible to put the indirect object first.
Give her one.
Send him some.
However, this structure is avoided in some cases: phrases ending with it or them (e.g. He gave you it or
Send them them) are often felt to be unnatural.
4 wfc-questions
Prepositions are used in irh-questions referring to the indirect object. Who did you buy it for? (NOT Who
did you buy it?) Who was it sent to? (NOT -Whe-was it sent?)
5 passives
When these verbs are used in passive structures, the subject is usually the person who receives
something, not the thing which is sent, given etc. In this case the prepositions to and for are not used. I've
just been given a lovely picture.
(NOT I've just been given a lovely picture to.) We were all bought little presents.
(NOT We wore all bought little presents for.) Mr Fairfax was paid L300 last month. Write is not normally
used in this structure.
(NOT USUALLY I was written a letter.)
The thing which is given, sent etc can be the subject if necessary. A preposition is most often used before
the indirect object in this case. 'What happened to the stuff he left behind?' 'Well, the picture was given to
MrFerguson.'
6 structures with explain, suggest and describe
We do not generally use explain, suggest or describe with the structure indirect object + direct object.
I'd like him to explain his decision to us.
(NOT ... to explain us his decision.) Can you suggest a good dentist to me?
(NOT Can you suggest me a good dentist?) Please describe your wife to us. (N o T Please describe us
your wife.) >
page 609


/ one ooject or two
Some verbs can be followed by either a direct object, or an indirect object, or both.
I asked John.
I asked a question.
I asked John a question.
Other verbs like this include teach, tell, pay, show, sing, play and write. Note
that when sing, play and write have no direct object, we put to before the indirect object. Compare:
- Sing her a song.
Sing to her. (NOT -Sing her.)
- Write me a letter.
Write to me when you get home.
(More common than Write me... in standard British English.)
For structures with object complements (e.g. They made him captain), see 580.
584 wait
Wait can be followed by an infinitive.
I'll wait to hear from you before I do anything. Before a direct object, wait for is used.
Please wait for me here. (NOT Please wait me here.)
That-clauses are not used after wait, but an object + infinitive structure is possible.
We'll have to wait for the photos to be ready. (NOT ... wait that the photos are ready.)
The time prepositionyfar is often dropped after wait. I waited (for) a very long time for her answer.
The transitive verb await is formal, and is used with abstract objects. We're still awaiting instructions.
For the difference between wait for and expect, see 202.
585 want
1 infinitive with to
After want, we normally use an infinitive with to. I don't want to come back here ever again. (NOT 4-
den'twantfome back...)
That-clauses are not normally used after want, but an object + infinitive
structure is possible. '
Do you want me to make you some coffee?
(NOT Do you want (that) I make you some coffee?) I don't want that woman to come here ever again. I
want you to be my wife.
page
610
2
3
4
structure with object complement
Want can be followed by an object together with a complement (adjective, adverb or past participle) to
express ideas such as change or result.
They wanted him dead. She doesn 't want him back.
I want her out of there now. We want the job finished by Tuesday.
Do you want your grass cut? To be or as is used before a noun complement.
I want you to be my friend. (OR I want you as my friend.) (NOT I want you my friend.)
want meaning 'need'
In informal British English, want is often used to mean 'need', particularly with reference to actions.
That car wants a clean. Your hair wants a good brush. In this case, want can be followed by an -ing form.
This coat wants cleaning. (=... needs to be cleaned.)
The grass wants cutting.
politeness
Want is not used in polite expressions of wishes.
Would you like some help? (NOT Wouldyou want some help?)
Need can be used in the same way. See 357.
For other verbs followed by object + infinitive, see 284.
For to used instead of a whole infinitive (e.g. I don't want to, thanks), see 186.
For want and will, see 600.7.
586 -ward(s)
Backward(s), forward(s), northward(s), outward(s) and similar words can be used as adjectives or
adverbs.
1 adjectives
When they are used as adjectives, they do not have -s. This country is very backward in some ways.
You're notallowed to make a forward pass in rugby. He was last seen driving in a northward direction.
2 adverbs
When these words are adverbs, they can generally be used with or without -s. The forms with -s are
probably more common in British English, and the forms without -s in American English.
Why are you moving backward(s) andforward(s)?
If we keep going upward(s) we must get to the top.
Let's start driving homeward(s).
In figurative expressions such as look forward to, bring forward, put forward, the form without -s is always
used.
I look forward to hearing from you.
She put forward a very interesting suggestion.
page
611


587 way
'"""" iHr
Towards is normally used in British English; toward is more common in
American English. Afterwards is normal in British English; both afterward and afterwards are used in
American English.
1 preposition dropped
Way can mean 'method', 'manner' or 'route', 'road'. In an informal style,
we usually drop the prepositions in or by before common expressions with either meaning.
You 're doing it (in) the wrong way. You don't put in the cassette that way. Do it (in) any way you like.
Come this """'
^ --./ WWJ yuu Itim.
Come this way. We went there the usual way. .1 • •
2 relative structures
In informal relative structures, that is often used instead of in which or by which after way. That can also
be dropped.
I don't like the way (that) you talk to me.
The way (that) they organised the meeting was completely crazy. Let's go the way (that) we went
yesterday.
3 infinitive or -ing
After way (meaning 'method'/ 'manner') we can use an infinitive structure or of.. .ing. There is no important
difference between the two structures. There's no way to prove / of proving that he was stealing.
4 way of and means of
Way of is unusual before a noun. We use means ofoi method of instead. We tried all possible means of
communication, but we couldn 'tget in
touch with him. (NOT ... ways of communication...) The 19th century saw a revolution in methods of
transport.
(NOT U^CIW of tTCtVi^YffWt^
5 in the way and on the way
These expressions are quite different. In the/my/etc way is used for obstacles -things that stop people
getting where they want to.
/ can 'tget the car out because those boxes are in the way. Please don't stand in the kitchen door-you're in
my way.
On the/'myetc way means 'during the journey/movement' or 'coming'. Spring is on the way.
She's got five children, and another one on the way. We'll have lunch on our way. Close the door on your
way out.
For by the way, see 159.8.
page 612
588 weak and strong forms
1 What are weak and strong forms?
Some English words have two pronunciations: one is used when they are stressed, and the other when
they are not. Compare:
What are you looking at I setl ?
I'm looking at i'at/ you.
Most of these words are prepositions, pronouns, conjunctions, articles and auxiliary verbs. Such words are
not usually stressed, so the unstressed ('weak') pronunciation is the normal one. This usually has the
vowel /a/ or no vowel; a few weak forms are pronounced with III. The 'strong' pronunciation has the vowel
that corresponds to the spelling. Compare:
- I was /waz/ late. It was /waz/ raining. Yes, it was /WDZ/. (stressed at end of sentence)
- I must /mas/ go now.
I really must ImAst/ stop smoking, (stressed for emphasis)
- Where have /av/ you been?
You might have /av/ told me.
What did you have /haev/ for breakfast? (non-auxiliary verb) Contracted negatives always have a strong
pronunciation.
can't /ko:nt/ mustn't /'mAsnt/ wasn't /'wnznt/
2 list of words with weak and strong forms
The most important words which have weak and strong forms are:
a
am
an
and
are
as
at
be
been
but
can
could
do
does
for
from
had
has
have
he
her
him
his
Weak form
/a/
/(a)m/
/an/
/(a)n(d)/
/a(r)/
/az/
/at/
/bi/
/bin/
/bat/
/k(a)n/
/kad/
/d(a)/
/daz/
/fa(r)/
/fram/
/(h)ad/
/(h)az/
/(h)av/
/(h)i/
/(h)a(r)/
/(h)im/
/(h)iz/
Strong form
/ei/ (unusual)
/aem/
/aen/ (unusual)
/send/
/a:(r)/
IXT.I
/aet/
/bi:/
/bi:n/
/bAt/
/kaen/
/kud/
/du:/
/dAZ/
/fo:(r)/
/from/
/haed/
/heez/
/haev/
/hi:/
/h3;(r)/
/him/
/hiz/
page 613


is
must
not
of
our
Saint
shall
she
should
sir
some (see 521)
than
that (conj.)
the
them
there (see 562)
to
us
was
we
were
who
would
will
you
your
Weak form

Strong form

/z,s/

/IZ/

/m(a)s(t)/

/mAst/

/nt/

/nDt/

/av/

/DV/

/a:(r)/

/aua(r)/

/s(a)nt/ (GB only)

/semt/

/J-(B)1/

/Jael/

/;!/

/fi:/

/f(a)d/

/J"ud/

/sa(r)/

/S3:(r)/

/s(a)m/

/sAm/

/o(a)n/

/oaen/ (rare)

/o(a)t/

/Qaet/

/oa, Qi/

/oi:/

/o(a)m/

/oem/

/53(r)/

/oea(r)/

/t3/

/tu:/

/as/

/AS/

/w(a)z/

/woz/

/WI/

/wi:/

/wa(r)/

/w3:(r)/

/hu/

/hu:/

/wad/ad/

/wud/

/(a)l/

/wil/

/JU/

/ju:/

/ja(r)/

/p;(r)/

589 well
well and good
Well and good can have similar meanings, but in this case well is an adverb, while good is an adjective.
Compare:
- The car runs well. (adverb modifying runs) (NOT The car runs good.) It's a well-made car. (adverb
modifying made) It's a good car. (adjective modifying car)
- He teaches very well.
Hike that teacher. He's good. (NOT He's well.)
- She speaks English well. (NOT She speaks English good.) She speaks good English. Her English is
good.
Note that we cannot say She speaks well English. (Adverbs cannot usually go between the verb and the
object - see 22.)
well = 'in good health'
There is also an adjective well, meaning 'in good health'. 'How are you?' 'Quite well, thanks.' I don't feel
very well. •"
page 614
Note that the adjective well is only used to talk about health. Compare:
When I'm in the mountains I am always well. When I'm with you I'm happy. (NOT When I'm with you I'm
well.)
Well is not common before a noun in British English. We can say She's well,
but it is less usual to say, for example, She's a well girl.
For ill and sick, see 266.
For well as a discourse marker, see 159.16,17,20.
For more complete information about uses of well, see a good dictionary.
590 when and if
A person who says when (referring to the future) is sure that something will happen. A person who says if
is unsure whether it will happen or not.
Compare:
I'll see you at Christmas when we're all at Sally's place.
(We are certain to be at Sally's place.) I'll see you in August if I come to New York.
(Perhaps I'll come to New York, perhaps not.)
To talk about repeated, predictable situations and events (in the sense of 'whenever'), both when and if
can be used with little difference of meaning. When/If you heat ice it turns to water. When/If I'm in
Liverpool I usually stay with my sister.
For past perfect with when, see 421.5; for future reference, see 556. For when in relative clauses, see
143.3.
591 where (to)
To is often dropped in questions after where.
Where are you going (to) ? Where does this road lead (to) ? Where do you want me to take these files
(to)? , . . •
To is not normally dropped in the short question Where to? 'Could you send this off for me?' 'Where to?'
For where in relative clauses, see 473.3.
592 whether... or...
We can use whether ...or... as a double conjunction, with a similar
meaning to It doesn't matter whether ...or... I Whether we go by bus or train, it'll take at least six hours. |
We'll have to pay the same for the hotel room, whether we leave today or
stay till the end of the week. When the second part of the structure is negative there are several
possibilities.
Whether you like it or not,... Whether or not you like it,...
Whether you like it or whether you don't,...
For whether and if, see 593.
page 615


ays wnether and if
1 indirect questions
We can generally use both whether and ;/to introduce indir questions.
I'm not sure whether/if I'll have time. I asked whether/if she had any letters for me. After some verbs,
whether is preferred to if.
We discussed whether we should close the shop. (More normal than We discussed if...)
In a formal style, whether is usually preferred in a two-part question with or
Let me know whether you can come or not. (... if you can come or not is also possible.)
The Directors have not decided whether they will recommend a dividend or reinvest the profits.
If an indirect question is fronted (see 217), whether is used. Whether I'll have time I'm not sure at the
moment.
2 not used in echo questions
Jfand whether are not normally used in 'echo questions' (see 463.2). 'Are you happy?' 'Am I happy? No!'
(NOT '... If/WhetherI'm happy?...')
3 prepositions
After prepositions, only whether is possible.
There was a big argument about whether we should move to a new house. (NOT .. .-abeut-ifwe-should
move...)
I haven't settled the question of whether I'll go back home. (NOT ... question of if...)
For cases when prepositions can be dropped before conjunctions,
4 infinitives
Whether, but not if, is used before to-infinitives.
They can't decide whether to get married now or wait. (NOT -They-ean 't decide if to get married...)
5 subject, complement and adverbial clauses
When a question-word clause is a subject or complement, whether is normally preferred.
Whether we can stay with my mother is another matter, (subject) The question is whether the man can be
trusted, (complement) If is sometimes possible in a very informal style. The question is if the man can be
trusted. Whether you like it or not, I'm staying here.
, see 441.
594 which, what and who: question words
1 which and what, the difference
Which and what are often both possible, with little difference of meaning.
Which/What is the hottest city in the world?
Which/What train did you come on?
Which/What people have influenced you most in your life? Which is preferred when the speaker has a
limited number of choices in
mind.
We've got white or brown bread. Which will you have? ?y, ,' (More natural than... What willyou have?)
Which size do you want - small, medium or large? When the speaker is not thinking of a limited number of
choices, what is
used.
What language do they speak in Greenland?
(More natural than Which language...) What's your phone number? (NOT Which is your phone number?)
2 determiners: which and what
Before nouns, which and what can be used to ask questions about both things and people.
Which teacher do you like best?
Which colour do you want-green, red, yellow or brown?
What writers do you like?
What colour are your baby's eyes?
3 which of
Before another determiner (e.g. the, my, these) or a pronoun, we use which of. Who and what are not
normally used with of like this in modem English.
Which of your teachers do you like best?
(NOT -Who/What ofyour teachers...) Which of us is going to do the washing up? (NOT Who of us...?)
Which of these coats is yours? (NOT -What ofthese... ?)
4 without nouns: who, which and what
When these words are used as pronouns, without nouns immediately after them, we generally use who,
not which, for people.
Who wan-Smith or Fitzgibbon? (NOT Which won...?)
Who are you going out with - Lesley or Maria? However, which can be used in questions about people's
identity, and what can be used to ask about people's jobs and functions.
'Which is your husband?' 'The one in jeans.'
'So Janet's the Managing Director. What's Peter?' 'He is the Company
Secretary.' And which is sometimes used instead of who in questions about classes
of people.
Which is more valuable to society - a politician or a nurse? ^
page 616
page 617


Which and what can both be used to ask about things (for the difference see above).
Which do you prefer - electric cookers or gas? What have you got in your pockets?
For the difference between who and whom, see 425.4-6.
For relative who and which, see 473. For relative what, see 476.
For singular and plural verbs after who and what, see 509.3.
For the grammar of clauses beginning with question words, see 460.
who ever, what ever etc
These expressions are used to show surprise or difficulty in believing something.
Who ever is that strange girl with Roger?
What ever are you doing?
How ever did you manage to start the car? Icouldn't.
How ever many people have you invited?
When ever will I have time to write some letters?
Why ever did I marry you?
The expressions can also be written as single words: whoever, whatever etc. Note that whose and which
are not used with ever in this way.
In an informal style, on earth can be used instead of ever.
Who on earth is that strange girl?
How on earth did you manage to start the car? Note that 071 earth is not used with longer question-word
expressions.
NOT 4iow-lmiirnn anrth i<- thif "^ng to take? OR How on earth long... ?
NOT HOW It
For whoever etc, see 596. For more about ever, see 197.
th iv fh]
i/iii u i/m
whoever, whatever etc
meaning and use
The words whoever, whatever, whichever, however, whenever and wherever have similar meanings to'it
doesn't matter who/what/which etc', 'any person who' / 'any thing that' etc, or 'the unknown person who' /
'the unknown thing that' etc.
A word of this kind has a double function, like a relative pronoun or adverb (see 473): it acts as a subject,
object or adverb in its own clause, but it also acts as a conjunction, joining its clause to the rest of the
sentence.
Whoever comes to the door, tell them I'm out.
Whoever phoned just now was very polite.
I'm not opening the door, whoever you are.
Send it to whoever pays the bills.
Whatever you do, I'll always love you.
Whatever is in that box is making a very funny noise.
page
618
Keep calm, whatever happens. Spend the money on whatever you like. Whichever of them you marry,
you'll have problems. We're free all next week. You'll be welcome whichever day you come. However
much he eats, he never gets fat. People always want more, however rich they are. However you travel, it'll
take you at least three days. Whenever I go to London I try to see Vicky. You can come whenever you
like. Wherever you go, you'll find Coca-Cola. The people were friendly wherever we went.
2 whoever, whichever and whatever: subjects and objects
Whoever, whichever and whatever can be the subjects or objects of the verbs in their clauses. (Note that
whomever is not used in modern English.) Whoever directed this film, it's not much good. (subject)
Whoever you marry, make sure he can cook. (object) Whatever you say, I don't think he's the right man
for you. (object) Whichever and whatever can also go with nouns as determiners. Note the
word order when they go with objects.
Whichever room you use, make sure you clean it up afterwards. Whatever problems you have, you can
always come to me for help. If you change your mind for whatever reason, just let me know.
3 clauses as subjects or objects
A clause with whoever, whichever and whatever can be the subject or object
of the verb in the other clause. Whoever told you that was lying. I'll marry whoever I like. Whatever you
want is fine with me. Prisoners have to eat whatever they're given. Whichever climber gets to the top first
will get a L5,000 prize. I'll take whichever tent you're not using.
4 whenever = 'every time that'
Whenever can suggest repetition, in the sense of 'every time that'.
Whenever I see you I feel nervous. I stay with Monica whenever I go to London.
5 whoever etc... may
May can be used after some of these words to suggest ignorance or
uncertainty.
He's written a book on the philosopher Matilda Vidmi, whoever she may be.
She's just written to me from Llandyfrdwy, wherever that may be. >
page 619


6 leaving out the verb
In a clause like whatever his problems may be, where whatever is the
complement of the verb be, it is possible to leave out the verb. This happens mostly with whatever and
however. Examples:
Whatever his problems, he has no right to behave like that.
A serious illness, whatever its nature, is almost always painful.
A grammar rule, however true, is useless unless it can be understood.
7 informal uses
In an informal style, these conjunctions are sometimes used as short answers.
'When shall we start?' 'Whenever.' (= 'Whenever you like.') 'Potatoes or rice?"Whichever.' (= 'I don't mind.')
Whatever can mean 'or anything else'.
Would you like some orange juice or a beer or whatever? If you play football or tennis or whatever, it does
take up a lot of time.
8 whatever meaning 'at all'
After any and no, whatever can be used to mean 'at all'. Don 'tyou have any regrets whatever? I can see
no point whatever in buying it.
In a formal style, whatsoever is sometimes used as an emphatic form of whatever in this structure.
For other uses ofwhatever and however, see a good dictionary. For who ever, whatever etc, see 595. For
no matter who/what/etc, see 371.
597 whose [question word)
1 with a noun or alone
The question word whose can be used with a noun as a determiner like my, your etc.
Whose car is that outside? Whose garden do you think looks the nicest? Whose can also be used alone,
like mine, yours etc. Whose is that car outside? 'Whose is this?' 'Mine.'
2 prepositions
Prepositions can normally come either before whose (more formal) or at the end of the clause (less
formal). See 440 for details.
For whose benefit were all these changes made?
Whose side are you on?
In short questions with no verb, prepositions can only come before whose. 'I'm going to buy a car.' 'With
whose money?' (NOT 'Whose money-wit"-'
For the relative pronoun whose, see 475. For whose and who's, see 598.
page 620
i
598 whose and who's
Whose is a possessive word meaning 'of whom/which', used in questions and relative clauses. Who's is
the contraction of who is or who has. Compare:
- Whose is that coat? (NOT Who's is that coat?)
It was a decision whose importance was not realised at the time.
(NOT ... who's importance...)
- Do you know anybody who's going to France in the next few days?
(NOT ... anybody whose going...) I've goto cousin who's never been to London.
(NOT ... whose never been...) There is a similar confusion between its and it's: see 303.
599 why and why not
1 replies
We generally use Why not?, not Why?, in short replies to negative statements.
Compare:
"They've decided to move to Devon.' 'Why?'
'I can't manage tomorrow evening.' 'Why not?'
(More natural than Why?)
Why not? can also be used to agree to a suggestion. 'Let's eat out this evening.' 'Yes, why not?'
2 why should...?
A structure with why followed by should can suggest surprise. I wonder why she should want to go out
with me.
(US... why she would...)
The structure can also suggest anger or refusal to do something. I don't see why we should have to pay
for your mistake. 'Give me a cigarette.' 'Why should I?'
For a similar structure with how, see 464.2.
3 infinitive structures
Why can be followed by an infinitive without to. This structure can be used to suggest that an action is
unnecessary or pointless.
Why argue with him? He'll never change his mind. (NOT Why arguing... ? OR Why to argue... ?)
Why pay more at other shops? We have the best value. Why not+ infinitive without to is used to make
suggestions.
'Sandy's in a bad mood.' 'Why not give her some flowers?'
(NOT -Why-net giving... ?') Why don't...? can be used in the same way.
Why don't you give her some flowers?
Why don't we go and seeJulie?
page 621


will
forms
Will is a modal auxiliary verb (see 344-345). It has no -s in the third person
singular; questions and negatives are made without do; after will, we use an infinitive without to.
Will the train be on time? Contractions are 'II, won't.
Do you think it'll rain7 It won't rain.
Would is used as a past or less definitive form of will for some of its meanings; for details, see 604.

'use an
2
future auxiliary
We can use will as an auxiliary verb when we make predictions about the future. For details, see 221.
/ will be happy when this is finished.
This time tomorrow I'll be sitting in the sun.
He will have finished the whole job by this evening.
For the use of shall as a future auxiliary, see 221.
certainty
Will can express certainty or confidence about present or future situations. As I'm sure you will
understand, we cannot wait any longer for our order. Don't phone them now-they'll be having dinner.
'"There's somebody coming up the stairs.' 'That'll be Mary.'
Will have + past participle can express certainty or confidence about the past.
Dear Sir, You will recently have received a form...
I wonder why we haven't heard from him - do you think he won't have got
our letter yet?
We can 'tgo and see them now - they'll have gone to bed.
For more about the use of will and other modal verbs to express certainty, probability and logical
deductions, see 345.
For modal verbs with perfect infinitives (e.g. won't have got), see 278.3.
willingness and decisions
We can use will to express the speaker's willingness, or a decision to do something.
'Can somebody help me?' 'I will.' "There's the doorbell.' Til go.' Will can express a firm intention, a promise
or a threat.
I really will stop smoking. I'll definitely pay you back next week. I'll kill her for this.
We can use will not or won't to talk about unwillingness or refusal.
She won't open the door. 'Give me a kiss.' 'No, I won't.' The car won't start.
Would not can refer to past refusal.
t-IJ - -
«--"'•"
She wouldn't open the door.
The car wouldn't start this morning.
page 622
5 requests, orders and offers
We use will you to tell people what to do.
Will you send me the bill, please? Come this way, will you?
Will you be quiet! Would you is 'softer', more polite.
Wouldyou send me the bill, please? Come this way, wouldyou? Will can be used in affirmative structures
to give impersonal, military-type orders.
All staff will submit weekly progress reports. sWillyou...? can be used to ask about people's wishes. '...;
Will you have some more potatoes? What will you drink? Won't you...? expresses a pressing offer.
Won'tyou have some more wine?
For more about requests, see 483.
6 habits and characteristics
We can use will to talk about habits and characteristic (typical) behaviour.
She'll sit talking to herself for hours.
When you look at clouds they will often remind you of animals.
If something breaks down and you kick it, it will often start working again.
Sulphuric acid will dissolve most metals. Sentences with stressed will can be used to criticise people's
typical behaviour.
She WILL fall in love with the wrong people.
Well, if you WILL keep telling people what you think of them... :
Would is used in a similar way to refer to the past. For details, see 604.7.
On Saturdays, when I was a child, we would all get up early and go fishing.
He was a nice boy, but he WOULD talk about himself all the time.
7 will and want
Will and want can both be used to talk about wishes, but they are rather different. Will is used mostly in
'interpersonal' ways, to express wishes that affect other people through orders, requests, offers, promises
etc. Want simply refers to people's wishes - nothing more. Will is to do with actions, want is to do with
thoughts. Compare:
- Will you open the window? (an order)
Do you want to open the window? (a question about somebody's wishes)
- She won't tell anybody. (= She refuses to...)
She doesn't want to tell anybody. (= She prefers not to...) Note that will cannot be used with a direct
object.
Doyou want /Would you likean aspirin? (NOT Willyou an aspirin?)
601 wish
1 wish + infinitive
We can use wish + infinitive to mean want. Wish is very formal in this sense.
Note that progressive forms are not used.
I wish to see the manager, please. (NOT I'm wishing to see...) • If you wish to reserve a table, please
telephone after five o'clock. > page 623


••""i UQl
An object + infinitive structure is also possible.
We do not wish our names to appear in the report. Do you wish me to serve drinks on the terrace,
madam?
Note that wish + direct object is not normally possible without a follow;
infinitive, "wig
I want/would like an appointment with the manager. (NOT I wish an appointment with the manager.}
2 Iwishyou...
Wish is used with two objects in some fixed expressions of good wishes
/ wish you a Merry Christmas. We all wish you a speedy recovery Here's wishing you all the best in your
new job.
3 wish + that-clause: meaning
We can also use wish with a that-clause (that can be dropped in an informal style). In this case, wish does
not mean 'want' - it expresses regret that things are not different, and refers to situations that are unreal,
impossible or unlikely. Tenses are similar to those used with if (see below).
/ wish (that) I was better looking. Don't you wish (that) you could fly? We all wish (that) the snow would
stay forever.
Wish + that-clause is not generally used for wishes about things that seem possible in the future. We often
use hope in this sense (see 252).
I hope you pass your exams. (NOT ^-wish-yeu-weuld pass your cxamsr) I hope you feel better tomorrow.
(NOT 4 wish youfol^bettcr tomorrow.)
4 wish + that-clause: tenses
In a that-clause after wish, we generally use the same tenses as we would use,
for instance, after 'It would be nice if...' (see 260). Past tenses are used with a present or future meaning.
/ wish I spoke French. (= It would be nice if I spoke French.) I wish I hod a yacht. I wish tomorrow was
Sunday. All the staff wish you weren't leaving so soon. Do you ever wish you lived somewhere else?
Many people use were instead of was in this structure, especially in a formal style.
/ wish that I were better looking. Past perfect tenses are used for wishes about the past.
I wish you hadn't said that. (= It would be nice if you hadn't said that.)
Now she wishes she had gone to university. In informal speech, sentences like I wish you'd have seen it
sometimes occur. For similar structures with if, see 261.9.
5 wish... would
Would is very common in that-clauses after wish (more common than it is in (^-clauses). Would is used as
a 'softened' equivalent of will, referring to
people's willingness, unwillingness, insistence or refusal to do things (see 604.2).
Everybody wishes you would go home. (= Why won't you go home?) I wish you would stop smoking. (=
Why won't you stop smoking?)
page
624
Wish... would usually expresses regret, dissatisfaction, impatience or irritation because somebody will
keep doing something or won't do
something.
I wish she would be quiet.
I wish you wouldn't keep making that stupid noise.
I wish the postman would come soon. Sometimes we talk as if things and situations could be willing or
unwilling, or
could insist or refuse to do things.
I wish it would stop raining. (It will keep on raining!)
Don't you wish that this moment would last for ever? Wish... would can be like an order or a critical
request. Compare:
- I wish you wouldn't drive so fast. (Similar to Please don't drive so fast.) I wish you didn't drive so fast.
(More like I'm sorry you drive so fast.)
- I wish you wouldn't work on Sundays. (= Why don't you stop?) I wish you didn't work on Sundays. (= It's
a pity.)
6 would not used
When we are not talking about willingness, unwillingness, insistence or refusal, wish... would is not
normally used. I wish today was Saturday.
(NOT -l-wish today would be Saturday- Nothing to do with
willingness.) / wish I could manage to give up smoking.
(NOT I wish I would give up smoking- It is strange to wish for oneself
to be willing.) J hope she doesn't have an accident.
(NOT I wish she wouldn't have an accident Nothing to do with
willingness.) I hope there's a strike tomorrow.
(NOT I wish there would be a strike tomorrow - We can'tsaythat 'there'
is willing to strike.)
For more about hope, see 252.
For similar structures with if only, see 265.
For other cases where past tenses have present or future meanings, see 422.
602 with
1 trembling with rage, blue with cold etc
With is used in a number of expressions which say how people are showing their emotions and
sensations.
My father was trembling with rage.
Annie was jumping up and down with excitement.
When I found her she was blue with cold.
white with fear I rage
red with anger/embarrassment
green with envy
shivering with cold >
page 625


2 angry with etc
M%/; is also used after a number of adjectives which say how people are feeling towards others.
I'm cross with you. You 're very patient with me. angry with furious with pleased with upset with
Note that with is not generally used after words like kind, nice, polite, rude good, which say how people act
towards others.
She was very nice to me. (NOT ... nice with me.)
iinfh r^'- '
3 with meaning 'against'
Aftftr firrt,^ *"--_ T
re
0 0-*"*>"-
After fight, struggle, quarrel, argue, play and words with similar meanings, with can be used with the same
meaning as against.
Don't fight with him - he's bigger than you are.
Will you play chess with me?
4 accompanying circumstances and reasons
With can introduce accompanying circumstances (rather like and there
is/was).
The runners started the race with a light following wind.
With can also introduce the reasons for a situation (rather like because ther is/was}.
With all this work to do, I won't have time to go out. With three people away ill, we'll have to close the
shop. With friends like you, who needs enemies? Without can be used in similar ways.
The meeting finished without a single disagreement. Without Sue and Jake, we're going to have trouble
finishing the repairs.
5 possession
With is very often used, like have, to indicate possession and similar ideas. There are so many people
around with no homes. (=... who have no homes.)
We need a computer with a huge memory. They've bought a house with a big garden.
He didn 'tjust look like a fish: he looked like a fish with a headache.
6 clothing, voices, transport etc
Note that in is often used instead of with to refer to articles of clothing. Who's the man in the funny hat?
Could you go and give this paper to the woman in glasses? We say in a... voice, not with a-^veiee:
Why are you talking in such a loud voice?
Note also: by car/train/ etc (NOT with the car etc), and write in pencil/ink.
For other uses of with, see a good dictionary. For the difference between by and with, see 117.
For omission of pronouns in expressions like a cake with creamon (it), see 181.13.
page 626
603 worth
1 worth a few pounds
Worth can be followed by a noun phrase which describes the value of something.
That piano must be worth a few pounds.
I don't think their pizzas are worth the money.
'Shall I talk to Rob?' 'It's not worth the trouble.' In questions about the value of something, either what or
how much can be used.
What/How much is that painting worth?
2 five pounds' worth of...
A possessive structure can be used before worth in measurement
expressions.
Could I have five pounds'worth of petrol, please? They've ordered a million dollars' worth of computer
software.
For more about possessives in measurement expressions, see 382.7.
3 It's worth talking to Joe
When we talk about the value of an activity, we can use an -ing form with worth. The -ing clause cannot be
the subject, but we often use a structure with preparatory it. (This structure is more common in British than
in American English.)
It's worth talking to Joe. (NOT Talking to Joe is worth.)
It isn't worth repairing the car. (NOT Repairing the car isn't worth.)
Is it worth visiting Leicester? It can be used to refer to an action mentioned earlier.
'Shall we take the car?' 'No, it's not worth it.'
4 Joe's worth talking to
Ideas like the ones in paragraph 3 can also be expressed by a structure in which the object of the -ing
form (Joe, the car, Leicester) is made the subject of the sentence.
Joe's worth talking to. The car isn't worth repairing.
(NOT The car isn't worth repairing it.) (NOT The car isn't worth to be repaired.) Is Leicester worth visiting?
She's not worth getting angry with.
For more about structures in which the object of a verb is the subject of the sentence (e.g. She's easy to
amuse), see 285.4.
5 worthwhile
In structures with -ing forms, worthwhile (or worth while) is sometimes used instead of worth, particularly
to express the idea 'worth spending time'. Is it worthwhile visiting Leicester? >
page 627


6
604
l
-H
Infinitives are also possible after worthwhile.
We thought it might be worthwhile to compare this year's accounts with lastyear's.
Note also the structure worth somebody's while.
Would you like to do some gardening for me? I'll make it worth your while. (=... I'll pay you enough.)
well worth
Worth can be modified by well.
Leicester's well worth visiting. (NOT .. ,-vwy-i
2
would
forms
Would, the past form of will, is a modal auxiliary verb (see 344-345).
Questions and negatives are made without do; after would, we us&an infinitive without to.
Would your daughter like to play with my little girl? Contractions are 'd, wouldn't. I'd like some advice,
please. I wish she wouldn't take things so seriously.
would and will
Would is often used in similar ways to will; it can act as a past of will in
indirect speech, for example, and as a softer, less definite form of will in other cases.
3 indirect speech
In indirect speech, would is used after past reporting verbs where will was used in direct speech. For
details, see 481.
Direct speech: Tomorrow will be fine. Indirect speech: The forecast said the next day would be fine. '
Would itself does not usually change in indirect speech (see 482). Direct speech: Would you like some
help?
Indirect speech: She asked if I would like some help.
4 future in the past
Would is also used to express the idea of 'future in the past' - to talk about
a past action which had not yet happened at the time we are talking about For details, see 226.
In Berlin, he first met the woman whom he would one day marry. There was a chance that my letter would
arrive in time.
5 interpersonal uses
Would is used in polite requests and offers; it often acts as a softer form of will.
Would you open the window, please? If you would come this way...
page 628
Would you mind standing up for a moment? Wouldyou like tea, or wouldyou prefer coffee? I'd liice to
speak to John fora moment, please.
6 past willingness and refusals
Would can refer to past willingness of a general kind, but not to willingness to do something on a particular
past occasion. Compare:
She would hoover, dustandiron, but she didn'tlike doing windows.
She agreed to come and see me. (NOT She would come and sec me.) But would not can be used to refer
to a refusal on a particular past occasion.
I asked him very politely, but he wouldn't tell me.
The car wouldn't start again this morning.
For present refusals with will not, see 222.
7 past habits
Would is used as the past of will (see 600.6) to talk about past habits and
typical characteristics.
When she was old, she would sit in the corner talking to herself for hours.
Sometimes he would bring me little presents without saying why.
On Sundays when I was a child we would all get up early and go fishing.
Sentences with stressed would can be used to criticise people's behaviour. He was a nice boy, but he
WOULD talk about himself all the time.
Stressed would can also be used to criticise a single past action - the
meaning is 'that's typical of you'.
YouWOULD tell Mary about the party -1 didn't want to invite her.
8
9
would and used to
Both would and used to (see 577) can refer to repeated actions and events in the past, but only used to
can refer to past states. Compare:
When we were children we would/used to go skating every winter.
I used to have an old Rolls-Royce.
(BUT NOT
old Rolls Royce.)
conditional auxiliary
The mixed verb would/should (see 498) is often used as an auxiliary with verbs that refer to unreal or
uncertain situations - for example in sentences with if. (Compare the use of will/shall to refer to more
definite situations.)
Ishould/would tellyou if I knew.
It would have been nice if he'd thankedyou.
For would after wish, see 601.5. For would after if only, see 265. For will, see 600.
page 629


yes and no
1 answers to negatives
In English, yes is used with affirmative sentences and no with negative sentences. In answers to negative
questions anrl ei-atow"*- -
- y,^, yr.a is used witn amrmative sentences and no with negative sentences. In answers to negative
questions and statements, yes and no are
chosen according to the form of the answer, not in order to show agreement or disagreement with the
speaker.
'Aren't you going out?' 'No, I'm not.' (NOT -'Yes,-I'm not.') 'I have no idea what's happening.' 'No, I haven't
either.' (NOT 'Yes, I haven't too.1)
'Haven't you got a raincoat7' 'Yes, I have. '(NOT -'No, I have.']
".«."_-r ••

contradicting
Some languages have a special word for contradicting negative statements or suggestions (e.g. French si
or German dock). English does not have a word
like this. Negative statements are generally contradicted with a short answer structure (see 493).
'The phone isn 't working.' '(Yes,) it is.' (NOT 'The phone isn't working, '-"fes^)
Affirmative statements or suggestions are contradicted with negative short answers.
'It's raining.' '(No,) it isn't.'
For more about negative questions, see 360. For yes and no in answers to Do/Would you mind...?, see
342.
page 630
Index
a/an 63-64; 66; 68-69
and any 54.4
and some 521.4
in measuring expressions 69.17
meaning'per' 385.19
with uncountables 148.6
position with as/how/so/too + adjective 16
see also articles a bit 106
modifying adjectives/adverbs 153
with comparatives 139.1 a bit of a 154.3
a couple of... with plural verb 503.2 a few and a little 322 a friend of mine etc 434 a good three weeks etc
509.6 a great deal 326
a group of... with plural verb 503.2 a large number 326 a little and a few 322 a little modifying
adjectives/adverbs 153
with comparatives 139.1 a longtime and long 323 a long way and/or 206 a lot 326
with comparatives 139.1 a lot of... with plural verb 503.2 a number of... with plural verb 503.2 abbreviated
styles 1 abbreviations 2 able 3
was able and could 122.3 about adverb particle 19 about and (a)round 60
and on 4 about to 5
above adverb particle 19 above and over 6 accept and agree 7
accommodation uncountable 148.3 according to 8 accuse preposition 437
accustomed to + -ing form or infinitive 296.11 ache simple or progressive 445.7 acronyms 2
across adverb particle 19 across and over 6.3; 9
and through 9.5 active and passive reasons for choice 289.3
see also passive active and passive infinitive with similar meaning 287
active past participles 404.3
active verb forms 10
actor, actress 227.4
actual(ly) 11
discourse marker 159.15,16,20
ADandBC 151.3 addresses prepositions 80.5 adjectives +-ing forms 294 + infinitives 285 after copular
verbs 147.2 after nouns 15.4
with pronouns (e.g. poor you) 424.3 after verbs in descriptions 147.5 and adverbs 20; 21
attributive and predicative position 15 commas 14.5 comparison 135-139 complementation 12 position of
complements 15.7 ending in -ed: pronunciation 13 modification 153 order before nouns 14 position after
as, how, so, too 16 position after nouns 15.4 position in expressions of measurement 15.( with and
17;51.3 without nouns (e.g. the accused, the beautifi,
the blind, the former) 18 admit... ing 293.1
adopted position and meaning 405.3 advanced active past participle 404.3 adverb particles 19; 582
modification for degree 156.1 adverbs comparison 137 modification 153 position 22; 23; 217.4 (fronting)
spelling of adverbs in -ly 530 -ically 256.5 adverbs and adjectives 20; 21 advertisements abbreviated style
1.1 advice uncountable 148.3 advise + -ing form or infinitive 296.4 affect and effect 24 afloat position, and
floating 15.3 afraid 25 position, and frightened 25.3 + -ing form or infinitive 296.13 preposition 437 afraid
so/not 515 very much afraid 25.3 after adverb 26
after and afterwards, then etc 26.2 after (preposition) and according to 8 after conjunction 27
tenses 27.2, 3; 421.5; after.. -ing 27.4; 406.6 after all 28; 159.19
after all and finally 28.2 afternoon, evening and night 29 afterwards and after 26.2 again and back 86 age
30
page 631


6° inarKea and unmarked uses 341 prepositions 30
aged pronunciation 13
agent in passive structures 408 ago 31
position 31.1 tenses 31.2
and before 31.4; 95.2 and/or 31.3
agree non-progressive verb 451.2 preposition 437
structures 295.2 and accept 7 ahead ad verb particle 19 ain't 144.4 (notes) alight position 15.3 alike 32
position 15.3 alive position 15.3 all 33-38
subject, object or complement 34 with nouns and pronouns 35 with verbs 36
omission of article 69.6 and every 37 and whole 38
all, everybody and everything 34
alllwantis ... etc 131.5
all the + comparative 138.6 all ready and already 44 all right and alright 39
all right (change of subject) 159.8 all the same 159.5
all together and altogether 49 allow structures 40.1
+ -ing form or infinitive 296.4
allow, permit and let 40 almost with superlatives 139.3
and nearly 41 alone position 15.3
alone, lonely, lonesome and lone 42 along adverb particle 19 along and through 43 already with present
perfect 418.5 already, yet and ever 197.7 already, yet and still 539 already and all ready 44 alright and all
right 39 also, as well and too 45; 46 also and even 195.3
alternately) and alternativedy) 47 although and though 48 altogether and all together 49 always with
progressive forms 452
and ever 197.2
position 23
position with imperatives 268.7 American 354 (notes) American and British English 50 among and
between 104 amount (of) 326.4 omission of article 69.8
and after try, wait, go etc 52
in numbers 385.9
with adjectives 17
commas 455.1, 5 angry preposition 437; 602.2 annoyed by/with 405.5 another and other(s) 53
another three weeks etc 53.2; 509.6 another thing Is 159.11 anxious preposition 437 any 54
non-assertive word 374.1
and some 522
and a/an 66.2
and every 55
and no article 67
not any and no 369
any different, any good/use 56 with comparatives 139.1 any the + comparative 138.6 after superlatives
138.13 -i-singular or plural verb 509.5 ;/"an.v261.11
hardly any 41.3 any more and anymore 57
not any more 372 anybody etc 523
non-assertive words 374.1 anybody and anyone 523 position with adjectives 15.5
anyhow 159.7
anyone and anyone 523.7
anything non-assertive word 374.1
position with adjectives 15.5
anything much 523.5 anyway 159.7
anywhere non-assertive word 374.1
position with adjectives 15.5 apart from 159.12
apart from, besides and except 101 apologies 520.7
apologise preposition 437
apostrophe 453
in abbreviations 2.5 apparently 159.16 . appear 58; 147
non-progressive verb 451.2 and seem 58.2
+ infinitive (negative structure) 359.4
there appears to be 563.5 appreciate.. .ing 293.1 approach no preposition 439
Arab, Arabian, Arabic 354 (notes) areas 385.18 aren't 17 466.1 arise and rise 59 around, round and about
60 arouse and rouse 61 arrange structures 295.3 arrive preposition 79.3; 437 arrived active past participle
404.3 art older English form of are 388
page 632

articles 62-69
and possessives 433.6
as determiners 157
left out in abbreviated styles 1
v\rith abbreviations 2.3, 4
see also a/an, the 35 + adjective + article + noun 16
+ object complement 580.2
+ object pronouns 70.4
modifying adjectives/adverbs 153
replacing subject/object 320.4; 70.11; 557.3
inversion after as 298.6
as I or as me etc 425.9
as and as much 153
and how 254.2
and like 320
as, because, since and/or 72
as, than and that 557
as, when and while 73
special word order after as and though 71 as... as 70
as a matter of fact 159.20 as a result 159.14 as far as... is concerned 159.1 as few 156.2 as for 159.1
as I was saying 159.9 as if and as though 74 as it were 541 as little 156.2 as long as 75; 262 as
much/many 156.2
as much/many as 70.5 as regards 159.1 as soon as 556 as though and as if 74 as usual 76
as well, also and too 45; 46 as well as 77
as well as that 159.11 as you know 320.5 aside adverb particle 19 ask 78
asleep position, and sleeping 15.3 astonish non-progressive verb 451.2 at, on and in (place) 80 at, on and
in (time) 81 at/In and to 79 at all 82
at any rate 159.7 atflrstand^rst83 at home 251.1; 69.1
at last, finally and in/at the end 210 at least 311.6
discourse marker 159.7,16 at/in the end, at last and finally 210 (at) what time preposition left out 439.5 ate
British and American pronunciations 300.3 attempt + -ing form or infinitive 296.11 attention signals 463.3
author, authoress 227
autumn article 69.10 auxiliary verbs 84
emphasis 189.2 available position 15.4; 477.6 avoid... ing 293.1 await 584 awake and asleep 85.3
position 15.3
awake, wake and (a)waken 85 away adverb particle 19
back adverb particle 19
and again 86
backward(s) 586 ...,. bad comparative and superlative 136.2
preposition 437
badly comparative and superlative 137 baggage uncountable 148.3 bath and bathe 87 BCandAD 151.3
be copular verb 147
progressive forms 88
subjunctive forms (I be, I were etc) 541
with auxiliary do 89
left out in abbreviated styles 1
with ages 30
in measurements 91
be and have 91 be + infinitive (am to ...} 90
future in the past (was to ...) 226 be able 3
be afraid and/ear 25.1 be born 107.1 be finished 211 be going to 220 begone 233 be supposed to 547 be
sure and... 52 be that as it may 541 be used to.. .ing 295.2; 578 bear verb 107.2
can't bear 296.11 beat and win 92 because and because of 93
because, as, since and for 72
position of because -clauses 93.2 become copular verb 147
changes 129.1
bed expressions without article 69.1 been meaning 'come' or 'gone' 94 before adverb 95
with perfect tenses 95; 418.5
and ago 31.4:95.2
and ever 197.8
before (that) and first 95.3 before adverb particle 19 before conjunction 96
position of before -clauses 96
tenses 96.2, 3
before... ing 406.6
page 633


before (preposition) and infrontof 97
and until 575.7 before.. .ing 96.4
begin + -ing form or infinitive 296.10
begin and ^rarf 98 behind adverb particle 19 believe non-progressive verb 451.2
negative structures 359.1
with so and not 359.3
preposition 437
believe somebody/something tobe ... 580.3
belong non-progressive verb 451.2 preposition 437
beloved pronunciation 13 below adverb particle 19 below and under 99 besides 159.11 beside and
besides 100
besides, except and apart from 101 best 136.2; 137 bet 102 better 103
had better 234 between and among 104
bicycle expressions without article 69.1 big, large sad great 105 billion 385.13
billion(s) (of) 385.14 binoculars 501.7 bit 106;426
a bit of a 154 blessed pronunciation 13 blind the blind 18 blue with cold etc 602.1 boat expressions
without article 69.1 body parts article use 69.16 bored and boring 404.2 born and borne 107 borrow and
lend 108 both (of) with nouns and pronouns 109 omission of article 69.6 with verbs; (word order) 110
both... and 111
bread uncountable 148.3 break meaning of passive 414 bride, bridegroom 227 A briefly 159.21 bring verb
with two objects 583
bring and take 112 bring up and educate 113
Britain, the United Kingdom, the British Isles and
England 114
British 354.3
the British 18.2
British and American ErigBsh 50 Briton 354 (notes) broad and wide 115 broadly speaking 159.12 build
meaning of passive 414
burn British and American forms 300.3 burst out ...ing 293.1
bus expressions without article 69.1 but meaning'except' 116 but I or but me etc 116; 425.9 meaning 'only'
116.4 ellipsis after but 182 buy verb with two objects 583 by adverb particle 19
by with agent in passive clauses 408 by and other prepositions with past
participles 405.5 time 118
by and near 119 and until 575.6
by (method, agent) and with (tools, etc) 117 by all/any/no means 340.2 by and large 159.12
by car, bus etc and other expressions without article 69.1
by far with superlatives 139.3 by oneself 471.6 by the kilo etc 69.17 by the time (that) 118 by the way
159.8
calculations in speech 385.21,22 call meaning 'telephone' or 'visit' 120 can and could 121-125
introduction 121
ability 122
possibility and probability 123 interpersonal uses (requests, etc) 124 with see, hear etc 125 can and be
able 3 could and was able 122.3 can and must (certainty) 350.2 can't pronunciation 144.4 (notes)
distancing use of could 161.3 can, could, may and might 331.10,11
can't bear + -ing form or infinitive 296.11
can't help 126
cannot (help) but 116.3 can't seem to... 490.4 can't stand.. .ing 293.1 capital letters 529
in East, North etc 176.3 car expressions without article 69.1 care take care (of), care (about) and care for
127 case (subject and object forms) 425 cattle 501.7
centuries 18th century etc 385.7 certain + -ing form or infinitive 296.15 certainly and surely 548
certainly structuring argument 159.5 chair, chairman, chairperson 227 L chance countable or uncountable
148.5 change countable or uncountable 148.5
followed by plural 128 changes verbs 129 chess uncountable 148.3 chewing gum uncountable 148.3
church expressions without article 69.1
page 634
cinema article use 69.12
preposition 438 city and town 130 classic and classical 256.4 classifying genitives 380 clean adverb 21.2
cleft sentences 131 clever preposition 437 close meaning of passive 414
close and shut 132 cloth and clothes 133 collapsed active past participle 404.3 collective nouns singular
or plural 503 college expressions without article 69.1 collocations 257.3 colon 454 colour with foe 91 come
and go 134
come and ... 52
come changes 129.5
come/go for a ... 231
come/go.. .ing 232
come from 134.3
come to 134.3 • comic and comical 256.4 commas 455
with adjectives 14.5
in numbers 385.9
in relative clauses 474
with and 455.1, 5
commentaries abbreviated style 1.2 committed to + - ing form or infinitive 296.11 comparatives and
superlatives 135-139
adjectives 136
adverbs 137
the difference between comparatives and superlatives 138 '
double comparatives 138.4
comparatives with the... the 138.5
three times more etc 138.7
comparative with all/any/none the 138.6
much, far etc with comparatives and superlatives 139.1,2
non-assertive words after superlatives 138.13
possessive 's after superlatives 138.9
prepositions after superlatives 138.9
the with superlatives 138.12 comparison structures 135
as ... as 70
ellipsis in comparative structures 138.10
see also comparatives and superlatives complements of verbs, nouns and adjectives 140.2
of verbs 579
of nouns 377
of adjectives 12
clause and subject/object complements 140.1 compound nouns 379-382
concentrate not used with reflexive pronouns 471. concern non-progressive verb 451.2 concerned position
and meaning 405.3 conditional clauses and verbs (terminology) 141.1
distancing use 161.4
in indirect speech 482.6
not used in subordinate clauses 556.5
see also if
congratulate, congratulations preposition 437 conjunctions general points 142
problems 143
conjunction + participle 406.6 consequently 159.14 consider ...ing 293.1
consider somebody/something to be ... 580.3
passive structures with consider 413 consist non-progressive verb 451.2 contain non-progressive verb
451.2 contemplate .. .ing 293.1 continually with progressive forms 452 continue + -ing form or infinitive
296.11 continuous see progressive contractions 144 contrary on the contrary I other hand 145
contrary and opposite 145.2 contrastive emphasis 189 control 146
co-ordinating conjunctions 142.2 copular verbs 147 costly 21 could see can countable and uncountable
nouns 148
article use 64 countries and regions 354 country 149 court martial 15.4 cowardly 21
crash preposition 437 crooked pronunciation 13 cursed pronunciation 13 cut meaning of passive 414
daily adjective and adverb 21.1 dangling participles 406.4 dare 150
Idaresay 150.3 dashes 456 data 501.3 dates 151 day expressions without article 69.1
the day we met etc 477.3
articles with Sunday etc 69.10 dead and died 152
dead slow etc 21.2
dead and deadly 21.2 decimals 385.1 declarative questions 462 definite article 63-65,68-69 and see the
degree modification of adjectives/adverbs 153
of nouns 154
of verbs 155 q of particles 156.1
of prepositions 156.1 delay... ing 293.1 demonstratives 565
as determiners 157
page 635


deny non-progressive verb 451.2
deny...ing 293.1 depend non-progressive verb 451.2
preposition 437 describe structures 583.6
describe somebody/something as ... 580.2 deserve non-progressive verb 451.2
deserve.. .ing passive meaning 293.3 details preposition 437 determiners 157 detest... ing 293.1
developed active past participle 404.3 diary entries abbreviated style 1.2 dice 501.3
die preposition 437 died and dead 152 difference countable or uncountable 148.5
difference between 104.4 different 158
and other 53.5 difficult to please etc 285.4 difficulty countable or uncountable 148.5
preposition 437 dinner, lunch and supper 338 direct adverb 21.2 direct speech see reporting directly,
immediately etc (conjunctions) 267 disagree non-progressive verb 451.2 disappointed preposition 437
discourse markers 159 dlscuss(ion) preposition 437; 439 disinterested 160 dislike non-progressive verb
451.2
structures 293.1,2 distancing 161
dive British and American forms 300.3 divide between/among 104.3
into 437 divorce 329 do 162 auxiliary verb 163 general-purpose verb 164 and make 164 do...ingl64.3
substitute verb 165 stressed 159.5 emphasis 189.2 with be 89; 268.4 do so, do it and do that 166 do you
mind... 7 342 dogged pronunciation 13 dost, doth older English forms of do 388 double comparatives
138.4 double negatives 361 doubling final consonants 535 doubt 167
non-progressive verb 451.2 down adverb particle 19
down and up 576 dozen(s) of 385.14 Or 353.3
dream British and American forms 300.3
preposition 437 dress 168
not used with reflexive pronouns 471.9 drinking polite formulae 520.12 drive preposition 437 drown 169
drunken 405.6 duchess, duke 227A due to and owing to 170 during position 440.6
and/or 171
and in 172
each 173
between each 104.6
each and every 174 each other and one another 175 early adjective and adverb 21.1
comparative and superlative 137
early, soon and quickly 525 easily with superlatives 139.3 east(ern), north(em) etc 176 easy comparative
and superlative 137
adverb 21.2
easy to amuse etc 285.4 echo questions 463.2 economic and economical 256.4
-ed and -ing forms 403-406
-ed pronunciation 13
pronunciation staged, naked etc 13. educate and bring up 113 effect and affect 24 effective and efficient
177 e.g. 159.13 either determiner 178
singular or plural verb 509.5 either adverb: not either 364 either, also, as well and too in negative
sentences 46 either... or 179 elder and eldest 15.2; 180 elect passive 413 electric and electrical 256.4
ellipsis (leaving out words) 181-186 general 181 with and, but and or 182 in co-ordinate clauses 142.5 at
the beginning of a sentence 183 after adjectives and determiners 184 after comparatives and superlatives
138.10 after auxiliary verbs 185 after if 261.10 of subject/object after as 70.10 of subject/object after than
138.14 to used instead of whole infinitive 186 adjectives without nouns 18 in abbreviated styles 1 omission
of that 560 else 187 elsewhere 187.6
page 636
embedding 188 emphasis 189
cleft sentences 131 enable 190 end andfinish 191
at/in the end 210 end preposition 438 end-weight 289.4 endure... ing 293.1 England, Britain, the United
Kingdom and
the British Isles 114 English, Englishman/woman 354.3
the English 18.2 enjoy 192
enjoy... ing 293.1 enough 193 modifying adjectives/adverbs 153 •{•for + infinitive 280.8 enter preposition
437; 439 equipment uncountable 148.3 ergative verbs 579.3 escape... ing 293.1 escaped active past
participle 404.3 especial(ly) and special(ly) 194 even 195
with comparatives 139.1 even if/though 195.4 even so 195.5 evening afternoon and night 29 eventual(ly)
196 ever 197 non-assertive word 374.1 with present perfect 418.5 after superlatives 138.13 used for
emphasis 189.3 hardly ever 41.3 ever and before 197.8 ever, yet and already 197.7 who ever etc 595
whoever etc 596 ever so,ever such 198 every (one) 199 every and all 37 and any 55 and each 174 every
now and then 199.9 every other 199.9 every single 199.9 every six weeks etc 509.8 every so often 199.9
everybody + singular 199.7 everybody and all 34.1,3 and everyone 523 everyday 199.8 everyone and
every one 523.7 everything + singular 199.7 and all 34.2,3 position with adjectives 15.5 example
preposition 437 except (for) 159.12; 200 except and without 200.6 except I or except me etc 425.9
except, besides and apart front 101 excited by/about 405.5
excited and exciting 404.2 exclamation mark 457 exclamations 201
article use 69.14 excuse... ing 293.1 excuse me 520.6,7 expect + infinitive (negative structure) 359.4
expectso/not 515
expect, hope, wait and look forward 202 experience countable or uncountable 148.5
experience and experiment 203 explain 204 extremely modifying adjectives/adverbs 153
face... ing 293.1
facing, opposite and in front of 272
fact the fact that 441.2; 559.3
faded active past participle 404.3
fair adverb 21.2
fairly modifying adjectives/adverbs 153
fairly, quite, rather and pretty 205 fall (meaning'autumn') article 69.10 fall with adjectives 129.8; 147.5
fall, feel and fill 300.2 fallen active past participle 404.3 fancy... ing 293.1 far and a long way 206 far
comparative and superlative 136.2; 207
used to modify comparatives 139.1
far too much etc 156.2 farther and further 207 fast and slow (marked and unmarked words)
341 fast comparative and superlative 137
adverb 21.2 fear and be afraid 25.1 feel 147;208
simple and progressive forms 445.7
can feel 125.1
not used with reflexive pronouns 471.9
feel somebody/something to be ... 580.3
there is felt to be ... 412.3
feel, fall and fill 300.2 feel like...ing 293.1 female and feminine 209 feminine and masculine words and
pronouns:
see gender
few and a few 322.3
(a) few and (a) little 322 fewer and less 313 fewest and least 311 flght preposition 437 fill, feel and fall
300.2 finally 159.10
and after all 28.2
finally, at last and Mat the end 210 find somebody/something to be ... 580.3
find and found 300.2 fine adverb 21.2
page 637


finish... ing 293.1
finish and end 191 finished adjective 211
active past participle 404.3 flrst position with cardinal numbers 14.4
first and at first 83
and before (that) 95.3
very first 139.4
this is the first time etc + present perfect 419.7 flrst floor 385.8 flrst of all 159.10
flrst(ly), seconddy), etc (structuring discourse)
159,10
fit non-progressive verb 451.2 British and American forms 300.3 fit and suit 212 flat and flatly 21.2 floating
and afloat 15.3 floor ground floor etc 385.8 flow and fly 300.2 flu uncountable 148.4 fly and/low 300.2
follow can follow 125.3 foot as plural 385.14
expressions without article 69.1 for purpose and cause 213 for...ing 294 for, as, because and since 72 for
time preposition left out 439.7; 584 for and ago 31.3 and during 171 for, in, since and from 214 for +
noun/pronoun + infinitive 280 for there to be 280.10 + object + infinitive after ask 78.3 for a long time and
long 323 for example 159.13 for instance 159.13 for one/another thing 159.10 forbid + -ing form or
infinitive 296.4 forever 197.2; with progressive forms 452 forget + -ing form or infinitive 296.1
forget and leave 215 forgive... i'Mg 293.1 formality and politeness 216 former the former 18 forward
adverb particle 19
fonuard(s) 586 found and find 300.2 fractions 385.1
with plural nouns 509.9 frankly 159.18 free adverb; free and freely 21.2 friendly 21 frightened and afraid
15.3 frightened by/of 405.5; 437
from school, university etc (expressions without
article) 69.1
from, since, for and in 214 from... to 575.2 front in front of97; 272
fronting 217
frown preposition 79.3
full stops 457
in abbreviations 2.1 fun and funny 218 furniture uncountable 148.3 further and farther 207 furthermore
159.11 future 219-226
introduction 219
present progressive and going to 220
shall/will 221 (future auxiliary) 222 (interpersonal uses)
shall/will contrasted with present 221.6 7 will with if 259.3 future perfect 224 future progressive 225 future
in the past 226 be + infinitive 90
simple present with future reference 223 present tense with future-reference in subordinate clauses 556;
102 (after bet);
252 (after hope)
distancing use of future verb forms 161.2
game and play 428 gather I gather (that) 246 gender 227 genitive see possessive '.•.'
geographical expressions article use 69.18 gerunds see-ing forms
get structures and meanings 228 got and gotten 228.7 copular verb 147 changes 129.2, 3 two objects 583
passive auxiliary 228-4 in passive imperatives 268.3 prepositions 437 get and go (movement) 229 have
got see have get divorced 329 get dressed 168.2 get married 329 get round to.. .ing 295.2 get up and rise
59 get used to 578.3 give passive 410 two objects 583 give a cough, push, smile etc 230 give up... ing
293.1 giving things polite formulae 520.18 glasses 501.7 go and come 134 go and get movement 229 go
changes 129.4 go and... 52 go/come for a ... 231 go/come... ing 232 go on + -ing form or infinitive 296.2
page 638
maex
eodsave... 541 going to 220
6 was going to 226
vonna 220.7 none active past participle 404.3
gone with be 233 good comparative and superlative 136.2
mod and well 589.1
any/no good... ing 292.5
a mod six weeks etc 509.6 good evening and good night 29 gotta 243.4 gotten 228.7
grass uncountable 148.3 grateful and thankful 558 Great Britain, the United Kingdom, the British
Isles sad England 114 great a great deal 326 great, big and large 105 greetings 520.2,4 ground floor
385.8
group nouns singular or plural 503 grow changes 129.6
grown-up active past participle 404.3 guess can guess 125.2 i
guess so/not 515
had better 234 had rather (obsolete form) 469.3 hair uncountable 148.3 half 235 half as ...as 70.6
half seven (meaning'seven thirty') 555.1 hanging participles 406.4 happen 236 happen to with if 261.2
negative structure 359.4 there happens to be 563.5 hard comparative and superlative 137
hard and hardly 21.2 hardly 21.2
hardly, scarcely and no sooner 237 hardly any, ever etc 41.3 hast older English form of have 388 hate
non-progressive verb 451.2
+ -ing form or infinitive 296.9 hath older English form of has 388 have 238-243 introduction 238 auxiliary
verb 239 actions (have a drink/bath etc) 240 have (got) possession, relationships, etc 241
have + object + verb form 242
have (got) to 243
gotta 243.4
have (got) to and must 352
have and be 91
have a good trip/journey etc 520.9,10 have on clothes 168.3 he and him 425
he or she 227.2
he and she for animals 227.1 headache, toothache etc countable or
uncountable 148.4 headings abbreviated style 1.4 headlines 366 health social enquiries 520.3 hear non-
progressive verb 451.2 + object + infinitive or-ing form 245 + object + past participle 245.3 + infinitive with
to in passive 412.2 can hear 125.1 hear and listen (to) 244 I hear (that) 246 heavy and light marked and
unmarked w
341 help structures 247 help...ing 293.1 infinitive with to in passive 412.2 can'thelp 126 here and there
248 here's + plural 509.4 here comes ... 444.6 here you are 520.18 hero, heroine 227.4 high comparative
and Superlative 137 high and highly 21.2 high and tall 249 historic and historical 256.4 holiday(s) 250
home 251
expressions without article 69.1 home adverb particle 19 homeward(s) 586 honestly 159.18 hope
structures 252 negative structures 359.2 hope so/not 515
hope, expect, wait and look forward 202 hopefully 253
hospital expressions without article 69.1 host, hostess 227.4 house and home 251.2 how long are you
here for? 323.5 how 254;460 in exclamations 201.1 in questions and exclamations 254.1 modifying
adjectives/adverbs 153 how + adjective + article + noun 16 nominal relative pronoun 476.4 how should...?
464.2 how to... 288 how and as 254.2 and how much 153 and what... like 255 how, what and why 254.3
how dare you? 150.3 how do you do? and how areyou? 520.1 how ever, the hell etc 595 how few/little
156.2 how much/many 156.2
how much of a 154.3 however discourse marker 159.3
page 639


however meaning 'it doesn't matter how' 596 hundred a hundred and one hundred 385.10
hundred(s) (of) 385.14
hurry not used with reflexive pronouns 471.9 hurry up and... 52
hurt simple and progressive forms 445.7 hyphens 532
I and me etc 425, and see personal pronouns I'm afraid meaning 'I'm sorry to tell you' 25.2;
159.16
I beg your pardon 520.6,7,8 I bet + present tense with future meaning 102 I dare say 150.3
I don't know discourse marker 159.17 I feel discourse marker 159.16 I gather (that)... 246 I guess
discourse marker 159.16 I hear (that)... 246
I hope + present tense with future meaning 252.1 I mean 159.15-17; 339.4 (reckon 159.16 I see (that)...
246
I should... meaning 'If I were you, I should...'
264.2
(suppose 159.16 I think 159.16
I thought + negative expressing surprise 359.1 I understand (that)... 246 I wish 601
-ic and -ical 256
-ics singular words ending in -ics 5013 idea countable or uncountable 148.5
preposition 437 Identifying relative clauses 474 idioms 257 if 258-265
introduction 258
ordinary tense-use 259
special tense-use 260
advanced points 261
extra negative 261.7
if I were 260.4
hadi..., were I... etc 261.6
would in both clauses 261.8
'dhave in t/'-clause 261.9
if... could/might 260.8
if... should/happen to 261.2
if... was/were to 261.3
if with will 259.3; 261.1
if structuring argument 159.5
i/and in case 271
if sad when 590
if in reported questions 481.6
;7and whether 593
if meaning 'although' 263
other words with the same meaning as if 262 Ifany 261.11 if I were you 264 If in doubt etc 261.10
If It was/were not for 261.4 If not and unless 574.2 if only 265 ifso/not 261.12 If you like etc 319.6 ill
comparative and superlative 136.2 preposition 437 ill and sick 266 Illnesses article use 69.15
uncountable words 148.4 imagine (that) 262 non-progressive verb 451.2 imagine... ing 293.1 imagine...+
object + - ing 293.2 negative structures 359.1 imagine so/not 515 Immediately conjunction 267
Imperatives 268 introduced by let 315 question tags 466.2 get in passive imperative 268.3 Impossible to
please etc 285.4 impress non-progressive verb 451.2 impressed preposition 437 in adverb particle 19 in
with time expression and later 308 In, at and on (place) 80 in and into 269 in and to 79; 270 in, at and on
(time) 81 in and during 172 in, for, since and from 214 In addition 159.11 in all/most/etc cases 159.12 in
any case 159.11 in case and (/ 271
icin front of, facing and opposite 272 In general 159.12 in my view/opinion 159.16 In order to 281
Inorderthat 519 In other words 159.15 In particular 159.13 in short 159.21 In spite of 273
in spite of this 159.3 in the first place 159.10 In/at the end, at last and finally 210 in the same way 159.4 in
the way and on the way 587.5 in time and on time 438 incidentally 159.8
Include non-progressive verb 451.2 Increase preposition 437 Increased active past participle 404.3 Indeed
274
Indefinite article 63-64; 66; 68-69 and see a/an Independent preposition 437
page 640
indirect object position 583.2,3 indirect speech 480-482 infinitive 275-288 introduction 275 negative,
progressive, perfect and passive
infinitive 276 split infinitive 276.7 infinitives without to 277; 77.2 (after «s well
as}; 116.3 (after but} use of perfect infinitive 278 active and passive infinitive with similar
meaning 287
infinitive after adjective 285 after superlative 285.3 after noun/pronoun 286 after verb 283 after verb +
object 284 after who, what, how etc 288 after why 599.3 after as 70.8
to used instead of whole infinitive 186 infinitive with its own subject 279.4 the life to come etc 286.6 easy
to please etc 285.4 a friend to play with/with whom to play etc
286.5
infinitive structure after ask 78.3 be + infinitive 90 infinitive or - ing form 296 Infinitive clause as subject,
object or
complement 279 introduced by/07- ... 280 expressing purpose 281 other uses 282 position of preposition
440.5 it as preparatory subject/object 301-2 information structure 289
with as well as 77 Information uncountable 148.3
-ing and -ed forms (verbal and adjectival uses) 403-406
•ing forms (noun-like uses) 290-296 introduction 290
used as modifiers before nouns 291 subject, object or complement 292 me/my going, etc 292.4 it as
preparatory subject/object 292.5; 301-2
-ing forms after verbs 293 with passive meaning 293.3 after noun or adjective 294 after preposition 295
after to 295.2 after as well as 77.2 after before 96.4 after do etc 164.3
-ing form or infinitive 296 Initials names of organisations 2.2 Insist preposition 437 Instant the instant
(conjunction) 267 Instead (of) 297
Instructions abbreviated style 1.1 Intend + infinitive (negative structure) 359.4 + -ing form or infinitive
296.11
interest(ed) preposition 437 + -ing form or infinitive 296.16 interested and interesting 404.2 Interrogative
pronouns see question words interrogative structures 461-466 (see also
questions) Into and in 269 Intonation 540 Intransitive verbs 579.2 Introductions 520.1
inversion auxiliary verb etc before subject 298 whole verb before subject 299 after as 320.4 in conditionals
261.6 Inverted commas 458 invitations polite formulae 520.15 Involve non-progressive verb 451.2
involve.. .ing 293.1 involved position and meaning 405.3 Irish, Irishman/woman 354.3 irregular verbs 300
it empty subject 424.7 referring to nothing, everything, all 424.6 used to identify 424.5 preparatory subject
301 preparatory object 302 preparatory subject/object for -ing
forms 292.5
cleft sentence structure with it is... that 131. it is I who am ...I It's me that is... 477.5 It is/was lime who... etc
425.7 it and one 391.9 it and this/that 566 It doesn't matter 371.4 it is true 159.5 it was not until... 131.5 it
was only when ... 131.5 it's no good/use ... ing 292.5 it's time structures 304 it's worth... ing 603 Its and it's
303
jeans 501.7
jobs article use 69.13
Journey, travel, trip and voyage 572
Just (time) 305
just now 305.2 Just used for emphasis 189.3 just and justly 21.2
keep + adjective 129.10
keep (on).. .ing 293.1 kind preposition 437 kind of 159.16,17; 526 know 306
know somebody/something to be... 580.3
known to 405.5
/ know and / know it 306 knowledge uncountable 148.3
page 641


Index
^ abbreviated style 1.4 -343.4
.^^'^-progressiveverb 451.2 lab^ ^/ position 437; 439 lact* ^^^ 0 torge number of 26.4 ll^r^-c and wide
105.6 p^ .(^^'ft ^i? anc! great 105
%^enses with this is the lost... etc 307.5 f^^y last 139.4 Y/'ition with numbers 14.4 ,", y^ and latest 307.4 t^
^•^ and the last 307 ?>^^210 Vf^/f but one etc 116.1 ^•^>. 159.10 ft.4 comparative and superlative 137
\'^/'^ and toe;y 2L2 la?* X^nd in 308
lat^^y^ rfie /offer 18
^y ^r preposition 79.3; 437 la^'^d Ke 309 la'/1/7 pritish and American i
^

lat*^^// pritish and American forms 300.3 \^'y structures 310
irtg form or infinitive 296.8
\e^y ,4tish and American forms 300.3 1®^ ^y^ (adjective) pronunciation 13
^ ^ ./ /.nrl fofnoct ^1 1
^

^
^^^ and/ewe^ 311 r^^ two objects 583 le^-^l/e and forget 215 i^^'/^ve it to somebody to ... 302.4 '^/'//f.ve
and i^^f1^ words out see ellipsis
«^^<-ieaning 'remaining' 312 \e' J /, fe^l adjective and adverb 21.1 \e~i, •/ two objects 583 1^'^ gsive 410
W^^nd and borrow 108 W^'^Jt'ft marked and unmarked uses 341 0nd fewer 313 fffa 154.3 .r 313.4 1<^
"314 |^'!^ yuctures 40.2; 316 \0^ ^7 aHow and permit 40 1'^' .^^itroducing imperatives 268.8; 315 \0
^f^rnesee 268.8
.; /''s 315 1^ /y/'5we 159.17
t / f's question tag 466.3 I,/' f expressions without article 69.1
y^ 317
^^^breviated style 1.2 l^^^^ith adjectives 147.5 ^ y ., and lay 309
;tives 147.5 " and lay 309
r^is
riing uncountable 148.3
4 and as 320 ^d s if/though 74
.^ /,,orh1 ^iq. 1Rfi.3
likely 21; 321 listen preposition 437
listen (to) and hear 244 little and small 511 little comparative and superlative 136.2
little and a little 322.3
(a) little and fel/ew 322 live and leave 300.2 live adjective and alive 15.2 lively 21
lonely 21; lone, lonely, lonesome and alone 42 long live... 541 long comparative and superlative
(pronunciation) 136.1
long and for a long time 323
a long way and far 206
as long as 75; 262
no longer 372 look 147;324
non-progressive verb 451.2
look (at), see and watch 489
look at + object + -ing form 245.4
preposition 79.3; 437
discourse marker 159.19 look after and look for 324.4 look forward to...ing 295.2
look forward, expect, hope and wait 202 look here 159.19 lose and loose 325 lot see a lot lots 326
with comparatives 139.1 loud comparative and superlative 137
adverb 21.2
love meaning 'zero' 385.3 love non-progressive verb 451.2
+ -ing form or infinitive 296.9 lovely 21 low comparative and superlative 137
adjective and adverb 21.2 luck uncountable 148.3 luggage uncountable 148.3 lunch and dinner 338
made preposition 328
magazines and newspapers article use 69.19
magic and magical 256.4
mail expressions without article 69.1
majority the majority 326
make structures 327
two objects 583
prepositions 328
+ infinitive with to in passive 412.2
+ object complement 580
object complement in passive 413
make and do 164 male and masculine 209 man omission of article 69.9
man meaning 'people in general', "the human race' 69.9; 227.6
Index
man-made 227.6 mankind 227.6 many and much 348
comparative and superlative 136.2
as much/many as 70.5
many with comparatives 139.2
see also much
marked and unmarked uses (tall/short etc) 341 marriage preposition 437 married preposition 437
get married 329 marry 329
preposition 437, 439 masculine and feminine words and pronouns
see gender matter non-progressive verb 451.2
no matter who etc 371 may and might 330-336
introduction 330
mayn't 144.4 (notes)
possibility 331
permission 332
may, might and can 331.10
may, might and could 331.11
may in wishes and hopes 333
may structuring argument 159.5
may... but 334
may/might as well 335
distancing use of mig^lf 161.3
might in requests, suggestions and criticisms
336
maybe and perhaps 337 mayor, mayoress 227.4 me too 45.3 meals 338
polite formulae 520.11 mean 339
non-progressive verb 451.2
+ -ing form or infinitive 296.7
mean and think 339.2 meaning and opinion 339.2 means 340
means and way 587.4 measles uncountable 148.4 measure non-progressive verb 451.2 measurement
marked and unmarked uses of measurement words 341
use of be 91
article use 69.17
measurement expressions 382.7,8
word order 15.6
British and American measures 385.17 mention...ing 293.1 method and way 587.4 might see may
million(s) (of) 385.14 mind 342
mind...ing 293.1
/ don't mind you/your.. .ing 292.4 mind you 159.3 mine, yours etc 433
n frifn/i nfminff etc 434
minute the minute (conjunction) 267 misrelated participles 406.4 Miss 353.3 miss 343
miss...ing 293.1 missing 343.5 modal auxiliary verbs 344-345
with perfect infinitives 278.3
in indirect speech 482.5 moment the moment (conjunction) 267 money British and American currency
385.15,16
singular verbs with sums of money 504.1 money uncountable 148.3 monthly adjective and adverb 21.1
months article use 69.10 more 346
in comparative structures 135-139
any more 57
more of a 154.3
more and more ... 138.4
no more and no longer 372
more and another 53.2
more than one + singular 504.3 more or less 159.16 moreover 159.11 most 347
in superlative structures 135-139
modifying adjectives/adverbs 153
meaning 'very' 153.2
most and mostly 21.2 Mr 353.3
punctuation 2.1 Mrs 353.3 Ms 227.7; 353.3 much and many 348
comparative and superlative 136.2
much before verbs 155.1
with comparatives 139.1 '
with superlatives 139.3
anything/nothing much 523.5
as much/many as 70.5
too much etc 156.2
much, very and rery much with past participles 405.4
see also many
musical Instruments article use 69.11 must 349-352
introduction 349
concluding that something is certain 350
must and can (certainty) 350.2
must not and need not 350.3; 357.6
necessity and obligation 351
must and have (got) to 352
must, should and ought 496 my, your etc 433 myself, yourself etc 471
and see reflexive pronouns
naked pronunciation 13 names and titles 353 nationalities 354


nature no article 68.3a near adverb particle 19 near comparative and superlative 137 near (to) 355; 437
near and fry 119 nearest and next 356 nearly with superlatives 139.3
nearly and almost 41 need 357
non-progressive verb 451.2 need.. .ing passive meaning 2933; 357.4 need not and must not 350.3; 357.6
need not have... and did not need to ... 357.5 there is no need to... 563.2 negative structures 358-362
basic rules 358 negative infinitive 276.5 transferred negation 359 negative questions 360
negative questions as exclamations 201.4 negative questions in indirect speech 482.7 double negatives
361 ambiguous sentences 362 extra negative in ly-clauses 261.7 distancing use of negative structures
161.4 neither (of) 363
neither and none 368.3 neither and both... not 109.4 singular or plural verb after neither 509.5 neither can
I/do I etc 364 neither... nor 365 never with present perfect 418.5 position with imperatives 268.7 never and
not ever 361.2 nevertheless 159.3 news uncountable 148.3 newspaper headlines 366 newspapers and
magazines article use 69.19 next position with numbers 14.4 very next 139.4 next and the next 367 and
nearest 356 nextbutone etc 116.1 nice preposition 437
nice and ...51.4 night expressions without article 69.1
night, afternoon and evening 29 nil 385.3 no and not 375 no and none 368 no/none and not a/any 369 no
and not all 35.5 no with comparatives 56; 139.1 no and yes 605
in answers to negative questions 360.4 no doubt 159.18,19; 370 no good 56
no good... ing 292.5 no ...ing 292.3 no matter who/what etc 371 no more and no longer 372
no one and nobody 523
no one and none 373 no sooner, scarcely and hardly 237 no use 56
no use.. .ing 292.5 nobody position with adjective 15.5 nobody and no one 523 and not anybody 361.2
nominal relatives 476 nominalisation 573 non-assertive words 374
after superlatives 138.13 non-identifying relative clauses 474 non-progressive verbs 451 none singular or
plural verb 509.5 none the + comparative 138.6 none of which 477.1 none and neither 368.3 and no 368
and no one 373 nor can 11do I etc 364
not... nor 364.3 north(ern), east(ern) etc 176 northward(s) 586
not referring to different parts of a sentence 362 with believe, hope etc 515 not and no 375 if not 261.12
not... either 364.2 not... nor 364.3 not a/any and no/none 54.3; 369 not a bit 106.3 not all and no 35.5 not
any more and not any longer 372 not at all 82.3 modifying adjectives/adverbs 153 answer to thanks
520.19 not even 195.2 not in the least 311.7 not much of a 154.3 not only 376 not quite 467.6 (not) so ...
as 70.2
not so much... as/but 518.4 not until inverted word order 575.5 not very modifying adjectives/adverbs 153
notes abbreviated style 1.2 nothing position with adjectives 15.5 nothing and not anything 361.2 nothing
much 523.5
nothing to do and nothing to be done 287.3 nothingbut 116.1 notice + object + infinitive or - ing form 245
+ object + past participle 245.3 notices abbreviated style 1.4 nought 385.3 nouns complementation 377
countable and uncountable 148 plurals 500-502 noun + -ing form 294 nouns in groups 379-382 noun
modifiers 378; 382
page 644
nouns modification for degree 154
nouns used for actions 573
now (that) 383
now to show change of subject 159.8
nowadays 384
number see singular and plural
number a large number 326
omission of article after number of 69.8 numbers 385
position of numbers 14.4
object to... ing 295.2 of course 386
structuring argument 159.5 of whom/which 477.1 of with determiners 157.4 with all 35 with both 109
compound nouns with of-structure and
possessive's 379-382 off adverb particle 19 offer two objects 583
passive 410 offers polite formulae 520.16 often 387
OK used to show change of subject 159.8 old position and meaning 15.2 comparative and superlative
136.2 old and young (marked and unmarked) 341 the old 18
older and elder, oldest and eldest 180 older English verb forms 388 omission of relative pronouns
(comprehension
problems) 188 omission of words see ellipsis on adverb particle 19 on, at and in (place) 80 (time) 81 on
and onto 269 on... ing 406.6 on and about 4 on condition (that) 262 on earth used for emphasis 189.3 on
foot 69.1 on holiday 250 on one's own 400.5 on the contrary 159.6
and on the other hand 145.1 on the other hand 159.2
and on the contrary 145.1 on the way and in the way 587.5 on the whole 159.12 on time and in time 438
once, sometime and one day 389 once conjunction meaning 'after' 390 one and a with numbers 385.10
one and a half 235.5 one and ft 391.9
one another and each other 175 one day and once 389 one of... 393
one of the...+ relative clause (singular or
plural) 506.1 one personal pronoun 392
distancing use 161.6
one, you and they 392 one substitute word 391 only referring to different parts of a sentence 394
inversion after only... 298
only today etc 394.4
if only 265
the only thing is 131.5 onto and on 269
open (adjective) and opened 395 open (verb) not used with reflexive pronouns
471.9
operate preposition 437 opinion preposition 438
opinion and meaning 339.2 opportunity and possibility 396 opposite position 397
opposite and contrary 145.2
opposite, in front of and facing 272 or words left out after or 182 or else 187.5 or rather 159.16; 469.4
other(s) and another 53
other and different 53.5
on the other hand 159.2; 145.1 ought 398
ought, should and must 496 out adverb particle 19 out of 399 outward(s) 586 over adverb particle 19 over
and above 6;
and across 6.3, 9 owe non-progressive verb 451.2 two objects 583
owe it to somebody to... 302.4 owing to and due to 170 own 400; non-progressive verb 451.2
pack meaning of passive 414
page preposition 438
pair 426.3
pants 501.7
paragraphs 401
pardon, excuse me and sorry 520.6-8
part no article 402
participles 403-406
introduction 403
active and passive participles 404
details of participle use 405
participles used as adjectives 405
participle clauses 406
dangling participles 406.4 particles modification for degree 156.1 parts of the body article use 69.16 party
preposition 438 passives 407-14
structures and verb forms 407
page 645


get as passive auxiliary 228.4 get in passive imperatives 268.3 passive infinitive 276.3 passive infinitive
after be 90 passive infinitive not used after able 3 agent 408
by sad with 117.2
choice between active and passive 409; 289.3 verbs with two objects 410 verbs with infinitive and clause
objects 411 verbs with object + infinitive 412 there as preparatory subject 412.3 verbs with object
complements 413 finished-result verbs (e.g. cut, close) 414 position of preposition in passive clauses
440.4
past adverb particle 19
past continuous see past progressive
past participles 403-406
confusion between past participles and past
tenses 188
past participles with very, much and very
much 405.4 past perfect tenses 421 past progressive tense 417
future in the past 226
past progressive and simple past 417.3-5 past simple see simple past past tenses introduction 415
distancing use 161.2
past verb forms with present or future
meaning 422
past with conditional meaning in subordinate clauses 556
see also simple past, present perfect etc
pay passive 410 preposition 437 two objects 583 pen/pencil/ink preposition 438 pennies and pence
385.15,16; 501.2 people 501.2 per 385.19 perfect verb forms 423 perfect infinitive 276.2; 278 see also
present perfect, past perfect,
future perfect perhaps and maybe 337 periods see full stops permission uncountable 148.3 permit
structures 40.1 + -ing form or infinitive 296.4 permit, allow and let 40 personal pronouns general 424
subject and object forms 425 with adjectives (e.g. poor you) 424.3 object pronouns after as 70.4 aster but
116 after than 138.8 pronouns left out in abbreviated styles 1 pronouns left out in informal speech 183
me/my going etc 292.4 phone expressions without article 69.1
preposition 438 phrasal verbs 19.2; 257.2; 582 picture preposition 438 piece 426
piece- and group-words 426 place + infinitive or relative 427
a place we can stay etc 477.3
prepositions 80; 439.11 place names article use 69.18
plane expressions without article 69.1 play and game 428 please 429
please non-progressive verb 451.2 pleased preposition 437 plenty 326 plural see singular plural
uncountables 148.7 plurals of abbreviations 2.5 Poet Laureate 15.4 poet, poetess 227.4 poetry
uncountable 148.3 point countable or uncountable 148.5
preposition 79.3 point of view 430
preposition 438 police the police 68.3b;501.7 policeman/woman 227.4 polite conversational formulae 520
polite preposition 437 politeness and formality 216 politic and political 256.4 politics and policy 431 poor
the poor 18 position of adjectives, adverbs, prepositions etc:
see adjectives, adverbs, prepositions etc possess non-progressive verb 451.2 possessive 's forms and
grammar 432 article use 69.3
used to make compound nouns 379-382 with superlatives 138.9 possessives my, mine etc 433
possessives as determiners 157 possessives with of: a friend of mine etc 434 possessives and object
pronouns with -ing
forms 292.4 possibility and opportunity 396 possible position 15.4; 477.6 postcards abbreviated style 1.2
postpone... ing 293.1 practically with superlatives 139.3 practise... ing 293.1 prefer 435; non-progressive
verb 451.2 + -ing form or infinitive 296.9 prefer.. .to.. .ing 295.2 prepositions 436-442 introduction 436
prepositions after particular words and expressions 437 after past participles 405.5 before particular words
and expressions 438 expressions without preposition 439 prepositions at the ends of clauses 440
page 646
before conjunctions 441 with -ing forms 295,406.6; 442 with infinitives 442 left out in abbreviated styles 1
modification for degree 156.1 prepositional verbs the difference between
prepositions and adverb particles 19 idiomatic prepositional verbs 257.2 present position and meaning
15.4 present continuous see present progressive present participles 403-406 present perfect tenses 418-
420 present perfect simple 418 present perfect and simple past 418.3-8; 419 present perfect progressive
420 comparison between simple and progressive
420.4-7
comparison between present and present
perfect progressive 420.3 present progressive 445 and see present tenses present simple 444 and see
present tenses present tenses 443-446
introduction 443
simple present 444
present progressive 445
present progressive and simple present 445.5-8
present tenses in stories, commentaries and
instructions 446 present tenses with future reference: see
future presently 447 President article use 69.13 Presidentelect 15.4 presume there is presumed to be ...
412.3 pretty and prettily 21.2 ' ' pretty modifying adjectives/adverbs 153 pretty, rather, quite said fairly 205
prevent preposition 437 price and prize 448 prince, princess 227.4 principal and principle 449 prison
expressions without article 69.1 prize and price 448 Professor 353.3 progress uncountable 148.3
progressive verb forms general 450 with always etc 452 distancing use of progressive forms 161.2
progressive infinitive 276.1 progressive forms of be 88 non-progressive verbs 451 see also present
progressive,
past progressive, future progressive promise non-progressive verb 451.2 two objects 583 passive 410
pronouns see personal pronouns, relative
pronouns etc
pronunciation British-American differences 50.4 -ed 416.2 adjectives ending in -ed 13 regular plural
endings 502
third person singular endings 444.3
possessive 's 432
the 65.9
intonation in question tags 465
pronunciation and spelling 538 proof preposition 437 proper position and meaning 15.4 provided/providing
(that) 262 publicity uncountable 148.3 punctuation 453-459
apostrophes in abbreviations 2.5
full stops in abbreviations 2.1
punctuation between clauses 142.4 commas with adjectives 14.5 punctuation of numbers 385.9 put off
...ing 293.1 put on clothes 168.2 pyjamas 501.7
Queen article use 69.13
question countable or uncountable 148.5
question mark 457
question tags 465-466
with imperatives 268.6 question words 460
question word clauses 460.5 questions 461-466
basic rules 461
questions with non-interrogative word order 462
negative questions 360
negative questions as exclamations 201.4
negative questions in indirect speech 482.7
reply questions 463
rhetorical questions 464
question tags 465-466
questions used for 'distancing' requests and
statements 161
position of prepositions 440.2
indirect questions 481.6 quick comparative and superlative 137
adverb 21.2
quickly, soon and early 525 quit British and American forms 300.3
quite 467
modifying adjectives/adverbs 153
with comparatives 139.1
quite a before nouns 154.2,5
quite, fairly, rather and pretty 205 quite a bit etc 467.5
quite a few la lot I enough 156.2 quotation marks 458
radio article use 69.1,12
preposition 438 ragged pronunciation 13 rain etc preposition 438 raise and rise 300.2 rather adverb of
degree 468
modifying adjectives/adverbs 153
with comparatives 139.1
page 647


rather a before nouns 154.2 rather few I little I many I much I too much I a lot 156.2
rather, fairly, quite and pretty 205 rather preference 469
rather than 469.1
or rather 159.16; 469.4 read two objects 583 real adverb 21.2 really discourse marker 159.16
used for emphasis 189.3 reason structures 470
countable or uncountable 148.5
preposition 438 reckon so/not 515
recognise non-progressive verb 451.2 recovered active past participle 404.3 reduced relative clauses
406.2; 477.6 reflexive pronouns 471
and each other 471.7 refuse passive 410 regard passive 413
regard somebody I something as... 580.2 regarding 159.1
regret + -ing form or infinitive 296.3 reinforcement tags 472 relative pronouns and clauses 473-477
introduction 473
identifying and non-identifying clauses 474 punctuation 474 whose 475
what and other nominal relatives 476 advanced points 477
relative pronouns like conjunctions 143.2 reduced relative clauses 406.2; 477.6 omission of relative
pronouns and
comprehension problems 188 position of preposition 440.3 relatives and indirect statements combined
(e.g. somebody I know you'll like) 477.10 relatives and indirect questions combined (e.g. a car that I didn 't
know how fast it would go) 477.11 remain + adjective 129.10 remember non-progressive verb 451.2 + -ing
form or infinitive 296.1 can remember 125.3 remember and remind 478.3 remind 478
preposition 437 repetition 479
for emphasis 189.4 reply questions 463 report there is reportedto'be... 412.3 reported speech see
reporting reporting 480-482 introduction 480 basic rules for indirect speech 481 advanced points 482
reporting expressions and comprehension problems 188 requests 483
require .. .ing passive meaning 293.3 research uncountable 148.3 resemble no preposition 439 resent...
ing 293.1 resist... ing 293.1
responsible/responsibility preposition 437 rest the rest 484
retired active past participle 4043 rhetorical questions 464 rhythm 540
rich the rich 18
right adverb; showing change of subject 159.8
right and rightly 21.2 rise and arise 59
rise and raise 300.2 risk... ing 293.1 road and street 485 Roman numbers 385.5 round, around and about
60 rouse and arouse 61 rubbish uncountable 148.3 rude preposition 437 rugged pronunciation 13 run
preposition 437 run and... 52
's genitive see possessive 's sacred pronunciation 13 same the same 486 satisfy non-progressive verb
451.2 say and tell 487
say so 514
there is said to be... 412.3 scales 501.7 scarcely, hardly and no sooner 237
school expressions without article 69.1 scissors 501.7
Scot, Scottish, Scotch 354 (notes) sea the sea 68.3a
expressions without article 69.1 search preposition 437 seasons article use 69.10 second the second
(conjunction) 267 Secretary General 15.4 see 488
non-progressive verb 451.2 can see 125.1
+ object + infinitive or -ing form 245
+ object + past participle 245.3
+ infinitive with to in passive 412.2
I see (that) 246
see somebody as... 580.2
see, look (at) and watch 489 see above/over 6.6 seem copular verb 147; 490 non-progressive verb 451.2
+ infinitive (negative structure) 359.4 can't seem to... 490.4 there seems to be 563.5 seem and appear
58.2
page 648
-self see reflexive pronouns sell not used with reflexive pronouns 471.9 semi-colon 459
send passive 410
with two objects 583 sensible and sensitive 491 several 157.3 shade and shadow 492 shall future auxiliary
221
interpersonal uses 222 share between/among 104.3 sharp and sharply 21.2
shave not used with reflexive pronouns 471.9 she for cars, ships, countries etc 227.1
she and her 425 shocked by/at 405.5; 437
shone British and American pronunciations 300.3 shoot preposition 79.3 short and shortly 21.2 short
answers 493 shorten 129.9 should 494-498
should and would 494 :
should obligation, deduction etc 495
should, ought and must 496
should in subordinate clauses 497
with incase 271.2
should/would auxiliary in conditional clauses etc 498
if... should 261.2
Ishould ...meaning'If I were you,
I should...' 264.2 shout preposition 79.3; 437 show passive 410
two objects 583 shrunken 405.6 shut and close 132 sick and ill 266 silly 21
similarly 159.4 simple past tense 416
simple past and past progressive 417.3-5
simple past and present perfect 418.3-8; 419
simple instead of progressive in subordinate clauses 556.7
simple past instead of perfect in subordinate
clauses 556.7
see also past tenses simple present tense 444
simple present and present progressive 445.5-8
future use 223
simple instead of progressive in subordinate
clauses 556.7 since tenses 499
since (preposition) position 440.6
since, in, from and/or 214 since, as, because and/or 72 singular and plural 500-509
regular plurals 500
irregular and special plurals 501
pronunciation of regular plurals 502
singular nouns with plural verbs 503
plural expressions with singular verbs 504
they with singular reference 505
mixed structures 506
distributive plural 507
noun modifiers (e.g. antique shop, ten-pound note, sports car) 508
miscellaneous points 509
fractions and decimals 385.2
abbreviations 2.5
plural uncountables 148.7 sit with adjectives 147.5 slang 510
sleep well etc 520.20 sleeping and asleep 153 slogans abbreviated style 1.4 slow comparative and
superlative 137
adverb 21.2 small and little 511 smell 512
British and American forms 300.3
can smell 125.1 smile preposition 79.3; 437 so degree adverb 513.1-7
modifying adjectives/adverbs 153
substitute word 513.8-10
used for emphasis 189.3
exclamations 201.3
logical consequence 159.14
inversion 298.6
so am I etc 516.1
so I am etc 516.2
so + adjective + article + noun 16
if so 261.12
so after say and tell 514
so she says, so I hear etc 515.3
so and not with believe, hope etc 515
so and so much 153
so and such 544
so and then 517
so and very 513.3
not so... as 70
so... as to... 513.6 so be it 541
so few/little/many/much 156.2 so long as condition 262 so many and so much 518 so that 519 so to speak
159.16 so-and-so 513.10 so-so 513.10 social language 520 society no article 68.3a some 521
ando/aw 521.4
and no article 521.5
and any 522
some of whom /which 477.1 some time, sometime and sometimes 524
sometime and once 389 somebody position with adjectives 15.5
somebody and someone 523
page 649


something position with adjectives 15.5 sometime and once 389
somewhere position with adjectives 15.5
somewhere we can stay etc 477.3 soon comparative and superlative 137
soon, early and quickly 525 sorry 520.7,8
+ -ing form or infinitive 296.14 preposition 437 sort of 159.16,17; 526
omission of article 69.7 sound and soundly 21.2 sound (verb) 527 south(ern), north(ern) etc 176 spaghetti
uncountable 148.3 speak preposition 437
speak and talk 528
speaking of/about 159.1 special(ly) and especial(ly) 194 spell British and American forms 300.3 spelling
529-537
capital letters 529
-/y530
-ise and-ize 531 hyphens 532
hyphens in compound nouns 379.7 final -e 533 y and i 534
doubling final consonants 535 ch and tch, k and ck 536 ie and ei 537 spelling and pronunciation 538
British-American differences 50.3 its and it's 303
whose and who's 598 regular past tenses 416.3 third person singular forms 444.2 spend... + object + -ing
293.2 spill British and American forms 300.3 spit British and American forms 300.3 split infinitive 276.7
spoil British and American forms 300.3
spokesman/woman, spokesperson 227.5
spring article 69.10
stand with adjectives 147.5
start +-ing form or infinitive 296.10
start and begin 98 stay + adjective 129.10
stay and... 52 steward, stewardess 227 A still 159.3
still, yet and already 539 stop + -ing form or infinitive 296.12
+ object +-ing 293.2 stopped active past participle 404.3 straight adjective and adverb 21.2 street and
road 485 stress 540 in abbreviations 2.3 for emphasis 189.2 strike and stroke 300.2 strong and weak
forms 588
subjunctive 541
subordinate clauses position 142.3
tenses 556
subordinating conjunctions 142.2 substitution 542 such 543
modifying nouns 154.4
used with adjective + noun 543.3; 544.1
used for emphasis 189.3
exclamations 201.3
such and like this/that 543.2
such and so 544
such and very 543.4
such as 543.9
such... as to 543.1 such-and-such 543.8 suffer preposition 437 suggest 545 suit and fit 212 summer article
69.10 Sunday etc no preposition 439 sunken 405.6
superlative see comparison, comparative superlatives with much, far etc 139.3,4
witheiw 197.4 prepositions 138.9 + infinitive 285,3
with non-assertive words 138.13 with the 65.4; 138.10 with very 139,4
see also comparatives and superlatives supper and dinner 338
suppose non-progressive Verb 451.2
suppose (that) 262 suppose so/not 515
I don't suppose so and I suppose not 359
suppose, supposing (conjunctions) 546
that after supposing 262 supposed to 547
sure + -ing form or infinitive 296.15
sure (adverb) 21.2 surely 548
surprise non-progressive verb 451.2 surprised by/at 405.5
swollen active past participle 404.3 sympathetic 549
sympathy polite formulae 520.14
tag questions see question tags
tags see question tags and reinforcement tags take 550
two objects 583
take and bring 112 take (time) 551 take care (of) 127 take off clothes 168.2 take part preposition 437 talk
and speak 528
talking of/about 159.1. l
page 650

tall and high 249
tall and short (marked and unmarked) 341 taste 552
can taste 125.1 tea meal 338 teach + -ing form or infinitive 296.8
two objects 583 technique and technology 553 telephoning 554
telephone numbers 385.4 television article use 69.12
preposition 438 tell passive 410
two objects 583
tell somebody hoivto ...28S
tell and say 487
I told you so 514
can tell 125.2 telling the time 555 tend there tends to be 563.5 tenses list of all active verb forms 10
passive verb forms 407
tenses in subordinate clauses 556
in indirect speech 481.4
in as-clauses 70.9
in be/ore-clauses 96.2,3
with as if and as though 74.2
with as long as 75
with as, when and while 73
with since 499
with before (adverb) 95
see also present tenses, past tenses etc than than I or than me etc 138.8; 425.9
than replacing subject/object 138.14
inversion 298.6
than, as and that 557 than ever 197.6 thank you 429 thankful and grateful 558 thanks 520.19 that
(conjunction) omission 560
dropped in indirect speech 481.5
that, than and as 557 that demonstrative: see this that relative pronoun 473-474; 477
that which (older English) 476.5
that, where and when (relative) 143.3 that-clauses 559 thatlstosay 159.15,16 that/those of... 391.8 the
British Isles, Britain, the United Kingdom
and England 114 the 63-65,68-69
the... tfiewith comparatives 138.5
the with superlatives 65.4; 138.12
the meaning 'enough' 193.7
see also articles the accused, the beautiful, the blind, the former
etc 18
the British, the Dutch etc 354 the fact that 441.2; 559.3 the hell used for emphasis 189.3
Index"
the majority 326
the matter (with) 561
the moment, the minutp ptr- r^n •
the police 68.3b Conjunction) 267
the rest 484
the sea 68.3a
the way and how 254.6
the weather 68.3a
theatre article use 69.12
preposition 438 thee older English 388 then logical consequence 159. i4i
then and .so 517 there 562; there is 563
there is said/thought/etc to be 412.3
there in question tags 466.4
there's + plural 509.4
there goes... 444.6
there and here 248 therefore 159.14 they and them 425
they with singular reference 227.3; 505
they, one and you 392 thicken 129.9 think 564
negative structures 359.1,3
think somebody/something to be 580.3
there is thought to be 412.3
preposition 437
think so/not 515
I thought so 515
think and mean 339.2 this and that 565
this/that and it 566
this and that meaning 'so' 565.7
this/these sort of etc 526 this is the first time etc + present/past perfect 419.7
this is the last...+ present 307.5 thou older English 388 though and although 48
though and as: special word order 71 thought preposition 437 thousand a thousand and one thousand
385.10
thousand(s) (of) 385.14 through 567
adverb particle 19
through and across 9.5
through and along 43 throw preposition 79.3; 437 thunder uncountable 148.3 thy older English 388 tight
adverb 21.2 till 575 time 568
countable or uncountable 148.5; 568
in time and 071 time 438
(at) what time...2 439
any time you're in town etc 477.3
this is the first time etc + present perfect 419.7 time telling the time 555
page 651


Index
titles 353
abbreviated style 1.4 to and at/in 79
to and in 270
to and until/till 575.2
to dropped after where 591
to school, university etc (expressions without
article) 69.1 to... ing 295.2
to used instead of whole infinitive 186 to a great/some extent 159.12 to begin/start with 159.10 to sum up
159.21 to tell the truth 159.20 tonight 569 too 570
modifying adjectives/adverbs 153
+ adjective + article + noun 16
too... for... + infinitive 280.8
too and too much 153; 570.3
too and very 570.5 too, also and as well 45,46 too few/little/much/many 156.2 too much and too many 571
toothache 148.4 town expressions without article 69.1
town and city 130 traffic uncountable 148.3 train expressions without article 69.1 transferred negation 359
transitive and intransitive verbs 579.2 translate preposition 437 travel uncountable 148.3 • '
travel, journey, trip and voyage 572
travels 148.5
travelled active past participle 404.3 trip preposition 437
trip, journey, travel and voyage 572 trousers 501.7 try + -ing form or infinitive 296.6
try and 52
tube expressions without article 69.1 turn changes 129.7 turning verbs into nouns 573 TV preposition 438
twice as... etc 70.6 type of 526
omission of article 69.7 typical preposition 437
ugly 21
UK 114
unable 3
uncountable see countable
under adverb particle 19
under and below 99 underneath 99.6 understand non-progressive verb 451.2
can understand 125.3
understand how to 288
understand.. .ing 293.1
understand somebody/something to be 580.3
there is understood to be 412.3
/ understand (that)... 246 uninterested and disinterested 160 United Kingdom 114 university preposition
438
expressions without article 69.1 unless 574
and if not 574.2 unlikely 21 until 575
and before 575.7
and by 575.6
and to 575.2 up adverb particle 19
up and down ... 576 us meaning 'me' 424.9 use any/no use 56
any/no use... ing 292.5
there's no use 563.2 used + infinitive 577
used to and would 604.8 used be used to.. .ing 578 usual as usual 76
vacation 250
vanished active past participle 404.3
verb forms active 10
passive 407
verb complementation 579
verb + infinitive 283
verb + -ing form 293
verb + object + complement 15.8; 580
verb + object + infinitive 284
verbs with two objects 583,410 (passive structures)
verbs not used in progressive forms 451
modification of verbs 155
verbs with prepositions and particles 582
verbs of movement (e.g. she danced in) 581 verbs left out in commentaries 1.3 very modifying
adjectives/adverbs 153
very with superlatives, first etc 139.4
very and very much 153
very and (very) much with past participles 405.4
with afraid 25.3
very... indeed 274
very and so 513.3
very and such 543.4
very and too 570.5 very few/little/much/many 156.2
very much with comparatives 139.1
very much afraid 25.3
very much of a 154.3
position of very much 22.2
very much, very and much with past
participles 405.4 voice preposition 438 voyage, travel, journey and trip 572
Index
wait 584
wait and... 52
wait, expect, hope and look forward 202 waiter, waitress 227A wake British and American forms 300.3
wake, awake and (a)waken 85 want 585
non-progressive verb 451.2
negative structure 359.4
want (to) 186.3
want... ing passive meaning 293.3
want and will 600.7 -ward(s) 586 wash (oneself) 471.9 watch + object + infinitive or -ing form 245
+ object + past participle 245.3
watch, look (at) and see 489 wave preposition 79.3
way prepositions, relative and other structures 587
way and means/method 587.4
the way she spoke etc 477.3
by the way 159.8 we inclusive or exclusive 424.8
we and us 425 weak and strong forms 588 wear 168.3 weather the weather 68.3a
weathers 148.5
weekly adjective and adverb 21.1 weigh non-progressive verb 451.2 well 589
position 589; 22.1
well and fit/healthy 15.3
comparative and superlative 137
discourse marker 159.16,17,20
well and good 589.1
as well 45-46
as well as 77; 159.11 well-read active past participle 404.3 Welsh, Welshman/woman 354.3 were instead
of was 260.4; 541 wert older English form of were 388 west(ern), north(em) etc 176 wet British and
American forms 300.3 what question word 460
nominal relative pronoun 476.1
exclamations 201.2
singular or plural verb 509.3
what I need is... etc 131
what to ... 288
what and pardon 520.8
what, how and why 254.3
what, which and who (question words) 594
see also question words and relative
pronouns
what do you mean? 339.5 what ever, on earth, the hell etc 595; 189.3 what if 546 what is more 159.11
what... like and how 255
Whattlma nn nronncitinn All
whatever 476.4; 596 when question word 460
relative use 473.3
when and that (relative) 143.3
nominal relative pronoun 476.4
conjunction with past perfect 421.5
when...ing 406.6
when, as and while 73
when and if 590
see also question word* when ever, the hell etc 595 whenever 476.4; 596 where question word 460
relative use 473.3
where and that (relative) 143.3
nominal relative pronoun 476.4
where (to) 591
where's + plural 509.4
see also question words where ever, the hell etc 595 whereas 159.2 wherever 476.4, 596 whether
andzy'593
whether ...or 592
preposition + whether 441 which question word 460
relative pronoun 473-477
nominal relative pronoun 476.2
which, what and who 594
see also question words and relative
pronouns whichever 596 while contrast 159.2
while, as and when 73
while.. .ing 406.6 who question word 460
relative pronoun 473-477
who and whom 425.4-6
singular or plural verb 509.3
who to ... 288
who, what and which 594
see also question words and relative pronoun who ever, the hell etc 595 whoever 476.4; 596 whole and all
38
on the whole 159.12 whose question word 433.4; 460; 597
relative pronoun 475
whose and who's 598 why question word 460
relative use 473.3
+ infinitive 599.3
why should...? 464.2; 599.2
why and why not 599.1
why, what and how 254.3 why ever, the hell etc 595 wicked pronunciation 13 wide and widely 21.2
wide and broad 115
wide and large 105.6 widen 129.9


will 600; future auxiliary 221
interpersonal uses 222
willyou...? (meanings) 221.9
will with if 259.3
will and want 600.7 win and beat 92 wind and wound 300.2 winter article 69.10 wish 601
non-progressive verb 451.2 wishes best wishes etc 520.13 with 602
possession 602.5
acompanying circumstances 602.4
clothing, voices, transport 602.6
meaning 'against' 602.3
with (tools) and by (method, agent) 117 with reference to 159.1 without and except 200.6
and instead of'297.2
article not dropped 69.2 woman omission of article 69.9 woman-haters, women drivers 508.2 wonder I
wondered 11 was wondering (polite
requests) 161.2 won't refusals 222.3 word order adjectives after nouns 15.4
adjectives after something etc 15.5
adverb position 22-23
verb not separated from object 22.1
as and though after adjective/adverb 71
auxiliary verb etc before subject 298
whole verb before subject 299
fronting 217
questions 461, 462
position of subordinate clauses 142.3
prepositions at the ends of clauses 440
direct and indirect object 583
object of phrasal verb 582.3
all 35-36
both 110
enough 193
even 195
how 254.1
quite 467.3
rather 468.3
well 22.1
very much 22.2
yet, still and already 539 work uncountable 148.3
expressions without article 69.1 worried about/by 408 worry active and passive with similar meanings
404.3
worse, worst 136.2; 137 worth 603 worthwhile 603 would 494; 498; 604
distancing use 161.3
future in the past 226
would and should with if 260.3
would and used to 604.8
would rather 469.2,3 would you mind ...? 342 wound and wind 300.2 wretched pronunciation 13 write
direct and indirect objects 583 wrong adverb 21.2 prepositions 437
ye older English form of you 388 yearly adjective and adverb 21.1 years old 30 yes and no 605
in answers to negative questions 360.4 yet 159.3
non-assertive word 374.1
with present perfect 418.5
after superlatives 138.13
yet, already and ever 197.7
yet, still and already 539 you and I etc 424.11; 425.3 you know 159.17 you meaning 'people in general'
392
you, one and they 392
you guys, you all (US) 424.2 your health 520.12 you're welcome 590.19 yours faithfully/sincerely 317
zero 385.3



Wyszukiwarka

Podobne podstrony:
English for Medical S&D Practical English sentences key
practical English sentences
English for Medical S&D Practical English sentences
English for Medical S&D Practical English dialogues
English Grammar Preposition
http www perfect english grammar com
Autotick English Grammar Test Level 3 42p
English for Medical S&D Practic Nieznany (2)
32 Grammar Verb And Prepositions Bbc English Learning Quizzes & Vocabulary

więcej podobnych podstron